Followership13
DESCRIPTION
You cannot have leaders without followers. In the previous chapter, "Inclusive Leadership" (Chapter 12), we focused on inclusive leadership and how leaders can ensure that followers feel a part of the group. In this chapter, we shift the focus to followers and the central role followers play in the leadership process. The process of leading requires the process of following. Leaders and followers together create the leadership relationship, and without an understanding of the process of following, our understanding of leadership is incomplete (Shamir, 2007; Uhl-Bien, Riggio, Lowe, & Carsten, 2014).
For many people, being a follower and the process offollowership have negative connotations. One reason is that people do not find followership as compelling as leadership. Leaders, rather than followers, have always taken center stage. For example, in school, children are taught early that it is better to be a leader than a follower. In athletics and sports, the praise for performance consistently goes to the leaders, not the team players. When people apply for jobs, they are asked to describe their leadership abilities, not their followership activities. Clearly, it is leadership skills that are applauded by society, not followership skills. It is just simply more intriguing to talk about how leaders use power than to talk about how followers respond to power.
While the interest in examining the active role offollowers was first approached in the 1930s by Follett (1949), groundwork on follower research wasn't estab lished until several decades later through the initial works of scholars such as Zaleznik (1965), Kelley (1988), Meindl (1990), and Chaleff (1995). Still, until recently, only a minimal number ofstudies have been published on followership. Traditionally, leadership research has focused on leaders' traits, roles, and behav iors because leaders are viewed as the causal agents for organizational change. At the same time, the impact of followers on organizational outcomes has not been generally addressed. Researchers often conceptualize leadership as a leader centric process, emphasizing the role of the leader rather than the role of the
352
follower. Furthermore, little research has conceptualized leadership as a shared process involving the interdependence between leaders and followers in a shared relationship. Even though followers share in the overall leadership process, the nature of their role has not been scrutinized. In effect, followership has rarely been studied as a central variable in the leadership process.
There are indications that this is beginning to change. In a 2017 New York Times article, Susan Cain (author of Quiet: The Power ofIntroverts in a World That Can't Stop Talking [2012]) decries the glorification of leadership skills in college admissions and curricula and argues that the world needs more followers. It needs team players, people called to service, and individuals committed to something outside of themselves. Followership is also receiv ing more attention now because of three major works devoted exclusively to the process of following: The Art ofFollowers hip: How Great Followers Create Great Leaders and Organizations by Riggio, Chaleff, and Lipman-Blumen (2008), Followership: How Followers Are Creating Change and Changing Leaders by Kellerman (2008); and Followership: What Is It and Why Do People Follow? by Lapierre and Carsten (2014). Collectively, these books have put the spotlight on followership and helped to establish it as a legitimate and significant area of study.
In this chapter, we examine followership and how it is related to the leadership process. First, we define followers and followership and discuss the implications of these definitions. Second, we discuss selected typologies offollowership that illus trate different styles used by followers. Next, we explore a formal theory of fol lowership that has been set forth by Uhl-Bien et al. (2014) and new perspectives on followership suggested by Carsten, Harms, and Uhl-Bien (2014). Last, we explore types ofineffective followership that contribute to destructive leadership.
Followership Defined
It is challenging to define fallowership because the term conjures up different meanings for people, and the idea of being a follower is positive for some and negative for others. For example, followership is seen as valuable in military situ ations when soldiers follow orders from a platoon leader to complete a mission, or when passengers boarding a plane follow the boarding agent's instructions. In contrast, however, followership is thought of negatively in such situations as when people follow a cult leader such as David Koresh of the Branch Davidians, or when members of a college fraternity take it upon themselves to conduct life-threatening hazing rituals with new members. Clearly, followership can be positive or negative, and it plays out differently in different settings.
What is followership? Followership is aprocess whereby an individual or individu als accept the influence efothers to accomplish a common goal. F ollowership involves a power differential between the follower and the leader. Typically, followers comply with the directions and wishes ofleaders-they defer to leaders' power.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 353
Followership also has an ethical dimension. Like leadership, followership is not amoral; that is, it is not a process that is morally neutral. Followership carries with it a responsibility to consider the morality of one's actions and the rightness or wrongness of the outcomes of what one does as a follower. Followers and lead ers work together to achieve common goals, and both share a moral obligation regarding those goals. There are ethical consequences to followership and to what followers do because the character and behavior of followers has an impact on leaders and on organizational outcomes.
Role-Based and Relational-Based Perspectives
Followership can be divided into two broad categories: role-based and relational based (Uhl-Bien et al.,2014).
The role-based perspective focuses on followers in regard to the typical roles or behaviors they exhibit while occupying a formal or informal position within a hierarchical system. For example, in a staff planning meeting, some people are very helpful to the group because they bring energy and offer insightful sugges tions regarding how the group might proceed. Their role as engaged followers, in this case, has a positive impact on the meeting and its outcomes. Emphasis in the role-based approach is on the roles and styles of followers and how their behaviors affect the leader and organizational outcomes.
The relational-based approach to followership is quite different from the role based approach. To understand the relational-based approach it is helpful to understand social constructivism. Social constructivism is a sociological theory that argues that people create meaning about their reality as they interact with each other. For example, a fitness instructor and an individual in an exercise class negotiate with each other about the kind of influence the instructor will have and the amount of influence the individual will accept. From a social constructivist perspective, followership is co-created by the leader and follower in a given situ ation. The meaning of followership emerges from the communication between leaders and followers and stresses the interplay between following and leading. Rather than focusing on roles, it focuses on the interpersonal process and one person's attempt to influence and the other person's response to these influence attempts. Leadership occurs within the interpersonal context ofpeople exerting influence and responding to those influence attempts. In the relational-based approach, followership is tied to interpersonal behaviors rather than to specific roles (Carsten, Uhl-Bien, West, Patera, &McGregor, 2010; DeRue &Ashford, 2010; Fairhurst & Uhl-Bien, 2012; Uhl-Bien et al., 2014).
Typologies of Followership
How can we describe followers' roles? Trying to do just that has been the primary focus of much of the existing followership research. As there are many types
354 LEADERSHIP
TABLE 1:s.1 Typologies of Followership
I I
I Zaleznik (1965) I Kelley (1992)
Kellerman I
I Chaleff (1995) (2008) I
Withdrawn Alienated Resource Isolate
Masochistic Passive Individualist Bystander
Compulsive Conformist Implementer Participant
Impulsive Pragmatist · Partner Activist
Exemplary Diehard
Source: Adapted from "Conceptualizing followership: A review of the literature," by B. Crossman and J. Crossman, 2011, Leadership, 7(4), 481-497.
of leaders, so, too, are there many types of followers (Table 13.1). Grouping followers' roles into distinguishable categories to create an accurate classifica tion system, or typology, of follower behaviors has been undertaken by several researchers. A typology enhances our understanding of the broader area of fol lowership by breaking it down into smaller pieces. In this case, these pieces are different types of follower roles observed in various settings.
The Zaleznik Typology ·
The first typology offollowers was provided by Zaleznik ( 1965) and was intended to help leaders understand followers and also to help followers understand and become leaders. In an article published in the Harvard Business Review, Zaleznik created a matrix that displayed followers' behaviors along two axes: dominance- submission and activity-passivity (Figure 13.1). The vertical axis represents a range of followers from those who want to control their leaders (i.e., be domi nant) to those who want to be controlled by their leaders (i.e., be submissive). The horizontal axis represents a range of followers from those who want to initiate and be involved to those who sit back and withdraw. Based on the two axes, the model identifies four types of followers: withdrawn (submissive/pas sive), masochistic (submissive/active), compulsive (highly dominant/passive), and impulsive (highly dominant/active). Because Zaleznik was trained in psychoana lytic theory, these follower types are based on psychological concepts. Zaleznik was interested in explaining the communication breakdowns between authority figures and subordinates, in particular the dynamics ofsubordinacy conflicts. The follower types illustrated in Figure 13.1 exist as a result offollowers' responses to inner tensions regarding authority. These tensions may be unconscious but can often come to the surface and influence the communication in leader-follower relationships.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 355
FIGURE 13 .1 Za leznik Follower Typology
Dominance (Con trolling)
Compulsive Impulsive
Passivity ——-+——– Activity
Withdrawn Masochistic
Submission (Being Controlled)
,. u .E Zaleznik, A. (1965). The dynam ics of subordinacy, Harvard Business Review, May-Jun.
The Kelley Typology
Kelley's (1992) typology (Figure 13.2) is currently the most recognized follow ership typology. Kelley believes followers are enormously valuable to organiza tions and that the power of followers often goes unrecognized. He stresses the importance of studying followers in the leadership process and gave impetus to the development of the field of followership. While Zaleznik ( 1965) focused on the personal aspects of followers, Kelley emphasizes the motivations of fol lowers and follower behaviors. In his efforts to give followership equal billing to leadership, Kelley examined those aspects offollowers that account for exemplary followers hip.
Kelley sorted followers' styles on two axes: independent critical thinking dependent uncritical thinking and active-passive. These dimensions resulted in five follower role types:
• passive followers (sometimes pejoratively called "sheep"), who look to the leader for direction and motivation,
• conformist followers, who are "yes people"-always on the leader's side but still looking to the leader for direction and guidance,
• alienated followers, who think for themselves and exhibit a lot of negative energy,
356 LEADERSHIP
FIGURE 13.2 Kelley Follower Typology
Independent, Critical Thinking
Alienated Exemplary Followers Followers
Passive —- – PragmatiSt – -===- Active Followers
Passive Conformist FollowersFollowers
Dependent, Uncritical Thinking
Source: Based on excerpts from Kelley, Robert. E. (1992). The Power of Followership: How to Create Leaders People Want to Follow and Followers Who Lead Themselves. New York: Doubleday.
• pragmatist followers, who are "fence-sitters" who support the status quo but do not get on board until others do, and
• exemplary followers (sometimes called "star"followers), who are active and positive and offer independent constructive criticism.
Based on his observations, Kelley (1988, 2008) asserts that effective follow ers share the same indispensible qualities: (1) They self-manage and think for themselves, exercise control and independence, and work without supervision; (2) they show strong commitment to organizational goals (i.e., something outside themselves) as well as their own personal goals; (3) they build their competence and master job skills; and (4) they are credible, ethical, and coura geous. Rather than framing followership in a negative light, Kelley underscores the positive dimensions offollowing.
The Chaleff Typology
Chaleff (1995, 2008, 2009) developed a typology to amplify the significance of the role of followers in the leadership process (Table 13 .1). He developed his typology as a result of a defining moment in his formative years when he became aware of the horrors of the World War II Holocaust that killed more than 6 million European Jews. Chaleff felt a moral imperative to seek answers
CHA PTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 357
FIGURE 13.3 Leader- Follower Interaction
r Common
Source.· Adapted from "Creating new ways of following" by I. Chaleff, in RE. Riggio, I. Chaleff, and J. Lipman-Blumen (Eds.), The Art of Fo!!owership· How Great Followers Create Great Leaders and Organizations (p. 71), 2008. Permission conveyed through Copyright Clearance Center, Inc. Republished with permission of John Wiley & Sons.
as to why people followed German leader Adolf Hitler, a purveyor of hate and death. What could be done to prevent this from happening again? How could followers be emboldened to help leaders use their power appropriately and act to keep leaders from abusing their power?
Rather than serving leaders, Chaleff argues that followers serve a common pur pose along with leaders (Figure 13.3) and that both leaders and followers work to achieve common outcomes. Chaleff states that followers need to take a more proactive role that brings it into parity with the leader's role. He sought to make followers more responsible, to change their own internal estimates of their abilities to influence others, and to help followers feel a greater sense of agency.
To achieve equal influence with leaders, Chaleff emphasizes that followers need to be courageous. His approach is a prescriptive one; that is, it advocates how followers ought to behave. According to Chaleff, followers need the courage to
a. assume responsibility for the common purpose,
b. support the leader and the organization,
c. constructively challenge the leader if the common purpose or integrity of the group is being threatened,
d. champion the need for change when necessary, and
e. take a moral stand that is different from the leader's to prevent ethical abuses.
358 LEADERSHIP
FIGURE 13.4 Chaleff Follower Typology
High Support
PartnerImplementer
Low ___::,_____…i..:::==-=====— High Challenge Challenge
Resource Individualist
Low Support
Source: Adapted from "Creating new ways of following" by I. Chaleff, in R. E. Riggio, I. Chaleff, and J. Lipman-Blurnen (Eds.), The Art of Followership: How Great Followers Create Great Leaders and Organizations (p. 71), 2008; permission conveyed through Copyright Clearance Center, Inc. Republished with permission of John Wiley & Sons.
In short, Chaleff proposes that followers should be morally strong and work to do the right thing when facing the multiplicity of challenges that leaders place upon them.
Chaleff created a follower typology (Figure 13.4), which is constructed using two characteristics of courageous followership: the courage to support the leader (vertical axis) and the courage to challenge the leader's behavior and policies (horizontal axis). This typology differentiates four styles of followership:
1. R esource (lower left quadrant), which exhibits low support and low challenge. This describes those followers who do just enough to get by.
2. Indiv idualist (lower right quadrant) , which demonstrates low support and high challenge. Often marginalized by others, i~dividualists speak up and let the leader know where they stand.
3. Implementer (upper left quadrant) , which acts with high support and low challenge. Often valued by the leader, implementers are supportive and get the work done but, on the downside, fail to challenge the leader's goals and values.
4. Partner (upper right quadrant), which shows high support and high challenge. Followers who exhibit this style take responsibility for themselves and for the leader and fully support the leader but are always willing to challenge the leader when necessary.
CHAPTER 13 . FOLLOWERSHIP 359
The Kellerman Typology
Kellerman's (2008) typology of followers was developed from her experience as a political scientist and her observations about followers in different historical contexts. Kellerman argues that the importance ofleaders tends to be overesti mated because they generally have more power, authority, and influence, while the importance iffollowers is underestimated. From her perspective, followers are subordinates who are "unleaders," by which she means they have little power, no position of authority, and no special influence.
Kellerman designed a typology that differentiates followers in regard to a single attribute: level efengagement. She suggests a continuum (Figure 13.5), which describes followers on one end as being detached and doing nothing for the leader or the group's goals and followers on the opposite end as being very dedicated and deeply involved with the leader and the group's goals. As shown in the figure, Kellerman's typology identifies five levels of follower engagement and behaviors:
l Isolates are completely unengaged. They are detached and do not care about their leaders. Isolates who do nothing actually strengthen the influence potential of a leader. For example, when an individual feels alienated from the political system and never votes, elected officials end up having more power and freedom to exert their will.
2 Bystanders are observers who do not participate. They are aware of the leader's intentions and actions but deliberately choose to not become involved. In a group situation, a bystander is one who listens to the discussion but, when it is time to make a decision, disengages and declares neutrality .
.1 Participants are partially engaged individuals who are willing to take a stand on issues, either supporting or opposing the leader. For example,
FIGURE 13.s Kellerman Follower Typology
Low High Level LEVELS OF ENGAGEMENT Level
Isolate Bystander Participant Activist Diehard
)Urce From Foilowership: How Followers Are Creating Change and Changing Leaders, by Barbara Kellerman. 2008, Br ig hton, MA: Harvard Business Rev iew Press.
360 LEADERSHIP
participants would be the employees who challenge or support their leader regarding the fairness of their company's new overtime policy.
4. Activists feel strongly about the leader and the leader's policies and are determined to act on their own beliefs. They are change agents. For example, in 2020 after the death of George Floyd, an African American man, at the hands of a white Minneapolis, Minnesota, police officer, antiracism activists took to the streets in protest to demand change in police practices. Their protests inspired similar protests across the United States and abroad.
5. Diehards are engaged to the extreme. They are deeply committed to supporting the leader or opposing the leader. Diehards are totally dedicated to their cause, even willing to risk their lives for it. In a small-group setting, diehards are followers who are all-consumed with their own position within the group to the point of forcing the group members to do what they want them to do or forcing the group process to implode. For example, there have been U.S. representatives willing to force the government into economic calamity by refusing to vote to raise the country's debt ceiling in order to force their will on a particular issue, such as increased defense spending or funding for a roads project in their district.
What do these four typologies (i.e., Zaleznik, Kelley, Chaleff, and Kellerman) tell us about followers? What insights or conclusions are suggested by the typologies?
First, these typologies provide a starting point for research. The first step in building theory is to define the phenomenon under observation, and these typologies are that first step to identifying key followership variables. Second, these typologies highlight the multitude of different ways followers have been characterized, from alienated or masochistic to activist or individualist. Third, while the typologies do not differentiate a definitive list of follower types, there are some commonalities among them. Generally, the major followership types are active-engaged, independent-assertive, submissive-compliant, and supportive conforming-or, as suggested by Carsten et al. (2014), passive followers, antiau thoritarian followers, and proactive followers.
Fourth, the typologies are important because they label individuals engaged in the leadership process. This labeling brings followers to the forefront and gives them more credence for their role in the leadership process. These descriptions can also assist leaders in effectively communicating with followers. By knowing that a follower adheres to a certain type of behavior, the leaders can adapt their style to optimally relate to the role the follower is playing.
Collectively, the typologies of followership provide a beginning point for theory building about followership. Building on these typologies, the next section discusses some of the first attempts to create a theory of followership.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 361
THEORETICAL APPROACHES TO FOLLOWERSHIP
What is the phenomenon of followership? Is there a theory that explains it? Uhl-Bien and her colleagues (2014) set out to answer those questions by systematically analyzing the existing followership literature and introducing a broad theory offollowership. They state that followership comprises "character istics, behaviors and processes of individuals acting in relation to leaders" (p. 96). In addition, they describe followership as a relationally basedprocess that includes how followers and leaders interact to construct leadership and its outcomes (Uhl-Bien et al., 2014, p. 99).
Based on these definitions, Uhl-Bien et al. proposed a formal theory of fol lowership. They first identified four constructs (i.e., components or attributes) and variables that comprise the process of followership as shown in Table 13.2.
Followership characteristics refer to the attributes of followers, such as the fol lower's traits (e.g., confidence), motivations, and the way an individual perceives what it means to be a follower.
Leadership characteristics refer to the attributes of the leader, such as the leader's power and/or willingness to empower others, the leader's perceptions of follow ers, and the leader's affect (i.e., the leader's positive or negative feelings toward
TABLE 13.2 Theoretical Constructs and Variables of Followership
I Followe,sMp Followe,sh;p · I Leade,sMp and Leadership Characteristics Characteristics Behaviors
Followership Outcomes
Follower Traits Leader Power Followership Behaviors
Individual Follower Outcomes
Follower Motivation
Perceptions and Constructions
Leadership Behaviors
Individual Leader Outcomes
Follower Perceptions and Constructions
Leader Affect Relationship Outcomes
Leadership Process Outcomes
Source: From "Followeiship Theory: A Review and Research Agenda," by M. Uhl-Bien, R. R. Riggio, R. B. Lowe, and M. K. Carsten, The Leadership Quarterly, 25, p. 98. Copyright 2014 by Elsevier. Reprinted with permission.
362 LEADERSHIP
followers). Followership behav iors are the behaviors of individuals who are in the follower role-that is, the extent to which they obey, defer, or resist the leader .. Leadership behaviors are the behaviors of the individuals in the leadership role, such as how the leader influences followers to respond. Finally,followership out comes are the results that occur based on the followership process. The outcomes can influence the individual follower, the leader, the relationship between the leader and the follower, and the leadership process. For example, how a leader reacts to a follower, whether a follower receives positive or negative reinforce ment from a leader, and whether a follower advances the organizational goals all contribute to followership outcomes.
To explain the possible relationships between the variables and constructs identi fied in Table 13.2, the authors proposed two theoretical frameworks: reversing the lens (Figure 13.6) and the leadership co-createdprocess (Figure 13. 7).
Reversing the Lens
Reversing the lens is an approach to followership that addresses followers in a manner opposite ofthe way they have been studied in most prior leadership research. Rather than focusing on how followers areaffectedby leaders, it focuses on howfollowers affect leaders and organizational outcomes. Reversing the lens emphasizes that followers can be change agents. As illustrated in Figure 13.6, this approach addresses (1) the impact offollowers' characteristics on followers'behavior, (2) the impact offollowers' behavior on leaders' perceptions and behavior and the impact ofthe leaders' percep tions and behavior on followers'behaviors, and (3) the impact of both followers' behavior and leaders'. perceptions and behavior on followership outcomes.
FIGURE 13.6 Reversing the Lens
Leader Perceptions
and Behavior
Source: From "Followership Theory: A Review and Research Agenda," by M. Uhl-Bien, R. R. Riggio, R. B. Lowe, and M. K. Carsten, The Leadership Quarterly, 25, p. 98. Copyright 2014 by Elsevier. Reprinted with permission.
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 363
A hypothetical example of how reversing the lens might work is the research a team is doing on employees and followership in a small, nonprofit organization. In this situation, researchers might be interested in how followers' personal ity traits (e.g., introversion-extraversion, dogmatism) relate to how they act at work-that is, their style and work behavior. Researchers might also examine how employees' behavior affects their supervisors' leadership behavior or how the follower- leader relationship affects organizational outcomes. These are just a sample of the research questions that could be addressed. However, notice that the overriding purpose and theme of the study is the impact offollowers on the followership process.
The Leadership Co-Created Process
A second theoretical approach, the leadership co-created process, is shown in Figure 13.7. The name of this approach is almost a misnomer because it implies that it is about leadership rather than followership. However, that is not the case. The leadership co-created process conceptualizes followership as a give-and take process where one individual's following behaviors interact with another individual's leading behaviors to create leadership and its resulting outcomes. This approach does not frame followership as role-based or as a lower rung on a hierarchical ladder; rather, it highlights how leadership is co-created through the combined act ofleading and following.
Leading behaviors are influence attempts-that is, using power to have an impact on another. Following behaviors, on the other hand, involve granting power to
FIGURE 13 7 The Leadership Co-Created Process
Leading Behaviors
Leadership
Following Behaviors
S,1L1r , Based on The A llure of Toxic Leaders by J. Lipman-Blumen, 2005, p. 29; permission conveyed throu g h Copyright Clearance Center, Inc. Republi shed w it h permission of Oxford University Press.
364 LEADERSHIP
another, complying, or challenging. Figure 13. 7 illustrates that (1) followers and leaders have a mutual influence on each other; (2) leadership occurs as a result of their interaction (i.e., their leading and following); and (3) this resulting process affects outcomes.
The following example illustrates what followership would entail using the lead ership co-created process framework in Figure 13.7. Terry Smith is a seasoned high school football coach who paints houses in the summer to supplement his income. One summer, Coach Smith invited one of his players,Jason Long, to work with him as a painter. Coach Smith and Jason worked well together, shar ing painting responsibilities, and often finding innovative ways to accomplish their painting jobs more efficiently.
When the summer was over and football practice resumed, however, Coach Smith and Jason ran into problems. At practice, Jason called Coach Smith by his first name, joking with him about their painting jobs, and behaving as a peer rather than a team member. Although Coach Smith liked being on a first-name basis with Jason in the summer, he was concerned that other team members would also start calling him by his first name and he would lose their respect of him as the coach.Jason, on the other hand, felt good about his relationship with Coach Smith and the influence he had with him. He did not want to lose this, which would happen ifhe was forced to resume calling him Coach Smith, like the rest of the players.
To resolve, their issues, Coach Smith and Jason discussed how they would address one another in a series of interactions and decided it was best for Jason to call Smith "Coach Smith" during the academic year to facilitate a positive working relationship between the coach and all of the team members.
In this example, the leadership co-created process can be seen in the different leading and following moves Smith and Jason made. For example, when Coach Smith asked Jason to join him to paint, he was asserting friendly influence which Jason accepted by agreeing to work with Smith. When Jason suggested more efficient methods ofpainting, Smith accepted the influence attempt and deferred to Jason's ideas. By calling each other by their first names while working together, both Jason and Smith assumed that leadership was being shared.
But, when football practice started in the fall and Jason continued to call Smith by his first name instead of "Coach Smith," it was apparent that for Coach Smith to retain his influence with the other players, Jason and Smith needed to reach an agreeable decision on "who was in charge" and "who was to follow." Together they decided what leadership (i.e., coaching) and followership meant in the different contexts. The result was better football practices because all players received what they perceived as equal treatment. In this situation, researchers studying followership would focus on the way Smith's and Jason's leading and
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 365
following behaviors resulted in leadership that in turn resulted in effective or ineffective outcomes.
Because followership research is in the initial stages of development, the two frameworks-reversing the fens and the leadership co-created process-set forth by Uhl-Bien and her colleagues (2014) are initial attempts to create a theory of followership. The frameworks provide a way to conceptualize followership that is useful to researchers in generating further studies to explore the intricacies of followership such as the work we discuss in the next section.
New Perspectives on Followership
The research on followership is continuing to evolve and has resulted in a growing interest in the role followers have in organizations. Work by Carsten et al. (2014) not only helps organizations understand followers but also presents positive aspects of being a follower and suggests several practical perspectives on followership.
Perspective 1: Followers Get the Job Done
In the past, there has been what Meindl (1995) called a "romance ofleadership," which emphasized the importance ofleaders and leadership to the functioning of groups and organizations. There has been less recognition of the importance of followers to getting the job done. When viewed from a less leader-centric perspec tive, leadership can be seen as something that occurs among followers as a result of how they interpret leadership. This places less emphasis on the personality of the leader and more on followers' reactions to the leader. It shifts attention away from leaders as the causal agents of organizational change and focuses on how the behavior offollowers affects organizational outcomes. Clearly, followers carry out the mission of the group and the organization; in short, they do the work. They are central to the life of the organization. Going forward, more attention needs to be given to the personalities, cognitive abilities, interpersonal skills, and problem-solving abilities of followers (Carsten et al., 2014 ).
Perspective 2: Followers Work in the Best Interest of the Organization's Mission
Although not true of all followers, proactive followers are committed to achiev ing the goals of the group or organization to which they belong. Rather than being passive and blindly obedient to the wishes of the leader, these followers report asserting themselves in ways that are in alignment with the goals of the organization. They put the organization's goals ahead of the leader's goals. The advantage of proactive followers is that they guard against leaders who act in self-serving or unethical ways. For example, if the president of the United States asked a cabinet member to do something that would personally benefit only the president, the cabinet member might refuse, arguing that what they were
366 LEADERSHIP
asked to do was not in the best interests of the country, which they ultimately serve. Followers act as a check and balance on a leader's power, protecting the organization against abuse of this power. Proactive followers keep the organiza tion front and center.
Perspective 3: Followers Challenge Leaders
As illustrated in the typologies outlined earlier in the chapter, being engaged, active, and challenging are identifying characteristics of effective followers. But followers who challenge the leader can also help to make an organization run more effectively and successfully. When followers have knowledge about a pro cess or procedure ofwhich the leader is unaware, the followers become a strong asset both to the leader and to the organization. They become extra "eyes" to make sure the leader sees the organization from another angle. In addition, fol lowers who are proactive and challenge the leader can keep the leader in sync with the overall mission of the organization.
In his work on a conceptual framework of"authentic followership," de Zilwa (2014) focuses on the relational interactions between leaders and followers and how authentic followership impacts leadership processes. De Zilwa argues that followership is proactive-followers make a conscious decision to follow a leader. This challenges the conventional view that a leader's influence is a one-way process. In being authentic, followers are assertive and offer independent, criti cal thought. Rather than blindly following a leader, authentic followers develop capacities for cooperation as they focus on organizational effectiveness. They are self-aware and know when to place the needs ofothers above their own, making the leader more effective.
To illustrate this point, consider what happened between Amy Malley, an upper level college student, and her professor, Dr. Orville. After Dr. Orville posted the final grades for a capstone course that he taught, Amy came to see him in his office.
"I saw my posted grade, and I want you to know it is wrong," she said. "I know for certain I did very well on the exam and my grade for the course should be an A, but your posting indicates I got a B. Something is wrong with your calculations or the key for the exam."
Dr. Orville, who had taught for 25 years and never made an error in a student's grade, began to shrug off Amy's assertions and tell her she was wrong. She persisted and challenged Dr. Orville because she was confident that her exam grade was incorrect. After much discussion, Dr. Orville offered to let Amy see her exam and the scoring key. To his surprise, her answe~s were correct, but he had marked them wrong. Upon looking further into the matter, Dr. Orville became aware that he had wrongly scored all the students' exams because he had used the incorrect scoring key. Recognizing his error, Dr. Orville immediately changed
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 367
Amy's grade and recalculated the grades for the rest of the class. In this example, Amy's challenging of Dr. Orville's leadership resulted in positive outcomes for all the students and also for the leader.
Perspective 4: Followers Support the Leader
In addition to challenging a leader, it is equally important for followers to support the leader. To advance an organization's mission, it is valuable for leaders when followers validate and affirm the leaders' intentions. Consider what happens in a small-group setting when an individual member attempts to make a point or advance an idea. If someone in the group supports the individual, the group member's idea is heard and gains traction in the group, as does the group member. However, if individual members do not receive support from other group members, they tend to feel disconfirmed and question their role in the group.
For a leader, having a follower who supports you is like having a lieutenant. The lieutenant affirms the leader's ideas to others and in so doing gives the leader's ideas validity. This support strengthens a leader's position in the group and helps advance the leader's goals (Yelsma, 1999). We all need lieutenants, but leaders especially need lieutenants. Support from others is essential to advancing ideas with others. An example of how not having this support can affect outcomes can be seen in the leadership of Michigan governor Gretchen Whitmer during the COVID-19 crisis, when she gave a mandate to close down businesses in the entire state to slow the spread of the virus but could not muster enough support from the state legislature to keep the measure solidly in place. In this case, not having the support of others in a group was detrimental to the leader.
Perspective 5: Followers Learn From Leaders
A serendipitous outcome of being a follower is that in the process of following you learn about leading. Followership gives individuals the opportunity to view leadership from a position unencumbered from the burdens and responsibilities of being the leader. Followers get to observe what does or does not work for a leader; they can learn which leadership approaches or methods are effective or ineffective and apply this learning if they become leaders.
Consider the training that individuals undergo to become teachers. In most edu cation programs, becoming certified as a teacher requires students to do "student teaching" or "supervised teaching," spending a semester working with a certified teacher in a classroom where actual teaching and learning are taking place. The student gets a chance to observe what teachers do and what teaching requires without the full responsibility of being in charge of the students and the edu cational outcomes. These student teachers have the opportunity to explore their own competencies and hone their teaching skills. From a followership perspective, the student is playing the follower role but in the process learns the leader role.
368 LEADERSHIP
Followership and Destructive Leaders
Thus far in this chapter, we have focused on effective rather than ineffective followership. For example, we have discussed how followers provide valuable confirmation to leaders and help them accomplish organizational goals. But there is another side to followership in which followers can play unproductive, and even harmful, roles.
Some research suggests there is actually a "dark side" to followership. Schyns, Wisse, and Sanders (2019) found that followers who exhibit the "dark triad" of traits-narcissism, Machiavellianism, and psychopathy-are likely to have nega – tive effects on fellow organization members and the organization as a whole. The authors identified "red flag"behaviors ofdark triad followers such as taking credit for others'work, self-promotion, becoming aggressive after feedback, controlling others, manipulation, and bullying. When both leaders and followers have dark triad traits, the outcomes for the other group members and the organization may be even more negative.
Another way followers can have a debilitating impact is through their facilita tion of toxic leadership. For example, when followers are passive or submissive, their inaction can contribute to unfettered leadership and unintentionally sup port toxic leaders. Furthermore, followers can create contexts that are unhealthy and make it possible for leaders who are not interested in the common good to thrive. When followers act in ways that contribute to the power of destructive leaders and their goals, it can have a debilitating impact on not just the group or organization they serve, but the followers as well.
In The Allure of Toxic Leaders (2005), Jean Lipman-Blumen explored toxic leadership from the perspective of followership. Toxic, or harmful, leaders are leaders who have dysfunctional personal characteristics and engage in numerous destructive behaviors. Yet, people follow them. There are many examples ofsuch leaders in world history, among them Adolf Hitler, whose leadership led to the extermination of6 million Jews in Europe; former Serbian and Yugoslavian pres ident Slobodan Milosevic, who ordered the genocide of thousands ofAlbanians and forced deportation of nearly a million, and Enron's Jeffrey Skilling and Kenneth Lay, whose conspiracy and fraud cost nearly 20,000 people their jobs and future retirement earnings.
Lipman-Blumen seeks to answer this question: Why do people follow bad lead ers? She identifies a series of psychological factors on the part of followers that contribute to harmful leadership and explains why followers can be compliant even with highly destructive leaders. She also examines how some followers become "henchmen'' for toxic leaders, helping and supporting the toxic leader in enacting a destructive agenda.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 369
Her thesis is that unhealthy followership occurs as a result of people's needs to find safety, feel unique, and be included in community, and her work is useful for developing an understanding of why some followership is negative and has counterproductive outcomes.
Among the psychological factors of followers that can foster destructive leader ship identified by Lipman-Blumen are our need for reassuring authority figures; our need for security and certainty; our need to feel chosen or special; our need for membership in the human community; our fear of ostracism, isolation, and social death; and our fear ofpowerlessness to challenge a bad leader (Table 13.3).
TABLE 13.3 Psychological Factors and Dysfunctional Leadership
1. Our need for reassuring authority figures
2. Our need for security and certainty
3. Our need to feel chosen or special
4 . Our need for membership in the human community
5. Our fear of ostracism, isolation, and social death
6. Our fear of powerlessness to challenge a bad leader
Source: From "Followership Theory: A Rev iew and Research Agenda," by M. Uhl-Bien, R. R. Riggio, R. B. Lowe, and M. K. Carsten, The Leadership Quarterly, 25, p. 98. Copyright 2014 by Elsevier. Reprinted with permission.
1. Our Need for Reassuring Authority Figures
As far back as psychoanalyst Sigmund Freud's research in the early 1900s, much has been written about how people deal with authority. When we are very young, we depend on our parents to guide and protect us; but as we mature, we learn to be our own compass/authority/person and make decisions without being dependent on others. However, even as adults, some people still have a high need for authority fig ures. They want their leaders to provide guidance and protection like their parents used to. This need can open the door for leaders who use followers for their own ends. When followers' needs for a reassuring authority figure are extremely strong, it makes them vulnerable to following abusive and destructive leaders. For example, a middle school student who plays an instrument may practice considerably more than is necessary just to obtain assurance from the teacher that they are good and worthwhile. In this example, the teacher could take advantage ofthis student's need for validation by having the student do more than is commonly required.
2. Our Need for Security and Certainty
The freedom many people experience when achieving adulthood can bring uncertainty and disruption to their lives. Psychologists who study people's belief
370 LEADERSHIP
systems have found that people have a need for consistency-to keep their beliefs and attitudes balanced. Our drive for certainty means we struggle in contexts where things are disrupted and we do not feel "in charge" of events. This uncertainty and insecurity creates stress from which we seek to find relief. It is in contexts like these that followers are susceptible to the lure of unethical leaders who have power. For example, think about migrant workers who come from Mexico to the United States to work on a large produce farm. The farmer they work for has promised good wages and a place to live. But upon arriving at the farm, the workers find they are required to work in the fields for up to 15 hours a day, seven days a week, and the housing provided is substandard. In addition, the farmer charges the workers a high rent for the housing, plus additional fees for providing drinking water in the fields. The workers, who are undocumented immigrants, put up with these conditions because they need the meager income they make and they know that if they complain, the farmer will report them to immigration authorities and they will be deported. The fragile security of working for the farmer outweighs the uncertainty of living in poverty in Mexico.
3. Our Need to Feel Chosen or Special
To explain the need to feel "chosen,"Lipman-Blumen points to historic religious leaders, such as Moses and John Calvin, who emphasized to their people that there were "chosen ones" among them who were special and singled out by a higher authority. Being a part of"the chosen'' means one has "truth" on one's side and those who are the "others" do not. Being chosen means protecting one's unique ness and distinguishing oneself from others. While being chosen provides some comfort and even a feeling of immortality, it can motivate some to do battle with others. Being part of the chosen and feeling that they are "right" gives a sense of security to followers, but it does so at the expense of appreciating the humanity of"the others."
Consider, for example, those who adhere to a white supremacist ideology based on the belief that white people are "chosen" and superior to all other races and should have control over people of those other races. White supremacists oppose people of color and those members of non-Christian religions who they believe threaten the "purity" of the white race. Followers ofwhite supremacy's belief in being somehow special reinforces their behaviors, which often involve treating others inhumanely.
4. Our Need for Membership in the Human Community
Psychologist William Schutz (1958) argued that one of humans' strongest interpersonal needs is to know whether they belong to the group. Are we "in" or "out"? Are we included with others and acknowledged as a member of the community or not?
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 371
When groups and organizations function positively, it is healthy for all group members, not detrimental. Group members feel accepted, comfortable, valued, and inspirited. But people's need to be members of the group can be exploited by destructive leaders who take advantage of individuals who are highly dependent on the group for their own personal meaning and purpose. Highly dependent followers may be willing to give up their individuality, beliefs, and integrity just to make sure they can retain their social belonging (Lipman-Blumen, 2005).
Consider the number of disturbing hazing incidents at fraternities or other groups on college campuses that have resulted in the injuries and deaths of new members (pledges) who are willing to endure dangerous rituals because of their high need to belong to the group. Followers can become vulnerable to bad leader ship when they are unable to moderate their own personal need for belonging.
5. Our Fear of Ostracism, Isolation, and Social Death
When an individual becomes a part ofand acquires full membership to a group, the individual typically learns and begins to practice the norms ofthe group. Surrounded by the group, followers become comfortable with the group's values, mission, and beliefs. In addition, followers begin to like being a group member and doing what group members do and find the inclusion and community ofthe group comforting.
But being a part of the group also has a downside. This inclusion and community makes it difficult for individuals to break out of the group or dissent if the group's mission or values run counter to their own. Pressure to conform to the group makes it challenging for individuals to disagree with the group or try to get the group to change. When followers act against group norms or bring attention to the negative aspects ofwhat the group is doing (e.g., whistle-blowers), they run a high risk of becoming ostracized and isolated from the group.
For example, imagine being in a group of friends, and several members of your group have started to make fun ofa young man in your class who is on the autism spectrum and often acts awkwardly in social situations. You dislike how they treat this young man and consider their behavior to be bullying. Do you speak up and tell them to stop, knowing that you might be ostracized by the rest ofthe group? Or do you "keep quiet" and maintain your relationships with your friends? Being an ethical follower carries with it the burden ofacting out your individual values even when it can mean social death.
6. Our Fear of Powerlessness to Challenge a Bad Leader
Finally, followers may unintentionally enable destructive leaders because they feel helpless to change them. Once a part of a group, followers often feel pressure to conform to the norms of the group. They find that it is not easy to challenge the leader or go against the leader's plans for the group. Even when a leader acts inap propriately or treats others in harmful ways, it is hard for followers to muster the
372 LEADERSHIP
courage to address the leader's behavior. Groups provide security for followers, and the threat of losing this security can make it scary to challenge authority figures. To speak truth to power is a brave act, and followers often feel powerless to express themselves in the face ofauthority. Although being an accepted follower in a group carries with it many benefits, it does not always promote personal agency. After all, who would support you ifyou challenged the leader? For example, imagine what it would be like to be a gay employee in an organization whose leadership is openly prejudiced against individuals who identify as lesbian, gay, bisexual, or trans gender. Would you be likely to express disapproval of the leadership and its policies?
The six psychological needs offollowers outlined by Lipman-Blumen are essen tial to understanding the role of followers in fostering destructive leadership. When followers attempt to fulfill these needs, it can create contexts where unethical and destructive leaders are allowed to thrive.
HOW DOES FOLLOWERSHIP WORK?
Unlike established leadership theories such as leader-member exchange theory (Chapter 7) or transformational leadership (Chapter 8) for which there are for mulated models, assumptions, and theorems, followership is an area of study still in its infancy. However, it does provide several "takeaways" that have valuable implications for practicing followership.
First, simply discussing followership forces us to elevate its importance and the value of followers. For many years, the role of leaders in the leadership process has been esteemed far above that of followers, as evidenced by the thousands of research studies that exist on leaders and leadership approaches and the very few that have been done on followership. Leadership has been idealized as a central component of organizational behavior. But by focusing on followership, we are forced to engage in a new way of thinking about those who do the work oflead ership and to explore the merits of the people who do the work of followership. Leadership does not exist in a vacuum; it needs followers to be operationalized. Followership research highlights the essential role that followers fulfill in every aspect of organizational accomplishments. Why should we focus on follower ship? Because it is just as important as leadership.
Second, followership is about how individuals accept the influence of others to reach a common goal. It describes the characteristics and actions of people who have less power than the leader yet are critical components in the leadership pro cess. The typologies offollower behaviors discussed in this chapter provide a cri terion ofwhat followers typically do in different situations when they are being influenced by a leader. Do they help the leader, or do they fight the leader? Do they make the organization run better or worse? Categorizations offollowers are beneficial because they help us understand the way people act when occupying
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 373
a follower role. To know that a person is a follower is useful, but to know if that follower is dependent-passive or proactive-antiauthoritarian is far more valuable. These categories provide information about how followers act and how a leader can respond accordingly. It also helps leaders know followers' attitudes toward work and the organization and how to best communicate with these followers.
Third, followership research provides a means of understanding why harmful leadership occurs and sometimes goes unrestrained. Followers are interdepen dent with leaders in the leadership process-each affects and is affected by the other. When leaders are abusive or unethical, it affects followers. But followers often feel restrained to respond. While they may want to respond to destructive leaders, followers will often become passive and inactive instead. This occurs because they fear losing the security provided by their membership in the group. By understanding their own feelings of powerlessness and need for security and community, followers can more easily identify and confront destructive leaders.
STRENGTHS In this chapter, we trace the development of followership and how it has been conceptualized by researchers over the past 50 years. This research has several strengths.
First, it gives recognition to followership as an integral part of the leadership equation. While some earlier theories ofleadership (e.g., implicit leadership the ory [Lord & Maher, 1991] and social identity theory [Tajfel & Turner, 1986]) recognize followers as an element in the leadership process, the most recent literature suggests an approach to followership that elevates it considerably and gives it equal footing with leadership. Further underscoring the complexity and importance of followership, Popper (2014) suggests that followers' attraction to leaders emerges from one of three perspectives: (a) psychoanalytic, where the leader is seen as a protective figure; (b) cognitive-psychological, where the leader is seen as a suitable and psychologically convenient explanation for a complex reality; or (c) social-psychological, in which the leader is a kind of narrative imparting meaning to followers' social identity and sense of self-worth. This emphasis broadens our purview of leadership and suggests that followership will-and should-receive far more attention by researchers and practitioners in the future.
Second, a focus on followership forces a whole new way for people to think about leadership. While there are textbooks on leadership, such as Hughes, Ginnett, and Curphy's Leadership: Enhancing the Lessons ofExperience (2014), that give special attention to followership, current followership research and literature go further and challenge us to take leadership off its pedestal and replace it with followership. It forces us to focus on followers rather than leaders. It looks to
374 LEADERSHIP
answer questions like these: What makes effective followership? How do follow ers affect group processes and influence goal accomplishment? How do followers influence leaders? For example, recent research by Carsten, Uhl-Bien, and Huang (2018) found that followers influence their leaders through less voice and upward delegation (for example, passing problems to a manager rather than solving the problem themselves). Leaders were less motivated, and less likely to contribute to goal attainment, when followers were passive and engaged in upward delegation. It makes sense that organizations should pay more attention to training follow ers, rather than just leaders, in how to work effectively together.
In addition, new followership literature invites us to view leadership as a co constructed process in which followers and leaders share equally. Rather than focusing on the individuals with the power, our thinking needs to shift to embrac ing the individuals without the power and the relationship these people make with the leader. The study of followership reminds us that leadership is incom plete and cannot be understood without focusing on and understanding the role and dimensions of followers. For example, Pietraszewski (2019) describes how leadership and followership can solve the problem of coordination and cooperation toward goal attainment. He points out that no one follower has all the information needed to solve complex problems alone. Therefore, leaders and followers create a "social marketplace" where leaders propose alternatives, and leaders and followers choose their responses from among them. This marketplace operates on social information processing where leaders and followers propose and evaluate options.
Third, although in its infancy, followership research provides a set of basic pre scriptions for what a follower should or should not do to be effective. These prescriptions provide a general blueprint of the types of behaviors that create effective followership. For example, effective followers balance their need for community with their need for self. They act in the best interests of the orga nization and challenge the leader when the leader's agenda is self-serving or unethical. Effective followers do not act antiauthoritarian, but collaborate to get the job done. Furthermore, they recognize powerlessness in themselves but do not let this keep them from challenging the leader when necessary. While the followership research has not yet produced elegant theories that explain the intricacies of how followership works, it does provide a set of ideas that have strong practical applications.
Furthermore, research on implicit followership theory suggests that leaders look for both attributes related to performance and attributes such as loyalty and being able to cooperate with others in their view of an "ideal" follower (Carsten et al., 2010). Sy (2010) found six factors constitute the ideal follower: industry, enthusiasm, good citizenship, conformity, insubordination, and incompetence. The first three were valued positively (i.e. followership prototype), and the latter three had negative values (i.e., followership antiprototype). This research also
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 375
found that when followers fit the leader's implicit prototype for being a good follower, they reported that they liked the leader more and had higher relation ship quality and trust. Alipour, Mohammed, and Martinez (2017) propose that timing plays an important role in understanding the effects offollowershi p pro totypes. Meeting a leader's expectations on deadlines, time perspective, prefer ence for multitasking, and pacing style all could depend on whether the follower matches the leader's implicit follower prototype. A follower who is aware of and able to engage in behaviors that are consistent with a leader's ideal follower prototype may be more likely to meet the leader's time-related expectations, reducing coordination problems. Followers who perceive an alignment between their followership prototype and their actual behavior are more likely to view followership as part of their self-concept, claim to be a follower rather than a leader, and be more open to their leader's attempts to shape their social identity as a good follower (Epitropaki, Kark, Mainemelis, & Lord, 2017).
CRITICISMS
In addition to its strengths, the study of followership has certain limitations. First, the methodical research that has been conducted on the process offollow ership is in the nascent stage. The absence of advanced research makes it difficult to concretely conceptualize the nature of followership including what defines followers and how followers contribute to the leadership process. Without pre cise theories and models offollowership, there can be no clear set ofprinciples or practices about how followership works and the role it plays in groups, organiza tions, and the community.
Second, the current followership literature is primarily personal observations and anecdotal. For example, the typologies of followership styles discussed earlier in the chapter (i.e., Zaleznik, Kelley, Chaleff, and Kellerman) are useful cat egory systems to differentiate between followers' styles, but the derivation of the typologies is simply the conjectures and hypotheses of a single author. While such descriptive research, including designing different typologies, is a traditional process in the initial phase of theory development, the value and power of our thinking on followership will not advance until followership is fully conceptual ized and tested.
Third, the leader-centric orientation that exists in the world may be too ingrained for followership to blossom. For followership to succeed, it will need both lead ers and followers to be strong in their roles; followers must serve the purpose of teaching the leader as well as learning from the leader (Chaleff, 1995). And in a leader-centric world, where followership's primary purpose is seen as important only to make leaders leaders (you can't be a leader if no one is following), this evolution may take a very long time to come about. There is a need for research that considers both leader and follower prototypes and how these expectations
376 LEADERSHIP
influence the leadership process and outcomes (Foti, Hansbrough, Epitropaki, & Coyle, 2017). Until we have more research that is dyadic, we will only understand parts of the dynamics that explain effective followership.
Fourth, research on followers has not fully addressed the question "Why follow?" Bastardoz and Van Vugt (2019) critiqued the followership literature from an evolutionary psychology perspective. They assert that followership is puzzling because there has been no explanation for why followers give up autonomy and put their own goals aside to follow leaders. From an evolutionary perspective, followership evolved to address problems in groups such as hunting, gathering, and peacekeeping. Those who do not have the ability to lead are more likely to become followers. Also, followership occurs because of the rewards fol lowers receive from a leader, goal alignment, the challenges faced by the group, and the leader's style. The authors argue that evolutionary psychology offers a more robust explanation for followership than current theoretical approaches offered in the literature.
Fifth, there has been little research on when and/or how patterns of follower ship are beneficial or detrimental. Followership is not without risks. Qyalitative research conducted by Benson, Hardy, and Eys (2016) found that leaders viewed followership as important because they rely on followers to offer alternative insights on and solutions to problems. However, they also expect followers to support leader directives. In some instances, follower attempts to influence their leaders were "at the wrong time and place" and viewed as disruptive by the leader. This research raises an important caveat for followers: While proactivity is important, followers must be aware and calibrate their influence attempts by taking the situational factors into account.
APPLICATION
"Follow the leader" is an expression familiar to many. Whether it was a way for teachers to avoid confusion and keep peace with their charges or a game played on the playground, "follow the leader" means people need to get in line behind the designated leader and do what the leader tells them to do. Following the leader is about the process of accepting the leader's authority and influence. More importantly, it is about deciding how to respond to what the leader says.
Followership research is about just that: understanding how and why followers respond to leaders. There are several applications of followership research.
First and foremost, the research underscores the importance of followership it is as important as leadership. This chapter helps us understand the critical and complex role followers play in regard to leaders. It differentiates common roles followers play, from very active and positive to very inactive and negative.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 377
When applied to real-life leadership situations, knowledge about followers and their roles and behaviors expands our understanding of the major components that contribute to group and organizational success.
In addition, the study of followership has implications for organizational train ing and development. Although followership is not currently recognized as a top topic in the training and development field, it is not difficult to see how workshops and training in followership could become very important to orga nizations in the near future. Learning about followership could help followers understand themselves, how they function, and how they can best contribute to the goals of the group or organization of which they are members. Clearly, there is demonstrable value in training programs on such topics as "Being an Effective Follower," "Dealing With Destructive Bosses," or "Accepting the Challenges ofFollowership."With the increased attention being given to fol lowership research, it is expected that an increase in training programs on followership will result as well.
Furthermore, the information described in this chapter can help leaders to understand followers and how to most effectively work with them. So much of the current leadership literature is about the leader and the leader's behavior; however, this chapter shifts the attention to the follower and why followers act the way they do. Leaders can use this followership information to adjust their style to the needs of followers. For example, if the leader finds that followers are aggressive and disruptive, the information in this chapter suggests that they may have authority issues and are acting out because of their own needs for security. Or, some followers may be quiet and compliant, suggesting they need leadership that assures them that they are a part of the group and encourages them to participate more in the group process. Leaders have tried for years to treat followers as individuals with unique needs, but this chapter goes further and provides leaders with cues for action that are derived directly from the followership literature.
3 7 8 LEADERSHIP
CASE STUDIES
The following three case studies (Cases 13.1, 13.2, and 13.3) present follow ership in three different contexts. The first case describes a home health care agency and the unique ways followers contribute to the work of the agency. The second case discusses a renowned rowing team and the way the followers worked together to create cohesiveness and a magical outcome. The last case examines the role of followership in the circumstances that brought down a well-regarded collegiate football program and the university's leadership. At the end of each case, there are questions that will help you to analyze the case utilizing the principles of followership discussed in the chapter.
' Case 1°3.1 BLUEBIRD CARE 1
Robin Martin started Bluebird Care, an in-home health care agency,
20 years ago with a staff of 2.and 5 clients. The agency has grown to a staff of
25 serving 50 clients.
Robin started in elder care as an aide at ·a reputable assisted living facility. She
liked caring for patients and was good at it. When she began running Bluebird
Care, Robin knew all her staff members and their clients. But as the demand for
in-home health care has increased, Bluebird Care has grown as well-hiring more
staff and expanding its service area. For Robin, this means less time with the
company's clients and more time managing her growing agency. She admits she
feels as if she is losing her connections with her clients and staff.
When asked to describe a time when the agency was r~ally running smoothly,
Robin talks about when Bluebird Care had just 10 employees. "This was a good
time for us. Everyone did what they were assigned and did not complain. No one
called in sick; they were very dependable. But, it was different then because we
all lived in the same area and I would see each of our employees every week. On
Tuesdays they had to hand in their time sheets, and every other Thursday they
. stopped to pick up their paycheck. I enjoyed this."
Because the agency's service area is much larger now, encompassing many of
the city's suburbs, Robin seldom sees her employees. Time sheets are emailed
in by employees, and paychecks are sent through the mail or directly deposited
into-employees' bank accounts. Robin says, "Because they never see us, the staff
feels like they can do what they want, and management has nothing to say about
it. It's not the same as when we were smaller."
There is a core of agency staff that Robin does interact with nearly every day. Terry,
a staff member who has been with Robin since the beginning, is Robin's go-to
(Continued)
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 379
(Continued)
person. "I trust her," Robin says. "When she says, 'Robin-we need to do it this way,'
I do what she says. She is always right." Terry is very positive and promotive of the
agency and complimentary of Robin. When other staff members challenge the rules
or procedures of the agency, Terry is the person to whom Robin goes to for advice.
But, Terry also challenges Robin to make Bluebird Care the best agency it can be.
Terry is a direct contrast to Belinda, another employee. A five-year staff member,
Belinda is dogmatic and doesn't like change, yet frequently challenges Robin and
the rules of the agency. Robin describes Belinda as "a bully" and not a team player.
For example, Belinda and Robin had a conflict about a rule in the agency's proce
dural manual that requires staff to work every other weekend. Belinda argued that
it was unfair to force staff members to work every other weekend and that other
similar agencies don't have such policies. To prove her point, Belinda obtained a
competing agency's manual that supported her position and showed it to Robin.
Robin, who does not like confrontation, was frustrated by Belinda's aggressive
conflict style. Robin brought up the issue about weekends with Terry, and Terry
supported her and the way the policy was written. In the end, Belinda did not
get the policy changed, but both Belinda and Robin are sure there will be more
conflicts to come.
Two other key staff members are Robin 's son, Caleb, who hires and trains most of the
employees, and her son-in-law, James. who answers the phone and does scheduling.
Robin says as a manager James does his work in a quiet, respectful manner and sel
dom causes problems. In addition to handling all the hiring and training, Robin relies
on Caleb to troubleshoot issues regarding client services. For both James and Caleb,
the job can become stressful because it is their phones that ring when a staff mem
ber doesn't show up to a client's for work and they have to find someone to fill in.
Caleb also says he is working hard to instill a sense of cohesiveness among the
agency's far-flung staff and to reduce turnover with their millennial-age staff
members. Caleb says while the agency's growth is seen as pos itive, he worries
that the caring philosophy his mother started the agency with is becoming lost.
Questions
1. Who are the followers at Bluebird Care?
2. In what way is followership related to the mission of the agency? Do Robin
and her managers recognize the importance of followership? Explain.
3. Using the roles identified in Chaleff's follower typology (Figure 13.4), what
roles do Terry, Belinda, Caleb, and James play at the agency?
4 . Using the "reversing the lens" framework (Figure 13.6), explain how Caleb
and James's characteristics contribute t o the foll owership outcomes at
Bluebird Care.
380 LEADERSHIP
5. Terry and Robin have a unique relationship in that they both engage in
lead.ing and following. How do you think each of them views leadership
and followership? Discuss.
6. If you were an organizational consultant, what would you suggest to Robin
that could strengthen Bluebird Care? If you were a followership coach,
how would you advise Robin?
Case 13.2 OLYMPIC ROWERS
In the 1930s, rowing was the most popular sport in the country. The sport not
only was physically brutal, but required inexhaustible teamwork. In an eight-man
rowing shell, each member of the team has a role to fulfill based on where he
sits in the boat. The movements of each rower are precisely synchronized with
the movements of the others in the boat. Every rower in the shell must perform
flawlessly with each and every pull of the oar; if one member of the crew is off,
the whole team is off. Any one rower's mistake can throw off the tempo for the
boat's thrust and jeopardize the balance and success of the boat.
In the early 1930s, rowing was a sport dominated by elite East Coast universi
ties like Cornell, Harvard, and Princeton; However; two West Coast teams, the
University of California, Berkeley, and the University of Washington, had an
intense rivalry not only with the crews from the East Coast but with one another
as well. Al Ulbrickson, the varsity crew coach at the University of Washington,
had watched jealously as the California team ascended to national prominence,
representing the United States in the 1932 Olympics, and was determined that his
University of Washington team would be the one to represent the United States
at the 1936 Olympics in Berlin, Germany.
Ulbrickson's program had a number of talented rowers, including those who had
rowed to win the national freshman championships in 1934. Unlike teams from
the East Coast whose members' lives were often marked by privilege and wealth,
many of the boys in the University of Washington program came from poor,
working-class backgrounds. They were the sons of loggers, farmers, and fisher
men, and gaining a spot on the rowing team would help pay for their college
education. Over the summer b·reak these same boys would work, often in danger
ous and physically taxing jobs, so they could afford to return to college in the fall.
Finding the ideal makeup of members for a successful rowing team is a complex
process. A great crew is a carefully balanced mix of rowers with different physical
abilities and personalities. According to Brown (2013), "Good crews are blends of personalities: someone to lead the charge, someone to hold something in reserve, someone to pick a fight, someone to make peace, someone to think through,
(Continued)
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 381
(Continued)
someone to charge ahead without thinking…. Even after the right mixture is
found, each oarsman must recognize their place in the fabric of the crew and
accept the others as they are" (pp. 179-180).
To find that magic mix, Ulbrickson experimented with different combinations of
rowers, putting individual rowers on different teams to see how they performed
together. But it was more than just putting the right abilities together; it was
finding the right chemistry. He finally did with a team of boys who "had been
winnowed down by punishing competition, and in the winnowing a kind of
common character had issued forth: they were all skilled, they were all tough,
they were all fiercely determined, but they were also all good-hearted. Every
one of them had come from humble origins or been humbled by the hard times
in which they had grown up…. The challenges they had faced together had
taught them humility-the need to subsume their individual egos for the sake
of the boat as a whole-and humility was the common gateway through which
they were able now to come together" (Brown, 2013, p. 241). One of those
team members said when he stepped into the shell with his new teammates,
he finally felt at home.
This Washington varsity team decimated the competition on the East and West
Coasts, earning a spot on the U,S. Olympic team. At the Berlin Olympics, the
team faced a number of challenges. One of their key oarsmen had fallen seri
ously ill on the transatlantic voyage to Germany and remained sick through
out the competition. There were distractions everywhere. But every time the
American boys saw tension or nervousness in one another, they drew closer
together as a group and talked earnestly and seriously to each other. They
draped arms over one another's shoulders and talked through their race plan.
"Each of them knew a defining moment in his life was nearly at hand and no
one wanted to waste it. And none wanted to waste it for the others" (Brown,
2013, p, 326).
The team defeated England in its preliminary heat, and made it to the finals. But
the odds were stacked against them: They were in the worst lane in the final race,
which put them at a two-length disadvantage; they experienced a delayed start
because their coxswain missed the signal that the race had begun; and their sick
oarsman was barely conscious. But they came frnm behind and triumphed, win
ning Olympic gold.
As Brown (2013) points out, "No other sport demands and rewards the complete
abandonment of the self the way that rowing does. Great crews may have men or
women of exceptional talent or strength; they may have outstanding skills … but
they have no stars. The team effort-the perfectly synchronized flow of muscle,
oars, boat, and water … the single, whole, unified, and beautiful symphony that
a crew in motion becomes-is all that matters. Not the individual, not the self"
(pp, 177-178).
382 LEADERSHIP
– – –
Questions
1. In what way is this case about followership? Who were the followers? Who
were the leaders?
2. The coxswain is the crew member who sits in the stern facing the bow,
steers the boat, and coordinates the power and rhythm of the rowers. In
this case, is the coxswain's role more or less important than the roles of
other crew members? Explain your answer.
3. Reversing the lens emphasizes that followers can be change agents-what
was the impact of followers' characteristics on followers' behaviors in this
case? What impact do you think Ulbrickson's perception and behaviors had
on the rowers in his program?
4. How would you describe the impact of both followers and leaders on
followership outcome?
5. In this case, the boys in the boat created a highly cohesive unit. Do you
think highly effective followership always results in cohesiveness?
Defend your answer.
Case 13.3 PENN STATE SEXUAL ABUSE SCANDAL
In the 46 years that Joe Paterno was head football coach of the Penn State
Nittany Lions, he racked up 409 victories and was the most victorious football
coach in the history of the National Collegiate Athletic Association. Paterno
called his brand of coaching "The Grand Experiment" because he aimed to prove
that football excellence and academic integrity could coexist. Imbuing his pro
gram with the motto "Success With Honor," Paterno was as interested in the
moral character of his players as in their physical abilities, a fact borne out by
the program's unusually high graduation rates (Mahler, 2011). Over four decades,
a positive mythology enveloped the program, the university, and Paterno, instill
ing a fervent Penn State pride in students, faculty, staff, athletes, and fans across
the globe, contributing to Penn State's reputation as one of the most highly
regarded public universities in the United States.
But in 2011, a child sexual abuse scandal involving a former Penn State assistant
football coach caused "The Grand Experiment" to tumble from its high •perch,
bringing down with it not only Coach Paterno, the university's athletic director
Tim Curley, and the storied Penn State football program, but also the university's
president, Graham B. Spanier.
The seeds of the scandal began in 1977 when Penn State's then defensive line
coach Jerry Sandusky established a nonprofit organization called The Second
(Continued)
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 383
(Continued)
Mile that was described as a "group foster home devoted to helping troubled
boys." Sandusky's position and association with Penn State gave the charity
credibility, but The Second Mile ultimately proved to be a cover and conduit
for Sandusky's sexual abuse of boys. It is alleged that through The Second Mile,
Sandusky was able to identify and meet many of the young men who ultimately
became his victims.
Fast-forward to more than 30 years later when, in 2008, the mother of a high
school freshman reported to officials that her son was sexually abused by
Sandusky. Sandusky had been retired from Penn State since 1999, but contin
ued to coach as a volunteer, working with kids through his Second Mile charity.
As a result of the call, the state's attorney general launched an investigation of
Sandusky, and evidence was uncovered that this wasn't the first time Sandusky
had been alleged of committing sexual abuse. Allegations of his abuse had been
cropping up since the late 1990s.
In 1998, the mother of an 11-year-old boy called Penn State University police after
she learned her son had showered naked with Sandusky in the campus's athletic
locker room and that Sandusky touched the child inappropriately. At the time,
Paterno, Curley, and Spanier, as well as Gary C. Schultz, senior vice president for
finance and business, were all informed of the incident, and an investigation was
conducted. Even though police talked with another boy who reported similar treat
ment, they opted to close the case. During an interview with university police and
a representative from the Pennsylvania Department of Public Welfare (now known
as Human Services), Sandusky said he would not shower with children again.
Two years later, in the fall of 2000, a janitor in Penn State's Lasch football building
told a coworker and supervisor that he saw Sandusky engaged in sexual activ
ity with a boy in the assistant coach's shower. Fearing for their jobs, neither the
· janitor nor his coworker filed a report; their supervisor did not file a report, eit_her.
"They knew who Sandusky was," Special Investigative Counsel Louis J. Freeh
later said after he completed an eight-month investigation of the scandal in 2012.
"They said the university would circle around it. It was like going against the
president of the United States. If that's the culture on the bottom, God help the
culture at the top" (Wolverton, 2012).
In 2001, Penn State graduate assistant Mike McQueary witnessed Sandusky sexu
ally assaulting a boy in the showers at the Lasch football building. McQueary
visited Coach Paterno's home the next morning to tell the coach what he had
witnessed. Paterno, in turn, reported the incident to Athletic Director Curley. It
wasn't until 10 days later, however, that McQueary finally met with Curley and
Schultz to describe what he saw.
Initially Curley, Schultz, and Spanier decided to report the incident to the
Department of Public Welfare. However, two days later, Curley informed Schultz
384 LEADERSHIP
and Spanier that he had changed his mind after "talking it over with Joe" Paterno.
They decided instead to offer Sandusky "professional help" and tell him to stop
bringing guests to the locker room (Wolverton, 2012). No report was made to the
police or the child protection agency. It was later found that in an email, Spanier
told Curley he approved of the athletic director's decision not to report the inci
dent, calling it a "humane and reasonable way to proceed" (Wolverton, 2012).
McQueary, meanwhile, continued to work at Penn State, being promoted to an
assistant football coach's position. And over the next seven years, Sandusky
reportedly kept meeting and sexually assaulting young boys.
When Sandusky was finally arrested and charged with 40 counts of sexual abuse
in 2011, it was at the end of a three-year investigation launched by that mother's
2008 phone call. The investigation not only uncovered that Sandusky sexually
abused eight boys over a 15-year period, but determined that university leaders,
including Spanier and Schultz, knew about the coach's behavior and did not act.
During testimony they gave during the attorney general's investigation, these
same leaders denied knowing about the 1998 and 2001 incidents; but the inves
tigation proved through emails and other documents that university leaders did
not truthfully admit what they knew about these incidents and when they knew
it. As a result, Curley and Schultz were charged with perjury and failure to report
what they knew of the allegations.
While Spanier called Sandusky's behavior "troubling," he pledged his uncondi
tional support for both Curley and Schultz, predicting they would be exonerated
(Keller, 2012). Two days later, however, Paterno and Spanier were fired by the uni
versity's Board of Trustees, and the board hired Freeh to conduct an independent
investigation of the scandal.
Eight months later, Freeh released a scathing 267-page report that detailed how
and when university leaders knew about Sandusky's behavior and stated that
they failed to report repeated allegations of child sexual abuse by Sandusky. The
report stated that Spanier and Paterno displayed "a total disregard for the safety
and welfare of children" and hid critical facts from authorities on the alleged
abuses (Wolverton, 2012).
The investigation by Freeh found emails and other documents suggesting that
Spanier, Paterno, Schultz, and Curley all knew for years about the sexual nature
of the accusations against Sandusky and kept these allegations under wraps.
The report stated that Paterno, especially, "was an integral part of the act to
conceal" (Keller, 2012). Athletic Director Curley was described in the report as
"someone who followed instruction regardless of the consequences and was
'loyal to a fault.'" One senior official called Curley Paterno's "errand boy." And
finally, the investigation concluded that Spanier "failed in his duties as president"
for "not promptly and fully advising the Board of Trustees about the 1998 and
(Continued)
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 385
(Continued)
2001 child-sexual abuse allegations against Sandusky and the subsequent grand
jury investigation of him" (Keller, 2012).
But it wasn't just the university administrators who took fire. The report also cited
the university's Board of Trustees for failing "to exercise its oversight," stating
"the Board did not create a 'tone at the top' environment wherein Sandusky and
other senior university officials believed they were accountable to it." Ultimately,
Freeh's report concluded that the reputations of the university and its exalted
football program were "more important to its leaders than the safety and welfare
of young children" (Keller, 2012).
Joe Paterno died in January 2012. Six months later, Sandusky, the assistant coach
he protected, was convicted of 45 counts of child sexual abuse and sentenced to
30 to 60 years in prison. Former Penn State officials Curley, Schultz, and Spanier
were all sentenced to jail time for failing to alert authorities of the allegations
against Sandusky, allowing him to continue molesting boys for years.
A month after Sandusky's conviction and 10 days after Freeh's report was released,
a much-beloved 7-foot, 900-pound bronze statue of Paterno was removed from
its pedestal outside Penn State's Beaver Stadium, providing symbolic evidence
of the failure of Paterno's "Success With Honor" motto and the public's faith in
Penn State's program.
Questions
1. How would you describe the followership at Penn State? Whom would you
identify as the followers? Who are the leaders?
2. Using Kelley's typology, how would you describe the follower styles for
Schultz and Curley? What about McQueary?
3. How did followers in this case act in ways that contribute to the power of
destructive leaders and their goals? What was the debilitating impact their
actions had on the organization?
4 . Based on Lipman-Blumen 's psychological factors that contribute to
harmful leadership (Table 13.3), explain why those who could have
reported Sandusky's behaviors chose not to.
5. Based on the outcome, where did Paterno's intentions go wrong? In what
ways could followers have changed the moral climate at Penn State?
6. In the end, who carries the burden of responsibility regarding the failure of
Paterno's program-the leaders or the followers? Defend your answer.
386 LEADERSHIP
LEADERSHIP INSTRUMENT
As discussed earlier in this chapter, Kelley (1992) developed a typology that categorized followers into one of five styles (exemplary, alienated, conformist, passive, and pragmatist) based on two axes (independent thinking and active engagement). These different dimensions of followership became the basis for Kelley's Followership Qyestionnaire, a survey that allows followership style to be determined through an empirical approach, rather than through observation.
CHAPTER 13 FOLLOWERSHIP 387
Followership Questionnaire
Purpose: The purpose of this questionnaire is to learn about your style as a
follower.
Instructions: Think of a specific leader-follower situation where you were in the
role of follower. For each statement, please use the following scale to indicate the
extent to which the statement describes you and your behavior in this situation.
Key: 0 = Rarely 1 = Almost rarely 2 = Seldom 3 = Occasionally
4 = More often than not 5 = Often 6 = Almost always
1. Does your work help you fulfill some societal goal or 0 2 3 4 5 6 personal dream that is important to you?
2. Are your personal work goals aligned with the 0 2 3 4 5 6 organization's priority goals?
3. Are you highly committed to and energized by your 0 2 3 4 5 6 work and organization, giv ing them your best ideas and performance?
4 . Does your enthusiasm also spread to and energize O 2 3 4 5 6 your coworkers?
5. Instead of waiting for or merely accepting what 0 2 3 4 5 6 the leader tells you, do you personally identify which organizational activities are most critical for achieving the organization's priority goals?
6. Do you actively develop a distinctive competence O 1 2 3 4 5 6 in those critical activities so that you become more valuable to the leader and the organization?
7. When starting a new job or assignment, do you O 1 2 3 4 5 6 promptly build a record of successes in tasks that are important to the leader?
8. Can the leader give you a difficult assignment O 1 2 3 4 5 6 without the benefit of much supervision, knowing that you will meet your deadline with highest-quality work and that you will "fill in the cracks" if need be?
9. Do you take the initiative to seek out and 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 successfully complete assignments that go above and beyond your job?
10. When you are not the leader of a group project, do 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 you still contribute at a high level, often doing more than your share?
11. Do you independently think up and champion new 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 ideas that will contribute significantly to the leader's or the organization's goals?
12. Do you try to solve the tough problems (technical or 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 organizational), rather than look to the leader to do it for you?
388 LEADERSHIP
13. Do you help out other coworkers, making them look 0 2 3 4 5 6 good, even when you don't get any credit?
14. Do you help the leader or group see both the 0 2 3 4 5 6 upside potential and downside risks of ideas or plans, playing the devil's advocate if need be?
15. Do you understand the leader's needs, goals, and 0 2 3 4 5 6 constraints, and work hard to help meet them?
16. Do you actively and honestly own up to your strengths 0 2 3 4 5 6 and weaknesses rather than put off evaluation?
17. Do you make a habit of internally questioning the 0 2 3 4 5 6 wisdom of the leader's decision rather than just doing what you are told?
18. When the leader asks you to do something that 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 runs contrary to your professional or personal preferences, do you say "no" rather than "yes"?
19. Do you act on your own ethical standards rather 0 2 3 4 5 6 than the leader's or the group's standards?
20. Do you assert your views on important issues, even 0 2 3 4 5 6 though it might mean conflict with your group or reprisals from the leader?
Source: Excerpts from Kelley, Robert E. (1992). The Power of Followership: How to Create Leaders People Want to Follow and Followers Who Lead Themselves. New York: Doubleday.
Scoring
The Followership Questionnaire measures your style as a follower based on two
dimensions of followership: independent thinking and active engagement. Your
responses indicate the degree to which you are an independent thinker and
actively engaged in your follower role. Score the questionnaire by doing the
following. Your scores will classify you as being primarily one of the five styles:
exemplary, alienated, conformist, pragmatist, or passive.
1. Independent Thinking Score: Sum of questions 1, 5, 11 , 12, 14, 16, 17, 18, 19,
and 20
2. Active Engagement Score: Sum of questions 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 13,
and15
• Exemplary Followership Style: If you scored high (above 40) on both
independent thinking and active engagement, your followership
style is categorized as exemplary.
• Alienated Followership Style: If you scored high (above 40) on
independent thinking and low (below 20) on active engagement, your
followership style is categorized as alienated.
(Continued)
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 389
(Continued)
• Conformist Followership Style: If you scored low (below 20) on
independent thinking and high (above 40) on active engagement,
your followership style is categorized as conformist.
• Pragmatist Followership Style: If you scored in the middle
range (from 20 to 40) on both independent thinking and active
engagement, your followership style is categorized as pragmatist.
• Passive Fol/owership Style: If you scored low (below 20) on both
independent thinking and active engagement, your followership style is categorized as passive.
I Independent I Active Engagement Followership Style Thinking Score I Score
EXEMPLARY High High
ALIENATED High Low
CONFORMIST Low High
PRAGMATIST Middling Middling
PASSIVE Low Low
Source: Adapted from Kelley, Robert E. (1992). The Power of Fo//owership: How to Create Leaders People Want to Follow and Followers Who Lead Themselves. New York: Doubleday.
Scoring Interpretation
What do the different styles mean? How should you interpret your style? The
followership styles characterize how you carry out the followership role, not who
you are as a person. At any point in time, or under different circumstances, you
may use one followership pattern rather than another.
Exemplary Follower
Exemplary followers score high in both independent thinking and active engage
ment. They exhibit independent, critical thinking, separate from the group or
leader. They are actively engaged, using their talents for the benefit of the orga
nization, even when confronted with bureaucracy or other noncontributing mem
bers. Up to 35% of people are categorized as exemplary followers.
Alienated Follower
Alienated followers score high in independent thinking but low in active engage
ment. This means that they think independently and critically, but are not active
in carrying out the role of a follower. They might disengage from the group at
times and may view themselves as victims who have received unfair treatment. Approximately 15%-25% of people are categorized as alienated followers.
390 LEADERSHIP
Conformist Follower
Conformist followers often say "yes" when they really want to say "no." Low in
independent thinking and high in active engagement, they willingly take orders
and are eager to please others. They believe that the leader's position of power
entitles the leader to followers' obedience. They do not question the social order
and find comfort in structure. Approximately 20%-30% of people are categorized
as conformist followers.
Pragmatist Follower
With independent thinking and active engagement styles that fall between high
and low, pragmatic followers are most comfortable in the middle of the road and
tend to adhere to a motto of "better safe than sorry." They will question a leader's
decisions, but not too often or too openly. They perform required tasks, but sel
dom do more than is asked or expected. Approximately 25%-35% of people are
categorized as pragmatist followers.
Passive Follower
With low independent thinking and low active engagement behaviors, passive
followers are the opposite of exemplary followers, looking to the leader to do
their thinking for them. They do not carry out their assignments with enthusiasm
and lack initiative and a sense of responsibility. Approximately 5%-10% of people
are categorized as passive followers.
Source: Excerpts from Kelley, Robert E. (1992). The Power of Followership: How to Create Leaders People Want to Follow and Followers Who Lead Themselves. New York: Doubleday. ·
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERSHIP 391
SUMMARY
Leadership requires followership, and without understanding what the act of following entails, it is difficult to fully understand leaders and leadership. Therefore, the focus in this chapter is on followership and the central role fol lowers play in the leadership process.
In recent years, followership has received increased attention as a legitimate and significant area of leadership study. Followership is defined as a process whereby an individual or individuals accept the influence of others to accom plish a common goal. It involves a power differential between the follower and the leader. From a social constructivist perspective, followership emerges from communication between leaders and followers and involves the relational process of people exerting influence and others responding to that influence.
Early research on followership resulted in a series of typologies that differ entiate the roles followers can play. The primary types of follower roles iden tified are active-engaged, independent-assertive, submissive-compliant, and supportive-conforming.
The development of these typologies provides a starting point for building the ory on followership. Based on a systematic analysis of the research literature, Uhl-Bien and her colleagues (2014) introduced a broad theory of follower ship comprising the characteristics, behaviors, and outcomes of followers and leaders acting in relation to each other. Furthermore, these researchers pro posed two ways of theorizing about followership: (1) reversing the lens, which addresses followers in the opposite way they have been studied in most prior leadership research, and (2) the leadership co-created process, which conceptual izes followership as a give-and-take process in which individuals' following behaviors and leading behaviors interact with each other to create leadership and its resulting outcomes.
Work by Carsten and colleagues (2014) also advanced several positive facets of followership-followers get the job done, work in the best interest ofthe organiza tion's mission, challenge leaders, support the leader, and learn from leaders.
In addition to having a positive impact, there is another, darker side to follow ership. Followers can play ineffective, and even harmful, roles. Lipman-Blumen (2005) identified a series of psychological factors offollowers that contribute to harmful, dysfunctional leadership. These factors include people's needfor reas suring authority figures; needfor security and certainty; need to feel chosen or special; needfar membership in the human community;fear ofostracism, isolation, and social death; and fear ofpowerlessness to challenge a bad leader. The emergence of these factors occurs as a result of people's needs to find safety to feel unique and to be included in community.
392 LEADERSHIP
The existing followership literature has several strengths and certain limitations. On the positive side, the most recent literature gives recognition to follower ship as an integral part of the leadership equation and elevates it considerably, giving it equal footing with leadership. Second, it forces us to take leadership off its pedestal and replace it with followership. Third, it provides a useful set of basic prescriptions for what a follower should or should not do in order to be an effective follower.
On the negative side, very little methodical research has been conducted on the process of followership, which makes it difficult to theorize about followership's role in groups, organizations, and the community. Furthermore, the descrip tive research that has been conducted on followership is primarily anecdotal and observational. Third, the world's pervasive emphasis on and glorification of leadership may be so ingrained that the study of followership will remain constrained and never flourish. Fourth, followership research has not fully addressed the question "Why follow?" Finally, there has been little research on when and/or how patterns of followership are beneficial or detrimental.
In summary, the demand in society for effective, principled followers is grow ing and along with it a strong need for research-based theories of the process of followership. Until more research is done on the intricacies of followership, our understanding ofleadership will be incomplete.
CHAPTER13 FOLLOWERS HIP 393
- txb2chp13pgs352-393a
- txb2chp13pgs352-393b
,
Leadership seventh edition
To Laurel, Lisa, Madison, Scott, and Kallie
Leadership Theory and practice • seventh edition
Peter g.Northouse Western Michigan University
Acquisitions Editor: Maggie Stanley
Associate Editor: Abbie Rickard
Editorial Assistant: Nicole Mangona
Production Editor: Libby Larson
Copy Editor: Melinda Masson
Typesetter: C&M Digitals (P) Ltd.
Proofreader: Sally Jaskold
Indexer: Sheila Bodell
Cover Designer: Gail Buschman
Marketing Manager: Liz Thornton
Digital Content Editor: Katie Bierach
Copyright 2016 by SAGE Publications, Inc.
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or utilized in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher.
Printed in the United States of America
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Northouse, Peter Guy.
Leadershop : theory and practice/Peter Northouse, Western Michigan University.—Seventh Edition.
pages cm Includes bibliographical references and index.
ISBN 978-1-4833-1753-3 (pbk. : alk. paper)
1. Leadership. 2. Leadership—Case studies. I. Title.
HM1261.N67 2015 303.3′4—dc23 2014044695 This book is printed on acid-free paper.
15 16 17 18 19 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
FoR INFoRMATIoN:
SAGE Publications, Inc.
2455 Teller Road
Thousand oaks, California 91320
E-mail: [email protected]
SAGE Publications Ltd.
1 oliver’s Yard
55 City Road
London EC1Y 1SP
United Kingdom
SAGE Publications India Pvt. Ltd.
B 1/I 1 Mohan Cooperative Industrial Area
Mathura Road, New Delhi 110 044
India
SAGE Publications Asia-Pacific Pte. Ltd.
3 Church Street
#10-04 Samsung Hub
Singapore 049483
Brief Contents
Preface xvii
1. Introduction 1 2. Trait Approach 19 3. Skills Approach 43 4. Behavioral Approach 71 5. Situational Approach 93 6. Path–Goal Theory 115 7. Leader–Member Exchange Theory 137 8. Transformational Leadership 161 9. Authentic Leadership 195 10. Servant Leadership 225 11. Adaptive Leadership 257 12. Psychodynamic Approach 295 13. Leadership Ethics 329 14. Team Leadership 363 15. Gender and Leadership 397 16. Culture and Leadership 427
Author Index 467 Subject index 477 About the Author 491 About the Contributors 493
Detailed Contents
Preface xvii
1. Introduction 1 Leadership Defined 2
Ways of Conceptualizing Leadership 5 Definition and Components 6
Leadership Described 7 Trait Versus Process Leadership 7 Assigned Versus Emergent Leadership 8 Leadership and Power 10 Leadership and Coercion 12 Leadership and Management 13
Plan of the Book 15 Summary 16 References 17
2. Trait Approach 19 Description 19
Intelligence 23 Self-Confidence 24 Determination 24 Integrity 25 Sociability 26 Five-Factor Personality Model and Leadership 26 Emotional Intelligence 27
How Does the Trait Approach Work? 29 Strengths 30 Criticisms 30
Application 32 Case Studies 32
Case 2.1 Choosing a New Director of Research 33 Case 2.2 A Remarkable Turnaround 34 Case 2.3 Recruiting for the Bank 36
Leadership Instrument 37 Leadership Trait Questionnaire (LTQ) 38
Summary 40 References 41
3. Skills Approach 43 Description 43
Three-Skill Approach 44 Technical Skill 44 Human Skill 44 Conceptual Skill 45 Summary of the Three-Skill Approach 46
Skills Model 47 Competencies 48 Individual Attributes 52 Leadership Outcomes 53 Career Experiences 54 Environmental Influences 55 Summary of the Skills Model 56
How Does the Skills Approach Work? 56 Strengths 57 Criticisms 58 Application 59 Case Studies 60
Case 3.1 A Strained Research Team 60 Case 3.2 A Shift for Lieutenant Colonel Adams 62 Case 3.3 Andy’s Recipe 64
Leadership Instrument 66 Skills Inventory 67
Summary 69 References 70
4. Behavioral Approach 71 Description 71
The Ohio State Studies 72 The University of Michigan Studies 73 Blake and Mouton’s Managerial (Leadership) Grid 74
Authority–Compliance (9,1) 75
Country-Club Management (1,9) 75 Impoverished Management (1,1) 75 Middle-of-the-Road Management (5,5) 76 Team Management (9,9) 77
Paternalism/Maternalism 77 Opportunism 77
How Does the Behavioral Approach Work? 78 Strengths 80 Criticisms 81 Application 81 Case Studies 82
Case 4.1 A Drill Sergeant at First 83 Case 4.2 Eating Lunch Standing Up 84 Case 4.3 We Are Family 85
Leadership Instrument 87 Leadership Behavior Questionnaire 88
Summary 90 References 91
5. Situational Approach 93 Description 93
Leadership Styles 94 Development Levels 96
How Does the Situational Approach Work? 97 Strengths 98 Criticisms 99 Application 102 Case Studies 103
Case 5.1 Marathon Runners at Different Levels 103 Case 5.2 Why Aren’t They Listening? 105 Case 5.3 Getting the Message Across 107
Leadership Instrument 108 Situational Leadership Questionnaire: Sample Items 109
Summary 112 References 113
6. Path–Goal Theory 115 Description 115
Leader Behaviors 117 Directive Leadership 117 Supportive Leadership 117 Participative Leadership 118 Achievement-Oriented Leadership 118
Follower Characteristics 118 Task Characteristics 119
How Does Path–Goal Theory Work? 120 Strengths 122 Criticisms 123 Application 124 Case Studies 125
Case 6.1 Three Shifts, Three Supervisors 126 Case 6.2 Direction for Some, Support for Others 128 Case 6.3 Playing in the Orchestra 129
Leadership Instrument 132 Path–Goal Leadership Questionnaire 133
Summary 135 References 136
7. Leader–Member Exchange Theory 137 Description 137
Early Studies 137 Later Studies 140 Leadership Making 142
How Does LMX Theory Work? 144 Strengths 145 Criticisms 146 Application 148 Case Studies 149
Case 7.1 His Team Gets the Best Assignments 150 Case 7.2 Working Hard at Being Fair 151 Case 7.3 Taking on Additional Responsibilities 152
Leadership Instrument 154 LMX 7 Questionnaire 155
Summary 157 References 158
8. Transformational Leadership 161 Description 161
Transformational Leadership Defined 162 Transformational Leadership and Charisma 164 A Model of Transformational Leadership 166
Transformational Leadership Factors 167 Transactional Leadership Factors 171 Nonleadership Factor 172
Other Transformational Perspectives 172 Bennis and Nanus 172 Kouzes and Posner 174
How Does the Transformational Approach Work? 175 Strengths 176 Criticisms 178 Application 180 Case Studies 181
Case 8.1 The Vision Failed 181 Case 8.2 An Exploration in Leadership 183 Case 8.3 Her Vision of a Model Research Center 185
Leadership Instrument 187 Summary 190 References 191
9. Authentic Leadership 195 Description 195
Authentic Leadership Defined 196 Approaches to Authentic Leadership 197
Practical Approach 197 Theoretical Approach 200
How Does Authentic Leadership Work? 205 Strengths 206 Criticisms 207 Applications 208 Case Studies 209
Case 9.1 Am I Really a Leader? 210 Case 9.2 A Leader Under Fire 212 Case 9.3 The Reluctant First Lady 214
Leadership Instrument 217 Authentic Leadership Self-Assessment Questionnaire 218
Summary 220 References 221
10. Servant Leadership 225 Description 225
Servant Leadership Defined 226 Historical Basis of Servant Leadership 226 Ten Characteristics of a Servant Leader 227 Building a Theory About Servant Leadership 229
Model of Servant Leadership 231 Antecedent Conditions 231 Servant Leader Behaviors 233 Outcomes 236 Summary of the Model of Servant Leadership 238
How Does Servant Leadership Work? 238 Strengths 239
Criticisms 240 Application 241 Case Studies 242
Case 10.1 Everyone Loves Mrs. Noble 243 Case 10.2 Doctor to the Poor 244 Case 10.3 Servant Leadership Takes Flight 247
Leadership Instrument 249 Servant Leadership Questionnaire 250
Summary 253 References 254
11. Adaptive Leadership 257 Description 257
Adaptive Leadership Defined 258 A Model of Adaptive Leadership 260
Situational Challenges 261 Leader Behaviors 263 Adaptive Work 273
How Does Adaptive Leadership Work? 274 Strengths 275 Criticisms 276 Application 277 Case Studies 279
Case 11.1 Silence, Stigma, and Mental Illness 279
Case 11.2 Taming Bacchus 281 Case 11.3 Redskins No More 283
Leadership Instrument 286 Adaptive Leadership Questionnaire 287
Summary 292 References 293
12. Psychodynamic Approach 295 Manfred F. R. Kets de Vries and Alicia Cheak Description 295 The Clinical Paradigm 296 History of the Psychodynamic Approach 297 Key Concepts and Dynamics Within the
Psychodynamic Approach 301 1. Focus on the Inner Theatre 301 2. Focus on the Leader-Follower
Relationships 302 3. Focus on the Shadow Side of Leadership 305
How Does the Psychodynamic Approach Work? 305 Strengths 306
Criticisms 307 Application 308
Group Coaching 309 Case Studies 313
Case 12.1 Dealing With Passive-Aggressives 313 Case 12.2 The Fear of Success 314 Case 12.3 Helping a Bipolar Leader 315
Leadership Instrument 317 The Leadership Archetype
Questionnaire (Abridged Version) 318 Summary 324 References 324
13. Leadership Ethics 329 Description 329
Ethics Defined 330 Level 1. Preconventional Morality 331 Level 2. Conventional Morality 332 Level 3. Postconventional Morality 332
Ethical Theories 333 Centrality of Ethics to Leadership 336 Heifetz’s Perspective on Ethical Leadership 337 Burns’s Perspective on Ethical Leadership 338 The Dark Side of Leadership 339 Principles of Ethical Leadership 341
Ethical Leaders Respect Others 341 Ethical Leaders Serve Others 342 Ethical Leaders Are Just 344 Ethical Leaders Are Honest 345 Ethical Leaders Build Community 346
Strengths 347 Criticisms 348 Application 349 Case Studies 349
Case 13.1 Choosing a Research Assistant 350 Case 13.2 How Safe Is Safe? 351 Case 13.3 Reexamining a Proposal 352
Leadership Instrument 355 Perceived Leader Integrity Scale (PLIS) 356
Summary 359 References 360
14. Team Leadership 363 Susan E. Kogler Hill Description 363
Team Leadership Model 366 Team Effectiveness 367 Leadership Decisions 372 Leadership Actions 377
How Does the Team Leadership Model Work? 381 Strengths 382 Criticisms 383 Application 384 Case Studies 385
Case 14.1 Can This Virtual Team Work? 385 Case 14.2 They Dominated the Conversation 386 Case 14.3 Starts With a Bang, Ends With a Whimper 387
Leadership Instrument 389 Team Excellence and Collaborative
Team Leader Questionnaire 391 Summary 393 References 393
15. Gender and Leadership 397 Crystal L. Hoyt and Stefanie Simon Description 397
The Glass Ceiling Turned Labyrinth 398 Evidence of the Leadership Labyrinth 398 Understanding the Labyrinth 399
Gender Differences in Leadership Styles and Effectiveness 401
Navigating the Labyrinth 406 Strengths 409 Criticisms 410 Application 411 Case Studies 411
Case 15.1 The “Glass Ceiling” 412 Case 15.2 Lack of Inclusion and Credibility 413 Case 15.3 Pregnancy as a Barrier to Job Status 414
Leadership Instrument 415 The Gender–Leader Implicit Association Test 416
Summary 419 References 420
16. Culture and Leadership 427 Description 427
Culture Defined 428 Related Concepts 428
Ethnocentrism 428 Prejudice 429
Dimensions of Culture 430 Uncertainty Avoidance 431 Power Distance 432 Institutional Collectivism 432 In-Group Collectivism 432 Gender Egalitarianism 433 Assertiveness 433 Future Orientation 433 Performance Orientation 434 Humane Orientation 434
Clusters of World Cultures 434 Characteristics of Clusters 436
Anglo 437 Confucian Asia 437 Eastern Europe 437 Germanic Europe 437 Latin America 438 Latin Europe 438 Middle East 438 Nordic Europe 439 Southern Asia 439 Sub-Saharan Africa 439
Leadership Behavior and Culture Clusters 439 Eastern Europe Leadership Profile 441 Latin America Leadership Profile 441 Latin Europe Leadership Profile 441 Confucian Asia Leadership Profile 443 Nordic Europe Leadership Profile 443 Anglo Leadership Profile 444 Sub-Saharan Africa Leadership Profile 445 Southern Asia Leadership Profile 445 Germanic Europe Leadership Profile 446 Middle East Leadership Profile 446
Universally Desirable and Undesirable Leadership Attributes 448
Strengths 449 Criticisms 450 Application 451 Case Studies 452
Case 16.1 A Challenging Workplace 452 Case 16.2 A Special Kind of Financing 454 Case 16.3 Whose Hispanic Center Is It? 456
Leadership Instrument 458 Dimensions of Culture Questionnaire 459
Summary 464 References 465
Author Index 467 Subject index 477
About the Author 491
About the Contributors 493
xvii
Preface
This seventh edition of Leadership: Theory and Practice is written with the objective of bridging the gap between the often-simplistic popular approaches to leadership and the more abstract theoretical approaches. Like the previous editions, this edition reviews and analyzes a selected number of leadership theories, giving special attention to how each theoretical approach can be applied in real-world organizations. In essence, my purpose is to explore how leadership theory can inform and direct the way leadership is practiced.
NEW TO THIS EDITION
New to this volume is a chapter on adaptive leadership, which examines the nature of adaptive leadership, its underpinnings, and how it works. The chapter presents a definition, a model, and the latest research and applica- tions of this emerging approach to leadership. In addition, the strengths and weaknesses of the adaptive leadership approach are examined, and a ques- tionnaire to help readers assess their own levels of adaptive leadership is provided. Three case studies illustrating adaptive leadership are presented at the end of the chapter.
This volume also presents an entirely new chapter on psychodynamic leader- ship written by a leading expert in the field, Manfred F. R. Kets De Vries, and Alicia Cheak. Like the other chapters, this chapter provides a theoreti- cal explanation of psychodynamic leadership, applications, cases studies, and an assessment instrument.
This edition also includes an expanded discussion of the dark side of leader- ship and psuedotransformational leadership and the negative uses and abuses of leadership. New research has been added throughout the book as
xvIII Leadership Theory and pracTice
well as many new case studies and examples that help students apply leader- ship concepts to contemporary settings.
This edition retains many special features from previous editions but has been updated to include new research findings, figures and tables, and every- day applications for many leadership topics including leader–member exchange theory, transformational and authentic leadership, team leadership, the labyrinth of women’s leadership, and historical definitions of leadership. The format of this edition parallels the format used in earlier editions. As with previous editions, the overall goal of Leadership: Theory and Practice is to advance our understanding of the many different approaches to leadership and ways to practice it more effectively.
SPEcIal FEaTurES
Although this text presents and analyzes a wide range of leadership research, every attempt has been made to present the material in a clear, concise, and interesting manner. Reviewers of the book have consistently commented that clarity is one of its major strengths. In addition to the writing style, several other features of the book help make it user-friendly.
• Each chapter follows the same format: It is structured to include first theory and then practice.
• Every chapter contains a discussion of the strengths and criticisms of the approach under consideration, and assists the reader in determin- ing the relative merits of each approach.
• Each chapter includes an application section that discusses the prac- tical aspects of the approach and how it could be used in today’s organizational settings.
• Three case studies are provided in each chapter to illustrate common leadership issues and dilemmas. Thought-provoking questions follow each case study, helping readers to interpret the case.
• A questionnaire is provided in each of the chapters to help the reader apply the approach to his or her own leadership style or setting.
• Figures and tables illustrate the content of the theory and make the ideas more meaningful.
Through these special features, every effort has been made to make this text substantive, understandable, and practical.
preface xix
auDIENcE
This book provides both an in-depth presentation of leadership theory and a discussion of how it applies to real-life situations. Thus, it is intended for undergraduate and graduate classes in management, leadership studies, business, educational leadership, public administration, nursing and allied health, social work, criminal justice, industrial and organizational psychol- ogy, communication, religion, agricultural education, political and military science, and training and development. It is particularly well suited as a supplementary text for core organizational behavior courses or as an over- view text within MBA curricula. This book would also be useful as a text in student activities, continuing education, in-service training, and other leadership-development programs.
Instructor Teaching Site
SAGE edge for Instructors, a password-protected instructor resource site, supports teaching by making it easy to integrate quality content and create a rich learning environment for students. The test banks, which have been expanded for this edition, include multiple-choice and true/false questions to test comprehension, as well as essay questions that ask students to apply the material. An electronic test bank, compatible with PCs and Macs through Diploma software, is also available. Chapter-specific resources include PowerPoint slides, study and discussion questions, suggested exer- cises, full-text journal articles, and video and audio links. General resources include course-long projects, sample syllabi, film resources, and case notes. Printable PDF versions of the questionnaires from the text are included for instructors to print and distribute for classroom use. A course cartridge includes assets found on the Instructor Teaching Site and the Student Study Site, as well as a bonus quiz for each chapter in the book—all in an easy-to- upload package. Go to edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e to access the com- panion site.
Student Study Site
SAGE edge for Students provides a personalized approach to help students accomplish their coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment. Mobile-friendly eFlashcards and practice quizzes strengthen understanding of key terms and concepts and allow for independent assessment by students of their mastery of course material. A customized online action plan includes
xx Leadership Theory and pracTice
tips and feedback on progress through the course and materials, which allows students to individualize their learning experience. Learning objec- tives, multimedia links, discussion questions, and SAGE journal articles help students study and reinforce the most important material. Students can go to edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e to access the site.
Media Icons
Icons appearing at the bottom of the page will direct you to online media such as videos, audio links, journal articles, and reference articles that cor- respond with key chapter concepts. Visit the Student Study Site at edge. sagepub.com/northouse7e to access this media.
IcONS
northouse on Leadership
reference article
Video
audio
saGe Journal article
xxi
acknowledgments
Many people directly or indirectly contributed to the development of the seventh edition of Leadership: Theory and Practice. First, I would like to acknowledge my editor, Maggie Stanley, and her talented team at SAGE Publications (Nicole, Abbie, MaryAnn, Liz, Katie, and Lauren) who have contributed significantly to the quality of this edition and ensured its suc- cess. For their very capable work during the production phase, I would like to thank copy editor Melinda Masson, and senior project editor Libby Lar- son. In her own unique way, each of these people made valuable contribu- tions to the seventh edition.
For comprehensive reviews of the seventh edition, I would like to thank the following reviewers:
Meera Alagaraja, University of Louisville
Mel Albin, Excelsior College
Thomas Batsching, Reutlingen University
Cheryl Beeler, Angelo State University
Mark D. Bowman, Methodist University
Dianne Burns, University of Manchester
Eric Buschlen, Central Michigan University
Steven Bryant, Drury University
Daniel Calhoun, Georgia Southern University
David Conrad, Augsburg College
Joyce Cousins, Royal College of Surgeons in Ireland
xxII Leadership Theory and pracTice
Denise Danna, LSUHSC School of Nursing
S. Todd Deal, Georgia Southern University
Caroline S. Fulmer, University of Alabama
Greig A. Gjerdalen, Capilano University
Andrew Gonzales, University of California, Irvine
Carl Holschen, Missouri Baptist University
Kiran Ismail, St. John’s University
Irma Jones, University of Texas at Brownsville
Michele D. Kegley, University of Cincinnati, Blue Ash College
David Lees, University of Derby
David S. McClain, University of Hawaii at Manoa
Carol McMillan, New School University
Richard Milter, Johns Hopkins University
Christopher Neck, Arizona State University–Tempe
Keeok Park, University of La Verne
Richard Parkman, University of Plymouth
Chaminda S. Prelis, University of Dubuque
Casey Rae, George Fox University
Noel Ronan, Waterford Institute of Technology
Louis Rubino, California State University, Northridge
Shadia Sachedina, Baruch College (School of Public Affairs)
Harriet L. Schwartz, Carlow University
Kelli K. Smith, University of Nebraska-Lincoln
David Swenson, The College of St. Scholastica
Danny L. Talbot, Washington State University
Robert L. Taylor, University of Louisville
Precious Taylor-Clifton, Cambridge College
John Tummons, University of Missouri
acknowledgments xxiii
Kristi Tyran, Western Washington University
Tamara Von George, Granite State College
Natalie Walker, Seminole State College
William Welch, Bowie State University
David E. Williams, Texas Tech University
Tony Wohlers, Cameron University
Sharon A. Wulf, Worcester Polytechnic Institute School of Business
Alec Zama, Grand View University
Xia Zhao, California State University, Dominguez Hills
I would like to thank, for their exceptional work on the leadership profile tool and the ancillaries, Isolde Anderson (Hope College), John Baker (Western Kentucky University), Renee Kosiarek (North Central College) and Lisa Burgoon (University of Illinois), and for his feedback in the con- struction and scoring of the adaptive leadership questionnaire, Paul Yelsma (Western Michigan University).
A special acknowledgment goes to Laurel Northouse for her insightful critiques and ongoing support. In addition, I am grateful to Marie Lee, for her exceptional editing and guidance throughout this project. For their reviews of and comments on the adaptive leadership chapter, I am indebted to Sarah Chace (Marian University), Carl Larson (University of Denver), and Chip Bailey (Duke University).
Finally, I would like to thank the many undergraduate and graduate students whom I have taught through the years. Their ongoing feedback has helped clarify my thinking about leadership and encouraged me to make plain the practical implications of leadership theories.
SAGE was founded in 1965 by Sara Miller McCune to support the dissemination of usable knowledge by publishing innovative and high-quality research and teaching content. Today, we publish more than 750 journals, including those of more than 300 learned societies, more than 800 new books per year, and a growing range of library products including archives, data, case studies, reports, conference highlights, and video. SAGE remains majority-owned by our founder, and after Sara’s lifetime will become owned by a charitable trust that secures our continued independence.
Los Angeles | London | Washington DC | New Delhi | Singapore | Boston
1 Introduction
Leadership is a highly sought-after and highly valued commodity. In the 15 years since the first edition of this book was published, the public
has become increasingly captivated by the idea of leadership. People con- tinue to ask themselves and others what makes good leaders. As individuals, they seek more information on how to become effective leaders. As a result, bookstore shelves are filled with popular books about leaders and advice on how to be a leader. Many people believe that leadership is a way to improve their personal, social, and professional lives. Corporations seek those with leadership ability because they believe they bring special assets to their organizations and, ultimately, improve the bottom line. Academic institu- tions throughout the country have responded by providing programs in leadership studies.
In addition, leadership has gained the attention of researchers worldwide. A review of the scholarly studies on leadership shows that there is a wide variety of different theoretical approaches to explain the complexities of the leader- ship process (e.g., Bass, 1990; Bryman, 1992; Bryman, Collinson, Grint, Jack- son, & Uhl-Bien, 2011; Day & Antonakis, 2012; Gardner, 1990; Hickman, 2009; Mumford, 2006; Rost, 1991). Some researchers conceptualize leader- ship as a trait or as a behavior, whereas others view leadership from an infor- mation-processing perspective or relational standpoint. Leadership has been studied using both qualitative and quantitative methods in many contexts, including small groups, therapeutic groups, and large organizations. Collec- tively, the research findings on leadership from all of these areas provide a picture of a process that is far more sophisticated and complex than the often- simplistic view presented in some of the popular books on leadership.
This book treats leadership as a complex process having multiple dimensions. Based on the research literature, this text provides an in-depth description
Leadership Defined Role of Leadership
2 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
and application of many different approaches to leadership. Our emphasis is on how theory can inform the practice of leadership. In this book, we describe each theory and then explain how the theory can be used in real situations.
LeadershIp defIned _____________________________
There are many ways to finish the sentence “Leadership is . . .” In fact, as Stogdill (1974, p. 7) pointed out in a review of leadership research, there are almost as many different definitions of leadership as there are people who have tried to define it. It is much like the words democracy, love, and peace. Although each of us intuitively knows what we mean by such words, the words can have different meanings for different people. As Box 1.1 shows, scholars and practitioners have attempted to define leadership for more than a century without universal consensus.
Box 1.1 The Evolution of Leadership Definitions
While many have a gut-level grasp of what leadership is, putting a definition to the term has proved to be a challenging endeavor for scholars and practitioners alike. More than a century has lapsed since leadership became a topic of academic introspection, and definitions have evolved continuously during that period. These definitions have been influenced by many factors from world affairs and politics to the perspectives of the discipline in which the topic is being studied. in a seminal work, Rost (1991) analyzed materials written from 1900 to 1990, finding more than 200 different definitions for leadership. his analysis provides a succinct history of how leadership has been defined through the last century:
1900–1929
Definitions of leadership appearing in the first three decades of the 20th century emphasized control and centralization of power with a common theme of domination. For example, at a conference on lead- ership in 1927, leadership was defined as “the ability to impress the will of the leader on those led and induce obedience, respect, loyalty, and cooperation” (Moore, 1927, p. 124).
Defining Leadership
chapter 1 introduction 3
1930s
Traits became the focus of defining leadership, with an emerging view of leadership as influence rather than domination. Leadership was also identified as the interaction of an individual’s specific personality traits with those of a group; it was noted that while the attitudes and activities of the many may be changed by the one, the many may also influence a leader.
1940s
The group approach came into the forefront with leadership being defined as the behavior of an individual while involved in directing group activities (hemphill, 1949). at the same time, leadership by persuasion was distinguished from “drivership” or leadership by coer- cion (copeland, 1942).
1950s
Three themes dominated leadership definitions during this decade:
• continuance of group theory, which framed leadership as what leaders do in groups;
• leadership as a relationship that develops shared goals, which defined leadership based on behavior of the leader; and
• effectiveness, in which leadership was defined by the ability to influence overall group effectiveness.
1960s
although a tumultuous time for world affairs, the 1960s saw harmony amongst leadership scholars. The prevailing definition of leadership as behavior that influences people toward shared goals was under- scored by seeman (1960) who described leadership as “acts by persons which influence other persons in a shared direction” (p. 53).
1970s
The group focus gave way to the organizational behavior approach, where leadership became viewed as “initiating and maintaining groups or organizations to accomplish group or organizational goals” (Rost, 1991, p. 59). Burns’s (1978) definition, however, was the most important concept of leadership to emerge: “Leadership is the reciprocal process
(Continued)
Leadership in nursing
4 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
of mobilizing by persons with certain motives and values, various eco- nomic, political, and other resources, in a context of competition and conflict, in order to realize goals independently or mutually held by both leaders and followers” (p. 425).
1980s
This decade exploded with scholarly and popular works on the nature of leadership, bringing the topic to the apex of the academic and public consciousnesses. as a result, the number of definitions for lead- ership became a prolific stew with several persevering themes:
• do as the leader wishes. Leadership definitions still predomi- nantly delivered the message that leadership is getting followers to do what the leader wants done.
• Influence. probably the most often used word in leadership definitions of the 1980s, influence was examined from every angle. in an effort to distinguish leadership from manage- ment, however, scholars insisted that leadership is noncoercive influence.
• Traits. spurred by the national best seller In Search of Excellence (peters & Waterman, 1982), the leadership-as-excellence move- ment brought leader traits back to the spotlight. as a result, many people’s understanding of leadership is based on a trait orientation.
• Transformation. Burns (1978) is credited for initiating a move- ment defining leadership as a transformational process, stating that leadership occurs “when one or more persons engage with others in such a way that leaders and followers raise one another to higher levels of motivation and morality” (p. 83).
Into the 21st Century
Debate continues as to whether leadership and management are separate processes, but emerging research emphasizes the process of leadership, whereby an individual influences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal, rather than developing new ways of defining leadership. among these emerging leadership approaches are
• authentic leadership, in which the authenticity of leaders and their leadership is emphasized;
• spiritual leadership, which focuses on leadership that utilizes values and sense of calling and membership to motivate followers;
(continued)
The Future of Leadership Working across Generations
chapter 1 introduction 5
• servant leadership, which puts the leader in the role of servant, who utilizes “caring principles” to focus on followers’ needs to help these followers become more autonomous, knowledge- able, and like servants themselves; and
• adaptive leadership, in which leaders encourage followers to adapt by confronting and solving problems, challenges, and changes.
after decades of dissonance, leadership scholars agree on one thing: They can’t come up with a common definition for leadership. Because of such factors as growing global influences and generational differences, leadership will continue to have different meanings for different people. The bottom line is that leadership is a complex con- cept for which a determined definition may long be in flux.
souRce: adapted from Leadership for the Twenty-First Century, by J. c. Rost, 1991, new york: praeger.
Ways of Conceptualizing Leadership
In the past 60 years, as many as 65 different classification systems have been developed to define the dimensions of leadership (Fleishman et al., 1991). One such classification system, directly related to our discussion, is the scheme proposed by Bass (1990, pp. 11–20). He suggested that some defini- tions view leadership as the focus of group processes. From this perspective, the leader is at the center of group change and activity and embodies the will of the group. Another set of definitions conceptualizes leadership from a per- sonality perspective, which suggests that leadership is a combination of special traits or characteristics that some individuals possess. These traits enable those individuals to induce others to accomplish tasks. Other approaches to leadership define it as an act or a behavior—the things leaders do to bring about change in a group.
In addition, some define leadership in terms of the power relationship that exists between leaders and followers. From this viewpoint, leaders have power that they wield to effect change in others. Others view leadership as a transformational process that moves followers to accomplish more than is usually expected of them. Finally, some scholars address leadership from a skills perspective. This viewpoint stresses the capabilities (knowledge and skills) that make effective leadership possible.
perspectives of Leadership
6 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
Definition and Components
Despite the multitude of ways in which leadership has been conceptualized, the following components can be identified as central to the phenomenon: (a) Leadership is a process, (b) leadership involves influence, (c) leadership occurs in groups, and (d) leadership involves common goals. Based on these components, the following definition of leadership is used in this text:
Leadership is a process whereby an individual influences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal.
Defining leadership as a process means that it is not a trait or characteristic that resides in the leader, but rather a transactional event that occurs between the leader and the followers. Process implies that a leader affects and is affected by followers. It emphasizes that leadership is not a linear, one-way event, but rather an interactive event. When leadership is defined in this manner, it becomes available to everyone. It is not restricted to the formally designated leader in a group.
Leadership involves influence. It is concerned with how the leader affects followers. Influence is the sine qua non of leadership. Without influence, leadership does not exist.
Leadership occurs in groups. Groups are the context in which leadership takes place. Leadership involves influencing a group of individuals who have a common purpose. This can be a small task group, a community group, or a large group encompassing an entire organization. Leadership is about one individual influencing a group of others to accomplish common goals. Oth- ers (a group) are required for leadership to occur. Leadership training pro- grams that teach people to lead themselves are not considered a part of leadership within the definition that is set forth in this discussion.
Leadership includes attention to common goals. Leaders direct their energies toward individuals who are trying to achieve something together. By common, we mean that the leaders and followers have a mutual purpose. Attention to common goals gives leadership an ethical overtone because it stresses the need for leaders to work with followers to achieve selected goals. Stressing mutuality lessens the possibility that leaders might act toward followers in ways that are forced or unethical. It also increases the possibility that leaders and followers will work together toward a common good (Rost, 1991).
The ethical Dimension of Leadership effective Leadership
chapter 1 introduction 7
Throughout this text, the people who engage in leadership will be called leaders, and those toward whom leadership is directed will be called followers. Both leaders and followers are involved together in the leadership process. Leaders need followers, and followers need leaders (Burns, 1978; Heller & Van Til, 1983; Hollander, 1992; Jago, 1982). Although leaders and followers are closely linked, it is the leader who often initiates the relationship, creates the communication linkages, and carries the burden for maintaining the relationship.
In our discussion of leaders and followers, attention will be directed toward follower issues as well as leader issues. Leaders have an ethical responsibility to attend to the needs and concerns of followers. As Burns (1978) pointed out, discussions of leadership sometimes are viewed as elitist because of the implied power and importance often ascribed to leaders in the leader- follower relationship. Leaders are not above or better than followers. Leaders and followers must be understood in relation to each other (Hollander, 1992) and collectively (Burns, 1978). They are in the leadership relationship together—and are two sides of the same coin (Rost, 1991).
LeadershIp desCrIbed ___________________________
In addition to definitional issues, it is important to discuss several other questions pertaining to the nature of leadership. In the following section, we will address questions such as how leadership as a trait differs from leadership as a process; how appointed leadership differs from emergent leadership; and how the concepts of power, coercion, and management dif- fer from leadership.
Trait Versus Process Leadership
We have all heard statements such as “He is born to be a leader” or “She is a natural leader.” These statements are commonly expressed by people who take a trait perspective toward leadership. The trait perspective suggests that certain individuals have special innate or inborn characteristics or qualities that make them leaders, and that it is these qualities that differentiate them from nonleaders. Some of the personal qualities used to identify leaders include unique physical factors (e.g., height), personality features (e.g., extra- version), and other characteristics (e.g., intelligence and fluency; Bryman, 1992). In Chapter 2, we will discuss a large body of research that has exam- ined these personal qualities.
Development of Leadership Followership
8 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
To describe leadership as a trait is quite different from describing it as a process (Figure 1.1). The trait viewpoint conceptualizes leadership as a prop- erty or set of properties possessed in varying degrees by different people ( Jago, 1982). This suggests that it resides in select people and restricts lead- ership to those who are believed to have special, usually inborn, talents.
The process viewpoint suggests that leadership is a phenomenon that resides in the context of the interactions between leaders and followers and makes leadership available to everyone. As a process, leadership can be observed in leader behaviors ( Jago, 1982), and can be learned. The process definition of leadership is consistent with the definition of leadership that we have set forth in this chapter.
Assigned Versus Emergent Leadership
Some people are leaders because of their formal position in an organization, whereas others are leaders because of the way other group members respond to them. These two common forms of leadership are called assigned leader- ship and emergent leadership. Leadership that is based on occupying a posi- tion in an organization is assigned leadership. Team leaders, plant managers, department heads, directors, and administrators are all examples of assigned leadership.
Yet the person assigned to a leadership position does not always become the real leader in a particular setting. When others perceive an individual as the most influential member of a group or an organization, regardless of the individual’s title, the person is exhibiting emergent leadership. The individual acquires emergent leadership through other people in the organization who support and accept that individual’s behavior. This type of leadership is not assigned by position; rather, it emerges over a period through communication. Some of the positive communication behaviors that account for successful leader emergence include being verbally involved, being informed, seeking others’ opinions, initiating new ideas, and being firm but not rigid (Fisher, 1974).
In addition to communication behaviors, researchers have found that per- sonality plays a role in leadership emergence. For example, Smith and Foti (1998) found that certain personality traits were related to leadership emer- gence in a sample of 160 male college students. The individuals who were more dominant, more intelligent, and more confident about their own per- formance (general self-efficacy) were more likely to be identified as leaders by other members of their task group. Although it is uncertain whether these findings apply to women as well, Smith and Foti suggested that these three traits could be used to identify individuals perceived to be emergent leaders.
Leadership: skill or process?
chapter 1 introduction 9
Leadership emergence may also be affected by gender-biased perceptions. In a study of 40 mixed-sex college groups, Watson and Hoffman (2004) found that women who were urged to persuade their task groups to adopt high-quality decisions succeeded with the same frequency as men with iden- tical instructions. Although women were equally influential leaders in their groups, they were rated significantly lower than comparable men were on leadership. Furthermore, these influential women were also rated as signifi- cantly less likable than comparably influential men were. These results sug- gest that there continue to be barriers to women’s emergence as leaders in some settings.
A unique perspective on leadership emergence is provided by social identity theory (Hogg, 2001). From this perspective, leadership emergence is the degree to which a person fits with the identity of the group as a whole. As groups develop over time, a group prototype also develops. Individuals emerge as leaders in the group when they become most like the group pro- totype. Being similar to the prototype makes leaders attractive to the group and gives them influence with the group.
The leadership approaches we discuss in the subsequent chapters of this book apply equally to assigned leadership and emergent leadership. When a person is engaged in leadership, that person is a leader, whether leadership
figure 1.1 The Different Views of Leadership
TRAIT DEFINITION OF LEADERSHIP
PROCESS DEFINITION OF LEADERSHIP
Leadership • Height • Intelligence • Extraversion • Fluency • Other Traits
Followers Followers
Leadership
Leader Leader
(Interaction)
souRce: adapted from A Force for Change: How Leadership Differs From Management (pp. 3–8), by J. p. Kotter, 1990, new york: Free press.
ordinary Leaders
10 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
was assigned or emerged. This book focuses on the leadership process that occurs when any individual is engaged in influencing other group members in their efforts to reach a common goal.
Leadership and Power
The concept of power is related to leadership because it is part of the influ- ence process. Power is the capacity or potential to influence. People have power when they have the ability to affect others’ beliefs, attitudes, and courses of action. Judges, doctors, coaches, and teachers are all examples of people who have the potential to influence us. When they do, they are using their power, the resource they draw on to effect change in us.
Although there are no explicit theories in the research literature about power and leadership, power is a concept that people often associate with leader- ship. It is common for people to view leaders (both good and bad) and people in positions of leadership as individuals who wield power over others, and as a result, power is often thought of as synonymous with leadership. In addition, people are often intrigued by how leaders use their power. Studying
power and Leadership Bases of power
Table 1.1 six Bases of power
referent power Based on followers’ identification and liking for the leader. A teacher who is adored by students has referent power.
expert power Based on followers’ perceptions of the leader’s competence. A tour guide who is knowledgeable about a foreign country has expert power.
Legitimate power Associated with having status or formal job authority. A judge who administers sentences in the courtroom exhibits legitimate power.
reward power Derived from having the capacity to provide rewards to others. A supervisor who gives rewards to employees who work hard is using reward power.
Coercive power Derived from having the capacity to penalize or punish others. A coach who sits players on the bench for being late to practice is using coercive power.
Information power
Derived from possessing knowledge that others want or need. A boss who has information regarding new criteria to decide employee promotion eligibility has information power.
souRce: adapted from “The Bases of social power,” by J. R. French Jr. and B. Raven, 1962, in D. cartwright (ed.), Group Dynamics: Research and Theory (pp. 259–269), new york: harper & Row; and “social influence and power,” by B. h. Raven, 1965, in i. D. steiner & M. Fishbein (eds.), Current Studies in Social Psychology (pp. 371–382), new york: holt, Rinehart, & Winston.
chapter 1 introduction 11
how famous leaders, such as Hitler or Alexander the Great, use power to effect change in others is titillating to many people because it underscores that power can indeed effectuate change and maybe if they had power they too could effectuate change. But regardless of people’s general interest in power and leadership, power has not been a major variable in theories of leadership. Clearly it is a component in the overall leadership process, but research on its role is limited.
In her recent book, The End of Leadership (2012), Kellerman argues there has been a shift in leadership power during the last 40 years. Power used to be the domain of leaders, but that is diminishing and shifting to followers. Changes in culture have meant followers demand more from leaders, and leaders have responded. Access to technology has empowered followers, given them access to huge amounts of information, and made leaders more transparent. The result is a decline in respect of leaders and leaders’ legiti- mate power. In effect, followers have used information power to level the playing field. Power is no longer synonymous with leadership, and in the social contract between leaders and followers, leaders wield less power, according to Kellerman.
In college courses today, the most widely cited research on power is French and Raven’s (1959) work on the bases of social power. In their work, they conceptualized power from the framework of a dyadic relationship that included both the person influencing and the person being influenced. French and Raven identified five common and important bases of power—referent, expert, legitimate, reward, and coercive—and Raven (1965) identified a sixth, information power (Table 1.1). Each of these bases of power increases a lead- er’s capacity to influence the attitudes, values, or behaviors of others.
In organizations, there are two major kinds of power: position power and personal power. Position power is the power a person derives from a particular office or rank in a formal organizational system. It is the influence
Types of power
Table 1.2 Types and Bases of power
Position Power Personal Power
Legitimate Referent Reward Expert Coercive
Information
souRce: adapted from A Force for Change: How Leadership Differs From Management (pp. 3–8), by J. p. Kotter, 1990, new york: Free press.
12 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
capacity a leader derives from having higher status than the followers have. Vice presidents and department heads have more power than staff personnel do because of the positions they hold in the organization. Position power includes legitimate, reward, coercive, and information power (Table 1.2).
Personal power is the influence capacity a leader derives from being seen by followers as likable and knowledgeable. When leaders act in ways that are important to followers, it gives leaders power. For example, some managers have power because their followers consider them to be good role models. Others have power because their followers view them as highly competent or considerate. In both cases, these managers’ power is ascribed to them by others, based on how they are seen in their relationships with others. Per- sonal power includes referent and expert power (Table 1.2).
In discussions of leadership, it is not unusual for leaders to be described as wielders of power, as individuals who dominate others. In these instances, power is conceptualized as a tool that leaders use to achieve their own ends. Contrary to this view of power, Burns (1978) emphasized power from a relationship standpoint. For Burns, power is not an entity that leaders use over others to achieve their own ends; instead, power occurs in relationships. It should be used by leaders and followers to promote their collective goals.
In this text, our discussions of leadership treat power as a relational concern for both leaders and followers. We pay attention to how leaders work with followers to reach common goals.
Leadership and Coercion
Coercive power is one of the specific kinds of power available to leaders. Coercion involves the use of force to effect change. To coerce means to influ- ence others to do something against their will and may include manipulating penalties and rewards in their work environment. Coercion often involves the use of threats, punishment, and negative reward schedules. Classic examples of coercive leaders are Adolf Hitler in Germany, the Taliban leaders in Afghanistan, Jim Jones in Guyana, and North Korea’s Supreme Leader Kim Jong-il, each of whom has used power and restraint to force followers to engage in extreme behaviors.
It is important to distinguish between coercion and leadership because it allows us to separate out from our examples of leadership the behaviors of individuals such as Hitler, the Taliban, and Jones. In our discussions of leadership, coercive people are not used as models of ideal leadership. Our
Leadership and coercion
chapter 1 introduction 13
definition suggests that leadership is reserved for those who influence a group of individuals toward a common goal. Leaders who use coercion are interested in their own goals and seldom are interested in the wants and needs of followers. Using coercion runs counter to working with followers to achieve a common goal.
Leadership and Management
Leadership is a process that is similar to management in many ways. Leader- ship involves influence, as does management. Leadership entails working with people, which management entails as well. Leadership is concerned with effective goal accomplishment, and so is management. In general, many of the functions of management are activities that are consistent with the definition of leadership we set forth at the beginning of this chapter.
But leadership is also different from management. Whereas the study of leadership can be traced back to Aristotle, management emerged around the turn of the 20th century with the advent of our industrialized society. Man- agement was created as a way to reduce chaos in organizations, to make them run more effectively and efficiently. The primary functions of manage- ment, as first identified by Fayol (1916), were planning, organizing, staffing, and controlling. These functions are still representative of the field of man- agement today.
In a book that compared the functions of management with the functions of leadership, Kotter (1990) argued that the functions of the two are quite dis- similar (Figure 1.2). The overriding function of management is to provide order and consistency to organizations, whereas the primary function of leadership is to produce change and movement. Management is about seek- ing order and stability; leadership is about seeking adaptive and constructive change.
As illustrated in Figure 1.2, the major activities of management are played out differently than the activities of leadership. Although they are different in scope, Kotter (1990, pp. 7–8) contended that both management and lead- ership are essential if an organization is to prosper. For example, if an orga- nization has strong management without leadership, the outcome can be stifling and bureaucratic. Conversely, if an organization has strong leadership without management, the outcome can be meaningless or misdirected change for change’s sake. To be effective, organizations need to nourish both competent management and skilled leadership.
Managers Require; Leaders inspire
14 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
figure 1.2 Functions of Management and Leadership
Management produces Order and Consistency
Leadership produces Change and Movement
Planning and Budgeting • Establish agendas • Set timetables • Allocate resources
Establishing Direction • Create a vision • Clarify big picture • Set strategies
Organizing and Staffing • Provide structure • Make job placements • Establish rules and
procedures
Aligning People • Communicate goals • Seek commitment • Build teams and coalitions
Controlling and Problem Solving • Develop incentives • Generate creative solutions • Take corrective action
Motivating and Inspiring • Inspire and energize • Empower followers • Satisfy unmet needs
souRce: adapted from A Force for Change: How Leadership Differs From Management (pp. 3–8), by J. p. Kotter, 1990, new york: Free press.
Many scholars, in addition to Kotter (1990), argue that leadership and man- agement are distinct constructs. For example, Bennis and Nanus (1985) maintained that there is a significant difference between the two. To manage means to accomplish activities and master routines, whereas to lead means to influence others and create visions for change. Bennis and Nanus made the distinction very clear in their frequently quoted sentence, “Managers are people who do things right and leaders are people who do the right thing” (p. 221).
Rost (1991) has also been a proponent of distinguishing between leadership and management. He contended that leadership is a multidirectional influ- ence relationship and management is a unidirectional authority relationship. Whereas leadership is concerned with the process of developing mutual pur- poses, management is directed toward coordinating activities in order to get a job done. Leaders and followers work together to create real change, whereas managers and subordinates join forces to sell goods and services (Rost, 1991, pp. 149–152).
In a recent study, Simonet and Tett (2012) explored how leadership and management are best conceptualized by having 43 experts identify the over- lap and differences between leadership and management in regard to 63 different competencies. They found a large number of competencies (22)
Leadership in the nhs
chapter 1 introduction 15
descriptive of both leadership and management (e.g., productivity, customer focus, professionalism, and goal setting), but they also found several unique descriptors for each. Specifically, they found leadership was distinguished by motivating intrinsically, creative thinking, strategic planning, tolerance of ambiguity, and being able to read people, and management was distinguished by rule orientation, short-term planning, motivating extrinsically, orderli- ness, safety concerns, and timeliness.
Approaching the issue from a narrower viewpoint, Zaleznik (1977) went so far as to argue that leaders and managers themselves are distinct, and that they are basically different types of people. He contended that managers are reactive and prefer to work with people to solve problems but do so with low emotional involvement. They act to limit choices. Zaleznik suggested that leaders, on the other hand, are emotionally active and involved. They seek to shape ideas instead of responding to them and act to expand the available options to solve long-standing problems. Leaders change the way people think about what is possible.
Although there are clear differences between management and leadership, the two constructs overlap. When managers are involved in influencing a group to meet its goals, they are involved in leadership. When leaders are involved in planning, organizing, staffing, and controlling, they are involved in management. Both processes involve influencing a group of individuals toward goal attainment. For purposes of our discussion in this book, we focus on the leadership process. In our examples and case studies, we treat the roles of managers and leaders similarly and do not emphasize the differ- ences between them.
pLan Of The bOOk _______________________________
This book is user-friendly. It is based on substantive theories but is written to emphasize practice and application. Each chapter in the book follows the same format. The first section of each chapter briefly describes the leader- ship approach and discusses various research studies applicable to the approach. The second section of each chapter evaluates the approach, high- lighting its strengths and criticisms. Special attention is given to how the approach contributes or fails to contribute to an overall understanding of the leadership process. The next section uses case studies to prompt discus- sion of how the approach can be applied in ongoing organizations. Finally, each chapter provides a leadership questionnaire along with a discussion of how the questionnaire measures the reader’s leadership style. Each chapter ends with a summary and references.
Leadership and nursing Theory
16 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
suMMary _______________________________________
Leadership is a topic with universal appeal; in the popular press and aca- demic research literature, much has been written about leadership. Despite the abundance of writing on the topic, leadership has presented a major challenge to practitioners and researchers interested in understanding the nature of leadership. It is a highly valued phenomenon that is very complex.
Through the years, leadership has been defined and conceptualized in many ways. The component common to nearly all classifications is that leadership is an influence process that assists groups of individuals toward goal attain- ment. Specifically, in this book leadership is defined as a process whereby an individual influences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal.
Because both leaders and followers are part of the leadership process, it is important to address issues that confront followers as well as issues that confront leaders. Leaders and followers should be understood in relation to each other.
In prior research, many studies have focused on leadership as a trait. The trait perspective suggests that certain people in our society have special inborn qualities that make them leaders. This view restricts leadership to those who are believed to have special characteristics. In contrast, the approach in this text suggests that leadership is a process that can be learned, and that it is available to everyone.
Two common forms of leadership are assigned and emergent. Assigned leader- ship is based on a formal title or position in an organization. Emergent lead- ership results from what one does and how one acquires support from fol- lowers. Leadership, as a process, applies to individuals in both assigned roles and emergent roles.
Related to leadership is the concept of power, the potential to influence. There are two major kinds of power: position and personal. Position power, which is much like assigned leadership, is the power an individual derives from having a title in a formal organizational system. It includes legitimate, reward, infor- mation, and coercive power. Personal power comes from followers and includes referent and expert power. Followers give it to leaders because followers believe leaders have something of value. Treating power as a shared resource is impor- tant because it deemphasizes the idea that leaders are power wielders.
While coercion has been a common power brought to bear by many indi- viduals in charge, it should not be viewed as ideal leadership. Our definition
chapter 1 introduction 17
of leadership stresses using influence to bring individuals toward a common goal, while coercion involves the use of threats and punishment to induce change in followers for the sake of the leaders. Coercion runs counter to leadership because it does not treat leadership as a process that emphasizes working with followers to achieve shared objectives.
Leadership and management are different concepts that overlap. They are different in that management traditionally focuses on the activities of plan- ning, organizing, staffing, and controlling, whereas leadership emphasizes the general influence process. According to some researchers, management is concerned with creating order and stability, whereas leadership is about adaptation and constructive change. Other researchers go so far as to argue that managers and leaders are different types of people, with managers being more reactive and less emotionally involved and leaders being more proactive and more emotionally involved. The overlap between leadership and man- agement is centered on how both involve influencing a group of individuals in goal attainment.
In this book, we discuss leadership as a complex process. Based on the research literature, we describe selected approaches to leadership and assess how they can be used to improve leadership in real situations.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
referenCes ______________________________________
Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass and Stogdill ’s handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York: Free Press.
Bennis, W. G., & Nanus, B. (1985). Leaders: The strategies for taking charge. New York: Harper & Row.
Bryman, A. (1992). Charisma and leadership in organizations. London: SAGE. Bryman, A., Collinson, D., Grint, K., Jackson, G., & Uhl-Bien, M. (Eds.). (2011).
The SAGE handbook of leadership. London: SAGE. Burns, J. M. (1978). Leadership. New York: Harper & Row. Copeland, N. (1942). Psychology and the soldier. Harrisburg, PA: Military Service
Publications. Day, D. V., & Antonakis, J. (Eds.). (2012). The nature of leadership (2nd ed.). Thousand
Oaks, CA: SAGE. Fayol, H. (1916). General and industrial management. London: Pitman. Fisher, B. A. (1974). Small group decision making: Communication and the group process.
New York: McGraw-Hill.
18 LeaDeRship TheoRy anD pRacTice
Fleishman, E. A., Mumford, M. D., Zaccaro, S. J., Levin, K. Y., Korotkin, A. L., & Hein, M. B. (1991). Taxonomic efforts in the description of leader behavior: A synthesis and functional interpretation. Leadership Quarterly, 2(4), 245–287.
French, J. R., Jr., & Raven, B. H. (1959). The bases of social power. In D. Cartwright (Ed.), Studies in social power (pp. 259–269). Ann Arbor, MI: Institute for Social Research.
Gardner, J. W. (1990). On leadership. New York: Free Press. Heller, T., & Van Til, J. (1983). Leadership and followership: Some summary propo-
sitions. Journal of Applied Behavioral Science, 18, 405–414. Hemphill, J. K. (1949). Situational factors in leadership. Columbus: Ohio State Uni-
versity, Bureau of Educational Research. Hickman, G. R. (Ed.). (2009). Leading organizations: Perspectives for a new era (2nd
ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE. Hogg, M. A. (2001). A social identity theory of leadership. Personality and Social
Psychology Review, 5, 184–200. Hollander, E. P. (1992). Leadership, followership, self, and others. Leadership Quar-
terly, 3(1), 43–54. Jago, A. G. (1982). Leadership: Perspectives in theory and research. Management Sci-
ence, 28(3), 315–336. Kellerman, B. (2012). The end of leadership. New York: HarperCollins. Kotter, J. P. (1990). A force for change: How leadership differs from management. New
York: Free Press. Moore, B. V. (1927). The May conference on leadership. Personnel Journal, 6, 124–128. Mumford, M. D. (2006). Pathways to outstanding leadership: A comparative analysis of
charismatic, ideological, and pragmatic leaders. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum. Peters, T. J., & Waterman, R. H. (1982). In search of excellence: Lessons from America’s
best-run companies. New York: Warner Books. Raven, B. H. (1965). Social influence and power. In I. D. Steiner & M. Fishbein
(Eds.), Current studies in social psychology (pp. 371–382). New York: Holt, Rinehart, & Winston.
Rost, J. C. (1991). Leadership for the twenty-first century. New York: Praeger. Seeman, M. (1960). Social status and leadership. Columbus: Ohio State University,
Bureau of Educational Research. Simonet, D. V., & Tett, R. P. (2012). Five perspectives on the leadership-management
relationship: A competency-based evaluation and integration. Journal of Leadership & Organizational Studies, 20(2), 199–213.
Smith, J. A., & Foti, R. J. (1998). A pattern approach to the study of leader emergence. Leadership Quarterly, 9(2), 147–160.
Stogdill, R. M. (1974). Handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York: Free Press.
Watson, C., & Hoffman, L. R. (2004). The role of task-related behavior in the emer- gence of leaders. Group & Organization Management, 29(6), 659–685.
Zaleznik, A. (1977, May–June). Managers and leaders: Are they different? Harvard Business Review, 55, 67–78.
2
Trait Approach
DescripTion _____________________________________
Of interest to scholars throughout the 20th century, the trait approach was one of the first systematic attempts to study leadership. In the early 20th century, leadership traits were studied to determine what made certain people great leaders. The theories that were developed were called “great man” theories because they focused on identifying the innate qualities and characteristics possessed by great social, political, and military leaders (e.g., Catherine the Great, Mohandas Gandhi, Indira Gandhi, Abraham Lincoln, Joan of Arc, and Napoleon Bonaparte). It was believed that people were born with these traits, and that only the “great” people possessed them. During this time, research concentrated on determining the specific traits that clearly differentiated leaders from followers (Bass, 1990; Jago, 1982).
In the mid-20th century, the trait approach was challenged by research that questioned the universality of leadership traits. In a major review, Stogdill (1948) suggested that no consistent set of traits differentiated leaders from nonleaders across a variety of situations. An individual with leadership traits who was a leader in one situation might not be a leader in another situation. Rather than being a quality that individuals possess, leadership was reconceptualized as a relationship between people in a social situation. Personal factors related to leadership continued to be important, but researchers contended that these factors were to be considered as relative to the requirements of the situation.
The trait approach has generated much interest among researchers for its explanation of how traits influence leadership (Bryman, 1992). For example, an analysis of much of the previous trait research by Lord, DeVader, and
Heroic Women What Traits Do Leaders Have?
20 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
Alliger (1986) found that traits were strongly associated with individuals’ perceptions of leadership. Similarly, Kirkpatrick and Locke (1991) went so far as to claim that effective leaders are actually distinct types of people in several key respects.
The trait approach has earned new interest through the current emphasis given by many researchers to visionary and charismatic leadership (see Bass, 1990; Bennis & Nanus, 1985; Nadler & Tushman, 1989; Zaccaro, 2007; Zaleznik, 1977). Charismatic leadership catapulted to the forefront of public attention with the 2008 election of the United States’ first African American president, Barack Obama, who is perceived by many to be charismatic, among many other attributes. In a study to determine what distinguishes charismatic leaders from others, Jung and Sosik (2006) found that charismatic leaders consistently possess traits of self-monitoring, engagement in impression management, motivation to attain social power, and motivation to attain self-actualization. In short, the trait approach is alive and well. It began with an emphasis on identifying the qualities of great persons, shifted to include the impact of situations on leadership, and, currently, has shifted back to reemphasize the critical role of traits in effective leadership.
Although the research on traits spanned the entire 20th century, a good overview of this approach is found in two surveys completed by Stogdill (1948, 1974). In his first survey, Stogdill analyzed and synthesized more than 124 trait studies conducted between 1904 and 1947. In his second study, he analyzed another 163 studies completed between 1948 and 1970. By taking a closer look at each of these reviews, we can obtain a clearer picture of how individuals’ traits contribute to the leadership process.
Stogdill’s first survey identified a group of important leadership traits that were related to how individuals in various groups became leaders. His results showed that the average individual in the leadership role is different from an average group member with regard to the following eight traits: intelligence, alertness, insight, responsibility, initiative, persistence, self-confidence, and sociability.
The findings of Stogdill’s first survey also indicated that an individual does not become a leader solely because that individual possesses certain traits. Rather, the traits that leaders possess must be relevant to situations in which the leader is functioning. As stated earlier, leaders in one situation may not necessarily be leaders in another situation. Findings showed that leadership was not a passive state but resulted from a working relationship between the leader and other group members. This research marked the beginning of a
Great Man Theory impression Management
chapter 2 Trait approach 21
new approach to leadership research that focused on leadership behaviors and leadership situations.
Stogdill’s second survey, published in 1974, analyzed 163 new studies and compared the findings of these studies to the findings he had reported in his first survey. The second survey was more balanced in its description of the role of traits and leadership. Whereas the first survey implied that leadership is determined principally by situational factors and not traits, the second survey argued more moderately that both traits and situational factors were determinants of leadership. In essence, the second survey validated the original trait idea that a leader’s characteristics are indeed a part of leadership.
Similar to the first survey, Stogdill’s second survey also identified traits that were positively associated with leadership. The list included the following 10 characteristics:
1. drive for responsibility and task completion;
2. vigor and persistence in pursuit of goals;
3. risk taking and originality in problem solving;
4. drive to exercise initiative in social situations;
5. self-confidence and sense of personal identity;
6. willingness to accept consequences of decision and action;
7. readiness to absorb interpersonal stress;
8. willingness to tolerate frustration and delay;
9. ability to influence other people’s behavior; and
10. capacity to structure social interaction systems to the purpose at hand.
Mann (1959) conducted a similar study that examined more than 1,400 findings regarding traits and leadership in small groups, but he placed less emphasis on how situational factors influenced leadership. Although tentative in his conclusions, Mann suggested that certain traits could be used to distinguish leaders from nonleaders. His results identified leaders as strong in the following six traits: intelligence, masculinity, adjustment, dominance, extraversion, and conservatism.
Trait Leadership everyday Leaders
22 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
Lord et al. (1986) reassessed Mann’s (1959) findings using a more sophisticated procedure called meta-analysis. Lord et al. found that intelligence, masculinity, and dominance were significantly related to how individuals perceived leaders. From their findings, the authors argued strongly that traits could be used to make discriminations consistently across situations between leaders and nonleaders.
Both of these studies were conducted during periods in American history where male leadership was prevalent in most aspects of business and society. In Chapter 15, we explore more contemporary research regarding the role of gender in leadership, and we look at whether traits such as masculinity and dominance still bear out as important factors in distinguishing between leaders and nonleaders.
Yet another review argues for the importance of leadership traits: Kirkpatrick and Locke (1991, p. 59) contended that “it is unequivocally clear that leaders are not like other people.” From a qualitative synthesis of earlier research, Kirkpatrick and Locke postulated that leaders differ from nonleaders on six traits: drive, motivation, integrity, confidence, cognitive ability, and task knowledge. According to these writers, individuals can be born with these traits, they can learn them, or both. It is these six traits that make up the
Table 2.1 studies of Leadership Traits and characteristics
Stogdill (1948) Mann (1959) Stogdill (1974)
Lord, DeVader, and Alliger (1986)
Kirkpatrick and Locke (1991)
Zaccaro, Kemp, and Bader (2004)
intelligence alertness insight responsibility initiative persistence self-confidence sociability
intelligence masculinity adjustment dominance extraversion conservatism
achievement persistence insight initiative self-confidence responsibility cooperativeness tolerance influence sociability
intelligence masculinity dominance
drive motivation integrity confidence cognitive ability task knowledge
cognitive abilities extraversion conscientiousness emotional stability openness agreeableness motivation social intelligence self-monitoring emotional intelligence problem solving
soUrces: adapted from “The Bases of social power,” by J. r. p. French, Jr., and B. raven, 1962, in D. cartwright (ed.), Group Dynamics: Research and Theory (pp. 259–269), new york: Harper and row; Zaccaro, Kemp, & Bader (2004).
Leadership presence Florence nightingale
chapter 2 Trait approach 23
“right stuff ” for leaders. Kirkpatrick and Locke contended that leadership traits make some people different from others, and this difference should be recognized as an important part of the leadership process.
In the 1990s, researchers began to investigate the leadership traits associated with “social intelligence,” characterized as those abilities to understand one’s own and others’ feelings, behaviors, and thoughts and to act appropriately (Marlowe, 1986). Zaccaro (2002) defined social intelligence as having such capacities as social awareness, social acumen, self-monitoring, and the ability to select and enact the best response given the contingencies of the situation and social environment. A number of empirical studies showed these capacities to be a key trait for effective leaders. Zaccaro, Kemp, and Bader (2004) included such social abilities in the categories of leadership traits they outlined as important leadership attributes (see Table 2.1).
Table 2.1 provides a summary of the traits and characteristics that were identified by researchers from the trait approach. It illustrates clearly the breadth of traits related to leadership. Table 2.1 also shows how difficult it is to select certain traits as definitive leadership traits; some of the traits appear in several of the survey studies, whereas others appear in only one or two studies. Regardless of the lack of precision in Table 2.1, however, it represents a general convergence of research regarding which traits are leadership traits.
What, then, can be said about trait research? What has a century of research on the trait approach given us that is useful? The answer is an extended list of traits that individuals might hope to possess or wish to cultivate if they want to be perceived by others as leaders. Some of the traits that are central to this list include intelligence, self-confidence, determination, integrity, and sociability (Table 2.2).
Intelligence
Intelligence or intellectual ability is positively related to leadership. Based on their analysis of a series of recent studies on intelligence and various indices of leadership, Zaccaro et al. (2004) found support for the finding that leaders tend to have higher intelligence than nonleaders. Having strong verbal
emotional and other intelligences
Table 2.2 Major Leadership Traits
• Intelligence • Self-confidence • Determination
• Integrity • Sociability
24 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
ability, perceptual ability, and reasoning appears to make one a better leader. Although it is good to be bright, the research also indicates that a leader’s intellectual ability should not differ too much from that of the subordinates. If the leader’s IQ is very different from that of the followers, it can have a counterproductive impact on leadership. Leaders with higher abilities may have difficulty communicating with followers because they are preoccupied or because their ideas are too advanced for their followers to accept.
An example of a leader for whom intelligence was a key trait was Steve Jobs, founder and CEO of Apple who died in 2011. Jobs once said, “I have this really incredible product inside me and I have to get it out” (Sculley, 2011, p. 27). Those visionary products, first the Apple II and Macintosh computers and then the iMac, iPod, iPhone, and iPad, have revolutionized the personal computer and electronic device industry, changing the way people play and work.
In the next chapter of this text, which addresses leadership from a skills perspective, intelligence is identified as a trait that significantly contributes to a leader’s acquisition of complex problem-solving skills and social judgment skills. Intelligence is described as having a positive impact on an individual’s capacity for effective leadership.
Self-Confidence
Self-confidence is another trait that helps one to be a leader. Self-confidence is the ability to be certain about one’s competencies and skills. It includes a sense of self-esteem and self-assurance and the belief that one can make a difference. Leadership involves influencing others, and self-confidence allows the leader to feel assured that his or her attempts to influence others are appropriate and right.
Again, Steve Jobs is a good example of a self-confident leader. When Jobs described the devices he wanted to create, many people said they weren’t possible. But Jobs never doubted his products would change the world, and, despite resistance, he did things the way he thought best. “Jobs was one of those CEOs who ran the company like he wanted to. He believed he knew more about it than anyone else, and he probably did,” said a colleague (Stone, 2011).
Determination
Many leaders also exhibit determination. Determination is the desire to get the job done and includes characteristics such as initiative, persistence,
political Leadership steve Jobs
chapter 2 Trait approach 25
dominance, and drive. People with determination are willing to assert themselves, are proactive, and have the capacity to persevere in the face of obstacles. Being determined includes showing dominance at times and in situations where followers need to be directed.
Dr. Paul Farmer has shown determination in his efforts to secure health care and eradicate tuberculosis for the very poor of Haiti and other third world countries. He began his efforts as a recent college graduate, traveling and working in Cange, Haiti. While there, he was accepted to Harvard Medical School. Knowing that his work in Haiti was invaluable to his training, he managed to do both: spending months traveling back and forth between Haiti and Cambridge, Massachusetts, for school. His first effort in Cange was to establish a one-room clinic where he treated “all comers” and trained local health care workers. Farmer found that there was more to providing health care than just dispensing medicine: He secured donations to build schools, houses, and communal sanitation and water facilities in the region. He spearheaded vaccinations of all the children in the area, dramatically reducing malnutrition and infant mortality. In order to keep working in Haiti, he returned to America and founded Partners In Health, a charitable foundation that raises money to fund these efforts. Since its founding, PIH not only has succeeded in improving the health of many communities in Haiti but now has projects in Haiti, Lesotho, Malawi, Peru, Russia, Rwanda, and the United States, and supports other projects in Mexico and Guatemala (Kidder, 2004; Partners In Health, 2014).
Integrity
Integrity is another of the important leadership traits. Integrity is the quality of honesty and trustworthiness. People who adhere to a strong set of principles and take responsibility for their actions are exhibiting integrity. Leaders with integrity inspire confidence in others because they can be trusted to do what they say they are going to do. They are loyal, dependable, and not deceptive. Basically, integrity makes a leader believable and worthy of our trust.
In our society, integrity has received a great deal of attention in recent years. For example, as a result of two situations—the position taken by President George W. Bush regarding Iraq’s alleged weapons of mass destruction and the impeachment proceedings during the Clinton presidency—people are demanding more honesty of their public officials. Similarly, scandals in the corporate world (e.g., Enron and WorldCom) have led people to become skeptical of leaders who are not highly ethical. In the educational arena, new
Terry Fox consultant nurses
26 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
K–12 curricula are being developed to teach character, values, and ethical leadership. (For instance, see the Character Counts! program developed by the Josephson Institute of Ethics in California at www.charactercounts.org, and the Pillars of Leadership program taught at the J. W. Fanning Institute for Leadership in Georgia at www.fanning.uga.edu.) In short, society is demanding greater integrity of character in its leaders.
Sociability
A final trait that is important for leaders is sociability. Sociability is a leader’s inclination to seek out pleasant social relationships. Leaders who show sociability are friendly, outgoing, courteous, tactful, and diplomatic. They are sensitive to others’ needs and show concern for their well-being. Social leaders have good interpersonal skills and create cooperative relationships with their followers.
An example of a leader with great sociability skills is Michael Hughes, a university president. Hughes prefers to walk to all his meetings because it gets him out on campus where he greets students, staff, and faculty. He has lunch in the dorm cafeterias or student union and will often ask a table of strangers if he can sit with them. Students rate him as very approachable, while faculty say he has an open-door policy. In addition, he takes time to write personal notes to faculty, staff, and students to congratulate them on their successes.
Although our discussion of leadership traits has focused on five major traits (i.e., intelligence, self-confidence, determination, integrity, and sociability), this list is not all-inclusive. While other traits indicated in Table 2.1 are associated with effective leadership, the five traits we have identified contribute substantially to one’s capacity to be a leader.
Until recently, most reviews of leadership traits have been qualitative. In addition, they have lacked a common organizing framework. However, the research described in the following section provides a quantitative assessment of leadership traits that is conceptually framed around the five-factor model of personality. It describes how five major personality traits are related to leadership.
Five-Factor Personality Model and Leadership
Over the past 25 years, a consensus has emerged among researchers regarding the basic factors that make up what we call personality (Goldberg, 1990;
extraversion
chapter 2 Trait approach 27
McCrae & Costa, 1987). These factors, commonly called the Big Five, are neuroticism, extraversion (surgency), openness (intellect), agreeableness, and conscientiousness (dependability). (See Table 2.3.)
To assess the links between the Big Five and leadership, Judge, Bono, Ilies, and Gerhardt (2002) conducted a major meta-analysis of 78 leadership and personality studies published between 1967 and 1998. In general, Judge et al. found a strong relationship between the Big Five traits and leadership. It appears that having certain personality traits is associated with being an effective leader.
Specifically, in their study, extraversion was the factor most strongly associated with leadership. It is the most important trait of effective leaders. Extraversion was followed, in order, by conscientiousness, openness, and low neuroticism. The last factor, agreeableness, was found to be only weakly associated with leadership.
Emotional Intelligence
Another way of assessing the impact of traits on leadership is through the concept of emotional intelligence, which emerged in the 1990s as an important area of study in psychology. It has been widely studied by researchers, and has captured the attention of many practitioners (Caruso & Wolfe, 2004; Goleman, 1995, 1998; Mayer & Salovey, 1995, 1997; Mayer, Salovey, & Caruso, 2000; Shankman & Allen, 2008).
Table 2.3 Big Five personality Factors
neuroticism The tendency to be depressed, anxious, insecure, vulnerable, and hostile
extraversion The tendency to be sociable and assertive and to have positive energy
openness The tendency to be informed, creative, insightful, and curious
Agreeableness The tendency to be accepting, conforming, trusting, and nurturing
conscientiousness The tendency to be thorough, organized, controlled, dependable, and decisive
soUrce: Goldberg, L. r. (1990). an alternative “description of personality”: The big-five factor structure. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 59, 1216–1229.
emotional intelligence
28 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
As the two words suggest, emotional intelligence has to do with our emotions (affective domain) and thinking (cognitive domain), and the interplay between the two. Whereas intelligence is concerned with our ability to learn information and apply it to life tasks, emotional intelligence is concerned with our ability to understand emotions and apply this understanding to life’s tasks. Specifically, emotional intelligence can be defined as the ability to perceive and express emotions, to use emotions to facilitate thinking, to understand and reason with emotions, and to effectively manage emotions within oneself and in relationships with others (Mayer, Salovey, & Caruso, 2000).
There are different ways to measure emotional intelligence. One scale is the Mayer-Salovey-Caruso Emotional Intelligence Test (MSCEIT; Mayer, Caruso, & Salovey, 2000). The MSCEIT measures emotional intelligence as a set of mental abilities, including the abilities to perceive, facilitate, understand, and manage emotion.
Goleman (1995, 1998) takes a broader approach to emotional intelligence, suggesting that it consists of a set of personal and social competencies. Personal competence consists of self-awareness, confidence, self-regulation, conscientiousness, and motivation. Social competence consists of empathy and social skills such as communication and conflict management.
Shankman and Allen (2008) developed a practice-oriented model of emotionally intelligent leadership, which suggests that leaders must be conscious of three fundamental facets of leadership: context, self, and others. In the model, emotionally intelligent leaders are defined by 21 capacities to which a leader should pay attention, including group savvy, optimism, initiative, and teamwork.
There is a debate in the field regarding how big a role emotional intelligence plays in helping people be successful in life. Some researchers, such as Goleman (1995), suggested that emotional intelligence plays a major role in whether people are successful at school, home, and work. Others, such as Mayer, Salovey, and Caruso (2000), made softer claims for the significance of emotional intelligence in meeting life’s challenges.
As a leadership ability or trait, emotional intelligence appears to be an important construct. The underlying premise suggested by this framework is that people who are more sensitive to their emotions and the impact of their emotions on others will be leaders who are more effective. As more research is conducted on emotional intelligence, the intricacies of how emotional intelligence relates to leadership will be better understood.
emergent Leadership
chapter 2 Trait approach 29
How Does THe TrAiT ApproAcH work? _________
The trait approach is very different from the other approaches discussed in subsequent chapters because it focuses exclusively on the leader, not on the followers or the situation. This makes the trait approach theoretically more straightforward than other approaches. In essence, the trait approach is concerned with what traits leaders exhibit and who has these traits.
The trait approach does not lay out a set of hypotheses or principles about what kind of leader is needed in a certain situation or what a leader should do, given a particular set of circumstances. Instead, this approach emphasizes that having a leader with a certain set of traits is crucial to having effective leadership. It is the leader and the leader’s traits that are central to the leadership process.
The trait approach suggests that organizations will work better if the people in managerial positions have designated leadership profiles. To find the right people, it is common for organizations to use trait assessment instruments. The assumption behind these procedures is that selecting the right people will increase organizational effectiveness. Organizations can specify the characteristics or traits that are important to them for particular positions and then use trait assessment measures to determine whether an individual fits their needs.
The trait approach is also used for personal awareness and development. By analyzing their own traits, managers can gain an idea of their strengths and weaknesses, and can get a feel for how others in the organization see them. A trait assessment can help managers determine whether they have the qualities to move up or to move to other positions in the company.
A trait assessment gives individuals a clearer picture of who they are as leaders and how they fit into the organizational hierarchy. In areas where their traits are lacking, leaders can try to make changes in what they do or where they work to increase their traits’ potential impact.
Near the end of the chapter, a leadership instrument is provided that you can use to assess your leadership traits. This instrument is typical of the kind of assessments that companies use to evaluate individuals’ leadership potential. As you will discover by completing this instrument, trait measures are a good way to assess your own characteristics.
introvert contributions
30 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
sTrengTHs ______________________________________
The trait approach has several identifiable strengths. First, the trait approach is intuitively appealing. It fits clearly with our notion that leaders are the individuals who are out front and leading the way in our society. The image in the popular press and community at large is that leaders are a special kind of people—people with gifts who can do extraordinary things. The trait approach is consistent with this perception because it is built on the premise that leaders are different, and their difference resides in the special traits they possess. People have a need to see their leaders as gifted people, and the trait approach fulfills this need.
A second strength of the trait approach is that it has a century of research to back it up. No other theory can boast of the breadth and depth of studies conducted on the trait approach. The strength and longevity of this line of research give the trait approach a measure of credibility that other approaches lack. Out of this abundance of research has emerged a body of data that points to the important role of various traits in the leadership process.
Another strength, more conceptual in nature, results from the way the trait approach highlights the leader component in the leadership process. Leadership is composed of leaders, followers, and situations, but the trait approach is devoted to only the first of these—leaders. Although this is also a potential weakness, by focusing exclusively on the role of the leader in leadership the trait approach has been able to provide us with a deeper and more intricate understanding of how the leader and the leader’s traits are related to the leadership process.
Last, the trait approach has given us some benchmarks for what we need to look for if we want to be leaders. It identifies what traits we should have and whether the traits we do have are the best traits for leadership. Based on the findings of this approach, trait assessment procedures can be used to offer invaluable information to supervisors and managers about their strengths and weaknesses and ways to improve their overall leadership effectiveness.
criTicisms _______________________________________
In addition to its strengths, the trait approach has several weaknesses. First and foremost is the failure of the trait approach to delimit a definitive list of leadership traits. Although an enormous number of studies have been conducted over the past 100 years, the findings from these studies have
character Traits
chapter 2 Trait approach 31
been ambiguous and uncertain at times. Furthermore, the list of traits that has emerged appears endless. This is obvious from Table 2.1, which lists a multitude of traits. In fact, these are only a sample of the many leadership traits that were studied.
Another criticism is that the trait approach has failed to take situations into account. As Stogdill (1948) pointed out more than 60 years ago, it is difficult to isolate a set of traits that are characteristic of leaders without also factoring situational effects into the equation. People who possess certain traits that make them leaders in one situation may not be leaders in another situation. Some people may have the traits that help them emerge as leaders but not the traits that allow them to maintain their leadership over time. In other words, the situation influences leadership. It is therefore difficult to identify a universal set of leadership traits in isolation from the context in which the leadership occurs.
A third criticism, derived from the prior two criticisms, is that this approach has resulted in highly subjective determinations of the most important leadership traits. Because the findings on traits have been so extensive and broad, there has been much subjective interpretation of the meaning of the data. This subjectivity is readily apparent in the many self-help, practice- oriented management books. For example, one author might identify ambition and creativity as crucial leadership traits; another might identify empathy and calmness. In both cases, it is the author’s subjective experience and observations that are the basis for the identified leadership traits. These books may be helpful to readers because they identify and describe important leadership traits, but the methods used to generate these lists of traits are weak. To respond to people’s need for a set of definitive traits of leaders, authors have set forth lists of traits, even if the origins of these lists are not grounded in strong, reliable research.
Research on traits can also be criticized for failing to look at traits in relationship to leadership outcomes. This research has emphasized the identification of traits, but has not addressed how leadership traits affect group members and their work. In trying to ascertain universal leadership traits, researchers have focused on the link between specific traits and leader emergence, but they have not tried to link leader traits with other outcomes such as productivity or employee satisfaction. For example, trait research does not provide data on whether leaders who might have high intelligence and strong integrity have better results than leaders without these traits. The trait approach is weak in describing how leaders’ traits affect the outcomes of groups and teams in organizational settings.
effective and ineffective Leaders
32 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
A final criticism of the trait approach is that it is not a useful approach for training and development for leadership. Even if definitive traits could be identified, teaching new traits is not an easy process because traits are not easily changed. For example, it is not reasonable to send managers to a training program to raise their IQ or to train them to become extraverted. The point is that traits are largely fixed psychological structures, and this limits the value of teaching and leadership training.
ApplicATion _____________________________________
Despite its shortcomings, the trait approach provides valuable information about leadership. It can be applied by individuals at all levels and in all types of organizations. Although the trait approach does not provide a definitive set of traits, it does provide direction regarding which traits are good to have if one aspires to a leadership position. By taking trait assessments and other similar questionnaires, people can gain insight into whether they have certain traits deemed important for leadership, and they can pinpoint their strengths and weaknesses with regard to leadership.
As we discussed previously, managers can use information from the trait approach to assess where they stand in their organization and what they need to do to strengthen their position. Trait information can suggest areas in which their personal characteristics are very beneficial to the company and areas in which they may want to get more training to enhance their overall approach. Using trait information, managers can develop a deeper understanding of who they are and how they will affect others in the organization.
cAse sTUDies
In this section, three case studies (Cases 2.1, 2.2, and 2.3) are provided to illustrate the trait approach and to help you understand how the trait approach can be used in making decisions in organizational settings. The settings of the cases are diverse—directing research and development at a large snack food company, running an office supply business, and being head of recruitment for a large bank—but all of the cases deal with trait leadership. At the end of each case, you will find questions that will help in analyzing the cases.
What are My Traits?
chapter 2 Trait approach 33
Case 2.1
choosing a new Director of research
sandra coke is vice president for research and development at Great Lakes Foods (GLF), a large snack food company that has approximately 1,000 employees. as a result of a recent reorganization, sandra must choose the new director of research. The director will report directly to sandra and will be responsible for developing and testing new products. The research division of GLF employs about 200 people. The choice of directors is important because sandra is receiving pressure from the president and board of GLF to improve the company’s overall growth and productivity.
sandra has identified three candidates for the position. each candidate is at the same managerial level. she is having difficulty choosing one of them because each has very strong credentials. alexa smith is a longtime employee of GLF who started part-time in the mailroom while in high school. after finishing school, alexa worked in as many as 10 different positions throughout the company to become manager of new product marketing. performance reviews of alexa’s work have repeatedly described her as being very creative and insightful. in her tenure at GLF, alexa has developed and brought to market four new product lines. alexa is also known throughout GLF as being very persistent about her work: When she starts a project, she stays with it until it is finished. it is probably this quality that accounts for the success of each of the four new products with which she has been involved.
a second candidate for the new position is Kelsey Metts, who has been with GLF for 5 years and is manager of quality control for established products. Kelsey has a reputation for being very bright. Before joining GLF, she received her MBa at Harvard, graduating at the top of her class. people talk about Kelsey as the kind of person who will be president of her own company someday. Kelsey is also very personable. on all her performance reviews, she received extra-high scores on sociability and human relations. There isn’t a supervisor in the company who doesn’t have positive things to say about how comfortable it is to work with Kelsey. since joining GLF, Kelsey has been instrumental in bringing two new product lines to market.
Thomas santiago, the third candidate, has been with GLF for 10 years and is often consulted by upper management regarding strategic plan- ning and corporate direction setting. Thomas has been very involved in establishing the vision for GLF and is a company person all the way. He believes in the values of GLF, and actively promotes its mission. The two
(Continued)
34 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
qualities that stand out above the rest in Thomas’s performance reviews are his honesty and integrity. employees who have worked under his supervision consistently report that they feel they can trust Thomas to be fair and consistent. Thomas is highly respected at GLF. in his tenure at the company, Thomas has been involved in some capacity with the devel- opment of three new product lines.
The challenge confronting sandra is to choose the best person for the newly established director’s position. Because of the pressure she feels from upper management, sandra knows she must select the best leader for the new position.
Questions
1. Based on the information provided about the trait approach in Tables 2.1 and 2.2, if you were sandra, whom would you select?
2. in what ways is the trait approach helpful in this type of selection?
3. in what ways are the weaknesses of the trait approach highlighted in this case?
(continued)
Case 2.2
A remarkable Turnaround
carol Baines was married for 20 years to the owner of the Baines company until he died in a car accident. after his death, carol decided not to sell the business but to try to run it herself. Before the accident, her only involvement in the business was in informal discussions with her husband over dinner, although she has a college degree in business, with a major in management.
Baines company was one of three office supply stores in a city with a population of 200,000 people. The other two stores were owned by national chains. Baines was not a large company, and employed only five people. Baines had stable sales of about $200,000 a year, serving mostly the smaller companies in the city. The firm had not grown in a number of years and was beginning to feel the pressure of the advertising and lower prices of the national chains.
For the first 6 months, carol spent her time familiarizing herself with the employees and the operations of the company. next, she did a citywide
chapter 2 Trait approach 35
analysis of companies that had reason to purchase office supplies. Based on her understanding of the company’s capabilities and her assessment of the potential market for their products and services, carol developed a specific set of short-term and long-term goals for the company. Behind all of her planning, carol had a vision that Baines could be a viable, healthy, and competitive company. she wanted to carry on the business that her husband had started, but more than that she wanted it to grow.
over the first 5 years, carol invested significant amounts of money in advertising, sales, and services. These efforts were well spent because the company began to show rapid growth immediately. Because of the growth, the company hired another 20 people.
The expansion at Baines was particularly remarkable because of another major hardship carol had to confront. carol was diagnosed with breast cancer a year after her husband died. The treatment for her cancer included 2 months of radiation therapy and 6 months of strong chemo- therapy. although the side effects included hair loss and fatigue, carol continued to manage the company throughout the ordeal. Despite her difficulties, carol was successful. Under the strength of her leadership, the growth at Baines continued for 10 consecutive years.
interviews with new and old employees at Baines revealed much about carol’s leadership. employees said that carol was a very solid person. she cared deeply about others and was fair and considerate. They said she created a family-like atmosphere at Baines. Few employees had quit Baines since carol took over. carol was devoted to all the employees, and she supported their interests. For example, the company sponsored a softball team in the summer and a basketball team in the winter. others described carol as a strong person. even though she had cancer, she continued to be positive and interested in them. she did not get depressed about the cancer and its side effects, even though coping with cancer was difficult. employees said she was a model of strength, good- ness, and quality.
at age 55, carol turned the business over to her two sons. she continues to act as the president but does not supervise the day-to-day operations. The company is doing more than $3.1 million in sales, and it outpaces the two chain stores in the city.
Questions
1. How would you describe carol’s leadership traits?
2. How big a part did carol’s traits play in the expansion of the company?
3. Would carol be a leader in other business contexts?
36 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
Case 2.3
recruiting for the Bank
pat nelson is the assistant director of human resources in charge of recruitment for central Bank, a large, full-service banking institu- tion. one of pat’s major responsibilities each spring is to visit as many college campuses as he can to interview graduating seniors for credit analyst positions in the commercial lending area at central Bank. although the number varies, he usually ends up hiring about 20 new people, most of whom come from the same schools, year after year.
pat has been doing recruitment for the bank for more than 10 years, and he enjoys it very much. However, for the upcoming spring he is feeling increased pressure from management to be particularly dis- criminating about whom he recommends hiring. Management is con- cerned about the retention rate at the bank because in recent years as many as 25% of the new hires have left. Departures after the first year have meant lost training dollars and strain on the staff who remain. although management understands that some new hires always leave, the executives are not comfortable with the present rate, and they have begun to question the recruitment and hiring procedures.
The bank wants to hire people who can be groomed for higher-level leadership positions. although certain competencies are required of entry-level credit analysts, the bank is equally interested in skills that will allow individuals to advance to upper management positions as their careers progress.
in the recruitment process, pat always looks for several characteristics. First, applicants need to have strong interpersonal skills, they need to be confident, and they need to show poise and initiative. next, because banking involves fiduciary responsibilities, applicants need to have proper ethics, including a strong sense of the importance of confiden- tiality. in addition, to do the work in the bank, they need to have strong analytical and technical skills, and experience in working with computers. Last, applicants need to exhibit a good work ethic, and they need to show commitment and a willingness to do their job even in difficult circumstances.
pat is fairly certain that he has been selecting the right people to be leaders at central Bank, yet upper management is telling him to reassess his hiring criteria. although he feels that he has been doing the right thing, he is starting to question himself and his recruitment practices.
chapter 2 Trait approach 37
Questions
1. Based on ideas described in the trait approach, do you think pat is looking for the right characteristics in the people he hires?
2. could it be that the retention problem raised by upper management is unrelated to pat’s recruitment criteria?
3. if you were pat, would you change your approach to recruiting?
leADersHip insTrUmenT _________________________
Organizations use a wide variety of questionnaires to measure individuals’ traits. In many organizations, it is common practice to use standard trait measures such as the Minnesota Multiphasic Personality Inventory or the Myers-Briggs Type Indicator. These measures provide valuable information to the individual and the organization about the individual’s unique attributes for leadership and where the individual could best serve the organization.
In this section, the Leadership Trait Questionnaire (LTQ ) is provided as an example of a measure that can be used to assess your personal leadership characteristics. The LTQ quantifies the perceptions of the individual leader and selected observers, such as subordinates or peers. It measures an individual’s traits and points the individual to the areas in which that individual may have special strengths or weaknesses.
By taking the LTQ , you can gain an understanding of how trait measures are used for leadership assessment. You can also assess your own leadership traits.
38 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
leadership Trait Questionnaire (lTQ)
Instructions: The purpose of this questionnaire is to measure personal charac- teristics of leadership. The questionnaire should be completed by the leader and five people who are familiar with the leader.
Make five copies of this questionnaire. This questionnaire should be com- pleted by you and five people you know (e.g., roommates, coworkers, rela- tives, friends). Using the following scale, have each individual indicate the degree to which he or she agrees or disagrees with each of the 14 statements below. Do not forget to complete one for yourself.
______________________________________ (leader’s name) is
Key: 1 = strongly 2 = Disagree 3 = neutral 4 = agree 5 = strongly disagree agree
1. Articulate: communicates effectively with others 1 2 3 4 5
2. perceptive: is discerning and insightful 1 2 3 4 5
3. self-confident: Believes in himself/herself and his/her ability 1 2 3 4 5
4. self-assured: is secure with self, free of doubts 1 2 3 4 5
5. persistent: stays fixed on the goals, despite interference 1 2 3 4 5
6. Determined: Takes a firm stand, acts with certainty 1 2 3 4 5
7. Trustworthy: is authentic and inspires confidence 1 2 3 4 5
8. Dependable: is consistent and reliable 1 2 3 4 5
9. Friendly: shows kindness and warmth 1 2 3 4 5
10. outgoing: Talks freely, gets along well with others 1 2 3 4 5
11. conscientious: is thorough, organized, and controlled 1 2 3 4 5
12. Diligent: is persistent, hardworking 1 2 3 4 5
13. sensitive: shows tolerance, is tactful and sympathetic 1 2 3 4 5
14. empathic: Understands others, identifies with others 1 2 3 4 5
scoring
1. enter the responses for raters 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 in the appropriate columns as shown in example 2.1. The example provides hypothetical ratings to help explain how the questionnaire can be used.
2. For each of the 14 items, compute the average for the five raters and place that number in the “average rating” column.
3. place your own scores in the “self-rating” column.
chapter 2 Trait approach 39
example 2.1 leadership Traits Questionnaire ratings
average self- rater 1 rater 2 rater 3 rater 4 rater 5 rating rating
1. articulate 4 4 3 2 4 3.4 4
2. perceptive 2 5 3 4 4 3.6 5
3. self-confident 4 4 5 5 4 4.4 4
4. self-assured 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
5. persistent 4 4 3 3 3 3.4 3
6. Determined 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
7. Trustworthy 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
8. Dependable 4 5 4 5 4 4.4 4
9. Friendly 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
10. outgoing 5 4 5 4 5 4.6 4
11. conscientious 2 3 2 3 3 2.6 4
12. Diligent 3 3 3 3 3 3 4
13. sensitive 4 4 5 5 5 4.6 3
14. empathic 5 5 4 5 4 4.6 3
scoring interpretation
The scores you received on the LTQ provide information about how you see yourself and how others see you as a leader. The chart allows you to see where your perceptions are the same as those of others and where they differ.
The example ratings show how the leader self-rated higher than the observ- ers did on the characteristic articulate. on the second characteristic, percep- tive, the leader self-rated substantially higher than others. on the self-confident characteristic, the leader self-rated quite close to others’ rat- ings but lower. There are no best ratings on this questionnaire. The purpose of the instrument is to give you a way to assess your strengths and weak- nesses and to evaluate areas where your perceptions are congruent with those of others and where there are discrepancies.
40 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
sUmmAry _______________________________________
The trait approach has its roots in leadership theory that suggested that certain people were born with special traits that made them great leaders. Because it was believed that leaders and nonleaders could be differentiated by a universal set of traits, throughout the 20th century researchers were challenged to identify the definitive traits of leaders.
Around the mid-20th century, several major studies questioned the basic premise that a unique set of traits defined leadership. As a result, attention shifted to incorporating the impact of situations and of followers on leadership. Researchers began to study the interactions between leaders and their context instead of focusing only on leaders’ traits. More recently, there have been signs that trait research has come full circle, with a renewed interest in focusing directly on the critical traits of leaders.
From the multitude of studies conducted through the years on personal characteristics, it is clear that many traits contribute to leadership. Some of the important traits that are consistently identified in many of these studies are intelligence, self-confidence, determination, integrity, and sociability. In addition, researchers have found a strong relationship between leadership and the traits described by the f ive-factor personality model. Extraversion was the trait most strongly associated with leadership, followed by conscientiousness, openness, low neuroticism, and agreeableness. Another recent line of research has focused on emotional intelligence and its relationship to leadership. This research suggests that leaders who are sensitive to their emotions and to the impact of their emotions on others may be leaders who are more effective.
On a practical level, the trait approach is concerned with which traits leaders exhibit and who has these traits. Organizations use personality assessment instruments to identify how individuals will fit within their organizations. The trait approach is also used for personal awareness and development because it allows managers to analyze their strengths and weaknesses and to gain a clearer understanding of how they should try to change to enhance their leadership.
There are several advantages to viewing leadership from the trait approach. First, it is intuitively appealing because it fits clearly into the popular idea that leaders are special people who are out front, leading the way in society. Second, a great deal of research validates the basis of this perspective. Third, by focusing exclusively on the leader, the trait approach provides an in-depth understanding of the leader component in the leadership process. Last, it has provided some benchmarks against which individuals can evaluate their own personal leadership attributes.
chapter 2 Trait approach 41
On the negative side, the trait approach has failed to provide a definitive list of leadership traits. In analyzing the traits of leaders, the approach has failed to take into account the impact of situations. In addition, the approach has resulted in subjective lists of the most important leadership traits, which are not necessarily grounded in strong, reliable research.
Furthermore, the trait approach has not adequately linked the traits of leaders with other outcomes such as group and team performance. Last, this approach is not particularly useful for training and development for leadership because individuals’ personal attributes are largely stable and fixed, and their traits are not amenable to change.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerences ______________________________________
Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass and Stogdill ’s handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York: Free Press.
Bennis, W. G., & Nanus, B. (1985). Leaders: The strategies for taking charge. New York: Harper & Row.
Bryman, A. (1992). Charisma and leadership in organizations. London: SAGE. Caruso, D. R., & Wolfe, C. J. (2004). Emotional intelligence and leadership
development. In D. V. Day, S. J. Zaccaro, & S. M. Halpin (Eds.), Leader development for transforming organizations: Growing leaders for tomorrow (pp. 237–266). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Goldberg, L. R. (1990). An alternative “description of personality”: The big-five factor structure. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 59, 1216–1229.
Goleman, D. (1995). Emotional intelligence. New York: Bantam. Goleman, D. (1998). Working with emotional intelligence. New York: Bantam. Jago, A. G. (1982). Leadership: Perspectives in theory and research. Management
Science, 28(3), 315–336. Judge, T. A., Bono, J. E., Ilies, R., & Gerhardt, M. W. (2002). Personality and
leadership: A qualitative and quantitative review. Journal of Applied Psychology, 87, 765–780.
Jung, D., & Sosik, J. J. (2006). Who are the spellbinders? Identifying personal attributes of charismatic leaders. Journal of Leadership & Organizational Studies, 12, 12–27.
Kidder, T. (2004). Mountains beyond mountains: The quest of Dr. Paul Farmer, a man who would cure the world. New York: Random House.
Kirkpatrick, S. A., & Locke, E. A. (1991). Leadership: Do traits matter? The Executive, 5, 48–60.
42 LeaDersHip THeory anD pracTice
Lord, R. G., DeVader, C. L., & Alliger, G. M. (1986). A meta-analysis of the relation between personality traits and leadership perceptions: An application of validity generalization procedures. Journal of Applied Psychology, 71, 402–410.
Mann, R. D. (1959). A review of the relationship between personality and performance in small groups. Psychological Bulletin, 56, 241–270.
Marlowe, H. A. (1986). Social intelligence: Evidence for multidimensionality and construct independence. Journal of Educational Psychology, 78, 52–58.
Mayer, J. D., Caruso, D. R., & Salovey, P. (2000). Selecting a measure of emotional intelligence: The case for ability scales. In R. Bar-On & J. D. A. Parker (Eds.), The handbook of emotional intelligence (pp. 320–342). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Mayer, J. D., & Salovey, P. (1995). Emotional intelligence and the construction and regulation of feelings. Applied & Preventive Psychology, 4, 197–208.
Mayer, J. D., & Salovey, P. (1997). What is emotional intelligence? In P. Salovey & D. Sluyter (Eds.), Emotional development and emotional intelligence: Implications for educators (pp. 3–31). New York: Basic Books.
Mayer, J. D., Salovey, P., & Caruso, D. R. (2000). Models of emotional intelligence. In R. J. Sternberg (Ed.), Handbook of intelligence (pp. 396–420). Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
McCrae, R. R., & Costa, P. T. (1987). Validation of the five-factor model of personality across instruments and observers. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 52, 81–90.
Nadler, D. A., & Tushman, M. L. (1989). What makes for magic leadership? In W. E. Rosenbach & R. L. Taylor (Eds.), Contemporary issues in leadership (pp. 135– 139). Boulder, CO: Westview.
Partners In Health. (2014). Our work. Retrieved from http://www.pih.org/our-work Sculley, J. (2011, October 10). No bozos. Ever. Bloomberg Businessweek, 4249, 27. Shankman, M. L., & Allen, S. J. (2008). Emotionally intelligent leadership: A guide for
college students. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass. Stogdill, R. M. (1948). Personal factors associated with leadership: A survey of the
literature. Journal of Psychology, 25, 35–71. Stogdill, R. M. (1974). Handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New
York: Free Press. Stone, B. (2011, October 10). The return. Bloomberg Businessweek, 4249, 40. Zaccaro, S. J. (2002). Organizational leadership and social intelligence. In R. Riggio
(Ed.), Multiple intelligence and leadership (pp. 29–54). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Zaccaro, S. J. (2007). Trait-based perspectives of leadership. American Psychologist, 62, 6–16.
Zaccaro, S. J., Kemp, C., & Bader, P. (2004). Leader traits and attributes. In J. Antonakis, A. T. Cianciolo, & R. J. Sternberg (Eds.), The nature of leadership (pp. 101–124). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Zaleznik, A. (1977, May–June). Managers and leaders: Are they different? Harvard Business Review, 55, 67–78.
3
Skills Approach
DeScription _____________________________________
Like the trait approach we discussed in Chapter 2, the skills approach takes a leader-centered perspective on leadership. However, in the skills approach we shift our thinking from a focus on personality characteristics, which usually are viewed as innate and largely fixed, to an emphasis on skills and abilities that can be learned and developed. Although personality certainly plays an integral role in leadership, the skills approach suggests that knowl- edge and abilities are needed for effective leadership.
Researchers have studied leadership skills directly or indirectly for a number of years (see Bass, 1990, pp. 97–109). However, the impetus for research on skills was a classic article published by Robert Katz in the Harvard Business Review in 1955, titled “Skills of an Effective Administrator.” Katz’s article appeared at a time when researchers were trying to identify a definitive set of leadership traits. Katz’s approach was an attempt to transcend the trait problem by addressing leadership as a set of developable skills. More recently, a revitalized interest in the skills approach has emerged. Beginning in the early 1990s, a multitude of studies have been published that contend that a leader’s effectiveness depends on the leader’s ability to solve complex orga- nizational problems. This research has resulted in a comprehensive skill- based model of leadership that was advanced by Mumford and his colleagues (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, Jacobs, & Fleishman, 2000; Yammarino, 2000).
In this chapter, our discussion of the skills approach is divided into two parts. First, we discuss the general ideas set forth by Katz regarding three basic administrative skills: technical, human, and conceptual. Second, we discuss
Leadership Skills
44 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
the recent work of Mumford and colleagues that has resulted in a new skills- based model of organizational leadership.
Three-Skill Approach
Based on field research in administration and his own firsthand observations of executives in the workplace, Katz (1955, p. 34) suggested that effective administration (i.e., leadership) depends on three basic personal skills: tech- nical, human, and conceptual. Katz argued that these skills are quite different from traits or qualities of leaders. Skills are what leaders can accomplish, whereas traits are who leaders are (i.e., their innate characteristics). Leader- ship skills are defined in this chapter as the ability to use one’s knowledge and competencies to accomplish a set of goals or objectives. This chapter shows that these leadership skills can be acquired and leaders can be trained to develop them.
technical Skill
Technical skill is knowledge about and proficiency in a specific type of work or activity. It includes competencies in a specialized area, analytical ability, and the ability to use appropriate tools and techniques (Katz, 1955). For example, in a computer software company, technical skill might include knowing soft- ware language and programming, the company’s software products, and how to make these products function for clients. Similarly, in an accounting firm, technical skill might include understanding and having the ability to apply generally accepted accounting principles to a client’s audit. In both these examples, technical skills involve a hands-on activity with a basic product or process within an organization. Technical skills play an essential role in pro- ducing the actual products a company is designed to produce.
As illustrated in Figure 3.1, technical skill is most important at lower and middle levels of management and less important in upper management. For leaders at the highest level, such as CEOs, presidents, and senior officers, technical competencies are not as essential. Individuals at the top level depend on skilled followers to handle technical issues of the physical operation.
Human Skill
Human skill is knowledge about and ability to work with people. It is quite different from technical skill, which has to do with working with things
applying Katz's Skills Technical Skills
chapter 3 Skills approach 45
(Katz, 1955). Human skills are “people skills.” They are the abilities that help a leader to work effectively with followers, peers, and superiors to accomplish the organization’s goals. Human skills allow a leader to assist group members in working cooperatively as a group to achieve common goals. For Katz, it means being aware of one’s own perspective on issues and, at the same time, being aware of the perspective of others. Leaders with human skills adapt their own ideas to those of others. Furthermore, they create an atmosphere of trust where employees can feel comfortable and secure and where they can feel encouraged to become involved in the planning of things that will affect them. Being a leader with human skills means being sensitive to the needs and motivations of others and taking into account others’ needs in one’s decision making. In short, human skill is the capacity to get along with oth- ers as you go about your work.
In Figure 3.1, human skills are important in all three levels of management. Although managers at lower levels may communicate with a far greater number of employees, human skills are equally important at middle and upper levels.
conceptual Skill
Broadly speaking, conceptual skills are the ability to work with ideas and concepts. Whereas technical skills deal with things and human skills deal with people, conceptual skills involve the ability to work with ideas. A leader with conceptual skills is comfortable talking about the ideas that shape an organization and the intricacies involved. He or she is good at putting the company’s goals into words and can understand and express the economic principles that affect the company. A leader with conceptual skills works easily with abstractions and hypothetical notions.
Conceptual skills are central to creating a vision and strategic plan for an organization. For example, it would take conceptual skills for a CEO in a struggling manufacturing company to articulate a vision for a line of new products that would steer the company into profitability. Similarly, it would take conceptual skill for the director of a nonprofit health organization to create a strategic plan that could compete successfully with for-profit health organizations in a market with scarce resources. The point of these examples is that conceptual skill has to do with the mental work of shaping the mean- ing of organizational or policy issues—understanding what a company stands for and where it is or should be going.
In Figure 3.1, conceptual skill is most important at the top management levels. In fact, when upper-level managers do not have strong conceptual
outdoor Leadership Skills
46 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
skills, they can jeopardize the whole organization. Conceptual skills are also important in middle management; as we move down to lower management levels, conceptual skills become less important.
Summary of the three-Skill Approach
To summarize, the three-skill approach includes technical, human, and con- ceptual skills. It is important for leaders to have all three skills; depending on where they are in the management structure, however, some skills are more important than others are.
Katz’s work in the mid-1950s set the stage for conceptualizing leadership in terms of skills, but it was not until the mid-1990s that an empirically based
Figure 3.1 Management Skills necessary at Various Levels of an organization
TOP Management
SUPERVISORY Management
MIDDLE Management
SKILLS NEEDED
CONCEPTUAL
TECHNICAL
HUMAN
TECHNICAL HUMAN CONCEPTUAL
CONCEPTUAL
TECHNICAL HUMAN
SoUrce: adapted from “Skills of an effective administrator,” by r. L. Katz, 1955, Harvard Business Review, 33(1), pp. 33–42.
chapter 3 Skills approach 47
skills approach received recognition in leadership research. In the next sec- tion, the comprehensive skill-based model of leadership is presented.
Skills Model
Beginning in the early 1990s, a group of researchers, with funding from the U.S. Army and Department of Defense, set out to test and develop a comprehensive theory of leadership based on problem-solving skills in organizations. The stud- ies were conducted over a number of years using a sample of more than 1,800 Army officers, representing six grade levels, from second lieutenant to colonel. The project used a variety of new measures and tools to assess the skills of these officers, their experiences, and the situations in which they worked.
The researchers’ main goal was to explain the underlying elements of effec- tive performance. They addressed questions such as these: What accounts for why some leaders are good problem solvers and others are not? What specific skills do high-performing leaders exhibit? How do leaders’ indi- vidual characteristics, career experiences, and environmental influences affect their job performance? As a whole, researchers wanted to identify the leader- ship factors that create exemplary job performance in an actual organization.
Based on the extensive findings from the project, Mumford and colleagues formulated a skill-based model of leadership. The model is characterized as a capability model because it examines the relationship between a leader’s knowledge and skills (i.e., capabilities) and the leader’s performance (Mum- ford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000, p. 12). Leadership capabilities can be developed over time through education and experience. Unlike the “great man” approach (discussed in this text, Chapter 2), which implies that leader- ship is reserved for only the gifted few, the skills approach suggests that many people have the potential for leadership. If people are capable of learn- ing from their experiences, they can acquire leadership. The skills approach can also be distinguished from the leadership approaches we will discuss in subsequent chapters, which focus on behavioral patterns of leaders (e.g., the style approach, transformational leadership, or leader–member exchange theory). Rather than emphasizing what leaders do, the skills approach frames leadership as the capabilities (knowledge and skills) that make effective leadership possible (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000, p. 12).
The skill-based model of Mumford’s group has five components: competen- cies, individual attributes, leadership outcomes, career experiences, and envi- ronmental influences. A portion of the model, illustrating three of these components, appears in Figure 3.2. This portion of the model is essential to understanding the overall skill-based leadership model.
Leadership development career experiences
48 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
competencies
As can be observed in the middle box in Figure 3.2, problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge are at the heart of the skills model. These three competencies are the key factors that account for effective performance.
Problem-Solving Skills. What are problem-solving skills? According to Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al. (2000), problem-solving skills are a leader’s creative ability to solve new and unusual, ill-defined organizational problems. The skills include being able to define significant problems, gather problem information, formulate new understandings about the problem, and generate prototype plans for problem solutions. These skills do not function in a vacuum, but are carried out in an organizational con- text. Problem-solving skills demand that leaders understand their own leadership capacities as they apply possible solutions to the unique prob- lems in their organization (Mumford, Zaccaro, Connelly, & Marks, 2000).
Being able to construct solutions plays a special role in problem solving. In considering solutions to organizational problems, skilled leaders need to attend to the time frame for constructing and implementing a solution, short-term and long-term goals, career goals and organizational goals, and external issues, all of which could influence the solution (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000, p. 15).
Figure 3.2 Three components of the Skills Model
INDIVIDUAL ATTRIBUTES
General Cognitive Ability
Crystallized Cognitive Ability
Motivation
Personality
COMPETENCIES
Problem-Solving Skills
Social Judgment Skills
Knowledge
LEADERSHIP OUTCOMES
Effective Problem Solving
Performance
SoUrce: adapted from “Leadership Skills for a changing World: Solving complex Social problems,” by M. d. Mumford, S. J. Zaccaro, F. d. harding, T. o. Jacobs, and e. a. Fleishman, 2000, Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 23.
conceptualizations of Skill Shared Leadership
chapter 3 Skills approach 49
To clarify what is meant by problem-solving skills, consider the following hypothetical situation. Imagine that you are the director of human resources for a medium-sized company and you have been informed by the president that you have to develop a plan to reduce the company’s health care costs. In deciding what you will do, you could demonstrate problem-solving skills in the following ways. First, you identify the full ramifications for employees of changing their health insurance coverage. What is the impact going to be? Second, you gather information about how benefits can be scaled back. What other companies have attempted a similar change, and what were their results? Third, you find a way to teach and inform the employees about the needed change. How can you frame the change in such a way that it is clearly understood? Fourth, you create possible scenarios for how the changes will be instituted. How will the plan be described? Fifth, you look closely at the solution itself. How will implementing this change affect the company’s mission and your own career? Last, are there issues in the organization (e.g., union rules) that may affect the implementation of these changes?
As illustrated by this example, the process of dealing with novel, ill-defined organizational problems is complex and demanding for leaders. In many ways, it is like a puzzle to be solved. For leaders to solve such puzzles, the skill-based model suggests that problem-solving skills are essential.
Social Judgment Skills. In addition to problem-solving skills, effective leadership performance also requires social judgment skills (see Figure 3.2). In general, social judgment skills are the capacity to understand people and social systems (Zaccaro, Mumford, Connelly, Marks, & Gilbert, 2000, p. 46). They enable leaders to work with others to solve problems and to marshal support to implement change within an organization. Social judg- ment skills are the people skills that are necessary to solve unique organiza- tional problems.
Conceptually, social judgment skills are similar to Katz’s (1955) early work on the role of human skills in management. In contrast to Katz’s work, Mumford and colleagues have delineated social judgment skills into the fol- lowing: perspective taking, social perceptiveness, behavioral flexibility, and social performance.
Perspective taking means understanding the attitudes that others have toward a particular problem or solution. It is empathy applied to problem solving. Perspective taking means being sensitive to other people’s perspectives and goals—being able to understand their point of view on different issues. Included in perspective taking is knowing how different constituencies in an
emotional intelligence Skills problem-Solving approaches
50 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
organization view a problem and possible solutions. According to Zaccaro, Gilbert, Thor, and Mumford (1991), perspective-taking skills can be likened to social intelligence. These skills are concerned with knowledge about people, the social fabric of organizations, and the interrelatedness of each of them.
Social perceptiveness is insight and awareness into how others in the organiza- tion function. What is important to others? What motivates them? What problems do they face, and how do they react to change? Social perceptive- ness means understanding the unique needs, goals, and demands of different organizational constituencies (Zaccaro et al., 1991). A leader with social perceptiveness has a keen sense of how followers will respond to any pro- posed change in the organization. In a sense, you could say it allows the leader to know the pulse of followers on any issue at any time.
In addition to understanding others accurately, social judgment skills also involve reacting to others with flexibility. Behavioral flexibility is the capacity to change and adapt one’s behavior in light of an understanding of others’ perspectives in the organization. Being flexible means one is not locked into a singular approach to a problem. One is not dogmatic but rather maintains an openness and willingness to change. As the circumstances of a situation change, a flexible leader changes to meet the new demands.
Social performance includes a wide range of leadership competencies. Based on an understanding of followers’ perspectives, leaders need to be able to communicate their own vision to others. Skill in persuasion and communi- cating change is essential to do this. When there is resistance to change or interpersonal conflict about change, leaders need to function as mediators. To this end, skill in conflict resolution is an important aspect of social per- formance competency. In addition, social performance sometimes requires that leaders coach followers, giving them direction and support as they move toward selected organizational goals. In all, social performance includes many related skills that may come under the umbrella of communication.
To review, social judgment skills are about being sensitive to how your ideas fit in with others. Can you understand others’ perspectives and their unique needs and motivations? Are you flexible, and can you adapt your own ideas to others? Can you work with others even when there is resistance and con- flict? Social judgment skills are the people skills needed to advance change in an organization.
Knowledge. As shown in the model (see Figure 3.2), the third aspect of competencies is knowledge. Knowledge is inextricably related to the
Flexibility
chapter 3 Skills approach 51
application and implementation of problem-solving skills in organizations. It directly influences a leader’s capacity to define complex organizational problems and to attempt to solve them (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000). Knowledge is the accumulation of information and the mental struc- tures used to organize that information. Such a mental structure is called a schema (a summary, a diagrammatic representation, or an outline). Knowledge results from having developed an assortment of complex schemata for learning and organizing data.
For example, all of us take various kinds of facts and information into our minds. As we organize that information into categories or schemata, the information becomes more meaningful. Knowledge emerges from the facts and the organizational structures we apply to them. People with a lot of knowledge have more complex organizing structures than those with less knowledge. These knowledgeable people are called experts.
Consider the following baseball example. A baseball expert knows a lot of facts about the game; the expert knows the rules, strategies, equipment, players, and much, much more. The expert’s knowledge about baseball includes the facts, but it also includes the complex mental structures used in organizing and structuring those facts. That person knows not only the season and lifetime statistics for each player, but also that player’s quirks and injuries, the personality of the manager, the strengths and weaknesses of available substitutes, and so on. The expert knows baseball because she or he comprehends the complexities and nuances of the game. The same is true for leadership in organizations. Leaders with knowledge know much about the products, the tasks, the people, the organization, and all the dif- ferent ways these elements are related to each other. A knowledgeable leader has many mental structures with which to organize the facts of orga- nizational life.
Knowledge has a positive impact on how leaders engage in problem solving. It is knowledge and expertise that make it possible for people to think about complex system issues and identify possible strategies for appropriate change. Furthermore, this capacity allows people to use prior cases and incidents in order to plan for needed change. It is knowledge that allows people to use the past to constructively confront the future.
To summarize, the skills model consists of three competencies: problem- solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge. Collectively, these three components are positively related to effective leadership performance (see Figure 3.2).
evidence-Based practice
52 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
individual Attributes
Returning to Figure 3.2, the box on the left identifies four individual attri- butes that have an impact on leadership skills and knowledge: general cogni- tive ability, crystallized cognitive ability, motivation, and personality. These attributes play important roles in the skills model. Complex problem solving is a very difficult process and becomes more difficult as people move up in the organization. These attributes support people as they apply their leader- ship competencies.
General Cognitive Ability. General cognitive ability can be thought of as a person’s intelligence. It includes perceptual processing, information pro- cessing, general reasoning skills, creative and divergent thinking capacities, and memory skills. General cognitive ability is linked to biology, not to experience.
General cognitive ability is sometimes described as fluid intelligence, a type of intelligence that usually grows and expands up through early adulthood and then declines with age. In the skills model, intelligence is described as having a positive impact on the leader’s acquisition of complex problem- solving skills and the leader’s knowledge.
Crystallized Cognitive Ability. Crystallized cognitive ability is intellectual ability that is learned or acquired over time. It is the store of knowledge we acquire through experience. We learn and increase our capacities over a lifetime, increasing our leadership potential (e.g., problem-solving skills, conceptual ability, and social judgment skills). In normally functioning adults, this type of cognitive ability grows continuously and typically does not fall off in adulthood. It includes being able to comprehend complex information and learn new skills and information, as well as being able to communicate to others in oral and written forms (Connelly et al., 2000, p. 71). Stated another way, crystallized cognitive ability is acquired intelli- gence: the ideas and mental abilities people learn through experience. Because it stays fairly stable over time, this type of intelligence is not dimin- ished as people get older.
Motivation. Motivation is listed as the third attribute in the model. Although the model does not purport to explain the many ways in which motivation may affect leadership, it does suggest three aspects of motivation that are essential to developing leadership skills (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000, p. 22): First, leaders must be willing to tackle complex organizational problems. This first step is critical. For leadership to occur, a
role of emotions
chapter 3 Skills approach 53
person wants to lead. Second, leaders must be willing to express domi- nance—to exert their influence, as we discussed in Chapter 2. In influencing others, the leader must take on the responsibility of dominance because the influence component of leadership is inextricably bound to dominance. Third, leaders must be committed to the social good of the organization. The social good is a broad term that can refer to a host of outcomes. However, in the skills model it refers to the leader’s willingness to take on the responsi- bility of trying to advance the overall human good and value of the organi- zation. Taken together, these three aspects of motivation (willingness, dominance, and social good) prepare people to become leaders.
Personality. Personality is the fourth individual attribute in the skills model. Placed where it is in the model, this attribute reminds us that our personality has an impact on the development of our leadership skills. For example, open- ness, tolerance for ambiguity, and curiosity may affect a leader’s motivation to try to solve some organizational problems. Or, in conflict situations, traits such as confidence and adaptability may be beneficial to a leader’s perfor- mance. The skills model hypothesizes that any personality characteristic that helps people to cope with complex organizational situations probably is related to leader performance (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000).
Leadership outcomes
In the right-hand box in Figure 3.2, effective problem solving and perfor- mance are the outcomes of leadership. These outcomes are strongly influenced by the leader’s competencies (i.e., problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge). When leaders exhibit these competencies, they increase their chances of problem solving and overall performance.
Effective Problem Solving. As we discussed earlier, the skills model is a capability model, designed to explain why some leaders are good problem solvers and others are not. Problem solving is the keystone in the skills approach. In the model (see Figure 3.2), problem-solving skills, as compe- tencies, lead to effective problem solving as a leadership outcome. The cri- teria for good problem solving are determined by the originality and the quality of expressed solutions to problems. Good problem solving involves creating solutions that are logical, effective, and unique, and that go beyond given information (Zaccaro et al., 2000).
Performance. In the model, performance outcomes reflect how well the leader has done her or his job. To measure performance, standard external
Managerial Leadership
54 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
criteria are used. If the leader has done well and been successful, the leader’s evaluations will be positive. Leaders who are effective receive good annual performance reviews, get merit raises, and are recognized by superiors and followers as competent leaders. In the end, performance is the degree to which a leader has successfully performed the assigned duties.
Taken together, effective problem solving and performance are the two ways to assess leadership effectiveness using the skills model. Furthermore, good problem solving and good performance go hand in hand. A full depiction of the comprehensive skills model appears in Figure 3.3. It contains two other components, not depicted in Figure 3.2, that contribute to overall leadership performance: career experiences and environmental influences.
career experiences
As you can see in Figure 3.3, career experiences have an impact on the char- acteristics and competencies of leaders. The skills model suggests that the experiences acquired in the course of leaders’ careers influence their knowl- edge and skills to solve complex problems. Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al. (2000, p. 24) pointed out that leaders can be helped through challenging job assignments, mentoring, appropriate training, and hands-on experience in solving new and unusual problems. In addition, the authors think that career experiences can positively affect the individual characteristics of lead- ers. For example, certain on-the-job assignments could enhance a leader’s motivation or intellectual ability.
In the first section of this chapter, we discussed Katz’s (1955) work, which notes that conceptual skills are essential for upper-level administrators. This is consistent with Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al.’s (2000) skills model, which contends that leaders develop competencies over time. Career experi- ence helps leaders to improve their skills and knowledge over time. Leaders learn and develop higher levels of conceptual capacity if the kinds of prob- lems they confront are progressively more complex and more long term as they ascend the organizational hierarchy (Mumford, Zaccaro, Connelly, et al., 2000). Similarly, upper-level leaders, as opposed to first-line supervi- sors, develop new competencies because they are required to address prob- lems that are more novel, that are more poorly defined, and that demand more human interaction. As these people move through their careers, higher levels of problem-solving and social judgment skills become increasingly important (Mumford & Connelly, 1991).
Mentoring and coaching
chapter 3 Skills approach 55
So the skills and knowledge of leaders are shaped by their career experiences as they address increasingly complex problems in the organization. This notion of developing leadership skills is unique and quite different from other leadership perspectives. If we say, “Leaders are shaped by their experi- ences,” then it means leaders are not born to be leaders (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000). Leaders can develop their abilities through experience, according to the skills model.
environmental influences
The final component of the skills model is environmental influences, which is illustrated at the bottom of Figure 3.3. Environmental influences represent factors that lie outside the leader’s competencies, characteristics, and experi- ences. These environmental influences can be internal and external.
Internal environmental influences affecting leadership performance can include such factors as technology, facilities, expertise of subordinates, and communication. For example, an aging factory or one lacking in high-speed technology could have a major impact on the nature of problem-solving activities. Another example might be the skill levels of followers: If a leader’s followers are highly competent, they will definitely improve the group’s problem solving and performance. Similarly, if a task is particularly complex or a group’s communication poor, the leader’s performance will be affected.
External environmental influences, including economic, political, and social issues, as well as natural disasters, can provide unique challenges to leaders. In March 2011, a massive earthquake and tsunami devastated large parts of Japan, crippling that nation’s automobile manufacturing industry. Toyota Motor Corp. alone had more than 650 of its suppliers and component man- ufacturers wiped out, halting worldwide production of Toyota vehicles and devastating the company’s sales. At the same time, this disaster was a boon to American carmakers, which increased shipments and began outselling Toyota, which had dominated the market. Leaders of these automobile com- panies, both Japanese and American, had to respond to unique challenges posed by external forces completely beyond their control.
The skills model does not provide an inventory of specific environmental influences. Instead, it acknowledges the existence of these factors and recog- nizes that they are indeed influences that can affect a leader’s performance. In other words, environmental influences are a part of the skills model but not usually under the control of the leader.
Veterans and Leadership
56 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
Summary of the Skills Model
In summary, the skills model frames leadership by describing five compo- nents of leader performance. At the heart of the model are three competen- cies: problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge. These three competencies are the central determinants of effective problem solving and performance, although individual attributes, career experiences, and environ- mental influences all have impacts on leader competencies. Through job experience and training, leaders can become better problem solvers and more effective leaders.
How DoeS tHe SkiLLS ApproAcH work? _________
The skills approach is primarily descriptive: It describes leadership from a skills perspective. Rather than providing prescriptions for success in leader- ship, the skills approach provides a structure for understanding the nature of effective leadership. In the previous sections, we discussed the skills perspective based on the work of Katz (1955) and Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al. (2000). What does each of these bodies of work suggest about the structure and functions of leadership?
Figure 3.3 Skills Model of Leadership
Career Experiences
Environmental Influences
INDIVIDUAL ATTRIBUTES
General Cognitive Ability
Crystallized Cognitive Ability
Motivation
Personality
COMPETENCIES
Problem-Solving Skills
Social Judgment Skills
Knowledge
Problem-Solving Skills
Social Judgment Skills
Knowledge
LEADERSHIP OUTCOMES
Effective Problem Solving
Performance
SoUrce: adapted from “Leadership Skills for a changing World: Solving complex Social problems,” by M. d. Mumford, S. J. Zaccaro, F. d. harding, T. o. Jacobs, and e. a. Fleishman, 2000, Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 23.
chapter 3 Skills approach 57
The three-skill approach of Katz suggests that the importance of certain leadership skills varies depending on where leaders are in a management hierarchy. For leaders operating at lower levels of management, technical and human skills are most important. When leaders move into middle manage- ment, it becomes important that they have all three skills: technical, human, and conceptual. At the upper management levels, it is paramount for leaders to exhibit conceptual and human skills.
This approach was reinforced in a 2007 study that examined the skills needed by executives at different levels of management. The researchers used a four- skill model, similar to Katz’s approach, to assess cognitive skills, interpersonal skills, business skills, and strategic skills of 1,000 managers at the junior, mid- dle, and senior levels of an organization. The results showed that interpersonal and cognitive skills were required more than business and strategic skills for those on the lower levels of management. As one climbed the career ladder, however, the execution of higher levels of all four of these leadership skills became necessary (Mumford, Campion, & Morgeson, 2007).
In their skills model, Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al. (2000) provided a more complex picture of how skills relate to the manifestation of effective leadership. Their skills model contends that leadership outcomes are the direct result of a leader’s competencies in problem-solving skills, social judg- ment skills, and knowledge. Each of these competencies includes a large repertoire of abilities, and each can be learned and developed. In addition, the model illustrates how individual attributes such as general cognitive abil- ity, crystallized cognitive ability, motivation, and personality influence the leader’s competencies. And finally, the model describes how career experi- ences and environmental influences play a direct or indirect role in leader- ship performance.
The skills approach works by providing a map for how to reach effective leadership in an organization: Leaders need to have problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge. Workers can improve their capabili- ties in these areas through training and experience. Although each leader’s personal attributes affect his or her skills, it is the leader’s skills themselves that are most important in addressing organizational problems.
StrengtHS ______________________________________
In several ways, the skills approach contributes positively to our under- standing about leadership. First, it is a leader-centered model that stresses
Leadership Skills development
58 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
the importance of developing particular leadership skills. It is the first approach to conceptualize and create a structure of the process of leadership around skills. Whereas the early research on skills highlighted the impor- tance of skills and the value of skills across different management levels, the later work placed learned skills at the center of effective leadership perfor- mance at all management levels.
Second, the skills approach is intuitively appealing. To describe leadership in terms of skills makes leadership available to everyone. Unlike personality traits, skills are competencies that people can learn or develop. It is like playing a sport such as tennis or golf. Even without natural ability in these sports, people can improve their games with practice and instruction. The same is true with leadership. When leadership is framed as a set of skills, it becomes a process that people can study and practice to become better at performing their jobs.
Third, the skills approach provides an expansive view of leadership that incorporates a wide variety of components, including problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, knowledge, individual attributes, career experiences, and environmental influences. Each of these components can further be subdivided into several subcomponents. The result is a picture of leadership that encompasses a multitude of factors. Because it includes so many vari- ables, the skills approach can capture many of the intricacies and complexi- ties of leadership not found in other models.
Last, the skills approach provides a structure that is very consistent with the curricula of most leadership education programs. Leadership education pro- grams throughout the country have traditionally taught classes in creative problem solving, conflict resolution, listening, and teamwork, to name a few. The content of these classes closely mirrors many of the components in the skills model. Clearly, the skills approach provides a structure that helps to frame the curricula of leadership education and development programs.
criticiSMS _______________________________________
Like all other approaches to leadership, the skills approach also has certain weaknesses. First, the breadth of the skills approach seems to extend beyond the boundaries of leadership. For example, by including motivation, critical thinking, personality, and conflict resolution, the skills approach addresses more than just leadership. Another example of the model’s breadth is its inclusion of two types of intelligence (i.e., general cognitive ability and crys- tallized cognitive ability). Although both areas are studied widely in the field
chapter 3 Skills approach 59
of cognitive psychology, they are seldom addressed in leadership research. By including so many components, the skills model of Mumford and others becomes more general and less precise in explaining leadership performance.
Second, related to the first criticism, the skills model is weak in predictive value. It does not explain specifically how variations in social judgment skills and problem-solving skills affect performance. The model suggests that these components are related, but it does not describe with any precision just how that works. In short, the model can be faulted because it does not explain how skills lead to effective leadership performance.
In addition, the skills approach can be criticized for claiming not to be a trait model when, in fact, a major component in the model includes individual attributes, which are trait-like. Although Mumford and colleagues describe cognitive abilities, motivation, and personality variables as factors contribut- ing to competencies, these are also factors that are typically considered to be trait variables. The point is that the individual attributes component of the skills model is trait driven, and that shifts the model away from being strictly a skills approach to leadership.
The final criticism of the skills approach is that it may not be suitably or appropriately applied to other contexts of leadership. The skills model was constructed by using a large sample of military personnel and observing their performance in the armed services. This raises an obvious question: Can the results be generalized to other populations or organizational settings? Although some research suggests that these Army findings can be general- ized to other groups (Mumford, Zaccaro, Connelly, et al., 2000), more research is needed to address this criticism.
AppLicAtion _____________________________________
Despite its appeal to theorists and academics, the skills approach has not been widely used in applied leadership settings. For example, there are no training packages designed specifically to teach people leadership skills from this approach. Although many programs have been designed to teach leadership skills from a general self-help orientation, few of these programs are based on the conceptual frameworks set forth in this chapter.
Despite the lack of formal training programs, the skills approach offers valu- able information about leadership. The approach provides a way to delineate the skills of the leader, and leaders at all levels in an organization can use it.
Skills and Business intelligence
60 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
In addition, this approach helps us to identify our strengths and weaknesses in regard to these technical, human, and conceptual skills. By taking a skills inventory such as the one provided at the end of this chapter, people can gain further insight into their own leadership competencies. Their scores allow them to learn about areas in which they may want to seek further training to enhance their overall contributions to their organization.
From a wider perspective, the skills approach may be used in the future as a template for the design of extensive leadership development programs. This approach provides the evidence for teaching leaders the important aspects of listening, creative problem solving, conflict resolution skills, and much more.
cASe StUDieS
The following three case studies (Cases 3.1, 3.2, and 3.3) describe leader- ship situations that can be analyzed and evaluated from the skills perspec- tive. The first case involves the principal investigator of a federally funded research grant. The second case takes place in a military setting and describes how a lieutenant colonel handles the downsizing of a military base. In the third case, we learn about how the owner of an Italian restau- rant has created his own recipe for success.
As you read each case, try to apply the principles of the skills approach to the leaders and their situations. At the end of each case are questions that will assist you in analyzing the case.
Case 3.1
A Strained research team
dr. adam Wood is the principal investigator on a 3-year, $1 million feder- ally funded research grant to study health education programs for older populations, called the elder care project. Unlike previous projects, in which dr. Wood worked alone or with one or two other investigators, on this project dr. Wood has 11 colleagues. his project team is made up of two co-investigators (with phds), four intervention staff (with Mas), and five general staff members (with Bas). one year into the project, it has become apparent to dr. Wood and the team that the project is underbudgeted and has too few resources. Team members are spending 20%–30% more time on the project than has been budgeted to pay
Training Skills
chapter 3 Skills approach 61
them. regardless of the resource strain, all team members are committed to the project; they believe in its goals and the importance of its out- comes. dr. Wood is known throughout the country as the foremost scholar in this area of health education research. he is often asked to serve on national review and advisory boards. his publication record is second to none. in addition, his colleagues in the university know dr. Wood as a very competent researcher. people come to dr. Wood for advice on research design and methodology questions. They also come to him for questions about theoretical formulations. he has a reputation as someone who can see the big picture on research projects.
despite his research competence, there are problems on dr. Wood’s research team. dr. Wood worries there is a great deal of work to be done but that the members of the team are not devoting sufficient time to the elder care project. he is frustrated because many of the day-to-day research tasks of the project are falling into his lap. he enters a research meeting, throws his notebook down on the table, and says, “i wish i’d never taken this project on. it’s taking way too much of my time. The rest of you aren’t pulling your fair share.” Team members feel exasperated at dr. Wood’s comments. although they respect his competence, they find his leadership style frustrating. his negative comments at staff meet- ings are having a demoralizing effect on the research team. despite their hard work and devotion to the project, dr. Wood seldom compliments or praises their efforts. Team members believe that they have spent more time than anticipated on the project and have received less pay or credit than expected. The project is sucking away a lot of staff energy, yet dr. Wood does not seem to understand the pressures confronting his staff.
The research staff is starting to feel burned out, but members realize they need to keep trying because they are under time constraints from the federal government to do the work promised. The team needs to develop a pamphlet for the participants in the elder care project, but the pamphlet costs are significantly more than budgeted in the grant. dr. Wood has been very adept at finding out where they might find small pockets of money to help cover those costs.
although team members are pleased that he is able to obtain the money, they are sure he will use this as just another example of how he was the one doing most of the work on the project.
Questions
1. Based on the skills approach, how would you assess dr. Wood’s leader- ship and his relationship to the members of the elder care project team? Will the project be successful?
(Continued)
62 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
2. does dr. Wood have the skills necessary to be an effective leader of this research team?
3. The skills model describes three important competencies for leaders: problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge. if you were to coach dr. Wood using this model, what competencies would you address with him? What changes would you suggest that he make in his leadership?
Case 3.2
A Shift for Lieutenant colonel Adams
Lt. col. John adams was an aeronautical engineer in the air Force who was recognized as an accomplished officer; he rose quickly through the ranks of lieutenant, captain, and major. in addition, he successfully com- pleted a number of professional development courses in the air Force and received a master’s degree in engineering. in the earlier part of his service, his career assignments required overseeing 15- to 20-person shifts that were responsible for routine maintenance schedules for squadron and base aircraft. as he progressed in rank, he moved to engi- neering projects, which were supported by small technical staffs.
Based on his strong performance, Major adams was promoted to lieuten- ant colonel earlier than his peers. instead of moving him into another engineering position, the personnel bureau and his assignment officer decided that Lieutenant colonel adams would benefit from a tour in which he could expand his professional background and experience. consequently, he was assigned to Base X as the commanding officer of the administration branch. Base X was an airbase with approximately 5,000 military and civilian personnel.
as the administration officer, adams was the senior human resource officer and the principal adviser to the base commander on all human resource issues. adams and his staff of 135 civilian and military personnel were responsible for personnel issues, food services, recreation, family support, and medical services. in addition, Lieutenant colonel adams was assigned to chair the Labor–Management relations committee for the base.
at the end of the cold War, as part of the declared peace dividend, the government decided to reduce its defense budget. in February, barely 6 months after adams took over command of the administration branch, the federal government announced a significant reduction in the size of the military and the closure of many bases. Base X was to be closed as an air base and reassigned to the army. The closure was to take place within 1 year, and the base was to be prepared for the arrival of the first army troops in 2 years. as part of the reduction program, the federal
(continued)
chapter 3 Skills approach 63
government initiated voluntary retirement programs for civilian and military personnel. Those wanting to retire had until april 1 to decide.
orders for the conversion of the airbase included the following:
• The base will continue normal operations for 6 months. • The squadrons—complete with aircrews, equipment, and families
(1,000)—must be relocated to their new bases and operational by august 1.
• The remaining base personnel strength, both civilian and military, must be reduced by 30%.
• The base must continue to provide personnel for operational missions. • The reduction of personnel must be consistent with federal
voluntary early-retirement programs. • The base must be prepared with a support structure to accept 2,000
new soldiers, expected to arrive in 2 years.
adams was assigned to develop a human resource plan that would meet the imposed staff levels for the entire base while ensuring that the base was still able to perform the operational tasks it had been given. Faced with this daunting task, adams conducted an extensive review of all of the relevant orders concerning the base transformation, and he familiar- ized himself with all of the rules concerning the early-retirement pro- gram. after a series of initial meetings with the other base branch chiefs, he laid out a plan that could be accomplished by the established dead- lines. at the same time, he chaired a number of meetings with his own staff about how to meet the mandated reductions within his own branch.
after considering the target figures for the early-retirement program, it was clear that the mandated numbers could not be reached. Simply allowing everyone who had applied for early retirement to leave was not considered an option because doing so would devastate entire sec- tions of the base. More job cuts were required, and choices had to be made as to who would stay, why, and in what areas. adams met stiff resistance in the meetings to determine what sections would bear the brunt of the additional cutbacks.
adams conducted his own independent analysis of his own branch before consulting with his staff. Based on his thorough examination of the data, he mandated further reductions in his sections. Specifically targeted were personnel in base housing, single-person accommoda- tions, family services, and recreational sections. he also mandated a fur- ther 10% cut of military positions in his sections.
after meeting the mandated reduction targets, Lieutenant colonel adams was informed that the federal government would accept all personnel who applied for early retirement, which was an unexpected decision. When superimposed on the already mandated reductions, this move
(Continued)
64 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
caused critical shortages in key areas. Within weeks of implementation of the plan, the base commander was receiving mounting complaints from both civilian and military members over the implementation of the plan.
incidents of stress, frustration, and discontent rose dramatically. Families trying to move found support services cut back or nonexistent. Members of the transition staff were forced to work evenings and weekends. Family support services were swamped and asking for additional help.
despite spending a large amount of overtime trying to address the diverse issues both base-wide and within his branch, adams found him- self struggling to keep his head above water. To make matters worse, the base was having difficulty meeting its operational mission, and vital sec- tions were critically understaffed. The base commander wanted answers. When pressed, adams stated that his plan met all of the required dead- lines and targets, and the plan conformed to all of the guidelines of the early retirement programs. “Maybe so,” replied the base commander, “but you forgot about the bigger picture.”
Questions
1. Based on the skills model, how would you assess Lt. col. John adams’s ability to meet the challenges of the base administration position?
2. how would you assess his ability to meet the additional tasks he faced regarding the conversion of the base?
3. if you were to coach adams on how he could improve his leadership, what would you tell him?
Case 3.3
Andy’s recipe
andy Garafallo owns an italian restaurant that sits in the middle of a cornfield near a large Midwestern city. on the restaurant’s far wall is an elaborate mural of the canals of Venice. a gondola hangs on the oppo- site wall, up by the ceiling. along another wall is a row of real potted lemon trees. “My ancestors are from Sicily,” says andy. “in fact, i can remember seeing my grandfather take a bite out of a lemon, just like the ones hanging on those trees.”
andy is very confident about his approach to this restaurant, and he should be, because the restaurant is celebrating its 25th anniversary. “i’m darned sure of what i want to do. i’m not trying different fads to get people to come here. people come here because they know they will get great food. They also want to support someone with whom they can
(continued)
chapter 3 Skills approach 65
connect. This is my approach. nothing more, nothing less.” although other restaurants have folded, andy seems to have found a recipe for success.
Since opening his restaurant, andy has had a number of managers. currently, he has three: Kelly, danielle, and patrick. Kelly is a kitchen (food prep) manager who is known as very honest and dependable. She loves her work, and is efficient, good with ordering, and good with preparation. andy really likes Kelly but is frustrated with her because she has such dif- ficulty getting along with the salespeople, delivery people, and waitstaff.
danielle, who works out front in the restaurant, has been with andy the longest, 6 years. danielle likes working at Garafallo’s—she lives and breathes the place. She fully buys into andy’s approach of putting cus- tomers first. in fact, andy says she has a knack for knowing what custom- ers need even before they ask. although she is very hospitable, andy says she is lousy with numbers. She just doesn’t seem to catch on to that side of the business.
patrick, who has been with andy for 4 years, usually works out front but can work in the kitchen as well. although patrick has a strong work ethic and is great with numbers, he is weak on the people side. For some rea- son, patrick treats customers as if they are faceless, coming across as very unemotional. in addition, patrick tends to approach problems with an either–or perspective. This has gotten him into trouble on more than one occasion. andy wishes that patrick would learn to lighten up. “he’s a good manager, but he needs to recognize that some things just aren’t that important,” says andy.
andy’s approach to his managers is that of a teacher and coach. he is always trying to help them improve. he sees part of his responsibility as teaching them every aspect of the restaurant business. andy’s stated goal is that he wants his managers to be “a” players when they leave his business to take on jobs elsewhere. helping people to become the best they can be is andy’s goal for his restaurant employees.
although andy works 12 hours a day, he spends little time analyzing the numbers. he does not think about ways to improve his profit margin by cutting corners, raising an item price here, or cutting quality there. andy says, “it’s like this: The other night i got a call from someone who said they wanted to come in with a group and wondered if they could bring along a cake. i said ‘yes’ with one stipulation. . . . i get a piece! Well the people came and spent a lot of money. Then they told me that they had actually wanted to go to another restaurant but the other place would not allow them to bring in their own cake.” andy believes very strongly in his approach. “you get business by being what you should be.” compared with other restaurants, his restaurant is doing quite well. although many places are happy to net 5%–7% profit, andy’s italian restaurant nets 30% profit, year in and year out.
(Continued)
66 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
Questions
1. What accounts for andy’s success in the restaurant business?
2. From a skills perspective, how would you describe the three manag- ers, Kelly, danielle, and patrick? What does each of them need to do to improve his or her skills?
3. how would you describe andy’s competencies? does andy’s leader- ship suggest that one does not need all three skills in order to be effective?
LeADerSHip inStrUMent _________________________
Many questionnaires assess an individual’s skills for leadership. A quick search of the Internet provides a host of these questionnaires. Almost all of them are designed to be used in training and development to give people a feel for their leadership abilities. Surveys have been used for years to help people understand and improve their leadership style, but most question- naires are not used in research because they have not been tested for reli- ability and validity. Nevertheless, they are useful as self-help instruments because they provide specific information to people about their leadership skills.
In this chapter, we present a comprehensive skills model that is based on many empirical studies of leaders’ skills. Although the questionnaires used in these studies are highly reliable and are valid instruments, they are not suitable for our more pragmatic discussion of leadership in this text. In essence, they are too complex and involved. For example, Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al. (2000) used measures that included open-ended responses and very sophisticated scoring procedures. Though critically important for validating the model, these complicated measures are less valuable as self- instruction questionnaires.
A skills inventory is provided in the next section to assist you in understand- ing how leadership skills are measured and what your own skills might be. Your scores on the inventory will give you a sense of your own leadership competencies. You may be strong in all three skills, or you may be stronger in some skills than in others. The questionnaire will give you a sense of your own skills profile. If you are stronger in one skill and weaker in another, this may help you determine where you want to improve in the future.
(continued)
chapter 3 Skills approach 67
Skills inventory
Instructions: read each item carefully and decide whether the item describes you as a person. indicate your response to each item by circling one of the five numbers to the right of each item.
Key: 1 = not 2 = Seldom 3 = occasionally 4 = Somewhat 5 = Very true true true true true
1. i enjoy getting into the details of how things work. 1 2 3 4 5
2. as a rule, adapting ideas to people’s needs is easy for me. 1 2 3 4 5
3. i enjoy working with abstract ideas. 1 2 3 4 5
4. Technical things fascinate me. 1 2 3 4 5
5. Being able to understand others is the most important part of my work. 1 2 3 4 5
6. Seeing the big picture comes easy for me. 1 2 3 4 5
7. one of my skills is being good at making things work. 1 2 3 4 5
8. My main concern is to have a supportive communication climate. 1 2 3 4 5
9. i am intrigued by complex organizational problems. 1 2 3 4 5
10. Following directions and filling out forms comes easily for me. 1 2 3 4 5
11. Understanding the social fabric of the organization is important to me. 1 2 3 4 5
12. i would enjoy working out strategies for my organization’s growth. 1 2 3 4 5
13. i am good at completing the things i’ve been assigned to do. 1 2 3 4 5
14. Getting all parties to work together is a challenge i enjoy. 1 2 3 4 5
15. creating a mission statement is rewarding work. 1 2 3 4 5
16. i understand how to do the basic things required of me. 1 2 3 4 5
17. i am concerned with how my decisions affect the lives of others. 1 2 3 4 5
18. Thinking about organizational values and philosophy appeals to me. 1 2 3 4 5
Scoring
The skills inventory is designed to measure three broad types of leadership skills: technical, human, and conceptual. Score the questionnaire by doing
68 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
the following. First, sum the responses on items 1, 4, 7, 10, 13, and 16. This is your technical skill score. Second, sum the responses on items 2, 5, 8, 11, 14, and 17. This is your human skill score. Third, sum the responses on items 3, 6, 9, 12, 15, and 18. This is your conceptual skill score.
Total scores: Technical skill ____ human skill ____ conceptual skill ____
Scoring interpretation
23–30 high range
14–22 Moderate range
6–13 Low range
The scores you received on the skills inventory provide information about your leadership skills in three areas. By comparing the differences between your scores, you can determine where you have leadership strengths and where you have leadership weaknesses. your scores also point toward the level of management for which you might be most suited.
chapter 3 Skills approach 69
SUMMAry _______________________________________
The skills approach is a leader-centered perspective that emphasizes the competencies of leaders. It is best represented in the early work of Katz (1955) on the three-skill approach and the more recent work of Mumford and his colleagues (Mumford, Zaccaro, Harding, et al., 2000), who initiated the development of a comprehensive skills model of leadership.
In the three-skill approach, effective leadership depends on three basic per- sonal skills: technical, human, and conceptual. Although all three skills are important for leaders, the importance of each skill varies between manage- ment levels. At lower management levels, technical and human skills are most important. For middle managers, the three different skills are equally important. At upper management levels, conceptual and human skills are most important, and technical skills become less important. Leaders are more effective when their skills match their management level.
In the 1990s, the skills model was developed to explain the capabilities (knowledge and skills) that make effective leadership possible. Far more com- plex than Katz’s paradigm, this model delineated five components of effective leader performance: competencies, individual attributes, leadership outcomes, career experiences, and environmental influences. The leader competencies at the heart of the model are problem-solving skills, social judgment skills, and knowledge. These competencies are directly affected by the leader’s individual attributes, which include the leader’s general cognitive ability, crystallized cognitive ability, motivation, and personality. The leader’s competencies are also affected by his or her career experiences and the environment. The model postulates that effective problem solving and performance can be explained by the leader’s basic competencies and that these competencies are in turn affected by the leader’s attributes, experience, and environment.
There are several strengths in conceptualizing leadership from a skills per- spective. First, it is a leader-centered model that stresses the importance of the leader’s abilities, and it places learned skills at the center of effective leadership performance. Second, the skills approach describes leadership in such a way that it makes it available to everyone. Skills are competencies that we all can learn to develop and improve. Third, the skills approach provides a sophisticated map that explains how effective leadership performance can be achieved. Based on the model, researchers can develop complex plans for studying the leadership process. Last, this approach provides a structure for leadership education and development programs that include creative prob- lem solving, conflict resolution, listening, and teamwork.
In addition to the positive features, there are also some negative aspects to the skills approach. First, the breadth of the model seems to extend beyond the boundaries of leadership, including, for example, conflict management,
70 LeaderShip Theory and pracTice
critical thinking, motivation theory, and personality theory. Second, the skills model is weak in predictive value. It does not explain how a person’s compe- tencies lead to effective leadership performance.
Third, the skills model claims not to be a trait approach; nevertheless, indi- vidual traits such as cognitive abilities, motivation, and personality play a large role in the model. Finally, the skills model is weak in general applica- tion because it was constructed using data only from military personnel. Until the model has been tested with other populations, such as small and large organizations and businesses, its basic tenets must still be questioned.
Sharpen your skills with SaGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerenceS ______________________________________
Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass & Stogdill ’s handbook of leadership: Theory, research, and man- agerial application (3rd ed.). New York: Free Press.
Connelly, M. S., Gilbert, J. A., Zaccaro, S. J., Threlfall, K. V., Marks, M. A., & Mum- ford, M. D. (2000). Exploring the relationship of leadership skills and knowledge to leader performance. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 65–86.
Katz, R. L. (1955). Skills of an effective administrator. Harvard Business Review, 33(1), 33–42.
Mumford, M. D., & Connelly, M. S. (1991). Leaders as creators: Leader performance and problem solving in ill-defined domains. Leadership Quarterly, 2, 289–315.
Mumford, M. D., Zaccaro, S. J., Connelly, M. S., & Marks, M. A. (2000). Leadership skills: Conclusions and future directions. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 155–170.
Mumford, M. D., Zaccaro, S. J., Harding, F. D., Jacobs, T. O., & Fleishman, E. A. (2000). Leadership skills for a changing world: Solving complex social problems. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 11–35.
Mumford, T. V., Campion, M. A., & Morgeson, F. P. (2007). The leadership skills strataplex: Leadership skill requirements across organizational levels. Leadership Quarterly, 18, 154–166.
Yammarino, F. J. (2000). Leadership skills: Introduction and overview. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 5–9.
Zaccaro, S. J., Gilbert, J., Thor, K. K., & Mumford, M. D. (1991). Leadership and social intelligence: Linking social perceptiveness and behavioral flexibility to leader effectiveness. Leadership Quarterly, 2, 317–331.
Zaccaro, S. J., Mumford, M. D., Connelly, M. S., Marks, M. A., & Gilbert, J. A. (2000). Assessment of leader problem-solving capabilities. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 37–64.
4
Behavioral Approach
Description _____________________________________
The style approach emphasizes the behavior of the leader. This distinguishes it from the trait approach (Chapter 2), which emphasizes the personality characteristics of the leader, and the skills approach (Chapter 3), which emphasizes the leader’s capabilities. The behavioral approach focuses exclusively on what leaders do and how they act. In shifting the study of leadership to leader behaviors, the behavioral approach expanded the research of leadership to include the actions of leaders toward followers in various contexts.
Researchers studying the behavioral approach determined that leadership is composed of two general kinds of behaviors: task behaviors and relationship behaviors. Task behaviors facilitate goal accomplishment: They help group members to achieve their objectives. Relationship behaviors help followers feel comfortable with themselves, with each other, and with the situation in which they find themselves. The central purpose of the behavioral approach is to explain how leaders combine these two kinds of behaviors to influence followers in their efforts to reach a goal.
Many studies have been conducted to investigate the behavioral approach. Some of the first studies to be done were conducted at The Ohio State University in the late 1940s, based on the findings of Stogdill’s (1948) work, which pointed to the importance of considering more than leaders’ traits in leadership research. At about the same time, another group of researchers at the University of Michigan was conducting a series of studies that explored how leadership functioned in small groups. A third line of research was begun by Blake and Mouton in the early 1960s; it explored how managers used task and relationship behaviors in the organizational setting.
What is the Behavior Approach? Hip-Hop Leader Behaviors
72 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
Although many research studies could be categorized under the heading of the behavioral approach, the Ohio State studies, the Michigan studies, and the studies by Blake and Mouton (1964, 1978, 1985) are strongly representative of the ideas in this approach. By looking closely at each of these groups of studies, we can draw a clearer picture of the underpinnings and implications of the behavioral approach.
The Ohio State Studies
A group of researchers at Ohio State believed that the results of studying leadership as a personality trait seemed fruitless and decided to analyze how individuals acted when they were leading a group or an organization. This analysis was conducted by having followers complete questionnaires about their leaders. On the questionnaires, followers had to identify the number of times their leaders engaged in certain types of behaviors.
The original questionnaire used in these studies was constructed from a list of more than 1,800 items describing different aspects of leader behavior. From this long list of items, a questionnaire composed of 150 questions was formulated; it was called the Leader Behavior Description Questionnaire (LBDQ ; Hemphill & Coons, 1957). The LBDQ was given to hundreds of people in educational, military, and industrial settings, and the results showed that certain clusters of behaviors were typical of leaders. Six years later, Stogdill (1963) published a shortened version of the LBDQ . The new form, which was called the LBDQ-XII, became the most widely used instrument in leadership research. A questionnaire similar to the LBDQ , which you can use to assess your own leadership behavior, appears later in this chapter.
Researchers found that followers’ responses on the questionnaire clustered around two general types of leader behaviors: initiating structure and consideration (Stogdill, 1974). Initiating structure behaviors are essentially task behaviors, including such acts as organizing work, giving structure to the work context, defining role responsibilities, and scheduling work activities. Consideration behaviors are essentially relationship behaviors and include building camaraderie, respect, trust, and liking between leaders and followers.
The two types of behaviors identified by the LBDQ-XII represent the core of the behavioral approach and are central to what leaders do: Leaders provide structure for followers, and they nurture them. The Ohio State studies viewed these two behaviors as distinct and independent. They were thought of not as two points along a single continuum, but as two different
different Leadership Behaviors Leadership Behavior
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 73
continua. For example, a leader can be high in initiating structure and high or low in task behavior. Similarly, a leader can be low in setting structure and low or high in consideration behavior. The degree to which a leader exhibits one behavior is not related to the degree to which she or he exhibits the other behavior.
Many studies have been done to determine which leadership behavior is most effective in a particular situation. In some contexts, high consideration has been found to be most effective, but in other situations, high initiating structure is most effective. Some research has shown that being high in both behaviors is the best form of leadership. Determining how a leader optimally mixes task and relationship behaviors has been the central task for researchers from the behavioral approach. The path–goal approach, which is discussed in Chapter 6, exemplifies a leadership theory that attempts to explain how leaders should integrate consideration and structure into their behaviors.
The University of Michigan Studies
Whereas researchers at Ohio State were developing the LBDQ , researchers at the University of Michigan were also exploring leadership behavior, giving special attention to the impact of leaders’ behaviors on the performance of small groups (Cartwright & Zander, 1960; Katz & Kahn, 1951; Likert, 1961, 1967).
The program of research at Michigan identified two types of leadership behaviors: employee orientation and production orientation. Employee orientation is the behavior of leaders who approach subordinates with a strong human relations emphasis. They take an interest in workers as human beings, value their individuality, and give special attention to their personal needs (Bowers & Seashore, 1966). Employee orientation is very similar to the cluster of behaviors identified as consideration in the Ohio State studies.
Production orientation consists of leadership behaviors that stress the technical and production aspects of a job. From this orientation, workers are viewed as a means for getting work accomplished (Bowers & Seashore, 1966). Production orientation parallels the initiating structure cluster found in the Ohio State studies.
Unlike the Ohio State researchers, the Michigan researchers, in their initial studies, conceptualized employee and production orientations as opposite ends of a single continuum. This suggested that leaders who were oriented toward production were less oriented toward employees, and those who were
Aesthetic Leadership Behavior Approach: An example
74 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
employee oriented were less production oriented. As more studies were completed, however, the researchers reconceptualized the two constructs, as in the Ohio State studies, as two independent leadership orientations (Kahn, 1956). When the two behaviors are treated as independent orientations, leaders are seen as being able to be oriented toward both production and employees at the same time.
In the 1950s and 1960s, a multitude of studies were conducted by researchers from both Ohio State and the University of Michigan to determine how leaders could best combine their task and relationship behaviors to maximize the impact of these behaviors on the satisfaction and performance of followers. In essence, the researchers were looking for a universal theory of leadership that would explain leadership effectiveness in every situation. The results that emerged from this large body of literature were contradictory and unclear (Yukl, 1994). Although some of the findings pointed to the value of a leader being both highly task oriented and highly relationship oriented in all situations (Misumi, 1985), the preponderance of research in this area was inconclusive.
Blake and Mouton’s Managerial (Leadership) Grid
Perhaps the best known model of managerial behavior is the Managerial Grid, which first appeared in the early 1960s and has been refined and revised several times (Blake & McCanse, 1991; Blake & Mouton, 1964, 1978, 1985). It is a model that has been used extensively in organizational training and development. The Managerial Grid, which has been renamed the Leadership Grid, was designed to explain how leaders help organizations to reach their purposes through two factors: concern for production and concern for people. Although these factors are described as leadership orientations in the model, they closely parallel the task and relationship leadership behaviors we have been discussing throughout this chapter.
Concern for production refers to how a leader is concerned with achieving organizational tasks. It involves a wide range of activities, including attention to policy decisions, new product development, process issues, workload, and sales volume, to name a few. Not limited to an organization’s manufactured product or service, concern for production can refer to whatever the organization is seeking to accomplish (Blake & Mouton, 1964).
Concern for people refers to how a leader attends to the people in the organization who are trying to achieve its goals. This concern includes
Likeable Leaders
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 75
building organizational commitment and trust, promoting the personal worth of followers, providing good working conditions, maintaining a fair salary structure, and promoting good social relations (Blake & Mouton, 1964).
The Leadership (Managerial) Grid joins concern for production and concern for people in a model that has two intersecting axes (Figure 4.1). The horizontal axis represents the leader’s concern for results, and the vertical axis represents the leader’s concern for people. Each of the axes is drawn as a 9-point scale on which a score of 1 represents minimum concern and 9 represents maximum concern. By plotting scores from each of the axes, various leadership styles can be illustrated. The Leadership Grid portrays five major leadership styles: authority–compliance (9,1), country-club management (1,9), impoverished management (1,1), middle-of-the-road management (5,5), and team management (9,9).
Authority–compliance (9,1)
The 9,1 style of leadership places heavy emphasis on task and job requirements, and less emphasis on people, except to the extent that people are tools for getting the job done. Communicating with subordinates is not emphasized except for the purpose of giving instructions about the task. This style is result driven, and people are regarded as tools to that end. The 9,1 leader is often seen as controlling, demanding, hard driving, and overpowering.
country-club Management (1,9)
The 1,9 style represents a low concern for task accomplishment coupled with a high concern for interpersonal relationships. Deemphasizing production, 1,9 leaders stress the attitudes and feelings of people, making sure the personal and social needs of followers are met. They try to create a positive climate by being agreeable, eager to help, comforting, and uncontroversial.
impoverished Management (1,1)
The 1,1 style is representative of a leader who is unconcerned with both the task and interpersonal relationships. This type of leader goes through the motions of being a leader but acts uninvolved and withdrawn. The 1,1 leader
Leadership Trust
76 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
often has little contact with followers and could be described as indifferent, noncommittal, resigned, and apathetic.
Middle-of-the-road Management (5,5)
The 5,5 style describes leaders who are compromisers, who have an intermediate concern for the task and an intermediate concern for the people who do the task. They find a balance between taking people into account and still emphasizing the work requirements. Their compromising style
Figure 4.1 The Leadership Grid
High
Low
Low
1,1
Concern for Results High
1 98765432
9,1
5,5
1,9 9,9
Thoughtful attention to the needs of the people for satisfying relationships leads to a comfortable, friendly organization atmosphere and work tempo.
Middle-of-the-Road Management
Adequate organization performance is possible through balancing the necessity to get work out while maintaining
morale of people at a satisfactory level.
Exertion of minimum effort to get required work done as appropriate to sustain organization membership.
Efficiency in operations results from arranging conditions of work in such a
way that human elements interfere to a minimum degree.
Work accomplishment is from committed people. Interdependence
through a common stake in organization purpose leads to
relationships of trust and respect.
Co nc
er n
fo r
Pe op
le
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Country-Club Management Team Management
Impoverished Management Authority-Compliance Management
soUrce: The Leadership Grid© figure, paternalism figure, and opportunism figure from Leadership Dilemmas—Grid Solutions, by robert r. Blake and Anne Adams Mccanse. (Formerly the Managerial Grid by robert r. Blake and Jane s. Mouton.) Houston: Gulf publishing company (Grid figure: p. 29, paternalism figure: p. 30, opportunism figure: p. 31). copyright 1991 by scientific Methods, inc. reproduced by permission of the owners.
negative Leadership
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 77
gives up some of the push for production and some of the attention to employee needs. To arrive at an equilibrium, the 5,5 leader avoids conflict and emphasizes moderate levels of production and interpersonal relationships. This type of leader often is described as one who is expedient, prefers the middle ground, soft-pedals disagreement, and swallows convictions in the interest of “progress.”
team Management (9,9)
The 9,9 style places a strong emphasis on both tasks and interpersonal relationships. It promotes a high degree of participation and teamwork in the organization and satisfies a basic need in employees to be involved and committed to their work. The following are some of the phrases that could be used to describe the 9,9 leader: stimulates participation, acts determined, gets issues into the open, makes priorities clear, follows through, behaves open-mindedly, and enjoys working.
In addition to the five major styles described in the Leadership Grid, Blake and his colleagues have identified two other behaviors that incorporate multiple aspects of the grid.
Paternalism/Maternalism
Paternalism/maternalism refers to a leader who uses both 1,9 and 9,1 styles but does not integrate the two (Figure 4.2). This is the “benevolent dictator” who acts graciously but does so for the purpose of goal accomplishment. In essence, the paternalistic/maternalistic style treats people as if they were dissociated from the task. Paternalistic/maternalistic leaders are often described as “fatherly” or “motherly” toward their followers; regard the organization as a “family”; make most of the key decisions; and reward loyalty and obedience while punishing noncompliance.
Opportunism
Opportunism refers to a leader who uses any combination of the basic five styles for the purpose of personal advancement (Figure 4.3). An opportunistic leader will adapt and shift his or her leadership behavior to gain personal advantage, putting self-interest ahead of other priorities. Both the performance and the effort of the leader are to realize personal gain. Some phrases used to describe this leadership behavior include ruthless, cunning,
charisma paternalistic Leadership
78 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
and self-motivated, while some could argue that these types of leaders are adaptable and strategic.
Blake and Mouton (1985) indicated that people usually have a dominant grid style (which they use in most situations) and a backup style. The backup style is what the leader reverts to when under pressure, when the usual way of accomplishing things does not work.
In summary, the Leadership Grid is an example of a practical model of leadership that is based on the two major leadership behaviors: task and relationship. It closely parallels the ideas and findings that emerged in the Ohio State and University of Michigan studies. It is used in consulting for organizational development throughout the world.
How Does tHe BeHAviorAl ApproAcH work? _______________________________
Unlike many of the other approaches discussed in the book, the behavioral approach is not a refined theory that provides a neatly organized set of prescriptions for effective leadership behavior. Rather, the behavioral approach provides a framework for assessing leadership in a broad way, as behavior with a task and relationship dimension. The behavioral approach
Figure 4.2 paternalism/Maternalism
9
99
1
+
,
,9 1
soUrce: The Leadership Grid© figure, paternalism figure, and opportunism figure from Leadership Dilemmas—Grid Solutions, by robert r. Blake and Anne Adams Mccanse. (Formerly the Managerial Grid by robert r. Blake and Jane s. Mouton.) Houston: Gulf publishing company (Grid figure: p. 29, paternalism figure: p. 30, opportunism figure: p. 31). copyright 1991 by scientific Methods, inc. reproduced by permission of the owners.
perspectives on Leadership
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 79
works not by telling leaders how to behave, but by describing the major components of their behavior.
The behavioral approach reminds leaders that their actions toward others occur on a task level and a relationship level. In some situations, leaders need to be more task oriented, whereas in others they need to be more relationship oriented. Similarly, some followers need leaders who provide a lot of direction, whereas others need leaders who can show them a great deal of nurturance and support. The behavioral approach gives the leader a way to look at his or her own behavior by subdividing it into two dimensions.
An example may help explain how the behavioral approach works. Imagine two college classrooms on the first day of class and two professors with entirely different styles. Professor Smith comes to class, introduces herself, takes attendance, goes over the syllabus, explains the first assignment, and dismisses the class. Professor Jones comes to class and, after introducing herself and handing out the syllabus, tries to help the students to get to know one another by having each of the students describe a little about themselves, their majors, and their favorite nonacademic activities. The leadership behaviors of professors Smith and Jones are quite different. The preponderance of what Professor Smith does could be labeled task behavior, and the majority of what Professor Jones does could be labeled relationship
Figure 4.3 opportunism
Opportunism
1,9
1,1
5,5
9,1
9,9
, 9 1
1
9+9
9,
soUrce: The Leadership Grid© figure, paternalism figure, and opportunism figure from Leadership Dilemmas—Grid Solutions, by robert r. Blake and Anne Adams Mccanse. (Formerly the Managerial Grid by robert r. Blake and Jane s. Mouton.) Houston: Gulf publishing company (Grid figure: p. 29, paternalism figure: p. 30, opportunism figure: p. 31). copyright 1991 by scientific Methods, inc. reproduced by permission of the owners.
personal Leadership Behaviors
80 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
behavior. The behavioral approach provides a way to inform the professors about the differences in their behaviors. Depending on the response of the students to their leadership behaviors, the professors may want to change their behavior to improve their teaching on the first day of class.
Overall, the behavioral approach offers a means of assessing in a general way the behaviors of leaders. It reminds leaders that their impact on others occurs through the tasks they perform as well as in the relationships they create.
strengtHs ______________________________________
The behavioral approach makes several positive contributions to our understanding of the leadership process. First, the behavioral approach marked a major shift in the general focus of leadership research. Before the inception of this approach, researchers treated leadership exclusively as a trait (see Chapter 2). The behavioral approach broadened the scope of leadership research to include the behaviors of leaders and what they do in various situations. No longer was the focus of leadership on the personal characteristics of leaders: It was expanded to include what leaders did and how they acted.
Second, a wide range of studies on leadership behavior validates and gives credibility to the basic tenets of the approach. First formulated and reported by researchers from The Ohio State University and the University of Michigan, and subsequently reported in the works of Blake and Mouton (1964, 1978, 1985) and Blake and McCanse (1991), the behavioral approach is substantiated by a multitude of research studies that offer a viable approach to understanding the leadership process.
Third, on a conceptual level, researchers of the behavioral approach have ascertained that a leader’s style consists primarily of two major types of behaviors: task and relationship. The significance of this idea is not to be understated. Whenever leadership occurs, the leader is acting out both task and relationship behaviors; the key to being an effective leader often rests on how the leader balances these two behaviors. Together they form the core of the leadership process.
Fourth, the behavioral approach is heuristic. It provides us with a broad conceptual map that is worthwhile to use in our attempts to understand the complexities of leadership. Leaders can learn a lot about themselves and how they come across to others by trying to see their behaviors in light of the task and relationship dimensions. Based on the behavioral approach, leaders can
Leadership Theories
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 81
assess their actions and determine how they may want to change to improve their leadership behaviors.
criticisMs _______________________________________
Along with its strengths, the behavioral approach also has several weaknesses. First, the research on the behavioral approach has not adequately shown how leaders’ behaviors are associated with performance outcomes (Bryman, 1992; Yukl, 1994). Researchers have not been able to establish a consistent link between task and relationship behaviors and outcomes such as morale, job satisfaction, and productivity. According to Yukl (1994, p. 75), the “results from this massive research effort have been mostly contradictory and inconclusive.” He further pointed out that the only strong finding about leadership behaviors is that leaders who are considerate have followers who are more satisfied.
Another criticism is that this approach has failed to find a universal style of leadership that could be effective in almost every situation. The overarching goal for researchers studying the behavioral approach appeared to be the identification of a universal set of leadership behaviors that would consistently result in effective outcomes. Because of inconsistencies in the research findings, this goal was never reached. Similar to the trait approach, which was unable to identify the definitive personal characteristics of leaders, the behavioral approach has been unable to identify the universal behaviors that are associated with effective leadership.
A final criticism of the behavioral approach is that it implies that the most effective leadership style is the high–high style (i.e., high task and high relationship). Although some researchers (e.g., Blake & McCanse, 1991; Misumi, 1985) suggested that high–high managers are most effective, that may not be the case in all situations. In fact, the full range of research findings provides only limited support for a universal high–high style (Yukl, 1994). Certain situations may require different leadership styles; some may be complex and require high- task behavior, and others may be simple and require supportive behavior. At this point in the development of research on the behavioral approach, it remains unclear whether the high–high style is the best style of leadership.
ApplicAtion _____________________________________
The behavioral approach can be applied easily in ongoing leadership settings. At all levels in all types of organizations, managers are continually
college Graduate Behaviors Behavioral strategies
82 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
engaged in task and relationship behaviors. By assessing their own behaviors, managers can determine how they are coming across to others and how they could change their behaviors to be more effective. In essence, the behavioral approach provides a mirror for managers that is helpful in answering the frequently asked question, “How am I doing as a leader?”
Many leadership training and development programs throughout the country are structured along the lines of the behavioral approach. Almost all are designed similarly and include giving managers questionnaires that assess in some way their task and relationship behaviors toward followers. Participants use these assessments to improve their overall leadership behavior.
An example of a training and development program that deals exclusively with leader behaviors is Blake and Mouton’s Leadership Grid (formerly Managerial Grid) seminar. Grid seminars are about increasing productivity, improving morale, and gaining employee commitment. They are offered by Grid International, an international organization development company (www.gridinternational.com). At grid seminars, self-assessments, small- group experiences, and candid critiques allow managers to learn how to define effective leadership, how to manage for optimal results, and how to identify and change ineffective leadership behaviors. The conceptual framework around which the grid seminars are structured is the behavioral approach to leadership.
In short, the behavioral approach applies to nearly everything a leader does. It is an approach that is used as a model by many training and development companies to teach managers how to improve their effectiveness and organizational productivity.
cAse stUDies
In this section, you will find three case studies (Cases 4.1, 4.2, and 4.3) that describe the leadership behaviors of three different managers, each of whom is working in a different organizational setting. The first case is about a maintenance director in a large hospital, the second deals with a supervisor in a small sporting goods store, and the third is concerned with the director of marketing and communications at a college. At the end of each case are questions that will help you to analyze the case from the perspective of the style approach.
organic Leadership Behaviors
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 83
Case 4.1
A Drill sergeant at First
Mark young is the head of the painting department in a large hospital; 20 union employees report to him. Before coming on board at the hos- pital, he had worked as an independent contractor. At the hospital, he took a position that was newly created because the hospital believed change was needed in how painting services were provided.
Upon beginning his job, Mark did a 4-month analysis of the direct and indi- rect costs of painting services. His findings supported the perceptions of his administrators that painting services were inefficient and costly. As a result, Mark completely reorganized the department, designed a new scheduling procedure, and redefined the expected standards of performance.
Mark says that when he started out in his new job he was “all task,” like a drill sergeant who didn’t seek any input from his subordinates. From Mark’s point of view, the hospital environment did not leave much room for errors, so he needed to be strict about getting painters to do a good job within the constraints of the hospital environment.
As time went along, Mark relaxed his style and was less demanding. He delegated some responsibilities to two crew leaders who reported to him, but he always stayed in close touch with each of the employees. on a weekly basis, Mark was known to take small groups of workers to the local sports bar for burgers on the house. He loved to banter with the employees and could take it as well as dish it out.
Mark is very proud of his department. He says he always wanted to be a coach, and that’s how he feels about running his department. He enjoys working with people; in particular, he says he likes to see the glint in their eyes when they realize that they’ve done a good job and they have done it on their own.
Because of Mark’s leadership, the painting department has improved sub- stantially and is now seen by workers in other departments as the most productive department in hospital maintenance. painting services received a customer rating of 92%, which is the highest of any service in the hospital.
Questions
1. From the behavioral perspective, how would you describe Mark’s leadership?
2. How did his behavior change over time?
3. in general, do you think he is more task oriented or more relationship oriented?
4. What score do you think he would get on Blake and Mouton’s grid?
84 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
Case 4.2
eating lunch standing Up
susan parks is the part–owner and manager of Marathon sports, an ath- letic equipment store that specializes in running shoes and accessories. The store employs about 10 people, most of whom are college students who work part-time during the week and full-time on weekends. Marathon sports is the only store of its kind in a college town with a population of 125,000. The annual sales figures for the store have shown 15% growth each year.
susan has a lot invested in the store, and she works very hard to make sure the store continues to maintain its reputation and pattern of growth. she works 50 hours a week at the store, where she wears many hats, including those of buyer, scheduler, trainer, planner, and salesper- son. There is never a moment when susan is not doing something. rumor has it that she eats her lunch standing up.
employees’ reactions to susan are strong and varied. some people like her style, and others do not. Those who like her style talk about how organized and efficient the store is when she is in charge. susan makes the tasks and goals for everyone very clear. she keeps everyone busy; when they go home at night, they feel as if they have accomplished something. They like to work for susan because she knows what she is doing. Those who do not like her style complain that she is too driven. it seems that her sole purpose for being at the store is to get the job done. she seldom, if ever, takes a break or just hangs out with the staff. These people say susan is pretty hard to relate to, and as a result it is not much fun working at Marathon sports.
susan is beginning to sense that employees have a mixed reaction to her leadership style. This bothers her, but she does not know what to do about it. in addition to her work at the store, susan struggles hard to be a good spouse and mother of three children.
Questions
1. According to the behavioral approach, how would you describe susan’s leadership?
2. Why does her leadership behavior create such a pronounced reaction from her subordinates?
3. do you think she should change her behavior?
4. Would she be effective if she changed?
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 85
Case 4.3
we Are Family
Betsy Moore has been hired as the director of marketing and communi- cations for a medium-sized college in the Midwest. With a long history of success as a marketing and public relations professional, she was the unanimous choice of the hiring committee. Betsy is excited to be working for Marianne, the vice president of college advancement, who comes from a similar background to Betsy’s. in a meeting with Marianne, Betsy is told the college needs an aggressive plan to revamp and energize the school’s marketing and communications efforts. Betsy and Marianne seem in perfect sync with the direction they believe is right for the col- lege’s program. Marianne also explains that she has established a depart- mental culture of teamwork and empowerment and that she is a strong advocate of being a mentor to her subordinates rather than a manager.
Betsy has four direct reports: two writers, Bridget and suzanne, who are young women in their 20s; and carol and Francine, graphic designers who are in their 50s. in her first month, Betsy puts together a meeting with her direct reports to develop a new communications plan for the college, presenting the desired goals to the team and asking for their ideas on initiatives and improvements to meet those goals. Bridget and suzanne provide little in the way of suggested changes, with Bridget asking pointedly, “Why do we need to change anything?”
in her weekly meeting with the vice president, Betsy talks about the resistance to change she encountered from the team. Marianne nods, saying she heard some of the team members’ concerns when she went to lunch with them earlier in the week. When Betsy looks surprised, Marianne gives her a knowing smile. “We are like a family here; we have close relationships outside of work. i go to lunch or the movies with suzanne and Bridget at least once a week. But don’t worry; i am only a sounding board for them, and encourage them to come to you to resolve their issues. They know you are their boss.”
But they don’t come to Betsy. soon, Bridget stops coming to work at 8 a.m., showing up at 10 a.m. daily. As a result, she misses the weekly plan- ning meetings. When Betsy approaches her about it, Bridget tells her, “it’s oK with Marianne; she says as long as i am using the time to exercise and improve my health she supports it.”
Betsy meets with suzanne to implement some changes to suzanne’s pet project, the internal newsletter. suzanne gets blustery and tearful, accus- ing Betsy of insulting her work. Later, Betsy watches suzanne and Marianne leave the office together for lunch. A few hours later, Marianne
(Continued)
86 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
comes into Betsy’s office and tells her, “Go easy on the newsletter changes. suzanne is an insecure person, and she is feeling criticized and put down by you right now.”
Betsy’s relationship with the other two staff members is better. neither seems to have the close contact with Marianne that the younger team members have. They seem enthusiastic and supportive of the new direc- tion Betsy wants to take the program in.
As the weeks go by, Marianne begins having regular “Mentor Meetings” with Bridget and suzanne, going to lunch with both women at least twice a week. After watching the three walk out together one day, Francine asks Betsy if it troubles her. Betsy replies, as calmly as she can, “it is part of Marianne’s mentoring program.”
Francine rolls her eyes and says, “Marianne’s not mentoring anyone; she just wants someone to go to lunch with every day.”
After 4 months on the job, Betsy goes to Marianne and outlines the chal- lenges that the vice president’s close relationships with Bridget and suzanne have presented to the progress of the marketing and commu- nications program. she asks her directly, “please stop.”
Marianne gives her the knowing, motherly smile again. “i see a lot of potential in Bridget and suzanne and want to help foster that,” she explains. “They are still young in their careers, and my relationship with them is important because i can provide the mentoring and guidance to develop their abilities.”
“But it’s creating problems between them and me,” Betsy points out. “i can’t manage them if they can circumvent me every time they disagree with me. We aren’t getting any work done. you and i have to be on the same team.”
Marianne shakes her head. “The problem is that we have very different lead- ership styles. i like to empower people, and you like to boss them around.”
Questions
1. Marianne and Betsy do indeed have different leadership styles. What style would you ascribe to Betsy? To Marianne?
2. does Betsy need to change her leadership style to improve the situa- tion with Bridget and suzanne? does Marianne need to change her style of leadership?
3. How can Marianne and Betsy work together?
(continued)
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 87
leADersHip instrUMent _________________________
Researchers and practitioners alike have used many different instruments to assess the behaviors of leaders. The two most commonly used measures have been the LBDQ (Stogdill, 1963) and the Leadership Grid (Blake & McCanse, 1991). Both of these measures provide information about the degree to which a leader acts task directed or people directed. The LBDQ was designed primarily for research and has been used extensively since the 1960s. The Leadership Grid was designed primarily for training and development; it continues to be used today for training managers and supervisors in the leadership process.
To assist you in developing a better understanding of how leadership behaviors are measured and what your own behavior might be, a leadership behavior questionnaire is included in this section. This questionnaire is made up of 20 items that assess two orientations: task and relationship. By scoring the Leadership Behavior Questionnaire, you can obtain a general profile of your leadership behavior.
88 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
leadership Behavior Questionnaire
Instructions: read each item carefully and think about how often you (or the person you are evaluating) engage in the described behavior. indicate your response to each item by circling one of the five numbers to the right of each item.
Key: 1 = never 2 = seldom 3 = occasionally 4 = often 5 = Always
1. Tells group members what they are supposed to do. 1 2 3 4 5
2. Acts friendly with members of the group. 1 2 3 4 5
3. sets standards of performance for group members. 1 2 3 4 5
4. Helps others in the group feel comfortable. 1 2 3 4 5
5. Makes suggestions about how to solve problems. 1 2 3 4 5
6. responds favorably to suggestions made by others. 1 2 3 4 5
7. Makes his or her perspective clear to others. 1 2 3 4 5
8. Treats others fairly. 1 2 3 4 5
9. develops a plan of action for the group. 1 2 3 4 5
10. Behaves in a predictable manner toward group members. 1 2 3 4 5
11. defines role responsibilities for each group member. 1 2 3 4 5
12. communicates actively with group members. 1 2 3 4 5
13. clarifies his or her own role within the group. 1 2 3 4 5
14. shows concern for the well-being of others. 1 2 3 4 5
15. provides a plan for how the work is to be done. 1 2 3 4 5
16. shows flexibility in making decisions. 1 2 3 4 5
17. provides criteria for what is expected of the group. 1 2 3 4 5
18. discloses thoughts and feelings to group members. 1 2 3 4 5
19. encourages group members to do high-quality work. 1 2 3 4 5
20. Helps group members get along with each other. 1 2 3 4 5
scoring
The Leadership Behavior Questionnaire is designed to measure two major types of leadership behaviors: task and relationship. score the questionnaire by doing the following: First, sum the responses on the odd-numbered items. This is your task score. second, sum the responses on the even-numbered items. This is your relationship score.
Total scores: Task ______________ relationship ____________
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 89
scoring interpretation
45–50 Very high range
40–44 High range
35–39 Moderately high range
30–34 Moderately low range
25–29 Low range
10–24 Very low range
The score you receive for task refers to the degree to which you help others by defining their roles and letting them know what is expected of them. This factor describes your tendencies to be task directed toward others when you are in a leadership position. The score you receive for relationship is a measure of the degree to which you try to make subordinates feel comfortable with themselves, each other, and the group itself. it represents a measure of how people oriented you are.
your results on the Leadership Behavior Questionnaire give you data about your task orientation and people orientation. What do your scores suggest about your leadership style? Are you more likely to lead with an emphasis on task or with an emphasis on relationship? As you interpret your responses to the Leadership Behavior Questionnaire, ask yourself if there are ways you could change your behavior to shift the emphasis you give to tasks and rela- tionships. To gain more information about your style, you may want to have four or five of your coworkers fill out the questionnaire based on their per- ceptions of you as a leader. This will give you additional data to compare and contrast to your own scores about yourself.
90 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
sUMMAry _______________________________________
The behavioral approach is strikingly different from the trait and skills approaches to leadership because the behavioral approach focuses on what leaders do rather than who leaders are. It suggests that leaders engage in two primary types of behaviors: task behaviors and relationship behaviors. How leaders combine these two types of behaviors to influence others is the central focus of the behavioral approach.
The behavioral approach originated from three different lines of research: the Ohio State studies, the University of Michigan studies, and the work of Blake and Mouton on the Managerial Grid.
Researchers at Ohio State developed a leadership questionnaire called the Leader Behavior Description Questionnaire (LBDQ ), which identified initiation of structure and consideration as the core leadership behaviors. The Michigan studies provided similar findings but called the leader behaviors production orientation and employee orientation.
Using the Ohio State and Michigan studies as a basis, much research has been carried out to find the best way for leaders to combine task and relationship behaviors. The goal has been to find a universal set of leadership behaviors capable of explaining leadership effectiveness in every situation. The results from these efforts have not been conclusive, however. Researchers have had difficulty identifying one best style of leadership.
Blake and Mouton developed a practical model for training managers that described leadership behaviors along a grid with two axes: concern for results and concern for people. How leaders combine these orientations results in five major leadership styles: authority–compliance (9,1), country-club management (1,9), impoverished management (1,1), middle-of-the-road management (5,5), and team management (9,9).
The behavioral approach has several strengths and weaknesses. On the positive side, it has broadened the scope of leadership research to include the study of the behaviors of leaders rather than only their personal traits or characteristics. Second, it is a reliable approach because it is supported by a wide range of studies. Third, the behavioral approach is valuable because it underscores the importance of the two core dimensions of leadership behavior: task and relationship. Fourth, it has heuristic value in that it provides us with a broad conceptual map that is useful in gaining an understanding of our own leadership behaviors. On the negative side,
chapter 4 Behavioral Approach 91
researchers have not been able to associate the behaviors of leaders (task and relationship) with outcomes such as morale, job satisfaction, and productivity. In addition, researchers from the behavioral approach have not been able to identify a universal set of leadership behaviors that would consistently result in effective leadership. Last, the behavioral approach implies but fails to support fully the idea that the most effective leadership style is a high–high style (i.e., high task and high relationship).
Overall, the behavioral approach is not a refined theory that provides a neatly organized set of prescriptions for effective leadership behavior. Rather, the behavioral approach provides a valuable framework for assessing leadership in a broad way as assessing behavior with task and relationship dimensions. Finally, the behavioral approach reminds leaders that their impact on others occurs along both dimensions.
sharpen your skills with sAGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerences ______________________________________
Blake, R. R., & McCanse, A. A. (1991). Leadership dilemmas: Grid solutions. Houston, TX: Gulf Publishing Company.
Blake, R. R., & Mouton, J. S. (1964). The Managerial Grid. Houston, TX: Gulf Publishing Company.
Blake, R. R., & Mouton, J. S. (1978). The new Managerial Grid. Houston, TX: Gulf Publishing Company.
Blake, R. R., & Mouton, J. S. (1985). The Managerial Grid III. Houston, TX: Gulf Publishing Company.
Bowers, D. G., & Seashore, S. E. (1966). Predicting organizational effectiveness with a four-factor theory of leadership. Administrative Science Quarterly, 11, 238–263.
Bryman, A. (1992). Charisma and leadership in organizations. London: SAGE. Cartwright, D., & Zander, A. (1960). Group dynamics research and theory. Evanston,
IL: Row, Peterson. Hemphill, J. K., & Coons, A. E. (1957). Development of the Leader Behavior
Description Questionnaire. In R. M. Stogdill & A. E. Coons (Eds.), Leader behavior: Its description and measurement (Research Monograph No. 88). Columbus: Ohio State University, Bureau of Business Research.
Kahn, R. L. (1956). The prediction of productivity. Journal of Social Issues, 12, 41–49. Katz, D., & Kahn, R. L. (1951). Human organization and worker motivation. In
L. R. Tripp (Ed.), Industrial productivity (pp. 146–171). Madison, WI: Industrial Relations Research Association.
Likert, R. (1961). New patterns of management. New York: McGraw-Hill.
92 LeAdersHip THeory And prAcTice
Likert, R. (1967). The human organization: Its management and value. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Misumi, J. (1985). The behavioral science of leadership: An interdisciplinary Japanese research program. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.
Stogdill, R. M. (1948). Personal factors associated with leadership: A survey of the literature. Journal of Psychology, 25, 35–71.
Stogdill, R. M. (1963). Manual for the Leader Behavior Description Questionnaire form XII. Columbus: Ohio State University, Bureau of Business Research.
Stogdill, R. M. (1974). Handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York: Free Press.
Yukl, G. (1994). Leadership in organizations (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
5
Situational Approach
DeScription _____________________________________
One of the more widely recognized approaches to leadership is the situa- tional approach, which was developed by Hersey and Blanchard (1969a) based on Reddin’s (1967) 3-D management style theory. The situational approach has been refined and revised several times since its inception (see Blanchard, Zigarmi, & Nelson, 1993; Blanchard, Zigarmi, & Zigarmi, 1985; Hersey & Blanchard, 1977, 1988), and it has been used extensively in organizational leadership training and development.
As the name of the approach implies, the situational approach focuses on leadership in situations. The premise of the theory is that different situations demand different kinds of leadership. From this perspective, to be an effec- tive leader requires that a person adapt his or her style to the demands of different situations.
The situational approach is illustrated in the model developed by Blanchard (1985) and Blanchard et al. (1985; 2013), called the Situational Leadership II (SLII) model (Figure 5.1). The model is an extension and refinement of the original model developed by Hersey and Blanchard (1969a). This chapter focuses on the SLII model.
The situational approach stresses that leadership is composed of both a directive and a supportive dimension, and that each has to be applied appro- priately in a given situation. To determine what is needed in a particular situation, a leader must evaluate her or his followers and assess how compe- tent and committed they are to perform a given goal. Based on the assump- tion that followers’ skills and motivation vary over time, situational leadership
Situational Leadership Creating Compelling Vision
94 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
suggests that leaders should change the degree to which they are directive or supportive to meet the changing needs of followers.
In brief, the essence of the situational approach demands that leaders match their style to the competence and commitment of the followers. Effective leaders are those who can recognize what followers need and then adapt their own style to meet those needs.
The dynamics of this approach are clearly illustrated in the SLII model which is comprised of two major dimensions: leadership style and development level of followers.
Leadership Styles
Leadership style consists of the behavior pattern of a person who attempts to influence others. It includes both directive behaviors and supportive behaviors. Directive behaviors help group members accomplish goals by giving directions, establishing goals and methods of evaluation, setting timelines, defining roles, and showing how the goals are to be achieved. Directive behaviors clarify, often with one-way communication, what is to be done, how it is to be done, and who is responsible for doing it. Supportive behaviors help group members feel com- fortable about themselves, their coworkers, and the situation. Supportive behav- iors involve two-way communication and responses that show social and emotional support to others. Examples of supportive behaviors include asking for input, solving problems, praising, sharing information about oneself, and listening. Supportive behaviors are mostly job related.
Leadership styles can be classified further into four distinct categories of directive and supportive behaviors (see Figure 5.1). The first style (S1) is a high directive–low supportive style, which is also called a directing style. In this approach, the leader focuses communication on goal achievement, and spends a smaller amount of time using supportive behaviors. Using this style, a leader gives instructions about what and how goals are to be achieved by the followers and then supervises them carefully.
The second style (S2) is called a coaching approach and is a high directive– high supportive style. In this approach, the leader focuses communication on both achieving goals and meeting followers’ socioemotional needs. The coaching style requires that the leader involve himself or herself with follow- ers by giving encouragement and soliciting follower input. However, coach- ing is an extension of S1 in that it still requires that the leader make the final decision on the what and how of goal accomplishment.
Ken Blanchard Cultural Situational Leadership
Chapter 5 Situational approach 95
Style 3 (S3) is a supporting approach that requires that the leader take a high supportive–low directive style. In this approach, the leader does not focus exclu- sively on goals but uses supportive behaviors that bring out followers’ skills around the goal to be accomplished. The supportive style includes listening, praising, asking for input, and giving feedback. A leader using this style gives followers control of day-to-day decisions but remains available to facilitate problem solving. An S3 leader is quick to give recognition and social support to followers.
Last, S4 is called the low supportive–low directive style, or a delegating approach. In this approach, the leader offers less goal input and social support, facilitating followers’ confidence and motivation in reference to the goal. The delegative
adjusting Behavioral Style
Figure 5.1 Situational Leadership ii
SoUrCe: From Leadership and the One Minute Manager: Increasing Effectiveness Through
Situational Leadership II, by K. Blanchard, p. Zigarmi, and d. Zigarmi, 2013, new york: William Morrow. Used with permission. This model cannot be used without the expressed, written consent of The Ken Blanchard Companies. To learn more, visit http://www .kenblanchard.com/
Leadership Styles
High Directive and
High Supportive Behavior
High Directive and Low Supportive Behavior
S1S4
DIRECTIVE BEHAVIOR
SU PP
O RT
IV E
BE H
AV IO
R
HIGH
D1 Low
Competence
High Commitment
D2 Low to Some Competence
Low Commitment
D3 Moderate to High
Competence
Variable Commitment
D4 High
Competence
High Commitment
DEVELOPINGDEVELOPED Development Levels
HIGH
LOW
S3 S2
High Supportive and Low Directive Behavior
Low Supportive and
Low Directive Behavior
DEL EG
AT IN
G
SU PP
OR TIN
G COACHING
DIRECTING
Task Leadership
96 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
leader lessens involvement in planning, control of details, and goal clarification. After the group agrees on what it is to do, this style lets followers take responsi- bility for getting the job done the way they see fit. A leader using S4 gives control to followers and refrains from intervening with unnecessary social support.
The SLII model (see Figure 5.1) illustrates how directive and supportive leadership behaviors combine for each of the four different leadership styles. As shown by the arrows on the bottom and left side of the model, directive behaviors are high in the S1 and S2 quadrants and low in S3 and S4, whereas supportive behaviors are high in S2 and S3 and low in S1 and S4.
Development Levels
A second major part of the SLII model concerns the development level of followers. Development level is the degree to which followers have the com- petence and commitment necessary to accomplish a given goal or activity (Blanchard et al., 1985). Stated another way, it indicates whether a person has mastered the skills to achieve a specific goal and whether a person has devel- oped a positive attitude regarding the goal (Blanchard et al., 1993). Followers are at a high development level if they are interested and confident in their work and know how to achieve the goal. Followers are at a developing level if they have little skill for the goal at hand but believe that they have the motiva- tion or confidence to get the job done.
The levels of development are illustrated in the lower portion of the diagram in Figure 5.1. The levels describe various combinations of commitment and competence for followers on a given goal. They are intended to be goal specific and are not intended to be used for the purpose of labeling followers.
On a particular goal, followers can be classified into four categories: D1, D2, D3, and D4, from developing to developed. Specifically, D1 followers are low in competence and high in commitment. They are new to a goal and do not know exactly how to do it, but they are excited about the challenge of it. D2 followers are described as having some competence but low commit- ment. They have started to learn a job, but they also have lost some of their initial motivation about the job. D3 represents followers who have moderate to high competence but may have variable commitment. They have essen- tially developed the skills for the job, but they are uncertain as to whether they can accomplish the goal by themselves. Finally, D4 followers are the highest in development, having both a high degree of competence and a high degree of commitment to getting the job done. They have the skills to do the job and the motivation to get it done.
The Situational approach decisional involvement
Chapter 5 Situational approach 97
How DoeS tHe SituAtionAl ApproAcH work? _______________________________
The situational approach is constructed around the idea that followers move forward and backward along the developmental continuum, which represents the relative competence and commitment of followers. For lead- ers to be effective, it is essential that they determine where followers are on the developmental continuum and adapt their leadership styles so they directly match their style to that development level.
In a given situation, the first task for a leader is to determine the nature of the situation. Questions such as the following must be addressed: What goal are followers being asked to achieve? How complex is the goal? Are the followers sufficiently skilled to accomplish the goal? Do they have the desire to complete the job once they start it? Answers to these questions will help leaders to identify correctly the specific developmental level at which their followers are functioning. For example, new followers who are very excited but lack under- standing of job requirements would be identified as D1-level followers. Conversely, seasoned followers with proven abilities and great devotion to an organization would be identified as functioning at the D4 level.
Having identified the correct development level, the second task for the leader is to adapt his or her style to the prescribed leadership style repre- sented in the SLII model. There is a one-to-one relationship between the development level of followers (D1, D2, etc.) and the leader’s style (S1, S2, etc.). For example, if followers are at the first level of development, D1, the leader needs to adopt a high-directive and low-supportive leadership style (S1, or directing). If followers are more advanced and at the second develop- ment level, D2, the leader needs to adopt a high directive–high supportive leadership style (S2, or coaching). For each level of development, there is a specific style of leadership that the leader should adopt.
An example of this would be Rene Martinez, who owns a house painting business. Rene specializes in restoration of old homes and over 30 years has acquired extensive knowledge of the specialized abilities required including understanding old construction, painting materials and techniques, plaster repair, carpentry, and window glazing. Rene has three employees: Ashley, who has worked for him for seven years and whom he trained from the beginning of her career; Levi, who worked for a commercial painter for four years before being hired by Rene two years ago; and Anton, who is just starting out.
Because of Ashley’s years of experience and training, Rene would classify her as primarily D3. She is very competent, but still seeks Rene’s insight on some
More on the Situational approach Leadership programs
98 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
tasks. She is completely comfortable prepping surfaces for painting and directing the others, but has some reluctance to taking on jobs that involve carpentry. Depending on the work he assigns Ashley, Rene moves between S3 (supporting) and S4 (delegating) leadership behaviors.
When it comes to painting, Levi is a developed follower needing little direc- tion or support from Rene. But Levi has to be trained in many other aspects of home restoration, making him a D1 or D2 in those skills. Levi is a quick learner, and Rene finds he only needs to be shown or told how to do some- thing once before he is able to complete it easily. In most situations, Rene uses an S2 (coaching) leadership behavior with Levi. If the goal is more compli- cated and requires detailed training, Rene moves back into the S1 (directing) behavior with Levi.
Anton is completely new to this field, developing his skills but at the D1 level. What he lacks in experience he more than makes up for in energy. He is always willing to jump in and do whatever he’s asked to do. He is not as careful as he needs to be, however, often neglecting the proper prepping techniques and cleanup about which Rene is a stickler. Rene finds that not only he, but also Ashley, uses an S1 (directing) behavior with Anton. Because Levi is also fairly new, he finds it difficult to be directive with Anton, but likes to give him help when he seems unsure of himself, falling in to the S3 (supporting) behavior.
This example illustrates how followers can move back and forth along the development continuum, requiring leaders to be flexible in their leadership behavior. Followers may move from one development level to another rather quickly over a short period (e.g., a day or a week), or more slowly on goals that proceed over much longer periods of time (e.g., a month). Leaders can- not use the same style in all contexts; rather, they need to adapt their style to followers and their unique situations. Unlike the trait and contingency approaches, which advocate a fixed style for leaders, the situational approach demands that leaders demonstrate a high degree of flexibility.
StrengtHS ______________________________________
The situational approach to leadership has several strengths, particularly for practitioners. The first strength is that it has a history of usefulness in the marketplace. Situational Leadership is well known and frequently used for training leaders within organizations. Hersey and Blanchard (1993) reported that it has been a factor in training programs of more than 400 of the Fortune 500 companies. It is perceived by corporations as offering a useful model for training people to become effective leaders.
Situational Leadership in practice
Chapter 5 Situational approach 99
A second strength of the approach is its practicality. Situational Leadership is easy to understand, intuitively sensible, and easily applied in a variety of set- tings. Whereas some leadership approaches provide complex and sophisticated ways to assess your own leadership behavior (e.g., the decision-making approach in Vroom & Yetton, 1973), Situational Leadership provides a straightforward approach that is easily used. Because it is described at an abstract level that is easily grasped, the ideas behind the approach are quickly acquired. In addition, the principles suggested by this approach are easy to apply across a variety of settings, including work, school, and family.
Closely akin to the strength of practicality is a third strength: it has prescrip- tive value. Whereas many theories of leadership are descriptive in nature, the situational approach is prescriptive. It tells you what you should and should not do in various contexts. For example, if your followers are very low in competence, Situational Leadership prescribes a directing style for you as the leader. On the other hand, if your followers appear to be competent but lack confidence, the situational approach suggests that you lead with a sup- porting style. These prescriptions provide leaders with a valuable set of guide- lines that can facilitate and enhance leadership.
A fourth strength of Situational Leadership is that it emphasizes leader flexibility (Graeff, 1983; Yukl, 1989). The approach stresses that leaders need to find out about their followers’ needs and then adapt their leader- ship style accordingly. Leaders cannot lead using a single style: They must be willing to change their style to meet the requirements of the situation. This approach recognizes that followers act differently when doing differ- ent goals, and that they may act differently during different stages of the same goal. Effective leaders are those who can change their own style based on the goal requirements and the followers’ needs, even in the mid- dle of a project.
Finally, Situational Leadership reminds us to treat each follower differently based on the goal at hand and to seek opportunities to help followers learn new skills and become more confident in their work (Fernandez & Vecchio, 1997; Yukl, 1998). Overall, this approach underscores that followers have unique needs and deserve our help in trying to become better at doing their work.
criticiSmS _______________________________________
Despite its history of use in leadership training and development, Situational Leadership has several limitations. The following criticisms point out
Creative Leadership Leader effectiveness
100 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
several weaknesses in this approach and help to provide a more balanced picture of the general utility of this approach in studying and practicing leadership.
The first criticism of Situational Leadership is that only a few research stud- ies have been conducted to justify the assumptions and propositions set forth by the approach. Although many doctoral dissertations address dimensions of Situational Leadership, most of these research studies have not been published. The lack of a strong body of research on this approach raises ques- tions about the theoretical basis of the approach (Fernandez & Vecchio, 1997; Graeff, 1997; Vecchio & Boatwright, 2002; Vecchio, Bullis, & Brazil, 2006). Can we be sure it is a valid approach? Is it certain that this approach does indeed improve performance? Does this approach compare favorably with other leadership approaches in its impact on followers? It is difficult to give firm answers to these questions when the testing of this approach has not resulted in a significant amount of published research findings.
A second criticism that can be directed at the situational approach concerns the ambiguous conceptualization in the model of followers’ development levels. The authors of the model do not make clear how commitment is combined with competence to form four distinct levels of development (Graeff, 1997; Yukl, 1989). In one of the earliest versions of the model, Hersey and Blanchard (1969b) defined the four levels of commitment (maturity) as unwilling and unable (Level 1), willing and unable (Level 2), unwilling and able (Level 3), and willing and able (Level 4). In a more recent version, represented by the SLII model, development level is described as high commitment and low competence in D1, low commitment and some competence in D2, variable commitment and high competence in D3, and high commitment and high competence in D4.
The authors of Situational Leadership do not explain the theoretical basis for these changes in the composition of each of the development levels. Further- more, they do not explain how competence and commitment are weighted across different development levels. As pointed out by Blanchard et al. (1993), there is a need for further research to establish how competence and commit- ment are conceptualized for each development level. Closely related to the general criticism of ambiguity about followers’ development levels is a concern with how commitment itself is conceptualized in the model. For example, Graeff (1997) suggested the conceptualization is very unclear. Blanchard et al. (1985) stated that followers’ commitment is composed of confidence and motivation, but it is not clear how confidence and motivation combine to define commitment. According to the SLII model, commitment starts out
Situational Leadership Theory
Chapter 5 Situational approach 101
high in D1, moves down in D2, becomes variable in D3, and rises again in D4. Intuitively, it appears more logical to describe follower commitment as existing on a continuum moving from low to moderate to high.
The argument provided by Blanchard et al. (1993) for how commitment varies in the SLII model is that followers usually start out motivated and eager to learn, and then they may become discouraged and disillusioned. Next, they may begin to lack confidence or motivation, or both, and last they become highly confident and motivated. But why is this so? Why do follow- ers who learn a task become less committed? Why is there a decrease in commitment at Development Levels 2 and 3? Without research findings to substantiate the way follower commitment is conceptualized, this dimension of Situational Leadership remains unclear.
A fourth criticism of the situational approach has to do with how the model matches leader style with follower development levels—the prescriptions of the model. To determine the validity of the prescriptions suggested by the Hersey and Blanchard approach, Vecchio (1987) conducted a study of more than 300 high school teachers and their principals. He found that newly hired teachers were more satisfied and performed better under principals who had highly structured leadership styles, but that the performance of more experienced and mature teachers was unrelated to the style their prin- cipals exhibited.
Vecchio and his colleagues have replicated this study twice: first in 1997, using university employees (Fernandez & Vecchio, 1997), and most recently in 2006, studying more than 800 U.S. Military Academy cadets (Vecchio et al., 2006). Both studies failed to find strong evidence to support the basic prescriptions suggested in the situational approach.
To further test the assumptions and validity of the Situational Leadership model, Thompson and Vecchio (2009) analyzed the original and revised versions of the model using data collected from 357 banking employees and 80 supervisors. They found no clear empirical support for the model in any of its versions. At best, they found some evidence to support leaders being more directive with newer employees, and being more supportive and less directive as employees become more senior.
A fifth criticism of Situational Leadership is that it fails to account for how certain demographic characteristics (e.g., education, experience, age, and gender) influence the leader–follower prescriptions of the model. For exam- ple, a study conducted by Vecchio and Boatwright (2002) showed that level of education and job experience were inversely related to directive leadership
102 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
and were not related to supportive leadership. In other words, followers with more education and more work experience desired less structure. An inter- esting finding is that age was positively related to desire for structure: The older followers desired more structure than the younger followers did. In addition, their findings indicated that female and male followers had differ- ent preferences for styles of leadership. Female followers expressed a stronger preference for supportive leadership, whereas male followers had a stronger desire for directive leadership. These findings indicate that demographic characteristics may affect followers’ preferences for a particular leadership style. However, these characteristics are not considered in the Situational Leadership approach.
Situational Leadership can also be criticized from a practical standpoint because it does not fully address the issue of one-to-one versus group leader- ship in an organizational setting. For example, should a leader with a group of 20 followers lead by matching her or his style to the overall development level of the group or to the development level of individual members of the group? Carew, Parisi-Carew, and Blanchard (1990) suggested that groups go through development stages that are similar to individuals’, and that therefore leaders should try to match their styles to the group’s development level. However, if the leader matches her or his style to the mean development level of a group, how will this affect the individuals whose development levels are quite different from those of their colleagues? Existing research on Situa- tional Leadership does not answer this question. More research is needed to explain how leaders can adapt their styles simultaneously to the development levels of individual group members and to the group as a whole.
A final criticism of Situational Leadership can be directed at the leadership questionnaires that accompany the model. Questionnaires on the situational approach typically ask respondents to analyze various work situations and select the best leadership style for each situation. The questionnaires are constructed to force respondents to describe leadership style in terms of four specific parameters (i.e., directing, coaching, supporting, and delegating) rather than in terms of other leadership behaviors. Because the best answers available to respondents have been predetermined, the questionnaires are biased in favor of Situational Leadership (Graeff, 1983; Yukl, 1989).
ApplicAtion _____________________________________
As we discussed earlier in this chapter, Situational Leadership is used in consulting because it is an approach that is easy to conceptualize and apply.
practice of Corporate hiring
Chapter 5 Situational approach 103
The straightforward nature of Situational Leadership makes it practical for managers to use.
The principles of this approach can be applied at many different levels in an organization. They can apply to how a CEO of a large corporation works with a board of directors, and they can also apply to how a crew chief in an assembly plant leads a small group of production workers. Mid- dle managers can use Situational Leadership to direct staff meetings, and heads of departments can use this approach in planning structural changes within an organization. There is no shortage of opportunities for using Situational Leadership.
Situational Leadership applies during the initial stages of a project, when idea formation is important, and during the various subsequent phases of a project, when implementation issues are important. The fluid nature of situ- ational Leadership makes it ideal for applying to followers as they move forward or go backward (regress) on various projects. Because Situational Leadership stresses adapting to followers, it is ideal for use with followers whose commitment and competence change over the course of a project.
Given the breadth of the situational approach, it is applicable in almost any type of organization, at any level, for nearly all types of goals. It is an encompassing model with a wide range of applications.
cASe StuDieS
To see how Situational Leadership can be applied in different organiza- tional settings, you may want to assess Cases 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3. For each of these cases, ask yourself what you would do if you found yourself in a simi- lar situation. At the end of each case, there are questions that will help you analyze the context from the perspective of Situational Leadership.
Case 5.1
marathon runners at Different levels
david abruzzo is the newly elected president of the Metrocity Striders Track Club (MSTC). one of his duties is to serve as the coach for runners
emergency Situations
(Continued)
104 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
who hope to complete the new york City Marathon. Because david has run many marathons and ultramarathons successfully, he feels quite com- fortable assuming the role and responsibilities of coach for the marathon runners.
The training period for runners intending to run new york is 16 weeks. during the first couple of weeks of training, david was pleased with the progress of the runners and had little difficulty in his role as coach. however, when the runners reached Week 8, the halfway mark, some things began to occur that raised questions in david’s mind regarding how best to help his runners. The issues of concern seemed quite differ- ent from those that david had expected to hear from runners in a mar- athon-training program. all in all, the runners and their concerns could be divided into three different groups.
one group of runners, most of whom had never run a marathon, pep- pered the coach with all kinds of questions. They were very concerned about how to do the marathon and whether they had the ability to complete such a challenging event successfully. They asked questions about how far to run in training, what to eat, how much to drink, and what kind of shoes to wear. one runner wanted to know what to eat the night before the marathon, and another wanted to know whether it was likely that he would pass out when he crossed the finish line. For david the questions were never-ending and rather basic. he wanted to treat the runners like informed adults, but they seemed to be acting imma- ture, and rather childish.
The second group of runners, all of whom had finished the new york City Marathon in the previous year, seemed most concerned about the effects of training on their running. For example, they wanted to know precisely how their per-week running mileage related to their possible marathon finishing time. Would running long practice runs help them through the wall at the 20-mile mark? Would taking a rest day during training actually help their overall conditioning? Basically, the runners in this group seemed to want assurances from david that they were train- ing in the right way for new york. For david, talking to this group was easy because he enjoyed giving them encouragement and motivational pep talks.
a third group was made up of seasoned runners, most of whom had run several marathons and many of whom had finished in the top 10 of their respective age divisions. Sometimes they complained of feeling flat and acted a bit moody and down about training. even though they had con- fidence in their ability to compete and finish well, they lacked an ele- ment of excitement about running in the new york event. The occasional
(Continued)
Chapter 5 Situational approach 105
questions they raised usually concerned such things as whether their overall training strategy was appropriate or whether their training would help them in other races besides the new york City Marathon. Because of his running experience, david liked to offer running tips to this group. however, when he did, he felt like the runners ignored and discounted his suggestions. he was concerned that they may not appre- ciate him or his coaching.
Questions
1. Based on the principles of the SLii model, how would you describe the runners in Group 1? What kind of leadership do they want from david, and what kind of leadership does david seem prepared to give them?
2. how would you describe the fit between the runners in Group 2 and david’s coaching style? discuss.
3. The experienced runners in Group 3 appear to be a challenge to david. Using SLii, explain why david appears ineffective with this group.
4. if you were helping david with his coaching, how would you describe his strengths and weaknesses? What suggestions would you make to him about how to improve?
Case 5.2
why Aren’t they listening?
Jim anderson is a training specialist in the human resource department of a large pharmaceutical company. in response to a recent company- wide survey, Jim specifically designed a 6-week training program on lis- tening and communication skills to encourage effective management in the company. Jim’s goals for the seminar are twofold: for participants to learn new communication behaviors and for participants to enjoy the seminar so they will want to attend future seminars.
The first group to be offered the program was middle-level managers in research and development. This group consisted of about 25 people, nearly all of whom had advanced degrees. Most of this group had attended several in-house training programs in the past, so they had a
(Continued)
106 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
sense of how the seminar would be designed and run. Because the previous seminars had not always been very productive, many of the managers felt a little disillusioned about coming to the seminar. as one of the managers said, “here we go again: a fancy in-house training program from which we will gain nothing.”
Because Jim recognized that the managers were very experienced, he did not put many restrictions on attendance and participation. he used a variety of presentation methods and actively solicited involvement from the managers in the seminar. Throughout the first two sessions, he went out of his way to be friendly with the group. he gave them fre- quent coffee breaks during the sessions; during these breaks, he pro- moted socializing and networking.
during the third session, Jim became aware of some difficulties with the seminar. rather than the full complement of 25 managers, attendance had dropped to about only 15 managers. although the starting time was established at 8:30, attendees had been arriving as late as 10:00. during the afternoon sessions, some of the managers were leaving the sessions to return to their offices at the company.
as he approached the fourth session, Jim was apprehensive about why things had been going poorly. he had become quite uncertain about how he should approach the group. Many questions were running through his mind: had he treated the managers in the wrong way? had he been too easy regarding attendance at the sessions? Should he have said something about the managers skipping out in the afternoon? Were the participants taking the seminar seriously? Jim was certain that the content of the seminars was innovative and substantive, but he could not figure out what he could change to make the program more successful. he sensed that his style was not working for this group, but he didn’t have a clue as to how he should change what he was doing to make the sessions better.
Questions
1. according to the SLii model (see Figure 5.1), what style of leadership is Jim using to run the seminars?
2. at what level are the managers?
3. From a leadership perspective, what is Jim doing wrong?
4. What specific changes could Jim implement to improve the seminars?
(Continued)
Chapter 5 Situational approach 107
Case 5.3
getting the message Across
ann Caldera is the program director of a college campus radio station (WCBa) that is supported by the university. WCBa has a long history and is viewed favorably by students, faculty, the board of trustees, and the people in the community.
ann does not have a problem getting students to work at WCBa. in fact, it is one of the most sought-after university-related activities. The few stu- dents who are accepted to work at WCBa are always highly motivated because they value the opportunity to get hands-on media experience. in addition, those who are accepted tend to be highly confident (sometimes naïvely so) of their own radio ability. despite their eagerness, most of them lack a full understanding of the legal responsibilities of being on the air.
one of the biggest problems that confronts ann every semester is how to train new students to follow the rules and procedures of WCBa when they are doing on-air announcing for news, sports, music, and other radio programs. it seems as if every semester numerous incidents arise in which an announcer violates in no small way the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) rules for appropriate airtime communication. For example, rumor has it that one year a first-year student disc jockey on the evening shift announced that a new band was playing in town, the cover was $10, and everyone should go to hear the group. Making an announcement such as this is a clear violation of FCC rules: it is illegal.
ann is frustrated with her predicament but cannot seem to figure out why it keeps occurring. She puts a lot of time and effort into helping new dJs, but they just do not seem to get the message that working at WCBa is a serious job and that obeying the FCC rules is an absolute necessity. ann wonders whether her leadership style is missing the mark.
each semester, ann gives the students a very complete handout on poli- cies and procedures. in addition, she tries to get to know each of the new students personally. Because she wants everybody to be happy at WCBa, she tries very hard to build a relational climate at the station. repeatedly, students say that ann is the nicest adviser on campus. Because she rec- ognizes the quality of her students, ann mostly lets them do what they want at the station.
Questions
1. What’s the problem at WCBa?
(Continued)
108 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
2. Using SLii as a basis, what would you advise ann to do differently at the station?
3. Based on Situational Leadership, what creative schemes could ann use to reduce FCC infractions at WCBa?
leADerSHip inStrument _________________________
Although different versions of instruments have been developed to mea- sure Situational Leadership, nearly all of them are constructed similarly. As a rule, the questionnaires provide 12 to 20 work-related situations and ask respondents to select their preferred style for each situation from four alternatives. The situations and styles are written to directly represent the leadership styles of the four quadrants in the model. Questionnaire responses are scored to give respondents information about their primary and secondary leadership styles, their flexibility, and their leadership effectiveness.
The brief questionnaire provided in this section illustrates how leadership style is measured in questionnaires of Situational Leadership. For each situation on the questionnaire, you have to identify the development level of the followers in the situation and then select one of the four response alternatives that indicate the style of leadership you would use in that situation.
Expanded versions of the brief questionnaire give respondents an overall profile of their leadership style. By analyzing the alternatives a respondent makes on the questionnaire, one can determine that respondent’s primary and secondary leadership styles. By analyzing the range of choices a respon- dent makes, one can determine that respondent’s leadership flexibility. Lead- ership effectiveness and diagnostic ability can be measured by analyzing the number of times the respondent made accurate assessments of a preferred leadership style.
In addition to these self-scored questionnaires, Situational Leadership uses similar forms to tap the concurrent perceptions that bosses, associates, and followers have of a person’s leadership style. These questionnaires give respondents a wide range of feedback on their leadership styles and the opportunity to compare their own views of leadership with the way others view them in a leadership role.
(Continued)
Chapter 5 Situational approach 109
Situational leadership Questionnaire: Sample items
Instructions: Look at the following four leadership situations and indicate what the development level is in each situation, which leadership style each response represents, and which leadership style is needed in the situation (i.e., action a, B, C, or d).
Situation 1
Because of budget restrictions imposed on your department, it is necessary to consolidate. you are thinking of asking a highly capable and experi- enced member of your department to take charge of the consolidation. This person has worked in all areas of your department and has the trust and respect of most of the staff. She is very willing to help with the consolidation.
a. assign the project to her and let her determine how to accomplish it.
B. assign the task to her, indicate to her precisely what must be done, and supervise her work closely.
C. assign the task to her and provide support and encouragement as needed.
d. assign the task to her and indicate to her precisely what needs to be done but make sure you incorporate her suggestions.
development level ____________ action ____________
Situation 2
you have recently been made a department head of the new regional office. in getting to know your departmental staff, you have noticed that one of your inexperienced employees is not following through on assigned tasks. She is enthusiastic about her new job and wants to get ahead in the organization.
a. discuss the lack of follow-through with her and explore the alternative ways this problem can be solved.
B. Specify what she must do to complete the tasks but incorporate any sug- gestions she may have.
C. define the steps necessary for her to complete the assigned tasks and monitor her performance frequently.
d. Let her know about the lack of follow-through and give her more time to improve her performance.
development level ____________ action ___________
110 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
Situation 3
Because of a new and very important unit project, for the past 3 months you have made sure that your staff members understood their responsibilities and expected level of performance, and you have supervised them closely. due to some recent project setbacks, your staff members have become somewhat discouraged. Their morale has dropped, and so has their performance.
a. Continue to direct and closely supervise their performance.
B. Give the group members more time to overcome the setbacks but occa- sionally check their progress.
C. Continue to define group activities but involve the group members more in decision making and incorporate their ideas.
d. participate in the group members’ problem-solving activities and encour- age and support their efforts to overcome the project setbacks.
development level ____________ action ____________
Situation 4
as a director of the sales department, you have asked a member of your staff to take charge of a new sales campaign. you have worked with this person on other sales campaigns, and you know he has the job knowledge and expe- rience to be successful at new assignments. however, he seems a little unsure about his ability to do the job.
a. assign the new sales campaign to him and let him function on his own.
B. Set goals and objectives for this new assignment but consider his sugges- tions and involve him in decision making.
C. Listen to his concerns but assure him he can do the job and support his efforts.
d. Tell him exactly what the new campaign involves and what you expect of him, and supervise his performance closely.
development level ____________ action ____________
SoUrCe: adapted from Game Plan for Leadership and the One Minute Manager (Figure 5.20, Learning activity, p. 5), by K. Blanchard, p. Zigarmi, and d. Zigarmi, 1992, escondido, Ca: Blanchard Training and development (phone 760-489-5005). Used with permission.
Scoring Interpretation
a short discussion of the correct answers to the brief questionnaire will help to explain the nature of Situational Leadership questionnaires.
Chapter 5 Situational approach 111
Situation 1 in the brief questionnaire describes a common problem faced by organizations during downsizing: the need to consolidate. in this particular situation, the leader has identified a person to direct the downsizing project who appears to be highly competent, experienced, and motivated. according to the SLii model, this person is at developmental Level 4, which calls for a delegative approach. of the four response alternatives, it is the (a) response, “assign the project to her and let her determine how to accomplish it,” that best represents delegating (S4): low supportive–low directive leadership.
Situation 2 describes a problem familiar to leaders at all levels in nearly all organizations: lack of follow-through by an enthusiastic follower. in the given example, the follower falls in developmental Level 1 because she lacks the experience to do the job even though she is highly motivated to succeed. The SLii approach prescribes directing (S1) leadership for this type of follower. She needs to be told when and how to do her specific job. after she is given directions, her performance should be supervised closely. The correct response is (C), “define the steps necessary to complete the assigned tasks and monitor her performance frequently.”
Situation 3 describes a very different circumstance. in this situation, the fol- lowers seem to have developed some experience and an understanding of what is required of them, but they have lost some of their motivation to complete the goal. Their performance and commitment have stalled because of recent setbacks, even though the leader has been directing them closely. according to SLii, the correct response for the leader is to shift to a more supportive coaching style (S2) of leadership. The action response that reflects coaching is (C), “Continue to define group activities but involve the group members more in decision making and incorporate their ideas.”
Situation 4 describes some of the concerns that arise for a director attempting to identify the correct person to head a new sales campaign. The person iden- tified for the position obviously has the skills necessary to do a good job with the new sales campaign, but he appears apprehensive about his own abilities. in this context, SLii suggests that the director should use a supportive style (S3), which is consistent with leading followers who are competent but lacking a certain degree of confidence. a supportive style is represented by action response (C), “Listen to his concerns but assure him he can do the job and support his efforts.”
now select two of your own followers. diagnose their current development level on three different goals and your style of leadership in each situation. is there a match? if not, what specifically can you do for them as a leader to ensure that they have what they need to succeed?
112 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
SummAry _______________________________________
Situational Leadership is a prescriptive approach to leadership that sug- gests how leaders can become effective in many different types of organiza- tional settings involving a wide variety of organizational goals. This approach provides a model that suggests to leaders how they should behave based on the demands of a particular situation.
Situational Leadership II classifies leadership into four styles: S1 is high directive–low supportive, S2 is high directive–high supportive, S3 is low directive–high supportive, and S4 is low directive–low supportive. The model describes how each of the four leadership styles applies to followers who work at different levels of development, from D1 (low in competence and high in commitment), to D2 (low to some competence and low in com- mitment), to D3 (moderately competent but lacking commitment), to D4 (a great deal of competence and a high degree of commitment).
Effective leadership occurs when the leader can accurately diagnose the development level of followers in a goal situation and then exhibit the pre- scribed leadership style that matches that situation.
Leadership is measured in this approach with questionnaires that ask respondents to assess a series of work-related situations. The question- naires provide information about the leader’s diagnostic ability, flexibility, and effectiveness. They are useful in helping leaders to learn about how they can change their leadership style to become more effective across different situations.
There are four major strengths to the situational approach. First, it is recog- nized by many as a standard for training leaders. Second, it is a practical approach, which is easily understood and easily applied. Third, this approach sets forth a clear set of prescriptions for how leaders should act if they want to enhance their leadership effectiveness. Fourth, Situational Leadership recognizes and stresses that there is not one best style of leadership; instead, leaders need to be flexible and adapt their style to the requirements of the situation.
Criticisms of Situational Leadership suggest that it also has limitations. Unlike many other leadership theories, this approach does not have a strong body of research findings to justify and support the theoretical underpin- nings on which it stands. As a result, there is ambiguity regarding how the approach conceptualizes certain aspects of leadership. It is not clear in explaining how followers move from developing levels to developed levels,
Chapter 5 Situational approach 113
nor is it clear on how commitment changes over time for followers. Without the basic research findings, the validity of the basic prescriptions for match- ing leaders’ styles to followers’ development levels must be questioned. In addition, the model does not address how demographic characteristics affect followers’ preferences for leadership. Finally, the model does not provide guidelines for how leaders can use this approach in group settings as opposed to one-to-one contexts.
Sharpen your skills with SaGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerenceS ______________________________________
Blanchard, K. H. (1985). SLII: A situational approach to managing people. Escondido, CA: Blanchard Training and Development.
Blanchard, K., Zigarmi, D., & Nelson, R. (1993). Situational Leadership after 25 years: A retrospective. Journal of Leadership Studies, 1(1), 22–36.
Blanchard, K., Zigarmi, P., & Zigarmi, D. (2013). Leadership and the one minute manager: Increasing effectiveness through Situational Leadership II. New York: William Morrow.
Blanchard, K., Zigarmi, P., & Zigarmi, D. (1992). Game plan for leadership and the one minute manager. Escondido, CA: Blanchard Training and Development.
Carew, P., Parisi-Carew, E., & Blanchard, K. H. (1990). Group development and Situational Leadership II. Escondido, CA: Blanchard Training and Development.
Fernandez, C. F., & Vecchio, R. P. (1997). Situational Leadership theory revisited: A test of an across-jobs perspective. Leadership Quarterly, 8(1), 67–84.
Graeff, C. L. (1983). The Situational Leadership theory: A critical view. Academy of Management Review, 8, 285–291.
Graeff, C. L. (1997). Evolution of Situational Leadership theory: A critical review. Leadership Quarterly, 8(2), 153–170.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1969a). Life-cycle theory of leadership. Training and Development Journal, 23, 26–34.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1969b). Management of organizational behavior: Utilizing human resources. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1977). Management of organizational behavior: Utilizing human resources (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1988). Management of organizational behavior: Utilizing human resources (5th ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1993). Management of organizational behavior: Utilizing human resources (6th ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Reddin, W. J. (1967, April). The 3-D management style theory. Training and Development Journal, pp. 8–17.
114 LeaderShip Theory and praCTiCe
Thompson, G., & Vecchio, R. P. (2009). Situational Leadership theory: A test of three versions. Leadership Quarterly, 20, 837–848.
Vecchio, R. P. (1987). Situational Leadership theory: An examination of a prescriptive theory. Journal of Applied Psychology, 72(3), 444–451.
Vecchio, R. P., & Boatwright, K. J. (2002). Preferences for idealized style of supervision. Leadership Quarterly, 13, 327–342.
Vecchio, R. P., Bullis, R. C., & Brazil, D. M. (2006). The utility of Situational Leadership theory: A replication in a military setting. Small Group Leadership, 37, 407–424.
Vroom, V. H., & Yetton, P. W. (1973). Leadership and decision-making. Pittsburgh, PA: University of Pittsburgh Press.
Yukl, G. A. (1989). Leadership in organizations (2nd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Yukl, G. A. (1998). Leadership in organizations (4th ed.). Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice Hall.
6
Path–Goal Theory
DescriPTion
Path–goal theory is about how leaders motivate followers to accomplish designated goals. Drawing heavily from research on what motivates follow- ers, path–goal theory first appeared in the leadership literature in the early 1970s in the works of Evans (1970), House (1971), House and Dessler (1974), and House and Mitchell (1974). The stated goal of this leadership theory is to enhance follower performance and follower satisfaction by focusing on follower motivation.
In contrast to the situational approach, which suggests that a leader must adapt to the development level of followers (see Chapter 5), path–goal theory emphasizes the relationship between the leader’s style and the char- acteristics of the followers and the organizational setting. For the leader, the imperative is to use a leadership style that best meets followers’ motivational needs. This is done by choosing behaviors that complement or supplement what is missing in the work setting. Leaders try to enhance followers’ goal attainment by providing information or rewards in the work environment (Indvik, 1986); leaders provide followers with the elements they think fol- lowers need to reach their goals.
According to House and Mitchell (1974), leadership generates motivation when it increases the number and kinds of payoffs that followers receive from their work. Leadership also motivates when it makes the path to the goal clear and easy to travel through coaching and direction, removing obstacles and roadblocks to attaining the goal, and making the work itself more personally satisfying (Figure 6.1).
Path-Goal Theory
116 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
Followers Goal(s) (Productivity)
Path–Goal Leadership
• Defines goals • Clarifies path • Removes obstacles • Provides support
Path Path
Obstacle(s)
Figure 6.1 The Basic idea Behind Path–Goal Theory
In brief, path–goal theory is designed to explain how leaders can help fol- lowers along the path to their goals by selecting specific behaviors that are best suited to followers’ needs and to the situation in which followers are working. By choosing the appropriate style, leaders increase followers’ expec- tations for success and satisfaction.
Within path-goal theory, motivation is conceptualized from the perspective of the expectancy theory of motivation (Vroom, 1964). The underlying assumption of expectancy theory is that followers will be motivated if they think they are capable of performing their work, if they believe their efforts will result in a certain outcome, and if they believe that the payoffs for doing their work are worthwhile. The challenge for a leader using ideas from expectancy theory is to understand fully the goals of each follower and the rewards associated with the goals. Followers want to feel efficacious, like they can accomplish what they set out to do. But, they also want to know that they will be rewarded if they can accomplish their work. A leader needs to find out what is rewarding to followers about their work and then make those rewards available to them when they accomplish the requirements of their work. Expectancy theory is about the goals that followers choose and how leaders help them and reward them for meeting those goals.
Conceptually, path–goal theory is complex. It is useful to break it down into smaller units so we can better understand the complexities of this approach.
Figure 6.2 illustrates the different components of path–goal theory, includ- ing leader behaviors, follower characteristics, task characteristics, and moti- vation. Path–goal theory suggests that each type of leader behavior has a different kind of impact on followers’ motivation. Whether a particular leader behavior is motivating to followers is contingent on the followers’ characteristics and the characteristics of the task.
Motivation is contagious Path-Goal Theory
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 117
Figure 6.2 Major components of Path–Goal Theory
Followers Goal(s) (Productivity)
Task Characteristics
Follower Characteristics
Motivation
Directive Supportive
Participative Achievement oriented
Leader Behaviors
Leader Behaviors
Although many different leadership behaviors could have been selected to be a part of path–goal theory, this approach has so far examined directive, supportive, participative, and achievement-oriented leadership behaviors (House & Mitchell, 1974, p. 83). Path–goal theory is explicitly left open to the inclusion of other variables.
Directive Leadership
Directive leadership is similar to the “initiating structure” concept described in the Ohio State studies (Halpin & Winer, 1957) and the “telling” style described in Situational Leadership. It characterizes a leader who gives followers instructions about their task, including what is expected of them, how it is to be done, and the timeline for when it should be completed. A directive leader sets clear standards of performance and makes the rules and regulations clear to followers.
supportive Leadership
Supportive leadership resembles the consideration behavior construct that was identified by the Ohio State studies discussed in Chapter 4. Supportive leadership consists of being friendly and approachable as a leader and
steve Jobs hope and Leadership
118 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
includes attending to the well-being and human needs of followers. Leaders using supportive behaviors go out of their way to make work pleasant for followers. In addition, supportive leaders treat followers as equals and give them respect for their status.
Participative Leadership
Participative leadership consists of inviting followers to share in the decision making. A participative leader consults with followers, obtains their ideas and opinions, and integrates their suggestions into the decisions about how the group or organization will proceed.
Achievement-oriented Leadership
Achievement-oriented leadership is characterized by a leader who chal- lenges followers to perform work at the highest level possible. This leader establishes a high standard of excellence for followers and seeks continuous improvement. In addition to expecting a lot from followers, achievement- oriented leaders show a high degree of confidence that followers are capable of establishing and accomplishing challenging goals.
House and Mitchell (1974) suggested that leaders might exhibit any or all of these four styles with various followers and in different situations. Path–goal theory is not a trait approach that locks leaders into only one kind of leader- ship. Leaders should adapt their styles to the situation or to the motivational needs of their followers. For example, if followers need participative leader- ship at one point in a task and directive leadership at another, the leader can change her or his style as needed. Different situations may call for different types of leadership behavior. Furthermore, there may be instances when it is appropriate for a leader to use more than one style at the same time.
In addition to leader behaviors, Figure 6.2 illustrates two other major com- ponents of path–goal theory: follower characteristics and task characteristics. Each of these two sets of characteristics influences the way leaders’ behaviors affect follower motivation. In other words, the impact of leadership is contingent on the characteristics of both followers and their task.
Follower Characteristics
Follower characteristics determine how a leader’s behavior is interpreted by followers in a given work context. Researchers have focused on followers’
Followers as individuals
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 119
needs for aff iliation, preferences for structure, desires for control, and self- perceived level of task ability. These characteristics and many others deter- mine the degree to which followers find the behavior of a leader an immediate source of satisfaction or instrumental to some future satisfaction.
Path–goal theory predicts that followers who have strong needs for affiliation prefer supportive leadership because friendly and concerned leadership is a source of satisfaction. For followers who are dogmatic and authoritarian and have to work in uncertain situations, path–goal theory suggests directive lead- ership because that provides psychological structure and task clarity. Directive leadership helps these followers by clarifying the path to the goal, making it less ambiguous. The authoritarian type of follower feels more comfortable when the leader provides a greater sense of certainty in the work setting.
Followers’ desires for control have received special attention in path–goal research through studies of a personality construct locus of control that can be subdivided into internal and external dimensions. Followers with an internal locus of control believe that they are in charge of the events that occur in their life, whereas those with an external locus of control believe that chance, fate, or outside forces determine life events. Path–goal theory suggests that for followers with an internal locus of control participative leadership is most satisfying because it allows them to feel in charge of their work and to be an integral part of decision making. For followers with an external locus of control, path–goal theory suggests that directive leadership is best because it parallels followers’ feelings that outside forces control their circumstances.
Another way in which leadership affects follower motivation is the followers’ perceptions of their own abilities to perform a specific task. As followers’ percep- tions of their abilities and competence goes up, the need for directive leader- ship goes down. In effect, directive leadership becomes redundant and perhaps excessively controlling when followers feel competent to complete their own work.
Task Characteristics
In addition to follower characteristics, task characteristics also have a major impact on the way a leader’s behavior influences followers’ motivation (see Figure 6.2). Task characteristics include the design of the follower’s task, the formal authority system of the organization, and the primary work group of followers. Collectively, these characteristics in themselves can provide moti- vation for followers. When a situation provides a clearly structured task, strong group norms, and an established authority system, followers will find
Path-Goal Leadership Motivating Volunteers
120 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
the paths to desired goals apparent and will not need a leader to clarify goals or coach them in how to reach these goals. Followers will feel as if they can accomplish their work and that their work is of value. Leadership in these types of contexts could be seen as unnecessary, unempathic, and excessively controlling.
In some situations, however, the task characteristics may call for leadership involvement. Tasks that are unclear and ambiguous call for leadership input that provides structure. In addition, highly repetitive tasks call for leadership that gives support in order to maintain followers’ motivation. In work set- tings where the formal authority system is weak, leadership becomes a tool that helps followers by making the rules and work requirements clear. In contexts where the group norms are weak or nonsupportive, leadership assists in building cohesiveness and role responsibility.
A special focus of path–goal theory is helping followers overcome obstacles. Obstacles could be just about anything in the work setting that gets in the way of followers. Specifically, obstacles create excessive uncertainties, frus- trations, or threats for followers. In these settings, path–goal theory suggests that it is the leader’s responsibility to help followers by removing these obstacles or helping them around them. Helping followers around these obstacles will increase followers’ expectations that they can complete the task and increase their sense of job satisfaction.
In 1996, House published a reformulated path–goal theory that extends his original work to include eight classes of leadership behaviors. Besides the four leadership behaviors discussed previously in this chapter—(a) directive, (b) supportive, (c) participative, and (d) achievement-oriented behavior—the new theory adds (e) work facilitation, (f ) group-oriented decision process, (g) work-group representation and networking, and (h) value-based leader- ship behavior. The essence of the new theory is the same as the original: To be effective, leaders need to help followers by giving them what is missing in their environment and by helping them compensate for deficiencies in their abilities.
How Does PATH–GoAL THeory work?
Path–goal theory is an approach to leadership that is not only theoretically complex, but also pragmatic. In theory, it provides a set of assumptions about how various leadership styles interact with characteristics of followers and the work setting to affect the motivation of followers. In practice, the theory
Motivation in Work settings role-Play exercise
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 121
Table 6.1 Path–Goal Theory: how it Works
Leadership Behavior Follower Characteristics Task Characteristics
Directive Provides guidance and psychological structure
dogmatic authoritarian
ambiguous Unclear rules complex
supportive Provides nurturance
Unsatisfied need affiliation need human touch
repetitive Unchallenging Mundane
Participative Provides involvement
autonomous need for control need for clarity
ambiguous Unclear Unstructured
Achievement oriented Provides challenges
high expectations need to excel
ambiguous challenging complex
provides direction about how leaders can help followers to accomplish their work in a satisfactory manner. Table 6.1 illustrates how leadership behaviors are related to follower and task characteristics in path–goal theory.
Theoretically, the path–goal approach suggests that leaders need to choose a leadership style that best fits the needs of followers and the work they are doing. The theory predicts that a directive style of leadership is best in situations in which followers are dogmatic and authoritarian, the task demands are ambiguous, the organizational rules are unclear, and the task is complex. In these situations, directive leadership complements the work by providing guidance and psychological structure for followers (House & Mitchell, 1974, p. 90).
For tasks that are structured, unsatisfying, or frustrating, path–goal theory suggests that leaders should use a supportive style. The supportive style pro- vides what is missing by nurturing followers when they are engaged in tasks that are repetitive and unchallenging. Supportive leadership offers a sense of human touch for followers engaged in mundane, mechanized activity.
Participative leadership is considered best when a task is ambiguous: Participation gives greater clarity to how certain paths lead to certain goals, and helps followers learn what leads to what (House & Mitchell, 1974, p. 92).
Motivation and rewards Goal orientation
122 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
In addition, participative leadership has a positive impact when followers are autonomous and have a strong need for control because this kind of follower responds favorably to being involved in decision making and in the structuring of work.
Furthermore, path–goal theory predicts that achievement-oriented leader- ship is most effective in settings in which followers are required to perform ambiguous tasks. In settings such as these, leaders who challenge and set high standards for followers raise followers’ confidence that they have the ability to reach their goals. In effect, achievement-oriented leadership helps followers feel that their efforts will result in effective performance. In set- tings where the task is more structured and less ambiguous, however, achievement-oriented leadership appears to be unrelated to followers’ expec- tations about their work efforts.
Pragmatically, path–goal theory is straightforward. An effective leader has to attend to the needs of followers. The leader should help followers to define their goals and the paths they want to take in reaching those goals. When obstacles arise, the leader needs to help followers confront them. This may mean helping the follower around the obstacle, or it may mean remov- ing the obstacle. The leader’s job is to help followers reach their goals by directing, guiding, and coaching them along the way.
sTrenGTHs
Path–goal theory has several positive features. First, path–goal theory pro- vides a useful theoretical framework for understanding how various leader- ship behaviors affect followers’ satisfaction and work performance. It was one of the first theories to specify four conceptually distinct varieties of leadership (e.g., directive, supportive, participative, and achievement ori- ented), expanding the focus of prior research, which dealt exclusively with task- and relationship-oriented behaviors ( Jermier, 1996). The path–goal approach was also one of the first situational contingency theories of leader- ship to explain how task and follower characteristics affect the impact of leadership on follower performance. The framework provided in path–goal theory informs leaders about how to choose an appropriate leadership style based on the various demands of the task and the type of followers being asked to do the task.
A second positive feature of path–goal theory is that it attempts to integrate the motivation principles of expectancy theory into a theory of leadership.
Motivation Theories dispersed Leadership
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 123
This makes path–goal theory unique because no other leadership approach deals directly with motivation in this way. Path–goal theory forces us con- tinually to ask questions such as these about follower motivation: How can I motivate followers to feel that they have the ability to do the work? How can I help them feel that if they successfully do their work, they will be rewarded? What can I do to improve the payoffs that followers expect from their work? Path–goal theory is designed to keep these kinds of questions, which address issues of motivation, at the forefront of the leader’s mind.
A third strength, and perhaps its greatest, is that path–goal theory provides a model that in certain ways is very practical. The representation of the model (see Figure 6.1) underscores and highlights the important ways lead- ers help followers. It shouts out for leaders to clarify the paths to the goals and remove or help followers around the obstacles to the goals. In its sim- plest form, the theory reminds leaders that the overarching purpose of lead- ership is to guide and coach followers as they move along the path to achieve a goal.
criTicisms
Although path–goal theory has various strengths, it also has several identi- fiable weaknesses. First, path–goal theory is so complex and incorporates so many different aspects of leadership that interpreting the theory can be confusing. For example, path–goal theory makes predictions about which of four different leadership styles is appropriate for tasks with different degrees of structure, for goals with different levels of clarity, for followers at different levels of ability, and for organizations with different degrees of formal authority. To say the least, it is a daunting task to incorporate all of these factors simultaneously into one’s selection of a preferred leadership style. Because the scope of path–goal theory is so broad and encompasses so many different interrelated sets of assumptions, it is difficult to use this theory fully in trying to improve the leadership process in a given organi- zational context.
A second limitation of path–goal theory is that it has received only partial support from the many empirical research studies that have been conducted to test its validity (House & Mitchell, 1974; Indvik, 1986; Schriesheim, Castro, Zhou, & DeChurch, 2006; Schriesheim & Kerr, 1977; Schriesheim & Schriesheim, 1980; Stinson & Johnson, 1975; Wofford & Liska, 1993). For example, some research supports the prediction that leader directiveness is positively related to follower satisfaction when tasks are ambiguous, but
rewards
124 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
other research has failed to confirm this relationship. Furthermore, not all aspects of the theory have been given equal attention. A great deal of research has been designed to study directive and supportive leadership, but fewer studies address participative and achievement-oriented leadership. The claims of path–goal theory remain tentative because the research findings to date do not provide a full and consistent picture of the basic assumptions and corollaries of path–goal theory (Evans, 1996; Jermier, 1996; Schriesheim & Neider, 1996).
Another criticism of path–goal theory is that it fails to explain adequately the relationship between leadership behavior and follower motivation. Path–goal theory is unique in that it incorporates the tenets of expectancy theory; however, it does not go far enough in explicating how leadership is related to these tenets. The principles of expectancy theory suggest that followers will be motivated if they feel competent and trust that their efforts will get results, but path–goal theory does not describe how a leader could use various styles directly to help followers feel competent or assured of success. For example, path–goal theory does not explain how directive lead- ership during ambiguous tasks increases follower motivation. Similarly, it does not explain how supportive leadership during tedious work relates to follower motivation. The result is that the practitioner is left with an inad- equate understanding of how her or his leadership will affect followers’ expectations about their work.
A final criticism that can be made of path–goal theory concerns a practical outcome of the theory. Path–goal theory suggests that it is important for leaders to provide coaching, guidance, and direction for followers, to help followers define and clarify goals, and to help followers around obstacles as they attempt to reach their goals. In effect, this approach treats leadership as a one-way event: The leader affects the follower. The potential difficulty in this type of “helping” leadership is that followers may easily become depen- dent on the leader to accomplish their work. Path–goal theory places a great deal of responsibility on leaders and much less on followers. Over time, this kind of leadership could be counterproductive because it promotes depen- dency and fails to recognize the full abilities of followers.
APPLicATion
Path–goal theory is not an approach to leadership for which many manage- ment training programs have been developed. You will not find many seminars with titles such as “Improving Your Path–Goal Leadership” or
how to Use Path-Goal Theory
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 125
“Assessing Your Skills in Path–Goal Leadership,” either. Nevertheless, path–goal theory does offer significant insights that can be applied in ongo- ing settings to improve one’s leadership.
Path–goal theory provides a set of general recommendations based on the characteristics of followers and tasks for how leaders should act in various situations if they want to be effective. It informs us about when to be direc- tive, supportive, participative, or achievement oriented. For instance, the theory suggests that leaders should be directive when tasks are complex, and the leader should give support when tasks are dull. Similarly, it suggests that leaders should be participative when followers need control and that leaders should be achievement oriented when followers need to excel. In a general way, path–goal theory offers leaders a road map that gives directions about ways to improve follower satisfaction and performance.
The principles of path–goal theory can be used by leaders at all levels in the organization and for all types of tasks. To apply path–goal theory, a leader must carefully assess the followers and their tasks, and then choose an appro- priate leadership style to match those characteristics. If followers are feeling insecure about doing a task, the leader needs to adopt a style that builds follower confidence. For example, in a university setting where a junior fac- ulty member feels apprehensive about his or her teaching and research, a department chair should give supportive leadership. By giving care and sup- port, the chair helps the junior faculty member gain a sense of confidence about his or her ability to perform the work (Bess & Goldman, 2001). If followers are uncertain whether their efforts will result in reaching their goals, the leader needs to prove to them that their efforts will be rewarded. As discussed earlier in the chapter, path–goal theory is useful because it continually reminds leaders that their central purpose is to help followers define their goals and then to help followers reach their goals in the most efficient manner.
cAse sTUDies
The following cases provide descriptions of various situations in which a leader is attempting to apply path–goal theory. Two of the cases, Cases 6.1 and 6.2, are from traditional business contexts; the third, Case 6.3, is from an academic perspective of teaching orchestra students. As you read the cases, try to apply the principles of path–goal theory to determine the degree to which you think the leaders in the cases have done a good job of using this theory.
empowerment
126 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
Case 6.1
Three shifts, Three supervisors
Brako is a small manufacturing company that produces parts for the automobile industry. The company has several patents on parts that fit in the brake assembly of nearly all domestic and foreign cars. each year, the company produces 3 million parts that it ships to assembly plants throughout the world. To produce the parts, Brako runs three shifts with about 40 workers on each shift.
The supervisors for the three shifts (art, Bob, and carol) are experienced employees, and each has been with the company for more than 20 years. The supervisors appear satisfied with their work and have reported no major difficulty in supervising employees at Brako.
art supervises the first shift. employees describe him as being a very hands-on type of leader. he gets very involved in the day-to-day opera- tions of the facility. Workers joke that art knows to the milligram the amount of raw materials the company has on hand at any given time. art often can be found walking through the plant and reminding people of the correct procedures to follow in doing their work. even for those working on the production line, art always has some directions and reminders.
Workers on the first shift have few negative comments to make about art’s leadership. however, they are negative about many other aspects of their work. Most of the work on this shift is very straightforward and repetitive; as a result, it is monotonous. The rules for working on the production line or in the packaging area are all clearly spelled out and require no independent decision making on the part of workers. Workers simply need to show up and go through the motions. on lunch breaks, workers often are heard complaining about how bored they are doing the same old thing over and over. Workers do not criticize art, but they do not think he really understands their situation.
Bob supervises the second shift. he really enjoys working at Brako and wants all the workers on the afternoon shift to enjoy their work as well. Bob is a people-oriented supervisor whom workers describe as very gen- uine and caring. hardly a day goes by that Bob does not post a message about someone’s birthday or someone’s personal accomplishment. Bob works hard at creating camaraderie, including sponsoring a company softball team, taking people out to lunch, and having people over to his house for social events.
despite Bob’s personableness, absenteeism and turnover are highest on the second shift. The second shift is responsible for setting up the machines
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 127
and equipment when changes are made from making one part to making another. in addition, the second shift is responsible for the complex com- puter programs that monitor the machines. Workers on the second shift take a lot of heat from others at Brako for not doing a good job.
Workers on the second shift feel pressure because it is not always easy to figure out how to do their tasks. each setup is different and entails different procedures. although the computer is extremely helpful when it is calibrated appropriately to the task, it can be extremely problematic when the software it uses is off the mark. Workers have complained to Bob and upper management many times about the difficulty of their jobs.
carol supervises the third shift. her style is different from that of the others at Brako. carol routinely has meetings, which she labels trouble- shooting sessions, for the purpose of identifying problems workers are experiencing. any time there is a glitch on the production line, carol wants to know about it so she can help workers find a solution. if work- ers cannot do a particular job, she shows them how. For those who are uncertain of their competencies, carol gives reassurance. carol tries to spend time with each worker and help the workers focus on their per- sonal goals. in addition, she stresses company goals and the rewards that are available if workers are able to make the grade.
People on the third shift like to work for carol. They find she is good at helping them do their job. They say she has a wonderful knack for making everything fall into place. When there are problems, she addresses them. When workers feel down, she builds them up. carol was described by one worker as an interesting mixture of part parent, part coach, and part manufacturing expert. Upper management at Brako is pleased with carol’s leadership, but they have experienced problems repeatedly when workers from carol’s shift have been rotated to other shifts at Brako.
Questions
1. Based on the principles of path–goal theory, describe why art and Bob appear to be less effective than carol.
2. how does the leadership of each of the three supervisors affect the motivation of their respective followers?
3. if you were consulting with Brako about leadership, what changes and recommendations would you make regarding the supervision of art, Bob, and carol?
128 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
Case 6.2
Direction for some, support for others
daniel shivitz is the manager of a small business called The copy center, which is located near a large university. The copy center employs about 18 people, most of whom work part-time while going to school full-time. The store caters to the university community by specializing in course packs, but it also provides desktop publishing and standard copying ser- vices. it has three large, state-of-the-art copy machines and several com- puter workstations.
There are two other national chain copy stores in the immediate vicinity of The copy center, yet this store does more business than both of the other stores combined. a major factor contributing to the success of this store is daniel’s leadership style.
one of the things that stand out about daniel is the way he works with his part-time staff. Most of them are students, who have to schedule their work hours around their class schedules, and daniel has a reputa- tion of being really helpful with working out schedule conflicts. no con- flict is too small for daniel, who is always willing to juggle schedules to meet the needs of everyone. students talk about how much they feel included and like the spirit at The copy center. it is as if daniel makes the store like a second family for them.
Work at The copy center divides itself into two main areas: duplicating services and desktop publishing. in both areas, daniel’s leadership is effective.
duplicating is a straightforward operation that entails taking a custom- er’s originals and making copies of them. Because this job is tedious, daniel goes out of his way to help the staff make it tolerable. he pro- motes a friendly work atmosphere by doing such things as letting the staff wear casual attire, letting them choose their own background music, and letting them be a bit wild on the job. daniel spends a lot of time each day conversing informally with each employee; he also wel- comes staff talking with each other. daniel has a knack for making each worker feel significant even when the work is insignificant. he promotes camaraderie among his staff, and he is not afraid to become involved in their activities.
The desktop publishing area is more complex than duplicating. it involves creating business forms, advertising pieces, and résumés for customers. Working in desktop publishing requires skills in writing, editing, design, and layout. it is challenging work because it is not always easy to satisfy customers’ needs. Most of the employees in this area are full-time workers.
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 129
Through the years, daniel has found that employees who work best in desktop publishing are a unique type of person, very different from those who work in duplicating. They are usually quite independent, self-assured, and self-motivated. in supervising them, daniel gives them a lot of space, is available when they need help, but otherwise leaves them alone.
daniel likes the role of being the resource person for these employees. For example, if an employee is having difficulty on a customer’s project, he willingly joins the employee in troubleshooting the problem. similarly, if one of the staff is having problems with a software program, daniel is quick to offer his technical expertise. Because the employees in desktop publishing are self-directed, daniel spends far less time with them than with those who work in duplicating.
overall, daniel feels successful with his leadership at The copy center. Profits for the store continue to grow each year, and its reputation for high-quality service is widespread.
Questions
1. according to path–goal theory, why is daniel an effective leader?
2. how does his leadership style affect the motivation of employees at The copy center?
3. how do characteristics of the task and the followers influence daniel’s leadership?
4. one of the principles of path–goal theory is to make the end goal valuable to workers. What could daniel do to improve follower moti- vation in this area?
Case 6.3
Playing in the orchestra
Martina Bates is the newly hired orchestra teacher at Middletown school district in rural sparta, Kansas. after graduating from the Juilliard school of Music, Martina had intended to play violin professionally, but when no jobs became available, she accepted an offer to teach orchestra in her hometown, believing it would be a good place to hone her skills until a professional position became available.
(Continued)
130 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
Being the orchestra instructor at Middletown is challenging because it involves teaching music classes, directing the high school orchestra, and directing both the middle school and grade school orchestra programs. When classes started, Martina hit the ground running and found she liked teaching, exhilarated by her work with students. after her first year, however, she is having misgivings about her decision to teach. Most of all, she is feeling troubled by how different students are in each of the three programs, and how her leadership does not seem to be effective with all the students.
running the elementary orchestra program is demanding, but fun. a lot of parents want their children to play an instrument, so the turnout for orchestra is really strong, and it is the largest of the three Middletown programs. Many students have never held an instrument before, so teaching them is quite a challenge. Learning to make the cornet sound like a cornet or moving the bow of a cello so it sounds like a cello is a huge undertaking. Whether it is drums, bass viol, clarinet, or saxophone, Martina patiently shows the kids how to play and consistently compli- ments them every small step of the way. First and foremost, she wants each child to feel like he or she can “do it.” she instructs her students with great detail about how to hold the instruments, position their tongues, and read notes. They respond well to Martina’s kindness and forbearance, and the parents are thrilled. The orchestra’s spring concert had many wild sounds but was also wildly successful, with excited chil- dren and happy parents.
The middle school orchestra is somewhat smaller in size and presents different challenges for Martina. The students in this orchestra are starting to sound good on their instruments and are willing to play together as a group, but some of them are becoming disinterested and want to quit. Martina uses a different style of leadership with the mid- dle schoolers, stressing practice and challenging students to improve their skills. at this level, students are placed in “chairs” for each instru- ment. The best players sit in the first chair, the next best are second chair, and so on down to the last chair. each week, the students engage in “challenges” for the chairs. if students practice hard and improve, they can advance to a higher chair; students who don’t practice can slip down to a lower chair. Martina puts up charts to track students’ practice hours, and when they reach established goals, they can choose a reward from “the grab bag of goodies,” which has candy, trinkets, and gift cards. never knowing what their prize will be motivates the students, especially as they all want to get the gift cards. although some kids avoid practice because they find it tedious and boring, many
(continued)
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 131
enjoy it because it improves their performance, to say nothing about the chance to get a prize. The spring concert for this group is Martina’s favorite, because the sounds are better and the students are interested in playing well.
Middletown’s high school orchestra is actually very small, which is sur- prising to Martina. Why does she have nearly a hundred kids in the elementary orchestra and less than half that number in the high school program? she likes teaching the high school students, but they do not seem too excited about playing. Because she is highly trained herself, Martina likes to show students advanced techniques and give them chal- lenging music to play. she spends hours listening to each student play, providing individualized feedback that, unfortunately in many cases, doesn’t seem to have any impact on the students. For example, chris Trotter, who plays third-chair trumpet, is considering dropping orchestra to go out for cross-country. similarly, Lisa Weiss, who is first-chair flute, seems bored and may quit the orchestra to get a part-time job. Martina is frustrated and baffled; why would these students want to quit? They are pretty good musicians, and most of them are willing to practice. The students have such wonderful potential but don’t seem to want to use it. students profess to liking Martina, but many of them just don’t seem to want to be in the orchestra.
Questions
1. Path–goal leadership is about how leaders can help followers reach their goals. Generally, what are the goals for the students in each of the different orchestras? What obstacles do they face? in what way does Martina help them address obstacles and reach their goals?
2. Based on the principles of expectancy theory described in the chapter, why is Martina effective with the elementary and middle school orchestras? Why do both of these groups seem motivated to play for her? in what ways did she change her leadership style for the middle schoolers?
3. Martina’s competencies as a musician do not seem to help her with the students who are becoming disinterested in orchestra. Why? Using ideas from expectancy theory, what would you advise her to do to improve her leadership with the high school orchestra?
4. achievement-oriented leadership is one of the four major kinds of path–goal leadership. For which of the three orchestras do you think this style would be most effective? discuss.
132 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
LeADersHiP insTrUmenT
Because the path–goal theory was developed as a complex set of theoretical assumptions to direct researchers in developing new leadership theory, it has used many different instruments to measure the leadership process. The Path–Goal Leadership Questionnaire has been useful in measuring and learning about important aspects of path–goal leadership (Indvik, 1985, 1988). This questionnaire provides information for respondents about four different leadership styles: directive, supportive, participative, and achieve- ment oriented. Respondents’ scores on each of the different styles provide them with information on their strong and weak styles and the relative importance they place on each of the styles.
To understand the path–goal questionnaire better, it may be useful to analyze a hypothetical set of scores. For example, hypothesize that your scores on the questionnaire were 29 for directive, which is high; 22 for supportive, which is low; 21 for participative, which is average; and 25 for achievement, which is high. These scores suggest that you are a leader who is typically more directive and achievement oriented than most other leaders, less supportive than other leaders, and quite similar to other leaders in the degree to which you act participatively.
According to the principles of path–goal theory, if your scores matched these hypothetical scores, you would be effective in situations where the tasks and procedures are unclear and your followers have a need for certainty. You would be less effective in work settings that are structured and unchalleng- ing. In addition, you would be moderately effective in ambiguous situations with followers who want control. Last, you would do very well in uncertain situations where you could set high standards, challenge followers to meet these standards, and help them feel confident in their abilities.
In addition to the Path–Goal Leadership Questionnaire, leadership researchers have commonly used multiple instruments to study path–goal theory, including measures of task structure, locus of control, follower expec- tancies, and follower satisfaction. Although the primary use of these instru- ments has been for theory building, many of the instruments offer valuable information related to practical leadership issues.
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 133
Path–Goal Leadership Questionnaire
Instructions: This questionnaire contains questions about different styles of path– goal leadership. indicate how often each statement is true of your own behavior.
Key: 1 = never 2 = hardly ever 3 = seldom 4 = occasionally 5 = often 6 = Usually 7 = always
1. i let followers know what is expected of them. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. i maintain a friendly working relationship with followers.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
3. i consult with followers when facing a problem.1 2 3 4 5 6 7
4. i listen receptively to followers’ ideas and suggestions.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5. i inform followers about what needs to be done and how it needs to be done.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6. i let followers know that i expect them to per- form at their highest level.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
7. i act without consulting my followers. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8. i do little things to make it pleasant to be a member of the group.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9. i ask followers to follow standard rules and regulations.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
10. i set goals for followers’ performance that are quite challenging.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
11. i say things that hurt followers’ personal feel- ings.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
12. i ask for suggestions from followers concern- ing how to carry out assignments.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
13. i encourage continual improvement in follow- ers’ performance.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
14. i explain the level of performance that is expected of followers.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
15. i help followers overcome problems that stop them from carrying out their tasks.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
16. i show that i have doubts about followers’ ability to meet most objectives.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
17. i ask followers for suggestions on what assign- ments should be made.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
18. i give vague explanations of what is expected of followers on the job.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
19. i consistently set challenging goals for follow- ers to attain.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
20. i behave in a manner that is thoughtful of fol- lowers’ personal needs.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
134 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
scoring
1. reverse the scores for items 7, 11, 16, and 18.
2. directive style: sum of scores on items 1, 5, 9, 14, and 18.
3. supportive style: sum of scores on items 2, 8, 11, 15, and 20.
4. Participative style: sum of scores on items 3, 4, 7, 12, and 17.
5. achievement-oriented style: sum of scores on items 6, 10, 13, 16, and 19.
scoring interpretation
• directive style: a common score is 23, scores above 28 are considered high, and scores below 18 are considered low.
• supportive style: a common score is 28, scores above 33 are consid- ered high, and scores below 23 are considered low.
• Participative style: a common score is 21, scores above 26 are considered high, and scores below 16 are considered low.
• achievement-oriented style: a common score is 19, scores above 24 are considered high, and scores below 14 are considered low.
The scores you received on the Path–Goal Leadership Questionnaire pro- vide information about which styles of leadership you use most often and which you use less often. in addition, you can use these scores to assess your use of each style relative to your use of the other styles.
soUrces: adapted from A Path–Goal Theory Investigation of Superior–Subordinate Relationships, by J. indvik, unpublished doctoral dissertation, University of Wisconsin– Madison, 1985; and indvik (1988). Based on the work of house and dessler (1974) and house (1977) cited in Fulk and Wendler (1982). Used by permission.
chapter 6 Path–Goal Theory 135
sUmmAry
Path–goal theory was developed to explain how leaders motivate followers to be productive and satisfied with their work. It is a contingency approach to leadership because effectiveness depends on the fit between the leader’s behavior and the characteristics of followers and the task.
The basic principles of path–goal theory are derived from expectancy theory, which suggests that followers will be motivated if they feel competent, if they think their efforts will be rewarded, and if they find the payoff for their work valuable. A leader can help followers by selecting a style of leadership (directive, supportive, participative, or achievement oriented) that provides what is missing for followers in a particular work setting. In simple terms, it is the leader’s responsibility to help followers reach their goals by directing, guiding, and coaching them along the way.
Path–goal theory offers a large set of predictions for how a leader’s style interacts with followers’ needs and the nature of the task. Among other things, it predicts that directive leadership is effective with ambiguous tasks, that supportive leadership is effective for repetitive tasks, that participative leadership is effective when tasks are unclear and followers are autonomous, and that achievement-oriented leadership is effective for challenging tasks.
Path–goal theory has three major strengths. First, it provides a theoretical framework that is useful for understanding how directive, supportive, par- ticipative, and achievement-oriented styles of leadership affect the produc- tivity and satisfaction of followers. Second, path–goal theory is unique in that it integrates the motivation principles of expectancy theory into a the- ory of leadership. Third, it provides a practical model that underscores the important ways in which leaders help followers.
On the negative side, four criticisms can be leveled at path–goal theory. First, the scope of path–goal theory encompasses so many interrelated sets of assumptions that it is hard to use this theory in a given organizational set- ting. Second, research findings to date do not support a full and consistent picture of the claims of the theory. Furthermore, path–goal theory does not show in a clear way how leader behaviors directly affect follower motivation levels. Last, path–goal theory is very leader oriented and fails to recognize the interactional nature of leadership. It does not promote follower involve- ment in the leadership process.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
136 LeadershiP Theory and PracTice
reFerences
Bess, J. L., & Goldman, P. (2001). Leadership ambiguity in universities and K–12 schools and the limits of contemporary leadership theory. Leadership Quarterly, 12, 419–450.
Evans, M. G. (1970). The effects of supervisory behavior on the path–goal relation- ship. Organizational Behavior and Human Performance, 5, 277–298.
Evans, M. G. (1996). R. J. House’s “A path–goal theory of leader effectiveness.” Lead- ership Quarterly, 7(3), 305–309.
Fulk, J., & Wendler, E. R. (1982). Dimensionality of leader–subordinate interactions: A path–goal investigation. Organizational Behavior and Human Performance, 30, 241–264.
Halpin, A. W., & Winer, B. J. (1957). A factorial study of the leader behavior descrip- tions. In R. M. Stogdill & A. E. Coons (Eds.), Leader behavior: Its description and measurement. Columbus: Ohio State University, Bureau of Business Research.
House, R. J. (1971). A path–goal theory of leader effectiveness. Administrative Science Quarterly, 16, 321–328.
House, R. J. (1977). A 1976 theory of charismatic leadership. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership: The cutting edge (pp. 189–207). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
House, R. J. (1996). Path–goal theory of leadership: Lessons, legacy, and a reformu- lated theory. Leadership Quarterly, 7(3), 323–352.
House, R. J., & Dessler, G. (1974). The path–goal theory of leadership: Some post hoc and a priori tests. In J. Hunt & L. Larson (Eds.), Contingency approaches in leadership (pp. 29–55). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
House, R. J., & Mitchell, R. R. (1974). Path–goal theory of leadership. Journal of Contemporary Business, 3, 81–97.
Indvik, J. (1985). A path–goal theory investigation of superior–subordinate relationships. Unpublished doctoral dissertation, University of Wisconsin–Madison.
Indvik, J. (1986). Path–goal theory of leadership: A meta-analysis. In Proceedings of the Academy of Management Meeting (pp. 189–192). Briarcliff Manor, NY: Acad- emy of Management.
Indvik, J. (1988). A more complete testing of path–goal theory. Paper presented at the Academy of Management, Anaheim, CA.
Jermier, J. M. (1996). The path–goal theory of leadership: A subtextual analysis. Lead- ership Quarterly, 7(3), 311–316.
Schriesheim, C. A., Castro, S. L., Zhou, X., & DeChurch, L. A. (2006). An investiga- tion of path-goal and transformational leadership theory predictions at the indi- vidual level of analysis. Leadership Quarterly, 17, 21–38.
Schriesheim, C. A., & Kerr, S. (1977). Theories and measures of leadership: A critical appraisal. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership: The cutting edge (pp. 9–45). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
Schriesheim, C. A., & Neider, L. L. (1996). Path–goal leadership theory: The long and winding road. Leadership Quarterly, 7(3), 317–321.
Schriesheim, J. R., & Schriesheim, C. A. (1980). A test of the path–goal theory of leader- ship and some suggested directions for future research. Personnel Psychology, 33, 349–370.
Stinson, J. E., & Johnson, R. W. (1975). The path–goal theory of leadership: A partial test and suggested refinement. Academy of Management Journal, 18, 242–252.
Vroom, V. H. (1964). Work and motivation. New York: McGraw Hill. Wofford, J. C., & Liska, L. Z. (1993). Path–goal theories of leadership: A meta-
analysis. Journal of Management, 19(4), 857–876.
7
Leader–Member Exchange Theory
DEscripTion
Most of the leadership theories discussed thus far in this book have emphasized leadership from the point of view of the leader (e.g., trait approach, skills approach, and style approach) or the follower and the context (e.g., Situational Leadership and path–goal theory). Leader– member exchange (LMX) theory takes still another approach and con- ceptualizes leadership as a process that is centered on the interactions between leaders and followers. As Figure 7.1 illustrates, LMX theory makes the dyadic relationship between leaders and followers the focal point of the leadership process.
Before LMX theory, researchers treated leadership as something leaders did toward all of their followers. This assumption implied that leaders treated followers in a collective way, as a group, using an average leadership style. LMX theory challenged this assumption and directed researchers’ attention to the differences that might exist between the leader and each of the leader’s followers.
Early Studies
In the first studies of exchange theory, which was then called vertical dyad linkage (VDL) theory, researchers focused on the nature of the vertical linkages leaders formed with each of their followers (Figure 7.2). A leader’s relationship to the work unit as a whole was viewed as a series of vertical dyads (Figure 7.3).
Leader-Member Exchange Theory
138 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
In assessing the characteristics of these vertical dyads, researchers found two general types of linkages (or relationships): those that were based on expanded and negotiated role responsibilities (extra-roles), which were called the in- group, and those that were based on the formal employment contract (defined roles), which were called the out-group (Figure 7.4).
Within an organizational work unit, followers become a part of the in-group or the out-group based on how well they work with the leader and how well the leader works with them. Personality and other personal characteristics are related to this process (Dansereau, Graen, & Haga, 1975). In addition, membership in one group or the other is based on how followers involve themselves in expanding their role responsibilities with the leader (Graen, 1976). Followers who are interested in negotiating with the leader what they are willing to do for the group can become a part of the in-group. These negotiations involve exchanges in which followers do certain activities that go beyond their formal job descriptions, and the leader, in turn, does more for these followers. If followers are not interested in taking on new and dif- ferent job responsibilities, they become a part of the out-group.
Followers in the in-group receive more information, influence, confidence, and concern from their leaders than do out-group followers (Dansereau et al., 1975). In addition, they are more dependable, more highly involved,
LeaderFollower Dyadic Relationship
Figure 7.1 dimensions of Leadership
soUrcE: reprinted from Leadership Quarterly, 6(2), G. B. Graen & M. Uhl-Bien, “relationship-Based approach to Leadership: development of Leader–Member Exchange (LMX) Theory of Leadership over 25 years: applying a Multi-Level, Multi-domain perspective” (pp. 219–247), copyright © 1995, with permission from Elsevier.
noTE: LMX theory was first described 28 years ago in the works of dansereau, Graen, and haga (1975), Graen (1976), and Graen and cashman (1975). since it first appeared, it has undergone several revisions, and it continues to be of interest to researchers who study the leadership process.
in and out Functions out-Group Members
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 139
and more communicative than out-group followers (Dansereau et al., 1975). Whereas in-group members do extra things for the leader and the leader does the same for them, followers in the out-group are less compatible with the leader and usually just come to work, do their job, and go home.
Figure 7.2 The Vertical dyad
Dyadic Relationship
L
F
noTE: The leader (L) forms an individualized working relationship with each of his or her followers (F). The exchanges (both content and process) between the leader and follower define their dyadic relationship.
Figure 7.3 Vertical dyads
L L L
F A F B F Z
noTE: The leader (L) forms special relationships with all of his or her followers (F). Each of these relationships is special and has its own unique characteristics.
What is LMX about? in-Groups and out-Groups
140 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Later Studies
After the first set of studies, there was a shift in the focus of LMX theory. Whereas the initial studies of this theory addressed primarily the nature of the differences between in-groups and out-groups, a subsequent line of research addressed how LMX theory was related to organizational effectiveness.
Specifically, these studies focus on how the quality of leader–member exchanges was related to positive outcomes for leaders, followers, groups, and the organization in general (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995).
Researchers found that high-quality leader–member exchanges produced less employee turnover, more positive performance evaluations, higher fre- quency of promotions, greater organizational commitment, more desirable work assignments, better job attitudes, more attention and support from the leader, greater participation, and faster career progress over 25 years (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995; Liden, Wayne, & Stilwell, 1993).
In a meta-analysis of 164 LMX studies, Gerstner and Day (1997) found that LMX was consistently related to member job performance, satisfaction (overall and supervisory), commitment, role conflict and clarity, and turnover
Figure 7.4 in-Groups and out-Groups
L
F A
L
F B
L
F C
+3+3 +3 +3 +3 +3
L
F X
L
F Y
L
F Z
0 0 0 0 0 0
IN-GROUP OUT-GROUP
noTE: a leader (L) and his or her followers (F) form unique relationships. relationships within the in-group are marked by mutual trust, respect, liking, and reciprocal influence. relationships within the out-group are marked by formal communication based on job descriptions. plus 3 is a high-quality relationship, and zero is a stranger.
Examining outcomes with LMX
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 141
intentions. In addition, they found strong support in these studies for the psychometric properties of the LMX 7 Questionnaire. For purposes of research, they highlighted the importance of measuring LMX from the perspective of both the leader and the follower.
Based on a review of 130 studies of LMX research conducted since 2002, Anand, Hu, Liden, and Vidyarthi (2011) found that interest in studying leader–member exchange has not diminished. A large majority of these studies (70%) examined the antecedents and outcomes of leader–member exchange. The research trends show increased attention to the context surrounding LMX relationships (e.g., group dynamics), analyzing leader–member exchange from individual and group levels, and studying leader–member exchange with non-U.S. samples.
For example, using a sample of employees in a variety of jobs in Israeli orga- nizations, Atwater and Carmeli (2009) examined the connection between employees’ perceptions of leader–member exchange and their energy and creativity at work. They found that perceived high-quality leader–member exchange was positively related to feelings of energy in employees, which, in turn, was related to greater involvement in creative work. LMX theory was not directly associated with creativity, but it served as a mechanism to nurture people’s feelings, which then enhanced their creativity.
Ilies, Nahrgang, and Morgeson (2007) did a meta-analysis of 51 research studies that examined the relationship between LMX and employee citizen- ship behaviors. Citizenship behaviors are discretionary employee behaviors that go beyond the prescribed role, job description, or reward system (Katz, 1964; Organ, 1988). They found a positive relationship between the quality of leader–member relationships and citizenship behaviors. In other words, followers who had higher-quality relationships with their leaders were more likely to engage in more discretionary (positive “payback”) behaviors that benefited the leader and the organization.
Researchers have also studied how LMX theory is related to empowerment. Harris, Wheeler, and Kacmar (2009) explored how empowerment moder- ates the impact of leader–member exchange on job outcomes such as job satisfaction, turnover, job performance, and organizational citizenship behaviors. Based on two samples of college alumni, they found that empow- erment and leader–member exchange quality had a slight synergistic effect on job outcomes. The quality of leader–member exchange mattered most for employees who felt little empowerment. For these employees, high-quality leader–member exchange appeared to compensate for the drawbacks of not being empowered.
Empowerment Through LMX Empowering Employees
142 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
In essence, the aforementioned findings clearly illustrate that organizations stand to gain much from having leaders who can create good working rela- tionships. When leaders and followers have good exchanges, they feel better and accomplish more, and the organization prospers.
Leadership Making
Research of LMX theory has also focused on how exchanges between leaders and followers can be used for leadership making (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1991). Leadership making is a prescriptive approach to leadership emphasizing that leaders should develop high-quality exchanges with all of their followers rather than just a few. It attempts to make every follower feel as if he or she is a part of the in-group and, by so doing, avoids the inequities and negative implications of being in an out-group. In general, leadership making promotes partnerships in which the leader tries to build effective dyads with all followers in the work unit (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995). In addition, leadership making suggests that leaders can create networks of partnerships throughout the organization, which will benefit the organization’s goals and the leader’s own career progress.
Graen and Uhl-Bien (1991) suggested that leadership making develops pro- gressively over time in three phases: (1) the stranger phase, (2) the acquaintance phase, and (3) the mature partnership phase (Table 7.1). During Phase 1, the stranger phase, the interactions in the leader–follower dyad generally are rule bound, relying heavily on contractual relationships. Leaders and followers relate to each other within prescribed organizational roles. They have lower-quality exchanges, similar to those of out-group members discussed earlier in the chap- ter. The follower complies with the formal leader, who has hierarchical status for the purpose of achieving the economic rewards the leader controls. The motives of the follower during the stranger phase are directed toward self- interest rather than toward the good of the group (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995).
In a study of the early stages of leader–member relationship development, Nahrgang, Morgeson, and Ilies (2009) found that leaders look for followers who exhibit enthusiasm, participation, gregariousness, and extraversion. In contrast, followers look for leaders who are pleasant, trusting, cooperative, and agreeable. Leader extraversion did not influence relationship quality for the followers, and follower agreeableness did not influence relationship qual- ity for the leaders. A key predictor of relationship quality for both leaders and followers was behaviors such as performance.
Phase 2, the acquaintance phase, begins with an offer by the leader or the follower for improved career-oriented social exchanges, which involve sharing more resources and personal or work-related information. It is a testing period
Leader Follower interaction changing relationships
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 143
for both the leader and the follower to assess whether the follower is interested in taking on more roles and responsibilities and to assess whether the leader is willing to provide new challenges for followers. During this time, dyads shift away from interactions that are governed strictly by job descriptions and defined roles and move toward new ways of relating. As measured by LMX theory, it could be said that the quality of their exchanges has improved to medium quality. Successful dyads in the acquaintance phase begin to develop greater trust and respect for each other. They also tend to focus less on their own self-interests and more on the purposes and goals of the group.
Phase 3, mature partnership, is marked by high-quality leader–member exchanges. People who have progressed to this stage in their relationships experience a high degree of mutual trust, respect, and obligation toward each other. They have tested their relationship and found that they can depend on each other. In mature partnerships, there is a high degree of reciprocity between leaders and followers: Each affects and is affected by the other. For example, in a study of 75 bank managers and 58 engineering managers, Schriesheim, Castro, Zhou, and Yammarino (2001) found that good leader– member relations were more egalitarian and that influence and control were more evenly balanced between the supervisor and the follower. In addition, during Phase 3, members may depend on each other for favors and special assistance. For example, leaders may rely on followers to do extra assignments, and followers may rely on leaders for needed support or encouragement. The point is that leaders and followers are tied together in productive ways that go well beyond a traditional hierarchically defined work relationship. They
relationships Mature partnership
Table 7.1 phases in Leadership Making
phase 1 stranger
phase 2 Acquaintance
phase 3 partnership
roles scripted Tested negotiated
influences one way Mixed reciprocal
Exchanges Low quality Medium quality high quality
interests self self and other Group Time
soUrcE: adapted from “relationship-Based approach to Leadership: development of Leader–Member Exchange (LMX) Theory of Leadership over 25 years: applying a Multi- Level, Multi-domain perspective,” by G. B. Graen and M. Uhl-Bien, 1995, Leadership Quarterly, 6(2), 231.
144 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
have developed an extremely effective way of relating that produces positive outcomes for themselves and the organization. In effect, partnerships are transformational in that they assist leaders and followers in moving beyond their own self-interests to accomplish the greater good of the team and orga- nization (see Chapter 8).
The benefits for employees who develop high-quality leader–member rela- tionships include preferential treatment, increased job-related communication, ample access to supervisors, and increased performance-related feedback (Harris et al., 2009). The disadvantages for those with low-quality leader– member relationships include limited trust and support from supervisors and few benefits outside the employment contract (Harris et al., 2009). To evaluate leader–member exchanges, researchers typically use a brief ques- tionnaire that asks leaders and followers to report on the effectiveness of their working relationships. The questionnaire assesses the degree to which respondents express respect, trust, and obligation in their exchanges with others. At the end of this chapter, a version of the LMX questionnaire is provided for you to take for the purpose of analyzing some of your own leader–member relationships.
How DoEs LMX THEory work?
LMX theory works in two ways: It describes leadership, and it prescribes leadership. In both instances, the central concept is the dyadic relationship that a leader forms with each of the leader’s followers. Descriptively, LMX theory suggests that it is important to recognize the existence of in-groups and out-groups within a group or an organization.
The differences in how goals are accomplished by in-groups and out-groups are substantial. Working with an in-group allows a leader to accomplish more work in a more effective manner than he or she can accomplish work- ing without one. In-group members are willing to do more than is required in their job description and look for innovative ways to advance the group’s goals. In response to their extra effort and devotion, leaders give them more responsibilities and more opportunities. Leaders also give in-group members more of their time and support.
Out-group members act quite differently than in-group members. Rather than trying to do extra work, out-group members operate strictly within their prescribed organizational roles. They do what is required of them but nothing more. Leaders treat out-group members fairly and according to the formal contract, but they do not give them special attention. For their efforts,
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 145
out-group members receive the standard benefits as defined in the job description.
Prescriptively, LMX theory is best understood within the leadership-making model of Graen and Uhl-Bien (1991). Graen and Uhl-Bien advocated that leaders should create a special relationship with all followers, similar to the relationships described as in-group relationships. Leaders should offer each follower the opportunity to take on new roles and responsibilities. Further- more, leaders should nurture high-quality exchanges with their followers. Rather than focusing on the differences between in-group and out-group members, the leadership-making model suggests that leaders should look for ways to build trust and respect with all of their followers, thus making the entire work unit an in-group. In addition, leaders should look beyond their own work unit and create high-quality partnerships with people throughout the organization.
Whether descriptive or prescriptive, LMX theory works by focusing our attention on the special, unique relationship that leaders can create with others. When these relationships are of high quality, the goals of the leader, the followers, and the organization are all advanced.
sTrEngTHs
LMX theory makes several positive contributions to our understanding of the leadership process. First, it is a strong descriptive theory. Intuitively, it makes sense to describe work units in terms of those who contribute more and those who contribute less (or the bare minimum) to the organization. Anyone who has ever worked in an organization has felt the presence of in-groups and out-groups. Despite the potential harm of out-groups, we all know that leaders have special relationships with certain people who do more and get more. We may not like this because it seems unfair, but it is a reality, and the LMX theory has accurately described this situation. LMX theory validates our experience of how people within organizations relate to each other and the leader. Some contribute more and receive more; others contribute less and get less.
Second, LMX theory is unique because it is the only leadership approach that makes the concept of the dyadic relationship the centerpiece of the leadership process. Other approaches emphasize the characteristics of lead- ers, followers, contexts, or a combination of these, but none of them addresses the specific relationships between the leader and each follower. LMX theory
Leadership and communication
146 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
underscores that effective leadership is contingent on effective leader– member exchanges.
Third, LMX theory is noteworthy because it directs our attention to the importance of communication in leadership. The high-quality exchanges advocated in LMX theory are inextricably bound to effective communica- tion. Communication is the vehicle through which leaders and followers create, nurture, and sustain useful exchanges. Effective leadership occurs when the communication of leaders and followers is characterized by mutual trust, respect, and commitment.
Fourth, LMX theory provides an important alert for leaders. It warns leaders to avoid letting their conscious or unconscious biases influence who is invited into the in-group (e.g., biases regarding race, gender, ethnicity, reli- gion, or age). The principles outlined in LMX theory serve as a good reminder for leaders to be fair and equal in how they approach each of their followers.
Finally, a large body of research substantiates how the practice of LMX the- ory is related to positive organizational outcomes. In a review of this research, Graen and Uhl-Bien (1995) pointed out that leader–member exchange is related to performance, organizational commitment, job climate, innovation, organizational citizenship behavior, empowerment, procedural and distribu- tive justice, career progress, and many other important organizational vari- ables. By linking the use of LMX theory to real outcomes, researchers have been able to validate the theory and increase its practical value.
criTicisMs
LMX theory also has some limitations. First, on the surface, leader–member exchange in its initial formulation (vertical dyad linkage theory) runs coun- ter to the basic human value of fairness. Throughout our lives, beginning when we are very young, we are taught to try to get along with everyone and to treat everyone equally. We have been taught that it is wrong to form in- groups or cliques because they are harmful to those who cannot be a part of them. Because LMX theory divides the work unit into two groups and one group receives special attention, it gives the appearance of discrimination against the out-group.
Our culture is replete with examples of people of different genders, ages, cultures, and abilities who have been discriminated against. Although LMX theory was not designed to do so, it supports the development of privileged
attribution Biases
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 147
groups in the workplace. In so doing, it appears unfair and discriminatory. Furthermore, as reported by McClane (1991), the existence of in-groups and out-groups may have undesirable effects on the group as a whole.
Whether LMX theory actually creates inequalities is questionable (cf. Harter & Evanecky, 2002; Scandura, 1999). If a leader does not intentionally keep out- group members “out,” and if they are free to become members of the in-group, then LMX theory may not create inequalities. However, the theory does not elaborate on strategies for how one gains access to the in-group if one chooses to do so.
Furthermore, LMX theory does not address other fairness issues, such as fol- lowers’ perceptions of the fairness of pay increases and promotion opportunities (distributive justice), decision-making rules (procedural justice), or communi- cation of issues within the organization (interactional justice) (Scandura, 1999). There is a need for further research on how these types of fairness issues affect the development and maintenance of LMX relationships.
A second criticism of LMX theory is that the basic ideas of the theory are not fully developed. For example, the theory does not fully explain how high-quality leader–member exchanges are created (Anand et al., 2011). In the early studies, it was implied that they were formed when a leader found certain followers more compatible in regard to personality, interpersonal skills, or job competencies, but these studies never described the relative importance of these factors or how this process worked (Yukl, 1994). Research has suggested that leaders should work to create high-quality exchanges with all followers, but the guidelines for how this is done are not clearly spelled out. For example, the model on leadership making highlights the importance of role making, incremental influence, and type of reciproc- ity (see Table 7.1), but it does not explain how these concepts function to build mature partnerships. Similarly, the model strongly promotes building trust, respect, and obligation in leader–follower relationships, but it does not describe the means by which these factors are developed in relationships.
Based on an examination of 147 studies of leader–member exchange, Schriesheim, Castro, and Cogliser (1999) concluded that improved theoriza- tion about leader–member exchange and its basic processes is needed. Simi- larly, in a review of the research on relational leadership, Uhl-Bien, Maslyn, and Ospina (2012) point to the need for further understanding of how high- and low-quality relationships develop in leader–member exchange. Although many studies have been conducted on leader–member exchange, these studies have not resulted in a clear, refined set of definitions, concepts, and proposi- tions about the theory.
nGo Leadership
148 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
A third criticism of the theory is that researchers have not adequately explained the contextual factors that may have an impact on LMX relation- ships (Anand et al., 2011). Since leader–member exchange is often studied in isolation, researchers have not examined the potential impact of other vari- ables on LMX dyads. For example, workplace norms and other organizational culture variables are likely to influence leader–member exchange. There is a need to explore how the surrounding constellations of social networks influ- ence specific LMX relationships and the individuals in those relationships.
Finally, questions have been raised about the measurement of leader– member exchanges in LMX theory (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995; Schriesheim, Castro, & Cogliser, 1999; Schriesheim, Castro, Zhou, et al., 2001). For example, no empirical studies have used dyadic measures to analyze the LMX process (Schriesheim, Castro, Zhou, et al., 2001). In addition, leader–member exchanges have been measured with different versions of leader–member exchange scales and with different levels of analysis, so the results are not always directly comparable. Furthermore, the content validity and dimensionality of the scales have been questioned (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995; Schriesheim, Castro, Zhou, et al., 2001).
AppLicATion
Although LMX theory has not been packaged in a way to be used in stan- dard management training and development programs, it offers many insights that leaders could use to improve their own leadership behavior. Foremost, LMX theory directs leaders to assess their leadership from a relationship perspective. This assessment will sensitize leaders to how in- groups and out-groups develop within their own organization. In addition, LMX theory suggests ways in which leaders can improve their organization by building strong leader–member exchanges with all of their followers.
The ideas set forth in LMX theory can be used by leaders at all levels within an organization. For example, LMX theory could be used to explain how CEOs develop special relationships with select individuals in upper manage- ment to develop new strategic and tactical corporate goals. A presidential cabinet is a good example of this. A U.S. president will handpick the 15 people that serve as his or her closest advisers. The cabinet includes the vice president and the heads of 15 executive departments—the secretaries of the Departments of Agriculture, Commerce, Defense, Education, Energy, Health and Human Services, Homeland Security, Housing and Urban Development, Interior, Labor, State, Transportation, Treasury, and Veterans Affairs, as well
Using LMX
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 149
as the attorney general. These individuals, in turn, run their own departments in accordance with the goals and philosophy of the president.
On a lower level, LMX theory could be used to explain how line managers in a manufacturing plant use a select few workers to accomplish the produc- tion quotas of their work unit. The point is that the ideas presented in LMX theory are applicable throughout organizations.
In addition, the ideas of LMX theory can be used to explain how individuals create leadership networks throughout an organization to help them accom- plish work more effectively (Graen & Scandura, 1987). A person with a network of high-quality partnerships can call on many people to help solve problems and advance the goals of the organization.
LMX theory can also be applied in different types of organizations. It applies in volunteer settings as well as traditional business, education, and government settings. Imagine a community leader who heads a volunteer program that assists older adults. To run the program effectively, the leader depends on a few of the volunteers who are more dependable and committed than the rest of the volunteers. This process of working closely with a small cadre of trusted volunteers is explained by the principles of LMX theory. Similarly, a manager in a traditional business setting might use certain indi- viduals to achieve a major change in the company’s policies and procedures. The way the manager goes about this process is explicated in LMX theory.
In summary, LMX theory tells us to be aware of how we relate to our fol- lowers. It tells us to be sensitive to whether some followers receive special attention and some followers do not. In addition, it tells us to be fair to all followers and allow each of them to become as involved in the work of the unit as they want to be. LMX theory tells us to be respectful and to build trusting relationships with all of our followers, recognizing that each follower is unique and wants to relate to us in a special way.
cAsE sTUDiEs
In the following section, three case studies (Cases 7.1, 7.2, and 7.3) are presented to clarify how LMX theory can be applied to various group set- tings. The first case is about the creative director at an advertising agency, the second is about a production manager at a mortgage company, and the third is about the leadership of the manager of a district office of the Social Security Administration. After each case, there are questions that will help you analyze it, using the ideas from LMX theory.
150 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Case 7.1
His Team gets the Best Assignments
carly peters directs the creative department of the advertising agency of Mills, smith, & peters. The agency has about 100 employees, 20 of whom work for carly in the creative department. Typically, the agency main- tains 10 major accounts and a number of smaller accounts. it has a repu- tation for being one of the best advertising and public relations agencies in the country.
in the creative department, there are four major account teams. Each is led by an associate creative director, who reports directly to carly. in addi- tion, each team has a copywriter, an art director, and a production artist. These four account teams are headed by Jack, Terri, Julie, and sarah.
Jack and his team get along really well with carly, and they have done excellent work for their clients at the agency. of all the teams, Jack’s team is the most creative and talented and the most willing to go the extra mile for carly. as a result, when carly has to showcase accounts to upper management, she often uses the work of Jack’s team. Jack and his team members are comfortable confiding in carly and she in them. carly is not afraid to allocate extra resources to Jack’s team or to give them free rein on their accounts because they always come through for her.
Terri’s team also performs well for the agency, but Terri is unhappy with how carly treats her team. she feels that carly is not fair because she favors Jack’s team. For example, Terri’s team was counseled out of pursuing an ad campaign because the campaign was too risky, whereas Jack’s group was praised for developing a very provocative campaign. Terri feels that Jack’s team is carly’s pet: his team gets the best assignments, accounts, and budg- ets. Terri finds it hard to hold back the animosity she feels toward carly.
Like Terri, Julie is concerned that her team is not in the inner circle, close to carly. she has noticed repeatedly that carly favors the other teams. For example, whenever additional people are assigned to team projects, it is always the other teams who get the best writers and art directors. Julie is mystified as to why carly doesn’t notice her team or try to help it with its work. she feels carly undervalues her team because Julie knows the quality of her team’s work is indisputable.
although sarah agrees with some of Terri’s and Julie’s observations about carly, she does not feel any antagonism about carly’s leadership. sarah has worked for the agency for nearly 10 years, and nothing seems to bother her. her account teams have never been earthshaking, but they have never been problematic either. sarah views her team and its work more as a nuts-and-bolts operation in which the team is given an assign- ment and carries it out. Being in carly’s inner circle would entail putting
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 151
in extra time in the evening or on weekends and would create more headaches for sarah. Therefore, sarah is happy with her role as it is, and she has little interest in trying to change the way the department works.
Questions
1. Based on the principles of LMX theory, what observations would you make about carly’s leadership at Mills, smith, & peters?
2. is there an in-group and out-group, and if so, which are they?
3. in what way is carly’s relationship with the four groups productive or counterproductive to the overall goals of the agency?
4. do you think carly should change her approach toward the associate directors? if so, what should she do differently?
Case 7.2
working Hard at Being Fair
city Mortgage is a medium-size mortgage company that employs about 25 people. Jenny hernandez, who has been with the company for 10 years, is the production manager who oversees its day-to-day operations.
reporting to Jenny are loan originators (salespeople), closing officers, mortgage underwriters, and processing and shipping personnel. Jenny is proud of the company and feels as if she has contributed substantially to its steady growth and expansion.
The climate at city Mortgage is very positive. people like to come to work because the office environment is comfortable. They respect each other at the company and show tolerance for those who are different from themselves.
Whereas at many mortgage companies it is common for resentments to build between people who earn different incomes, this is not the case at city Mortgage.
Jenny’s leadership has been instrumental in shaping the success of city Mortgage. her philosophy stresses listening to employees and then determining how each employee can best contribute to the mission of the company. she makes a point of helping each person explore her or his own talents, and challenges each one to try new things.
(Continued)
152 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
at the annual holiday party, Jenny devised an interesting event that symbolizes her leadership style. she bought a large piece of colorful glass and had it cut into 25 pieces and handed out one piece to each person. Then she asked each employee to come forward with the piece of glass and briefly state what he or she liked about city Mortgage and how he or she had contributed to the company in the past year. after the statements were made, the pieces of glass were formed into a cut glass window that hangs in the front lobby of the office. The glass is a reminder of how each individual contributes his or her uniqueness to the overall purpose of the company.
another characteristic of Jenny’s style is her fairness. she does not want to give anyone the impression that certain people have the inside track, and she goes to great lengths to prevent this from happening. For exam- ple, she avoids social lunches because she thinks they foster the percep- tion of favoritism. similarly, even though her best friend is one of the loan originators, she is seldom seen talking with her, and if she is, it is always about business matters.
Jenny also applies her fairness principle to how information is shared in the office. she does not want anyone to feel as if he or she is out of the loop, so she tries very hard to keep her employees informed on all the matters that could affect them. Much of this she does through her open-door office policy. Jenny does not have a special group of employees with whom she confides her concerns; rather, she shares openly with each of them.
Jenny is very committed to her work at city Mortgage. she works long hours and carries a beeper on the weekend. at this point in her career, her only concern is that she could be burning out.
Questions
1. Based on the LMX model, how would you describe Jenny’s leadership?
2. how do you think the employees at city Mortgage respond to Jenny?
3. if you were asked to follow in Jenny’s footsteps, do you think you could or would want to manage city Mortgage with a similar style?
(continued)
Case 7.3
Taking on Additional responsibilities
Jim Madison is manager of a district office for the social security administration. The office serves a community of 200,000 people and has a staff of 30 employees, most of whom work as claim representatives.
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 153
The primary work of the office is to provide the public with information about social security benefits and to process retirement, survivor, disabil- ity, and Medicare claims.
Jim has been the manager of the office for 6 years; during that time, he has made many improvements in the overall operations of the office. people in the community have a favorable view of the office and have few complaints about the services it provides. on the annual survey of community service organizations, the district office receives consistently high marks for overall effectiveness and customer satisfaction.
almost all of the employees who work for Jim have been employed at the district office for 6 years or more; one employee has been there for 22 years. although Jim takes pride in knowing all of them personally, he calls on a few of them more frequently than others to help him accomplish his goals.
When it comes to training staff members about new laws affecting claim procedures, Jim relies heavily on two particular claim representatives, shirley and patti, both of whom are very knowledgeable and competent. shirley and patti view the additional training responsibilities as a challenge. This helps Jim: he does not need to do the job himself or supervise them closely because they are highly respected people within the office, and they have a history of being mature and conscientious about their work. shirley and patti like the additional responsibility because it gives them greater recognition and increased benefits from receiving positive job appraisals.
To showcase the office’s services to the community, Jim calls on two other employees, Ted and Jana. Ted and Jana serve as field representatives for the office and give presentations to community organizations about the nature of social security and how it serves the citizens of the district. in addition, they speak on local radio stations, answering call-in questions about the various complexities of social security benefits.
although many of the claim people in the office could act as field repre- sentatives, Jim typically calls on Ted and Jana because of their willingness to take on the public relations challenge and because of their special capabilities in this area. This is advantageous for Jim for two reasons: First, these people do an outstanding job in representing the office to the public. second, Jim is a reticent person, and he finds it quite threaten- ing to be in the public eye. Ted and Jana like to take on this additional role because it gives them added prestige and greater freedom. Being a field representative has its perks because field staff can function as their own bosses when they are not in the office; they can set their own sched- ules and come and go as they please.
a third area in which Jim calls on a few representatives for added effort is in helping him supervise the slower claim representatives, who seem to be continually behind in writing up the case reports of their clients.
(Continued)
154 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
When even a few staff members get behind with their work, it affects the entire office operation. To ameliorate this problem, Jim calls on Glenda and annie, who are both highly talented, to help the slower staff complete their case reports. although it means taking on more work themselves, Glenda and annie do it to be kind and to help the office run more smoothly. other than personal satisfaction, no additional benefits accrue to them for taking on the additional responsibilities.
overall, the people who work under Jim’s leadership are satisfied with his supervision. There are some who feel that he caters too much to a few special representatives, but most of the staff think Jim is fair and impartial. Even though he depends more on a few, Jim tries very hard to attend to the wants and needs of his entire staff.
Questions
1. From an LMX theory point of view, how would you describe Jim’s relationships with his employees at the district social security office?
2. can you identify an in-group and an out-group?
3. do you think the trust and respect Jim places in some of his staff are productive or counterproductive? Why?
4. as suggested in the chapter, leadership making recommends that the leader build high-quality relationships with all of the followers. how would you evaluate Jim’s leadership in regards to leadership making? discuss.
LEADErsHip insTrUMEnT
Researchers have used many different questionnaires to study LMX theory. All of them have been designed to measure the quality of the working rela- tionship between leaders and followers. We have chosen to include in this chapter the LMX 7, a seven-item questionnaire that provides a reliable and valid measure of the quality of leader–member exchanges (Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995).
The LMX 7 is designed to measure three dimensions of leader–member relationships: respect, trust, and obligation. It assesses the degree to which leaders and followers have mutual respect for each other’s capabilities, feel a deepening sense of reciprocal trust, and have a strong sense of obligation to one another. Taken together, these dimensions are the ingredients of strong partnerships.
(continued)
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 155
LMX 7 Questionnaire
Instructions: This questionnaire contains items that ask you to describe your relationship with either your leader or one of your followers. For each of the items, indicate the degree to which you think the item is true for you by circling one of the responses that appear below the item.
1. do you know where you stand with your leader (follower) . . . [and] do you usually know how satisfied your leader (follower) is with what you do?
rarely occasionally sometimes Fairly often Very often
1 2 3 4 5
2. how well does your leader (follower) understand your job problems and needs?
not a bit a little a fair amount Quite a bit a great deal
1 2 3 4 5
3. how well does your leader (follower) recognize your potential?
not at all a little Moderately Mostly Fully
1 2 3 4 5
4. regardless of how much formal authority your leader (follower) has built into his or her position, what are the chances that your leader (follower) would use his or her power to help you solve problems in your work?
none small Moderate high Very high
1 2 3 4 5
5. again, regardless of the amount of formal authority your leader (fol- lower) has, what are the chances that he or she would “bail you out” at his or her expense?
none small Moderate high Very high
1 2 3 4 5
6. i have enough confidence in my leader (follower) that i would defend and justify his or her decision if he or she were not present to do so.
strongly disagree disagree neutral agree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5
7. how would you characterize your working relationship with your leader (follower)?
Extremely Worse than average Better than Extremely ineffective average average effective
1 2 3 4 5
156 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
By completing the LMX 7, you can gain a fuller understanding of how LMX theory works. The score you obtain on the questionnaire reflects the quality of your leader–member relationships, and indicates the degree to which your relationships are characteristic of partnerships, as described in the LMX model.
you can complete the questionnaire both as a leader and as a follower. in the leader role, you would complete the questionnaire multiple times, assessing the quality of the relationships you have with each of your fol- lowers. in the follower role, you would complete the questionnaire based on the leaders to whom you report.
scoring interpretation
although the LMX 7 is most commonly used by researchers to explore theoretical questions, you can also use it to analyze your own leadership style. you can interpret your LMX 7 scores using the following guidelines: very high = 30–35, high = 25–29, moderate = 20–24, low = 15–19, and very low = 7–14. scores in the upper ranges indicate stronger, higher- quality leader–member exchanges (e.g., in-group members), whereas scores in the lower ranges indicate exchanges of lesser quality (e.g., out- group members).
soUrcE: reprinted from “relationship-Based approach to Leadership: development of Leader–Member Exchange (LMX) Theory of Leadership over 25 years: applying a Multi- Level, Multi-domain perspective,” by G. B. Graen and M. Uhl-Bien, 1995, Leadership Quarterly, 6(2), 219–247. copyright © 1995. reprinted with permission from Elsevier science.
The LMX score
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 157
sUMMAry
Since it first appeared more than 30 years ago under the title “vertical dyad linkage (VDL) theory,” LMX theory has been and continues to be a much- studied approach to leadership. LMX theory addresses leadership as a pro- cess centered on the interactions between leaders and followers. It makes the leader–member relationship the pivotal concept in the leadership process.
In the early studies of LMX theory, a leader’s relationship to the overall work unit was viewed as a series of vertical dyads, categorized as being of two dif- ferent types: Leader–member dyads based on expanded role relationships were called the leader’s in-group, and those based on formal job descriptions were called the leader’s out-group. It is believed that followers become in- group members based on how well they get along with the leader and whether they are willing to expand their role responsibilities. Followers who maintain only formal hierarchical relationships with their leader are out-group mem- bers. Whereas in-group members receive extra influence, opportunities, and rewards, out-group members receive standard job benefits.
Subsequent studies of LMX theory were directed toward how leader– member exchanges affect organizational performance. Researchers found that high-quality exchanges between leaders and followers produced mul- tiple positive outcomes (e.g., less employee turnover, greater organizational commitment, and more promotions). In general, researchers determined that good leader–member exchanges result in followers feeling better, accomplishing more, and helping the organization prosper.
A select body of LMX research focuses on leadership making, which empha- sizes that leaders should try to develop high-quality exchanges with all of their followers. Leadership making develops over time and includes a stranger phase, an acquaintance phase, and a mature partnership phase. By taking on and fulfilling new role responsibilities, followers move through these three phases to develop mature partnerships with their leaders. These partnerships, which are marked by a high degree of mutual trust, respect, and obligation, have positive payoffs for the individuals themselves, and help the organization run more effectively.
There are several positive features to LMX theory. First, LMX theory is a strong descriptive approach that explains how leaders use some followers (in-group members) more than others (out-group members) to accomplish organizational goals effectively. Second, LMX theory is unique in that, unlike other approaches, it makes the leader–member relationship the focal
LMX Explanation
158 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
point of the leadership process. Related to this focus, LMX theory is note- worthy because it directs our attention to the importance of effective com- munication in leader–member relationships. In addition, it reminds us to be evenhanded in how we relate to our followers. Last, LMX theory is sup- ported by a multitude of studies that link high-quality leader–member exchanges to positive organizational outcomes.
There are also negative features in LMX theory. First, the early formulation of LMX theory (VDL theory) runs counter to our principles of fairness and justice in the workplace by suggesting that some members of the work unit receive special attention and others do not. The perceived inequalities cre- ated by the use of in-groups can have a devastating impact on the feelings, attitudes, and behavior of out-group members. Second, LMX theory empha- sizes the importance of leader–member exchanges but fails to explain the intricacies of how one goes about creating high-quality exchanges. Although the model promotes building trust, respect, and commitment in relation- ships, it does not fully explicate how this takes place. Third, researchers have not adequately explained the contextual factors that influence LMX rela- tionships. Finally, there are questions about whether the measurement pro- cedures used in LMX research are adequate to fully capture the complexities of the leader–member exchange process.
sharpen your skills with saGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
rEFErEncEs
Anand, S., Hu, J., Liden, R. C., & Vidyarthi, P. R. (2011). Leader-member exchange: Recent research findings and prospects for the future. In A. Bryman, D. Collinson, K. Grint, G. Jackson, & B. Uhl-Bien (Eds.), The SAGE handbook of leadership (pp. 311–325). London: SAGE.
Atwater, L., & Carmeli, A. (2009). Leader-member exchange, feelings of energy, and involvement in creative work. Leadership Quarterly, 20, 264–275.
Dansereau, F., Graen, G. B., & Haga, W. (1975). A vertical dyad linkage approach to leadership in formal organizations. Organizational Behavior and Human Perfor- mance, 13, 46–78.
Gerstner, C. R., & Day, D. V. (1997). Meta-analytic review of leader-member exchange theory: Correlates and construct issues. Journal of Applied Psychology, 82, 827–844.
chapter 7 Leader–Member Exchange Theory 159
Graen, G. B. (1976). Role-making processes within complex organizations. In M. D. Dunnette (Ed.), Handbook of industrial and organizational psychology (pp. 1202– 1245). Chicago: Rand McNally.
Graen, G. B., & Cashman, J. (1975). A role-making model of leadership in formal organizations: A developmental approach. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership frontiers (pp. 143–166). Kent, OH: Kent State University Press.
Graen, G. B., & Scandura, T. A. (1987). Toward a psychology of dyadic organizing. In B. Staw & L. L. Cumming (Eds.), Research in organizational behavior (Vol. 9, pp. 175–208). Greenwich, CT: JAI.
Graen, G. B., & Uhl-Bien, M. (1991). The transformation of professionals into self- managing and partially self-designing contributions: Toward a theory of leadership making. Journal of Management Systems, 3(3), 33–48.
Graen, G. B., & Uhl-Bien, M. (1995). Relationship-based approach to leadership: Development of leader–member exchange (LMX) theory of leadership over 25 years: Applying a multi-level, multi-domain perspective. Leadership Quarterly, 6(2), 219–247.
Harris, K. J., Wheeler, A. R., & Kacmar, K. M. (2009). Leader-member exchange and empowerment: Direct and interactive effects on job satisfaction, turnover inten- tions, and performance. Leadership Quarterly, 20, 371–382.
Harter, N., & Evanecky, D. (2002). Fairness in leader–member exchange theory: Do we all belong on the inside? Leadership Review, 2(2), 1–7.
Ilies, R., Nahrgang, J. D., & Morgeson, F. P. (2007). Leader-member exchange and citizenship behaviors: A meta-analysis. Journal of Applied Psychology, 92(1), 269–277.
Katz, D. (1964). Motivational basis of organizational behavior. Behavioral Science, 9 131–146.
Liden, R. C., Wayne, S. J., & Stilwell, D. (1993). A longitudinal study on the early development of leader–member exchange. Journal of Applied Psychology, 78, 662–674.
McClane, W. E. (1991). Implications of member role differentiation: Analysis of a key concept in the LMX model of leadership. Group & Organization Studies, 16(1), 102–113.
Nahrgang, J. D., Morgeson, R. P., & Ilies, R. (2009). The development of leader- member exchanges: Exploring how personality and performance influence leader and member relationships over time. Organizational Behavior and Human Decision Processes, 108, 256–266.
Organ, D. W. (1988). Organizational citizenship behavior: The good soldier syndrome. Lexington, MA: Lexington Books.
Scandura, T. A. (1999). Rethinking leader–member exchange: An organizational jus- tice perspective. Leadership Quarterly, 10(1), 25–40.
Schriesheim, C. A., Castro, S. L., & Cogliser, C. C. (1999). Leader–member exchange (LMX) research: A comprehensive review of theory, measurement, and data- analytic practices. Leadership Quarterly, 10, 63–113.
160 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Schriesheim, C. A., Castro, S. L., Zhou, X., & Yammarino, F. J. (2001). The folly of theorizing “A” but testing “B”: A selective level-of-analysis review of the field and a detailed leader–member exchange illustration. Leadership Quarterly, 12, 515–551.
Uhl-Bien, M., Maslyn, J., & Ospina, S. (2012). The nature of relational leadership: A multitheoretical lens on leadership relationships and processes. In D. V. Day & J. Antonakis (Eds.), The nature of leadership (2nd ed., pp. 289–330). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Yukl, G. (1994). Leadership in organizations (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
8
Transformational Leadership
DescripTion
One of the current and most popular approaches to leadership that has been the focus of much research since the early 1980s is the transformational approach. Transformational leadership is part of the “New Leadership” paradigm (Bryman, 1992), which gives more attention to the charismatic and affective elements of leadership. In a content analysis of articles pub- lished in Leadership Quarterly, Lowe and Gardner (2001) found that one third of the research was about transformational or charismatic leadership. Similarly, Antonakis (2012) found that the number of papers and citations in the field has grown at an increasing rate, not only in traditional areas like management and social psychology, but in other disciplines such as nursing, education, and industrial engineering. Bass and Riggio (2006) suggested that transformational leadership’s popularity might be due to its emphasis on intrinsic motivation and follower development, which fits the needs of today’s work groups, who want to be inspired and empowered to succeed in times of uncertainty. Clearly, many scholars are studying transformational leadership, and it occupies a central place in leadership research.
As its name implies, transformational leadership is a process that changes and transforms people. It is concerned with emotions, values, ethics, stan- dards, and long-term goals. It includes assessing followers’ motives, satisfying their needs, and treating them as full human beings. Transformational lead- ership involves an exceptional form of influence that moves followers to accomplish more than what is usually expected of them. It is a process that often incorporates charismatic and visionary leadership.
Transformational Leadership
162 Leadership Theory and pracTice
An encompassing approach, transformational leadership can be used to describe a wide range of leadership, from very specific attempts to influence followers on a one-to-one level, to very broad attempts to influence whole organizations and even entire cultures. Although the transformational leader plays a pivotal role in precipitating change, followers and leaders are inextri- cably bound together in the transformation process.
Transformational Leadership Defined
The term transformational leadership was first coined by Downton (1973). Its emergence as an important approach to leadership began with a classic work by political sociologist James MacGregor Burns titled Leadership (1978). In his work, Burns attempted to link the roles of leadership and followership. He wrote of leaders as people who tap the motives of followers in order to better reach the goals of leaders and followers (p. 18). For Burns, leadership is quite different from power because it is inseparable from followers’ needs.
Transformational vs. Transactional Leadership. Burns distinguished between two types of leadership: transactional and transformational. Transactional leadership refers to the bulk of leadership models, which focus on the exchanges that occur between leaders and their followers. Politicians who win votes by promising “no new taxes” are demonstrating transactional leadership. Similarly, managers who offer promotions to employees who surpass their goals are exhibiting transactional leadership. In the classroom, teachers are being transactional when they give students a grade for work completed. The exchange dimension of transactional leadership is very common and can be observed at many levels throughout all types of organizations.
In contrast to transactional leadership, transformational leadership is the process whereby a person engages with others and creates a connection that raises the level of motivation and morality in both the leader and the fol- lower. This type of leader is attentive to the needs and motives of followers and tries to help followers reach their fullest potential. Burns points to Mohandas Gandhi as a classic example of transformational leadership. Gandhi raised the hopes and demands of millions of his people, and, in the process, was changed himself.
Another good example of transformational leadership can be observed in the life of Ryan White. This teenager raised the American people’s awareness about AIDS and in the process became a spokesperson for increasing gov- ernment support of AIDS research. In the organizational world, an example of transformational leadership would be a manager who attempts to change
James MacGregor Burns
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 163
his or her company’s corporate values to reflect a more humane standard of fairness and justice. In the process, both the manager and the followers may emerge with a stronger and higher set of moral values.
Pseudotransformational Leadership. Because the conceptualization of transformational leadership set forth by Burns (1978) includes raising the level of morality in others, it is difficult to use this term when describing leaders such as Adolf Hitler and Saddam Hussein, who were transforming but in a negative way. To deal with this problem Bass (1998) coined the term pseudotransformational leadership. This term refers to leaders who are self-consumed, exploitive, and power oriented, with warped moral values (Bass & Riggio, 2006). Pseudotransformational leadership is considered personalized leadership, which focuses on the leader’s own interests rather than on the interests of others (Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999). Authentic transformational leadership is socialized leadership, which is concerned with the collective good. Socialized transformational leaders transcend their own interests for the sake of others (Howell & Avolio, 1993).
In a series of four experimental studies, Christie, Barling, and Turner (2011) set forth a preliminary model of pseudotransformational leadership that reflected four components of transformational leadership discussed later in this chapter: idealized influence, inspirational motivation, intellectual stimulation, and individualized consideration. This model helps to clarify the meaning of pseudotransformational leadership. It suggests that pseu- dotransformational leadership is inspired leadership that is self-serving, is unwilling to encourage independent thought in followers, and exhibits little general caring for others. A pseudotransformational leader has strong inspirational talent and appeal but is manipulative and dominates and directs followers toward his or her own values. It is leadership that is threatening to the welfare of followers because it ignores the common good.
To sort out the complexities related to the “moral uplifting” component of authentic transformational leadership, Zhu, Avolio, Riggio, and Sosik (2011) proposed a theoretical model examining how authentic transformational leadership influences the ethics of individual followers and groups. The authors hypothesize that authentic transformational leadership positively affects followers’ moral identities and moral emotions (e.g., empathy and guilt) and this, in turn, leads to moral decision making and moral action by the followers. Furthermore, the authors theorize that authentic transforma- tional leadership is positively associated with group ethical climate, decision making, and moral action. In the future, research is needed to test the valid- ity of the assumptions laid out in this model.
Transformational Leadership
164 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Transformational Leadership and Charisma
At about the same time Burns’s book was published, House (1976) published a theory of charismatic leadership. Since its publication, charismatic leader- ship has received a great deal of attention by researchers (e.g., Conger, 1999; Hunt & Conger, 1999). It is often described in ways that make it similar to, if not synonymous with, transformational leadership.
The word charisma was first used to describe a special gift that certain individuals possess that gives them the capacity to do extraordinary things. Weber (1947) provided the most well-known definition of cha- risma as a special personality characteristic that gives a person superhu- man or exceptional powers and is reserved for a few, is of divine origin, and results in the person being treated as a leader. Despite Weber’s emphasis on charisma as a personality characteristic, he also recognized the important role played by followers in validating charisma in these leaders (Bryman, 1992; House, 1976).
In his theory of charismatic leadership, House suggested that charismatic leaders act in unique ways that have specific charismatic effects on their fol- lowers (Table 8.1). For House, the personality characteristics of a charismatic leader include being dominant, having a strong desire to influence others, being self-confident, and having a strong sense of one’s own moral values.
In addition to displaying certain personality characteristics, charismatic leaders also demonstrate specific types of behaviors. First, they are strong role models for the beliefs and values they want their followers to adopt. For example, Gandhi advocated nonviolence and was an exemplary role model of civil disobedience. Second, charismatic leaders appear competent to fol- lowers. Third, they articulate ideological goals that have moral overtones. Martin Luther King, Jr.’s famous “I Have a Dream” speech is an example of this type of charismatic behavior.
Fourth, charismatic leaders communicate high expectations for followers, and they exhibit confidence in followers’ abilities to meet these expectations. The impact of this behavior is to increase followers’ sense of competence and self- efficacy (Avolio & Gibbons, 1988), which in turn improves their performance.
Fifth, charismatic leaders arouse task-relevant motives in followers that may include affiliation, power, or esteem. For example, former U.S. President John F. Kennedy appealed to the human values of the American people when he stated, “Ask not what your country can do for you; ask what you can do for your country.”
Teaching charisma
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 165
According to House’s charismatic theory, several effects are the direct result of charismatic leadership. They include follower trust in the leader’s ideol- ogy, similarity between the followers’ beliefs and the leader’s beliefs, unques- tioning acceptance of the leader, expression of affection toward the leader, follower obedience, identification with the leader, emotional involvement in the leader’s goals, heightened goals for followers, and increased follower con- fidence in goal achievement. Consistent with Weber, House contends that these charismatic effects are more likely to occur in contexts in which fol- lowers feel distress because in stressful situations followers look to leaders to deliver them from their difficulties.
House’s charismatic theory has been extended and revised through the years (see Conger, 1999; Conger & Kanungo, 1998). One major revision to the theory was made by Shamir, House, and Arthur (1993). They pos- tulated that charismatic leadership transforms followers’ self-concepts and tries to link the identity of followers to the collective identity of the orga- nization. Charismatic leaders forge this link by emphasizing the intrinsic rewards of work and deemphasizing the extrinsic rewards. The hope is that followers will view work as an expression of themselves. Throughout the process, leaders express high expectations for followers and help them gain a sense of confidence and self-efficacy. In summary, charismatic leadership works because it ties followers and their self-concepts to the organizational identity.
Table 8.1 personality characteristics, Behaviors, and effects on Followers of charismatic Leadership
Personality Characteristics Behaviors Effects on Followers
Dominant
Desire to influence
Self-confident
Strong moral values
Sets strong role model
Shows competence
Articulates goals
Communicates high expectations
Expresses confidence
Arouses motives
Trust in leader’s ideology
Belief similarity between leader and follower
Unquestioning acceptance
Affection toward leader
Obedience
Identification with leader
Emotional involvement
Heightened goals
Increased confidence
romance of Leadership
166 Leadership Theory and pracTice
A Model of Transformational Leadership
In the mid-1980s, Bass (1985) provided a more expanded and refined version of transformational leadership that was based on, but not fully consistent with, the prior works of Burns (1978) and House (1976). In his approach, Bass extended Burns’s work by giving more attention to followers’ rather than lead- ers’ needs, by suggesting that transformational leadership could apply to situ- ations in which the outcomes were not positive, and by describing transac- tional and transformational leadership as a single continuum (Figure 8.1) rather than mutually independent continua (Yammarino, 1993). Bass extended House’s work by giving more attention to the emotional elements and origins of charisma and by suggesting that charisma is a necessary but not sufficient condition for transformational leadership (Yammarino, 1993).
Transformational Leadership
Transactional Leadership
Laissez–Faire Leadership
Figure 8.1 Leadership continuum From Transformational to Laissez-Faire Leadership
Bass (1985, p. 20) argued that transformational leadership motivates follow- ers to do more than expected by (a) raising followers’ levels of consciousness about the importance and value of specified and idealized goals, (b) getting followers to transcend their own self-interest for the sake of the team or organization, and (c) moving followers to address higher-level needs. An elaboration of the dynamics of the transformation process is provided in his model of transformational and transactional leadership (Bass, 1985, 1990; Bass & Avolio, 1993, 1994). Additional clarification of the model is provided by Avolio in his book Full Leadership Development: Building the Vital Forces in Organizations (1999).
As can be seen in Table 8.2, the model of transformational and transac- tional leadership incorporates seven different factors. These factors are also illustrated in the Full Range of Leadership model, which is provided in Figure 8.2 on page 168. A discussion of each of these seven factors will help
Transformational Leadership
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 167
to clarify Bass’s model. This discussion will be divided into three parts: transformational factors (4), transactional factors (2), and the nonleadership, nontransactional factor (1).
Table 8.2 Leadership Factors
Transformational Leadership
Transactional Leadership
Laissez–Faire Leadership
Factor 1
Idealized influence
Charisma
Factor 2
Inspirational motivation
Factor 3
Intellectual stimulation
Factor 4
Individualized consideration
Factor 5
Contingent reward
Constructive transactions
Factor 6
Management-by-exception
Active and passive
Corrective transactions
Factor 7
Laissez–faire
Nontransactional
Transformational Leadership Factors
Transformational leadership is concerned with improving the performance of followers and developing followers to their fullest potential (Avolio, 1999; Bass & Avolio, 1990a). People who exhibit transformational leadership often have a strong set of internal values and ideals, and they are effective at moti- vating followers to act in ways that support the greater good rather than their own self-interests (Kuhnert, 1994).
Idealized Influence. Factor 1 is called charisma or idealized influence. It is the emotional component of leadership (Antonakis, 2012). Idealized influence describes leaders who act as strong role models for followers; followers identify with these leaders and want very much to emulate them. These leaders usually have very high standards of moral and ethical conduct and can be counted on to do the right thing. They are deeply respected by followers, who usually place a great deal of trust in them. They provide followers with a vision and a sense of mission.
The idealized influence factor is measured on two components: an attribu- tional component that refers to the attributions of leaders made by followers based on perceptions they have of their leaders, and a behavioral component that refers to followers’ observations of leader behavior.
innovative Leader Behaviors
168 Leadership Theory and pracTice
In essence, the charisma factor describes people who are special and who make others want to follow the vision they put forward. A person whose leadership exemplifies the charisma factor is Nelson Mandela, the first non-White pres- ident of South Africa. Mandela is viewed as a leader with high moral standards and a vision for South Africa that resulted in monumental change in how the people of South Africa would be governed. His charismatic qualities and the people’s response to them transformed an entire nation.
Effective
Ineffective
ActivePassive
Fr eq
ue nc
y
LEGEND
Nonleadership
LF Laissez-Faire Transactional
MBE-P Management-by-Exception, Passive MBE-A Management-by-Exception, Active CR Contingent Reward Transformational 4 I’s
Idealized Influence Inspirational Motivation Intellectual Stimulation Individualized Consideration
LF Laissez-Faire
MBE-P Management-by-Exception, Passive MBE-A Management-by-Exception, Active CR Contingent Reward
Idealized Influence Inspirational Motivation Intellectual Stimulation Individualized Consideration
4 I’s
CR
MBE-A
MBE-P
LF
Figure 8.2 Full range of Leadership Model
soUrce: From Bass, B. M., & avolio, B. J., Improving Organizational Effectiveness Through Transformational Leadership, © 1994, saGe publications, inc. reprinted with permission.
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 169
Inspirational Motivation. Factor 2 is called inspiration or inspirational motivation. This factor is descriptive of leaders who communicate high expectations to followers, inspiring them through motivation to become committed to and a part of the shared vision in the organization. In practice, leaders use symbols and emotional appeals to focus group members’ efforts to achieve more than they would in their own self-interest. Team spirit is enhanced by this type of leadership. An example of this factor would be a sales manager who motivates members of the sales force to excel in their work through encouraging words and pep talks that clearly communicate the integral role they play in the future growth of the company.
Intellectual Stimulation. Factor 3 is intellectual stimulation. It includes leadership that stimulates followers to be creative and innovative and to challenge their own beliefs and values as well as those of the leader and the organization.
This type of leadership supports followers as they try new approaches and develop innovative ways of dealing with organizational issues. It encourages followers to think things out on their own and engage in careful problem solving. An example of this type of leadership is a plant manager who promotes workers’ individual efforts to develop unique ways to solve problems that have caused slowdowns in production.
Individualized Consideration. Factor 4 of transformational leadership is called individualized consideration. This factor is representative of leaders who provide a supportive climate in which they listen carefully to the individual needs of followers. Leaders act as coaches and advisers while trying to assist followers in becoming fully actualized. These leaders may use delegation to help followers grow through personal challenges. An example of this type of leadership is a manager who spends time treating each employee in a caring and unique way. To some employees, the leader may give strong affiliation; to others, the leader may give specific directives with a high degree of structure.
In essence, transformational leadership produces greater effects than transactional leadership (Figure 8.3). Whereas transactional leadership results in expected outcomes, transformational leadership results in performance that goes well beyond what is expected. In a meta-analysis of 39 studies in the transformational literature, for example, Lowe, Kroeck, and Sivasubramaniam (1996) found that people who exhibited transformational leadership were perceived to be more effective leaders with better work outcomes than those who exhibited only transactional leadership. These
additive effect Mother Theresa
170 Leadership Theory and pracTice
findings were true for higher- and lower-level leaders, and for leaders in both public and private settings. Transformational leadership moves followers to accomplish more than what is usually expected of them. They become motivated to transcend their own self-interests for the good of the group or organization (Bass & Avolio, 1990a).
In a study of 220 employees at a large public transport company in Germany, Rowold and Heinitz (2007) found that transformational leadership augmented the impact of transactional leadership on employees’ performance and company profit. In addition, they found that transformational leadership and charismatic leadership were overlapping but unique constructs, and that both were different from transactional leadership.
Similarly, Nemanich and Keller (2007) examined the impact of transformational leadership on 447 employees from a large multinational firm who were going through a merger and being integrated into a new organization. They found that transformational leadership behaviors such as idealized influence, inspirational motivation, individualized consideration, and intellectual stimulation were positively related to acquisition acceptance, job satisfaction, and performance.
More recently, Tims, Bakker, and Xanthopoulou (2011) examined the relationship between transformational leadership and work engagement in
soUrce: adapted from “The implications of Transactional and Transformational Leadership for individual, Team, and organizational development,” by B. M. Bass and B. J. avolio, 1990a, Research in Organizational Change and Development, 4, 231–272.
Idealized Influence
Individualized Consideration
Inspirational Motivation
Intellectual Stimulation
+ +
+
+
Expected Outcomes
Performance Beyond
Expectations
TRANSACTIONAL LEADERSHIP
TRANSFORMATIONAL LEADERSHIP
Contingent Reward
Management- by-Exception
Figure 8.3 The additive effect of Transformational Leadership
Transformational or Transactional?
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 171
42 employees and their supervisors in two different organizations in the Netherlands. Findings revealed that employees became more engaged in their work (i.e., vigor, dedication, and absorption) when their supervisors were able to boost employees’ optimism through a transformational leadership style. These findings underscore the important role played by personal characteristics (i.e., optimism) in the transformational leadership- performance process.
Transactional Leadership Factors
Transactional leadership differs from transformational leadership in that the transactional leader does not individualize the needs of followers or focus on their personal development. Transactional leaders exchange things of value with followers to advance their own and their followers’ agendas (Kuhnert, 1994). Transactional leaders are influential because it is in the best interest of followers for them to do what the leader wants (Kuhnert & Lewis, 1987).
Contingent Reward. Factor 5, contingent reward, is the first of two transactional leadership factors (see Figure 8.2). It is an exchange process between leaders and followers in which effort by followers is exchanged for specified rewards. With this kind of leadership, the leader tries to obtain agreement from followers on what must be done and what the payoffs will be for the people doing it. An example of this type of transaction is a parent who negotiates with a child about how much television the child can watch after practicing the piano. Another example often occurs in the academic setting: A dean negotiates with a college professor about the number and quality of publications he or she needs to have written in order to receive tenure and promotion.
Management-by-Exception. Factor 6 is called management-by-exception. It is leadership that involves corrective criticism, negative feedback, and negative reinforcement. Management-by-exception takes two forms: active and passive. A leader using the active form of management-by-exception watches followers closely for mistakes or rule violations and then takes corrective action. An example of active management-by-exception can be illustrated in the leadership of a sales supervisor who daily monitors how employees approach customers. She quickly corrects salespeople who are slow to approach customers in the prescribed manner. A leader using the passive form intervenes only after standards have not been met or problems have arisen. An example of passive
172 Leadership Theory and pracTice
management-by-exception is illustrated in the leadership of a supervisor who gives an employee a poor performance evaluation without ever talking with the employee about her or his prior work performance. In essence, both the active and passive management types use more negative reinforcement patterns than the positive reinforcement pattern described in Factor 5 under contingent reward.
nonleadership Factor
In the model, the nonleadership factor diverges farther from transactional leadership and represents behaviors that are nontransactional.
Laissez-Faire. Factor 7 describes leadership that falls at the far right side of the transactional–transformational leadership continuum (see Figure 8.1). This factor represents the absence of leadership. As the French phrase implies, the laissez-faire leader takes a “hands-off, let-things-ride” approach. This leader abdicates responsibility, delays decisions, gives no feedback, and makes little effort to help followers satisfy their needs. There is no exchange with followers or attempt to help them grow. An example of a laissez-faire leader is the president of a small manufacturing firm who calls no meetings with plant supervisors, has no long-range plan for the firm, acts detached, and makes little contact with employees.
Other Transformational Perspectives
In addition to Bass’s (1985, 1990; Bass & Avolio, 1994) work, two other lines of research have contributed in unique ways to our understanding of the nature of transformational leadership. They are the research of Bennis and Nanus (1985) and the work of Kouzes and Posner (1987, 2002). These schol- ars used similar research methods. They identified a number of middle- or senior-level leaders and conducted interviews with them, using open-ended, semistructured questionnaires. From this information, they constructed their models of leadership.
Bennis and nanus
Bennis and Nanus (1985) asked 90 leaders basic questions such as “What are your strengths and weaknesses?” “What past events most influenced your leadership approach?” and “What were the critical points in your career?” From the answers leaders provided to these questions, Bennis and
Maxwell's Five Levels
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 173
Nanus identified four common strategies used by leaders in transforming organizations.
First, transforming leaders had a clear vision of the future state of their orga- nizations. It was an image of an attractive, realistic, and believable future (Bennis & Nanus, 1985, p. 89). The vision usually was simple, understandable, beneficial, and energy creating. The compelling nature of the vision touched the experiences of followers and pulled them into supporting the organiza- tion. When an organization has a clear vision, it is easier for people within the organization to learn how they fit in with the overall direction of the organization and even the society in general. It empowers them because they feel they are a significant dimension of a worthwhile enterprise (pp. 90–91). Bennis and Nanus found that, to be successful, the vision had to grow out of the needs of the entire organization and to be claimed by those within it. Although leaders play a large role in articulating the vision, the emergence of the vision originates from both the leaders and the followers.
Second, transforming leaders were social architects for their organizations. This means they created a shape or form for the shared meanings people maintained within their organizations. These leaders communicated a direc- tion that transformed their organization’s values and norms. In many cases, these leaders were able to mobilize people to accept a new group identity or a new philosophy for their organizations.
Third, transforming leaders created trust in their organizations by making their own positions clearly known and then standing by them. Trust has to do with being predictable or reliable, even in situations that are uncertain. For organizations, leaders built trust by articulating a direction and then consistently implementing the direction even though the vision may have involved a high degree of uncertainty. Bennis and Nanus (1985) found that when leaders established trust in an organization, it gave the organization a sense of integrity analogous to a healthy identity (p. 48).
Fourth, transforming leaders used creative deployment of self through positive self-regard. Leaders knew their strengths and weaknesses, and they emphasized their strengths rather than dwelling on their weaknesses. Based on an awareness of their own competence, effective leaders were able to immerse themselves in their tasks and the overarching goals of their organizations. They were able to fuse a sense of self with the work at hand. Bennis and Nanus also found that positive self-regard in leaders had a reciprocal impact on followers, creating in them feelings of confidence and high expectations. In addition, leaders in the study were committed to learning and relearning, so in their organizations there was consistent emphasis on education.
Workplace civility
174 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Kouzes and posner
Kouzes and Posner (1987, 2002) developed their model by interviewing lead- ers about leadership. They interviewed more than 1,300 middle- and senior- level managers in private and public sector organizations and asked them to describe their “personal best” experiences as leaders. Based on a content analysis of these descriptions, Kouzes and Posner constructed a model of leadership.
The Kouzes and Posner model consists of five fundamental practices that enable leaders to get extraordinary things accomplished: model the way, inspire a shared vision, challenge the process, enable others to act, and encourage the heart. For each of the five practices of exemplary leadership, Kouzes and Posner also have identified two commitments that serve as strategies for practicing exemplary leadership.
Model the Way. To model the way, leaders need to be clear about their own values and philosophy. They need to find their own voice and express it to others. Exemplary leaders set a personal example for others by their own behaviors. They also follow through on their promises and commitments and affirm the common values they share with others.
Inspire a Shared Vision. Effective leaders create compelling visions that can guide people’s behavior. They are able to visualize positive outcomes in the future and communicate them to others. Leaders also listen to the dreams of others and show them how their dreams can be realized. Through inspiring visions, leaders challenge others to transcend the status quo to do something for others.
Challenge the Process. Challenging the process means being willing to change the status quo and step into the unknown. It includes being willing to innovate, grow, and improve. Exemplary leaders are like pioneers: They want to experiment and try new things. They are willing to take risks to make things better. When exemplary leaders take risks, they do it one step at a time, learning from their mistakes as they go.
Enable Others to Act. Outstanding leaders are effective at working with people. They build trust with others and promote collaboration. Teamwork and cooperation are highly valued by these leaders. They listen closely to diverse points of view and treat others with dignity and respect. They also allow others to make choices, and they support the decisions that others make. In short, they create environments where people can feel good about their work and how it contributes to the greater community.
philanthropic Leadership
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 175
Encourage the Heart. Leaders encourage the heart by rewarding others for their accomplishments. It is natural for people to want support and recognition. Effective leaders are attentive to this need and are willing to give praise to workers for jobs well done. They use authentic celebrations and rituals to show appreciation and encouragement to others. The outcome of this kind of support is greater collective identity and community spirit.
Overall, the Kouzes and Posner model emphasizes behaviors and has a pre- scriptive quality: It recommends what people need to do in order to become effective leaders. The five practices and their accompanying commitments provide a unique set of prescriptions for leaders. Kouzes and Posner (2002, p. 13) stressed that the five practices of exemplary leadership are available to everyone and are not reserved for those with “special” ability. The model is not about personality: It is about practice.
To measure the behaviors described in the model, Kouzes and Posner devel- oped the Leadership Practices Inventory (LPI). The LPI is a 360-degree leadership assessment tool that consists of 30 questions that assess individual leadership competencies. It has been widely used in leadership training and development.
How Does THe TransFormaTionaL approacH worK? ————————————————————————-
The transformational approach to leadership is a broad-based perspective that encompasses many facets and dimensions of the leadership process. In general, it describes how leaders can initiate, develop, and carry out signifi- cant changes in organizations. Although not definitive, the steps followed by transformational leaders usually take the following form.
Transformational leaders set out to empower followers and nurture them in change. They attempt to raise the consciousness in individuals and to get them to transcend their own self-interests for the sake of others. For example, Jung, Chow, and Wu (2003) studied upper-level leadership in 32 Taiwanese companies and found that transformational leadership was directly related to organizational innovation. Transformational leadership created a culture in which employees felt empowered and encouraged to freely discuss and try new things.
To create change, transformational leaders become strong role models for their followers. They have a highly developed set of moral values and a self- determined sense of identity (Avolio & Gibbons, 1988). They are confident,
achieving More Than expected
176 Leadership Theory and pracTice
competent, and articulate, and they express strong ideals. They listen to followers and are not intolerant of opposing viewpoints. A spirit of coop- eration often develops between these leaders and their followers. Followers want to emulate transformational leaders because they learn to trust them and believe in the ideas for which they stand.
It is common for transformational leaders to create a vision. The vision emerges from the collective interests of various individuals and units in an organization. The vision is a focal point for transformational leadership. It gives the leader and the organization a conceptual map for where the orga- nization is headed; it gives meaning and clarifies the organization’s identity. Furthermore, the vision gives followers a sense of identity within the orga- nization and also a sense of self-efficacy (Shamir et al., 1993).
The transformational approach also requires that leaders become social architects. This means that they make clear the emerging values and norms of the organization. They involve themselves in the culture of the organiza- tion and help shape its meaning. People need to know their roles and under- stand how they contribute to the greater purposes of the organization. Transformational leaders are out front in interpreting and shaping for orga- nizations the shared meanings that exist within them.
Throughout the process, transformational leaders are effective at working with people. They build trust and foster collaboration with others. Trans- formational leaders encourage others and celebrate their accomplishments. In the end, transformational leadership results in people feeling better about themselves and their contributions to the greater common good.
sTrengTHs
In its present stage of development, the transformational approach has several strengths. First, transformational leadership has been widely researched from many different perspectives, including a series of qualitative studies of prom- inent leaders and CEOs in large, well-known organizations. It has also been the focal point for a large body of leadership research since its introduction in the 1970s. For example, content analysis of all the articles published in Leadership Quarterly from 1990 to 2000 showed that 34% of the articles were about transformational or charismatic leadership (Lowe & Gardner, 2001).
Second, transformational leadership has intuitive appeal. The transforma- tional perspective describes how the leader is out front advocating change
inspiring Leaders
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 177
for others; this concept is consistent with society’s popular notion of what leadership means. People are attracted to transformational leadership because it makes sense to them. It is appealing that a leader will provide a vision for the future.
Third, transformational leadership treats leadership as a process that occurs between followers and leaders. Because this process incorporates both the followers’ and the leader’s needs, leadership is not the sole responsibility of a leader but rather emerges from the interplay between leaders and followers. The needs of others are central to the transformational leader. As a result, followers gain a more prominent position in the leadership process because their attributions are instrumental in the evolving transformational process (Bryman, 1992, p. 176).
Fourth, the transformational approach provides a broader view of leader- ship that augments other leadership models. Many leadership models focus primarily on how leaders exchange rewards for achieved goals—the transactional process. The transformational approach provides an expanded picture of leadership that includes not only the exchange of rewards, but also leaders’ attention to the needs and growth of followers (Avolio, 1999; Bass, 1985).
Fifth, transformational leadership places a strong emphasis on followers’ needs, values, and morals. Burns (1978) suggested that transformational leadership involves attempts by leaders to move people to higher standards of moral responsibility. It includes motivating followers to transcend their own self-interests for the good of the team, organization, or community (Howell & Avolio, 1993; Shamir et al., 1993). Transformational leadership is fundamentally morally uplifting (Avolio, 1999). This emphasis sets the transformational approach apart from all other approaches to leadership because it suggests that leadership has a moral dimension. Therefore, the coercive uses of power by people such as Hitler, Jim Jones, and David Koresh can be disregarded as models of leadership.
Finally, there is substantial evidence that transformational leadership is an effective form of leadership (Yukl, 1999). In a critique of transformational and charismatic leadership, Yukl reported that in studies using the Multi- factor Leadership Questionnaire (MLQ) to appraise leaders, transforma- tional leadership was positively related to follower satisfaction, motivation, and performance. Furthermore, in studies that used interviews and observa- tions, transformational leadership was shown to be effective in a variety of different situations.
Morals Matter
178 Leadership Theory and pracTice
criTicisms
Transformational leadership has several weaknesses. One criticism is that it lacks conceptual clarity. Because it covers such a wide range of activities and characteristics—including creating a vision, motivating, being a change agent, building trust, giving nurturance, and acting as a social architect, to name a few—it is difficult to define exactly the parameters of transforma- tional leadership. Specifically, research by Tracey and Hinkin (1998) has shown substantial overlap between each of the Four Is (idealized influence, inspirational motivation, intellectual stimulation, and individualized con- sideration), suggesting that the dimensions are not clearly delimited. Furthermore, the parameters of transformational leadership often overlap with similar conceptualizations of leadership. Bryman (1992), for example, pointed out that transformational and charismatic leadership often are treated synonymously, even though in some models of leadership (e.g., Bass, 1985) charisma is only one component of transformational leadership.
Another criticism revolves around how transformational leadership is mea- sured. Researchers typically have used some version of the MLQ to measure transformational leadership. However, some studies have challenged the validity of the MLQ . In some versions of the MLQ , the four factors of transformational leadership (the Four Is) correlate highly with each other, which means they are not distinct factors (Tejeda, Scandura, & Pillai, 2001). In addition, some of the transformational factors correlate with the transac- tional and laissez-faire factors, which means they may not be unique to the transformational model (Tejeda et al., 2001).
A third criticism is that transformational leadership treats leadership as a personality trait or personal predisposition rather than a behavior that peo- ple can learn (Bryman, 1992, pp. 100–102). If it is a trait, training people in this approach becomes more problematic because it is difficult to teach people how to change their traits. Even though many scholars, including Weber, House, and Bass, emphasized that transformational leadership is concerned with leader behaviors, such as how leaders involve themselves with followers, there is an inclination to see this approach from a trait per- spective. Perhaps this problem is exacerbated because the word transforma- tional creates images of one person being the most active component in the leadership process. For example, even though “creating a vision” involves follower input, there is a tendency to see transformational leaders as vision- aries. There is also a tendency to see transformational leaders as people who have special qualities that transform others. These images accentuate a trait characterization of transformational leadership.
comparing Leadership Theories
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 179
Fourth, researchers have not established that transformational leaders are actually able to transform individuals and organizations (Antonakis, 2012). There is evidence that indicates that transformational leadership is associ- ated with positive outcomes, such as organizational effectiveness; however, studies have not yet clearly established a causal link between transforma- tional leaders and changes in followers or organizations.
A fifth criticism some have made is that transformational leadership is elit- ist and antidemocratic (Avolio, 1999; Bass & Avolio, 1993). Transforma- tional leaders often play a direct role in creating changes, establishing a vision, and advocating new directions. This gives the strong impression that the leader is acting independently of followers or putting himself or herself above the followers’ needs. Although this criticism of elitism has been refuted by Bass and Avolio (1993) and Avolio (1999), who contended that transformational leaders can be directive and participative as well as demo- cratic and authoritarian, the substance of the criticism raises valid questions about transformational leadership.
Related to this criticism, some have argued that transformational leadership suffers from a “heroic leadership” bias (Yukl, 1999). Transformational leader- ship stresses that it is the leader who moves followers to do exceptional things. By focusing primarily on the leader, researchers have failed to give attention to shared leadership or reciprocal influence. Followers can influence leaders just as leaders can influence followers. More attention should be directed toward how leaders can encourage followers to challenge the leader’s vision and share in the leadership process.
A final criticism of transformational leadership is that it has the potential to be abused. Transformational leadership is concerned with changing people’s values and moving them to a new vision. But who is to determine whether the new directions are good and more affirming? Who decides that a new vision is a better vision? If the values to which the leader is moving his or her followers are not better, and if the set of human values is not more redeeming, then the leadership must be challenged. However, the dynamics of how followers challenge leaders or respond to their visions is not fully understood.
There is a need to understand how transformational leaders affect followers psychologically and how leaders respond to followers’ reactions. In fact, Burns argued that understanding this area (i.e., charisma and follower wor- ship) is one of the central problems in leadership studies today (Bailey & Axelrod, 2001). The charismatic nature of transformational leadership pres- ents significant risks for organizations because it can be used for destructive purposes (Conger, 1999; Howell & Avolio, 1993).
180 Leadership Theory and pracTice
History is full of examples of charismatic individuals who used coercive power to lead people to evil ends. For this reason, transformational leadership puts a burden on individuals and organizations to be aware of how they are being influenced and in what directions they are being asked to go. Christie et al. (2011) warn that astute followers need to be vigilant and pay careful attention to the vision of their leader, whether it is collective or self-focused, whether the leader is tolerant of opposing viewpoints, and whether the leader is caring of followers. The potential for abuse of transformational leadership is mitigated when followers are aware and engaged in how they are being led.
appLicaTion
Rather than being a model that tells leaders what to do, transformational lead- ership provides a broad set of generalizations of what is typical of leaders who are transforming or who work in transforming contexts. Unlike other leader- ship approaches, such as Situational Leadership (discussed in Chapter 5), transformational leadership does not provide a clearly defined set of assump- tions about how leaders should act in a particular situation to be successful. Rather, it provides a general way of thinking about leadership that emphasizes ideals, inspiration, innovations, and individual concerns. Transformational lead- ership requires that leaders be aware of how their own behavior relates to the needs of their followers and the changing dynamics within their organizations.
Bass and Avolio (1990a) suggested that transformational leadership can be taught to people at all levels in an organization and that it can positively affect a firm’s performance. It can be used in recruitment, selection and pro- motion, and training and development. It can also be used in improving team development, decision-making groups, quality initiatives, and reorga- nizations (Bass & Avolio, 1994).
Programs designed to develop transformational leadership usually require that leaders or their associates take the MLQ (Bass & Avolio, 1990b) or a similar questionnaire to determine the leader’s particular strengths and weaknesses in transformational leadership. Taking the MLQ helps leaders pinpoint areas in which they could improve their leadership. For example, leaders might learn that it would be beneficial if they were more confident in expressing their goals, or that they need to spend more time nurturing followers, or that they need to be more tolerant of opposing viewpoints. The MLQ is the spring- board to helping leaders improve a whole series of their leadership attributes.
One particular aspect of transformational leadership that has been given special emphasis in training programs is the process of building a vision. For
Become a Transformational Leader
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 181
example, it has become quite common for training programs to have leaders write elaborate statements that describe their own five-year career plans and their perceptions of the future directions for their organizations. Working with leaders on vision statements is one way to help them enhance their transformational leadership behavior. Another important aspect of training is teaching leaders to exhibit greater individual consideration and promote intellectual stimulation for their followers. Lowe et al. (1996) found that this is particularly valuable for lower-level leaders in organizations.
The desire to provide effective training in how to be more successful in demonstrating transactional and transformational leadership resulted in the development of a guide by Sosik and Jung (2010). This comprehensive, evidence-based approach includes self-assessments, 360-degree feedback, and leadership development planning. Their work serves as a thorough training guide that explains how, when, and why the full range of leadership behaviors work.
Overall, transformational leadership provides leaders with information about a full range of their behaviors, from nontransactional to transactional to trans- formational. In the next section, we provide some actual leadership examples to which the principles of transformational leadership can be applied.
case sTUDies
In the following section, three brief case studies (Cases 8.1, 8.2, and 8.3) from very different contexts are provided. Each case describes a situation in which transformational leadership is present to some degree. The questions at the end of each case point to some of the unique issues surrounding the use of transformational leadership in ongoing organizations.
Case 8.1
The Vision Failed
high Tech engineering (hTe) is a 50-year-old family-owned manufactur- ing company with 250 employees that produces small parts for the air- craft industry. The president of hTe is harold Barelli, who came to the company from a smaller business with strong credentials as a leader in
(Continued)
Transformational Leadership in education
182 Leadership Theory and pracTice
advanced aircraft technology. Before harold, the only other president of hTe was the founder and owner of the company. The organizational structure at hTe was very traditional, and it was supported by a very rich organizational culture.
as the new president, harold sincerely wanted to transform hTe. he wanted to prove that new technologies and advanced management techniques could make hTe one of the best manufacturing companies in the country. To that end, harold created a vision statement that was displayed throughout the company. The two-page statement, which had a strong democratic tone, described the overall purposes, directions, and values of the company.
during the first 3 years of harold’s tenure as president, several major reorganizations took place at the company. These were designed by harold and a select few of his senior managers. The intention of each reorganization was to implement advanced organizational structures to bolster the declared hTe vision.
yet the major outcome of each of the changes was to dilute the leader- ship and create a feeling of instability among the employees. Most of the changes were made from the top down, with little input from lower or middle management. some of the changes gave employees more con- trol in circumstances where they needed less, whereas other changes limited employee input in contexts where employees should have been given more input. There were some situations in which individual work- ers reported to three different bosses, and other situations in which one manager had far too many workers to oversee. rather than feeling com- fortable in their various roles at hTe, employees began to feel uncertain about their responsibilities and how they contributed to stated goals of the company. The overall effect of the reorganizations was a precipitous drop in worker morale and production.
in the midst of all the changes, the vision that harold had for the com- pany was lost. The instability that employees felt made it difficult for them to support the company’s vision. people at hTe complained that although mission statements were displayed throughout the company, no one understood in which direction they were going.
To the employees at hTe, harold was an enigma. hTe was an american company that produced U.s. products, but harold drove a foreign car. harold claimed to be democratic in his style of leadership, but he was arbitrary in how he treated people. he acted in a nondirective style toward some people, and he showed arbitrary control toward others. he wanted to be seen as a hands-on manager, but he delegated operational
(continued)
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 183
control of the company to others while he focused on external customer relations and matters of the board of directors.
at times harold appeared to be insensitive to employees’ concerns. he wanted hTe to be an environment in which everyone could feel empow- ered, but he often failed to listen closely to what employees were saying.
he seldom engaged in open, two-way communication. hTe had a long, rich history with many unique stories, but the employees felt that harold either misunderstood or did not care about that history.
Four years after arriving at hTe, harold stepped down as president after his operations officer ran the company into a large debt and cash-flow crisis. his dream of building hTe into a world-class manufacturing com- pany was never realized.
Questions
1. if you were consulting with the hTe board of directors soon after harold started making changes, what would you advise them regard- ing harold’s leadership from a transformational perspective?
2. did harold have a clear vision for hTe? Was he able to implement it?
3. how effective was harold as a change agent and social architect for hTe?
4. What would you advise harold to do differently if he had the chance to return as president of hTe?
Case 8.2
an exploration in Leadership
every year, dr. cook, a college professor, leads a group of 25 college students to the Middle east on an archaeological dig that usually lasts about 8 weeks. The participants, who come from big and small colleges throughout the country, usually have little prior knowledge or back- ground in what takes place during an excavation. dr. cook enjoys lead- ing these expeditions because he likes teaching students about archaeology and because the outcomes of the digs actually advance his own scholarly work.
(Continued)
184 Leadership Theory and pracTice
While planning for his annual summer excavation, dr. cook told the following story:
This summer will be interesting because i have 10 people returning from last year. Last year was quite a dig. during the first couple of weeks eve- rything was very disjointed. Team members seemed unmotivated and tired. in fact, there was one time early on when it seemed as if nearly half the students were either physically ill or mentally exhausted. students seemed lost and uncertain about the meaning of the entire project.
For example, it is our tradition to get up every morning at 4:30 a.m. to depart for the excavation site at 5:00 a.m. however, during the first weeks of the dig, few people were ever ready at 5, even after several reminders.
every year it takes some time for people to learn where they fit with each other and with the purposes of the dig. The students all come from such different backgrounds. some are from small, private, religious schools, and others are from large state universities. each comes with a different agenda, different skills, and different work habits. one person may be a good photographer, another a good artist, and another a good surveyor. it is my job to complete the excavation with the resources available to us.
at the end of Week 2, i called a meeting to assess how things were going. We talked about a lot of things including personal things, how our work was progressing, and what we needed to change. The students seemed to appreciate the chance to talk at this meeting. each of them described his or her special circumstances and hopes for the summer.
i told the students several stories about past digs; some were humorous, and others highlighted accomplishments. i shared my particular interests in this project and how i thought we as a group could accomplish the work that needed to be done at this important historical site. in particular, i stressed two points: (a) that they shared the responsibility for the success- ful outcome of the venture, and (b) that they had independent authority to design, schedule, and carry out the details of their respective assign- ments, with the director and other senior staff available at all times as advisers and resource persons. in regard to the departure time issue, i told the participants that the standard departure time on digs was 5:00 a.m.
Well, shortly after our meeting i observed a real shift in the group atti- tude and atmosphere. people seemed to become more involved in the work, there was less sickness, and there was more camaraderie. all assignments were completed without constant prodding and in a spirit of mutual support. each morning at 5:00 a.m. everyone was ready to go.
(continued)
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 185
i find that each year my groups are different. it’s almost as if each of them has a unique personality. perhaps that is why i find it so challeng- ing. i try to listen to the students and use their particular strengths. it really is quite amazing how these students can develop in 8 weeks. They really become good at archaeology, and they accomplish a great deal.
This coming year will again be different because of the 10 returning “veterans.”
Questions
1. how is this an example of transformational leadership?
2. Where are dr. cook’s strengths on the Full range of Leadership model (see Figure 8.2)?
3. What is the vision dr. cook has for the archaeology excavations?
Case 8.3
Her Vision of a model research center
rachel adams began as a researcher at a large pharmaceutical company. after several years of observing how clinical drug studies were con- ducted, she realized that there was a need and an opportunity for a research center not connected with a specific pharmaceutical company. in collaboration with other researchers, she launched a new company that was the first of its kind in the country. Within 5 years, rachel had become president and ceo of the independent center for clinical research (iccr). Under rachel’s leadership, iccr has grown to a company with revenues of $6 million and profits of $1 million. iccr employs 100 full-time employees, most of whom are women.
rachel wants iccr to continue its pattern of formidable growth. her vision for the company is to make it a model research center that will blend credible science with efficient and cost-effective clinical trials. To that end, the company, which is situated in a large urban setting, main- tains strong links to academia, industry, and the community.
rachel and her style have a great deal to do with the success of iccr. she is a freethinker who is always open to new ideas, opportunities,
(Continued)
186 Leadership Theory and pracTice
and approaches. she is a positive person who enjoys the nuances of life, and she is not afraid to take risks. her optimistic approach has had a significant influence on the company’s achievements and its organizational climate. people employed at iccr claim they have never worked at a place that is so progressive and so positive in how it treats its employees and customers. The women employees at iccr feel particularly strongly about rachel’s leadership, and many of them use rachel as a role model. it is not by accident that the majority (85%) of the people who work at iccr are women. her support for women’s concerns is evident in the type of drug studies the company selects to conduct and in her service to national committees on wom- en’s health and research issues. Within iccr, rachel has designed an on-site day care program, flextime scheduling for mothers with young children, and a benefit package that gives full health coverage to part-time employees. at a time when most companies are searching for ways to include more women in decision making, iccr has women in established leadership positions at all levels.
although rachel has been extremely effective at iccr, the success of the company has resulted in many changes that have affected rachel’s lead- ership at the company.
rapid growth of iccr has required that rachel spend a great deal of time traveling throughout the country. Because of her excessive travel, rachel has begun to feel distant from the day-to-day operations of iccr. she has begun to feel as if she is losing her handle on what makes the com- pany tick. For example, although she used to give weekly pep talks to supervisors, she finds that she now gives two formal presentations a year. rachel also complains of feeling estranged from employees at the com- pany. at a recent directors’ meeting, she expressed frustration that peo- ple no longer called her by her first name, and others did not even know who she was.
Growth at iccr has also demanded that more planning and decision mak- ing be delegated to department heads. This has been problematic for rachel, particularly in the area of strategic planning. rachel finds that the department heads are beginning to shift the focus of iccr in a direction that contradicts her ideal model of what the company should be and what it is best at doing. rachel built the company on the idea that iccr would be a strong blend of credible science and cost-effective clinical tri- als, and she does not want to give up that model. The directors, on the other hand, would like to see iccr become similar to a standard pharma- ceutical company dedicated primarily to the research and development of new drugs.
(continued)
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 187
Questions
1. What is it about rachel’s leadership that clearly suggests that she is engaged in transformational leadership?
2. in what ways has the growth of iccr had an impact on rachel’s leadership?
3. Given the problems rachel is confronting as a result of the growth of the company, what should she do to reestablish herself as a transfor- mational leader at iccr?
LeaDersHip insTrUmenT
The most widely used measure of transformational leadership is the Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire (MLQ). An earlier version of the MLQ was developed by Bass (1985), based on a series of interviews he and his associates conducted with 70 senior executives in South Africa. These executives were asked to recall leaders who had raised their aware- ness to broader goals, moved them to higher motives, or inspired them to put others’ interests ahead of their own. The executives were then asked to describe how these leaders behaved—what they did to effect change. From these descriptions and from numerous other interviews with both junior and senior executives, Bass constructed the questions that make up the MLQ. The questions measure followers’ perceptions of a leader’s behavior for each of the factors in the Full Range of Leadership model (see Figure 8.2).
Antonakis, Avolio, and Sivasubramaniam (2003) assessed the psychometric properties of the MLQ using a business sample of more than 3,000 raters and found strong support for the validity of the MLQ. They found that the MLQ (Form 5X) clearly distinguished nine factors in the Full Range of Leadership model. Similarly, Hinkin and Schriesheim (2008) examined the empirical properties of the transactional and the nonleadership factors on the MLQ and identified several ways to use the questionnaire to generate more reliable and valid results. Since the MLQ was first designed, it has gone through many revisions, and it continues to be refined to strengthen its reliability and validity.
Based on a summary analysis of a series of studies that used the MLQ to predict how transformational leadership relates to outcomes such as effec- tiveness, Bryman (1992) and Bass and Avolio (1994) have suggested that the charisma and motivation factors on the MLQ are the most likely to
188 Leadership Theory and pracTice
be related to positive effects. Individualized consideration, intellectual stimulation, and contingent reward are the next most important factors. Management-by-exception in its passive form has been found to be somewhat related to outcomes, and in its active form it has been found to be negatively related to outcomes. Generally, laissez-faire leadership has been found to be negatively related to outcomes such as effectiveness and satisfaction in organizations.
We present sample items from the MLQ (Form 5X-short) in this section so that you can explore your beliefs and perceptions about transformational, transactional, and nontransactional leadership. This questionnaire should give you a clearer picture of your own style and the complexity of transfor- mational leadership itself.
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 189
sample items From the multifactor Leadership Questionnaire (mLQ) Form 5X-short
These questions provide examples of the items that are used to evaluate leadership style. The MLQ is provided in both self and rater forms. The self form measures self-perception of leadership behaviors. The rater form is used to measure leadership. By thinking about the leadership styles as exem- plified below, you can get a sense of your own belief about your leadership.
Key: 0 = not 1 = once in 2 = sometimes 3 = Fairly 4 = Frequently, at all a while often if not always
Transformational Leadership Styles
idealized influence i go beyond self-interest for the good 0 1 2 3 4 (attributes) of the group.
idealized influence i consider the moral and ethical 0 1 2 3 4 (Behaviors) consequences of decisions.
inspirational i talk optimistically about 0 1 2 3 4 Motivation the future.
intellectual i reexamine critical assumptions 0 1 2 3 4 stimulation to question whether they are appropriate.
individualized i help others to develop 0 1 2 3 4 consideration their strengths.
Transactional Leadership Styles
contingent reward i make clear what one can expect 0 1 2 3 4 to receive when performance goals are achieved.
Management by i keep track of all mistakes. 0 1 2 3 4 exception: active
Passive/Avoidant Leadership Styles
Management by i wait for things to go wrong before 0 1 2 3 4 exception: passive taking action.
Laissez-Faire i avoid making decisions. 0 1 2 3 4
soUrce: reproduced by special permission of the publisher, Mind Garden, inc., www .mindgarden.com from the Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire by Bernard M. Bass and Bruce J. avolio. copyright © 1995, 2000, 2004 by Bernard M. Bass and Bruce J. avolio. Further reproduction is prohibited without the publisher’s written consent.
190 Leadership Theory and pracTice
sUmmary
One of the most encompassing approaches to leadership—transformational leadership—is concerned with the process of how certain leaders are able to inspire followers to accomplish great things. This approach stresses that leaders need to understand and adapt to the needs and motives of followers. Transformational leaders are recognized as change agents who are good role models, who can create and articulate a clear vision for an organization, who empower followers to meet higher standards, who act in ways that make others want to trust them, and who give meaning to organizational life.
Transformational leadership emerged from and is rooted in the writings of Burns (1978) and Bass (1985). The works of Bennis and Nanus (1985) and Kouzes and Posner (1987) are also representative of transformational leadership.
Transformational leadership can be assessed through use of the Multifac- tor Leadership Questionnaire (MLQ), which measures a leader’s behavior in seven areas: idealized influence (charisma), inspirational motivation, intellectual stimulation, individualized consideration, contingent reward, management-by-exception, and laissez-faire. High scores on individualized consideration and motivation factors are most indicative of strong trans- formational leadership.
There are several positive features of the transformational approach, includ- ing that it is a current model that has received a lot of attention by research- ers, it has strong intuitive appeal, it emphasizes the importance of followers in the leadership process, it goes beyond traditional transactional models and broadens leadership to include the growth of followers, and it places strong emphasis on morals and values.
Balancing against the positive features of transformational leadership are several weaknesses. These include that the approach lacks conceptual clarity; it is based on the MLQ , which has been challenged by some research; it creates a framework that implies that transformational leader- ship has a trait-like quality; it is sometimes seen as elitist and undemo- cratic; it suffers from a “heroic leadership” bias; and it has the potential to be used counterproductively in negative ways by leaders. Despite the weaknesses, transformational leadership appears to be a valuable and widely used approach.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 191
reFerences
Antonakis, J. (2012). Transformational and charismatic leadership. In D. V. Day & J. Antonakis (Eds.), The nature of leadership (2nd ed., pp. 256–288). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Antonakis, J., Avolio, B. J., & Sivasubramaniam, N. (2003). Context and leadership: An examination of the nine-factor full-range leadership theory using the Multi- factor Leadership Questionnaire. Leadership Quarterly, 14(3), 261–295.
Avolio, B. J. (1999). Full leadership development: Building the vital forces in organizations. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Avolio, B. J., & Gibbons, T. C. (1988). Developing transformational leaders: A life span approach. In J. A. Conger, R. N. Kanungo, & Associates (Eds.), Charismatic leadership: The elusive factor in organizational effectiveness (pp. 276–308). San Fran- cisco: Jossey-Bass.
Bailey, J., & Axelrod, R. H. (2001). Leadership lessons from Mount Rushmore: An interview with James MacGregor Burns. Leadership Quarterly, 12, 113–127.
Bass, B. M. (1985). Leadership and performance beyond expectations. New York: Free Press.
Bass, B. M. (1990). From transactional to transformational leadership: Learning to share the vision. Organizational Dynamics, 18, 19–31.
Bass, B. M. (1998). The ethics of transformational leadership. In J. Ciulla (Ed.), Eth- ics: The heart of leadership (pp. 169–192). Westport, CT: Praeger.
Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1990a). The implications of transactional and transfor- mational leadership for individual, team, and organizational development. Research in Organizational Change and Development, 4, 231–272.
Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1990b). Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire. Palo Alto, CA: Consulting Psychologists Press.
Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1993). Transformational leadership: A response to critiques. In M. M. Chemers & R. Ayman (Eds.), Leadership theory and research: Perspectives and directions (pp. 49–80). San Diego, CA: Academic Press.
Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1994). Improving organizational effectiveness through trans- formational leadership. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1995). Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire for research. Menlo Park, CA: Mind Garden.
Bass, B. M., & Riggio, R. E. (2006). Transformational leadership (2nd ed.). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Bass, B. M., & Steidlmeier, P. (1999). Ethics, character, and authentic transformational leadership. Leadership Quarterly, 10, 181–217.
Bennis, W. G., & Nanus, B. (1985). Leaders: The strategies for taking charge. New York: Harper & Row.
Bryman, A. (1992). Charisma and leadership in organizations. London: SAGE. Burns, J. M. (1978). Leadership. New York: Harper & Row. Christie, A., Barling, J., & Turner, N. (2011). Pseudo-transformational leadership:
Model specification and outcomes. Journal of Applied Social Psychology, 44(12), 2943–2984.
192 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Conger, J. A. (1999). Charismatic and transformational leadership in organizations: An insider’s perspective on these developing streams of research. Leadership Quar- terly, 10(2), 145–179.
Conger, J. A., & Kanungo, R. N. (1998). Charismatic leadership in organizations. Thou- sand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Downton, J. V. (1973). Rebel leadership: Commitment and charisma in a revolutionary process. New York: Free Press.
Hinkin, T. R., & Schriesheim, C. A. (2008). A theoretical and empirical examination of the transactional and non-leadership dimensions of the Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire (MLQ). Leadership Quarterly, 19, 501–513.
House, R. J. (1976). A 1976 theory of charismatic leadership. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership: The cutting edge (pp. 189–207). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
Howell, J. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1993). The ethics of charismatic leadership: Submission or liberation? Academy of Management Executive, 6(2), 43–54.
Hunt, J. G., & Conger, J. A. (1999). From where we sit: An assessment of trans- formational and charismatic leadership research. Leadership Quarterly, 10(3), 335–343.
Jung, D. I., Chow, C., & Wu, A. (2003). The role of transformational leadership in enhancing organizational innovation: Hypotheses and some preliminary findings. Leadership Quarterly, 14(4–5), 525–544.
Kouzes, J. M., & Posner, B. Z. (1987). The leadership challenge: How to get extraordinary things done in organizations. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Kouzes, J. M., & Posner, B. Z. (2002). The leadership challenge (3rd ed.). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Kuhnert, K. W. (1994). Transforming leadership: Developing people through del- egation. In B. M. Bass & B. J. Avolio (Eds.), Improving organizational effective- ness through transformational leadership (pp. 10–25). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Kuhnert, K. W., & Lewis, P. (1987). Transactional and transformational leadership: A constructive/developmental analysis. Academy of Management Review, 12(4), 648–657.
Lowe, K. B., & Gardner, W. L. (2001). Ten years of the Leadership Quarterly: Contributions and challenges for the future. Leadership Quarterly, 11(4), 459–514.
Lowe, K. B., Kroeck, K. G., & Sivasubramaniam, N. (1996). Effectiveness correlates of transformational and transactional leadership: A meta-analytic review of the MLQ literature. Leadership Quarterly, 7(3), 385–425.
Nemanich, L. A., & Keller, R. T. (2007). Transformational leadership in an acquisition: A field study of employees. Leadership Quarterly, 18, 49–68.
Rowold, J., & Heinitz, K. (2007). Transformational and charismatic leadership: Assessing the convergent, divergent and criterion validity of the MLQ and the CKS. Leadership Quarterly, 18, 121–133.
Shamir, B., House, R. J., & Arthur, M. B. (1993). The motivational effects of charismatic leadership: A self-concept based theory. Organization Science, 4(4), 577–594.
chapter 8 Transformational Leadership 193
Sosik, J. J., & Jung, D. I. (2010). Full range leadership development: Pathways for people, profit, and planet. New York: Psychology Press.
Tejeda, M. J., Scandura, T. A., & Pillai, R. (2001). The MLQ revisited: Psychometric properties and recommendations. Leadership Quarterly, 12, 31–52.
Tims, M., Bakker, A. B., & Xanthopoulou, D. (2011). Do transformational leaders enhance their followers’ daily work engagement? Leadership Quarterly, 22, 121–131.
Tracey, J. B., & Hinkin, T. R. (1998). Transformational leadership or effective mana- gerial practices? Group & Organization Management, 23(3), 220–236.
Weber, M. (1947). The theory of social and economic organizations (T. Parsons, Trans.). New York: Free Press.
Yammarino, F. J. (1993). Transforming leadership studies: Bernard Bass’ leadership and performance beyond expectations. Leadership Quarterly, 4(3), 379–382.
Yukl, G. A. (1999). An evaluation of conceptual weaknesses in transformational and charismatic leadership theories. Leadership Quarterly, 10(2), 285–305.
Zhu, W., Avolio, B. J., Riggio, R. E., & Sosik, J. J. (2011). The effect of authentic transformational leadership on follower and group ethics. Leadership Quarterly, 22, 801–817.
9
Authentic Leadership
Description
Authentic leadership represents one of the newest areas of leadership research. It focuses on whether leadership is genuine and “real.” As the title of this approach implies, authentic leadership is about the authenticity of leaders and their leadership. Unlike many of the theories that we have discussed in this book, authentic leadership is still in the formative phase of development. As a result, authentic leadership needs to be considered more tentatively: It is likely to change as new research about the theory is published.
In recent times, upheavals in society have energized a tremendous demand for authentic leadership. The destruction on 9/11, corporate scandals at companies like WorldCom and Enron, and massive failures in the banking industry have all created fear and uncertainty. People feel apprehensive and insecure about what is going on around them, and as a result, they long for bona fide leadership they can trust and for leaders who are honest and good. People’s demands for trustworthy leadership make the study of authentic leadership timely and worthwhile.
In addition to the public’s interest, authentic leadership has been intriguing to researchers: It was identified earlier in transformational leadership research but never fully articulated (Bass, 1990; Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999; Burns, 1978; Howell & Avolio, 1993). Furthermore, practitioners had devel- oped approaches to authentic leadership that were not evidence based, and so needed further clarification and testing. In attempts to more fully explore authentic leadership, researchers set out to identify the parameters of authen- tic leadership and more clearly conceptualize it, efforts that continue today.
Authentic Leadership Character and Purpose
196 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
Authentic Leadership Defined
On the surface, authentic leadership appears easy to define. In actuality, it is a complex process that is difficult to characterize. Among leadership schol- ars, there is no single accepted definition of authentic leadership. Instead, there are multiple definitions, each written from a different viewpoint and with a different emphasis (Chan, 2005).
One of those viewpoints is the intrapersonal perspective, which focuses closely on the leader and what goes on within the leader. It incorporates the leader’s self-knowledge, self-regulation, and self-concept. In Shamir and Eilam’s (2005) description of the intrapersonal approach, they suggest that authentic leaders exhibit genuine leadership, lead from conviction, and are originals, not copies. This perspective emphasizes a leader’s life experiences and the meaning he or she attaches to those experiences as being critical to the development of the authentic leader.
A second way of defining authentic leadership is as an interpersonal process. This perspective outlines authentic leadership as relational, created by leaders and followers together (Eagly, 2005). It results not from the leader’s efforts alone, but also from the response of followers. Authenticity emerges from the interactions between leaders and followers. It is a reciprocal process because leaders affect followers and followers affect leaders.
Finally, authentic leadership can be defined from a developmental perspective, which is exemplified in the work of Avolio and his associates (Avolio & Gardner, 2005; Gardner, Avolio, & Walumbwa, 2005; Walumbwa, Avolio, Gardner, Wernsing, & Peterson, 2008). This perspective, which underpins the approaches to authentic leadership discussed in the following section, views authentic leadership as something that can be nurtured in a leader, rather than as a fixed trait. Authentic leadership develops in people over a lifetime and can be triggered by major life events, such as a severe illness or a new career.
Taking a developmental approach, Walumbwa et al. (2008) conceptualized authentic leadership as a pattern of leader behavior that develops from and is grounded in the leader’s positive psychological qualities and strong ethics. They suggest that authentic leadership is composed of four distinct but related components: self-awareness, internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transparency (Avolio, Walumbwa, & Weber, 2009). Over a lifetime, authentic leaders learn and develop each of these four types of behavior.
Building Authenticity Vital Leadership
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 197
Approaches to Authentic Leadership
Formulations about authentic leadership can be differentiated into two areas: (1) the practical approach, which evolved from real-life examples and training and development literature; and (2) the theoretical approach, which is based on findings from social science research. Both approaches offer interesting insights about the complex process of authentic leadership.
practical Approach
Books and programs about authentic leadership are popular today; people are interested in the basics of this type of leadership. Specifically, they want to know the “how to” steps to become an authentic leader. In this section, we will discuss Bill George’s authentic leadership approach (2003).
Bill George’s Authentic Leadership Approach. The authentic leadership approach developed by George (2003; George & Sims, 2007) focuses on the characteristics of authentic leaders. George describes, in a practical way, the essential qualities of authentic leadership and how individuals can develop these qualities if they want to become authentic leaders.
Based on his experience as a corporate executive and through interviews with a diverse sample of 125 successful leaders, George found that authen- tic leaders have a genuine desire to serve others, they know themselves, and they feel free to lead from their core values. Specifically, authentic leaders demonstrate five basic characteristics: (1) They understand their purpose, (2) they have strong values about the right thing to do, (3) they establish trusting relationships with others, (4) they demonstrate self-discipline and act on their values, and (5) they are passionate about their mission (i.e., act from their heart) (Figure 9.1; George, 2003).
Figure 9.1 illustrates five dimensions of authentic leadership identified by George: purpose, values, relationships, self-discipline, and heart. The figure also illustrates each of the related characteristics—passion, behavior, con- nectedness, consistency, and compassion—that individuals need to develop to become authentic leaders.
In his interviews, George found that authentic leaders have a real sense of purpose. They know what they are about and where they are going. In addi- tion to knowing their purpose, authentic leaders are inspired and intrinsi- cally motivated about their goals. They are passionate individuals who have a deep-seated interest in what they are doing and truly care about their work.
The Authentic Leader
198 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
A good example of an authentic leader who exhibited passion about his goals was Terry Fox, a cancer survivor, whose leg was amputated after it was over- come by bone cancer. Using a special leg prosthesis, Terry attempted to run across Canada, from the Atlantic to the Pacific, to raise awareness and money for cancer research. Although he died before he finished his run, his courage and passion affected the lives of millions of people. He also accom- plished his goals to increase cancer awareness and to raise money for cancer research. Today, the Terry Fox Foundation is going strong and has raised more than $400 million (Canadian) for cancer research (www.terryfox.org). Of the dimensions and characteristics in Figure 9.1, Terry Fox clearly dem- onstrated purpose and passion in his leadership.
Authentic leaders understand their own values and behave toward others based on these values. Stated another way, George suggests that authentic leaders know their “True North.” They have a clear idea of who they are,
The Authentic
Leader
Passion
Purpose
He ar
t
Self-Discipline Relationsh ips
ValuesCo m
pa ss
io n
Consistency Connecte dne
ss
Behavior
Figure 9.1 Authentic Leadership Characteristics
soUrCe: From Authentic Leadership: Rediscovering the Secrets to Creating Lasting Value by Bill George, copyright © 2003. reproduced with permission of John Wiley & sons, inc.
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 199
where they are going, and what the right thing is to do. When tested in difficult situations, authentic leaders do not compromise their values, but rather use those situations to strengthen their values.
An example of a leader with a strong set of values is Nobel Peace Prize Laureate Nelson Mandela. Mandela was a deeply moral man with a strong conscience. While fighting to abolish apartheid in South Africa, he was unyielding in his pursuit of justice and equality for all. When he was in prison and offered early release in exchange for denouncing his viewpoint, he chose to remain incarcerated rather than compromise his position. Nelson Mandela knew who he was at his core. He knew his values, and his leadership reflected those values.
A third characteristic of authentic leadership in the George approach is strong relationships. Authentic leaders have the capacity to open themselves up and establish a connection with others. They are willing to share their own story with others and listen to others’ stories. Through mutual disclosure, leaders and followers develop a sense of trust and closeness.
George argued that people today want to have access to their leaders and they want their leaders to be open with them. In a sense, people are asking leaders to soften the boundary around their leadership role and to be more transparent. People want to have a trusting relationship with their leaders. In exchange, people are willing to give leaders greater loyalty and commitment.
As we discussed in Chapter 7 (leader–member exchange theory), effective leader–follower relationships are marked by high-quality communication in which leaders and followers demonstrate a high degree of mutual trust, respect, and obligation toward each other. Leaders and followers are tied together in productive ways that go beyond the stereotypical leader–follower relationship. This results in strong leader–member relationships, greater understanding, and higher productivity.
Self-discipline is another dimension of authentic leadership, and is the qual- ity that helps leaders to reach their goals. Self-discipline gives leaders focus and determination. When leaders establish objectives and standards of excellence, self-discipline helps them to reach these goals and to keep every- one accountable. Furthermore, self-discipline gives authentic leaders the energy to carry out their work in accordance with their values.
Like long-distance runners, authentic leaders with self-discipline are able to stay focused on their goals. They are able to listen to their inner compass and
human rights Leadership
200 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
can discipline themselves to move forward, even in challenging circum- stances. In stressful times, self-discipline allows authentic leaders to remain cool, calm, and consistent. Because disciplined leaders are predictable in their behavior, other people know what to expect and find it easier to communi- cate with them. When the leader is self-directed and “on course,” it gives other people a sense of security.
Last, the George approach identifies compassion and heart as important aspects of authentic leadership. Compassion refers to being sensitive to the plight of others, opening one’s self to others, and being willing to help them. George (2003, p. 40) argued that as leaders develop compassion, they learn to be authentic. Leaders can develop compassion by getting to know others’ life stories, doing community service projects, being involved with other racial or ethnic groups, or traveling to developing countries (George, 2003). These activities increase the leader’s sensitivity to other cultures, back- grounds, and living situations.
In summary, George’s authentic leadership approach highlights five impor- tant features of authentic leaders. Collectively, these features provide a practi- cal picture of what people need to do to become authentic in their leadership. Authentic leadership is a lifelong developmental process, which is formed and informed by each individual’s life story.
theoretical Approach
Although still in its initial stages of development, a theory of authentic lead- ership is emerging in social science literature. In this section, we identify the basic components of authentic leadership and describe how these compo- nents are related to one another.
Background to the Theoretical Approach. Although people’s interest in “authenticity” is probably timeless, research on authentic leadership is very recent, with the first article appearing in 2003. The primary catalyst for this research was a leadership summit at the University of Nebraska. This summit was sponsored by the Gallup Leadership Institute, and focused on the nature of authentic leadership and its development. From the summit, two sets of publications emerged: (1) a special issue of Leadership Quarterly in the summer of 2005, and (2) Monographs in Leadership and Management, titled “Authentic Leadership Theory and Process: Origins, Effects and Development,” also published in 2005. Prior to the summit, Luthans and Avolio (2003) published an article on authentic leadership development
Authenticity and Brand
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 201
and positive organizational scholarship. The article also helped to ignite this area of research.
Interest in authentic leadership increased during a time in which there was a great deal of societal upheaval and instability in the United States. The attacks of 9/11, widespread corporate corruption, and a troubled economy all created a sense of uncertainty and anxiety in people about leadership. Widespread unethical and ineffective leadership necessitated the need for more humane, constructive leadership that served the common good (Fry & Whittington, 2005; Luthans & Avolio, 2003).
In addition, researchers felt the need to extend the work of Bass (1990) and Bass and Steidlmeier (1999) regarding the meaning of authentic transforma- tional leadership. There was a need to operationalize the meaning of authentic leadership and create a theoretical framework to explain it. To develop a theory of authentic leadership, researchers drew from the fields of leadership, positive organizational scholarship, and ethics (Cooper, Scandura, & Schriesheim, 2005; Gardner et al., 2005).
A major challenge confronting researchers in developing a theory was to define the construct and identify its characteristics. As we discussed earlier in the chapter, authentic leadership has been defined in multiple ways, with each definition emphasizing a different aspect of the process. For this chap- ter, we have selected the definition set forth in an article by Walumbwa et al. (2008), who defined authentic leadership as “a pattern of leader behavior that draws upon and promotes both positive psychological capacities and a positive ethical climate, to foster greater self-awareness, an internalized moral perspective, balanced processing of information, and relational trans- parency on the part of leaders working with followers, fostering positive self-development” (p. 94). Although complex, this definition captures the current thinking of scholars regarding the phenomenon of authentic leader- ship and how it works.
In the research literature, different models have been developed to illustrate the process of authentic leadership. Gardner et al. (2005) created a model that frames authentic leadership around the developmental processes of leader and follower self-awareness and self-regulation. Ilies, Morgeson, and Nahrgang (2005) constructed a multicomponent model that discusses the impact of authenticity on leaders’ and followers’ happiness and well-being. In contrast, Luthans and Avolio (2003) formulated a model that explains authentic lead- ership as a developmental process. In this chapter, we will present a basic model of authentic leadership that is derived from the research literature that
Fostering Authenticity Ceos and Positive Psychology
202 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
focuses on the core components of authentic leadership. Our discussion will focus on authentic leadership as a process.
Components of Authentic Leadership. In an effort to further our understanding of authentic leadership, Walumbwa and associates (2008) conducted a comprehensive review of the literature and interviewed groups of content experts in the field to determine what components constituted authentic leadership and to develop a valid measure of this construct. Their research identified four components: self-awareness, internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transparency (Figure 9.2). Together, these four components form the foundation for a theory of authentic leadership.
Self-awareness refers to the personal insights of the leader. It is not an end in itself but a process in which individuals understand themselves, including their strengths and weaknesses, and the impact they have on others. Self- awareness includes reflecting on your core values, identity, emotions, motives,
Figure 9.2 Authentic Leadership
Internalized Moral Perspective
Authentic Leadership
Balanced Processing
Relational Transparency
Self-Awareness
Critical Life
Events
Positive Psychological Capacities
Moral Reasoning
soUrCe: Adapted from Luthans, F., & Avolio, B. J. (2003). Authentic leadership development. in K. s. Cameron, J. e. dutton, & r. e. Quinn (eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 241– 258). san Francisco: Berrett-Koehler; and Gardner, W. L., Avolio, B. J., Luthans, F., May, d. r., & Walumbwa, F. o. (2005). “Can you see the real me?” A self-based model of authentic leader and follower development. Leadership Quarterly, 16, 343–372.
Authenticity and identity
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 203
and goals, and coming to grips with who you really are at the deepest level. In addition, it includes being aware of and trusting your own feelings (Kernis, 2003). When leaders know themselves and have a clear sense of who they are and what they stand for, they have a strong anchor for their decisions and actions (Gardner et al., 2005). Other people see leaders who have greater self-awareness as more authentic.
Internalized moral perspective refers to a self-regulatory process whereby indi- viduals use their internal moral standards and values to guide their behavior rather than allow outside pressures to control them (e.g., group or societal pressure). It is a self-regulatory process because people have control over the extent to which they allow others to influence them. Others see leaders with an internalized moral perspective as authentic because their actions are con- sistent with their expressed beliefs and morals.
Balanced processing is also a self-regulatory behavior. It refers to an individu- al’s ability to analyze information objectively and explore other people’s opinions before making a decision. It also means avoiding favoritism about certain issues and remaining unbiased. Balanced processing includes solicit- ing viewpoints from those who disagree with you and fully considering their positions before taking your own action. Leaders with balanced processing are seen as authentic because they are open about their own perspectives, but are also objective in considering others’ perspectives.
Relational transparency refers to being open and honest in presenting one’s true self to others. It is self-regulatory because individuals can control their transparency with others. Relational transparency occurs when individuals share their core feelings, motives, and inclinations with others in an appropri- ate manner (Kernis, 2003). It includes the individuals showing both positive and negative aspects of themselves to others. In short, relational transparency is about communicating openly and being real in relationships with others.
Fundamentally, authentic leadership comprises the above four factors— self-awareness, internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and rela- tional transparency. These factors form the basis for authentic leadership.
Factors That Influence Authentic Leadership. There are other factors such as positive psychological capacities, moral reasoning, and critical life events that influence authentic leadership (Figure 9.2).
The four key positive psychological attributes that have an impact on authentic leadership—confidence, hope, optimism, and resilience—have been drawn from the fields of positive psychology and positive organizational behavior
Leadership from Within
204 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
(Table 9.1; Luthans & Avolio, 2003). Positive attributes predispose or enhance a leader’s capacity to develop the components of authentic leader- ship discussed in the previous section. Each of these attributes has a trait- like and a state-like quality. They are trait-like because they may characterize a relatively fixed aspect of someone’s personality that has been evident throughout his or her life (e.g., extraversion), and they are state-like because, with training or coaching, individuals are capable of developing or changing their characteristics.
table 9.1 related Positive Psychological Capacities
• Confidence
• hope
• optimism
• resilience
soUrCe: Luthans, F., & Avolio, B. J. (2003). Authentic leadership development. in K. s. Cameron, J. e. dutton, & r. e. Quinn (eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 241– 258). san Francisco: Berrett-Koehler.
Confidence refers to having self-efficacy—the belief that one has the ability to successfully accomplish a specified task. Leaders who have confidence are more likely to be motivated to succeed, to be persistent when obstacles arise, and to welcome a challenge (Bandura, 1997; Luthans & Avolio, 2003). Hope is a positive motivational state based on willpower and goal planning (Luthans & Avolio, 2003). Authentic leaders with hope have goals they know can be accomplished; their hope inspires followers to trust them and believe in their goals. Optimism refers to the cognitive process of viewing situations from a positive light and having favorable expectations about the future. Leaders with optimism are positive about their capabilities and the outcomes they can achieve. They approach life with a sense of abundance rather than scarcity (Covey, 1990). Resilience is the capacity to recover from and adjust to adverse situations. It includes the ability to positively adapt to hardships and suffering. During difficult times, resilient people are able to bounce back from challenging situations and feel strengthened and more resourceful as a result of them (Sutcliffe & Vogus, 2003).
Moral reasoning is another factor that can influence authentic leadership (Figure 9.2). It is the capacity to make ethical decisions about issues of right or wrong and good or bad. Developing the capacity for moral reasoning is a lifelong process. Higher levels of moral reasoning make it possible for the authentic leader to make decisions that transcend individual differences and align individuals toward a common goal. They enable leaders to be selfless
Authentic Leadership
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 205
and make judgments that serve the greater good of the group, organization, or community. Moral reasoning capacity also enables authentic leaders to use this ability to promote justice and achieve what is right for a community.
A final factor related to authentic leadership is critical life events (Figure 9.2). Critical events are major events that shape people’s lives. They can be positive events, like receiving an unexpected promotion, having a child, or reading an important book; or they can be negative events, like being diagnosed with cancer, getting a negative year-end evaluation, or having a loved one die. Crit- ical life events act as catalysts for change. Shamir and Eilam (2005) argued that authentic leadership rests heavily on the insights people attach to their life experiences. When leaders tell their life stories, they gain greater self-knowledge, more clarity about who they are, and a better understanding of their role. By understanding their own life experiences, leaders become more authentic.
Critical life events also stimulate growth in individuals and help them become stronger leaders (Luthans & Avolio, 2003). For example, Howard Schultz (founder and CEO of Starbucks) tells a story about when he was little: His father, who was a delivery driver, fell and was hurt on the job. His father did not have health insurance or worker’s compensation. Seeing the problems that resulted from his father’s difficulties, when Schultz built Star- bucks he provided comprehensive health insurance for employees who worked as few as 20 hours a week. Schultz’s style of leadership was triggered by his childhood experience.
As the theory of authentic leadership develops further, other antecedent factors that influence the process may be identified. To date, however, it is positive psychological capacities, moral reasoning capacities, and critical life events that have been identified as factors that are influential in a person’s ability to become an authentic leader.
How Does AutHentic LeADersHip tHeory work?
In this chapter, we have discussed authentic leadership from a practical and theoretical perspective. Both perspectives describe authentic leadership as a developmental process that forms in leaders over time; however, both per- spectives provide different descriptions for how authentic leadership works.
The practical approach provides prescriptions for how to be authentic and how to develop authentic leadership. For example, the George approach (2003)
Authenticity
206 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
focuses on five characteristics leaders should develop to become authentic leaders. More specifically, George advocates that leaders become more purpose- ful, value centered, relational, self-disciplined, and compassionate. The essence of authentic leadership is being a leader who strongly demonstrates these five qualities.
Rather than simple prescriptions, the theoretical approach describes what authentic leadership is and what accounts for it. From this perspective, authentic leadership works because leaders demonstrate self-awareness, an internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transparency. Leaders develop these attributes through a lifelong process that is often influenced by critical life events. In addition, the literature suggests that positive psychological characteristics and moral reasoning have a significant impact on authentic leaders.
Authentic leadership is a complex process that emphasizes the development of qualities that help leaders to be perceived as trustworthy and believable by their followers. The leader’s job is to learn to develop these qualities and apply them to the common good as he or she serves others.
strengtHs
Although it is in its early stages of development, the authentic leadership approach has several strengths. First, it fulfills an expressed need for trust- worthy leadership in society. During the past 20 years, failures in public and private leadership have created distrust in people. Authentic leadership helps to fill a void and provides an answer to people who are searching for good and sound leadership in an uncertain world.
Second, authentic leadership provides broad guidelines for individuals who want to become authentic leaders. Both the practical and theoretical approaches clearly point to what leaders should do to become authentic leaders. Social science literature emphasizes that it is important for leaders to have self-awareness, an internalized moral perspective, balanced process- ing, and relational transparency to be authentic. Taken together, these approaches provide a map for becoming an authentic leader.
Third, similar to transformational and servant leadership, authentic leadership has an explicit moral dimension. Underlying both the practical and theoretical approaches is the idea that authenticity requires leaders to do what is “right” and “good” for their followers and society. Authentic leaders understand their own values, place followers’ needs above their own, and
Authenticity Framework
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 207
work with followers to align their interests in order to create a greater common good.
Fourth, authentic leadership emphasizes that authentic values and behaviors can be developed in leaders over time. Authentic leadership is not an attri- bute that only some people exhibit: Everyone can develop authenticity and learn to be more authentic. For example, leaders can learn to become more aware and transparent, or they can learn to be more relational and other- directed. Leaders can also develop moral reasoning capacities. Furthermore, Luthans and Avolio (2003) contended that leaders could learn to develop positive psychological capacities such as confidence, hope, optimism, and resilience, and could use these to create a positive organizational climate. They contended that there are many ways that leaders can learn to become authentic leaders over a lifetime.
Finally, authentic leadership can be measured using the Authentic Leader- ship Questionnaire (ALQ). The ALQ is a validated, theory-based instru- ment comprising 16 items that measure four factors of authentic leadership (Avolio et al., 2009; Walumbwa et al., 2008). As research moves forward in refining authentic leadership theory, it is valuable to have an established instrument of this construct that is theory-based and can be used to measure authentic leadership in future research.
criticisms
Authentic leadership is still in the formative stages of development, and a number of questions still need to be addressed about the theory. First, the concepts and ideas presented in George’s practical approach are not fully substantiated. While the practical approach is interesting and offers insight on authentic leadership, it is not built on a broad empirical base, nor has it been tested for validity. Without research support, the ideas set forth in the practical approach should be treated cautiously as explanations of the authentic leadership process.
Second, the moral component of authentic leadership is not fully explained. Whereas authentic leadership implies that leaders are motivated by higher- order end values such as justice and community, the way that these values function to influence authentic leadership is not clear. For example, how are a leader’s values related to a leader’s self-awareness? Or, what is the path or underlying process through which moral values affect other components of authentic leadership? In its present form, authentic leadership does not offer thorough answers to these questions.
Authentic Leadership Questionnaire
208 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
Third, researchers have questioned whether positive psychological capacities should be included as components of authentic leadership. Although there is an interest in the social sciences to study positive human potential and the best of the human condition (Cameron, Dutton, & Quinn, 2003), the ratio- nale for including positive psychological capacities as an inherent part of authentic leadership has not been clearly explained by researchers. In addi- tion, some have argued that the inclusion of positive leader capacities in authentic leadership broadens the construct of authentic leadership too much and makes it difficult to measure (Cooper et al., 2005). At this point in the development of research on authentic leadership, the role of positive psycho- logical capacities in authentic leadership theory needs further clarification.
Finally, it is not clear how authentic leadership results in positive organi- zational outcomes. Given that it is a new area of research, it is not unex- pected that there are few data on outcomes, but these data are necessary to substantiate the value of the theory. Although authentic leadership is intuitively appealing on the surface, questions remain about whether this approach is effective, in what contexts it is effective, and whether authen- tic leadership results in productive outcomes. Relatedly, it is also not clear in the research whether authentic leadership is sufficient to achieve orga- nizational goals. For example, can an authentic leader who is disorganized and lacking in technical competence be an effective leader? Authenticity is important and valuable to good leadership, but how authenticity relates to effective leadership is unknown. Clearly, future research should be con- ducted to explore how authentic leadership is related to organizational outcomes.
AppLicAtion
Because authentic leadership is still in the early phase of its development, there has been little research on strategies that people can use to develop or enhance authentic leadership behaviors. While there are prescriptions set forth in the practical approach, there is little evidence-based research on whether these prescriptions or how-to strategies actually increase authentic leadership behavior.
In spite of the lack of intervention research, there are common themes from the authentic leadership literature that may be applicable to organizational or practice settings. One theme common to all of the formulations of authentic leadership is that people have the capacity to learn to be authentic
Teaching Authentic Leadership
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 209
leaders. In their original work on authentic leadership, Luthans and Avolio (2003) constructed a model of authentic leadership development. Concep- tualizing it as a lifelong learning process, they argued that authentic leader- ship is a process that can be developed over time. This suggests that human resource departments may be able to foster authentic leadership behaviors in employees who move into leadership positions.
Another theme that can be applied to organizations is the overriding goal of authentic leaders to try to do the “right” thing, to be honest with themselves and others, and to work for the common good. Authentic leadership can have a positive impact in organizations. For example, Cianci, Hannah, Rob- erts, and Tsakumis (2014) investigated the impact of authentic leadership on followers’ morality. Based on the responses of 118 MBA students, they found that authentic leaders significantly inhibited followers from making unethi- cal choices in the face of temptation. Authentic leadership appears to be a critical contextual factor that morally strengthens followers. Cianci et al. suggest that the four components of authentic leadership (i.e., self- awareness, internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and rela- tional transparency) should be developed in organizational leadership to increase ethical organizational behavior.
Last, authentic leadership is shaped and reformed by critical life events that act as triggers to growth and greater authenticity. Being sensitive to these events and using them as springboards to growth may be relevant to many people who are interested in becoming leaders who are more authentic.
cAse stuDies
The following section provides three case studies (Cases 9.1, 9.2, and 9.3) of individuals who demonstrate authentic leadership. The first case is about Sally Helgesen, author of The Female Advantage: Women’s Ways of Leadership (1990). The second case is about Greg Mortenson and how his mission to promote schools and peace in Pakistan and Afghanistan came under fire when he was accused of lying and financial impropriety. The final case is about Betty Ford, former First Lady of the United States, and her work in the areas of breast cancer awareness and substance abuse treatment. At the end of each of the cases, questions are provided to help you analyze the case using ideas from authentic leadership.
210 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
Case 9.1
Am i really a Leader?
sally helgesen was born in the small Midwestern town of saint Cloud, Minnesota. her mother was a housewife who later taught english, and her father was a college professor of speech. After attending a local state college, where she majored in english and comparative religion, sally spread her wings and moved to new york, inspired by the classic film Breakfast at Tiffany’s.
sally found work as a writer, first in advertising and then as an assistant to a columnist at the then-influential Village Voice. she contributed free- lance articles to magazines such as Harper’s, Glamour, Vogue, Fortune, and Inside Sports. she also returned to school, completing a degree in classics at hunter College and taking language courses at the city gradu- ate center in preparation for a Phd in comparative religion. she envi- sioned herself as a college professor, but also enjoyed freelancing. she felt a strong dichotomy within her, part quiet scholar and part footloose dreamer. The conflict bothered her, and she wondered how she would resolve it. Choosing to be a writer—actually declaring herself to be one— seemed scary, grandiose, and fraudulent.
Then one day, while walking on a new york side street in the rain, sally saw an adventuresome black cat running beside her. it reminded her of holly Golightly’s cat in Breakfast at Tiffany’s, an emblem in the movie for holly’s dreamy temperament and rootlessness. it made her realize how much the freedom and independence offered by her “temporary” career as a writer suited her temperament. sally told the cat she was a writer—she’d never been able to say the words before—and decided she was going to commit to full-time writing, at least for a time. When she saw the opportunity to cover a prominent murder trial in Fort Worth, Texas, she took it.
While covering the trial, sally became intrigued with the culture of Texas, and decided she wanted to write a book on the role of independent oil producers in shaping the region. doing so required a huge expenditure of time and money, and for almost a year sally lived out of the trunk of her car, staying with friends in remote regions all over Texas. it was lonely and hard and exhilarating, but sally was determined to see the project through. When the book, Wildcatters (1981), was published, it achieved little recognition, but sally felt an enormous increase in confidence and commitment as a result of having finished the book. it strengthened her conviction that, for better or worse, she was a writer.
sally moved back to new york and continued to write articles and search around for another book. she also began writing speeches for the Ceo at a Fortune 500 company. she loved the work, and particularly enjoyed being an observer of office politics, even though she did not perceive
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 211
herself to be a part of them. sally viewed her role as being an “outsider looking in,” an observer of the culture. she sometimes felt like an actor in a play about an office, but this detachment made her feel professional rather than fraudulent.
As a speechwriter, sally spent a lot of time interviewing people in the companies she worked for. doing so made her realize that men and women often approach their work in fundamentally different ways. she also became convinced that many of the skills and attitudes women brought to their work were increasingly appropriate for the ways in which organizations were changing, and that women had certain advan- tages as a result. she also noticed that the unique perspectives of women were seldom valued by Ceos or other organizational leaders, who could have benefited if they had better understood and been more attentive to what women had to offer.
These observations inspired sally to write another book. in 1988, she signed a contract with a major publisher to write a book on what women had to contribute to organizations. Until then, almost everything written about women at work focused on how they needed to change and adapt. sally felt strongly that if women were encouraged to emphasize the negative, they would miss a historic opportunity to help lead organ- izations in a time of change. The time was right for this message, and The Female Advantage: Women’s Ways of Leadership (1990) became very successful, topping a number of best-seller charts and remaining steadily in print for nearly 20 years. The book’s prominence resulted in numerous speaking and consulting opportunities, and sally began traveling the world delivering seminars and working with a variety of clients.
This acclaim and visibility were somewhat daunting to sally. While she recognized the value of her book, she also knew that she was not a social scientist with a body of theoretical data on women’s issues. she saw her- self as an author rather than an expert, and the old questions about fraudulence that she had dealt with in her early years in new york began to reassert themselves in a different form. Was she really being authentic? Could she take on the mantle of leadership and all it entailed? in short, she wondered if she could be the leader that people seemed to expect.
The path sally took to answer these questions was simply to present herself for who she was. she was sally helgesen, an outsider looking in, a skilled and imaginative observer of current issues. For sally, the path to leadership did not manifest itself in a step-by-step process. sally’s leadership began with her own journey of finding herself and accepting her personal authen- ticity. Through this self-awareness, she grew to trust her own expertise as a writer with a keen eye for current trends in organizational life.
(Continued)
212 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
sally continues to be an internationally recognized consultant and speaker on contemporary issues, and has published five books. she remains uncertain about whether she will finish her degree in compara- tive religion and become a college professor, but always keeps in mind the career of i. F. stone, an influential political writer in the 1950s and 1960s who went back to school and got an advanced degree in classics at the age of 75.
Questions
1. Learning about one’s self is an essential step in becoming an authen- tic leader. What role did self-awareness play in sally helgesen’s story of leadership?
2. how would you describe the authenticity of sally helgesen’s leadership?
3. At the end of the case, sally helgesen is described as taking on the “mantle of leadership.” Was this important for her leadership? how is taking on the mantle of leadership related to a leader’s authentic- ity? does every leader reach a point in his or her career where embrac- ing the leadership role is essential?
(Continued)
Case 9.2
A Leader under Fire
(The previous edition of this book includes a case study outlining Greg Mortenson’s creation of the Central Asia Institute and highlighting his authentic leadership qualities in more detail. For an additional perspec- tive on Mortenson, you can access the original case study at www.sage pub.com/northouse6e.)
By 2011, there were few people who had never heard of Greg Mortenson. he was the subject of two best-selling books, Three Cups of Tea (2006, with david o. relin) and Stones Into Schools (2009), which told how the former emergency trauma room nurse had become a hero who built schools in rural areas of Afghanistan and Pakistan.
his story was phenomenal: Lost and sick after attempting to scale K2, Greg was nursed back to health by the villagers of remote Korphe, Afghanistan. Greg promised to build the village a school, a monumental effort that took him three years as he learned to raise money, navigate the foreign culture, and build a bridge above a 60-foot-deep chasm. his
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 213
success led him to create the Central Asia institute (CAi), a nonprofit organization that “empowers communities of Central Asia through lit- eracy and education, especially for girls, promotes peace through educa- tion, and conveys the importance of these activities globally.” By 2011, the CAi had successfully established or supported more than 170 schools in Pakistan and Afghanistan, and helped to educate more than 68,000 students (CAi, 2011a).
Greg’s story seemed too good to be true. in April 2011, television news show 60 Minutes and author Jon Krakauer alleged that it was. 60 Minutes accused Greg of misusing money and benefitting excessively from the CAi. The show’s reporter visited schools the CAi had built overseas and claimed that he could not find six of the schools and that others were abandoned. The show featured an interview with Krakauer, who claimed Greg had fabricated parts of his best-selling book, Three Cups of Tea. When 60 Minutes approached Greg for comment at a book signing, he refused to talk to the program.
The next day, Krakauer (Into Thin Air [1997] and Under the Banner of Heaven [2003]) published a short online book, Three Cups of Deceit (2011), in which he claimed Greg lied many times in Three Cups of Tea, starting with his initial tale of being in Korphe.
Greg and the CAi were caught in a firestorm of media and public scrutiny. An investigation into the alleged financial improprieties was launched by Montana’s attorney general (the CAi is based in Bozeman), and two Montana legislators filed a $5 million class action lawsuit claiming Greg fooled 4 million people into buying his books.
Greg withdrew from the public eye. The day the 60 Minutes program aired, he posted a letter on the CAi website saying he stood by his books and claiming the news show “paints a distorted picture using inaccurate information, innuendo and a microscopic focus on one year’s (2009) irs 990 financial, and a few points in the book Three Cups of Tea that occurred almost 18 years ago” (CAi, 2011b). Many criticized the organiza- tion’s founder for not more aggressively defending himself.
What many people did not know, however, was that two days before the 60 Minutes segment appeared, Greg had been diagnosed with a hole and a large aneurysm in his heart and was scheduled for open-heart surgery in the next few months. Meanwhile, the CAi worked to ensure its transparency by posting its tax returns and a master list of projects and their status. The report documented 210 schools, with 17 of those receiving “full support” from the CAi, which includes teachers’ salaries, supplies, books, and furniture and monitoring by CAi contractors (Flandro, 2011).
(Continued)
214 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
The attorney general investigation concluded in 2012 and determined that Greg as well as CAi board members had mismanaged the CAi, and that Greg had personally profited from it. in a settlement, Greg agreed to pay $1 million to the CAi for expenses he incurred that were deemed as per- sonal. The attorney general’s conclusions did not address the allegations that Mortenson fabricated parts of his book. While he continues to be a CAi employee, Greg is not allowed to have any financial oversight for the organization or sit on its board of directors (Flandro, 2012).
despite the controversy and subsequent finding of wrongdoing, former CAi board member Andrew Marcus hopes the public will consider what Greg and the organization have accomplished.
“it’s hard to imagine anyone who’s done more for education in that part of the world,” Marcus has said. “it took a real human being to do that” (Flandro, 2011).
Questions
1. Would you describe Greg Mortenson as an authentic leader? explain your answer.
2. in the chapter, we discussed moral reasoning and transparency as components of authentic leadership. do you think Greg exhibited these components as part his leadership?
3. how was Greg’s response to the allegations against him characteristic of an authentic leader?
4. how did the outcome of the investigation affect the authenticity of Greg Mortenson’s leadership?
(Continued)
Case 9.3
the reluctant First Lady
Betty Ford admits that August 9, 1974, the day her husband was sworn in as the 38th President of the United states, was “the saddest day of my life” (Ford, 1978, p. 1).
elizabeth Bloomer Ford was many things—a former professional dancer and dance teacher, the mother of four nearly grown children, the wife of 13-term U.s. Congressman Gerald “Jerry” r. Ford who was looking
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 215
forward to their retirement—but she never saw being the country’s First Lady as her destiny.
As she held the Bible her husband’s hand rested on while he took the oath of office, Betty began a journey in which she would become many more things: a breast cancer survivor, an outspoken advocate of women’s rights, a recovering alcoholic and addict, and cofounder and president of the Betty Ford Center, a nonprofit treatment center for substance abuse.
The Fords’ path to the White house began in october 1973, when Jerry was tapped to replace then-U.s. Vice President spiro Agnew who had resigned. After only 9 months in that role, Jerry became the U.s. President after richard M. nixon left office amidst the Watergate scandal.
in her first days as the First Lady, Betty became known for her openness and candor. At the time, women were actively fighting for equal rights in the workplace and in society. Less than half of American women were employed outside the home, and women’s earnings were only 38% of their male counterparts’ (spraggins, 2005). Betty raised a number of eye- brows in her first press conference, when she spoke out in support of abortion rights, women in politics, and the equal rights Amendment.
Betty hadn’t even been in the White house a month when she was diag- nosed with breast cancer. she again broke with social conventions and spoke openly about the diagnosis and treatment for a disease that was not widely discussed in public. With her cooperation, Newsweek maga- zine printed a complete account of her surgery and treatment, which included a radical mastectomy. This openness helped raise awareness of breast cancer screening and treatment options and created an atmos- phere of support and comfort for other women fighting the disease.
“Lying in the hospital, thinking of all those women going for cancer checkups because of me, i’d come to recognize more clearly the power of the woman in the White house,” she said in her first autobiography, The Times of My Life. “not my power, but the power of the position, a power which could be used to help” (Ford, 1978, p. 194).
After her recuperation, Betty made good use of that newfound power. she openly supported and lobbied for passage of the equal rights Amendment, a bill that would ensure that “equality of rights under the law shall not be denied or abridged by the United states or by any state on account of sex” (Francis, 2009).
in an interview with 60 Minutes, Betty drew the ire of many conservatives when she candidly shared her views on the provocative issues of abortion rights, premarital sex, and marijuana use. After the interview aired,
(Continued)
216 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
public opinion of Betty plummeted, but her popularity quickly rebounded, and within months her approval rating had climbed to 75%.
At the same time, Betty was busy with the duties of First Lady, entertain- ing dignitaries and heads of state from countries across the globe. in 1975 she began actively campaigning for her husband for the 1976 pres- idential election, inspiring buttons that read “Vote for Betty’s husband.” Ford lost the election to Jimmy Carter and, because he was suffering from laryngitis, Betty stepped into the spotlight to read Jerry’s concession speech to the country, congratulating Carter on his victory. Betty’s time as First Lady ended in January 1977, and the Fords retired to rancho Mirage, California, and Vail, Colorado.
A little more than a year later, at the age of 60, Betty began another personal battle: overcoming alcoholism and an addiction to prescription medicine. Betty had a 14-year dependence on painkillers for chronic neck spasms, arthritis, and a pinched nerve, but refused to admit she was addicted to alcohol. After checking into the Long Beach naval hospital’s Alcohol and drug rehabilitation service, she found the strength to face her demons and, again, went public with her struggles.
“i have found that i am not only addicted to the medications i’ve been taking for my arthritis, but also to alcohol,” she wrote in a statement released to the public. “i expect this treatment and fellowship to be a solution for my problems and i embrace it not only for me but for all the others who are here to participate” (Ford, 1978, p. 285).
Betty Ford found recovering from addiction was particularly daunting at a time when most treatment centers were geared toward treating men. “The female alcoholic has more emotional problems, more health prob- lems, more parenting problems, makes more suicide attempts, than the alcoholic man,” Betty explained in her second autobiography, Betty, a Glad Awakening (Ford, 1987, p. 129).
For this reason, Betty helped to establish the nonprofit Betty Ford Center in 1982 in rancho Mirage. The center splits its space equally between male and female patients, but the treatment is gender specific with pro- grams for the entire family system affected by addiction. The center’s success has attracted celebrities as well as everyday people including middle-class moms, executives, college students, and laborers. Betty’s activism in the field of recovery earned her the Presidential Medal of Freedom in 1991 and the Congressional Medal of honor in 1999.
speaking at an alumni reunion of Betty Ford Center patients, Betty said, “i’m really proud of this center. And i’m really grateful for my own recovery, because with my recovery, i was able to help some other peo- ple come forward and address their own addictions. And i don’t think
(Continued)
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 217
there’s anything as wonderful in life as being able to help someone else” (Ford, 1987, p. 217).
Questions
1. how would you describe Betty Ford’s leadership? in what ways could her leadership be described as authentic?
2. how did critical life events play a role in the development of her leadership?
3. is there a clear moral dimension to Betty Ford’s leadership? in what way is her leadership about serving the common good? discuss.
4. As we discussed in the chapter, self-awareness and transparency are associated with authentic leadership. how does Betty Ford exhibit these qualities?
LeADersHip instrument
Although still in its early phases of development, the Authentic Leadership Questionnaire (ALQ) was created by Walumbwa and associates (2008) to explore and validate the assumptions of authentic leadership. It is a 16-item instrument that measures four factors of authentic leadership: self-awareness, internalized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transpar- ency. Based on samples in China, Kenya, and the United States, Walumbwa and associates validated the dimensions of the instrument and found it positively related to outcomes such as organizational citizenship, organiza- tional commitment, and satisfaction with supervisor and performance. To obtain this instrument, contact Mind Garden, Inc., in Menlo Park, California, or visit www.mindgarden.com.
In this section, we provide an authentic leadership self-assessment to help you determine your own level of authentic leadership. This questionnaire will help you understand how authentic leadership is measured and provide you with your own scores on items that characterize authentic leadership. The ques- tionnaire includes 16 questions that assess the four major components of authentic leadership discussed earlier in this chapter: self-awareness, internal- ized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transparency. Your results on this self-assessment questionnaire will give you information about your level of authentic leadership on these underlying dimensions of authen- tic leadership. This questionnaire is intended for practical applications to help you understand the complexities of authentic leadership. It is not designed for research purposes.
218 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
Authentic Leadership self-Assessment Questionnaire
Instructions: This questionnaire contains items about different dimensions of authentic leadership. There are no right or wrong responses, so please answer honestly. Use the following scale when responding to each statement by writ- ing the number from the scale below that you feel most accurately character- izes your response to the statement.
key: 1 = strongly 2 = disagree 3 = neutral 4 = Agree 5 = strongly disagree agree
1. i can list my three greatest weaknesses. 1 2 3 4 5
2. My actions reflect my core values. 1 2 3 4 5
3. i seek others’ opinions before making up my own mind. 1 2 3 4 5
4. i openly share my feelings with others. 1 2 3 4 5
5. i can list my three greatest strengths. 1 2 3 4 5
6. i do not allow group pressure to control me. 1 2 3 4 5
7. i listen closely to the ideas of those who disagree with me. 1 2 3 4 5
8. i let others know who i truly am as a person. 1 2 3 4 5
9. i seek feedback as a way of understanding who i really am 1 2 3 4 5 as a person.
10. other people know where i stand on controversial issues. 1 2 3 4 5
11. i do not emphasize my own point of view at the expense 1 2 3 4 5 of others.
12. i rarely present a “false” front to others. 1 2 3 4 5
13. i accept the feelings i have about myself. 1 2 3 4 5
14. My morals guide what i do as a leader. 1 2 3 4 5
15. i listen very carefully to the ideas of others before 1 2 3 4 5 making decisions.
16. i admit my mistakes to others. 1 2 3 4 5
scoring
1. sum the responses on items 1, 5, 9, and 13 (self-awareness).
2. sum the responses on items 2, 6, 10, and 14 (internalized moral perspective).
3. sum the responses on items 3, 7, 11, and 15 (balanced processing).
4. sum the responses on items 4, 8, 12, and 16 (relational transparency).
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 219
total scores
self-Awareness: ______
internalized Moral Perspective: _____
Balanced Processing: _____
relational Transparency: _____
scoring interpretation
This self-assessment questionnaire is designed to measure your authentic lead- ership by assessing four components of the process: self-awareness, internal- ized moral perspective, balanced processing, and relational transparency. By comparing your scores on each of these components, you can determine which are your stronger and which are your weaker components in each cat- egory. you can interpret your authentic leadership scores using the following guideline: high = 16–20 and low = 15 and below. scores in the upper range indicate stronger authentic leadership, whereas scores in the lower range indicate weaker authentic leadership.
220 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
summAry
As a result of leadership failures in the public and private sectors, authentic leadership is emerging in response to societal demands for genuine, trust- worthy, and good leadership. Authentic leadership describes leadership that is transparent, morally grounded, and responsive to people’s needs and val- ues. Even though authentic leadership is still in the early stages of develop- ment, the study of authentic leadership is timely and worthwhile, offering hope to people who long for true leadership.
Although there is no single accepted definition of authentic leadership, it can be conceptualized intrapersonally, developmentally, and interpersonally. The intrapersonal perspective focuses on the leader and the leader’s knowl- edge, self-regulation, and self-concept. The interpersonal perspective claims that authentic leadership is a collective process, created by leaders and fol- lowers together. The developmental perspective emphasizes major compo- nents of authentic leadership that develop over a lifetime and are triggered by major life events.
The practical approach to authentic leadership provides basic “how to” steps to become an authentic leader. George’s approach (2003) identifies five basic dimensions of authentic leadership and the corresponding behavioral characteristics individuals need to develop to become authentic leaders.
In the social science literature, a theoretical approach to authentic leadership is emerging. Drawing from the fields of leadership, positive organizational scholarship, and ethics, researchers have identified four major components of authentic leadership: self-awareness, internalized moral perspective, bal- anced processing, and relational transparency.
In addition, researchers have found that authentic leadership is influenced by a leader’s positive psychological capacities, moral reasoning, and critical life events.
Authentic leadership has several positive features. First, it provides an answer to people who are searching for good and sound leadership in an uncertain world. Second, authentic leadership is prescriptive and provides a great deal of information about how leaders can learn to become authen- tic. Third, it has an explicit moral dimension that asserts that leaders need to do what is “right” and “good” for their followers and society. Fourth, it is framed as a process that is developed by leaders over time rather than as a fixed trait. Last, authentic leadership can be measured with a theory- based instrument.
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 221
There are also negative features to authentic leadership. First, the ideas set forth in the practical approach need to be treated cautiously because they have not been fully substantiated by research. Second, the moral component of authentic leadership is not fully explained. For example, it does not describe how values such as justice and community are related to authentic leadership. Third, the rationale for including positive psychological capacities as an inherent part of a model of authentic leadership has not been fully explicated. Finally, there is a lack of evidence regarding the effectiveness of authentic leadership and how it is related to positive organizational outcomes.
In summary, authentic leadership is a new and exciting area of research, which holds a great deal of promise. As more research is conducted on authentic leadership, a clearer picture will emerge about the true nature of the process and the assumptions and principles that it encompasses.
sharpen your skills with sAGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerences
Avolio, B. J., & Gardner, W. L. (2005). Authentic leadership development: Getting to the root of positive forms of leadership. Leadership Quarterly, 16, 315–338.
Avolio, B. J., Walumbwa, F. O., & Weber, T. J. (2009). Leadership: Current theories, research, and future directions. Annual Review of Psychology, 60, 421–449.
Bandura, A. (1997). Self-eff icacy: The exercise of control. New York: Freeman. Bass, B. M. (1990). Handbook of leadership. New York: Free Press. Bass, B. M., & Steidlmeier, P. (1999). Ethics, character, and authentic transforma-
tional leadership. Leadership Quarterly, 10, 181–217. Burns, J. M. (1978). Leadership. New York: Harper & Row. Cameron, K. S., Dutton, J. E., & Quinn, R. E. (2003). Foundations of positive
organizational scholarship. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 3–13). San Francisco: Berrett- Koehler.
Central Asia Institute. (2011a). Central Asia Institute. Retrieved September 30, 2011, from https://www.ikat.org
Central Asia Institute. (2011b). Executive Director Greg Mortenson’s message to sup- porters 04/17/11. Retrieved September 30, 2011, from https://www.ikat.org
Chan, A. (2005). Authentic leadership measurement and development: Challenges and suggestions. In W. L. Gardner, B. J. Avolio, & F. O. Walumbwa (Eds.), Authentic leadership theory and practice: Origins, effects, and development (pp. 227–251). Oxford: Elsevier Science.
222 LeAdershiP Theory And PrACTiCe
Cianci, A. M., Hannah, S. T., Roberts, R. P., & Tsakumis, G. T. (2014). The effects of authentic leadership on followers’ ethical decision-making in the face of temp- tation: An experimental study. The Leadership Quarterly, 25, 581–594.
Cooper, C., Scandura, T. A., & Schriesheim, C. A. (2005). Looking forward but learning from our past: Potential challenges to developing authentic leadership theory and authentic leaders. Leadership Quarterly, 116, 474–495.
Covey, S. R. (1990). Principle-centered leadership. New York: Fireside. Eagly, A. H. (2005). Achieving relational authenticity in leadership: Does gender
matter? Leadership Quarterly, 16, 459–474. Flandro, C. (2011, September 25). The rise, fall and future of humanitarian Greg
Mortenson and the Central Asia Institute. Retrieved September 27, 2011, from http://www.bozemandailychronicle.com/news/
Flandro, C. (2012, April 5). Greg Mortenson, Central Asia Institute mismanaged money, reach $1M settlement with attorney general’s off ice. Retrieved August 12, 2014, from http://www.bozemandailychronicle.com/news/
Ford, B. (1978). The times of my life. New York: Harper & Row. Ford, B. (1987). Betty, a glad awakening. Garden City, NY: Doubleday. Francis, R. W. (2009). The history of the equal rights amendment. Retrieved May 29,
2009, from http://www.equalrightsamendment.org/ Fry, L. W., & Whittington, J. L. (2005). In search of authenticity: Spiritual leadership
theory as a source for future theory, research, and practice on authentic leadership. In W. L. Gardner, B. J. Avolio, & F. O. Walumbwa (Eds.), Authentic leadership theory and practice: Origins, effects, and development (pp. 183–202). Oxford: Else- vier Science.
Gardner, W. L., Avolio, B. J., Luthans, F., May, D. R., & Walumbwa, F. O. (2005). “Can you see the real me?” A self-based model of authentic leader and follower development. Leadership Quarterly, 16, 343–372.
Gardner, W. L., Avolio, B. J., & Walumbwa, F. O. (2005). Authentic leadership development: Emergent trends and future directions. In W. L. Gardner, B. J. Avolio, & F. O. Walumbwa (Eds.), Authentic leadership theory and practice: Origins, effects, and development (pp. 387–406). Oxford: Elsevier Science.
George, B. (2003). Authentic leadership: Rediscovering the secrets to creating lasting value. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
George, B., & Sims, P. (2007). True north: Discover your authentic leadership. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Helgesen, S. (1981). Wildcatters: A story of Texans, oil, and money. New York: Double- day.
Helgesen, S. (1990). The female advantage: Women’s ways of leadership. New York: Doubleday.
Howell, J. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1993). The ethics of charismatic leadership: Submis- sion or liberation? Academy of Management Executive, 6(2), 43–54.
Ilies, R., Morgeson, F. P., & Nahrgang, J. D. (2005). Authentic leadership and eudae- monic well-being: Understanding leader-follower outcomes. Leadership Quar- terly, 16, 373–394.
Kernis, M. H. (2003). Toward a conceptualization of optimal self-esteem. Psycho- logical Inquiry, 14, 1–26.
Chapter 9 Authentic Leadership 223
Krakauer, J. (1997). Into thin air: A personal account of the Mount Everest disaster. New York: Villard Books.
Krakauer, J. (2003). Under the banner of heaven: A story of violent faith. New York: Doubleday.
Krakauer, J. (2011). Three cups of deceit. New York: Anchor Books. Luthans, F., & Avolio, B. J. (2003). Authentic leadership development. In K. S.
Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 241–258). San Francisco: Berrett-Koehler.
Mortenson, G. (2009). Stones into schools: Promoting peace with education in Afghani- stan and Pakistan. New York: Penguin Books.
Mortenson, G., & Relin, D. O. (2006). Three cups of tea: One man’s mission to promote peace . . . one school at a time. New York: Penguin Books.
Shamir, B., & Eilam, G. (2005). “What’s your story?” A life-stories approach to authentic leadership development. Leadership Quarterly, 16, 395–417.
Spraggins, R. E. (2005). We the people: Men and women in the United States. Retrieved May 30, 2009, from http://www.census.gov/prod/2005pubs/censr-20.pdf
Sutcliffe, K. M., & Vogus, T. J. (2003). Organizing for resilience. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 94–110). San Francisco: Berrett-Koehler.
Walumbwa, F. O., Avolio, B. J., Gardner, W. L., Wernsing, T. S., & Peterson, S. J. (2008). Authentic leadership: Development and validation of a theory-based measure. Journal of Management, 34(1), 89–126.
10
Servant Leadership
DESCRIPTION
Servant leadership is a paradox—an approach to leadership that runs counter to common sense. Our everyday images of leadership do not coincide with leaders being servants. Leaders influence, and servants follow. How can leadership be both service and influence? How can a person be a leader and a servant at the same time? Although servant leadership seems contradic- tory and challenges our traditional beliefs about leadership, it is an approach that offers a unique perspective.
Servant leadership, which originated in the writings of Greenleaf (1970, 1972, 1977), has been of interest to leadership scholars for more than 40 years. Until recently, little empirical research on servant leadership has appeared in established peer-reviewed journals. Most of the academic and nonacademic writing on the topic has been prescriptive, focusing on how servant leadership should ideally be, rather than descriptive, focusing on what servant leadership actually is in practice (van Dierendonck, 2011). However, in the past 10 years, multiple publications have helped to clarify servant leadership and substantiate its basic assumptions.
Similar to earlier leadership theories discussed in this book (e.g., skills approach and behavioral approach), servant leadership is an approach focus- ing on leadership from the point of view of the leader and his or her behav- iors. Servant leadership emphasizes that leaders be attentive to the concerns of their followers, empathize with them, and nurture them. Servant leaders put followers f irst, empower them, and help them develop their full personal capacities. Furthermore, servant leaders are ethical (see Chapter 13, “Leadership Ethics,” for an extended discussion of this topic) and lead in
Servant Leadership Everyday Servant Leadership
226 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
ways that serve the greater good of the organization, community, and society at large.
Servant Leadership Defined
What is servant leadership? Scholars have addressed this approach from many different perspectives resulting in a variety of definitions of servant leadership. Greenleaf (1970) provides the most frequently referenced definition:
[Servant leadership] begins with the natural feeling that one wants to serve, to serve f irst. Then conscious choice brings one to aspire to lead. . . . The difference manifests itself in the care taken by the servant—first to make sure that other people’s highest priority needs are being served. The best test . . . is: do those served grow as persons; do they, while being served, become healthier, wiser, freer, more auton- omous, more likely themselves to become servants? And, what is the effect on the least privileged in society; will they benefit, or, at least, will they not be further deprived? (p. 15)
Although complex, this definition sets forth the basic ideas of servant lead- ership that have been highlighted by current scholars. Servant leaders place the good of followers over their own self-interests and emphasize follower development (Hale & Fields, 2007). They demonstrate strong moral behav- ior toward followers (Graham, 1991; Walumbwa, Hartnell, & Oke, 2010), the organization, and other stakeholders (Ehrhart, 2004). Practicing servant leadership comes more naturally for some than others, but everyone can learn to be a servant leader (Spears, 2010). Although servant leadership is sometimes treated by others as a trait, in our discussion, servant leadership is viewed as a behavior.
Historical Basis of Servant Leadership
Robert K. Greenleaf coined the term servant leadership and is the author of the seminal works on the subject. Greenleaf ’s persona and writings have significantly influenced how servant leadership has developed on the practi- cal and theoretical level. He founded the Center for Applied Ethics in 1964, now the Greenleaf Center for Servant Leadership, which provides a clearing- house and focal point for research and writing on servant leadership.
Greenleaf worked for 40 years at AT&T and, after retiring, began exploring how institutions function and how they could better serve society. He was
Being a Servant Leader Serving on Southwest
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 227
intrigued by issues of power and authority and how individuals in organiza- tions could creatively support each other. Decidedly against coercive leader- ship, Greenleaf advocated using communication to build consensus in groups.
Greenleaf credits his formulation of servant leadership to Hermann Hesse’s (1956) novel The Journey to the East. It tells the story of a group of travelers on a mythical journey who are accompanied by a servant who does menial chores for the travelers but also sustains them with his spirits and song. The servant’s presence has an extraordinary impact on the group. When the ser- vant becomes lost and disappears from the group, the travelers fall into disar- ray and abandon the journey. Without the servant, they are unable to carry on. It was the servant who was ultimately leading the group, emerging as a leader through his selfless care of the travelers.
In addition to serving, Greenleaf states that a servant leader has a social responsibility to be concerned about the “have-nots” and those less privi- leged. If inequalities and social injustices exist, a servant leader tries to remove them (Graham, 1991). In becoming a servant leader, a leader uses less institutional power and control while shifting authority to those who are being led. Servant leadership values community because it provides a face- to-face opportunity for individuals to experience interdependence, respect, trust, and individual growth (Greenleaf, 1970).
Ten Characteristics of a Servant Leader
In an attempt to clarify servant leadership for practitioners, Spears (2002) identified 10 characteristics in Greenleaf ’s writings that are central to the development of servant leadership. Together, these characteristics comprise the first model or conceptualization of servant leadership.
1. Listening. Communication between leaders and followers is an interactive process that includes sending and receiving messages (i.e., talk- ing and listening). Servant leaders communicate by listening first. They recognize that listening is a learned discipline that involves hearing and being receptive to what others have to say. Through listening, servant lead- ers acknowledge the viewpoint of followers and validate these perspectives.
2. Empathy. Empathy is “standing in the shoes” of another person and attempting to see the world from that person’s point of view. Empathetic servant leaders demonstrate that they truly understand what followers are thinking and feeling. When a servant leader shows empathy, it is confirming and validating for the follower. It makes the follower feel unique.
Unexpected Servant Leaders
228 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
3. Healing. To heal means to make whole. Servant leaders care about the personal well-being of their followers. They support followers by help- ing them overcome personal problems. Greenleaf argues that the process of healing is a two-way street—in helping followers become whole, servant leaders themselves are healed.
4. Awareness. For Greenleaf, awareness is a quality within servant leaders that makes them acutely attuned and receptive to their physical, social, and political environments. It includes understanding oneself and the impact one has on others. With awareness, servant leaders are able to step aside and view themselves and their own perspectives in the greater context of the situation.
5. Persuasion. Persuasion is clear and persistent communication that convinces others to change. As opposed to coercion, which utilizes posi- tional authority to force compliance, persuasion creates change through the use of gentle nonjudgmental argument. According to Spears (2002), Greenleaf ’s emphasis on persuasion over coercion is perhaps related to his denominational affiliation with the Religious Society of Friends (Quakers).
6. Conceptualization. Conceptualization refers to an individual’s abil- ity to be a visionary for an organization, providing a clear sense of its goals and direction. This characteristic goes beyond day-to-day operational thinking to focus on the “big picture.” Conceptualization also equips ser- vant leaders to respond to complex organizational problems in creative ways, enabling them to deal with the intricacies of the organization in relationship to its long-term goals.
7. Foresight. Foresight encompasses a servant leader’s ability to know the future. It is an ability to predict what is coming based on what is occur- ring in the present and what has happened in the past. For Greenleaf, foresight has an ethical dimension because he believes leaders should be held accountable for any failures to anticipate what reasonably could be foreseen and to act on that understanding.
8. Stewardship. Stewardship is about taking responsibility for the lead- ership role entrusted to the leader. Servant leaders accept the responsibility to carefully manage the people and organization they have been given to lead. In addition, they hold the organization in trust for the greater good of society.
9. Commitment to the growth of people. Greenleaf ’s conceptualization of servant leadership places a premium on treating each follower as a unique person with intrinsic value that goes beyond his or her tangible contribu- tions to the organization. Servant leaders are committed to helping each person in the organization grow personally and professionally. Commitment
Stewardship
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 229
can take many forms, including providing followers with opportunities for career development, helping them develop new work skills, taking a per- sonal interest in the their ideas, and involving them in decision making (Spears, 2002).
10. Building community. Servant leadership fosters the development of community. A community is a collection of individuals who have shared interests and pursuits and feel a sense of unity and relatedness. Community allows followers to identify with something greater than themselves that they value. Servant leaders build community to provide a place where people can feel safe and connected with others, but are still allowed to express their own individuality.
These 10 characteristics of servant leadership represent Greenleaf ’s seminal work on the servant as leader. They provide a creative lens from which to view the complexities of servant leadership.
Building a Theory About Servant Leadership
For more than three decades after Greenleaf ’s original writings, servant leader- ship remained a set of loosely defined characteristics and normative principles. In this form it was widely accepted as a leadership approach, rather than a theory, that has strong heuristic and practical value. Praise for servant leadership came from a wide range of well-known leadership writers, including Bennis (2002), Blanchard and Hodges (2003), Covey (2002), DePree (2002), Senge (2002), and Wheatley (2002). At the same time, servant leadership was adopted as a guiding philosophy in many well-known organizations such as The Toro Company, Herman Miller, Synovus Financial Corporation, ServiceMaster, Men’s Wearhouse, Southwest Airlines, and TDIndustries (Spears, 2002). Although novel and paradoxical, the basic ideas and prescriptions of servant leadership resonated with many as an ideal way to run an organization.
More recently, researchers have begun to examine the conceptual under- pinnings of servant leadership in an effort to build a theory about it. These studies have resulted in a wide array of models that describe servant leader- ship using a multitude of variables. For example, Russell and Stone (2002) developed a practical model of servant leadership that contained 20 attri- butes, nine functional characteristics (distinctive behaviors observed in the workplace), and 11 accompanying characteristics that augment these behav- iors. Similarly, Patterson (2003) created a value-based model of servant leadership that distinguished seven constructs that characterize the virtues and shape the behaviors of servant leaders.
dave ramsey Servant Leadership Framework
230
Ta b
le 1
0. 1
K ey
c h
ar ac
te ri
st ic
s o
f Se
rv an
t Le
ad er
sh ip
La ub
(1 99
9) W
on g
& D
av ey
(2
00 7)
Ba rb
ut o
& W
he el
er
(2 00
6) D
en ni
s &
B oc
ar ne
a (2
00 5)
Se nd
ja ya
, S ar
ro s,
&
Sa nt
or a
(2 00
8) va
n D
ie re
nd on
ck &
N
ui jt
en (2
01 1)
• d
ev el
o p
in g
p
eo p
le •
Sh ar
in g
le
ad er
sh ip
• d
is p
la yi
n g
au
th en
ti ci
ty •
V al
u in
g
p eo
p le
• pr
o vi
d in
g
le ad
er sh
ip •
B u
ild in
g
co m
m u
n it
y
• Se
rv in
g a
n d
d
ev el
o p
in g
o
th er
s •
c o
n su
lt in
g
an d
in vo
lv in
g
o th
er s
• h
u m
ili ty
a n
d
se lf
le ss
n es
s •
M o
d el
in g
in
te g
ri ty
a n
d
au th
en ti
ci ty
• in
sp ir
in g
a n
d
in fl
u en
ci n
g
o th
er s
• a
lt ru
is ti
c ca
lli n
g •
Em o
ti o
n al
h
ea lin
g •
pe rs
u as
iv e
m ap
p in
g •
o rg
an iz
at io
n al
st
ew ar
d sh
ip •
W is
d o
m
• Em
p o
w er
m en
t •
Tr u
st •
h u
m ili
ty •
a g
ap ao
lo ve
• V
is io
n
• Tr
an sf
o rm
in g
in
fl u
en ce
• V
o lu
n ta
ry
su b
o rd
in at
io n
• a
u th
en ti
c se
lf •
Tr an
sc en
d en
ta l
sp ir
it u
al it
y •
c o
ve n
an ta
l re
la ti
o n
sh ip
• r
es p
o n
si b
le
m o
ra lit
y
• Em
p o
w er
m en
t •
h u
m ili
ty •
St an
d in
g b
ac k
• a
u th
en ti
ci ty
• Fo
rg iv
en es
s •
c o
u ra
g e
• a
cc o
u n
ta b
ili ty
• S
te w
ar d
sh ip
So U
r c
E: a
d ap
te d
f ro
m v
an d
ie re
n d
o n
ck , d
. ( 20
11 ).
S er
va n
t le
ad er
sh ip
: a r
ev ie
w a
n d
s yn
th es
es . J
o u
rn al
o f
M an
ag em
en t,
3 7(
4) , 1
22 8–
12 61
.
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 231
Other conceptualizations of servant leadership have emerged from researchers’ efforts to develop and validate instruments to measure the core dimensions of the servant leadership process. Table 10.1 provides a summary of some of these studies, illustrating clearly the extensiveness of characteristics related to ser- vant leadership. This table also exhibits the lack of agreement among research- ers on what specific characteristics define servant leadership. While some of the studies include common characteristics, such as humility or empowerment, none of the studies conceptualize servant leadership in exactly the same way. In addition, Table 10.1 demonstrates how servant leadership is treated as a trait phenomenon (e.g., courage, humility) in some studies while other researchers regard it as a behavioral process (e.g., serving and developing oth- ers). Although scholars are not in agreement regarding the primary attributes of servant leadership, these studies provide the groundwork necessary for the development of a refined model of servant leadership.
MODEL Of SERvaNT LEaDERShIP
This chapter presents a servant leadership model based on Liden, Wayne, Zhao, and Henderson (2008) and Liden, Panaccio, Hu, and Meuser (2014) that has three main components: antecedent conditions, servant leader behaviors, and leadership outcomes (Figure 10.1). The model is intended to clarify the phenomenon of servant leadership and provide a framework for understanding its complexities.
Antecedent Conditions
As shown on the left side of Figure 10.1, three antecedent, or existing, con- ditions have an impact on servant leadership: context and culture, leader attri- butes, and follower receptivity. These conditions are not inclusive of all the conditions that affect servant leadership, but do represent some factors likely to influence the leadership process.
Context and Culture. Servant leadership does not occur in a vacuum but occurs within a given organizational context and a particular culture. The nature of each of these affects the way servant leadership is carried out. For example, in health care and nonprofit settings, the norm of caring is more prevalent, while for Wall Street corporations it is more common to have competition as an operative norm. Because the norms differ, the ways ser- vant leadership is performed may vary.
Dimensions of culture (see Chapter 16, “Culture and Leadership”) will also influence servant leadership. For example, in cultures where power distance
232 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
is low (e.g., Nordic Europe) and power is shared equally among people at all levels of society, servant leadership may be more common. In cultures with low humane orientation (e.g., Germanic Europe), servant leadership may present more of a challenge. The point is that cultures influence the way servant leadership is able to be achieved.
Leader Attributes. As in any leadership situation, the qualities and dispo- sition of the leader influence the servant leadership process. Individuals bring their own traits and ideas about leading to leadership situations. Some may feel a deep desire to serve or are strongly motivated to lead. Others may be driven by a sense of higher calling (Sendjaya, Sarros, & Santora, 2008). These dispositions shape how individuals demonstrate servant leadership. In addition, people differ in areas such as moral development, emotional intelligence, and self-determinedness, and these traits interact with their ability to engage in servant leadership.
Follower Receptivity. The receptivity of followers is a factor that appears to influence the impact of servant leadership on outcomes such as personal and organizational job performance. Follower receptivity concerns the
Context and Culture
Leader Attributes
Follower Receptivity
Outcomes
Follower Performance and Growth
Organizational Performance
Societal Impact
Servant Leader Behaviors
• Conceptualizing
• Emotional Healing
• Putting Followers First
• Helping Followers Grow and Succeed
• Behaving Ethically
• Empowering
• Creating Value for the Community
Antecedent Conditions
figure 10.1 Model of Servant Leadership
SoUrcE: adapted from Liden, r. c., panaccio, a., hu, J., & Meuser, J. d. (2014). Servant leadership: antecedents, consequences, and contextual moderators. in d. V. day (Ed.), The Oxford handbook of leadership and organizations. oxford, England: oxford University press; and van dierendonck, d. (2011). Servant leadership: a review and syntheses. Journal of Management, 37(4), 1228–1261.
The ripple Effect antecedents of Servant Leadership
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 233
question “Do all followers show a desire for servant leadership?” Research suggests the answer may be no. Some followers do not want to work with servant leaders. They equate servant leadership with micromanagement, and report that they do not want their leader to get to know them or try to help, develop, or guide them (Liden, Wayne, et al., 2008). Similarly, Meuser, Liden, Wayne, and Henderson (2011) found empirical evidence showing that when servant leadership was matched with followers who desired it, this type of leadership had a positive impact on performance and organiza- tional citizenship behavior. The opposite was seen when there was no match between servant leadership and the desire of followers for it. It appears that, for some followers, servant leadership has a positive impact and, for others, servant leadership is not effective.
Servant Leader Behaviors
The middle component of Figure 10.1 identifies seven servant leader behaviors that are the core of the servant leadership process. These behav- iors emerged from Liden, Wayne, et al.’s (2008) vigorous efforts to develop and validate a measure of servant leadership. The findings from their research provide evidence for the soundness of viewing servant leadership as a multidimensional process. Collectively, these behaviors are the central focus of servant leadership. Individually, each behavior makes a unique contribution.
Conceptualizing. Conceptualizing refers to the servant leader’s thorough understanding of the organization—its purposes, complexities, and mission. This capacity allows servant leaders to think through multifaceted prob- lems, to know if something is going wrong, and to address problems cre- atively in accordance with the overall goals of the organization.
For example, Kate Simpson, a senior nursing supervisor in an emergency room of a large hospital, uses conceptualizing to lead her department. She fully understands the mission of the hospital and, at the same time, knows how to effectively manage staff on a day-to-day basis. Her staff members say Kate has a sixth sense about what is best for people. She is known for her wisdom in dealing with difficult patients and helping staff diagnose complex medical problems. Her abilities, competency, and value as a servant leader earned her the hospital’s Caregiver of the Year Award.
Emotional Healing. Emotional healing involves being sensitive to the personal concerns and well-being of others. It includes recognizing others’
Servant Leader Beginnings
234 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
problems and being willing to take the time to address them. Servant leaders who exhibit emotional healing make themselves available to oth- ers, stand by them, and provide them with support.
Emotional healing is apparent in the work of Father John, a much sought- after hospice priest on Chicago’s South Side. Father John has a unique approach to hospice patients: He doesn’t encourage, give advice, or read Scripture. Instead he simply listens to them. “When you face death, the only important thing in life is relationships,” he says. “I practice the art of stand- ing by. I think it is more important to come just to be there than to do anything else.”
Putting Followers First. Putting others first is the sine qua non of servant leadership—the defining characteristic. It means using actions and words that clearly demonstrate to followers that their concerns are a priority, including placing followers’ interests and success ahead of those of the leader. It may mean a leader breaks from his or her own tasks to assist fol- lowers with theirs.
Dr. Autumn Klein, a widely published health education professor at a major research university, is responsible for several ongoing large interdisciplinary public health studies. Although she is the principal investigator on these studies, when multiauthored articles are submitted for publication, Dr. Klein puts the names of other researchers before her own. She chooses to let oth- ers be recognized because she knows it will benefit them in their annual performance reviews. She puts the success of her colleagues ahead of her own interests.
Helping Followers Grow and Succeed. This behavior refers to know- ing followers’ professional or personal goals and helping them to accom- plish those aspirations. Servant leaders make followers’ career development a priority, including mentoring followers and providing them with sup- port. At its core, helping followers grow and succeed is about aiding these individuals to become self-actualized, reaching their fullest human potential.
An example of how a leader helps others grow and succeed is Mr. Yon Kim, a high school orchestra teacher who consistently receives praise from parents for his outstanding work with students. Mr. Kim is a skilled violinist with high musical standards, but he does not let that get in the way of helping each student, from the most highly accomplished to the least capable. Students like Mr. Kim because he listens to them and treats them as adults.
community health nursing
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 235
He gives feedback without being judgmental. Many of his former students have gone on to become music majors. They often visit Mr. Kim to let him know how important he was to them. Yon Kim is a servant leader who helps students grow through his teaching and guidance.
Behaving Ethically. Behaving ethically is doing the right thing in the right way. It is holding to strong ethical standards, including being open, honest, and fair with followers. Servant leaders do not compromise their ethical principles in order to achieve success.
An example of ethical behavior is how CEO Elizabeth Angliss responded when one of her employees brought her a copy of a leaked document from their company’s chief competitor, outlining its plans to go after some of Angliss’s largest customers. Although she knew the document undoubtedly had valuable information, she shredded it instead of reading it. She then called the rival CEO and told him she had received the document and wanted him to be aware that he might have a security issue within his com- pany. “I didn’t know if what I received was real or not,” she explains. “But it didn’t matter. If it was the real thing, someone on his end did something wrong, and my company wasn’t going to capitalize on that.”
Empowering. Empowering refers to allowing followers the freedom to be independent, make decisions on their own, and be self-sufficient. It is a way for leaders to share power with followers by allowing them to have control. Empowerment builds followers’ confidence in their own capacities to think and act on their own because they are given the freedom to handle difficult situations in the way they feel is best.
For example, a college professor teaching a large lecture class empowers two teaching assistants assigned to him by letting them set their own office hours, independently grade student papers, and practice teaching by giving one of the weekly class lectures. They become confident in their teaching abilities and bring new ideas to the professor to try in the classroom.
Creating Value for the Community. Servant leaders create value for the community by consciously and intentionally giving back to the community. They are involved in local activities and encourage followers to also volun- teer for community service. Creating value for the community is one way for leaders to link the purposes and goals of an organization with the broader purposes of the community.
community Building
236 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
An example of creating value for the community can be seen in the leader- ship of Mercedes Urbanez, principal of Alger High School. Alger is an alter- native high school in a midsize community with three other high schools. Mercedes’s care and concern for students at Alger is remarkable. Ten percent of Alger’s students have children, so the school provides on-site day care. Fifteen percent of the students are on probation, and Alger is often their last stop before dropping out entirely and resuming criminal activities. While the other schools in town foster competition and push advanced placement courses, Alger focuses on removing the barriers that keep its students from excelling and offers courses that provide what its students need including multimedia skills, reading remediation, and parenting.
Under Mercedes, Alger High School is a model alternative school appreci- ated at every level in the community. Students, who have failed in other schools, find they have a safe place to go where they are accepted and adults try to help them solve their problems. Law enforcement supports the school’s efforts to help these students get back into the mainstream of soci- ety and away from crime. The other high schools in the community know that Alger provides services they find difficult to provide. Mercedes Urbanez serves the have-nots in the community, and the whole community reaps the benefits.
Outcomes
Although servant leadership focuses primarily on leader behaviors, it is also important to examine the potential outcomes of servant leadership. The outcomes of servant leadership are follower performance and growth, organi- zational performance, and societal impact (see Figure 10.1). As Greenleaf highlighted in his original work (1970), the central goal of servant leader- ship is to create healthy organizations that nurture individual growth, strengthen organizational performance, and, in the end, produce a positive impact on society.
Follower Performance and Growth. In the model of servant leadership, most of the servant leader behaviors focus directly on recognizing followers’ contributions and helping them realize their human potential. The expected outcome for followers is greater self-actualization. That is, followers will realize their full capabilities when leaders nurture them, help them with their personal goals, and give them control.
Another outcome of servant leadership, suggested by Meuser et al. (2011), is that it will have a favorable impact on follower in-role performance—the
Servant Leadership review
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 237
way followers do their assigned work. When servant leaders were matched with followers who were open to this type of leadership, the results were positive. Followers became more effective at accomplishing their jobs and fulfilling their job descriptions.
Finally, another expected result of servant leadership is that followers them- selves may become servant leaders. Greenleaf ’s conceptualization of servant leadership hypothesizes that when followers receive caring and empower- ment from ethical leaders they, in turn, will likely begin treating others in this way. Servant leadership would produce a ripple effect in which servant leaders create more servant leaders. Further research is needed, however, to test this hypothesis.
Organizational Performance. In addition to positively affecting fol- lowers and their performance, initial research has shown that servant leadership has an influence on organizational performance. Several studies have found a positive relationship between servant leadership and organizational citizenship behaviors (OCBs), which are follower behaviors that go beyond the basic requirements of their duties and help the overall functioning of the organization (Ehrhart, 2004; Liden, Wayne, et al., 2008; Neubert, Kacmar, Carlson, Chonko, & Roberts, 2008; Walumbwa et al., 2010).
Servant leadership also affects the way organizational teams function. Hu and Liden (2011) found that servant leadership enhanced team effectiveness by increasing the members’ shared confidence that they could be effective as a work group. Furthermore, their results showed that servant leadership contributed positively to team potency by enhancing group process and clarity. However, when servant leadership was absent, team potency decreased, despite clearer goals. In essence, it frustrates people to know exactly what the goal is, but not get the support needed to accomplish the goal.
Current research on organizational outcomes is in its initial stages. Further study is needed to substantiate the direct and indirect ways that servant leadership is related to organizational performance.
Societal Impact. Another outcome expected of servant leadership is that it is likely to have a positive impact on society. Although societal impact is not commonly measured in studies of servant leadership, there are examples of servant leadership’s impact that are highly visible. One example we are all familiar with is the work of Mother Teresa whose years of service for the
cultural Servant Leadership
238 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
hungry, homeless, and unwanted resulted in the creation of a new religious order, the Missionaries of Charity. This order now has more than 1 million workers in over 40 countries that operate hospitals, schools, and hospices for the poor. Mother Teresa’s servant leadership has had an extraordinary impact on society throughout the world.
In the business world, an example of the societal impact of servant leadership can be observed at Southwest Airlines (see Case 10.3). Leaders at Southwest instituted an “others first” organizational philosophy in the management of the company, which starts with how it treats its employees. This philosophy is adhered to by those employees who themselves become servant leaders in regards to the airline’s customers. Because the company thrives, it impacts society by providing jobs in the communities it serves and, to a lesser extent, by providing the customers who rely on it with transportation.
In his conceptualization of servant leadership, Greenleaf did not frame the process as one that was intended to directly change society. Rather, he visu- alizes leaders who become servants first and listen to others and help them grow. As a result, their organizations are healthier, ultimately benefiting soci- ety. In this way, the long-term outcomes of putting others first include pos- itive social change and helping society flourish.
Summary of the Model of Servant Leadership
In summary, the model of servant leadership consists of three components: antecedent conditions, servant leader behaviors, and outcomes. The central focus of the model is the seven behaviors of leaders that foster servant lead- ership: conceptualizing, emotional healing, putting followers first, helping followers grow and succeed, behaving ethically, empowering, and creating value for the community. These behaviors are influenced by context and culture, the leader’s attributes, and the followers’ receptivity to this kind of leadership. When individuals engage in servant leadership, it is likely to improve outcomes at the individual, organizational, and societal levels.
hOw DOES SERvaNT LEaDERShIP wORk?
The servant leadership approach works differently than many of the prior theories we have discussed in this book. For example, it is unlike the trait approach (Chapter 2), which emphasizes that leaders should have certain specific traits. It is also unlike path–goal theory (Chapter 6), which lays out principles regarding what style of leadership is needed in various situations.
Servant Leaders iron Man helps the homeless
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 239
Instead, servant leadership focuses on the behaviors leaders should exhibit to put followers first and to support followers’ personal development. It is con- cerned with how leaders treat followers and the outcomes that are likely to emerge.
So what is the mechanism that explains how servant leadership works? It begins when leaders commit themselves to putting their followers first, being honest with them, and treating them fairly. Servant leaders make it a priority to listen to their followers and develop strong long-term relation- ships with them. This allows leaders to understand the abilities, needs, and goals of followers, which, in turn, allows these followers to achieve their full potential. When many leaders in an organization adopt a servant leadership orientation, a culture of serving others within and outside the organization is created (Liden, Wayne, et al., 2008).
Servant leadership works best when leaders are altruistic and have a strong moti- vation and deep-seated interest in helping others. In addition, for successful servant leadership to occur, it is important that followers are open and receptive to servant leaders who want to empower them and help them grow.
It should be noted that in much of the writing on servant leadership there is an underlying philosophical position, originally set forth by Greenleaf (1970), that leaders should be altruistic and humanistic. Rather than using their power to dominate others, leaders should make every attempt to share their power and enable others to grow and become autonomous. Leadership framed from this perspective downplays competition in the organization and promotes egalitarianism.
Finally, in an ideal world, servant leadership results in community and soci- etal change. Individuals within an organization who care for each other become committed to developing an organization that cares for the com- munity. Organizations that adopt a servant leadership culture are committed to helping those in need who operate outside of the organization. Servant leadership extends to serving the “have-nots” in society (Graham, 1991). Case 10.2 in this chapter provides a striking example of how one servant leader’s work led to positive outcomes for many throughout the world.
STRENgThS
In its current stage of development, research on servant leadership has made several positive contributions to the field of leadership. First, while there are other leadership approaches such as transformational and
Service Leadership
240 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
authentic leadership that include an ethical dimension, servant leadership is unique in the way it makes altruism the central component of the lead- ership process. Servant leadership argues unabashedly that leaders should put followers first, share control with followers, and embrace their growth. It is the only leadership approach that frames the leadership process around the principle of caring for others.
Second, servant leadership provides a counterintuitive and provocative approach to the use of influence, or power, in leadership. Nearly all other theories of leadership treat influence as a positive factor in the leadership process, but servant leadership does just the opposite. It argues that leaders should not dominate, direct, or control; but rather, leaders should share con- trol and influence. To give up control rather than seek control is the goal of servant leadership. Servant leadership is an influence process that does not incorporate influence in a traditional way.
Third, rather than imply that servant leadership is a panacea, research on servant leadership has shown there are conditions under which servant lead- ership is not a preferred kind of leadership. Findings indicate that servant leadership may not be effective in contexts where followers are not open to being guided, supported, and empowered. Followers’ readiness to receive ser- vant leadership moderates the potential usefulness of leading from this approach (Liden, Wayne, et al., 2008).
Fourth, recent research has resulted in a sound measure of servant leadership. Using a rigorous methodology, Liden, Wayne, et al. (2008) developed and validated the Servant Leadership Questionnaire (SLQ), which appears at the end of the chapter. It comprises 28 items that identify seven distinct dimensions of servant leadership. Studies show that the SLQ is unique and measures aspects of leadership that are different from those measured by the transformational and leader–member exchange theories (Liden, Wayne, et al., 2008; Schaubroeck, Lam, & Peng, 2011). The SLQ has proved to be a suitable instrument for use in future research on servant leadership.
CRITICISMS
In addition to the positive features of servant leadership, this approach has several limitations. First, the paradoxical nature of the title “servant leadership” creates semantic noise that diminishes the potential value of the approach. Because the name appears contradictory, servant leadership is prone to be perceived as fanciful or whimsical. In addition, being a servant leader
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 241
implies following, and following is viewed as the opposite of leading. Although servant leadership incorporates influence, the mechanism of how influence functions as a part of servant leadership is not fully explicated in the approach.
Second, there is debate among servant leadership scholars regarding the core dimensions of the process. As illustrated in Table 10.1, servant leadership is hypothesized to include a multitude of abilities, traits, and behaviors. To date, researchers have been unable to reach consensus on a common defini- tion or theoretical framework for servant leadership (van Dierendonck, 2011). Until a larger body of findings is published on servant leadership, the robustness of theoretical formulations about it will remain limited.
Third, a large segment of the writing on servant leadership has a prescriptive overtone that implies that good leaders “put others first.” While advocating an altruistic approach to leadership is commendable, it has a utopian ring because it conflicts with individual autonomy and other principles of leader- ship such as directing, concern for production, goal setting, and creating a vision (Gergen, 2006). Furthermore, along with the “value-push” prescriptive quality, there is an almost moralistic nature that seems to surround servant leadership. As a result, many practitioners of servant leadership are not nec- essarily researchers who want to conduct studies to test the validity of ser- vant leadership theory.
Finally, it is unclear why “conceptualizing” is included as one of the servant leadership behaviors in the model of servant leadership (see Figure 10.1). Is conceptualizing actually a behavior, or is it a cognitive ability? Furthermore, what is the rationale for identifying conceptualizing as a determinant of servant leadership? Being able to conceptualize is undoubtedly an important cognitive capacity in all kinds of leadership, but why is it a defining charac- teristic of servant leadership? A clearer explanation for its central role in servant leadership needs to be addressed in future research.
aPPLICaTION
Servant leadership can be applied at all levels of management and in all types of organizations. Within a philosophical framework of caring for oth- ers, servant leadership sets forth a list of behaviors that individuals can engage in if they want to be servant leaders. The prescribed behaviors of servant leadership are not esoteric; they are easily understood and generally applicable to a variety of leadership situations.
242 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
Unlike leader–member exchange theory (Chapter 7) or authentic leadership (Chapter 9), which are not widely used in training and development, servant leadership has been used extensively in a variety of organizations for more than 30 years. Many organizations in the Fortune 500 (e.g., Starbucks, AT&T, Southwest Airlines, and Vanguard Group) employ ideas from ser- vant leadership. Training in servant leadership typically involves self- assessment exercises, educational sessions, and goal setting. The content of servant leadership is straightforward and accessible to followers at every level within the organization.
Liden, Wayne, et al. (2008) suggest that organizations that want to build a culture of servant leadership should be careful to select people who are inter- ested in and capable of building long-term relationships with followers. Furthermore, because “behaving ethically” is positively related to job perfor- mance, organizations should focus on selecting people who have high integ- rity and strong ethics. In addition, organizations should develop training programs that spend time helping leaders develop their emotional intelli- gence, ethical decision making, and skills for empowering others. Behaviors such as these will help leaders nurture followers to their full potential.
Servant leadership is taught at many colleges and universities around the world and is the focus of numerous independent coaches, trainers, and con- sultants. In the United States, Gonzaga University and Regent University are recognized as prominent leaders in this area because of the academic attention they have given to servant leadership. Overall, the most recognized and comprehensive center for training in servant leadership is the Greenleaf Center for Servant Leadership (www.greenleaf.org).
In summary, servant leadership provides a philosophy and set of behaviors that individuals in the organizational setting can learn and develop. The following section features cases illustrating how servant leadership has been manifested in different ways.
CaSE STUDIES
This section provides three case studies (Cases 10.1, 10.2, and 10.3) that illustrate different facets of servant leadership. The first case describes the servant leadership of a high school secretary. The second case is about Dr. Paul Farmer and his efforts to stop disease in Haiti and other parts of the world. The third case is about the leaders of Southwest Airlines who created a servant leadership culture that permeates the company. At the end
Emotional intelligence in Servant Leaders
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 243
of each case, several questions are provided to help you analyze the case from the perspective of servant leadership.
Case 10.1
Everyone Loves Mrs. Noble
Sharon noble is in charge of the main office at Essex high School, a position she has held for nearly 30 years. She does not have a college degree, but that does not seem to hinder her work as “secretary” for the school. She is an extravert, and people say her jokes are corny, but she runs the office efficiently and well, getting along with teachers and students and dealing with the rules and procedures that govern day-to-day Essex school life.
When people describe Sharon, they say that she is wise and seems to know just about everything there is to know about the school. She understands the core curriculum, testing, dress code, skip policy, after- school programs, helicopter parents, and much more. if students want to have a bake sale, she tells them the best way to do it. if they want to take advanced placement courses, she tells them which ones to take. The list of what she knows is endless. For years parents have told one another, “if you want to know anything about the school, go to Mrs. noble—she is Essex high School.”
There is nothing pretentious about Mrs. noble. She drives an old car and wears simple clothes. Students say they’ve never seen her wear makeup. But nevertheless, she is still “with it” when it comes to student fads and eccentricities. When students had long hair and fringed vests in the 1970s, Sharon was cool with it. She never mocks students who are “way out” and seems to even enjoy these students. When students wear clothes to get attention because they feel ostracized, Sharon is accepting and even acknowledges the “uniqueness” of their act, unless it violates the dress code. in those cases, she talks nonjudgmentally with students about their clothing, guiding them to make different choices to stay out of trouble.
Even though it isn’t technically in her job description, Mrs. noble excels at helping juniors prepare applications for college. She knows all the requirements and deadlines and the materials required by the different universities. She spends hours pushing, nudging, and convincing students to stay on task and get their applications submitted. She doesn’t care if students go to ivy League schools, state schools, or community colleges; but she does care if they go on to school. Mrs. noble regrets not having been able to attend college, so it is important to her that “her” students do everything they can to go.
(Continued)
244 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
at times her job is challenging. For example, the principal made teaching assignments that the faculty did not like, and Sharon was the one they shared their concerns with. She was a great listener and helped them see the differing perspectives of the situation. one year, when a student was in a car accident and unable to come to school for several months, Sharon personally worked with each one of the student’s teachers to get her assignments, delivered them to the student’s home, and picked them up when they were complete. When the seniors held a dance marathon to raise money for cancer research, it was Sharon who pledged the most, even though she didn’t make very much as the school’s secretary. She wanted to make sure each senior participating had at least one pledge on his or her roster; in most cases it was Sharon’s.
in 2010, the class of 1989 had its 25-year reunion, and of all the memories shared, the most were about Sharon noble. Essex high School had a won- derful principal, many good teachers, and great coaches, but when alumni were asked, who runs the school? The answer was always “Mrs. noble.”
Questions
1. What servant leader behaviors would you say Mrs. noble demon- strates?
2. Who are Mrs. noble’s followers?
3. Based on the model of servant leadership (Figure 10.1), what out- comes has Mrs. noble’s servant leadership attained?
4. can you think of someone at a school or organization you were part of who acted like Mrs. noble? describe what this person did and how it affected you and the school or organization.
(continued)
Case 10.2
Doctor to the Poor
“Education wasn’t what he wanted to perform on the world . . . He was after transformation.”
—Kidder (2003, p. 44)
When paul Farmer graduated from duke University at 22, he was unsure whether he wanted to be an anthropologist or a doctor. So he
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 245
went to haiti. as a student, paul had become obsessed with the island nation after meeting many haitians at local migrant camps. paul was used to the grittier side of life; he had grown up in a family of eight that lived in a converted school bus and later on a houseboat moored in a bayou. But what he observed at the migrant camps and learned from his discussions with haitian immigrants made his childhood seem idyllic.
in haiti, he volunteered for a small charity called Eye care haiti, which conducted outreach clinics in rural areas. he was drawn in by the deplorable conditions and lives of the haitian people and deter- mined to use his time there to learn everything he could about illness and disease afflicting the poor. Before long, paul realized that he had found his life’s purpose: he’d be a doctor to poor people, and he’d start in haiti.
paul entered harvard University in 1984 and, for the first two years, traveled back and forth to haiti where he conducted a health census in the village of cange. during that time he conceived of a plan to fight disease in haiti by developing a public health system that included vac- cination programs and clean water and sanitation. The heart of this program, however, would be a cadre of people from the villages who were trained to administer medicines, teach health classes, treat minor ailments, and recognize the symptoms of grave illnesses such as hiV, tuberculosis, and malaria.
his vision became reality in 1987, thanks to a wealthy donor who gave $1 million to help paul create partners in health (pih). at first it wasn’t much of an organization—no staff, a small advisory board, and three committed volunteers. But its work was impressive: pih began building schools and clinics in and around cange. Soon pih established a training program for health outreach workers and organized a mobile unit to screen residents of area villages for preventable diseases.
in 1990, paul finished his medical studies and became a fellow in infec- tious diseases at Brigham and Women’s hospital in Boston. he was able to remain in haiti for most of each year, returning to Boston to work at Brigham for a few months at a time, sleeping in the basement of pih headquarters.
it wasn’t long before pih’s successes started gaining attention outside of haiti. Because of its success treating the disease in haiti, the World health organization appointed paul and pih staffer Jim yong Kim to spearhead pilot treatment programs for multiple-drug-resistant tuberculosis (Mdr-TB). paul’s attention was now diverted to the slums of peru and russia where cases of Mdr-TB were on the rise. in peru, paul and pih
(Continued)
246 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
encountered barriers in treating Mdr-TB that had nothing to do with the disease. They ran headlong into governmental resistance and had to battle to obtain expensive medications. paul learned to gently navigate governmental obstacles, while the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation stepped in with a $44.7 million grant to help fund the program.
in 2005, pih turned its attention to another part of the world: africa, the epicenter of the global aidS pandemic. Beginning its efforts in rwanda, where few people had been tested or were receiving treatment, pih tested 30,000 people in 8 months and enrolled nearly 700 in drug ther- apy to treat the disease. Soon, the organization expanded its efforts to the african nations of Lesotho and Malawi (partners in health, 2011).
But paul’s efforts weren’t just in far-flung reaches of the world. From his work with patients at Brigham, paul observed the needs of the impover- ished in Boston. The prevention and access to care and Treatment (pacT) project was created to offer drug therapy for hiV and diabetes for the poor residents of the roxbury and dorchester districts. pih has since sent pacT project teams across the United States to provide support to other community health programs.
By 2009, partners in health had grown to 13,600 employees working in health centers and hospitals in 8 countries (partners in health, 2013), including the dominican republic, peru, Mexico, rwanda, Lesotho, Malawi, navajo nation (U.S.), and russia. Each year the organization increases the number of facilities and personnel that provide health care to the residents of some of the most impoverished and diseased places in the world. paul continues to travel around the world, monitoring programs and raising funds for pih in addition to leading the department of Global health and Social Medicine at harvard Medical School.
Questions
1. Would you characterize paul Farmer as a servant leader? Explain your answer.
2. putting others first is the essence of servant leadership. in what way does paul Farmer put others first?
3. another characteristic of a servant leader is getting followers to serve. Who are paul’s followers, and how did they become servants to his vision?
4. What role do you think paul’s childhood had in his development as a servant leader?
(continued)
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 247
Case 10.3
Servant Leadership Takes flight
a young mother traveling with a toddler on a long cross-country flight approached the flight attendant looking rather frantic. Because of weather and an hour-and-a-half wait on the runway to take off, the plane would arrive at its destination several hours late. The plane had made an intermediate stop in denver to pick up passengers but not long enough for travelers to disembark. The mother told the atten- dant that with the delays and the long flight, her child had already eaten all the food she brought and if she didn’t feed him soon he was bound to have a total meltdown. “can i get off for five minutes just to run and get something for him to eat?” she pleaded.
“i have to recommend strongly that you stay on the plane,” the atten- dant said, sternly. But then, with a smile, she added, “But i can get off. The plane won’t leave without me. What can i get your son to eat?”
Turns out that flight attendant not only got the little boy a meal, but brought four other children on board meals as well. anyone who has traveled in a plane with screaming children knows that this flight attendant not only took care of some hungry children and frantic par- ents, but also indirectly saw to the comfort of a planeload of other passengers.
This story doesn’t surprise anyone familiar with Southwest airlines. The airline’s mission statement is posted every 3 feet at all Southwest locations: Follow the Golden rule—treat people the way you want to be treated.
it’s a philosophy that the company takes to heart and begins with how it treats employees. colleen Barrett, the former president of Southwest airlines, says the company’s cofounder and her mentor, herb Kelleher, was adamant that “a happy and motivated workforce will essentially extend that goodwill to Southwest’s customers” (Knowledge@ Wharton, 2008). if the airline took care of its employees, the employ- ees would take care of the customers, and the shareholders would win, too.
From the first days of Southwest airlines, herb resisted establishing tra- ditional hierarchies within the company. he focused on finding employ- ees with substance, willing to say what they thought and committed to doing things differently. described as “an egalitarian spirit,” he employed a collaborative approach to management that involved his associates at every step.
(Continued)
248 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
colleen, who went from working as herb’s legal secretary to being the president of the airline, is living proof of his philosophy. a poor girl from rural Vermont who got the opportunity of a lifetime to work for herb when he was still just a lawyer, she rose from his aide to become vice president of administration, then executive vice president of cus- tomers, and then president and chief operating officer in 2001 (which she stepped down from in 2008). She had no formal training in avia- tion, but that didn’t matter. herb “always treated me as a complete equal to him,” she says.
it was colleen who instituted the Golden rule as the company motto and developed a model that focuses on employee satisfaction and issues first, followed by the needs of the passengers. The company hired employees for their touchy-feely attitudes and trained them for skill. Southwest airlines developed a culture that celebrated and encouraged humor. The example of being themselves on the job started at the top with herb and colleen.
This attitude has paid off. Southwest airlines posted a profit for 35 consecutive years and continues to make money while other airlines’ profits are crashing. colleen says the most important numbers on the balance sheet, however, are those that indicate how many millions of people have become frequent flyers of the airline, a number that grows every year.
Questions
1. What type of servant leader behaviors did herb Kelleher exhibit in starting the airline? What about colleen Barrett?
2. how do the leaders of Southwest airlines serve others? What others are they serving?
3. Southwest airlines emphasizes the Golden rule. What role does the Golden rule play in servant leadership? is it always a part of servant leadership? discuss.
4. Based on Figure 10.1, describe the outcomes of servant leadership at Southwest airlines, and how follower receptivity may have influenced those outcomes.
(continued)
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 249
LEaDERShIP INSTRUMENT
Many questionnaires have been used to measure servant leadership (see Table 10.1). Because of its relevance to the content, the Servant Leadership Questionnaire (SLQ) by Liden, Wayne, et al. (2008) was chosen for inclusion in this chapter. It is a 28-item scale that measures seven major dimensions of servant leadership: conceptualizing, emotional healing, putting followers first, helping followers grow and succeed, behaving ethically, empowering, and creating value for the community. Using exploratory and confirmatory factor analysis, Liden, Wayne, et al. established the multiple dimensions of this scale and described how it is uniquely different from other leadership measures.
By completing the SLQ you will gain an understanding of how servant leadership is measured and explore where you stand on the different dimensions of servant leadership. Servant leadership is a complex pro- cess, and taking the SLQ is one way to discover the dynamics of how it works.
250 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
Servant Leadership Questionnaire
Instructions: Select two people who know you in a leadership capacity such as a coworker, fellow group member, or follower. Make two copies of this ques- tionnaire and give a copy to each individual you have chosen. Using the fol- lowing 7-point scale, ask them to indicate the extent to which they agree or disagree with the following statements as they pertain to your leadership. in these statements, “he/She” is referring to you in a leadership capacity.
Key: 1 = Strongly disagree 2 = disagree 3 = disagree somewhat 4 = Undecided 5 = agree Somewhat 6 = agree 7 = Strongly agree
1. others would seek help from him/her if they had a 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 personal problem.
2. he/She emphasizes the importance of giving back to 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 the community.
3. he/She can tell if something work related is going wrong. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
4. he/She gives others the responsibility to make important 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 decisions about their own jobs.
5. he/She makes others’ career development a priority. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6. he/She cares more about others’ success than his/her own. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
7. he/She holds high ethical standards. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8. he/She cares about others’ personal well-being. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
9. he/She is always interested in helping people in the 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 community.
10. he/She is able to think through complex problems. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
11. he/She encourages others to handle important work 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 decisions on their own.
12. he/She is interested in making sure others reach their 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 career goals.
13. he/She puts others’ best interests above his/her own. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
14. he/She is always honest. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
15. he/She takes time to talk to others on a personal level. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
16. he/She is involved in community activities. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
17. he/She has a thorough understanding of the organization 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 and its goals.
18. he/She gives others the freedom to handle difficult 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 situations in the way they feel is best.
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 251
19. he/She provides others with work experiences that 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 enable them to develop new skills.
20. he/She sacrifices his/her own interests to meet 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 others’ needs.
21. he/She would not compromise ethical principles in 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 order to meet success.
22. he/She can recognize when others are feeling down 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 without asking them.
23. he/She encourages others to volunteer in the community. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
24. he/She can solve work problems with new or 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 creative ideas.
25. if others need to make important decisions at work, they 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 do not need to consult him/her.
26. he/She wants to know about others’ career goals. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
27. he/She does what he/she can to make others’ jobs easier. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
28. he/She values honesty more than profits. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
SoUrcE: reprinted (adapted version) from “Servant Leadership: development of a Multidimensional Measure and Multi-Level assessment,” by r. c. Liden, S. J. Wayne, h. Zhao, and d. henderson, 2008, The Leadership Quarterly, 19, 161–177. copyright © reprinted with permission from Elsevier Science.
Scoring
Using the questionnaires on which others assessed your leadership, take the separate scores for each item, add them together, and divide that sum by two. This will give you the average score for that item. For example, if person a assessed you at 4 for item 2, and person B marked you as a 6, your score for item 2 would be 5.
once you have averaged each item’s scores, use the following steps to com- plete the scoring of the questionnaire:
1. add up the scores on 1, 8, 15, and 22. This is your score for emotional healing.
2. add up the scores for 2, 9, 16, and 23. This is your score for creating value for the community.
3. add up the scores for 3, 10, 17, and 24. This is your score for conceptual skills.
4. add up the scores for 4, 11, 18, and 25. This is your score for empowering.
252 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
5. add up the scores for 5, 12, 19, and 26. This is your score for helping fol- lowers grow and succeed.
6. add up the scores for 6, 13, 20, and 27. This is your score for putting followers first.
7. add up the scores for 7, 14, 21, and 28. This is your score for behaving ethically.
Scoring Interpretation
• High range: a score between 23 and 28 means you strongly exhibit this servant leadership behavior.
• Moderate range: a score between 14 and 22 means you tend to exhibit this behavior in an average way.
• Low range: a score between 8 and 13 means you exhibit this leadership below the average or expected degree.
• Extremely low range: a score between 0 and 7 means you are not inclined to exhibit this leadership behavior at all.
The scores you received on the Servant Leadership Questionnaire indicate the degree to which you exhibit the seven behaviors characteristic of a servant leader. you can use the results to assess areas in which you have strong servant leadership behaviors and areas in which you may strive to improve.
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 253
SUMMaRY
Originating in the seminal work of Greenleaf (1970), servant leadership is a paradoxical approach to leadership that challenges our traditional beliefs about leadership and influence. Servant leadership emphasizes that leaders should be attentive to the needs of followers, empower them, and help them develop their full human capacities.
Servant leaders make a conscious choice to serve f irst—to place the good of followers over the leaders’ self-interests. They build strong relationships with others, are empathic and ethical, and lead in ways that serve the greater good of followers, the organization, the community, and society at large.
Based on an idea from Hermann Hesse’s (1956) novel The Journey to the East, Greenleaf argued that the selfless servant in a group has an extraordi- nary impact on the other members. Servant leaders attend fully to the needs of followers, are concerned with the less privileged, and aim to remove inequalities and social injustices. Because servant leaders shift authority to those who are being led, they exercise less institutional power and control.
Scholars have conceptualized servant leadership in multiple ways. According to Spears (2002), there are 10 major characteristics of servant leadership: listening, empathy, healing, awareness, persuasion, conceptualization, fore- sight, stewardship, commitment to the growth of people, and building com- munity. Additional efforts by social science researchers to develop and validate measures of servant leadership have resulted in an extensive list of other servant leadership attributes.
Liden, Panaccio, et al. (2014) have created a promising model of servant leadership that has three main components: antecedent conditions, servant leader behaviors, and leadership outcomes. Antecedent conditions that are likely to impact servant leaders include context and culture, leader attributes, and follower receptivity. Central to the servant leader process are the seven servant leader behaviors: conceptualizing, emotional healing, putting followers first, helping followers grow and succeed, behaving ethically, empowering, and cre- ating value for the community. The outcomes of servant leadership are follower performance and growth, organizational performance, and societal impact.
Research on servant leadership has several strengths. First, it is unique because it makes altruism the main component of the leadership process. Second, servant leadership provides a counterintuitive and provocative approach to the use of influence wherein leaders give up control rather than seek control. Third, rather than a panacea, research has shown that there are
254 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
conditions under which servant leadership is not a preferred kind of leader- ship. Last, recent research has resulted in a sound measure of servant leader- ship (Servant Leadership Questionnaire) that identifies seven distinct dimensions of the process.
The servant leadership approach also has limitations. First, the paradoxical nature of the title “servant leadership” creates semantic noise that diminishes the potential value of the approach. Second, no consensus exists on a com- mon theoretical framework for servant leadership. Third, servant leadership has a utopian ring that conflicts with traditional approaches to leadership. Last, it is not clear why “conceptualizing” is a defining characteristic of ser- vant leadership.
Despite the limitations, servant leadership continues to be an engaging approach to leadership that holds much promise. As more research is done to test the substance and assumptions of servant leadership, a better under- standing of the complexities of the process will emerge.
Sharpen your skills with SaGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
REfERENCES
Barbuto, J. E., Jr., & Wheeler, D. W. (2006). Scale development and construct clarification of servant leadership. Group and Organizational Management, 31, 300–326.
Bennis, W. (2002). Become a tomorrow leader. In L. C. Spears & M. Lawrence (Eds.), Focus on leadership: Servant-leadership for the twenty-first century (pp. 101–110). New York: Wiley.
Blanchard, K., & Hodges, P. (2003). The servant leader: Transforming your hearts, heads, hands, and habits. Nashville, TN: Thomas Nelson.
Covey, S. R. (2002). Foreword. In R. K. Greenleaf (Ed.), Servant leadership: A journey into the nature of legitimate power and greatness (pp. 1–14). New York: Paulist Press.
Dennis, R. S., & Bocarnea, M. (2005). Development of the servant leadership assessment instrument. Leadership & Organization Development Journal, 26, 600–615.
DePree, M. (2002). Servant-leadership: Three things necessary. In L. C. Spears & M. Lawrence (Eds.), Focus on leadership: Servant-leadership for the twenty-first century (pp. 27–34). New York: Wiley.
Ehrhart, M. G. (2004). Leadership and procedural justice climate as antecedents of unit-level organizational citizenship behavior. Personnel Psychology, 57, 61–94.
chapter 10 Servant Leadership 255
Gergen, D. (2006, June 11). Bad news for bullies. U.S. News and World Report, 140, 54. Graham, J. W. (1991). Servant leadership in organizations: Inspirational and moral.
Leadership Quarterly, 2, 105–119. Greenleaf, R. K. (1970). The servant as leader. Westfield, IN: Greenleaf Center for
Servant Leadership. Greenleaf, R. K. (1972). The institution as servant. Westfield, IN: Greenleaf Center
for Servant Leadership. Greenleaf, R. K. (1977). Servant leadership: A journey into the nature of legitimate power
and greatness. New York: Paulist Press. Hale, J. R., & Fields, D. L. (2007). Exploring servant leadership across cultures:
A study of followers in Ghana and the USA. Leadership, 3, 397–417. Hesse, H. (1956). The journey to the East. London: P. Owen. Hu, J., & Liden, R. C. (2011). Antecedents of team potency and team effectiveness:
An examination of goal and process clarity and servant leadership. Journal of Applied Psychology, 96(4), 851–862.
Kidder, T. (2003). Mountains beyond mountains: The quest of Dr. Paul Farmer, a man who would cure the world. New York: Random House.
Knowledge@Wharton. (2008, July 9). Southwest Airlines’ Colleen Barrett flies high on fuel hedging and “servant leadership.” Retrieved November 13, 2011, from http:// knowledge.wharton.upenn.edu/article.cfm?articleid=2006
Laub, J. A. (1999). Assessing the servant organization: Development of the servant organizational leadership assessment (SOLA) instrument. Dissertation Abstracts International, 60(2), 308. (UMI No. 9921922)
Liden, R. C., Panaccio, A., Hu, J., & Meuser, J. D. (2014). Servant leadership: Antecedents, consequences, and contextual moderators. In D. V. Day (Ed.), The Oxford handbook of leadership and organizations. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Liden, R. C., Wayne, S. J., Zhao, H., & Henderson, D. (2008). Servant leadership: Development of a multidimensional measure and multi-level assessment. Leader- ship Quarterly, 19, 161–177.
Meuser, J. D., Liden, R. C., Wayne, S. J., & Henderson, D. J. (2011, August). Is servant leadership always a good thing? The moderating influence of servant leadership proto- type. Paper presented at the meeting of the Academy of Management, San Anto- nio, TX.
Neubert, M. J., Kacmar, K. M., Carlson, D. S., Chonko, L. B., & Roberts, J. A. (2008). Regulatory focus as a mediator of the influence of initiating structure and servant leadership on employee behavior. Journal of Applied Psychology, 93, 1220–1233.
Partners In Health. (2011). History. Retrieved September 27, 2011, from http://www .pih.org/pages/partners-in-health-history.html
Partners In Health. (2013) 2013 annual report. Retrieved August 15, 2014, from http://www.pih.org/pages/2013-annual-report
Patterson, K. A. (2003). Servant leadership: A theoretical model (Doctoral dissertation, Regent University, ATT 30882719).
Russell, R. F., & Stone, A. G. (2002). A review of servant-leadership attributes: Devel- oping a practical model. Leadership & Organization Development Journal, 23, 145–157.
256 LEadErShip ThEory and pracTicE
Schaubroeck, J., Lam, S. S. K., & Peng, A. C. (2011). Cognition-based and affect- based trust as mediators of leader behavior influences on team performance. Jour- nal of Applied Psychology, 96(4), 863–871.
Sendjaya, S., Sarros, J. C., & Santora, J. C. (2008). Defining and measuring servant leadership behaviour in organizations. Journal of Management Studies, 45(2), 402–424.
Senge, P. M. (2002). Afterword. In R. K. Greenleaf (Ed.), Servant leadership: A jour- ney into the nature of legitimate power and greatness (pp. 343–360). New York: Pau- list Press.
Spears, L. C. (2002). Tracing the past, present, and future of servant-leadership. In L. C. Spears & M. Lawrence (Eds.), Focus on leadership: Servant-leadership for the 21st century (pp. 1–16). New York: Wiley.
Spears, L. C. (2010). Servant leadership and Robert K. Greenleaf ’s legacy. In D. van Dierendonck & K. Patterson (Eds.), Servant leadership: Developments in theory and research (pp. 11–24). New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
van Dierendonck, D. (2011). Servant leadership: A review and synthesis. Journal of Management, 37(4), 1228–1261.
van Dierendonck, D., & Nuijten, I. (2011). The servant leadership survey: Develop- ment and validation of a multidimensional measure. Journal of Business and Psychol- ogy, 26, 249–267.
Walumbwa, F. O., Hartnell, C. A., & Oke, A. (2010). Servant leadership, proce- dural justice climate, service climate, employee attitudes, and organizational citizenship behavior: A cross-level investigation. Journal of Applied Psychology, 95, 517–529.
Wheatley, M. (2002). The work of the servant leader. In L. C. Spears & M. Law- rence (Eds.), Focus on leadership: Servant-leadership for the twenty-f irst century (pp. 349–362). New York: Wiley.
Wong, P. T. P., & Davey, D. (2007). Best practices in servant leadership. Paper pre- sented at the Servant Leadership Research Roundtable, Regent University, Virginia Beach, VA.
11
Adaptive Leadership
Description
As the name of the approach implies, adaptive leadership is about how leaders encourage people to adapt—to face and deal with problems, chal- lenges, and changes. Adaptive leadership focuses on the adaptations required of people in response to changing environments. Simply stated, adaptive leaders prepare and encourage people to deal with change. Unlike the trait approach (Chapter 2) or authentic leadership (Chapter 9), which focus predominantly on the characteristics of the leader, adaptive leadership stresses the activities of the leader in relation to the work of followers in the contexts in which they find themselves.
Since Heifetz first published Leadership Without Easy Answers (1994), the seminal book on adaptive leadership, this approach has occupied a unique place in the leadership literature. Adaptive leadership has been used effec- tively to explain how leaders encourage effective change across multiple lev- els, including self, organizational, community, and societal. However, most of the writing about adaptive leadership has been prescriptive and based on anecdotal and observational data rather than data derived from rigorous scientific inquiry. Scholars and practitioners have recognized the merits of the approach, but the theoretical underpinnings of adaptive leadership remain in the formative stages.
Development of the adaptive leadership framework emerged largely from the work of Heifetz and his associates (Heifetz, 1994; Heifetz & Sinder, 1988; Heifetz, Grashow, & Linsky, 2009; Heifetz & Laurie, 1997; Heifetz & Linsky, 2002). From the beginning, they set out to create a different approach to leadership. Rather than seeing the leader as a savior who solves
Adaptive Leadership Ronald Heifetz on Adaptive Leadership
258 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
problems for people, they conceptualized the leader as one who plays the role of mobilizing people to tackle tough problems (e.g., drug abuse or sex- ism in the workplace). An adaptive leader challenges others to face difficult challenges, providing them with the space or opportunity they need to learn new ways of dealing with the inevitable changes in assumptions, perceptions, beliefs, attitudes, and behaviors that they are likely to encounter in address- ing real problems.
Adaptive Leadership Defined
Although people often think of adaptive leadership as being leader centered, it is actually more follower centered. It focuses primarily on how leaders help others do the work they need to do, in order to adapt to the chal- lenges they face. Generally, adaptive leadership is concerned with how people change and adjust to new circumstances. In this chapter, we emphasize the process leaders use to encourage others to grapple with difficult problems.
In the leadership literature, Heifetz and his colleagues suggest that “adaptive leadership is the practice of mobilizing people to tackle tough challenges and thrive” (Heifetz et al., 2009, p. 14). In contrast to emphasizing the position or characteristics of the leader, this definition suggests that leadership is con- cerned with the behaviors of leaders. This approach also makes a distinction between leadership and authority (Heifetz and Sinder, 1988). Leadership revolves around work and how people are mobilized to do work. It is not defined by position, so anyone can exhibit leadership. In contrast, authority revolves around power and how it is formally (e.g., position) and informally (e.g., admiration) conferred to leaders by followers. Authority allows leaders to do what followers expect them to do and is a primary tool for exercising leadership and giving followers a sense of security and protection.
Adaptive leaders engage in activities that mobilize, motivate, organize, orient, and focus the attention of others (Heifetz, 1994). In addition, this approach to leadership is about helping others to explore and change their values. The goal of adaptive leadership is to encourage people to change and learn new ways of living so that they may do well and grow. In short, adaptive leader- ship is the behavior of leaders and the actions they take to encourage others to address and resolve changes that are central in their lives. To better under- stand how adaptive leadership works, Table 11.1 provides some examples of “real world” situations in which adaptive leadership would be ideal.
Conceptually, the process of adaptive leadership incorporates ideas from four different viewpoints: the systems, biological, service orientation, and psycho- therapy perspectives (Heifetz, 1994). First, adaptive leadership takes a systems
nature of Adaptive Leadership
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 259
table 11.1 Adaptive Leadership in practice
Adaptive leaders mobilize, motivate, organize, orient, and focus the attention of others to address and resolve changes that are central in their lives. The first step will be to help followers address the challenges they are experiencing. These are some examples of cases where adaptive leadership would be beneficial:
church Membership
Over the past decade, the membership of a large traditional denomination of churches in the United States has shrunken by 200,000 members, which many attribute to the denomination’s stand against same-sex marriage. If the church wants to reverse the trend and begin to grow, the church leadership and its membership need to confront the social implications of their doctrinal stand on marriage and members of the LGBT community.
company Merger
A midsize family-owned paper company merges with another similar paper company. The merger creates tensions between the employees regarding job titles and duties, different wage schedules, overtime, and vacation pay. The new owners must bring these disparate groups of employees together to have their company function successfully. They will have to identify their adaptive challenges and then decide what work needs to be done (e.g., learning new ways of performing, shedding old ways that no longer work, and reevaluating their beliefs and values).
Merit pay
In an established engineering company, a small group of young high-achieving engineers wants to change the way merit pay is given by removing seniority and years of service as part of the criteria. Longtime employees are resisting the change. The management must find a way to address this issue without alienating either group.
condominium rules
You are president of a small condo association, and two groups in the association are at odds about an association rule requiring condo owners to be 55 years old or older. Some think it is important to have young people around while others do not. In addition, in this area, young, new homeowners are buying condos at higher rates than empty nesters. The president must guide the association to reach consensus in a way that will benefit the association.
perspective, in that this approach assumes that many problems people face are actually embedded in complicated interactive systems. Problems are viewed as complex with many facets, dynamic in that they can evolve and change, and connected to others in a web of relationships. Second, the biological perspective to adaptive leadership recognizes that people develop and evolve as a result of having to adapt to both their internal cues/state and external environments. The ability to adapt allows people to thrive in new circumstances. Third,
260 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
adaptive leadership assumes a service orientation. Similar to a physician, an adaptive leader uses his or her expertise or authority to serve the people by diagnosing their problems and prescribing possible solutions. Fourth, this approach incorporates the psychotherapy perspective to explain how people accomplish adaptive work. Adaptive leaders understand that people need a supportive environment and adapt more successfully when they face difficult problems directly, learn to distinguish between fantasy and reality, resolve internal conflicts, and learn new attitudes and behaviors. Taken together, these four viewpoints help explain and characterize the nature of adaptive leadership.
In addition to the way Heifetz and his colleagues defined adaptive leadership, it has been conceptualized as an element or subset of Complexity Leadership Theory, a framework designed to explain leadership for organizations of the 21st century that concentrate on knowledge or information as a core commod- ity rather than the production of goods that was prevalent in the industrial era (Uhl-Bien, Marion, & McKelvey, 2007). Complexity Leadership Theory (which includes administrative, adaptive, and enabling leadership) focuses on the strategies and behaviors that encourage learning, creativity, and adaptation in complex organizational systems. Within this framework, adaptive leader- ship is described as a complex process that emerges to produce adaptive change in a social system. It originates in struggles or tensions among people over conflicting needs, ideas, and preferences. It is conceptualized not as a person or a specific act (Uhl-Bien et al., 2007), but rather as a dynamic process.
Adaptive leadership is a unique kind of leadership that focuses on the dynamics of mobilizing people to address change. In the next section, we will describe the various components of adaptive leadership and discuss how each component contributes to the overall process of adaptive leadership.
A MoDeL oF ADAptiVe LeADersHip
Although adaptive leadership is in the early stages of theoretical develop- ment, the initial writings about this approach provide a basis for formulating a model of the adaptive leadership process. Based on the work of Heifetz and his associates (Heifetz, 1994; Heifetz & Sinder, 1988; Heifetz et al., 2009; Heifetz & Laurie, 1997; Heifetz & Linsky, 2002), Figure 11.1 offers a visual representation of the major components of adaptive leadership and how they fit together, including situational challenges, leader behaviors, and adaptive work. Heuristically, this model provides a basis for clarifying the process of adaptive leadership as well as generating empirical research to validate and refine the concepts and principles described by the model.
Adaptive Leader Behaviors
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 261
Situational Challenges
As illustrated on the left side of Figure 11.1, the practice of leadership requires that leaders address three kinds of situational challenges. There are challenges or problems that are primarily technical in nature, chal- lenges that have both a technical and an adaptive dimension, and challenges that are primarily adaptive in nature. Not all situational challenges are adaptive challenges. While addressing technical challenges is important, adaptive leadership is concerned with helping people address adaptive challenges.
Technical Challenges
Technical and Adaptive Challenges
Adaptive Challenges
Adaptive Work
Holding Environment
Leader Followers
Interaction
Leader Behaviors
1. Get on the Balcony 2. Identify the Adaptive Challenge 3. Regulate Distress 4. Maintain Disciplined Attention 5. Give the Work Back to the People 6. Protect Leadership Voices from Below
Situational Challenges
Figure 11.1 Model of Adaptive Leadership
technical challenges
Technical challenges are problems in the workplace or community that are clearly defined with known solutions that can be implemented through existing organizational rules and procedures. They are problems that can be solved by experts. For technical challenges, people look to the leader for a solution, and they accept the leader’s authority to resolve the problem. For example, if employees at a tax accounting firm are frustrated about a newly adopted tax software program, the manager at the firm could assess the software issues, identify the weaknesses and problems with the software, contact the company that provided the software, and have the programs modified in accordance with the accountants’ needs at the tax firm. In this example, the problem is identifiable, it has an achievable solution, and the manager at the tax firm has the authority to address it through the accepted
peace corps challenges
262 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
structures and procedures of the organization. The employees look to the manager to solve the technical problem and accept her or his authority to do so.
technical and Adaptive challenges
Some challenges have both a technical and an adaptive dimension. In this case, the challenges are clearly defined but do not have distinct straightfor- ward solutions within the existing organizational system. The responsibility of tackling this type of challenge is shared between the leader and the peo- ple. The leader may act as a resource for others and provide support, but the people need to do the work—they need to learn to change and adapt. For example, if an urban hospital with a traditional approach to care (i.e., provid- ers are the experts, and patients are the visitors) wanted to establish a patient-centered culture, the goal could be clearly laid out. To reach the goal, the hospital leadership, through its hierarchical authority, could provide in- service training on how to involve patients in their own care. New rules could be designed to preserve patients’ personal routines, to give them access to their own records, and to give them more control of their own treatment. However, the staff, doctors, patients, and family members would need to accept the proposed change and learn how to implement it. Making the hospital a model of patient-centered care would require a lot of work and adaptation on the part of many different people.
Adaptive challenges
Central to the process of adaptive leadership are adaptive challenges. Adaptive challenges are problems that are not clear-cut or easy to identify. They cannot be solved by the leader’s authority or expertise or through the normal ways of doing things in the organization. Adaptive challenges require that leaders encourage others, with their support, to define challenging situations and implement solutions. Not easy to tackle and often resisted, adaptive chal- lenges are difficult because they usually require changes in people’s assump- tions, perceptions, beliefs, attitudes, and behaviors. An example of adaptive challenges would be the problems and concerns a family confronts when placing a parent in hospice care. In a hospice, there is a great deal of uncer- tainty for patients and families about how and when the patient will die and how to best comfort the patient during this time. While hospice workers can give support and informal feedback about the dying process, the patient and his or her family have to come to grips with how they want to approach the patient’s final days. What does the impending loss mean? How can they
Technical or Adaptive challenge
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 263
prepare for it? How will they cope with the loss going forward? In this con- text, adaptive leadership is about mobilizing the patient and family members to address the many questions and concerns that surround the death of the family member. Hospice nurses, social workers, and staff all play an important role in helping families cope, but at the same time, it is the families that have to confront the complexities and concerns of the impending loss.
Leader Behaviors
As shown in the middle of Figure 11.1, six leader behaviors, or activities, play a pivotal role in the process of adaptive leadership. Based on the work of Heifetz and his colleagues (Heifetz, 1994; Heifetz & Laurie, 1997), these behaviors are general prescriptions for leaders when helping others confront difficult challenges and the inevitable changes that accompany them. Although there is a general order as to which leader behavior comes first in the adaptive leadership process, many of these behaviors overlap with each other and should be demonstrated by leaders at the same time. Taken together, these leader behaviors suggest a kind of recipe for being an adaptive leader.
1. Get on the Balcony
A prerequisite for the other adaptive leader behaviors, “getting on the balcony” is a metaphor for stepping out of the fray and finding perspective in the midst of a challenging situation. It is an allusion to a dance floor and that one needs to be above the dancing to understand what’s going on below. Being on the balcony enables the leader to see the big picture—what is really happening. On the balcony, the leader is momentarily away from the noise, activity, and chaos of a situation, allowing him or her to gain a clearer view of reality. It allows the leader to identify value and power con- flicts among people, ways they may be avoiding work, and other dysfunc- tional reactions to change (Heifetz & Laurie, 1997). Getting on the balcony can include such things as taking some quiet time, forming a group of unofficial advisers for alternative discussions about organizational issues, or simply attending meetings as an observer. In the model, the adaptive leader is urged to step away from the conflict in order to see it fully, but never to dissociate entirely from the conflict. Effective leaders are able to move back and forth as a participant and observer between the struggles of their people and the intentions of the group, organization, or community.
To understand what it means to stand on the balcony, imagine yourself as the principal of an elementary school. From the balcony, you see all the pieces that go into educating your students: federal and state
264 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
requirements, teachers and staff, budgets, teacher evaluations, parents and discipline, not to mention the children themselves. From above, you can see how these issues relate to and affect one another, and who is dancing with which partners, all while working toward the common goal of educating children.
Another example would be a chief union negotiator, who in the midst of difficult labor talks steps away from the table for a moment to separate from the emotion and intensity and reflect on the goals of the talks. Once this leader feels she again has a grasp of the issues at hand, she dives directly back into negotiations. In both of these examples, the leader takes time to see the “big” picture as an observer but also stays engaged as a participant with the challenges his or her people are confronting.
2. identify Adaptive challenges
In addition to getting on the balcony and observing the dynamics of the complex situations people face, leaders must analyze and diagnose these challenges. Central to this process is differentiating between technical and adaptive challenges. Failures in leadership often occur because leaders fail to diagnose challenges correctly. The adaptive leadership process suggests that leaders are most effective using adaptive leadership behaviors for adap- tive challenges and technical leadership for technical challenges. Treating challenges with the wrong kind of leadership is maladaptive.
If challenges are technical in nature, leaders can fix the problem with their own expertise. For example, in a manufacturing environment, problems that arise in scheduling, product sales quotas, facility expansion, or raising the minimum wage are all problems the leader can use his or her authority to resolve. However, it is essential that a leader also know when his or her authority is not sufficient or appropriate to address a particular challenge. When people’s beliefs, attitudes, and values are affected by a problem, lead- ers need to take an adaptive approach. How a leader decides if he or she faces an adaptive challenge is to determine whether or not the challenge strikes at the core feelings and thoughts of others. Adaptive challenges are usually value laden and stir up people’s emotions. Furthermore, if challenges require that people learn new ways of coping, they are adaptive. Take the manufac- turing environment that was discussed earlier. If another company buys that manufacturing facility and the new owners implement production proce- dures and standards that the facility’s workers are unfamiliar with, these changes would create adaptive challenges for the workers. Identifying adaptive challenges means leaders need to focus their attention on problems
Member expertise
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 265
they cannot solve themselves and that demand collaboration between the leader and followers. For adaptive challenges, leaders do what is necessary (e.g., give support, challenge, or even take themselves out of the picture) to mobilize others to do the work they need to do.
To more easily identify complex adaptive challenges and also distinguish them from technical challenges, there are four archetypes or basic patterns of adaptive change to consider (Heifetz et al., 2009).
Archetype 1: Gap Between Espoused Values and Behavior. This archetype is pres- ent when an organization espouses, or claims, to adhere to values that it doesn’t in reality support by its actions. For example, a company that promotes itself as a family-friendly place to work but does not have a flexible-hour work policy, an extended maternity leave policy, or in-house child care doesn’t have behaviors that match the family-friendly image it promotes itself as having.
Archetype 2: Competing Commitments. When an organization has numerous commitments and some come into conflict with each other, this archetype is in play. For example, a health and fitness center wants to grow and expand its services but at the same time sees the best way to reduce costs is by trim- ming the number of trainers and staff it employs.
Archetype 3: Speaking the Unspeakable. The phrases “sacred cow” and “ele- phant in the room” are examples of this archetype—when there are radical ideas, unpopular issues, or conflicting perspectives that people don’t dare address because of their sensitive or controversial nature. Speaking out about these is seen as “risky.” Consider an organization with a well-liked, estab- lished owner who is perceived by the employees as “over the hill” and not in touch with the current business climate, but no one is willing to discuss the matter. It is easier to suffer the consequences of the owner’s dated leadership than confront the man and risk hurting him.
Archetype 4: Work Avoidance. This archetype represents a situation where people avoid addressing difficult issues by staying within their “comfort zone” or by using diversionary methods. For example, coworkers at a com- pany refuse to confront or discuss a very skilled employee who is not par- ticipating in organizational planning because he feels the company suffers from institutional racism. It is easier to continue to do the same things and avoid the concerns of the disgruntled employee. Another example would be an ad agency that has a graphic designer who is not able to produce the quality of creative work needed, so, rather than address the problem directly, that designer is assigned menial jobs that are essentially busy work. The agency then hires a second graphic designer to do the more creative work
266 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
despite the cost and the fact that the agency doesn’t have enough work to justify two designers.
These four archetypes are representative of some of the common challenges that require adaptive change. Although they do not describe every possible type of adaptive change, they are useful as frames of reference when trying to identify adaptive challenges in a particular organizational setting.
3. regulate Distress
A third behavior, or activity, important for adaptive leaders is to regulate distress (Figure 11.1). Psychologically, we all have a need for consistency— to keep our beliefs, attitudes, and values the same. In fact, it is quite natural for individuals to be more comfortable when things are predictable and their way of doing things stays the same. But adaptive challenges create the need to change, and the process of change creates uncertainty and distress for people. Feeling a certain level of distress during change is inevitable and even useful for most, but feeling too much distress is counterproductive and can be debilitating. The challenge for a leader is to help others recognize the need for change but not become overwhelmed by the need for the change itself. The adaptive leader needs to monitor the stress people are experiencing and keep it within a productive range. This is what it means to regulate distress. The model suggests three ways that leaders can main- tain productive levels of stress: (1) create a holding environment; (2) provide direction, protection, orientation, conflict management, and productive norms; and (3) regulate personal distress.
Creating a holding environment. This refers to establishing an atmo- sphere in which people can feel safe tackling difficult problems, but not so much so that they can avoid the problem. You can think of a holding envi- ronment in terms of a child learning to swim—the instructor is within a watchful distance, but allows the child to do the hard work of overcoming his or her fears and learning to kick, breathe, and stroke in sync. A holding environment is a structural, procedural, or virtual space formed by cohesive relationships between people. It can be physical space, a shared language, common history, a deep trust in an institution and its authority, or a clear set of rules and processes that allow groups to function with safety. As illustrated in Figure 11.1, the holding environment represents the space where the work of adaptive leadership gets played out. The idea of a holding environment has its roots in the field of psychotherapy where the counselor creates a therapeutic setting and uses effective communication and empathy to pro- vide a sense of safety and protection for the client (Heifetz & Linsky, 2002;
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 267
Modell, 1976). Within the holding environment, adaptive leaders use authority to help people attend to the issues, to act as a reality test regarding information, to orchestrate conflicting perspectives, and to facilitate decision making (Heifetz, 1994, p. 113).
Creating a holding environment also allows a leader to regulate the pressures people face when confronting adaptive challenges. It can be described as analogous to a pressure cooker because initially a leader turns up the heat on the issues. This gets dialogue started and also allows some of the pressures from the issues to escape. If too much tension concerning issues is expressed, the holding environment can become too intense and ineffective for address- ing problems. However, without the leader’s initial catalyst of the issues, little dialogue would transpire.
Similar to labor negotiations in organizations, the holding environment is the place where all parties gather to begin talking to each other, define issues, and clarify competing interests and needs. If this discussion is too heated, negotiations reach a quick impasse. However, as negotiation develops, newer issues can be addressed. Over time the holding environment provides the place where new contractual relationships can be agreed upon and enacted.
Providing direction, protection, orientation, conflict management, and productive norms. These are specific ways leaders can use their formal and informal authority to help people manage the uncertainty and distress that accompany adaptive work. They are prescribed behaviors for adaptive leaders.
• Providing direction involves helping identify the adaptive challenges that others face and then framing these so they can be addressed. In difficult situations it is not uncommon for people to be unclear or con- fused about their goals. Sometimes the goal is unknown, sometimes it is obscure, and at other times it is entangled with competing goals. By providing direction, the leader helps people feel a sense of clarity, order, and certainty, reducing the stress people feel in uncertain situations.
• Protection refers to a leader’s responsibility to manage the rate of adaptive change. It includes monitoring whether the change is too much or too fast for people. Furthermore, it requires monitoring external pressures people are experiencing and keeping these within a range they can tolerate.
• Orientation is the responsibility a leader has to orient people to new roles and responsibilities that may accompany adaptive change. When a change requires adopting new values and acting in accor- dance with those values, people may need to adopt entirely new roles
Adaptive Work
268 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
within the organization. Orientation is the process of helping people to find their identity within a changing system.
• Conflict management refers to the leader’s responsibility to handle conflict effectively. Conflict is inevitable in groups and organizations during adaptive challenges and presents an opportunity for people to learn and grow. Although conflict can be uncomfortable, it is not unhealthy, nor is it necessarily bad. The question is not “How can people avoid conflict and eliminate change?” but rather “How can people manage conflict and produce positive change?”
• Establishing productive norms is a responsibility of the adaptive leader. Norms are the rules of behavior that are established and shared by group members and are not easily changed. When norms are con- structive, they have a positive influence on the progress of the group. However, when norms are unproductive and debilitating, they can impede the group. A leader should pay close attention to norms and challenge those that need to be changed and reinforce those that maximize the group’s effectiveness and ability to adapt to change.
Collectively, the five prescribed behaviors above provide a general blueprint for how adaptive leaders can mitigate the frustrations people feel during adaptive change. While not inclusive, they highlight some of the many important ways leaders can help people during the change process.
Regulating personal distress. This is a third way leaders can maintain a productive level of stress during adaptive change. As we discussed previously, change and growth within an organization do not occur without uncertainty and stress. Because stress is inherent in change, adaptive leaders need to withstand the pressures from those who want to avoid change and keep things the same. While moderate amounts of tension are normal and neces- sary during change, too much or too little tension is unproductive. Leaders need to keep people focused on the hard work they need to do and the ten- sion that accompanies that, while at the same time being sensitive to the very real frustrations and pain that people feel when doing adaptive work.
To help others through the adaptive process, adaptive leaders need to make sure they have their own act together. They must be strong and steady because people look to and depend on them for support in situations that can be very trying and painful. Adaptive leaders need to be role models and exhibit confidence and the emotional capacity to handle conflict. This is not a stress-free role. Adaptive leaders need to be willing to experience the frus- trations and pain that people feel during change but not to the extent that they lose their own sense of who they are as leaders.
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 269
An example of the demands of regulating personal distress can be seen in the leadership of a therapist who runs a support group for high school stu- dents recovering from substance abuse. In her role as a group facilitator, the therapist faces many challenges. She has to listen to students’ stories and the challenges they face as they try to stay clean. She also has to push people to be honest about their successes and failures regarding drug use. She cannot push so hard, however, that group members feel threatened, stop communi- cating, or stop attending the group sessions. In the holding environment, she has to be able to show nurturance and support, but not enable destructive behavior. The pain and frustrations recovering addicts feel are tremendous, and the therapist has to be in touch with this pain without losing her role as therapist. Hearing stories of recovery and failed recovery can be heartbreak- ing, while hearing success stories can be uplifting. Throughout all of this, the therapist needs to monitor herself closely and control her own anxieties regarding recovery. Group members look to the therapist for direction and support. They want the therapist to be strong, confident, and empathic. Regulating her own stress is essential in order to make herself fully available to students who are recovering from substance abuse.
4. Maintain Disciplined Attention
As illustrated in Figure 11.1, the fourth leader behavior described by the adaptive leadership process is to maintain disciplined attention. This means that the leader needs to encourage people to focus on the tough work they need to do. This does not come easily; people naturally do not want to confront change, particularly when it is related to changing their beliefs, values, or behaviors. It is common for all of us to resist change and strive for a sense of balance and equilibrium in our day-to-day experiences. People do not like things “out of sync,” so when their sense of balance is disrupted by the need to change, it is natural for them to engage in avoidance behavior. Maintaining disciplined attention is about the leader helping people address change and not avoid it.
Avoidance behaviors can take many forms. People can ignore the problem, blame the problem on the authority, blame coworkers for the problem, attack those who want to address the problem, pretend the problem does not exist, or work hard in areas unrelated to the problem. No matter the form of avoid- ance, the leader’s task is to mobilize and encourage people to drop their defenses and openly confront their problems. Adaptive leaders help people focus on issues. If some topics are deemed to “hot” in the organization, the leader should support people in getting these topics on the agenda for dis- cussion. If some issues create deep divisions between people, the leadership
Wicked and Tame problems
270 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
should provide a vessel of safety where competing sides can address the issues without feeling as if the organization will explode. If there is an “ele- phant in the room”—an issue no one wants to address but that is pivotal in making change—the leader needs to nudge people to talk about it. Whatever the situation, the adaptive leader gets people to focus—to show disciplined attention to the work at hand.
An example of disciplined attention can be seen in how the director of an assisted care facility responds to the members of a family who are struggling with their decision to move their 80-year-old mother into nursing care. The mother has early signs of dementia, but has successfully lived alone since her husband died 10 years earlier and prides herself on being able to cook, drive, and live independently. Although her forgetfulness and physical problems have her two adult children very concerned about their mother’s health and safety, they just cannot bring themselves to make their mother move from her home. They say things like “Mom just doesn’t need it yet. She is so much better than those people at the care facility. She won’t survive in a new envi- ronment. She just won’t be herself if she’s not at her own home.” The direc- tor of the assisted care facility’s challenge is to help them make the decision—a decision they are afraid of making, and avoiding. He always gives a listening ear and sets up multiple appointments for the children to visit the care facility. In addition, he arranges for the children to talk to staff members and other families who have a parent at the facility. In all of these sessions, the director emphasizes the importance of the children communi- cating their concerns while letting them know that the children’s concerns and hesitations are normal because accepting the failing health of a parent is very difficult. He continues to tell them gently, without sounding like he’s selling something, the benefits of going into the assisted care facility: The parent will be safer, receive good care, and learn to thrive in her new home. In this example, the director is sensitive to the adaptive challenges the chil- dren face, and he makes a point of “standing by” and giving guidance and support. The director helps the children stay focused on the changes they need to make and mobilizes them to confront their decisions.
5. Give the Work Back to the people
A fifth leader behavior important for adaptive leaders is to give the work back to the people (Figure 11.1). People want leaders to provide some direc- tion and structure to their work and want to feel secure in what they are doing, but too much leadership and authority can be debilitating, decrease people’s confidence to solve problems on their own, and suppress their cre- ative capacities. Overly directive leadership can result in people being
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 271
dependent on their leaders and inhibit them from doing adaptive work. Even though it makes people feel comfortable and secure to have leaders tell them what to do, leaders need to learn ways to curtail their influence and shift problem solving back to the people involved.
Leaders need to be aware of and monitor the impact they have on others. Giving work back to the people requires a leader to be attentive to when he or she should drop back and let the people do the work that they need to do. This can be a fine line; leaders have to provide direction, but they also have to say, “This is your work—how do you think you want to handle it?” For adaptive leaders, giving work back to the people means empowering people to decide what to do in circumstances where they feel uncertain, expressing belief in their ability to solve their own problems, and encouraging them to think for themselves rather than thinking for them.
The famous boarding school Summerhill, on the east coast of England, provides a good example of where giving the work back to the people takes center stage. Summerhill is a self-governing, democratic school where adults and students have equal status. Summerhill’s philosophy stresses that stu- dents have the freedom to take their own path in life and develop their own interests so long as it does not harm others. Classes are optional for students who have the freedom to choose what they do with their time. The schedules and rules of the school are established in weekly group meetings at which all participants have an equal vote. Summerhill’s leaders give the work of learn- ing back to the students. Instead of the teachers telling students what to study and learn, the students themselves make those decisions within a sup- portive environment. It is an unusual model of education and not without its problems, but it clearly demonstrates recognition of the need for students, and not their teachers, to identify and define their goals and take responsibil- ity for meeting those goals.
6. protect Leadership Voices from Below
A final leader behavior that is important to the adaptive leadership process is protecting leadership voices from below (Figure 11.1). This means that adaptive leaders have to be cautious to listen and be open to the ideas of people who may be at the fringe, marginalized, or even deviant in the group or organization. This is a challenge because when the leader gives voice to an out-group member, it is upsetting to the social equilibrium of the group. To be open to the ideas of low-status individuals, who often may express themselves ineffectively, is also challenging because it is disruptive to the “normal” way of doing things. Too often, leaders find it convenient
Learning and Adaptive Leadership
272 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
to ignore the dissident, nonconforming voices in an effort to maintain things as they are and keep things moving. Adaptive leaders should try to resist the tendency to minimize or shut down minority voices for the sake of the majority. To give voice to others requires that a leader relinquish some control, giving other individual members more control. This is why it is a challenging process.
Protecting voices from below is important because it puts low-status indi- viduals on equal footing with other members of the group. It means the leader and the other people of the group give credence to the out-group members’ ideas and actions. When out-group members have a voice, they know their interests are being recognized and that they can have an impact on the leader and the group. Giving them voice allows low-status members to be more involved, independent, and responsible for their actions. It allows them to become more fully engaged in the adaptive work of the group, and they can feel like full members in the planning and decision making of the group.
Consider a college social work class in which students are required to do a service-learning project. For this project, one group chose to build a wheelchair ramp for an elderly woman in the community. In the initial stages of the project, morale in the group was down because one group member (Alissa) chose not to participate. Alissa said she was not com- fortable using hand tools, and she chose not to do manual labor. The other team members, who had been doing a lot of planning for the proj- ect, wanted to proceed without her help. Alissa felt rejected and began to criticize the purpose of the project and the personalities of the other team members. At that point, one of the group’s leaders decided to start listening to Alissa’s concerns. He learned that while Alissa could not work with her hands, she had two other talents: She was good with music, and she made wonderful lunches. As a result, Alissa was asked to use her strengths for the group. During the construction of the ramp, Alissa kept up morale by playing each group member’s and the elderly woman’s favorite music while they worked on the ramp. In addition, Alissa made sandwiches and provided drinks that accommodated each of the group members’ unique dietary interests. By the last day, Alissa felt so included by the group, and was praised so frequently for providing great food, that she joined in the manual labor and began raking up trash around the ramp site. Although Alissa’s talents didn’t tie in directly with constructing a ramp, she still contributed to building a successful team, which would not have happened if the leader had not given voice to Alissa’s concerns and talents.
Wicked problems and public policy
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 273
Adaptive Work
As represented on the right side of the model of adaptive leadership (Figure 11.1), adaptive work is the process toward which adaptive leaders direct their work. It is the focus and intended goal of adaptive leadership. Adaptive work develops from the communication process that occurs between the leader and followers but is primarily the work of followers. It occurs within a hold- ing environment where people can feel safe as they confront possible changes in their roles, priorities, and values.
The model illustrates that the holding environment is the place where adap- tive work is conducted. It is a real or virtual space where people can address the adaptive challenges that confront them. Because the holding environ- ment plays a critical role in the adaptive process, leaders direct considerable energy toward establishing and maintaining it.
While the term followers is used in the holding environment portion of the model to depict individuals who are not the leader, it is important to note that throughout most of the writing on adaptive leadership, the term follower is not used because it implies a submissive role in relationship to the leader. In adaptive leadership, leaders do not use their authority to control others; rather, leaders interact with people to help them do adaptive work. The term followers is used in the model simply to distinguish the specific individuals who are doing adaptive work.
An example of adaptive work can be seen at a fitness center where a fitness instructor is running a class for a group of individuals who have had heart problems and struggle with being overweight. The goal of the instructor is to provide a safe place where people can challenge themselves to do training exercises that will help them to lose weight and reduce their risk for health problems. Because the people must change their lifestyles to live more healthfully, they must engage in adaptive work with the support of the fit- ness instructor.
Another example where adaptive work can be observed is in a public ele- mentary school where the principal is asking the teachers to adopt the Common Core State Standards but the teachers, who have a proven record of success using their own student-centered curriculum, are resisting. To help the teachers with the intended change, the principal sets up a series of 10 open faculty meetings where teachers are invited to discuss freely their con- cerns about the new policies. The meetings provide a holding environment where teachers can confront their deeply held positions regarding the useful- ness and efficacy of standardized testing and what it will mean for them to
creative Holding environment
274 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
have to shift to the Common Core. The principal’s role is to communicate in ways that support the teachers in their adaptive work.
HoW Does ADAptiVe LeADersHip WorK?
Adaptive leadership is a complex process comprising multiple dimensions, including situational challenges, leader behaviors, and adaptive work. The overriding focus of the process is to engage individuals in doing adaptive work. This unique emphasis, on mobilizing individuals (followers) to con- front adaptive challenges, makes adaptive leadership very different from other traditional leadership approaches that focus on leader traits (Chapter 2), skills (Chapter 3), behaviors (Chapter 4), and authenticity (Chapter 9). Adaptive leadership centers on the adaptations required of people in response to changing environments and how leaders can support them during these changes.
The process of adaptive leadership works like this: First, the leader takes time to step back from a challenging situation to understand the com- plexities of the situation and obtain a fuller picture of the interpersonal dynamics occurring among the participants. Second, in any situation or context where people are experiencing change, the leader first makes an assessment to determine if the change creates challenges that are technical or adaptive in nature. If the challenges are technical, the leader addresses the problems with his or her authority and expertise or through the rules and procedures of the organization. If the challenges are adaptive, the leader engages in several specific leader behaviors to move the adaptive process forward.
While the recipe for adaptive leadership is composed of many leader behaviors and activities, there is no particular order to the prescribed behaviors. Adaptive leadership incorporates many of these behaviors simultaneously, and interdependently, with some of them more important at the beginning of the process and others at the end. Some important adaptive leader behaviors are regulating distress, creating a holding envi- ronment, providing direction, keeping people focused on important issues, empowering people, and giving voice to those who feel unrecognized or marginalized.
Overall, it is safe to say that adaptive leadership works because leaders are willing to engage in all of these behaviors with the intention of helping fol- lowers do adaptive work.
Using Adaptive Leadership
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 275
strenGtHs
In its present stage of development, adaptive leadership has multiple strengths. First, in contrast to many other leadership theories, adaptive leadership takes a process approach to the study of leadership. Consistent with the process definition of leadership discussed in Chapter 1, adaptive leadership underscores that leadership is not a trait or characteristic of the leader, but rather a complex interactional event that occurs between leaders and followers in different situations. The process perspective highlights that leaders and followers mutually affect each other, making leadership an interactive activity that is not restricted to only a formal, designated leader. This approach emphasizes that the phenomenon of leadership is a complex interactive process comprising multiple dimensions and activities.
Second, adaptive leadership stands out because it is follower centered. Adaptive leaders mobilize people to engage in adaptive work. The adaptive approach to leadership is other directed, stressing follower involvement and follower growth. The raison d’être of adaptive leaders is to provide a holding environment where others can learn, grow, and work on the changes that are needed. This approach encapsulates leadership as those behaviors and actions leaders need to engage in to give followers the greatest opportunity to do adaptive work.
Third, adaptive leadership is unique in how it directs attention to the use of leadership to help followers deal with conflicting values that emerge in chang- ing work environments and social contexts. Change and learning are inher- ent in organizational life, and adaptive leadership focuses specifically on helping followers to confront change and examine the emergence of new values that may accompany change. No other leadership approach’s central purpose is to help followers confront their personal values and adjust these as needed in order for change and adaptation to occur.
Another strength of adaptive leadership is that it provides a prescriptive approach to leadership that is useful and practical. In their writings, Heifetz and his colleagues (Heifetz, 1994; Heifetz & Sinder, 1988; Heifetz et al., 2009; Heifetz & Laurie, 1997; Heifetz & Linsky, 2002) identify many things leaders can do to facilitate adaptive leadership. The leader behaviors in Figure 11.1 are prescriptions for what an adaptive leader should do. For example, “get on the balcony,” “regulate distress,” and “give work back to the people” are all prescrip- tive behaviors leaders can use to mobilize followers to do the work they need to do to adapt or change. In a general sense, even the model is prescriptive. It suggests that followers should learn to adapt and leaders should set up a con- text where this is most likely to occur. In short, adaptive leadership provides a
Adaptive Transformational Leadership
276 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
recipe for what leaders and followers should do to facilitate adaptive change. It describes the kind of work that followers should address and then the behaviors leaders should employ to help them accomplish this work.
Finally, adaptive leadership makes a unique contribution to the field of lead- ership studies by identifying the concept of a holding environment as an inte- gral part of the leadership process. Few leadership theories discuss how leaders are responsible for creating a safe environment for followers to address difficult issues. The holding environment can be physical, virtual, or relational, but most importantly, it is an atmosphere where people should feel safe tackling difficult issues. It is a place where leaders get a dialogue started but do not let it become too heated or explosive. Although abstract, the concept of a holding environment can be easily visualized and is useful for anyone wanting to demonstrate adaptive leadership.
criticisMs
In addition to its strengths, adaptive leadership has several weaknesses. First, very little empirical research has been conducted to test the claims of adap- tive leadership theory even though the conceptual framework for this approach was set forth more than 20 years ago in Heifetz’s Leadership Without Easy Answers (1994). Originally intended as a practical framework for theory building, adaptive leadership is based on ideas and assumptions, but not on established research. Without evidence-based support for the tenets of the model, the ideas and principles set forth on adaptive leadership should be viewed cautiously.
Second, conceptualization of the process of adaptive leadership needs further refinement. Adaptive leadership was designed intentionally as a practical approach to leadership and is composed of a series of prescriptions about what leaders should do to help people engage in adaptive work. However, the major factors in the adaptive process and the way these factors relate to one another to facilitate adaptive work is not clearly delineated. Figure 11.1 provides a “first attempt” at modeling the phenomenon of adaptive leadership, but much more needs to be done to clarify the essential factors in the model, the empirical relationships among these factors, and the process through which these factors lead to adaptive change within groups and organizations.
Third, adaptive leadership can be criticized for being too wide ranging and abstract. For example, the approach suggests that leaders should “identify your loyalties,” “protect leadership voices from below,” “mobilize the system,”
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 277
“name the default,” “hold steady,” “act politically,” “anchor yourself,” and many more that were not discussed in this chapter. Interpreting what these prescriptions mean and their relationship to being an adaptive leader can become overwhelming because of the breadth and wide-ranging nature of these prescriptions. In addition, the recommended leader behaviors such as “give the work back to the people” often lack specificity and conceptual clar- ity. Without clear conceptualizations of recommended behaviors, it is diffi- cult to know how to analyze them in research or implement them in practice. As a result, leaders may infer their own conceptualizations of these prescrip- tions, which may vary widely from what Heifetz and his colleagues (Heifetz, 1994; Heifetz & Sinder, 1988; Heifetz et al., 2009; Heifetz & Laurie, 1997; Heifetz & Linsky, 2002) intended.
Finally, from a theoretical perspective, adaptive leadership hints at but does not directly explain how adaptive leadership incorporates a moral dimension. Adaptive leadership focuses on how people evolve and grow through change. It implies that the evolution of one’s values leads to a greater common good, but the way the evolution of values leads to a greater common good is not fully explicated. It advocates mobilizing people to do adaptive work but does not elaborate or explain how doing adaptive work leads to socially useful outcomes. The model acknowledges the importance of promoting values such as equality, justice, and community, but the link between adaptive work and achieving those social values is not clear.
AppLicAtion
How can adaptive leadership be applied to real-life situations? There are several ways. On an individual level, adaptive leadership provides a concep- tual framework made up of a unique set of constructs that help us determine what type of challenges we face (e.g., technical vs. adaptive) and strategies for managing them (e.g., establishing a holding environment). Individuals can eas- ily integrate these constructs into their own practice of leadership. Furthermore, it is an approach to leadership that people can apply in a wide variety of settings, including family, school, work, community, and societal.
On the organizational level, adaptive leadership can be used as a model to explain and address a variety of challenges that are ever present during change and growth. It has been studied as a model to train urban school superintendants (Chace, 2013) and to enhance the leadership education of aspiring school principals (Guilleux, 2010). Consultants have applied adaptive leadership at all levels in many different kinds of organizations. In
Technical Leadership
278 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
particular, it has been an approach to leadership of special interest to people in nonprofits, faith-based organizations, and health care.
At this point in the development of adaptive leadership, the context in which most of the research has been conducted is health care. For example, one group of researchers suggests that adaptive leadership can improve the practice of medicine (Thygeson, Morrissey, & Ulstad, 2010). They contend that health professionals who practice from an adaptive leadership perspective view patients as complex adaptive systems who face both technical and adaptive challenges (Figure 11.2). Overall, they claim the adaptive leadership approach has promise to make health care more efficient, patient centered, and sustainable.
Eubank, Geffken, Orzano, and Ricci (2012) used adaptive leadership as the overarching framework to guide the curriculum they developed for a family medicine residency program. They argue that if physicians practice the behaviors promoted in adaptive leadership (e.g., get on the balcony, identify adaptive chal- lenges, or regulate distress), they can acquire the process skills that are necessary to implement and sustain true patient-centered care and healing relationships. Furthermore, to assist patients who are suffering, Eubank et al. contend that physicians need more than technical problem-solving competencies. Physicians also need adaptive skills that will enable them to help patients process and learn to live with the challenges resulting from changes in their health and well-being.
In two separate case studies, researchers found adaptive leadership could be used to help patients and family members confront health care challenges.
Figure 11.2 Adaptive Leadership Framework developed by Heifetz & Linsky
Patient/Caregivers Challenges
Technical Challenges
Provider
Technical Work
Adaptive Challenges
Adaptive Work Adaptive Leadership
Patient/Caregiver Provider
soURce: Adapted from Adams, J. A., Bailey, d. e., Jr., Anderson, R. A., & Thygeson, M. (2013). Finding your way through eoL challenges in the icU using Adaptive Leadership behaviours: A qualitative descriptive case study. Intensive and Critical Care Nursing, 29, 329–336 and Thygeson, M., Morrissey, L., & Ulstad, V. (2010). Adaptive leadership and the practice of medicine: A complexity-based approach to reframing the doctor-patient relationship. Journal of Evaluation in Clinical Practice, 16, 1009–1015.
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 279
Using the adaptive leadership framework, Adams, Bailey, Anderson, and Thygeson (2013) identified nurse and physician behaviors that can facilitate the transition from curative to palliative care by helping family members do the adaptive work of letting go. Similarly, Adams, Bailey, Anderson, and Galanos (2013) found adaptive leadership principles were useful in helping family members of patients in intensive care units to come to terms with loss and change, and to make decisions consistent with the patient’s goals.
In summary, there are many applications for adaptive leadership, both on the personal and on the organizational level, as well as in the research environ- ment. While further research needs to be done to support the tenets of adaptive leadership, it is clearly a leadership approach that can be utilized in many settings.
cAse stUDies
This section provides three case studies (Cases 11.1, 11.2, and 11.3) from very different contexts where adaptive leadership is present to a degree. The first case describes the challenges faced by two editors of a high school news- paper who wanted to lessen the stigma of mental illness by sharing other students’ stories. The second case is about how two co-captains tried to change the culture of their college ultimate disc team. The third case describes the challenges faced by people in a small town when trying to change the name of a high school mascot. At the end of each case, questions are provided to help you explore dimensions of adaptive leadership and how it can be utilized in addressing “real” problems.
Case 11.1
silence, stigma, and Mental illness
Madeline Halpert and eva Rosenfeld had three things in common: Both were on the high school newspaper staff, both suffered from depression, and until they shared their experiences with each other, both felt the isolation of the stigma that comes with suffering from mental illness.
The two student editors knew they were far from the only ones in their high school who experienced these challenges, and in a concerted effort
(Continued)
280 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
to support others and lessen the stigma of mental illness, they decided to do an in-depth feature on the topic for their student newspaper. Recent cases of school shootings had brought mental illness in teens to the forefront, and evidence shows that depression is a major cause of suicide in young people (Halpert & Rosenfeld, 2014). yet, the strong stigma that surrounds depression and mental illness often isolates those who suffer from it. The purpose of eva and Madeline’s feature was to open the dialogue and end the stigma. They interviewed a number of teens from schools in the surrounding area who agreed to use their real names and share their personal stories about mental illness including depression, eating disorders, and homelessness. The student editors even obtained waivers from the subjects’ parents giving them permission to use the stories. However, their stories never made it to print.
While they were putting the story together, their school’s principal called them into her office and told them about a former college football player from the area who struggled with depression and would be will- ing to be interviewed. The editors declined, not wanting to replace the deeply personal articles about their peers with one from someone removed from the students. The principal then told them she wouldn’t support printing the stories. she objected to the use of students’ real names, saying she feared potential personal repercussions such as bully- ing or further mental health problems that publishing such an article could have on those students. district officials stood by the principal’s decision to halt printing of the piece, saying it was the right one to pro- tect the students featured in the article.
This move surprised the two student editors because they felt that their school had a very tolerant atmosphere, which included offering a depres- sion awareness group. “We were surprised that the administration and the adults who advocated for mental health awareness were the ones standing in the way of it,” they wrote. “By telling us that students could not talk openly about their struggles, they reinforced the very stigma we were trying to eliminate.”
instead, the two editors penned an op-ed piece, “depressed, but not Ashamed,” which was published in The New York Times. The article discussed their dismay with having the student articles halted by school administrators, an act that they believe further stigmatized those with mental illnesses.
“By interviewing these teenagers for our newspaper, we tried—and failed—to start small in the fight against stigma. Unfortunately, we’ve learned this won’t be easy. it seems that those who are charged with advocating for our well-being aren’t ready yet to let us have an open and honest dialogue about depression,” they wrote.
(continued)
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 281
The op-ed piece generated a response—and, interestingly, a dialogue— about the topic.
The two student editors were subsequently interviewed on the national public Radio show Weekend Edition. in that interview, the editors acknowledged that they had experienced mostly positive reactions to their piece, with more than 200 comments after the initial publishing of their article. Many of those comments said the article resonated with readers and gave them the courage to talk to someone about their strug- gles with mental illness in a way they hadn’t before.
“And i think, most importantly, it’s opening a dialogue,” said one of the editors in the interview. “There were negative comments. There were positive comments. But the most important thing is that it’s so amazing to see people discussing this and finally opening up about it.”
Questions
1. How do you define the problem the editors were trying to address? Was this a technical or an adaptive challenge?
2. What is your reaction to what the principal did in this situation? How do you think what she did fits in with providing direction, protection, orientation, conflict management, and productive norms?
3. describe the holding environment in this case. Was the holding envi- ronment sufficient to meet the adaptive challenges in this situation? How would you improve it?
4. Based on Figure 11.1, discuss who were the adaptive leaders in this case. Which of the leader behaviors (get on the balcony, identify adaptive challenges, regulate distress, etc.) did these leaders exhibit?
Case 11.2
taming Bacchus
Kyle Barrett is a serious ultimate disc player. He became involved in the sport—which is a bit like soccer only with a flying disc—in middle school and played competitively in high school. When he went to college at a small liberal arts school in the pacific northwest, he was excited to find the school had an ultimate disc team. His excitement quickly turned to dismay when he found the team members were more interested in par- tying than playing.
(Continued)
282 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
Kyle remembers this about his first year on the team: “The team really had this sort of fraternity culture in that there was light hazing, drinking was a priority, and tournaments were about parties, not competition. The team threw a lot of parties and had this reputation for exclusivity.” even the team’s name, Bacchus (the Roman god of wine and drunken- ness), reflected this culture.
Kyle found a like-minded soul in his teammate Harrison, and together they sought to turn the club team into a program that operated on a more competitive level. The pair was chosen as team co-captains and began to share their deeper knowledge of the sport with the team. They also communicated their aspirations for success. This flew in the face of some team members who were there for the parties. As one player put it, “you were either down with it, or you decided it was too intense and you left the club.”
The two captains knew that the team’s culture wasn’t going to change just because they wanted it to. They also knew that they couldn’t be captains, coach the team, and be players at the same time. so they began taking a number of steps to help the team change its own culture.
First, they brought in Mario o’Brien, a well-known ultimate disc coach, to help guide the team and teach the players skills and strategy. The team had had other coaches in the past, but none of those had the knowledge, experience, or reputation that o’Brien did.
“That really took some forethought,” says a player, “to be able to step back and say, ‘What does this team really need to become a strong program?’ And then making a move to bring in someone of o’Brien’s stature.”
After a few weeks of practice with o’Brien, the captains and coach organized a team dinner. Before the dinner they asked each player to anonymously submit in writing what he thought of the team and what he wanted to see the team be. “There were no rules—just say what you need to say,” says a player. each submission was read aloud and discussed by team members.
“no one was put in the position of having to publically speak out and be embarrassed in front of the others,” says a player. “We came out of that meeting more together, more bonded as a team. We hashed out a lot of issues, and came to the realization that we were looking for the same goals. The process helped filter out those who weren’t as committed to those goals, but not in a confrontational way.”
The goals agreed to at that dinner meeting were for the team to do well enough at the sectional competition to obtain a berth at the national collegiate competition. But the team was young with a number of inexperienced players, which sometimes caused stress,
(continued)
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 283
frustration, and friction. The captains, however, continued to have multiple meetings to talk about concerns, discussed the team’s goals before and after each practice, and organized social events (with a minimum of drinking) where team members engaged in activities together other than playing ultimate disc. older, more experienced players began mentoring the younger, newer players to help them improve their skills. even Harrison, who was an exceptional offensive player, put himself on the defensive line to help improve those players’ skills. While it wasn’t optimal for his own enjoyment and playing abili- ties, he felt it was needed to help improve the team.
Bacchus reached its goals two years later; it came in second at sectionals and earned a spot in the national competition. After the team completed its last game at nationals, Kyle and Harrison gathered the team members together in a circle. “We accomplished something more than being here today,” Kyle said. “We’ve become a family with goals, and with respect for one another and for our game. And that’s a better victory than any other.”
Questions
1. What changes were Kyle and Harrison trying to make? How did these changes affect the beliefs, attitudes, or values of the players?
2. Were the challenges the team faced technical, technical and adaptive, or adaptive? What examples can you give to explain your answer?
3. citing examples, explain how the captains engaged in each of these adaptive leader behaviors: (1) get on the balcony, (2) identify adaptive challenges, (3) regulate distress, (4) maintain disciplined attention, (5) give the work back to people, and (6) protect leadership voices from below.
4. describe the holding environment that the co-captains created for the team. do you think it was successful? Why or why not?
Case 11.3
redskins no More
When there became a vacancy on the school board for Gooding public schools, scott Rogers decided to throw his hat into the ring for consid- eration. A former college professor who had retired with his wife to the
(Continued)
284 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
small Midwestern town, scott was hoping to help the board, which had for years been a “good old boy” network, focus more on educational pursuits than its traditional emphasis on high school athletics.
shortly after scott was appointed to the board, a local family with native American ancestry came before the board to ask that the name of Gooding High school’s athletic teams be changed from the Redskins. The family found the use of the name Redskins to be offensive. “The use of the word Redskins is essentially a racial slur,” says scott, “and as a racial slur, it needed to be changed.”
The request set off a firestorm in the small town of 7,000. The school’s athletic teams had competed as Redskins for 50 years, and many felt the name was an integral part of the community. people personally identi- fied with the Redskins, and the team and the team’s name were ingrained in the small town’s culture.
“We went through months of folks coming to the school board meetings to speak on the issue and it got totally out of control,” scott says. “Locals would say, ‘i was born a Redskin, and i’ll die a Redskin.’ They argued that the name was never intended to be offensive and that it honored the area’s relatively strong native American presence. The local family that raised the issue was getting all sorts of national support, and speakers came in from as far away as oklahoma to discuss the negative ramifica- tions of native American mascots. Local groups argued back that these speakers weren’t from Gooding and shouldn’t even be allowed to be at the board meetings.”
scott felt strongly that the name needed to be changed. in meeting after meeting, he tried to explain to both his fellow board members and those in the audience that if the name was offensive to someone and recog- nized as a racial slur, then the intent of its original choosing was irrele- vant. if someone was offended by the name, then it was wrong to maintain it.
Finally, scott put forward a motion to change the name. That motion included a process for the students at Gooding High school to choose a new name for their athletic teams. The board approved the motion 5–2. The students immediately embraced the opportunity to choose a new name, developing designs and logos for their proposed choices. in the end, the student body voted to become the Redhawks.
There was still an angry community contingent, however, that was fester- ing over the change. They began circulating petitions to recall the school board members and received enough signatures for the recall to be put up for an election.
(continued)
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 285
“While the kids are going about the business of changing the name and the emblem, the community holds an election and proceeds to recall five of the seven members of the board,” scott says. The five recalled mem- bers included scott and the other board members who voted in favor of the name change.
The remaining two board members, both of whom were ardent members of the athletic booster organization, held a special meeting of the board (all two of them) and voted to change the name back to the Redskins.
That’s when the state department of civil Rights and the state’s commission for High school Athletics stepped in. They told the Gooding school Board there could not be a reversal of the name change and that Gooding High school’s teams would have to go for four years without one, competing only as Gooding.
over the course of those four years, new school board members were elected, and the issue quieted down. At the end of that period, the stu- dents again voted to become the Gooding Redhawks.
“you know, the kids were fine with it,” says scott. “it’s been 10 years, and there’s an entire generation of kids who don’t have a clue that it was ever different. They are Redhawks and have always been Redhawks.
“it was the adults who had the problem. There’s still a small contingent today that can’t get over it. A local hardware store still sells Gooding Redskins T-shirts and other gear. There is just this group of folks who believe there was nothing disrespectful in the Redskins name. once that group is gone, it will be a nonissue.”
Questions
1. What change were the people in Gooding trying to avoid? Why do you think they wanted to avoid this change? What tactics did they use to resist change?
2. Would you describe the efforts of scott Rogers or the school board as adaptive leadership? Why or why not?
3. How would you describe the holding environment created by the school board? do you think it was successful? Why or why not?
4. citing examples, describe how the school board engaged or didn’t engage in each of these adaptive leader behaviors: (1) get on the balcony, (2) maintain disciplined attention, and (3) give the work back to people.
5. What group would you describe as the “low-status group”? How did the school board seek to give voice to this group?
286 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
LeADersHip instrUMent
To assist you in understanding the process of adaptive leadership and what your own style might be, the adaptive leadership questionnaire is included in this section. This questionnaire provides 360-degree, or multirater, feed- back about your leadership. The adaptive leadership questionnaire is com- posed of 30 items that assess six dimensions of adaptive leadership discussed earlier in this chapter: get on the balcony, identify the adaptive challenge, regu- late distress, maintain disciplined attention, give the work back to people, and protect leadership voices from below. The results you obtain on this question- naire will provide you with information on how you view yourself and how others view you on these six dimensions of adaptive leadership. This ques- tionnaire is intended for practical applications. It is not designed for research purposes. For research purposes, the psychometric properties of the questionnaire (i.e., reliability and validity) would need to be established.
Adaptive leadership is a complex process, and taking this questionnaire will help you understand the theory of adaptive leadership as well as your own style of adaptive leadership.
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 287
ADAptiVe LeADersHip QUestionnAire
Instructions: This questionnaire contains items that assess different dimensions of adaptive leadership and will be completed by you and others who know you (coworkers, friends, members of a group you belong to).
1. Make five copies of this questionnaire.
2. Fill out the assessment about yourself; where you see the phrase “this leader,” replace it with “i” or “me.”
3. Have each of five individuals indicate the degree to which they agree with each of the 30 statements below regarding your leadership by circling the number from the scale that they believe most accurately characterizes their response to the statement. There are no right or wrong responses.
Key: 1 = strongly 2 = disagree 3 = neutral 4 = Agree 5 = strongly disagree agree
1. When difficulties emerge in our organization, this leader is 1 2 3 4 5 good at stepping back and assessing the dynamics of the people involved.
2. When events trigger strong emotional responses among 1 2 3 4 5 employees, this leader uses his/her authority as a leader to resolve the problem.
3. When people feel uncertain about organizational change, 1 2 3 4 5 they trust that this leader will help them work through the difficulties.
4. in complex situations, this leader gets people to focus on the 1 2 3 4 5 issues they are trying to avoid.
5. When employees are struggling with a decision, this leader 1 2 3 4 5 tells them what he/she thinks they should do.
6. during times of difficult change, this leader welcomes the 1 2 3 4 5 thoughts of group members with low status.
7. in difficult situations, this leader sometimes loses sight of 1 2 3 4 5 the “big picture.”
8. When people are struggling with a value conflict, this 1 2 3 4 5 leader uses his or her expertise to tell them what to do.
9. When people begin to be disturbed by unresolved conflicts, 1 2 3 4 5 this leader encourages them to address the issues.
10. during organizational change, this leader challenges people 1 2 3 4 5 to concentrate on the “hot” topics.
11. When employees look to this leader for answers, he/she 1 2 3 4 5 encourages them to think for themselves.
12. Listening to group members with radical ideas is valuable 1 2 3 4 5 to this leader.
288 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
13. When this leader disagrees with someone, he/she has 1 2 3 4 5 difficulty listening to what the other person is really saying.
14. When others are struggling with intense conflicts, this leader 1 2 3 4 5 steps in to resolve their differences for them.
15. This leader has the emotional capacity to comfort others 1 2 3 4 5 as they work through intense issues.
16. When people try to avoid controversial organizational 1 2 3 4 5 issues, this leader brings these conflicts into the open.
17. This leader encourages his/her employees to take 1 2 3 4 5 initiative in defining and solving problems.
18. This leader is open to people who bring up unusual ideas 1 2 3 4 5 that seem to hinder the progress of the group.
19. in challenging situations, this leader likes to observe the 1 2 3 4 5 parties involved and assess what’s really going on.
20. This leader encourages people to discuss the “elephant 1 2 3 4 5 in the room.”
21. people recognize that this leader has confidence to tackle 1 2 3 4 5 challenging problems.
22. This leader thinks it is reasonable to let people avoid 1 2 3 4 5 confronting difficult issues.
23. When people look to this leader to solve problems, he/she 1 2 3 4 5 enjoys providing solutions.
24. This leader has an open ear for people who don’t seem to 1 2 3 4 5 fit in with the rest of the group.
25. in a difficult situation, this leader will step out of the 1 2 3 4 5 dispute to gain perspective on it.
26. This leader thrives on helping people find new ways of 1 2 3 4 5 coping with organizational problems.
27. people see this leader as someone who holds steady 1 2 3 4 5 in the storm.
28. in an effort to keep things moving forward, this leader lets 1 2 3 4 5 people avoid issues that are troublesome.
29. When people are uncertain about what to do, this 1 2 3 4 5 leader empowers them to decide for themselves.
30. To restore equilibrium in the organization, this leader 1 2 3 4 5 tries to neutralize comments of out-group members.
scoring
Get on the Balcony—This score represents the degree to which you are able to step back and see the complexities and interrelated dimensions of a situation.
Chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 289
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 1, 19, and 25 and the reversed (R) score values for 7 and 13 (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2 to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged).
____ 1 ____ 7(R) ____ 13(R) ____ 19 ____ 25 ____ Total
Identify the Adaptive Challenge—This score represents the degree to which you recognize adaptive challenges and do not respond to these challenges with technical leadership.
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 16 and 20 and the reversed (R) score values for 2, 8 and 14 (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2 to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged).
____ 2(R) ____ 8(R) ____ 14(R) ____ 16 ____ 20 ____ Total
Regulate Distress—This score represents the degree to which you provide a safe environment in which others can tackle difficult problems and to which you are seen as confident and calm in conflict situations.
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 3, 9, 15, 21, and 27.
____ 3 ____ 9 ____ 15 ____ 21 ____ 27 ____ Total
Maintain Disciplined Attention—This score represents the degree to which you get others to face challenging issues and not let them avoid difficult problems.
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 4, 10, and 26 and the reversed (R) score values for 22 and 28 (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2 to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged).
____ 4 ____ 10 ____ 26 ____ 22(R) ____ 28(R) ____ Total
Give the Work Back to People—This score is the degree to which you empower others to think for themselves and solve their own problems.
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 11, 17, and 29 and the reversed (R) score values for 5 and 23 (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2 to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged).
____ 5(R) ____ 11 ____ 17 ____ 23(R) ____ 29 ____ Total
Protect Leadership Voices From Below—This score represents the degree to which you are open and accepting of unusual or radical contributions from low-status group members.
To arrive at this score:
Sum items 6, 12, 18, and 24 and the reversed (R) score value for 30 (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2 to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged).
____ 6 ____ 12 ____ 18 ____ 24 ____ 30(R) ____ Total
sc o
ri n
g c
h ar
t
To c
o m
p le
te t
h e
sc o
ri n
g c
h ar
t, e
n te
r th
e ra
te rs
’ s co
re s
an d
y o
u r
o w
n s
co re
s in
t h
e ap
p ro
p ri
at e
co lu
m n
o n
t h
e sc
o ri
n g
s h
ee t
b el
o w
. Fi
n d
t h
e av
er ag
e sc
o re
f ro
m y
o u
r fi
ve r
at er
s, a
n d
t h
en c
al cu
la te
t h
e d
if fe
re n
ce b
et w
ee n
t h
e av
er ag
e an
d y
o u
r se
lf -r
at in
g .
Ra te
r 1
Ra te
r 2
Ra te
r 3
Ra te
r 4
Ra te
r 5
Av er
ag e
Ra ti
ng Se
lf- Ra
ti ng
D iff
er en
ce
G et
o n
th e
Ba lc
on y
Id en
tif y
th e
Ad ap
tiv e
Ch al
le ng
e
Re gu
la te
Di
st re
ss
M ai
nt ai
n Di
sc ip
lin ed
At
te nt
io n
G iv
e th
e W
or k
Ba ck
to
th e
Pe op
le
Pr ot
ec t
Le ad
er sh
ip
Vo ic
es F
ro m
Be
lo w
290
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 291
scoring interpretation
• High range: A score between 21 and 25 means you are strongly inclined to exhibit this adaptive leadership behavior.
• Moderately high range: A score between 16 and 20 means you moderately exhibit this adaptive leadership behavior.
• Moderate low range: A score between 11 and 15 means you at times exhibit this adaptive leadership behavior.
• Low range: A score between 5 and 10 means you are seldom inclined to exhibit this adaptive leadership behavior.
This questionnaire measures adaptive leadership by assessing six compo- nents of the process: get on the balcony, identify the adaptive challenge, regulate distress, maintain disciplined attention, give the work back to peo- ple, and protect leadership voices from below. By comparing your scores on each of these components, you can determine which are your stronger and which are your weaker components. The scoring chart allows you to see where your perceptions are the same as those of others and where they differ. There are no “perfect” scores for this questionnaire. While it is con- firming when others see you in the same way as you see yourself, it is also beneficial to know when they see you differently. This assessment can help you understand those dimensions of your adaptive leadership that are strong and dimensions of your adaptive leadership you may seek to improve.
292 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
sUMMArY
Adaptive leadership is about helping people change and adjust to new situ- ations. Originally formulated by Heifetz (1994), adaptive leadership con- ceptualizes the leader not as one who solves problems for people, but rather as one who encourages others to do the problem solving. Adaptive leader- ship occupies a unique place in the leadership literature. While the merits of the approach are well recognized, the theoretical conceptualizations of adaptive leadership remain in the formative stages.
While the name of this approach, adaptive leadership, makes one think it is concerned with how leaders adapt, it is actually more about the adaptations of followers. Adaptive leadership is defined as “the practice of mobilizing people to tackle tough challenges and thrive” (Heifetz et al., 2009, p. 14). Consistent with complexity theory, adaptive leadership is about leader behaviors that encourage learning, creativity, and adaptation by followers in complex situations.
This chapter offers a model of the major components of adaptive leadership and how they fit together, including situational challenges, leader behaviors, and adap- tive work (Figure 11.1). Leaders confront three kinds of situational challenges (technical, technical and adaptive, and adaptive); adaptive leadership is con- cerned with helping people address adaptive challenges. The six leader behaviors that play a major role in the process are (1) get on the balcony, (2) identify adaptive challenges, (3) regulate distress, (4) maintain disciplined attention, (5) give the work back to people, and (6) protect leadership voices from below. These six behaviors form a kind of recipe for being an adaptive leader. Adaptive work is the focus and goal of adaptive leadership. Central to adaptive work is creating a holding environ- ment, a space created and maintained by adaptive leaders where people can feel secure as they confront and resolve difficult life challenges.
Adaptive leadership has several strengths. First, adaptive leadership takes a unique approach that emphasizes that leadership is a complex interactive process composed of multiple dimensions and activities. Second, unlike most other leadership theories, adaptive leadership clearly describes leadership as actions the leaders undertake to afford followers the best opportunity to do adaptive work. Third, adaptive leadership is unique in describing how leaders can help people confront and adjust their values in order to adapt and thrive. Fourth, adaptive leadership provides a useful and practical set of prescrip- tions for what leaders and followers should do to facilitate adaptive change. Last, adaptive leadership highlights the important role a holding environ- ment plays in the leadership process.
chapter 11 Adaptive Leadership 293
The adaptive leadership process also has certain weaknesses. Foremost, there is very little empirical research to support the claims and tenets of adaptive leadership. Second, the conceptualizations of the process of adaptive leadership need further refinement. The major factors and how they fit together are not clearly delineated. Third, interpreting the pre- scriptions of adaptive leadership can become overwhelming because of the breadth and wide-ranging nature of these prescriptions. In addition, the abstract nature of the recommended leadership behaviors makes these behaviors difficult to analyze in research or implement in practice. Finally, on a theoretical level, adaptive leadership acknowledges the moral dimen- sion of leadership and the importance of change for the common good, but does not show how doing adaptive work leads to such socially useful outcomes.
Overall, adaptive leadership offers a unique prescriptive approach to leader- ship that is applicable in many situations. Going forward, more research is needed to clarify the conceptualizations of adaptive leadership and validate the assumptions and propositions regarding how it works.
sharpen your skills with sAGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerences
Adams, J. A., Bailey, D. E., Jr., Anderson, R. A., & Galanos, A. N. (2013). Adaptive leadership: A novel approach for family decision making. Journal of Palliative Medicine, 16(3), 326–329.
Adams, J. A., Bailey, D. E., Jr., Anderson, R. A., & Thygeson, M. (2013). Finding your way through EOL challenges in the ICU using Adaptive Leadership behav- iours: A qualitative descriptive case study. Intensive and Critical Care Nursing, 29, 329–336.
Chace, S. (2013). Learning leadership: A case study on influences of a leadership train- ing program on the practices of one group of urban school superintendents (Unpub- lished doctoral dissertation). Teachers College Columbia University, New York, NY.
Eubank, D., Geffken, D., Orzano, J., & Ricci, R. (2012, September). Teaching adap- tive leadership to family medicine residents: What? Why? How? Families, Systems & Health, 30(3), 241–252.
Guilleux, F. (2010). A developmental perspective on leadership education of aspiring prin- cipals (Unpublished doctoral dissertation). University of Pittsburgh, Pittsburgh, PN.
294 LeAdeRsHip THeoRy And pRAcTice
Halpert, M., & Rosenfeld, E. (2014, May 21). Depressed, but not ashamed. The New York Times. Retrieved from http://www.nytimes.com/2014/05/22/opinion/ depressed-but-not-ashamed.html
Heifetz, R. A. (1994). Leadership without easy answers. Cambridge, MA: Belknap Press.
Heifetz, R. A., Grashow, A., & Linsky, M. (2009). The practice of adaptive leadership: Tools and tactics for changing your organization and the world. Boston, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Heifetz, R. A., & Laurie, D. L. (1997). The work of leadership. Harvard Business Review, 7(1), 124–134.
Heifetz, R. A., & Linsky, M. (2002). Leadership on the line: Staying alive through the dangers of leading. Boston, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Heifetz, R.A., & Sinder, R. M. (1988). Political leadership: Managing the public's problem solving. In R. B. Reich (Ed.), The power of public ideas (pp. 179-204). Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.
Modell, A. H. (1976). The “holding environment” and the therapeutic action of psy- choanalysis. Journal of the American Psychological Association 24, 285–307. National Public Radio. (2014, May 24). Students struggle with depression—and with telling the story [S. Simon, interviewer]. Weekend Edition. Retrieved from http://www.npr.org/2014/05/24/315445104/students-struggle-with-depression- and-with-telling-the-story
Thygeson, M., Morrissey, L., & Ulstad, V. (2010). Adaptive leadership and the prac- tice of medicine: A complexity-based approach to reframing the doctor-patient relationship. Journal of Evaluation in Clinical Practice, 16, 1009–1015.
Uhl-Bien, M., Marion, R., & McKelvey, B. (2007). Complexity Leadership The- ory: Shifting leadership from the industrial age to the knowledge era. Leadership Quarterly, 18, 298–318.
12
Psychodynamic Approach
Manfred F. R. Kets de Vries and Alicia Cheak
DescriPtion
The interpretation of dreams is the royal road to a knowledge of the uncon- scious activities of the mind.
—Sigmund Freud
Kafka truly illustrates the way the environment oppresses the individual. He shows how the unconscious controls our lives.
—Manuel Puig
At its heart, leadership is about human behavior—what we do, how we do it, and why we do it. Leadership is about the way people behave in orga- nizations, and effective leaders are those who meet the needs of their followers, pay careful attention to group processes, calm anxieties and arouse hopes and aspirations, and know how to liberate human energy and inspire people to positive action. In short, leadership involves har- nessing and leveraging the different and complex forces and dynamics at play in organizational functioning.
Our everyday lives consist of webs of constantly shifting and irrational forces that underlie seemingly “rational” behaviors and choices—and life in organizations is no exception. However, most definitions of leadership,
The Psychodynamic Approach
296 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
methodologies for studying leadership, and recommendations for leader- ship development address observable, conscious, and rational phenomena. Moreover, historically, many organizational practitioners and researchers have tended to avoid treading in the emotional and psychological realm of organizational life, fearing the messy but real-life complexities and the relationships within (Kets de Vries, 1980, 2006b; Kets de Vries & Miller, 1984; Volkan, 1988). The result is that too many organizational phenom- ena remain unresolved and unexplained. Any meaningful explanation of human behaviors therefore requires both a rational and an irrational lens of investigation.
The psychodynamic approach to leadership study and development focuses on the dynamics of human behavior, which are often the most difficult to understand. It acknowledges that people are complex, unique, and paradox- ical beings with rich and myriad motivational drivers and decision-making and interaction patterns. Applying psychodynamic concepts to the ebb and flow of life in organizations contributes to our understanding of the vicis- situdes of life and leadership. Only through accepting and exploring the hidden undercurrents that affect human behavior can we begin to under- stand organizational life in all its complexities.
the clinicAl PArADigm _________________________
The Clinical Paradigm is the framework through which we apply a psycho- dynamic lens to the study of behavior in organizations. By making sense out of leaders’ deeper wishes and fantasies, and showing how these fantasies influence behavior in the organizational world, this paradigm offers a practi- cal way of discovering how leaders and organizations really function (Kets de Vries & Miller, 1984).
The Clinical Paradigm consists of four basic premises:
• First, it argues that there is a rationale behind every human act—a logical explanation—even for actions that seem irrational. This point of view stipulates that all behavior has an explanation. Because that explanation may be elusive—inextricably interwoven with uncon- scious needs and desires—one has to do “detective work” to tease out hints and clues underlying perplexing behavior.
• The second premise is that a great deal of mental life—feelings, fears, and motives—lies outside of conscious awareness, but still affects conscious reality and even physical well-being. We all have blind spots. People aren’t always aware of what they are doing much less
emotional intelligence effect of early iQ Testing
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 297
why they are doing it. Though hidden from rational thought, the human unconscious affects (and in some cases even dictates) con- scious reality. Even the most “rational” people have blind spots, and even the “best” people have a shadow side—a side that they don’t know, and don’t want to know.
• The third premise states that nothing is more central to whom a person is than the way he or she regulates and expresses emotions. Emotions color experiences with positive and negative connotations, creating preference in the choices we make and the way we deal with the world. Emotions also form the basis for the internalization of mental representations of the self and others that guide relationships throughout one’s life. The way a person perceives and expresses emo- tions may change as the years go by, influenced by life experiences (Darwin, 1920; Plutchick, 1980; Tomkins, 1995).
• The fourth premise underlying the Clinical Paradigm is that human development is an inter- and intrapersonal process; we are all products of our past experiences, and those experiences, including the develop- mental experiences provided by our early caregivers, continue to influence us throughout life (Emde, 1980; Erikson, 1950; Kagan, 1994; Kohlberg, 1981; Oglensky, 1995; Piaget, 1952; Pine, 1985).
The Clinical Paradigm unlocks and reveals the subconscious forces under- lying human behavior. It illuminates the human mind—a dark sea filled with strange life-forms, most of them unconscious. And unless we can understand the motives and reasonings for this obscurity, we can hardly hope to foresee or control them. Unless we recognize the role that psycho- dynamic processes play in organizational life, we will never truly understand why leaders, and followers, act the way they do.
history of the PsychoDynAmic APProAch ____
The psychodynamic paradigm has its origins in Freud’s psychoanalytic theories of human behavior. Specifically, this approach draws attention to the sources of energy and motivational forces that drive human actions by considering what is “within”—the inner world of individuals, including their emotions—and relationships between individuals—the “reality” created by the dynamics of groups (Neumann & Hirschhorn, 1999).
Freud also believed that neurotic symptoms or dysfunctional behavior were manifestations of a person’s inner drivers and that these types of acting-out behaviors can be seen as “the royal road to an understanding
sigmund Freud
298 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
of the unconscious” (Freud, 1900/1953, p. 608). This perspective implies that every neurotic symptom or act has an underlying reason. The repeti- tion of certain dysfunctional patterns suggests the existence of specific motivational undercurrents underlying decision making and behavior.
Freud himself didn’t make any direct observations about the application of his ideas to the working world, but the psychoanalytic paradigm was taken up by many of his contemporaries and became a critical element of analy- ses of modern society. Many scholars, influenced by Freud’s contributions, applied aspects of the psychodynamic paradigm to the workplace by claim- ing that the inner world of the leader—his or her early childhood experi- ences, and related hopes, fears, and desires—was extremely influential, even at a systemic level in organizations, and should not be ignored (Erikson, 1950).
Most noticeably, in the aftermath of World War II, four streams of research from the London Tavistock Institute, the Menninger Clinic in Topeka, Kansas, Harvard Business School, and Weill Cornell Medical College sig- nificantly advanced the application of the psychodynamic approach to the study of organizations by being among the first to argue that applying psy- choanalytic concepts to organizational life could help in illuminating the irrational processes that underlie leader and follower behavior and decision making.
Founded in 1946, London-based Tavistock brought together an illustrious group of psychoanalysts such as Elliott Jaques, Wilfred Bion, John Bowlby, Eric Trist, Melanie Klein, and R. D. Laing. Elaborating on Bion’s work on the unconscious functioning of the group as a whole, rather than as an aggre- gate of individuals (Bion, 1961; Bion & Rickman, 1943), the Tavistock group contributed a great deal to our understanding of the hidden dynamics within organizations that may directly influence leadership through socio- technical systems (Trist & Bamforth, 1951); industrial democracy ( Jaques, 1951); social systems as a defense against anxiety ( Jaques, 1955, 1970; Menzies Lyth, 1959); the interpretation of social dreaming as a way to define meaning for a group (Lawrence, 1998); and organizational role analysis (Newton, Long & Sievers, 2006). However, members of the Tavistock Institute focused pri- marily on group processes in public organizations such as hospitals and schools, and not specifically in business organizations, with the notable exception of Elliott Jaques, who in partnership with businessman Wilfred Brown conducted a 17-year study, “the Glacier project,” that explored the underlying motives and drivers of authority, role clarity, accountability, and power of both leaders and workers in a Scottish factory, Glacier Metal, of which Brown was the CEO.
Psychoanalytic Approach
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 299
The Menninger Clinic, founded in 1942 to promote the training of psy- choanalysts, also began to apply a psychodynamic approach to the world of work, notably through the work of Will Menninger and Harry Levinson with the Menninger Foundation Division of Industrial Mental Health. In the mid-1950s, an extensive national survey of mental health problems in industries was conducted, including recommendations on how to solve or alleviate them. In response to the findings of the survey, Menninger offered weeklong seminars for executives from all parts of the country in order to give these business leaders an understanding of why human beings act as they do. At Harvard Business School, Levinson con- tinued to apply psychoanalytic theory to management and leadership and linked the failure of managers to effectively contain the anxieties of work- ers to employee depression and low productivity. He proposed the concept of a “psychological contract” between leaders and followers, arguing in Men, Management and Mental Health (1962) that if management did not pay attention to the conscious and subconscious needs of their employees, organizational performance would be adversely affected. His seminal book, Organizational Diagnosis, outlined a new, clinical contribution to the diagnosis of systemic organizational problems (1972).
Around the same time, Abraham Zaleznik (while in training as a psycho- analyst at the Boston Psychoanalytic Society & Institute) started to influ- ence a group of young scholars, including Manfred Kets de Vries, Sudhir Kakar, Pierre Laurin, Anne Jardim, Roland Reitter, Georges Trepo, and Michael Hofmann, who were interested in marrying the world of work and the world of psychoanalysis. Zaleznik (1989) argued that businesspeople focused too much on process and structure, and not enough on ideas and emotions, and suggested that leaders should relate to followers in more empathetic and intuitive ways. To emphasize this point, in Power and the Corporate Mind, Zaleznik and Kets de Vries (1975) applied concepts from psychoanalysis, political science, and management theory to examine the effect that the conscious and unconscious motivations of the chief executive have upon his or her organization. In the seminal study, The Neurotic Organization, Kets de Vries and Miller (1984) integrated psychiatric and psychological findings and insights with organizational behavior theories to create a new framework for analysis of organizations, proposing that the neuroses of a top leader can be re-created throughout the organization.
The early work of Zaleznik and his group of young scholars also provided the stimulus for the first International Symposium on Applied Psychoanalysis and Organizations in 1980, organized by Michael Hofmann of the Wirtschaftsuniversität of Vienna (in collaboration with the Vienna
Leadership development
300 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
Psychoanalytic Society). A further impetus came from Leopold Gruenfeld, who organized a number of conferences under the auspices of Cornell University. Eventually, in 1983, these various symposia led to the founding of the International Society for the Psychoanalytic Study of Organizations (ISPSO); by the early 2000s, ISPSO had a worldwide reach, whose vision was to provide “a forum for academics, clinicians, consultants and others interested in working in and with organizations utilizing psychoanalytic concepts and insights” (www.ispso.org).
Larry Hirschhorn, another influential scholar in the study of organizational dynamics, used the term applied clinical practice to describe organizational con- sulting interventions that included diagnostic methods and actions based on a clinical, applied approach: exploring the organization systemically, and draw- ing on personality theory and group and organizational processes. His study The Workplace Within: Psychodynamics of Organizational Life (1988) opened the door to a better understanding of the irrational and emotional character of organizations. With the goal of creating healthier organizational cultures, Hirschhorn proposed a systemic, psychodynamic model of work that entailed working with real clients on practical outcomes, by addressing the hidden, and unconscious mechanisms underlying patterns of organizational behavior.
In Germany, psychoanalyst Alexander Mitscherlich applied the principles of psychoanalysis to postwar society, and his books Society Without the Father (1963) and The Inability to Mourn (with Margarete Mitscherlich, 1975) became extremely influential works that not only shaped Germany’s analyses of the causes of its war, but also opened the field of social psychol- ogy to a much broader audience. In France, a sociopsychoanalytic move- ment emerged that included scholars such as Gérard Mendel (1968), Didier Anzieu (1972, 1999), René Kaës (1993), Eugène Enriquez (1992), Gilles Amado and Leopold Vansina (2005), and Jean Benjamin Stora (2007), who used psychoanalytic conceptualizations to better understand the fantasies, projections, and identifications that play themselves out in groups, as well as the processes of repression, suppression, and idealization that are manifest in organizational life.
As this brief history of the psychodynamic approach shows, the field has come a long way from the early roots in Freud’s psychoanalytic concepts and techniques with clinical patients to its application on a larger scale to the dynamics and functioning of leaders and organizations. Through the work of researchers and practitioners working at the interface of psychoanalysis and organizational studies, psychoanalytic theory and techniques have become increasingly sophisticated, incorporating the findings from domains such as dynamic psychiatry, developmental psychology, ethology, anthropology,
Psychological development
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 301
neuroscience, cognitive theory, family systems theory, and individual and group psychotherapy. The clinical lens addresses practical problems and opportunities in social systems from a simultaneously deep (psychodynamic) and broad (organizational theory) perspective. Although quite a few aspects of Freud’s theories are no longer valid in light of new information about the workings of the mind, fundamental components of psychoanalytic theory and technique have been scientifically and empirically tested and verified, spe- cifically as they relate to cognitive and emotional processes (Barron & Eagle, 1992; Westen, 1998). Hence, many of Freud’s ideas have retained their rele- vance and have contributed to our understanding of organizations, the prac- tice of management, and the hidden dynamics in the world of work (Czander, 1993; DeBoard, 1978; Gabriel, 1999; Kets de Vries, 1984, 1989, 1991, 2004, 2005, 2006a, 2006b, 2009, 2011a, 2011b, 2014; Kets de Vries & Korotof, 2011; Kets de Vries & Miller, 1984; Kets de Vries, Vrignaud, Agrawal, & Florent-Treacy, 2010; Levinson, 1972; Zaleznik, 1966, 1989; Zaleznik & Kets de Vries, 1975). The psychodynamic approach has greatly advanced the understanding of the vicissitudes of organizational behavior and the people working in such systems.
Key concePts AnD DynAmics Within the PsychoDynAmic APProAch ________________
This section describes the key concepts and ideas that have emerged from the psychodynamic field as it relates to leadership and organization study. Each perspective or lens provides a way of looking at the hidden dynamics and undercurrents of organizational behavior in order to decipher the motives for why people behave the way they do.
1. Focus on the Inner Theatre One of the core concepts of the psychodynamic paradigm is the “inner theatre” (McDougall, 1985). It is the stage filled with people who have influ- enced, for better or worse, our experiences in life. Early experiences with key individuals (such as early caregivers) contribute to the creation of response patterns that have a tendency to repeat themselves in other contexts with different people.
Within the inner theatre, certain relationship themes develop over time— themes rooted in our deepest wishes, needs, and goals, which contribute to our unique personality style. These “core conflictual relationship themes”
302 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
(CCRTs; Luborsky & Crits-Christoph, 1998) become recurring relationship patterns that we take into adulthood. In the context of the workplace, replete with superior and subordinate relationships, we act out these themes onto others and, based on those wishes, rightly or wrongly anticipate how others will react to us; then we react to their perceived reactions, and not to their actual reactions. Unfortunately, these scripts drawn up in childhood on the basis of our CCRTs can become psychic prisons—ineffectual and even dysfunctional in adult situations.
Attending to the CCRT of an individual allows us to understand the motiva- tion behind human behavior, identify key relationship conflicts affecting one’s ability to live and work productively, and in doing so work to align these deep wishes to more productive and mutually enhancing interpersonal relationships.
2. Focus on the Leader-Follower Relationships
A study of leader-follower relationships necessarily addresses the psychology of groups. The psychiatrist Wilfred Bion (1961) identified three basic assumptions in groups—dependency, fight-flight, and pairing—that may result in pathological regressive processes, deflecting people from the prin- cipal tasks to be performed.
People often assume, at an unconscious level, that the leader or organization can and should offer protection and guidance similar to that offered by parents in earlier years. Groups subject to the dependency assumption are united by feelings of helplessness, inadequacy, neediness, and fear of the outside world. They per- ceive the leader as omnipotent, and as a result, readily give up their autonomy. This contributes to goal-directedness and cohesiveness, but impairs followers’ critical judgment and leaves them unwilling to take initiative.
Another common unconscious assumption is that the organizational world is dangerous and participants must use fight or flight as a defense mechanism. In groups subject to the fight-flight assumption, there is a tendency to split the world into camps of friend or foe. Fight reactions manifest themselves in aggression against the self, peers, or authority and include avoidance, absen- teeism, and resignation. Subscribing to a rigid, bipolar view of the world, these groups possess a strong desire for protection from and conquest of “the enemy.” Some leaders even encourage the fight-flight assumption, inflaming their followers against real and/or imagined enemies, using the in-group/ out-group division to motivate people and to channel anxiety outward. This enforces the group’s identity and creates meaning for followers who feel lost. The resulting sense of unity is highly reassuring but makes the group increasingly dependent on their leader.
Michael Mccoby
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 303
Bion’s third assumption is that pairing up with a person or subgroup per- ceived as powerful will help a person cope with anxiety, alienation, and loneliness. People experiencing the pairing assumption fantasize that strength will take place in pairs. Unfortunately, pairing also implies split- ting, which may result in intra- and intergroup conflict and building of smaller systems within the group. It also manifests itself in ganging up against the leader perceived as an aggressor or authority figure.
social Defense mechanisms
Organizational life is filled with angst and unpredictability, and leaders need to know how to deal adequately with the emerging anxiety of work- ing in a social setting (Diamond, 1993; Gilmore & Krantz, 1985; Gould, Stapley & Stein, 2001; Hirschhorn, 1988; Jaques, 1951; Kets de Vries, 2011a; Menzies Lyth, 1959). When organizational anxieties are not properly managed, people may act out and engage in regressive social defenses to transform and neutralize strong tensions. These defenses include splitting (seeing everything as black or white); projection (seeing one’s own shortcomings in others); displacement (expressing negative emotions by focusing on a less threatening target); and denial (refusal to accept facts).
Typically, executives rely on existing structures and processes to “contain” anxiety. When these ways of dealing with organizational anxieties become the dominant mode of operation (rather than an occasional stopgap mea- sure), they become dysfunctional for the organization as a whole by creating bureaucratic obstacles. Task forces, administrative procedures, rationaliza- tion, intellectualization, and other structures and processes are used to keep people emotionally uninvolved and to help them feel safe and in control. However, these bureaucratic routines and pseudorational activities can also obscure personal and organizational realities, allowing people to detach themselves by replacing creativity, empathy, awareness, openness to change, and meaning with control and impersonality.
mirroring and idealizing
Mirroring and idealizing are two types of transferential processes that are especially common in the workplace. It is said that the first mirror for a baby is the mother’s face. From that point on, the process of mirroring— that is, taking our cues about being and behaving from those around
Leaders and Followers
304 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
us—becomes an ongoing aspect of our daily life and of our relationships with others (Kets de Vries, 2011a; Kohut, 1971, 1985). In organizations, this mirroring dynamic between leader and follower can become collu- sive. Followers are eager to use their leaders to reflect what they would like to see. Leaders, on the other hand, find the affirmation of followers hard to resist. The result is often a mutual admiration society that encourages leaders to take actions that shore up their image rather than serve the needs of the organization. When these transferential patterns persist, however, leader and followers gradually stop responding to the reality of the situation, allowing their past hopes and fantasies instead to govern their interactions.
identification With the Aggressor
To overcome the anxiety prompted by a leader’s aggressive behavior, some followers may resort to the defensive process known as “identification with the aggressor.” Confronted with a superior force, people sometimes feel a strong incentive to become like that superior force, to protect against pos- sible aggression (Freud, 1966; Kets de Vries, 2009). In full-fledged identifi- cation with the aggressor, individuals impersonate the aggressor, transforming themselves from those threatened to those making threats. In this climate of dependency, the world becomes starkly black and white. In other words, the leader sees people as being either for or against him or her. When a leader has this kind of mind-set, independent thinkers are “removed”; those who hesitate to collaborate become fresh targets for the leader’s anger or become scapegoats, designated victims on whom the group assigns blame whenever things go wrong.
Folie à Deux
Some leader-follower collusions can be described as “folie à deux,” or shared madness (Kets de Vries, 1979, 2001). In such collusions, there is usually a dominant person whose delusions become adopted by other members of the organization. Leaders whose capacity for reality testing has become impaired may transfer their delusions to their followers, who in order to minimize conflict and disagreement and risk opportunities for self-enhancement will sacrifice truth and honest criticism to maintain a connection with the leader even though he or she has lost touch with reality. In extreme cases, a folie à deux can lead to the self-destruction of the leader, professionally speaking, and to the collective demise of followers.
Archetypes
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 305
3. Focus on the Shadow Side of Leadership
narcissism
At the heart of leadership lies narcissism (Freud, 1914/1957; Kernberg, 1975; Kets de Vries, 1989; Kets de Vries & Miller, 1985; Kohut, 1971, 1985; Maccoby, 1976). Narcissism—which Freud (1914/1957) summarized as behaviors that range from a normal self-interest to a pathological self-absorption—offers leaders the conviction about the righteousness of their cause, which in turn inspires loyalty and group identification. Narcissism can be either constructive or reactive (Kets de Vries, 2004; Kets de Vries & Miller, 1985). Constructive, or healthy, narcissists have been fortunate enough to have caretakers who provided a supportive environment that led to basic trust and to a sense of control over one’s actions. In leadership roles, constructive narcissists tend to be relatively well balanced and have vitality and a sense of self-esteem, capacity for intro- spection, and empathy. They inspire others not only to be better at what they do, but also to entirely change what they do. Reactive, or excessive, narcissistic leaders, on the other hand, were not as fortunate in childhood. Instead, they were the recipients of over- or understimulation, or inconsistent stimulation. Typically, such leaders are fixated on issues of power, status, prestige, and supe- riority. They are often driven toward achievement and attainment by the need to get even for perceived slights experienced in childhood. Unwilling to tolerate disagreement and criticism, such leaders rarely consult with others. The result is that reactive narcissists operate in their own reality, and without any measures of control or reality testing, this can wreak havoc in the organization.
hoW Does the PsychoDynAmic APProAch WorK?
As mentioned, the essence of leadership is about human behavior and effec- tive leadership is rooted in the underlying motives that govern such behavior. Contrary to the writings of various management theorists who attribute organizational effectiveness to environmental constraints, the psychodynamic approach defends the idea that psychological, social and emotional processes between leaders and followers have a great influence and need to be taken into consideration. That is not to minimize the context in which leaders oper- ate. But a company can have all the “environmental” advantages in the world—strong financial resources, enviable market position, and state-of-the- art technology—and still fail in the absence of leadership.
Anyone wanting to create or manage an effective organization needs to understand the complexity of why leaders act the way they do. What the psychodynamic study of leadership effectiveness demonstrates more clearly
narcissistic Personality narcissism
306 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
than other conceptual frameworks is that leaders need to recognize that people differ in their motivational patterns (Kets de Vries, 2006). This approach also acknowledges that leaders and followers are not one-dimensional enti- ties, but rather complex and paradoxical people who radiate a combination of soaring idealism and gloomy pessimism, stubborn short-sightedness and courageous vision, narrow-minded suspicion and open-handed trust, irratio- nal envy and greed and unbelievable unselfishness. Taking the emotional pulse of followers, both individually and as a group, is essential, but that alone does not comprise effective leadership. The essence of leadership is the ability to use motivational patterns to influence others—in other words, to get people to voluntarily do things that they would not otherwise do.
Scholars and leaders who adopt a psychodynamic approach to organizational studies look at the dark side of leadership as well as the atypical successes (Czander, 1993; DeBoard, 1978; Eisold, 2010; Gabriel, 1999; Hirschhorn, 1988; Kets de Vries, 1989; Kets de Vries & Miller, 1985; Krantz, 2010; Levinson, 1962; Obholzer & Zagier Roberts, 1994; Zaleznik, 1966; Zaleznik & Kets de Vries, 1975). They realize that only by accepting the fact that leaders, like the rest of us, are not paragons of rationality can we begin to understand why many well-laid plans and strategies derail or, conversely, why great leaders sometimes come from very unexpected places.
However, the application of psychodynamics into leadership or organizational phenomena is not without challenges. Neumann and Hirschhorn (in a special issue of Human Relations) identified this challenge as the “limited degree to which those working with psychodynamic theories have managed to also relate to organizational theories, and vice versa” (1999, p. 683). They also identified a delicate balance that needs to be maintained in the psychodynamic approach to organizational study. A too narrowly focused psychodynamic approach could limit the scope of interventions to the unconscious motivation of individuals and groups. Conversely, a broader organizational theory perspective that focuses on large systems or environments might overlook major sources of motivation and energy that are imperceptible at the organizational level, but influential at the individual level. However, both authors agreed that despite this challenge, integrating psychodynamic and organizational theory would promote better analyses of the “motivational forces in individuals, groups and their leaders in the context of structures and processes within major subsystems, organizations, and their environments—and vice versa” (1999, p. 685).
strengths —————————————————————————————————-
The psychodynamic approach provides another lens to the study of organi- zational dynamics beyond a purely rational, structural approach. Specifically,
Mood Matters
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 307
it addresses the undercurrents of organizational life through issues such as interpersonal communication, group processes, social defenses, and organiza- tion-wide neurosis. A clinically informed approach aims to instill in the orga- nization’s leaders an interest in and understanding of their own behavior—why they do what they do—as well as the behavior of others in order to best influence and leverage the potential of their followers. In short, the psychodynamic approach focuses on personal and collective insight on the part of the leader and follower—it strives to create reflective practitioners.
Another strength is that the psychodynamic approach involves an in-depth and systemic investigation of a single person, group, event, or community. It consists not only of an analysis of the self but also of the self in relation to others and to the context in which he or she exists. To this end, life case stud- ies, coaching, and 360° feedback assessments gathered from a variety of sources may be used to provide rich and detailed insight into a person’s behavior.
Another strength is that the psychodynamic approach emphasizes the rela- tionship between leader and follower by focusing on the underlying drivers of each and what accounts for the type of relationship between them. Ideally, leaders will eventually internalize the ability to learn, work, and reflect with the psychological realm in mind, and in doing so improve their organiza- tional relationships and team performance.
criticisms
The most prevalent criticism of the psychodynamics approach comes from the fact that much of the early work was based on clinical observation of the treatment of individuals with serious mental issues. This approach focuses on dysfunction and is premised on atypical or abnormal rather than the typical behavior. Many of the concepts central to Freud’s theories are subjec- tive and difficult to prove scientifically.
Another criticism is that the psychodynamic approach does not lend itself to training in a conventional sense. This is because the focus is to increase an individual’s self-awareness in order to find better ways to behave and relate personally. The route to change therefore varies from individual to individual, with no standard solution that can be applied broadly. This makes it difficult to provide specific guidelines for systematic change. A third criticism, related to the second, is that it situates the intervention at the individual level, focus- ing on the leader’s personality and leadership style, and hence, more structural and systemic organizational issues, while important, remain in the background. Team dynamics can be addressed through psychodynamic team coaching,
308 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
although the focus again is on the interpersonal relationships and issues within the group. Structural issues may, however, arise through team discussions, but they are not the focal point of discussion. Just as the structural approach to leadership studies and development may fail to address people issues, the psychodynamic approach likewise may fail to capture key structural issues. Hence the best intervention is a holistic one, which adopts both a structural and a psychodynamic lens.
APPlicAtion
As mentioned, the psychodynamic approach to organizational study has evolved visibly during the last 25 years or so, rooted in the Clinical Paradigm of psychoanalysis and in particular the psychoanalytic study of organizations (Czander, 1993; Diamond, 1993; Gabriel, 1999). Kets de Vries (2005) argued that to be more effective in developing reflective leaders, leadership develop- ment programs should integrate a clinical or psychodynamic orientation, because this paradigm provides a solid framework for designing executive programs in which participants learn to become “organizational detectives,” uncovering the nonrational patterns—the intrapsychic and interpersonal undercurrents—that influence the behavior of individuals, dyads, and groups.
One of the objectives of a psychodynamic leadership development program is to create an opportunity for participants that provokes an exploration of hidden or unconscious rationale—often related in some way to sexuality, financial issues, a search for happiness and meaning, or fears of mortality— for what may appear to be irrational career choices and leadership decisions. Leadership coaches and organizational consultants work with their clients to explore undercurrents that drive behavior so that executives can better manage defenses, learn how to express emotions in a situation-appropriate manner, and cultivate a perception of self and others that is in accord with reality (Kets de Vries, 2006; McCullough Vaillant, 1997).
In such programs, a peer group coaching methodology plays a vital role wherein group dynamic effects such as social reciprocity, peer pressure, and network contagion are harnessed. Participants work together to uncover blind spots, challenge one another, identify behavior for change, and experi- ment with new behavior in their workplace that will help them advance in their career trajectory and future goals (Dubouloy, 2004; Kets de Vries, 2005, 2011a, 2011b; Kets de Vries & Korotov, 2011).
Mirvis (2008) suggested that executive programs may be, under some cir- cumstances, a “consciousness-raising” experience that cultivates participants’
Team coaching
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 309
self-awareness, deepens their understanding of others, and helps them to relate to society. Some of these programs may even be described by the par- ticipants themselves as “a transformative experience through which an indi- vidual comes to a new or altered sense of identity” (Bennis & Thomas, 2002, p. 40). By paying attention to behavioral patterns that may have their origin in their clients’ earlier life experiences, consultants and coaches look for the- matic unity (Kets de Vries, 2011a) to create meaning at multiple levels to determine the individual and organizational roots and consequences of actions and decisions. When the link between present and distant past rela- tionships is made meaningful, leaders are more likely to arrive at tipping points for change. Indeed, one of the most powerful and effective experiences in leadership programs is creating such turning points in which participants make a connection between their current choices in life, see the discrepancies in their lives, and work to realign them.
Moreover the clinical intervention can have team and organizational benefits beyond just individual change. By making conscious what had been unconscious and then working to address dysfunctional behavior patterns at the team and organizational level, the consultant and the client can work together to address social defenses with the aim of healing organizational neurosis.
Group Coaching
A group coaching intervention is one very effective methodology for apply- ing the psychodynamic principles to leadership development. Guided by an experienced external group facilitator, group coaching brings a group of lead- ers together to reflect on their interpersonal relationships, work practices, leadership styles, decision-making practices, and organizational culture. An always-present agenda, however, is to create alignment and become more effective in implementing the organizational strategy.
Prior to the actual intervention, the group facilitator/coach interviews the participants to get a better idea of individual and team issues and identify the major themes preoccupying the group. Participants are also asked to answer a number of 360° feedback surveys on various dimensions such as leadership behaviors, personality, inner drivers, and leadership roles. The purpose of these surveys is to draw from multiple sources of feedback, from the individual’s private and public/work life to provide a more well-rounded view of the individual and the system within which he or she operates. The day prior to the actual intervention, participants are given a copy of their assessment results to reflect on.
identity and self-concept
310 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
On the day of the group intervention, the group coach gives a short lecture about high-performance organizations and effective leadership. Subsequently, using an approach popularized at INSEAD, a top business school with cam- puses in France, Singapore, and Abu Dhabi, the coach asks all members of the leaders’ committee to draw a self-portrait of how they see themselves as it relates to their head, heart, stomach, past, present, work, and leisure. When all the self-portraits are complete and displayed on the wall, the group coach begins the session by asking a first participant to kick off the process by tell- ing the group about his or her drawing. Through the narrative of one’s self- portrait, the group is able to learn intimate facts about the individual in question. Next, the group coach focuses on the 360° survey feedback reports, which were handed out to the group the night before. The coach then asks the participant about his or her own and observers’ feedback, and if there was anything in the report that was not new or surprising to the participant. Specifically, the coach draws attention to the discrepancies between self and observers’ perceptions in order to examine blind spots, or areas of a person’s personality not known to the self but perceived to be poignant by others. Through further exploration of the feedback report and personal narrative and history of the individual, the participant continues to reveal aspects of his or her life underlying major life decisions and current behaviors. The coach then asks other members of the team to provide feedback to the par- ticipant. This begins a two-way dialogue between the individual and the group, with the purpose of arriving at mutual understanding—and making the person in the “hot seat” more effective. The participant, working with the coach and other team members, identifies a number of specific behaviors to focus on to facilitate communication and collaboration with the other team members. These priorities are aimed at drawing out one’s strengths while minimizing less effective behavior. The participant then confirms publically his or her commitments to change. In response, others voice their under- standing and support of this change process. Subsequently, each member of the executive team goes through the same process. Each takes the “hot seat” in turn to tell his or her story and is given constructive feedback by the group. Each individual session is concluded with an action plan to identify ways in which the team member could improve his or her leadership behaviors and personally contribute to team alignment and performance.
Group coaching has several advantages. Compared to one-on-one coaching, group coaching has proven to be a highly intensive and effective intervention to prepare leaders for individual and organizational change. Although indi- vidual interventions can be valuable, they don't create the same intensity and focus in a single session that group coaching does. Group coaching ensures that, after the intervention, the team will assume a constructively challenging follow-up role supporting one another. By contrast, in one-on-one coaching,
Perception of effective Leadership
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 311
follow-up is conducted by executive coaches who are often available irregularly, leaving individual leaders very much on their own to get things done. In group coaching, individuals also benefit from the peer group; they become mutually invested in encouraging the new behaviors that each one has identified, and they are committed to working together to achieve their goals. Group mem- bers get the opportunity to know each other much better—even though some of them may have worked together for many years. Furthermore, it encourages them to really have courageous conversations—and to be more open with one another. This kind of “group contagion” is a powerful way to bring about tipping points for change. A final benefit is the opportunity for peer coaching, in which members of the group learn to give and receive feedback. When continued beyond the intervention and into the workplace, this peer coaching relationship is a powerful means for supporting one another through the change process.
The following are a number of complex (conscious and unconscious) psychological processes at play that bring about the much desired tipping points for change:
1. To start, a group intervention provides a context for cathartic experiences. The group setting allows executives to get things off their chest—a forum, at least figuratively, for “emotional cleansing.” The group becomes an enabler of bringing repressed feelings, fears, and covert conflicts to the surface. Putting out into the open the things that trouble them can be an extremely powerful emotional experience. Under the right circumstances, using the narrative technique provides an opportunity to reexperience and transform deeply troubling incidents, helping executives better understand why they do what they do.
2. Furthermore, while listening to the other leaders’ life stories and chal- lenges, the members of the group come to realize that they are not alone in their confusion. They are not the only ones who, at times, feel like impos- tors working in the organization. Others, too, struggle with similar fears. This realization can bring a great sense of relief. Mutual identif ication with specific problems brings the team together and offers opportunities to jointly discuss more effective ways of dealing with knotty issues at work.
3. A psychodynamic lens into the discussion can set into motion a whole process of associations of why a leader has been doing things in a particu- lar way. It contributes to reflections whether there are other, better ways to solve problems they may be struggling with. Is a particular behavioral repertoire that was extremely appropriate at one point in time still effec- tive in the present? Should other ways be explored to deal with specific issues? While these reflections take place, a major tool in the intervention
312 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
methodology will be transferential interpretations—the realization that we tend to act toward people in the present based on models of the past. Understanding these old patterns of interaction can help us unpack dys- functional behavior. Through recognizing long-standing and maladaptive past patterns, the link between present relationships and distant past is made meaningful, thereby improving the chances for change.
4. In addition (very much encouraged by the other members of the group), such reflections can lead to a willingness to experiment in doing things dif- ferently—and by doing so, create new scenarios for the future. Leaders may come to realize that they can free themselves from what may resemble psychic prisons. In many instances, such self-understanding and insight moves people a long way along the road to personal and organizational change.
5. What also should be kept in mind is that every presentation—not just one’s own—offers the opportunity for vicarious learning. Leaders soon come to realize that learning does not only occur through direct participa- tion in dialogue (being in the “hot seat”), but that much of the learning takes place vicariously through observing and listening to other people’s stories. This kind of learning implies retaining and replicating effective behavior observed in others. Furthermore, as there are always leaders in the group who are admired because of the way they deal with life’s adversities, they may turn into role models, the kind of people the others would like to emulate. Imitative, mirroring behavior—or identification with the other—is an important part of the interpersonal learning process and a very powerful force for change.
6. During the group coaching process (if done well), the leaders going through it become a real community, members of a “tribe” that have gone through the same emotional experience. Tribe people draw on a great deal of mutual support whenever one of them embarks on a new challenge. This feeling of social belonging also becomes a very powerful catalyst for change.
7. A group setting is also an opportunity for collective learning. Occasionally, didactic instruction by the group coach can be beneficial, although (in my experience) it should be given sparingly. Explanation, clarification, and even direct advice about how to do things better within the group can reduce anxiety and establish control when there is a troublesome issue. However, it should not only be the leadership coach who offers sugges- tions, as leaders themselves are vast troves of expertise. And here again, the process of vicarious experience can be extremely powerful. Leaders can draw from their own rich experiences to share information about work issues and recommend different approaches and ways of doing things. And
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 313
by giving advice to others, they are practicing the supportive and challeng- ing behaviors that can help the team function better.
8. Finally, a further positive force for change can be the altruistic motive, or the desire to put the needs of others above our own. While helping for helping’s sake—the genuine desire to make things better for others—may seem selfless, ironically, it can have some selfish side effects. The act of giving to others can have numerous personal benefits. Helping others— offering support, reassurance, suggestions, and insights—can have a therapeutic effect, contributing to each leader’s level of positive emotion, sense of self-respect, and well-being.
cAse stUDies
In this section, we present three cases (12.1, 12.2, and 12.3) onto which you can apply the psychodynamic lens to decipher why the leader behaves the way he or she does and to think about ways a coach can help address the underlying dynamics and help the individual change his or her behavior.
Case 12.1
Dealing With Passive-Aggressives
robert wondered why he was always so stressed out when he was dealing with Lucas, the latest addition to his team. on the face of it, the new hire seemed very agreeable and supportive, but whatever interactions robert had with Lucas left him wondering about Lucas’s true intentions. Lucas made lots of promises but never really seemed to deliver on them. What troubled him especially was that Lucas didn’t respect deadlines. Whenever he pointed this out, Lucas always had a good excuse: The instructions hadn’t been clear, perhaps, or he had misunderstood, or he had been relying on someone else for some key task and that person hadn’t come through. To make matters even worse (according to some colleagues), Lucas also had the habit of constantly complaining about robert behind his back. it is not difficult to ascertain that Lucas’s behavior is passive- aggressive: continuously expressing negative feelings, resentment, and aggression in an unassertive, passive manner. All the while, people like Lucas show all the signs of agreeable compliance, which makes them dif- ficult to pin down and hold to account. As a coach, what can you do to help robert and Lucas work more effectively together?
(Continued)
314 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
Questions
1. should robert confront Lucas directly?
2. What can the coach do to get Lucas to express his negative feelings openly?
3. What subjects or issues should be explored with Lucas?
4. What exercises can Lucas do to practice direct confrontation with robert?
5. What can robert do to improve his relationship with Lucas?
(continued)
Case 12.2
the fear of success
Tim had been on the fast track. An ivy League graduate, he had joined one of the premier consulting firms as an associate. he went on to earn an MBA, graduating at the top of his class. recruited by a pharmaceuti- cal firm, he rose quickly through the ranks, joining the executive team in record time. Just eight years after joining the company, he was appointed its ceo. That was when things started to fall apart. colleagues soon noticed that Tim seemed oddly reluctant to make important deci- sions. he would put off big projects and spend an inordinate amount of time on minor problems. As a result, the company missed out on some big opportunities. his behavior became increasingly worrisome. he would even turn up visibly drunk for important meetings. Although the board cut Tim some slack at first, his shortcomings quickly became too obvious to be ignored, and within two years of his appointment the board dismissed him. What went wrong?
Tim appears to have functioned extremely well as long as he wasn’t in the number-one position. But the moment he was placed in the spot- light, he was in uncharted territory and could no longer hide behind someone else. in that extremely visible role, he became highly vulnera- ble, and his effectiveness diminished as he succumbed to self-destructive behaviors. At times, he even felt like an impostor. he also feared that the higher he climbed, the further he would fall when he made a mistake.
Tim seemed to have unconscious feelings of guilt about his success. he was consumed by the idea that his being too successful would upset his father, who had repeatedly failed in his business endeavors
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 315
and had become embittered by it. he had taken out these emotions on Tim, constantly telling him that he didn’t have what it took to be successful. As the years went by, Tim had internalized these criticisms. But this debasing sense of self remained dormant until Tim finally became ceo.
Questions
1. should the executive board have fired Tim for failing to live up to expectations? What alternatives are there?
2. What could the board have done to help Tim address these disruptive behaviors?
3. What areas should be explored with Tim in trying to decode his neg- ative associations with success?
4. What can Tim do to develop an alternative, more constructive internal narrative of success?
5. As a coach, how would you work with Tim to confront his fear of success?
Case 12.3
helping a Bipolar leader
John is a talented executive with extraordinary drive and charisma. The people reporting to him all agreed that he provided outstanding leader- ship in the company’s last crisis; his refusal to bow to adversity and his ability to rally people behind him had been truly remarkable. But they also agreed he could go over the top. he sent emails at 2 a.m., and it was sometimes hard to follow exactly what he was saying. he would jump suddenly from one idea to another, and some of his plans seemed unre- alistic, even grandiose. And whenever anyone tried to slow him down, John wouldn’t hear of it. his sense of invincibility made him feel that he could do anything. once he had made up his mind, it was almost impos- sible to change it. his inability to listen coupled with his lack of judgment eventually resulted in his making a number of seriously bad decisions, plunging his unit into the red. The board was considering firing him.
John suffers from a mood disorder called bipolar dysfunction, previously known as manic depression, a condition that haunts approximately 4% of the population. People suffering from this condition report they
(Continued)
316 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
periodically experience an overactive mind and often seem to get by on little or no sleep. They often feel a heightening of the senses, which may trigger increased sexual activity, and are highly prone to bouts of extrav- agant behavior. Their moods swing wildly from this state of exuberance to the polar opposite, when they suddenly become withdrawn and inert, shunning the company of others. Bipolar dysfunction is a condi- tion often associated with highly creative people (e.g., William Blake, Friedrich nietzsche, and Ludwig van Beethoven, as well as many famous leaders such as Theodore roosevelt, Winston churchill, and General George Patton).
As history shows, manic-depressive leaders are great in a crisis, refusing to bow to adversity. They rush in where others fear to tread and can inspire others to follow. The downside is that due to their extreme sense of empowerment, energy, and optimism, their thinking and judgment can be flawed. caught up in their grandiosity, they overestimate their capabilities and try to do more than they can handle. The problems are often aggravated by an inability to recognize that their behavior is dys- functional. While “high,” they rarely have insight into their condition. They like the sense of invulnerability that comes with the “high,” and are reluctant to give that up.
When the inevitable setbacks and disasters happen, they fall into a tail- spin of depression. This had just happened to John, who had gone so far as to check himself into a hospital psychiatric ward for a brief stay. Adding to his woes, his wife asked for a trial separation. Apparently John had been reckless with his personal finances and had been involved in numerous affairs. John is a clearly talented executive, but his behavior is self-destructive.
Questions
1. What should the board members do with regard to John’s poor deci- sions? should they fire him? What alternative routes are available?
2. how can John be made aware of his disruptive behaviors?
3. What role can his wife/family play to help John address his bipolarity?
4. Within the workplace, what can be done to leverage John’s strengths (creativity) and minimize his disruptive behavior? What type of struc- ture will be a best fit for John in the organization?
5. As a coach, how can you help John to rebalance his life?
(continued)
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 317
leADershiP instrUment
Effective leaders have two roles—a charismatic one and an architectural one. In the charismatic role, leaders envision a better future and empower and energize their followers to work toward this vision. In the architectural role, leaders address issues related to organizational design processes and control and reward systems. Both roles are necessary for effective leadership, but it is a rare leader who can fulfill both roles seamlessly. Usually, align- ment is only achieved within a leadership role constellation that enables members to take different but complementary roles. A diverse group of carefully selected individuals can be structured to become a highly effective team that delivers much more than the sum of its parts. The first step is to identify each individual’s personality makeup and leadership style, and then match his or her strengths and competencies to particular roles and chal- lenges. This sort of creative team configuration can energize and enhance the workplace.
The Leadership Archetype Questionnaire (Kets de Vries, 2006b) is a psy- chometrically validated 360° feedback instrument designed to identify indi- viduals’ dominant leadership behaviors and what steps are needed to create a well-balanced team. Leadership archetypes are prototypes of leadership styles in today’s complex organizational environment. Successful organiza- tions are characterized by a distributive, collective, complementary form of leadership, wherein a group of carefully selected individuals can become a highly effective team that delivers much more than the sum of its parts. Although individuals may “drift” toward one particular archetype, it is more common for a person to possess the characteristics of a number of arche- types. It is also important to keep in mind that each of these leadership archetypes will prove more or less effective, depending on the situation. Therefore, the ideal leadership team should include people with diverse dominant leadership characteristics. A team in which multiple archetypes are represented should be able to cover most of the leadership needs that are required, whatever the context.
From a psychodynamic point of view, leadership archetypes represent differ- ent leadership styles and different ways of behaving in the organizational environment. These behaviors in turn are rooted in different personalities, inner drivers, and strengths. Some of these styles can come in conflict with others, while others are more complementary. In becoming aware of these different ways of being and behaving, leaders can better understand their own strengths and weaknesses, as well as the strengths and weaknesses of others. This awareness can then be used to help them better influence their people, through leveraging their strengths and managing weaknesses, and in doing so create balanced, symbiotic, and mutually enhancing teams.
318 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
the leadership Archetype Questionnaire (Abridged Version)
To assist you in understanding the process of what your own dominant leadership behaviors might be, this questionnaire provides 360°, or multi- rater, feedback about your leadership. The Leadership Archetype Questionnaire (LAQ), Abridged Version, comprises 8 items that assess 8 archetypes: the strategist, the change catalyst, the transactor, the builder, the innovator, the processor, the coach, and the communicator. The results you obtain on this questionnaire will provide you with information on what your own leadership archetype may be.
note: Another recommendation is to get other members of your team to complete the questionnaire for themselves so that you can map out your team constellation to see how balanced your team is, or if there are areas that are lacking.
instructions: This questionnaire contains items that assess different dimensions of your leadership and will be completed by you and others who know you (coworkers, friends, members of a group you belong to).
1. Make five copies of this questionnaire.
2. self-assessment: Fill out the assessment about yourself.
3. For the 360° feedback, have each individual answer the same questions about you. it is insightful to see how other people perceive you; their percep- tions also influence the way they deal and interact with you.
study the following statements and mark the ones that you think are true for you. select more than one if appropriate.
1. i have great strategic sense.
2. i take on the role of deal maker, always prepared to make propositions about new business deals.
3. i am highly experienced at turning around difficult situations.
4. i suggest entrepreneurial ways of developing the business.
5. i come up with a number of new product or process innovations.
6. i promote and monitor structures, systems, and tasks.
7. i am very interested in devising creative ways to develop people.
8. i take on the role of communicator in my organizations.
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 319
scoring interpretation
each statement corresponds to one of the following leadership archetypes:
1. the strategist—Leadership as a game of chess
2. the change catalyst—Leadership as a turnaround activity
3. the transactor—Leadership as deal making
4. the Builder—Leadership as entrepreneurial activity
5. the innovator—Leadership as creative idea generation
6. the Processor—Leadership as an exercise in efficiency
7. the coach—Leadership as people development
8. the communicator—Leadership as stage management
1. The Strategist
strategists are good at dealing with developments in the organization’s envi- ronment. They provide vision, strategic direction, and outside-the-box thinking to create new organizational forms and generate future growth. They can see the big picture, anticipate future developments, and respond quickly to change. Although strategists have a talent for aligning vision with strategy, they are not always good at taking the next step—aligning strategy with values and behavior. They prefer to ignore “soft” issues and avoid conflict, focusing instead on facts, figures, and abstract scenarios. To compensate for this defi- ciency, strategists often join forces with coaches. strategists are often not good communicators. Their followers may not always fully understand what they are trying to do or what message they are trying to get across. Because they are preoccupied with the big picture, strategists may ignore some of the “micro” issues that warrant attention to keep organizational processes on track. in these instances, processors and communicators can be very helpful to them.
2. The Change Catalyst
change catalysts function best in the integration of organizational cultures after a merger or acquisition or when spearheading reengineering or turna- round projects. They are also excellent at managing rapidly growing organi- zational units and recognizing opportunities for organizational transformation. change catalysts are implementation driven and very good at selecting talent to get the task done. Unlike strategists, they have the talent to align vision, strategy, and behavior. They are both outcome and process oriented. The flip side is that change catalysts can quickly become bored in
320 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
stable situations and are not suited to participating in small, incremental change efforts. Many operate on a short-term timeline, and need to see imme- diate results. if no challenging assignment is available, these leaders may try to create one (sometimes for the wrong reasons). Although many change catalysts have a talent for people management, there will be times when their sense of urgency may override their sensitivity to people and make them poor communicators. change catalysts also tend to have a starkly black-and-white view of what is right or wrong. Thus, they are not always politically sensitive enough to handle complex organizational problems. What they see as inno- cent actions can have disastrous consequences. some of these problems can be avoided, however, if they team up with coaches.
3. The Transactor
Transactors like making acquisitions or other deals. extremely dynamic and enthusiastic, they thrive on new challenges and negotiations. They like novelty, adventure, and exploration, and have high risk tolerance.
Proactive in welcoming change and instinctive networkers, transactors know how to lobby inside and outside the organization to get their point of view across. They are outcome oriented but not as effective at processes. Like change catalysts, transactors can become very restless if they do not have enough stimulation. As a result, they can be seduced by the excitement of mergers and takeovers. once they get going, there is no holding them back, and they can take other people on a very risky journey. After they pull off a deal, however, transactors lose interest in taking the project to the next phase. Their impatience with structures, processes, and systems means that they are poor at organization building. Their sometimes mercurial tempera- ments can also create very stressful situations. Being good deal makers and negotiators, they are frequently hard to read—an asset in negotiation, which can confuse collaborators. They need others, such as strategists, processors, and coaches, to compensate for their limitations.
4. The Builder
Builders enjoy starting and building their own organizations or setting up “skunkworks” and other entrepreneurial ventures inside a large organization. They have a powerful need for independence and to be in control. They also have the talent to make their dreams come true: They possess an enormous amount of energy, drive, dynamism, and enterprise. Builders are creative, decisive, focused, single-minded, and persevering, and have a great capacity to deal with setbacks. They also have a high, but calculated, propensity to take
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 321
risks, and they are quick to adapt when they see opportunities. They know how to get other people to produce results. Builders have to be at the center of things, however. They tend to have little regard for authority and great difficulties with delegation. Although a builder’s leadership can be inspira- tional, poor communication and a culture of domination and control can contribute to dysfunctional decision making. Builders need others, such as processors and coaches, to be their sparring partners.
5. The Innovator
extremely curious, innovators want to learn more about anything and every- thing that grabs their attention. Their passion for learning new things and their insatiable search for knowledge can be a source of inspiration to others. innovators are the most reluctant of all the leadership archetypes to do things in a particular way simply because that is how things have always been done. Because of this innovative mind-set, they can bring fresh, new approaches to their organizations. More politically astute innovators can be good at managing innovative projects, if not hampered by routine. starting in childhood, innova- tors tend to be introverts, stimulated by thoughts and ideas rather than people and things. Adept at logic and reason, they typically lack the usual social graces and may not always express their feelings appropriately. They are poor social sensors, unskilled at decoding body language, sensing others’ feelings, or recog- nizing hidden agendas, thus making a rather “nerdy” impression. Moreover, innovators’ driven way of working means that they have trouble conforming to organizational norms and may be treated as outsiders. in going their own way, they may lose sight of the financial realities and limitations, thus endangering the viability of the organization.
6. The Processor
Processors like to create order out of disorder and are adept at helping organ- izations make an effective transition from an entrepreneurial to a more pro- fessionally managed stage. Talented at setting boundaries and at creating the structures and systems necessary to support the organization’s objectives, they have a systemic, practical outlook and dislike unstructured situations. They are good at time management, very conscientious, reliable, and efficient, able to keep a cool head in stressful situations. As team players, they have a very positive attitude toward authority and are committed corporate citizens. Because they tend to be adaptable and collaborative, processors complement most other leadership styles and thus play an important role in any executive role constellation. sometimes, however, a processor’s need for order, systems,
322 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
and rules can shade into stubbornness and inflexibility, so these leaders can be slow to respond to new opportunities or even hinder them. They tend to lack imagination, flexibility, and spontaneity. Their inflexibility can create people-management problems. not only will it be helpful for processors to be paired up with coaches, but strategists or innovators can also help to bring in an element of out-of-the-box thinking.
7. The Coach
coaches are very good at instituting culture change projects to address organizational alienation and loss of trust. They are exceptional people developers who possess empathy, are extremely good listeners, and have high emotional intelligence. With their positive, constructive outlook on life, they inspire confidence and trust. Great communicators and motiva- tors, coaches are excellent at handling difficult interpersonal and group situations and at giving constructive feedback. They create high-perfor- mance teams and high-performance cultures. They are great believers in participatory management and know how to delegate. The downside is that their sensitivity to others’ feelings can make them overly careful when giving feedback: They may find it hard to be tough when needed, and they may shy away from dealing with difficult underperformance and personal issues. in crisis situations, some coaches may be slow to act or may procras- tinate about important issues, a danger when speed is a competitive advan- tage. Given the organizational context, teaming coaches with executives who possess other archetypes can be highly effective.
8. The Communicator
With their ability to express a vision strongly and powerfully, communicators can inspire people at all levels. They are good at projecting optimism in times of adversity or crisis and are strongly influential with the various constituen- cies in the organization. Possessing impressive theatrical skills and great presence, communicators are very effective in building alliances and enlist- ing the support of other people. however, a communicator’s preference for looking at the big picture, rather than dealing with details, means that these leaders need others, such as strategists and processors, to make their dreams become reality. communicators can also appear to operate on the surface: When it’s time to deliver, very little happens, and everything they have been saying can seem like empty rhetoric. expert in looking out for number one, they are not averse to obtaining excessive perks and other benefits for them- selves. They sometimes latch on to others for support and even take credit for other people’s achievements, a self-serving style that can contribute to
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 323
organizational disintegration. in their drive to acquire the symbols of power, they will tolerate warfare between internal fiefdoms in the organization. As in the case of coaches, when balanced with other archetypes, communica- tors can play an essential role in many role constellations.
When interpreting the Leadership Archetype Questionnaire results, keep this in mind:
• The results are based on your own (and your observers’) perceptions at a single point in time. Though the responses certainly reflect long- standing behavioral characteristics, situational factors can have consider- able influence.
• Most of us—and most effective leaders—can be slotted into more than one archetype. Archetype identifications change as our life changes. Assessing where and what we are is not a static, one-off, operation.
• Furthermore, it is a rare leader who can fulfill all the roles seamlessly. successful organizations are characterized by a distributive, collective, complementary form of leadership.
• Finally, people are much more complex than the scores shown on the LAQ (or any other instrument). What the LAQ attempts to do is capture some of that complexity and illuminate basic elements of your behavior. The results are jumping-off points for self-examination and discussion.
For more information on the development and validation of the Leadership Archetype Questionnaire, please refer to Kets de Vries et al. (2010). Development and application of the Leadership Archetype Questionnaire. International Journal of Human Resource Management, 21(15), 2846–2861.
324 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
sUmmAry
This chapter proposes an approach to leadership that goes beyond the tradi- tional, more conventional “rational” approach. The psychodynamic approach is the flip side of the coin, and looks at the underlying irrational processes and dynamics governing human behavior. Indeed, much of what we do, whether we want to admit it or not, is guided by deep-seated experiences and patterns that are first mapped out in early infancy, through our experiences with early caregivers. We carry these patterns subconsciously into our adult and working lives, and they color our interactions with those we work with—superiors, peers, and followers alike. Any understanding of leadership behavior needs to consider these undercurrents. Only in understanding our- selves and our drivers, and in turn turning our analytic gaze to deciphering the motivations and behaviors of others around us, can we truly understand the complexity of the system in which we live and work. The psychodynamic approach not only provides us with better self-knowledge, but this knowl- edge can also be used in our interface with other organizational actors in a way that allows us to shape, influence, and leverage organizational dynamics.
sharpen your skills with sAGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
references
Amado, G., & Vansina, L. (2005). The transitional approach in action. London: Karnac Books.
Anzieu, D. (1972). Le travail psychanalytique dans les groupes. Paris: Dunod. Anzieu, D. (1999). Le groupe et l ’inconscient. L’imaginaire groupal. Paris: Dunod. Barron, J. W., & Eagle, M. N. (Eds.). (1992). The interface of psychoanalysis and psychol-
ogy. Washington, DC: American Psychological Association. Bennis, W. G., & Thomas, R. J. (2002, September). Crucibles of leadership. Harvard
Business Review, 80(9), pp. 39–45. Bion, W. R. (1961). Experiences in groups. London: Tavistock. Bion, W. R., & Rickman, J. (1943). Intra-group tensions in therapy. Lancet, 242,
678–682. Czander, W. M. (1993). The psychodynamics of work and organizations. New York:
Guilford Press. Darwin, C. (1920). The expression of emotion in man and animals. New York: Appleton-
Century-Crofts. DeBoard, R. (1978). The psychoanalysis of organisations. London: Routledge. Diamond, M. A. (1993). The unconscious life of organizations: Interpreting organiza-
tional identity. Westport, CT: Quorum Books.
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 325
Dubouloy, M. (2004). The transitional space and self-recovery: A psychoanalytical approach to high-potential managers’ training. Human Relations, 57(4), 467–496.
Eisold, K. (2010). What you don’t know you know. New York: Other Press. Emde, R. N. (1980). Toward a psychoanalytic theory of affect: II. Emerging models
of emotional development in infancy. In S. Greenspan & G. Pollock (Eds.), The course of life: Psychoanalytic contributions toward understanding personality develop- ment. Vol. I: Infancy and early childhood (pp. 85–112). Washington, DC: U.S. Gov- ernment Printing Office.
Enriquez, E. (1992). L’Organisation en analyse. Paris: Presses Universitaires de France.
Erikson, E. H. (1950). Childhood and society. New York: Norton. Freud, S. (1953). The interpretation of dreams (first part). In J. Strachey (Ed., Trans.),
The standard edition of the complete psychological works of Sigmund Freud (Vol. IV). London: The Hogarth Press and the Institute of Psychoanalysis. (Original work published 1900)
Freud, S. (1957). On narcissism. In J. Strachey (Ed., Trans.), The standard edition of the complete psychological works of Sigmund Freud (Vol. XIV). London: The Hogarth Press and the Institute of Psychoanalysis. (Original work published 1914)
Freud, A. (1966). The ego and the mechanisms of defense. Madison, CT: International Universities Press.
Gabriel, Y. (1999). Organizations in depth. London: SAGE. Gilmore, T., & Krantz, J. (1985). Projective identification in the consulting relation-
ship: Exploring the unconscious dimensions of a client system. Human Relations 38(12), 1159–1177.
Gould, L., Stapley, L., & Stein, M. (Eds.). (2001). The systems psychodynamics of orga- nizations: Integrating the group relations, psychoanalytic, and open systems perspectives. London: Karnac Books.
Hirschhorn, L. (1988). The workplace within: Psychodynamics of organizational life. Cambridge, MA: The MIT Press.
Jaques, E. (1951). The changing culture of a factory. London: Routledge. Jaques, E. (1955). Social systems as a defense against persecutory and depressive
anxiety. In M. Klein, P. Heimann, & R. E. Money-Kyrle (Eds.), New directions in psychoanalysis. London: Tavistock.
Jaques, E. (1970). Work, creativity, and social justice. New York: International Universi- ties Press.
Kaës, R. (1993). Le groupe et le sujet du groupe. Paris: Dunod. Kagan, J. (1994). Nature of the child. New York: Basic Books. Kernberg, O. (1975). Borderline conditions and pathological narcissism. New York: Aronson. Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (1979, July/August). Managers can drive their subordinates
mad. Harvard Business Review, pp. 125–134. Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (1980). Organizational paradoxes: Clinical approaches to manage-
ment. London: Tavistock. Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (Ed.). (1984). The irrational executive: Psychoanalytic explorations
in management. New York: International Universities Press. Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (1989). Leaders who self-destruct: The causes and cures.
Organizational Dynamics 17(4), 4–17.
326 LeAdershiP Theory And PrAcTice
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (Ed.). (1991). Organizations on the couch. San Francisco: Jossey- Bass.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2001). Struggling with the demon: Perspectives on individual and organizational irrationality. Madison, WI: Psychosocial Press.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2004). Lessons on leadership by terror: Finding Shaka Zulu in the attic. London: Edgar Allen.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2005). Leadership group coaching in action: The zen of creat- ing high performance teams. Academy of Management Executive, 19(1), 61–76.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2006a). Decoding the team conundrum: The eight roles executives play. Organisational Dynamics, Fall.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2006b). The leader on the couch: A clinical approach to changing people and organizations. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2009). Reflections on leadership and character. London: Wiley.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2011a). Reflections on groups and organizations: On the couch with Manfred Kets de Vries. London: Wiley.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2011b). The hedgehog effect: The secrets of building high perfor- mance teams. London: Wiley.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (2014). Vision without action is a hallucination: Making strategy implementation a reality. INSEAD Working Paper Series.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R., & Korotov, K. (2011). Transformational leadership develop- ment programs: Creating long-term sustainable change. In S. Snook, N. Nohria, & R. Khurana (Eds.), The handbook for teaching leadership: Knowing, being, and doing. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R., & Miller, D. (1984). The neurotic organization. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R., & Miller, D. (1985). Narcissism and leadership: An object relations perspective. Human Relations, 36(6), 583–601.
Kets de Vries, M. F. R., Vrignaud, P., Agrawal, A., & Florent-Treacy, E. (2010). Development and application of the Leadership Archetype Questionnaire. Inter- national Journal of Human Resource Management, 21(15), 2846–2861.
Kohlberg, L. (1981). The philosophy of moral development. New York: Harper & Row. Kohut, H. (1971). The analysis of the self. New York: International Universities Press. Kohut, H. (1985). Self psychology and the humanities. New York: Norton. Krantz, J. (2010). The myth that binds: Psychoanalytic perspectives on a turbulent world.
London: Karnac Books. Lawrence, W. G. (1998). Social dreaming @ work. London: Karnac Books. Levinson, H. (1962). Men, management, and mental health. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press. Levinson, H. (1972). Organizational diagnosis. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University
Press. Luborsky, L., & Crits-Christoph, P. (1998). Understanding transference: The core
conflictual relationship theme method. Washington, DC: American Psychological Organization.
Maccoby, M. (1976). The gamesman: The new corporate leaders. New York: Simon & Schuster.
chapter 12 Psychodynamic Approach 327
McCullough Vaillant, L. (1997). Changing character. New York: Basic Books. McDougall, J. (1985). Theaters of the mind. New York: Basic Books. Mendel, G. (1968). La révolte contre le père. Paris: Payot. Menzies Lyth, I. (1959). The functions of social systems as a defence against anxiety:
A report on a study of the nursing service of a general hospital. Human Relations, 13, 95–121; reprinted in Containing anxiety in institutions: Selected essays (Vol. 1, pp. 43–88). Free Association Books, 1988.
Mirvis, P. (2008). Executive development through consciousness-raising experiences. Academy of Management Learning and Education, 7(2).
Mitscherlich, A. (1963). Society without the father: A contribution to social psychology. New York: Harper.
Mitscherlich, A., & Mitscherlich, M. (1975). The inability to mourn: Principles of col- lective behavior. New York: Grove Press.
Neumann, J. E., & Hirschhorn, L. (1999). The challenge of integrating psychody- namic and organizational theory. Human Relations, 52(6).
Newton, J., Long, S., & Sievers, B. (2006). Coaching in depth: The organizational role analysis approach. London: Karnac Books.
Obholzer, A., & Zagier Roberts, V. (Eds.). (1994). The unconscious at work. London: Routledge.
Oglensky, B. (1995). Socio-psychoanalytic perspectives on the subordinate. Human Relations 48(9), 1029–1054.
Piaget, J. (1952). The origins of intelligence in children. New York: International Uni- versities Press.
Pine, F. (1985). Developmental theory and clinical process. New Haven, CT: Yale Uni- versity Press.
Plutchick, R. (1980). Emotions: A psycho-evolutionary synthesis. New York: HarperCol- lins.
Stora, J. B. (2007). When the body displaces the mind: Stress, trauma and somatic disease. London: Karnac Books.
Tomkins, S. S. (1995). Script theory: Differential magnification of affect. Exploring affect: Selections from the writings of Silvan S. Tomkins (pp. 312–410). New York: Cambridge University Press.
Trist, E., & Bamforth, K. (1951). Some social and psychological consequences of the longwall method of coal getting. Human Relations, 4, 3–38.
Volkan, V. D. (1988). The need to have enemies and allies: From clinical practice to inter- national relationships. Northvale, NJ: Jason Aronson.
Westen, D. (1998). The scientific legacy of Sigmund Freud: Toward a psycho- dynamically informed psychological science. Psychological Bulletin, 124(3), 333–371.
Zaleznik, A. (1966). Human dilemmas of leadership. New York: Harper & Row. Zaleznik, A. (1989). The managerial mystique: Restoring leadership in business. New
York: Harper & Row. Zaleznik, A., & Kets de Vries, M. F. R. (1975). Power and the corporate mind. Oxford:
Houghton Mifflin.
13
Leadership Ethics
DEscription
This chapter is different from many of the other chapters in this book. Most of the other chapters focus on one unified leadership theory or approach (e.g., trait approach, path–goal theory, or transformational leader- ship), whereas this chapter is multifaceted and presents a broad set of ethi- cal viewpoints. The chapter is intended not as an “ethical leadership theory,” but rather as a guide to some of the ethical issues that arise in leadership situations.
Probably since our cave-dwelling days, human beings have been concerned with the ethics of our leaders. Our history books are replete with descrip- tions of good kings and bad kings, great empires and evil empires, and strong presidents and weak presidents. But despite a wealth of biographical accounts of great leaders and their morals, very little research has been published on the theoretical foundations of leadership ethics. There have been many stud- ies on business ethics in general since the early 1970s, but these studies have been only tangentially related to leadership ethics. Even in the literature of management, written primarily for practitioners, there are very few books on leadership ethics. This suggests that theoretical formulations in this area are still in their infancy.
One of the earliest writings that specifically focused on leadership ethics appeared as recently as 1996. It was a set of working papers generated from a small group of leadership scholars, brought together by the W. K. Kellogg Foundation. These scholars examined how leadership theory and practice could be used to build a more caring and just society. The ideas of the Kellogg group are now published in a volume titled Ethics, the Heart of Leadership (Ciulla, 1998).
Ethical Leadership
330 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Interest in the nature of ethical leadership has continued to grow, particularly because of the many recent scandals in corporate America and the political realm. On the academic front, there has also been a strong interest in exploring the nature of ethical leadership (see Aronson, 2001; Ciulla, 2001, 2003; Johnson, 2011; Kanungo, 2001; Price, 2008; Trevino, Brown, & Hartman, 2003).
Ethics Defined
From the perspective of Western tradition, the development of ethical the- ory dates back to Plato (427–347 b.c.) and Aristotle (384–322 b.c.). The word ethics has its roots in the Greek word ethos, which translates to “cus- toms,” “conduct,” or “character.” Ethics is concerned with the kinds of values and morals an individual or a society finds desirable or appropriate. Furthermore, ethics is concerned with the virtuousness of individuals and their motives. Ethical theory provides a system of rules or principles that guide us in making decisions about what is right or wrong and good or bad in a particular situation. It provides a basis for understanding what it means to be a morally decent human being.
In regard to leadership, ethics is concerned with what leaders do and who leaders are. It has to do with the nature of leaders’ behavior, and with their virtuousness. In any decision-making situation, ethical issues are either implicitly or explicitly involved. The choices leaders make and how they respond in a given circumstance are informed and directed by their ethics.
A leader’s choices are also influenced by their moral development. The most widely recognized theory advanced to explain how people think about moral issues is Kohlberg’s stages of moral development. Kohlberg (1984) presented a series of dilemmas (the most famous of which is “the Heinz dilemma”) to groups of young children who he then interviewed about the reasoning behind their choices regarding the dilemmas. From these data he created a classification system of moral reasoning that was divided into six stages: Stage 1—Obedience and Punishment, Stage 2— Individualism and Exchange, Stage 3—Interpersonal Accord and Conformity, Stage 4—Maintaining the Social Order, Stage 5—Social Contract and Individual Rights, and Stage 6—Universal Principles (see Table 13.1). Kohlberg further classified the first two stages as preconventional moral- ity, the second two as conventional morality, and the last two as postcon- ventional morality.
Ethics introduction
Chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 331
LEVEL 1: PRECONVENTIONAL MORALITY
STAGE 2STAGE 1 Obedience and Punishment
“I follow the rules so I don’t get hurt” Individualism and Exchange
“I will do a favor for you, if you do one for me”
Reasoning based on self-interest, avoiding punishment, and rewards
STAGE 4
LEVEL 2: CONVENTIONAL MORALITY
STAGE 3 Interpersonal Accord and Conformity “I try to be good and do what others
expect of me”
Maintaining the Social Order “I follow the rules and support the
laws of society”
Reasoning based on society’s views and expectations
LEVEL 3: POSTCONVENTIONAL MORALITY
STAGE 5 STAGE 6 Social Contract and Individual Rights
“I work with others to do what is best for all of us”
Universal Principles “I act out of my internalized and universal
principle of justice”
Reasoning based on conscience and creating a just society
Table 13.1 Kohlberg’s Stages of Moral Development
Level 1. Preconventional Morality
When an individual is at the preconventional morality level, he or she tends to judge the morality of an action by its direct consequences. There are two stages that fall within preconventional morality:
Stage 1—Obedience and Punishment. At this stage, the individual is egocen- tric and sees morality as external to self. Rules are fixed and handed down by authority. Obeying rules is important because it means avoiding punish- ment. For example, a child reasons it is bad to steal because the consequence will be to go to jail.
Stage 2—Individualism and Exchange. At this stage, the individual makes moral decisions based on self-interest. An action is right if it serves the individual. Everything is relative, so each person is free to do his or her own thing. People do not identify with the values of the community (Crain,
332 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
1985) but are willing to exchange favors. For example, an individual might say, “I’ll do a favor for you, if you do a favor for me.”
Level 2. conventional Morality
Those who are at this level judge the morality of actions by comparing them to society’s views and expectations. Authority is internalized but not ques- tioned, and reasoning is based on the norms of the group to which the person belongs. Kohlberg identified two stages at the conventional morality level:
Stage 3—Interpersonal Accord and Conformity. At this stage, the individual makes moral choices based on conforming to the expectations of others and trying to behave like a “good” person. It is important to be “nice” and live up to the community standard of niceness. For example, a student says, “I am not going to cheat because that is not what a good student does.”
Stage 4—Maintaining the Social Order. At this stage, the individual makes moral decisions in ways that show concern for society as a whole. In order for society to function, it is important that people obey the laws, respect authority, and support the rules of the community. For example, a person does not run a red light in the middle of the night when no other cars are around because it is important to maintain and support the traffic laws of the community.
Level 3. postconventional Morality
At this level of morality, also known as the principled level, individuals have developed their own personal set of ethics and morals that guide their behavior. Postconventional moralists live by their own ethical principles—principles that typically include such basic human rights as life, liberty, and justice. There are two stages that Kohlberg identified as part of the postconventional morality level:
Stage 5—Social Contract and Individual Rights. At this stage, the individual makes moral decisions based on a social contract and his or her views on what a good society should be like. A good society supports values such as liberty and life, and fair procedures for changing laws (Crain, 1985), but recognizes that groups have different opinions and values. Societal laws are important, but people need to agree on them. For example, if a boy is dying of cancer and his parents do not have money to pay for his treatment, the state should step in and pay for it.
Ethical dilemmas
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 333
Stage 6—Universal Principles. At this stage, the individual’s moral reasoning is based on internalized universal principles of justice that apply to everyone. Decisions that are made need to respect the viewpoints of all parties involved. People follow their internal rules of fairness, even if they conflict with laws. An example of this stage would be a civil rights activist who believes a com- mitment to justice requires a willingness to disobey unjust laws.
Kohlberg’s model of moral development has been criticized for focusing exclusively on justice values, for being sex-biased since it is derived from an all-male sample, for being culturally biased since it is based on a sample from an individualist culture, and for advocating a postconventional morality where people place their own principles above those of the law or society (Crain, 1985). Regardless of these criticisms, this model is seminal to developing an understanding of what forms the basis for individuals’ ethical leadership.
Ethical Theories
For the purposes of studying ethics and leadership, ethical theories can be thought of as falling within two broad domains: theories about leaders’ con- duct and theories about leaders’ character (Table 13.2). Stated another way, ethical theories when applied to leadership are about both the actions of leaders and who they are as people. Throughout the chapter, our discussions about ethics and leadership will always fall within one of these two domains: conduct or character.
Ethical theories that deal with the conduct of leaders are in turn divided into two kinds: theories that stress the consequences of leaders’ actions and those that emphasize the duty or rules governing leaders’ actions (see Table 13.2). Teleological theories, from the Greek word telos, meaning “ends” or “pur- poses,” try to answer questions about right and wrong by focusing on whether a person’s conduct will produce desirable consequences. From the
table 13.2 domains of Ethical Theories
conduct character
Consequences (teleological theories)
• Ethical egoism • Utilitarianism
Virtue-based theories
Duty (deontological theories)
consequences
334 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
teleological perspective, the question “What is right?” is answered by looking at results or outcomes. In effect, the consequences of an individual’s actions determine the goodness or badness of a particular behavior.
In assessing consequences, there are three different approaches to making decisions regarding moral conduct (Figure 13.1): ethical egoism, utilitarian- ism, and altruism. Ethical egoism states that a person should act so as to cre- ate the greatest good for her- or himself. A leader with this orientation would take a job or career that she or he selfishly enjoys (Avolio & Locke, 2002). Self-interest is an ethical stance closely related to transactional lead- ership theories (Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999). Ethical egoism is common in some business contexts in which a company and its employees make deci- sions to achieve its goal of maximizing profits. For example, a midlevel, upward-aspiring manager who wants her team to be the best in the company could be described as acting out of ethical egoism.
A second teleological approach, utilitarianism, states that we should behave so as to create the greatest good for the greatest number. From this viewpoint, the morally correct action is the action that maximizes social benefits while minimizing social costs (Schumann, 2001). When the U.S. government allocates a large part of the federal budget for pre- ventive health care rather than for catastrophic illnesses, it is acting from a utilitarian perspective, putting money where it will have the best result for the largest number of citizens.
Figure 13.1 Ethical Theories Based on self-interest Versus interest for others
CONCERN FOR
SELF-INTEREST
High
Medium
Low
Low Medium High
CONCERN FOR THE INTEREST OF OTHERS
• Ethical Egoism
• Utilitarianism
• Altruism
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 335
Closely related to utilitarianism, and opposite of ethical egoism, is a third teleological approach, altruism. Altruism is an approach that suggests that actions are moral if their primary purpose is to promote the best interests of others. From this perspective, a leader may be called on to act in the interests of others, even when it runs contrary to his or her own self-interests (Bowie, 1991). Authentic transformational leadership (Chapter 8) is based on altru- istic principles (Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999; Kanungo & Mendonca, 1996) and altruism is pivotal to exhibiting servant leadership (Chapter 10). The strongest example of altruist ethics can be found in the work of Mother Teresa, who devoted her life to helping the poor.
Quite different from looking at which actions will produce which outcomes, deontological theory is derived from the Greek word deos, which means “duty.” Whether a given action is ethical rests not only with its consequences (teleo- logical), but also with whether the action itself is good. Telling the truth, keep- ing promises, being fair, and respecting others are all examples of actions that are inherently good, independent of the consequences. The deontological per- spective focuses on the actions of the leader and his or her moral obligations and responsibilities to do the right thing. A leader’s actions are moral if the leader has a moral right to do them, if the actions do not infringe on others’ rights, and if the actions further the moral rights of others (Schumann, 2001).
In the late 1990s, the president of the United States, Bill Clinton, was brought before Congress for misrepresenting under oath an affair he had maintained with a White House intern. For his actions, he was impeached by the U.S. House of Representatives, but then was acquitted by the U.S. Senate. At one point during the long ordeal, the president appeared on national television and, in what is now a famous speech, declared his innocence. Because subsequent hearings provided information that suggested that he may have lied during this television speech, many Americans felt President Clinton had violated his duty and responsibility (as a person, leader, and president) to tell the truth. From a deontological perspective, it could be said that he failed his ethical responsibility to do the right thing—to tell the truth.
Whereas teleological and deontological theories approach ethics by looking at the behavior or conduct of a leader, a second set of theories approaches ethics from the viewpoint of a leader’s character (see Table 13.2). These theories are called virtue-based theories; they focus on who leaders are as people. In this perspective, virtues are rooted in the heart of the individual and in the individual’s disposition (Pojman, 1995). Furthermore, it is believed that virtues and moral abilities are not innate but can be acquired and learned through practice. People can be taught by their families and communities to be morally appropriate human beings.
approaches to Ethical Leadership
336 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
With their origin traced back in the Western tradition to the ancient Greeks and the works of Plato and Aristotle, virtue theories are experiencing a resurgence in popularity. The Greek term associated with these theories is aretaic, which means “excellence” or “virtue.” Consistent with Aristotle, cur- rent advocates of virtue-based theory stress that more attention should be given to the development and training of moral values (Velasquez, 1992). Rather than telling people what to do, attention should be directed toward telling people what to be, or helping them to become more virtuous.
What, then, are the virtues of an ethical person? There are many, all of which seem to be important. Based on the writings of Aristotle, a moral person demonstrates the virtues of courage, temperance, generosity, self-control, honesty, sociability, modesty, fairness, and justice (Velasquez, 1992). For Aristotle, virtues allowed people to live well in communities. Applying eth- ics to leadership and management, Velasquez has suggested that managers should develop virtues such as perseverance, public-spiritedness, integrity, truthfulness, fidelity, benevolence, and humility.
In essence, virtue-based ethics is about being and becoming a good, worthy human being. Although people can learn and develop good values, this the- ory maintains that virtues are present in one’s disposition. When practiced over time, from youth to adulthood, good values become habitual, and part of the people themselves. By telling the truth, people become truthful; by giving to the poor, people become benevolent; by being fair to others, people become just. Our virtues are derived from our actions, and our actions man- ifest our virtues (Frankena, 1973; Pojman, 1995).
Centrality of Ethics to Leadership
As discussed in Chapter 1, leadership is a process whereby the leader influ- ences others to reach a common goal. The influence dimension of leadership requires the leader to have an impact on the lives of those being led. To make a change in other people carries with it an enormous ethical burden and responsibility. Because leaders usually have more power and control than followers, they also have more responsibility to be sensitive to how their leadership affects followers’ lives.
Whether in group work, organizational pursuits, or community projects, leaders engage followers and utilize them in their efforts to reach common goals. In all these situations, leaders have the ethical responsibility to treat followers with dignity and respect—as human beings with unique identities. This “respect for people” demands that leaders be sensitive to followers’ own
integrity drives Growth
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 337
interests, needs, and conscientious concerns (Beauchamp & Bowie, 1988). Although all of us have an ethical responsibility to treat other people as unique human beings, leaders have a special responsibility, because the nature of their leadership puts them in a special position in which they have a greater opportunity to influence others in significant ways.
Ethics is central to leadership, and leaders help to establish and reinforce organizational values. Every leader has a distinct philosophy and point of view. “All leaders have an agenda, a series of beliefs, proposals, values, ideas, and issues that they wish to ‘put on the table’” (Gini, 1998, p. 36). The values promoted by the leader have a significant impact on the values exhibited by the organization (see Carlson & Perrewe, 1995; Schminke, Ambrose, & Noel, 1997; Trevino, 1986). Again, because of their influence, leaders play a major role in establishing the ethical climate of their organizations.
In short, ethics is central to leadership because of the nature of the process of influence, the need to engage followers in accomplishing mutual goals, and the impact leaders have on the organization’s values.
The following section provides a discussion of some of the work of promi- nent leadership scholars who have addressed issues related to ethics and leadership. Although many additional viewpoints exist, those presented are representative of the predominant thinking in the area of ethics and leader- ship today.
Heifetz’s Perspective on Ethical Leadership
Based on his work as a psychiatrist and his observations and analysis of many world leaders (e.g., President Lyndon Johnson, Mohandas Gandhi, and Margaret Sanger), Ronald Heifetz (1994) has formulated a unique approach to ethical leadership. His approach emphasizes how leaders help followers to confront conflict and to address conflict by effecting changes. Heifetz’s perspective is related to ethical leadership because it deals with values: the values of workers and the values of the organizations and communities in which they work. According to Heifetz, leadership involves the use of authority to help followers deal with the conflicting values that emerge in rapidly changing work environments and social cultures. It is an ethical per- spective because it speaks directly to the values of workers.
For Heifetz (1994), leaders must use authority to mobilize people to face tough issues. As was discussed in the chapter on adaptive leadership (Chapter 11), it is up to the leader to provide a “holding environment” in
Ethical norms
338 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
which there is trust, nurturance, and empathy. In a supportive context, followers can feel safe to confront hard problems. Specifically, leaders use authority to get people to pay attention to the issues, to act as a reality test regarding information, to manage and frame issues, to orchestrate con- flicting perspectives, and to facilitate decision making (Heifetz, 1994, p. 113). The leader’s duties are to assist the follower in struggling with change and personal growth.
Burns’s Perspective on Ethical Leadership
As discussed in Chapter 8, Burns’s theory of transformational leadership places a strong emphasis on followers’ needs, values, and morals. Transformational leadership involves attempts by leaders to move fol- lowers to higher standards of moral responsibility. This emphasis sets transformational leadership apart from most other approaches to leader- ship because it clearly states that leadership has a moral dimension (see Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999).
Similar to that of Heifetz, Burns’s (1978) perspective argues that it is impor- tant for leaders to engage themselves with followers and help them in their personal struggles regarding conflicting values. The resulting connection raises the level of morality in both the leader and the follower.
The origins of Burns’s position on leadership ethics are rooted in the works of such writers as Abraham Maslow, Milton Rokeach, and Lawrence Kohlberg (Ciulla, 1998). The influence of these writers can be seen in how Burns emphasizes the leader’s role in attending to the personal motivations and moral development of the follower. For Burns, it is the responsibility of the leader to help followers assess their own values and needs in order to raise them to a higher level of functioning, to a level that will stress values such as liberty, justice, and equality (Ciulla, 1998).
Burns’s position on leadership as a morally uplifting process has not been without its critics. It has raised many questions: How do you choose what a better set of moral values is? Who is to say that some decisions represent higher moral ground than others? If leadership, by definition, entails raising individual moral functioning, does this mean that the leadership of corrupt leaders is not actually leadership? Notwithstanding these very legitimate questions, Burns’s perspective is unique in that it makes ethics the central characteristic of the leadership process. His writing has placed ethics at the forefront of scholarly discussions of what leadership means and how leader- ship should be carried out.
Teaching Ethical Leadership
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 339
The Dark Side of Leadership
Although Burns (1978) placed ethics at the core of leadership, there still exists a dark side of leadership that exemplifies leadership that is unethical and destructive. It is what we defined in Chapter 8 (“Transformational Leadership”) as pseudotransformational leadership. The dark side of leadership is the destructive and toxic side of leadership in that a leader uses leadership for personal ends. Lipman-Blumen (2005) suggests that toxic leaders are characterized by destructive behaviors such as leaving their followers worse off than they found them, violating the basic human rights of others, and playing to their basest fears. Furthermore, Lipman-Blumen identifies many dysfunctional personal characteristics destructive leaders demonstrate including lack of integrity, insatiable ambition, arrogance, and reckless dis- regard for their actions. The same characteristics and behaviors that distin- guish leaders as special can also be used by leaders to produce disastrous outcomes (Conger, 1990). Because researchers have been focused on the positive attributes and outcomes of effective leadership, until recently, there has been little attention paid to the dark side of leadership. Nevertheless, it is important to understand that it exists.
In a meta-analysis of 57 studies of destructive leadership and its outcomes, Schyns and Schilling (2013) found a strong relationship between destructive leadership and negative attitudes in followers toward the leader. Destructive leadership is also negatively related to followers’ attitudes toward their jobs and toward their organization as a whole. Furthermore, Schyns and Schilling found it closely related to negative affectivity and to the experience of occu- pational stress.
In an attempt to more clearly define destructive leadership, Padilla, Hogan, and Kaiser (2007) developed the concept of a toxic triangle that focuses on the influences of destructive leaders, susceptible followers, and conducive environments (see Figure 13.2). As shown in the model, destructive leaders are characterized by having charisma and a need to use power and coercion for personal gains. They are also narcissistic and often attention-getting and self-absorbed. Destructive leaders often have negative life stories that can be traced to traumatic childhood events. Perhaps from self-hatred, they often express an ideology of hate in their rhetoric and worldview.
As illustrated in Figure 13.2, destructive leadership also incorporates suscep- tible followers who have been characterized as conformers and colluders. Conformers go along with destructive leaders to satisfy unmet needs such as emptiness, alienation, or need for community. These followers have low self- esteem and identify with charismatic leaders in an attempt to become more
The dark side of Leadership
340 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
desirable. Because they are psychologically immature, conformers more eas- ily go along with authority and engage in destructive activity. On the other hand, colluders may respond to destructive leaders because they are ambitious, desire status, or see an opportunity to profit. Colluders may also go along because they identify with the leader’s beliefs and values, which may be unsocialized such as greed and selfishness.
Finally, the toxic triangle illustrates that destructive leadership includes a conducive environment. When the environment is unstable, the leader is often granted more authority to assert radical change. When there is a perceived threat, followers often accept assertive leadership. People are attracted to leaders who will stand up to the threats they feel in the environment. Destructive leaders who express compatible cultural values with followers are more likely to succeed. For example, cultures high on collectiveness would prefer a leader who promotes community and group identity. Destructive
Figure 13.2 The Toxic Triangle
• Charisma • Personalized power
• Narcissism • Negative life themes
• Ideology of hate
• Unmet needs • Low core self- evaluations • Low maturity
• Ambition • Similar world- view • Bad values
• Instability • Perceived threat • Cultural values
• Lack of checks and balances and ineffective
institutions
Destructive Leaders
Susceptible Followers
Conducive Environments
Conformers Colluders
soUrcE: padilla, a., hogan, r., & Kaiser, r. B. (2007). The toxic triangle: destructive leaders, susceptible followers, and conducive environments. The Leadership Quarterly, 18, 180.
opportunism and Ethics
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 341
leadership will also thrive when the checks and balances of the organization are weak and the rules of the institution are ineffective.
Although research on the dark side of leadership has been limited, it is an area critical to our understanding of leadership that is unethical. Clearly, there is a need for the development of models, theories, and assessment instruments about the process of destructive leadership.
Principles of Ethical Leadership
In this section, we turn to a discussion of five principles of ethical leadership, the origins of which can be traced back to Aristotle. The importance of these principles has been discussed in a variety of disciplines, including biomedical ethics (Beauchamp & Childress, 1994), business ethics (Beauchamp & Bowie, 1988), counseling psychology (Kitchener, 1984), and leadership edu- cation (Komives, Lucas, & McMahon, 1998), to name a few. Although not inclusive, these principles provide a foundation for the development of sound ethical leadership: respect, service, justice, honesty, and community (Figure 13.3).
Ethical Leaders respect others
Philosopher Immanuel Kant (1724–1804) argued that it is our duty to treat others with respect. To do so means always to treat others as ends in
Figure 13.3 principles of Ethical Leadership
ETHICAL LEADERSHIP
Respects Others
Builds Community
Shows Justice
Serves Others
Manifests Honesty
practical Ethical Theory
342 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
themselves and never as means to ends. As Beauchamp and Bowie (1988, p. 37) pointed out, “Persons must be treated as having their own autono- mously established goals and must never be treated purely as the means to another’s personal goals.” These writers then suggested that treating others as ends rather than as means requires that we treat other people’s decisions and values with respect: Failing to do so would signify that we were treat- ing them as a means to our own ends.
Leaders who respect others also allow them to be themselves, with creative wants and desires. They approach other people with a sense of their uncon- ditional worth and valuable individual differences (Kitchener, 1984). Respect includes giving credence to others’ ideas and confirming them as human beings. At times, it may require that leaders defer to others. As Burns (1978) suggested, leaders should nurture followers in becoming aware of their own needs, values, and purposes, and assist followers in integrating these with the leader’s needs, values, and purposes.
Respect for others is a complex ethic that is similar to but goes deeper than the kind of respect that parents teach little children. Respect means that a leader listens closely to followers, is empathic, and is tolerant of opposing points of view. It means treating followers in ways that confirm their beliefs, attitudes, and values. When a leader exhibits respect to followers, followers can feel competent about their work. In short, leaders who show respect treat others as worthy human beings.
Ethical Leaders serve others
Earlier in this chapter, we contrasted two ethical theories, one based on a concern for self (ethical egoism) and another based on the interests of others (ethical altruism). The service principle clearly is an example of altruism. Leaders who serve are altruistic: They place their followers’ welfare foremost in their plans. In the workplace, altruistic service behavior can be observed in activities such as mentoring, empowerment behaviors, team building, and citizenship behaviors, to name a few (Kanungo & Mendonca, 1996).
The leader’s ethical responsibility to serve others is very similar to the ethical principle in health care of beneficence. Beneficence is derived from the Hippocratic tradition, which holds that health professionals ought to make choices that benefit patients. In a general way, beneficence asserts that pro- viders have a duty to help others pursue their own legitimate interests and goals (Beauchamp & Childress, 1994). Like health professionals, ethical
Ethical school Leadership
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 343
leaders have a responsibility to attend to others, be of service to them, and make decisions pertaining to them that are beneficial and not harmful to their welfare.
In the past decade, the service principle has received a great deal of empha- sis in the leadership literature. It is clearly evident in the writings of Block (1993), Covey (1990), De Pree (1989), Gilligan (1982), and Kouzes and Posner (1995), all of whom maintained that attending to others is the pri- mary building block of moral leadership. Further emphasis on service can be observed in the work of Senge (1990) in his well-recognized writing on learning organizations. Senge contended that one of the important tasks of leaders in learning organizations is to be the steward (servant) of the vision within the organization. Being a steward means clarifying and nurturing a vision that is greater than oneself. This means not being self-centered, but rather integrating one’s self or vision with that of others in the organization. Effective leaders see their own personal vision as an important part of something larger than themselves—a part of the organization and the community at large.
The idea of leaders serving others was more deeply explored by Robert Greenleaf (1970, 1977), who developed the servant leadership approach. Servant leadership, which is explored in depth in Chapter 10, has strong altruistic ethical overtones in how it emphasizes that leaders should be attentive to the concerns of their followers and should take care of them and nurture them. In addition, Greenleaf argues that the servant leader has a social responsibility to be concerned with the have-nots and should strive to remove inequalities and social injustices. Greenleaf places a great deal of emphasis on listening, empathy, and unconditional acceptance of others.
In short, whether it is Greenleaf ’s notion of waiting on the have-nots or Senge’s notion of giving oneself to a larger purpose, the idea behind service is contributing to the greater good of others. Recently, the idea of serving the “greater good” has found an unusual following in the business world. In 2009, 20% of the graduating class of the Harvard Business School, consid- ered to be one of the premier schools producing today’s business leaders, took an oath pledging that they will act responsibly and ethically, and refrain from advancing their own ambitions at the expense of others. Similarly, Columbia Business School requires all students to pledge to an honor code requiring they adhere to truth, integrity, and respect (Wayne, 2009). In prac- ticing the principle of service, these and other ethical leaders must be willing to be follower centered, must place others’ interests foremost in their work, and must act in ways that will benefit others.
344 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Ethical Leaders Are Just
Ethical leaders are concerned about issues of fairness and justice. They make it a top priority to treat all of their followers in an equal manner. Justice demands that leaders place issues of fairness at the center of their decision making. As a rule, no one should receive special treatment or special consid- eration except when his or her particular situation demands it. When indi- viduals are treated differently, the grounds for different treatment must be clear and reasonable, and must be based on moral values.
For example, many of us can remember being involved with some type of athletic team when we were growing up. The coaches we liked were those we thought were fair with us. No matter what, we did not want the coach to treat anyone differently from the rest. When someone came late to practice with a poor excuse, we wanted that person disciplined just as we would have been disciplined. If a player had a personal problem and needed a break, we wanted the coach to give it, just as we would have been given a break. Without question, the good coaches were those who never had favorites and who made a point of playing everyone on the team. In essence, what we wanted was that our coach be fair and just.
When resources and rewards or punishments are distributed to employees, the leader plays a major role. The rules that are used and how they are applied say a great deal about whether the leader is concerned about justice and how he or she approaches issues of fairness.
Rawls (1971) stated that a concern with issues of fairness is necessary for all people who are cooperating together to promote their common interests. It is similar to the ethic of reciprocity, otherwise known as the Golden Rule— “Do unto others as you would have them do unto you”—variations of which have appeared in many different cultures throughout the ages. If we expect fairness from others in how they treat us, then we should treat others fairly in our dealings with them. Issues of fairness become problematic because there is always a limit on goods and resources, and there is often competition for the limited things available. Because of the real or perceived scarcity of resources, conflicts often occur between individuals about fair methods of distribution. It is important for leaders to clearly establish the rules for dis- tributing rewards. The nature of these rules says a lot about the ethical underpinnings of the leader and the organization.
Beauchamp and Bowie (1988) outlined several of the common principles that serve as guides for leaders in distributing the benefits and burdens fairly in an organization (Table 13.3). Although not inclusive, these principles point to the reasoning behind why leaders choose to distribute things as they
Ethics in Management Ethics in nursing
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 345
do in organizations. In a given situation, a leader may use a single principle or a combination of several principles in treating followers.
To illustrate the principles described in Table 13.3, consider the following hypothetical example: You are the owner of a small trucking company that employs 50 drivers. You have just opened a new route, and it promises to be one that pays well and has an ideal schedule. Only one driver can be assigned to the route, but seven drivers have applied for it. Each driver wants an equal opportunity to get the route. One of the drivers recently lost his wife to breast cancer and is struggling to care for three young children (individual need). Two of the drivers are minorities, and one of them feels strongly that he has a right to the job. One of the drivers has logged more driving hours for three consecutive years, and she feels her effort makes her the logical candidate for the new route. One of the drivers serves on the National Transportation Safety Board and has a 20-year accident-free driving record (societal contri- bution). Two drivers have been with the company since its inception, and their performance has been meritorious year after year.
As the owner of the company, your challenge is to assign the new route in a fair way. Although many other factors could influence your decision (e.g., seniority, wage rate, or employee health), the principles described in Table 13.3 provide guidelines for deciding who is to get the new route.
table 13.3 principles of distributive Justice
These principles are applied in different situations.
To each person
• An equal share or opportunity • According to individual need • According to that person’s rights • According to individual effort • According to societal contribution • According to merit or performance
Ethical Leaders Are Honest
When we were children, grown-ups often told us we must “never tell a lie.” To be good meant we must be truthful. For leaders the lesson is the same: To be a good leader, one must be honest.
The importance of being honest can be understood more clearly when we consider the opposite of honesty: dishonesty (see Jaksa & Pritchard, 1988). Dishonesty is a form of lying, a way of misrepresenting reality. Dishonesty may bring with it many objectionable outcomes; foremost among those outcomes
developing Leadership character
346 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
is the distrust it creates. When leaders are not honest, others come to see them as undependable and unreliable. People lose faith in what leaders say and stand for, and their respect for leaders is diminished. As a result, the leader’s impact is compromised because others no longer trust and believe in the leader.
When we relate to others, dishonesty also has a negative impact. It puts a strain on how people are connected to each other. When we lie to others, we are in essence saying that we are willing to manipulate the relationship on our own terms. We are saying that we do not trust the other person in the relationship to be able to deal with information we have. In reality, we are putting ourselves ahead of the relationship by saying that we know what is best for the relationship. The long-term effect of this type of behavior is that it weakens relationships. Even when used with good intentions, dishonesty contributes to the breakdown of relationships.
But being honest is not just about telling the truth. It has to do with being open with others and representing reality as fully and completely as possible. This is not an easy task, however, because there are times when telling the complete truth can be destructive or counterproductive. The challenge for leaders is to strike a balance between being open and candid while monitor- ing what is appropriate to disclose in a particular situation. Many times, there are organizational constraints that prevent leaders from disclosing information to followers. It is important for leaders to be authentic, but it is also essential that they be sensitive to the attitudes and feelings of others. Honest leadership involves a wide set of behaviors.
Dalla Costa (1998) made the point clearly in his book, The Ethical Imperative, that being honest means more than not deceiving. For leaders in organiza- tions, being honest means, “Do not promise what you can’t deliver, do not misrepresent, do not hide behind spin-doctored evasions, do not suppress obligations, do not evade accountability, do not accept that the ‘survival of the fittest’ pressures of business release any of us from the responsibility to respect another’s dignity and humanity” (p. 164). In addition, Dalla Costa suggested that it is imperative that organizations recognize and acknowledge the necessity of honesty and reward honest behavior within the organization.
Ethical Leaders Build community
In Chapter 1, we defined leadership as a process whereby an individual influ- ences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal. This definition has a clear ethical dimension because it refers to a common goal. A common goal requires that the leader and followers agree on the direction to be taken by
Group Ethical Voice
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 347
the group. Leaders need to take into account their own and followers’ purposes while working toward goals that are suitable for both of them. This factor, concern for others, is the distinctive feature that delineates authentic transformational leaders from pseudotransformational leaders (Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999) (for more on pseudotransformational leadership see page 163 in Chapter 8). Concern for the common good means that leaders cannot impose their will on others. They need to search for goals that are compat- ible with everyone.
Burns (1978) placed this idea at the center of his theory on transformational leadership. A transformational leader tries to move the group toward a com- mon good that is beneficial for both the leaders and the followers. In moving toward mutual goals, both the leader and the followers are changed. It is this feature that makes Burns’s theory unique. For Burns, leadership has to be grounded in the leader–follower relationship. It cannot be controlled by the leader, such as Hitler’s influence in Germany. Hitler coerced people to meet his own agenda and followed goals that did not advance the goodness of humankind.
An ethical leader takes into account the purposes of everyone involved in the group and is attentive to the interests of the community and the culture. Such a leader demonstrates an ethic of caring toward others (Gilligan, 1982) and does not force others or ignore the intentions of others (Bass & Steidlmeier, 1999).
Rost (1991) went a step farther and suggested that ethical leadership demands attention to a civic virtue. By this, he meant that leaders and fol- lowers need to attend to more than their own mutually determined goals. They need to attend to the community’s goals and purpose. As Burns (1978, p. 429) wrote, transformational leaders and followers begin to reach out to wider social collectivities and seek to establish higher and broader moral purposes. Similarly, Greenleaf (1970) argued that building community was a main characteristic of servant leadership. All of our individual and group goals are bound up in the common good and public interest. We need to pay attention to how the changes proposed by a leader and followers will affect the larger organization, the community, and society. An ethical leader is concerned with the common good, in the broadest sense.
strEngtHs
This chapter discusses a broad set of ideas regarding ethics and leadership. This general field of study has several strengths. First, it provides a body
Ethical role of Management
348 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
of timely research on ethical issues. There is a high demand for moral leadership in our society today. Beginning with the Nixon administration in the 1970s and continuing through Barack Obama’s administration, people have been insisting on higher levels of moral responsibility from their leaders. At a time when there seems to be a vacuum in ethical lead- ership, this research offers us some direction on how to think about and practice ethical leadership.
Second, this body of research suggests that ethics ought to be considered as an integral part of the broader domain of leadership. Except for servant, transfor- mational, and authentic leadership, none of the other leadership theories dis- cussed in this book includes ethics as a dimension of the leadership process. This chapter suggests that leadership is not an amoral phenomenon. Leadership is a process of influencing others; it has a moral dimension that distinguishes it from other types of influence, such as coercion or despotic control. Leadership involves values, including showing respect for followers, being fair to others, and building community. It is not a process that we can demonstrate without show- ing our values. When we influence, we have an effect on others, which means we need to pay attention to our values and our ethics.
Third, this body of research highlights several principles that are important to the development of ethical leadership. The virtues discussed in this research have been around for more than 2,000 years. They are reviewed in this chapter because of their significance for today’s leaders.
criticisMs
Although the area of ethics and leadership has many strengths, it also has some weaknesses. First, it is an area of research in its early stage of develop- ment, and therefore lacks a strong body of traditional research findings to substantiate it. As was pointed out at the beginning of the chapter, very little research has been published on the theoretical foundations of leader- ship ethics. Although many studies have been published on business ethics, these studies have not been directly related to ethical leadership. The dearth of research on leadership ethics makes speculation about the nature of ethical leadership difficult. Until more research studies have been con- ducted that deal directly with the ethical dimensions of leadership, theo- retical formulations about the process will remain tentative.
Another criticism is that leadership ethics today relies primarily on the writings of just a few people who have written essays and texts that are
Ethical issues in nursing
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 349
strongly influenced by their personal opinions about the nature of leadership ethics and their view of the world. Although these writings, such as Heifetz’s and Burns’s, have stood the test of time, they have not been tested using traditional quantitative or qualitative research methods. They are primarily descriptive and anecdotal. Therefore, leadership ethics lacks the traditional kind of empirical support that usually accompanies accepted theories of human behavior.
AppLicAtion
Although issues of morality and leadership are discussed more often in society today, these discussions have not resulted in a large number of pro- grams in training and development designed to teach ethical leadership. Many new programs are oriented toward helping managers become more effective at work and in life in general, but these programs do not directly target the area of ethics and leadership.
Yet the ethics and leadership research in this chapter can be applied to peo- ple at all levels of organizations and in all walks of life. At a very minimum, it is crucial to state that leadership involves values, and one cannot be a leader without being aware of and concerned about one’s own values. Because lead- ership has a moral dimension, being a leader demands awareness on our part of the way our ethics defines our leadership.
Managers and leaders can use the information in this research to better understand themselves and strengthen their own leadership. Ethical theories can remind leaders to ask themselves, “What is the right and fair thing to do?” or “What would a good person do?” Leaders can use the ethical principles described in this research as benchmarks for their own behavior. Do I show respect to others? Do I act with a generous spirit? Do I show honesty and faithfulness to others? Do I serve the community? Finally, we can learn from the overriding theme in this research that the leader–follower relationship is central to ethical leadership. To be an ethical leader, we must be sensitive to the needs of others, treat others in ways that are just, and care for others.
cAsE stUDiEs
The following section contains three case studies (Cases 13.1, 13.2, and 13.3) in which ethical leadership is needed. Case 13.1 describes a department chair
Ethical case study
350 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
who must choose which student will get a special assignment. Case 13.2 is concerned with one manufacturing company’s unique approach to safety standards. Case 13.3 deals with the ethical issues surrounding how a human resource service company established the pricing for its services. At the end of each case, there are questions that point to the intricacies and complexities of practicing ethical leadership.
Case 13.1
choosing a research Assistant
dr. angi dirks is the chair of the state university’s organizational psychol- ogy department, which has four teaching assistants (Tas). angi has just found out that she has received a grant for research work over the sum- mer and that it includes money to fund one of the Tas as her research assistant. in angi’s mind, the top two candidates are roberto and Michelle, who are both available to work over the summer. roberto, a foreign student from Venezuela, has gotten very high teaching evalua- tions and is well liked by the faculty. roberto needs a summer job to help pay for school since it is too expensive for him to return home for the summer to work. Michelle is also an exceptional graduate student; she is married and doesn’t necessarily need the extra income, but she is going to pursue a phd, so the extra experience would be beneficial to her future endeavors.
a third teaching assistant, carson, commutes to school from a town an hour away, where he is helping to take care of his aging grandparents. carson manages to juggle school, teaching, and his home responsibilities well, carrying a 4.0 Gpa in his classwork. angi knows carson could use the money, but she is afraid that he has too many other responsibilities to take on the research project over the summer.
as angi weighs which Ta to offer the position, a faculty member approaches her about considering the fourth Ta, analisa. it’s been a tough year with analisa as a Ta. she has complained numerous times to her faculty mentor and to angi that the other Tas treat her differently, and she thinks it’s because of her race. The student newspaper printed a column she wrote about “being a speck of brown in a campus of white,” in which she expressed her frustration with the predominantly white faculty’s inability to understand the unique perspectives and experiences of minority students. after the column came out, the faculty in the department became wary of working with analisa, fearing becoming part of the controversy. Their lack of interaction with her made analisa feel further alienated.
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 351
angi knows that analisa is a very good researcher and writer, and her skills would be an asset to the project. analisa’s faculty mentor says that giving the position to her would go a long way to “smooth things over” between faculty and analisa and make analisa feel included in the department. analisa knows about the open position and has expressed interest in it to her faculty mentor, but hasn’t directly talked to angi. angi is afraid that by not giving it to analisa, she may stir up more accu- sations of ill treatment while at the same time facing accusations from others that she is giving analisa preferential treatment.
1. of the four options available to angi, which is the most ethical?
2. Using the principles of distributive justice, who would angi choose to become the research assistant?
3. From heifetz’s perspective, can angi use this decision to help her department and faculty face a difficult situation? should she?
4. do you agree with Burns’s perspective that it is angi’s responsibility to help followers assess their own values and needs in order to raise them to a higher level that will stress values such as liberty, justice, and equality? if so, how can angi do that through this situation?
Case 13.2
How safe is safe?
perfect plastics incorporated (ppi) is a small injection molding plastics com- pany that employs 50 people. The company is 10 years old, has a healthy balance sheet, and does about $4 million a year in sales. The company has a good safety record, and the insurance company that has ppi’s liability policy has not had to pay any claims to employees for several years. There have been no major injuries of any kind since the company began.
Tom Griffin, the owner, takes great pride in the interior design and work- ing conditions at ppi. he describes the interior of the plant as being like a hospital compared with his competitors. order, efficiency, and cleanli- ness are top priorities at ppi. it is a remarkably well-organized manufac- turing company.
ppi has a unique approach to guaranteeing safe working conditions. Each year, management brings in outside consultants from the insurance indus- try and the occupational safety and health administration (osha) to audit
(Continued)
352 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
the plant for unsafe conditions. Each year, the inspections reveal a variety of concerns, which are then addressed through new equipment, repairs, and changed work-flow designs. although the inspectors continue to find opportunities for improvement, the overall safety improves each year.
The attorneys for ppi are very opposed to the company’s approach to safety. The lawyers are vehemently against the procedure of having out- side auditors. if a lawsuit were to be brought against ppi, the attorneys argue that any previous issues could be used as evidence of a historical pattern and knowledge of unsafe conditions. in effect, the audits that ppi conducts voluntarily could be used by plaintiffs to strengthen a case against the company.
The president and management recognize the potential downside of outside audits, but they point out that the periodic reviews are critical to the ongoing improvement of the safety of everyone in the plant. The purpose of the audits is to make the shop a secure place, and that is what has occurred. Management also points out that ppi employees have responded positively to the audits and to the changes that result.
Questions
1. as a company, would you describe ppi as having an identifiable philoso- phy of moral values? how do its policies contribute to this philosophy?
2. Which ethical perspective best describes ppi’s approach to safety issues? Would you say ppi takes a utilitarian-, duty-, or virtue-based approach?
3. regarding safety issues, how does management see its responsibilities toward its employees? how do the attorneys see their responsibilities toward ppi?
4. Why does it appear that the ethics of ppi and its attorneys are in conflict?
(continued)
Case 13.3
reexamining a proposal
after working 10 years as the only minority manager in a large printing company, david Jones decided he wanted to set out on his own. Because
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 353
of his experience and prior connections, david was confident he could survive in the printing business, but he wondered whether he should buy an existing business or start a new one. as part of his planning, david contacted a professional employer organization (pEo), which had a ster- ling reputation, to obtain an estimate for human resource services for a startup company. The estimate was to include costs for payroll, benefits, workers’ compensation, and other traditional human resource services. Because david had not yet started his business, the pEo generated a generic quote applicable to a small company in the printing industry. in addition, because the pEo had nothing tangible to quote, it gave david a quote for human resource services that was unusually high.
in the meantime, david found an existing small company that he liked, and he bought it. Then he contacted the pEo to sign a contract for human resource services at the previously quoted price. david was ready to take ownership and begin his new venture. he signed the original contract as presented.
after david signed the contract, the pEo reviewed the earlier proposal in light of the actual figures of the company he had purchased. This review raised many concerns for management. although the goals of the pEo were to provide high-quality service, be competitive in the marketplace, and make a reasonable profit, the quote it had provided david appeared to be much too high. it was not comparable in any way with the other service contracts the pEo had with other companies of similar size and function.
during the review, it became apparent that several concerns had to be addressed. First, the original estimate made the pEo appear as if it was gouging the client. although the client had signed the original contract, was it fair to charge such a high price for the proposed services? Would charging such high fees mean that the pEo would lose this client or similar clients in the future? another concern was related to the pEo’s support of minority businesses. For years, the pEo had prided itself on having strong values about affirmative action and fairness in the work- place, but this contract appeared to actually hurt and to be somewhat unfair to a minority client. Finally, the pEo was concerned with the implications of the contract for the salesperson who drew up the pro- posal for david. changing the estimated costs in the proposal would have a significant impact on the salesperson’s commission, which would negatively affect the morale of others in the pEo’s sales area.
after a reexamination of the original proposal, a new contract was drawn up for david’s company with lower estimated costs. Though lower than the original proposal, the new contract remained much higher than the average contract in the printing industry. david willingly signed the new contract.
(Continued)
354 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Questions
1. What role should ethics play in the writing of a proposal such as this? did the pEo do the ethical thing for david? how much money should the pEo have tried to make? What would you have done if you were part of management at the pEo?
2. From a deontological (duty) perspective and a teleological (conse- quences) perspective, how would you describe the ethics of the pEo?
3. Based on what the pEo did for david, how would you evaluate the pEo on the ethical principles of respect, service, justice, honesty, and community?
4. how would you assess the ethics of the pEo if you were david? if you were among the pEo management? if you were the salesperson? if you were a member of the printing community?
(continued)
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 355
LEADErsHip instrUMEnt
Ethics and morals often are regarded as very personal, and we resist having others judge us about them. We also resist judging others. Perhaps for this reason, very few questionnaires have been designed to measure ethical leader- ship. To address this problem, Craig and Gustafson (1998) developed the Perceived Leader Integrity Scale (PLIS), which is based on utilitarian ethical theory. The PLIS attempts to evaluate leaders’ ethics by measuring the degree to which coworkers see them as acting in accordance with rules that would produce the greatest good for the greatest number of people. Craig and Gustafson found PLIS ratings to be strongly and positively related to subor- dinates’ job satisfaction, and negatively related to their desire to quit their jobs.
Parry and Proctor-Thomson (2002) used the PLIS in a study of 1,354 manag- ers and found that perceived integrity was positively related to transformational leadership. Leaders who were seen as transformational were also seen as having more integrity. In addition, the researchers found that perceived integrity was positively correlated with leader and organizational effectiveness.
By taking the PLIS, you can try to assess the ethical integrity of a leader you know, such as a supervisor or leader of a group or organization of which you are a member. At the same time, the PLIS will allow you to apply the ideas we discussed in the chapter to a real-world setting. By focusing on observers’ impressions, the PLIS represents one way to assess the principle of ethical leadership.
In addition, the PLIS can be used for feedback to employees in organizations and as a part of leadership training and development. Finally, if used as part of an organizational climate survey, the PLIS could be useful as a way of identifying areas in an organization that may need an ethics intervention (Craig & Gustafson, 1998).
356 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
perceived Leader integrity scale (pLis)
Instructions: The following items concern your perceptions of another person’s behavior. circle responses to indicate how well each item describes the person you are rating.
Key: 1 = not at all 2 = Barely 3 = somewhat 4 = Well
1. puts his or her personal interests ahead of the 1 2 3 4 organization
2. Would risk other people to protect himself or herself 1 2 3 4 in work matters
3. Enjoys turning down requests 1 2 3 4
4. deliberately fuels conflict between other people 1 2 3 4
5. Would blackmail an employee if she or he thought she 1 2 3 4 or he could get away with it
6. Would deliberately exaggerate people’s mistakes to 1 2 3 4 make them look bad to others
7. Would treat some people better if they were of the other 1 2 3 4 sex or belonged to a different ethnic group
8. ridicules people for their mistakes 1 2 3 4
9. can be trusted with confidential information 1 2 3 4
10. Would lie to me 1 2 3 4
11. is evil 1 2 3 4
12. is not interested in tasks that don’t bring personal 1 2 3 4 glory or recognition
13. Would do things that violate organizational policy and 1 2 3 4 then expect others to cover for him or her
14. Would allow someone else to be blamed for 1 2 3 4 his or her mistake
15. Would deliberately avoid responding to email, telephone, 1 2 3 4 or other messages to cause problems for someone else
16. Would make trouble for someone who got on his 1 2 3 4 or her bad side
17. Would engage in sabotage against the organization 1 2 3 4
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 357
18. Would deliberately distort what other people say 1 2 3 4
19. is a hypocrite 1 2 3 4
20. is vindictive 1 2 3 4
21. Would try to take credit for other people’s ideas 1 2 3 4
22. Likes to bend the rules 1 2 3 4
23. Would withhold information or constructive feedback 1 2 3 4 because he or she wants someone to fail
24. Would spread rumors or gossip to try to hurt people 1 2 3 4 or the organization
25. is rude or uncivil to coworkers 1 2 3 4
26. Would try to hurt someone’s career because of a grudge 1 2 3 4
27. shows unfair favoritism toward some people 1 2 3 4
28. Would steal from the organization 1 2 3 4
29. Would falsify records if it would help his 1 2 3 4 or her work situation
30. has high moral standards 1 2 3 4
soUrcE: adapted from a version of the pLis that appeared in Leadership Quarterly, 9(2), s. B. craig and s. B. Gustafson, “perceived Leader integrity scale: an instrument for assessing Employee perceptions of Leader integrity,” pp. 143–144, 1998. Used with permission of the authors.
scoring
The pLis measures your perceptions of another person’s integrity in an organ- izational setting. your responses on the pLis indicate the degree to which you see that person’s behavior as ethical.
score the questionnaire by doing the following. First, reverse the scores on items 9 and 30 (i.e., 1 becomes 4, 2 becomes 3, 3 becomes 2, and 4 becomes 1). next, sum the responses on all 30 items. a low score on the questionnaire indicates that you perceive the person you evaluated to be highly ethical. a high score indicates that you perceive that person to be very unethical. The interpretation of what the score represents follows.
358 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
scoring interpretation
your score is a measure of your perceptions of another person’s ethical integ- rity. Based on previous findings (craig & Gustafson, 1998), the following inter- pretations can be made about your total score:
• 30–32 high ethical: if your score is in this range, it means that you see the person you evaluated as highly ethical. your impression is that the person is very trustworthy and principled.
• 33–45 Moderate ethical: scores in this range mean that you see the person as moderately ethical. your impression is that the person might engage in some unethical behaviors under certain conditions.
• 46–120 Low ethical: scores in this range describe people who are seen as very unethical. your impression is that the person you evaluated does things that are dishonest, unfair, and unprincipled almost any time he or she has the opportunity.
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 359
sUMMAry
Although there has been an interest in ethics for thousands of years, very little theoretical research exists on the nature of leadership ethics. This chapter has presented an overview of ethical theories as they apply to the leadership process.
Ethical theory provides a set of principles that guide leaders in making deci- sions about how to act and how to be morally decent. In the Western tradi- tion, ethical theories typically are divided into two kinds: theories about conduct and theories about character. Theories about conduct emphasize the consequences of leader behavior (teleological approach) or the rules that govern their behavior (deontological approach). Virtue-based theories focus on the character of leaders, and they stress qualities such as courage, honesty, fairness, and fidelity.
Ethics plays a central role in the leadership process. Because leadership involves influence and leaders often have more power than followers, they have an enormous ethical responsibility for how they affect other people. Leaders need to engage followers to accomplish mutual goals; therefore, it is imperative that they treat followers and their ideas with respect and dignity. Leaders also play a major role in establishing the ethical climate in their organization; that role requires leaders to be particularly sensitive to the values and ideals they promote.
Several prominent leadership scholars, including Heifetz, Burns, and Greenleaf, have made unique contributions to our understanding of ethical leadership. The theme common to these authors is an ethic of caring, which pays attention to followers’ needs and the importance of leader–follower relationships.
This chapter suggests that sound ethical leadership is rooted in respect, ser- vice, justice, honesty, and community. It is the duty of leaders to treat others with respect—to listen to them closely and be tolerant of opposing points of view. Ethical leaders serve others by being altruistic, placing others’ welfare ahead of their own in an effort to contribute to the common good. Justice requires that leaders place fairness at the center of their decision making, including the challenging task of being fair to the individual while simulta- neously being fair to the common interests of the community. Good leaders are honest. They do not lie, nor do they present truth to others in ways that are destructive or counterproductive. Finally, ethical leaders are committed to building community, which includes searching for goals that are compat- ible with the goals of followers and with society as a whole.
360 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Research on ethics and leadership has several strengths. At a time when the public is demanding higher levels of moral responsibility from its leaders, this research provides some direction in how to think about ethical leadership and how to practice it. In addition, this research reminds us that leadership is a moral process. Scholars should include ethics as an integral part of the leader- ship studies and research. Third, this area of research describes basic princi- ples that we can use in developing real-world ethical leadership.
On the negative side, this research area of ethical leadership is still in an early stage of development. Few studies have been done that directly address the nature of ethical leadership. As a result, the theoretical formulations about the process remain tentative. Second, this area of research relies on the writ- ings of a few individuals whose work has been primarily descriptive and anecdotal. As a result, the development of theory on leadership ethics lacks the traditional empirical support that usually accompanies theories of human behavior. Despite these weaknesses, the field of ethical leadership is wide open for future research. There remains a strong need for research that can advance our understanding of the role of ethics in the leadership process.
sharpen your skills with saGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
rEFErEncEs
Aronson, E. (2001). Integrating leadership styles and ethical perspectives. Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences, 18(4), 244–256.
Avolio, B. J., & Locke, E. E. (2002). Contrasting different philosophies of leader motivation: Altruism versus egoism. Leadership Quarterly, 13, 169–191.
Bass, B. M., & Steidlmeier, P. (1999). Ethics, character, and authentic transformational leadership behavior. Leadership Quarterly, 10(2), 181–217.
Beauchamp, T. L., & Bowie, N. E. (1988). Ethical theory and business (3rd ed.). Engle- wood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Beauchamp, T. L., & Childress, J. F. (1994). Principles of biomedical ethics (4th ed.). New York: Oxford University Press.
Block, P. (1993). Stewardship: Choosing service over self-interest. San Francisco: Berrett- Koehler.
Bowie, N. E. (1991). Challenging the egoistic paradigm. Business Ethics Quarterly, 1(1), 1–21.
Burns, J. M. (1978). Leadership. New York: Harper & Row. Carlson, D. S., & Perrewe, P. L. (1995). Institutionalization of organizational
ethics through transformational leadership. Journal of Business Ethics, 14(10), 829–838.
chapter 13 Leadership Ethics 361
Ciulla, J. B. (1998). Ethics, the heart of leadership. Westport, CT: Greenwood. Ciulla, J. B. (2001). Carving leaders from the warped wood of humanity. Canadian
Journal of Administrative Sciences, 18(4), 313–319. Ciulla, J. B. (2003). The ethics of leadership. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth/Thomson
Learning. Conger, J. (1990). The dark side of leadership. Organizational Dynamics, 19,
44–55. Covey, S. R. (1990). Principle-centered leadership. New York: Fireside. Craig, S. B., & Gustafson, S. B. (1998). Perceived Leader Integrity Scale: An instru-
ment for assessing employee perceptions of leader integrity. Leadership Quarterly, 9(2), 127–145.
Crain, W. C. (1985). Kohlberg’s stages of moral development. In W. C. Crain (Ed.), Theories of development: Concepts and applications (pp. 118–136). New York: Prentice-Hall.
Dalla Costa, J. (1998). The ethical imperative: Why moral leadership is good business. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
De Pree, M. (1989). Leadership is an art. New York: Doubleday. Frankena, W. (1973). Ethics (2nd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall. Gilligan, C. (1982). In a different voice: Psychological theory and women’s development.
Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Gini, A. (1998). Moral leadership and business ethics. In J. B. Ciulla (Ed.), Ethics, the
heart of leadership (pp. 27–46). Westport, CT: Greenwood. Greenleaf, R. K. (1970). The servant as leader. Newton Centre, MA: Robert K. Green-
leaf Center. Greenleaf, R. K. (1977). Servant leadership: A journey into the nature of legitimate power
and greatness. New York: Paulist. Heifetz, R. A. (1994). Leadership without easy answers. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press. Jaksa, J. A., & Pritchard, M. S. (1988). Communication ethics: Methods of analysis.
Belmont, CA: Wadsworth. Johnson, C. R. (2011). Meeting the ethical challenges of leadership (4th ed.). Thousand
Oaks, CA: SAGE. Kanungo, R. N. (2001). Ethical values of transactional and transformational leaders.
Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences, 18(4), 257–265. Kanungo, R. N., & Mendonca, M. (1996). Ethical dimensions of leadership. Thousand
Oaks, CA: SAGE. Kitchener, K. S. (1984). Intuition, critical evaluation, and ethical principles: The foun-
dation for ethical decisions in counseling psychology. Counseling Psychologist, 12(3), 43–55.
Kohlberg, L. (1984). Essays on moral development, Vol. 2: The psychology of moral devel- opment. New York: Harper & Row.
Komives, S. R., Lucas, N., & McMahon, T. R. (1998). Exploring leadership: For college students who want to make a difference. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Kouzes, J. M., & Posner, B. Z. (1995). The leadership challenge: How to keep getting extraordinary things done in organizations (2nd ed.). San Francisco: Jossey- Bass.
362 LEadErship ThEory and pracTicE
Lipman-Blumen, J. (2005). The allure of toxic leaders. New York: Oxford University Press.
Padilla, A., Hogan, R., & Kaiser, R. B. (2007). The toxic triangle: Destructive leaders, susceptible followers, and conducive environments. The Leadership Quarterly, 18, 176–194.
Parry, K. W., & Proctor-Thomson, S. B. (2002). Perceived integrity of transforma- tional leaders in organisational settings. Journal of Business Ethics, 35, 75–96.
Pojman, L. P. (1995). Ethical theory: Classical and contemporary readings (2nd ed.). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth.
Price, T. (2008). Leadership ethics: An introduction. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Rawls, J. (1971). A theory of justice. Boston: Harvard University Press. Rost, J. C. (1991). Leadership for the twenty-first century. New York: Praeger. Schminke, M., Ambrose, M. L., & Noel, T. W. (1997). The effect of ethical frame-
works on perceptions of organizational justice. Academy of Management Journal, 40(5), 1190–1207.
Schumann, P. L. (2001). A moral principles framework for human resource manage- ment ethics. Human Resource Management Review, 11, 93–111.
Schyns, B., & Schilling, J. (2013). How bad are the effects of bad leaders? A meta- analysis of destructive leadership and its outcomes. The Leadership Quarterly, 24, 138–158.
Senge, P. M. (1990). The fifth discipline: The art and practice of the learning organization. New York: Doubleday.
Trevino, L. K. (1986). Ethical decision making in organizations: A person–situation interactionist model. Academy of Management Review, 11(3), 601–617.
Trevino, L. K., Brown, M., & Hartman, L. P. (2003). A qualitative investigation of perceived executive ethical leadership: Perceptions from inside and outside the executive suite. Human Relations, 56(1), 5–37.
Velasquez, M. G. (1992). Business ethics: Concepts and cases (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Wayne, L. (2009, May 30). A promise to be ethical in an era of immorality. The New York Times. Retrieved June 15, 2009, from http://www.nytimes.com/2009/05/30/ business
14
Team Leadership
Susan E. Kogler Hill
DescripTion
Work teams are very prevalent in today’s organizations. The reliance on teams is due partially to increasingly complex tasks, more globalization, and the flattening of organizational structures. A team is a type of orga- nizational group that is composed of members who are interdependent, who share common goals, and who must coordinate their activities to accomplish these goals. Team members must work collectively to achieve their goals. Examples of organizational teams include senior executive teams, project management teams, task forces, work units, standing com- mittees, quality teams, and improvement teams. Teams can be located in the same place meeting face-to-face, or they can be geographically dis- persed “virtual” teams meeting via various forms of communication tech- nology. The exact definition of which organizational group is a team or not is constantly evolving as organizations confront the many new forms of contemporary collaboration (Wageman, Gardner, & Mortensen, 2012).
The study of organizational teams has focused on strategies for maintaining a competitive advantage. Team-based organizations have faster response capability because of their flatter organizational structures, which rely on teams and new technology to enable communication across time and space (Porter & Beyerlein, 2000). These newer organizational structures have been referred to as “team-based and technology-enabled” (Mankin, Cohen, &
Team Leadership
364 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Bikson, 1996). Increasingly, companies are depending on virtual teams, or teams that are geographically dispersed and rely on technology to interact and collaborate (Muethel, Gehrlein, & Hoegl, 2012).
The organizational team-based structure is an important way for orga- nizations to remain competitive by responding quickly and adapting to constant, rapid changes. Studies of both face-to-face and virtual teams have increasingly become focused on team processes and team outcomes (Ilgen, Hollenbeck, Johnson, & Jundt, 2005; Thomas, Martin, & Riggio, 2013). Also, researchers focused on the problems work teams confront as well as how to make these work teams more effective (Ilgen, Major, Hollenbeck, & Sego, 1993). Effective organizational teams lead to many desirable outcomes, such as
• greater productivity,
• more effective use of resources,
• better decisions and problem solving,
• better-quality products and services, and
• greater innovation and creativity (Parker, 1990).
However, for teams to be successful, the organizational culture needs to support member involvement. The traditional authority structure of many organizations does not support decision making at lower levels, and this can lead to the failure of many teams. Teamwork is an example of lateral deci- sion making as opposed to the traditional vertical decision making that occurs in the organizational hierarchy based on rank or position in the organization. The dynamic and fluid power shifting in teams has been referred to as heterarchy (Aime, Humphrey, DeRue, & Paul, 2014). Such power shifting within teams can lead to positive outcomes as long as team members see these shifting sources of power as legitimate. Teams will have great difficulty in organizational cultures that are not supportive of such collaborative work and decision making. Changing an organizational cul- ture to one that is more supportive of teams is possible, but it takes time and effort (Levi, 2011).
Leadership of teams has also become an important area of study. The ideas of “team leadership” are quite different from leadership within the organi- zational vertical structure. Many theories of leadership, such as situational (discussed in Chapter 5) and transformational (discussed in Chapter 8), can be applied in the team setting. However, team leadership is a unique setting for leadership, and it is very process oriented. How do teams develop their
Traits of healthy Teams
chapter 14 Team Leadership 365
“critical capabilities”? How do team leaders shift their actions over time to deal with contingencies as they arise? How do leader actions promote task and interpersonal development (Kozlowski, Watola, Jensen, Kim, & Botero, 2009)? Effective team leadership facilitates team success and helps teams to avoid team failure (Stagl, Salas, & Burke, 2007; Stewart & Manz, 1995). Effective leadership processes are the most critical factor in team success (Zaccaro, Rittman, & Marks, 2001, p. 452).
Shared or Distributed Leadership: The complexities of team processes demand the attention and focus of all members of the team. Some teams are autonomous and self-directed with no formal leader. But even those with a formal leader will benefit from shared leadership among team mem- bers. Team leadership functions can be performed by the formal team leader and/or shared by team members. Shared team leadership occurs when members of the team take on leadership behaviors to influence the team and to maximize team effectiveness (Bergman, Rentsch, Small, Davenport, & Bergman, 2012). Shared leadership has been referred to as team leadership capacity, encompassing the leadership repertoire of the entire team (Day, Gronn, & Salas, 2004). Such distributed leadership involves the sharing of influence by team members. Team members step forward when situations warrant, providing the leadership necessary, and then step back to allow others to lead. Such shared leadership has become more and more impor- tant in today’s organizations to allow faster responses to more complex issues (Morgeson, DeRue, & Karam, 2010; Pearce, Manz, & Sims, 2009; Solansky, 2008).
Shared leadership, while very important, does involve risk and takes some courage for the member who steps forward to provide leadership outside the formal role of team leader (Amos & Klimoski, 2014). Risks aside, teams with shared leadership have less conflict, more consensus, more trust, and more cohesion than teams that do not have shared leadership (Bergman et al., 2012). Shared leadership is even more important for virtual teams. Virtual teams are more effective when there is shared team leadership (Hoch & Kozlowski, 2014; Muethel et al., 2012). Virtual teams especially benefit from shared leadership when the task is complex (Wang, Waldman, & Zhang, 2014).
How leaders and members can share the leadership of teams so that these teams can truly become effective and achieve excellence will be discussed in this chapter. It will introduce a model that provides a mental road map to help the leader or any team member providing leadership diagnose team problems and take appropriate action to correct those problems.
self-Managed Teams shared Leadership
366 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Team Leadership Model
The Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) is based on the func- tional leadership claim that the leader’s job is to monitor the team and then take whatever action is necessary to ensure team effectiveness. The model provides a tool for understanding the very complex phenomenon of team leadership, starting at the top with its initial leadership decisions, moving to leader actions, and finally focusing on the indicators of team effectiveness. In addition, the model suggests specific actions that leaders can perform to improve team effectiveness. Effective team leaders need a wide repertoire of communication skills to monitor and take appropriate action. The model is designed to simplify and clarify the complex nature of team leadership and to provide an easy tool to aid leadership decision making for team leaders and members alike.
Effective team performance begins with how the leader sees the situation that the team is experiencing (the leader’s mental model). This mental model reflects not only the components of the problem confronting the team, but also the environmental and organizational contingencies that define the larger context of team action. The leader develops a mental conception of what the team problem is and what solutions are possible in this context, given the environmental and organizational constraints and resources (Zaccaro et al., 2001).
To respond appropriately to the problem envisioned in the mental model, a good team leader needs to be behaviorally flexible and have a wide repertoire of actions or skills to meet the team’s diverse needs (Barge, 1996). When the leader’s behavior matches the complexity of the situation, he or she is behav- ing with “requisite variety,” or the set of behaviors necessary to meet the team’s needs (Drecksel, 1991). Effective team leaders are able to construct accurate mental models of the team’s problems by observing team function- ing, and can take requisite action to solve these problems. Effective team leaders can diagnose correctly and choose the right action.
The leader has special responsibility for functioning in a manner that will help the team achieve effectiveness. Within this perspective, leadership behavior is seen as team-based problem solving, in which the leader attempts to achieve team goals by analyzing the internal and external situation and then selecting and implementing the appropriate behaviors to ensure team effectiveness (Fleishman et al., 1991). Leaders must use discretion about which problems need intervention, and make choices about which solutions are the most appropriate (Zaccaro et al., 2001). The appropriate solution varies by circumstance and focuses on what should be done to make the team
Team effectiveness
chapter 14 Team Leadership 367
more effective. Effective leaders have the ability to determine what leadership interventions are needed, if any, to solve team problems. When leadership is shared throughout the team, various members are diagnosing problems and intervening with appropriate behaviors. The monitoring and selection of behaviors is shared throughout the team membership. Given the complexity of team functioning, such shared leadership can—and, in fact, does—lead to greater team effectiveness.
Team effectiveness
At the bottom of the Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) is “Team Effectiveness,” which focuses on team excellence or the desired outcomes of teamwork. Two critical functions of team effectiveness are
Internal Leadership Actions External Leadership Actions
Networking Advocating Negotiating Support Buffering Assessing Sharing Information
Environmental Coaching Collaborating Managing Conflict Building Commitment Satisfying Needs Modeling Principles
Relational Goal Focusing Structuring for Results Facilitating Decisions Training Maintaining Standards
Task
Performance Development
Team Effectiveness
Leadership Decisions
• Monitor or Take Action • Task or Relational • Internal or External
Figure 14.1 The hill Model for Team Leadership
Goals
368 Leadership Theory and pracTice
performance (task accomplishment) and development (team maintenance). Performance refers to the quality of the outcomes of the team’s work. Did the team accomplish its goals and objectives in a quality manner? Development refers to the cohesiveness of the team and the ability of team members to satisfy their own needs while working effectively with other team members (Nadler, 1998). Excellent teams accomplish both of these objectives: getting the job done and maintaining a cohesive team.
Scholars have systematically studied organizational work teams and devel- oped standards of effectiveness or criteria of excellence that can be used to assess a team’s health (Hackman, 1990, 2002, 2012; Hughes, Ginnett, & Curphey, 1993; LaFasto & Larson, 2001; Larson & LaFasto, 1989; Zaccaro et al., 2001). Hackman (2012) has posited six enabling conditions that lead to effective team functioning: (1) Is it a real team? (2) Does it have a com- pelling purpose? (3) Does it have the right people? (4) Are the norms of conduct clear? (5) Is there support from the organizational context? (6) Is there team-focused coaching? Larson and LaFasto (1989) studied success- ful teams and found that, regardless of the type of team, eight characteris- tics were consistently associated with team excellence. Table 14.1 demonstrates the similarity of these excellence characteristics to the enabling conditions suggested by Hackman (2012).
It is helpful if team leaders understand the conditions that contribute to or enable team excellence. Such understanding will allow the leader to bench- mark or compare his or her team’s performance to these standards and to determine possible areas of team weakness or ineffectiveness. Assessing how well the team compares to these established indicators of team success pro- vides a valuable source of information to guide the leader to take appropriate actions to improve team success.
1. Clear, Elevating Goal. “A compelling purpose energizes team members, orients them toward their collective objective, and fully engages their tal- ents” (Hackman, 2012, p. 437). Team goals must be very clear so that one can tell whether the performance objective has been realized. Teams some- times fail because they are given a vague task and then asked to work out the details (Hackman, 1990). In addition, the team goal must be involving or motivating so that the members believe it to be worthwhile and impor- tant. Teams often fail because they let something else replace their goal, such as personal agendas or power issues (Larson & LaFasto, 1989). Research data from numerous teams show that effective leaders keep the team focused on the goal (LaFasto & Larson, 2001).
Future Team effectiveness
chapter 14 Team Leadership 369
2. Results-Driven Structure. Teams need to find the best structure for accomplishing their goals. Structural features that lead to effective team- work include task design, team composition, and core norms of conduct (Wageman, Fisher, & Hackman, 2009). Top management teams typically deal with power and influence, task forces deal with ideas and plans, customer service teams deal with clients, and production teams deal with technology (Hackman, 1990). Problem resolution teams such as task forces need a structure that emphasizes trust so that all will be willing and able to contribute. Creative teams such as advertising teams need to emphasize autonomy so that all can take risks and be free from undue censorship. Tactical teams such as emergency room teams need to emphasize clarity so that everyone knows what to do and when. In addi- tion, all teams need clear roles for team members, a good communication system, methods of assessing individual performance, and an emphasis on fact-based judgments (Larson & LaFasto, 1989). Appropriate struc- tures enable teams to meet their needs while still accomplishing team goals.
3. Competent Team Members. Teams should be composed of the right number and mix of members to accomplish all the tasks of the team. In addition, members need sufficient information, education, and training to
Table 14.1 comparison of Theory and research criteria of Team effectiveness
Enabling Conditions of Group Effectiveness (Hackman, 2012)
Characteristics of Team Excellence (Larson & LaFasto, 1989)
Compelling purpose Clear, elevating goal
Results-driven structure
Right people Competent team members
Real team Unified commitment
Collaborative climate
Clear norms of conduct Standards of excellence
Supportive organizational context External support and recognition
Team-focused coaching Principled leadership
coaching and Goals
370 Leadership Theory and pracTice
become or remain competent team members (Hackman & Walton, 1986). As a whole, the individual team members need to possess the requisite technical competence to accomplish the team’s goals. Members also need to be personally competent in interpersonal and teamwork skills. A com- mon mistake in forming teams is to assume that people who have all the technical skills necessary to solve a problem also have the interpersonal skills necessary to collaborate effectively (Hackman, 1990). Just because someone is a good engineer or doctor does not mean he or she has the interpersonal skills to function on a team. Team members need certain core competencies that include the ability to do the job and the ability to solve problems. In addition, members need certain teamwork factors such as openness, supportiveness, action orientation, and a positive personal style (LaFasto & Larson, 2001).
4. Unified Commitment. A common mistake is to call a work group a team but treat it as a collection of individuals (Hackman, 1990). Teams do not just happen: They are carefully designed and developed. Excellent teams are those that have developed a sense of unity or identification. Such team spirit often can be developed by involving members in all aspects of the process (Larson & LaFasto, 1989).
5. Collaborative Climate. The ability of a team to collaborate or work well together is essential to team effectiveness. A collaborative climate is one in which members can stay problem focused, listen to and understand one another, feel free to take risks, and be willing to compensate for one another. To build an atmosphere that fosters collaboration, we need to develop trusting relationships based on honesty, openness, consistency, and respect (Larson & LaFasto, 1989). Integration of individual actions is one of the fundamental characteristics of effective teams. Team members each have their own unique roles that they typically perform to contribute to the team’s success. Team failure may result from the members’ “collective failure to coordinate and synchronize their individual contributions” (Zaccaro et al., 2001, p. 451). Effective team leaders can facilitate a collaborative climate by managing their own needs to control, by making communication safe, by demanding and rewarding collaborative behavior, and by guiding the team’s problem-solving efforts (LaFasto & Larson, 2001).
6. Standards of Excellence. Clear norms of conduct (how we should behave) are important for team functioning (Hackman, 2012). Team mem- bers’ performance should be regulated so that actions can be coordinated and tasks completed (Hackman & Walton, 1986). It is especially important that the organizational context or the team itself set up standards of excellence so
cohesiveness in Teams
chapter 14 Team Leadership 371
that members will feel pressure to perform at their highest levels. The standards must be clear and concrete, and all team members must be required to perform to standard (Larson & LaFasto, 1989). A team leader can facilitate this process by requiring results—making expectations clear and reviewing results—providing feedback to resolve performance issues, and rewarding results by acknowledging superior performance (LaFasto & Larson, 2001). With such standards in place and monitored, members will be encouraged to perform at their highest levels.
7. External Support and Recognition. A supportive organizational con- text includes material resources, rewards for excellent performance, an educational system to develop necessary team skills, and an information system to provide data needed to accomplish the task (Wageman et al., 2009). A common mistake is to give organizational teams challenging assignments but fail to give them organizational support to accomplish these assignments (Hackman, 1990). The leader must identify which type of support is needed and intervene as needed to secure this support (Hack- man, 2002). The best goals, team members, and commitment will not mean much if there is no money, equipment, or supplies for accomplishing the goals. Also, organizations often ask employees to work on a difficult team assignment and then do not reward them with raises or bonuses for that performance. Hyatt and Ruddy (1997) found that having systems in place to support teams (clear direction, information, data, resources, rewards, and training) enables the team to become more effective and achieve perfor- mance goals. Teams can achieve excellence if they are given the resources needed to do their jobs, are recognized for team accomplishments, and are rewarded for team performance rather than for individual performances (Larson & LaFasto, 1989).
8. Principled Leadership. Effective team leadership has been found to consistently relate to team effectiveness (Zaccaro, Heinen, & Shuffler, 2009). Leadership has been described as the central driver of team effec- tiveness, influencing the team through four sets of processes: cognitive, motivational, affective, and coordination (Zaccaro et al., 2001). Cogni- tively, the leader helps the team understand the problems confronting the team. Motivationally, the leader helps the team become cohesive and capable by setting high performance standards and helping the team to achieve them. Affectively, the leader helps the team handle stressful cir- cumstances by providing clear goals, assignments, and strategies. Coor- dinately, the leader helps integrate the team’s activities by matching members’ skills to roles, providing clear performance strategies, monitor- ing feedback, and adapting to environmental changes.
nursing Team Leaders
372 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Effective team leaders are committed to the team’s goals and give members autonomy to unleash their talents when possible. Leaders can reduce the effectiveness of their team by being unwilling to confront inadequate per- formance, diluting the team’s ability to perform by having too many priori- ties, and overestimating the positive aspects of team performance. Leaders can enhance the effectiveness of their team by keeping the team focused on its goals, maintaining a collaborative climate, building confidence among members, demonstrating technical competence, setting priorities, and man- aging performance (Larson & LaFasto, 1989). It is essential that the leader- ship of the team be assessed along with the other criteria of team excellence. Such feedback is essential to the health and effectiveness of the team.
The leadership of the team can use these eight characteristics of team excel- lence (Table 14.1) in a normative fashion to assess the health of the team and to take appropriate action to address any weaknesses. If the team leader assesses that one or more of the eight characteristics of team success are not being achieved, then he or she needs to address these weaknesses. Continually assessing the standards of team effectiveness can also provide feedback, enabling leaders to determine whether past actions and interventions had the desired results. To assess team effectiveness, team leaders need to use whatever tools are at their disposal, such as direct observation, surveys, feed- back, and performance indicators. The information gained from the analysis of team effectiveness can provide feedback to the leader and guide future leadership decisions. The line on the Hill Model of Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) that connects the “Team Effectiveness” box at the bottom to the “Leadership Decisions” box at the top reflects the ongoing learning process of data gathering, analysis, and decision making. Such feedback loops dem- onstrate the dynamic and evolving nature of teams (Ilgen et al., 2005). Past leadership decisions and actions are reflected in the team’s performance and relational outcomes. In turn, these indicators of team effectiveness shape the future analysis and decisions of the team leadership.
Leadership Decisions
At the top of the Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) are “Leadership Decisions,” which include the major decisions the team’s leadership needs to make when determining whether and how to inter- vene to improve team functioning. The first of these decisions is whether it is most appropriate to continue to observe and monitor the team or to intervene in the team’s activities and take action. The second decision is to choose whether a task or a relational intervention is needed (i.e., does the team need help in accomplishing its tasks, or does it need help in
assessing Fit in Teams
chapter 14 Team Leadership 373
maintaining relationships?). The final decision is whether to intervene at the internal level (within the team itself ) or at the external level (in the team’s environment).
Leadership Decision 1: Should I monitor the team or take action? The first decision confronting the team’s leadership is whether to keep observing the team or to take action to help the team. McGrath (as cited in Hackman & Walton, 1986) outlined the critical leadership functions of group effective- ness, taking into account the analysis of the situation both internally and externally and whether this analysis indicates that the leader should take an immediate action. Figure 14.2, “McGrath’s Critical Leadership Functions,” demonstrates these two dimensions of leadership behavior: monitoring ver- sus taking action and internal group issues versus external group issues. As lead- ers, we can diagnose, analyze, or forecast problems (monitoring), or we can take immediate action to solve a problem. We can also focus on the prob- lems within the group (internal) or problems outside the group (external). These two dimensions result in the four types of team leadership functions shown in Figure 14.2.
Quadrants 1 and 2 in Figure 14.2 focus on the internal operations of the team. In Quadrant 1, the leader is diagnosing group deficiencies, and in Quadrant 2, the leader is acting to repair or remedy the observed problems. Quadrants 3 and 4 focus on the external operations of the team. In the third quadrant, the leader is scanning the environment to determine and forecast
Figure 14.2 McGrath’s critical Leadership Functions
INTERNAL
EXTERNAL
EXECUTIVE ACTION
Taking Remedial
Action
Preventing Deleterious
Changes
MONITOR
Diagnosing Group
Deficiencies
Forecasting Environmental
Changes
1 2
3 4
soUrce: McGrath’s critical leadership functions as cited in “Leading Groups in organizations,” by J. r. hackman and r. e. Walton, 1986, in p. s. Goodman & associates (eds.), Designing Effective Work Groups (p. 76). san Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
374 Leadership Theory and pracTice
any external changes that will affect the group. In the fourth quadrant, the leader acts to prevent any negative changes in the environment from hurting the team.
Therefore, the first decision confronting the team’s leadership is “Should I continue monitoring these factors, or should I take action based on the information I have already gathered and structured?” To develop an accurate mental model of team functioning, leaders need to monitor both the internal and external environments to gather information, reduce equivocality, pro- vide structure, and overcome barriers. Fleishman et al. (1991) described two phases in this initial process: information search and structuring. A leader must first seek out information to understand the current state of the team’s functioning (information search), and then this information must be ana- lyzed, organized, and interpreted so the leader can decide how to act (infor- mation structuring). Leaders can also help their information search process by obtaining feedback from team members, networking with others outside the team, conducting team assessment surveys, and evaluating team out- comes. Once information on the team is gathered, the leader needs to struc- ture or interpret this information so that he or she can make action plans. Virtual teams operate under the same group dynamics principles and also need to monitor and intervene as appropriate (Berry, 2011).
All members of the team can engage in monitoring (information search and structuring) and collectively provide distributed or shared leadership to help the team adapt to changing conditions. In fast-paced, rapidly changing situations, the team leader and members might have to work in concert to assess the situ- ation accurately. The official leader of the team might be too busy processing information from the environment to process information internal to the team. The team members can help the leader by staying on top of internal problems. Together, they can form an accurate picture of the team’s effectiveness.
In addition to gathering and interpreting information, team leaders must take the right action based on this information. Determining the right action to take is at the very heart of team leadership. It involves selecting from among competing courses of action to facilitate the team’s work (Barge, 1996). Leaders differ in their tendencies to take action quickly (hasty to act) or their tendencies to delay taking action by analyzing the situation at length (slow to act). “Hasty to act” leaders might prevent problems from getting out of control; however, they might not make the right intervention because they do not have all the information, and such fast action might undermine the development of shared leadership. “Slow to act” leaders might encourage other team members to emerge as leaders (shared leadership), but the action- taking delay might cause the team’s problem to become unmanageable.
high-risk environments
chapter 14 Team Leadership 375
The exact timing of a leadership intervention is as important as the spe- cific type of intervention (Wageman et al., 2009). It has been proposed that groups go through developmental stages of forming, storming, norm- ing, performing, and adjourning (Tuckman & Jensen, 2010). Certain behaviors are common and even expected at each of these stages. If, for example, conflict was occurring during the storming stage of team life, the leadership might not intervene at that time but just continue monitoring. Or, the leadership might choose an intervention that advances the team to the next phase of norming. Others have described three phases of group life and the leadership needed during each: (1) motivational coaching (at start), (2) consultative coaching (at midpoint), and (3) educational coaching (at end). The important aspect of timing is that the leader should understand where the team is in its life cycle and provide the type of leadership needed at that time (Hackman, 2012).
Leadership Decision 2: Should I intervene to meet task or relational needs? Returning to the top box in Figure 14.1 (“Leadership Decisions”), the second decision confronting the leader is whether the team needs help in dealing with relational issues or task issues. Since the early study of small groups, the focus has been on two critical leadership functions: task and maintenance. Task leadership functions include getting the job done, making decisions, solving problems, adapting to changes, making plans, and achieving goals. Maintenance functions include developing a posi- tive climate, solving interpersonal problems, satisfying members’ needs, and developing cohesion. These two functions have also been referred to in terms of performance and development (i.e., how well the team has accomplished its task and how well the team has developed effective relationships).
Superior team leadership focuses constantly on both task and maintenance functions (Kinlaw, 1998); both types of leadership behaviors (task-focused and person-focused) have been found to be related to perceived team effectiveness (Burke et al., 2006).
Task functions are closely intertwined with relational functions. If the team is well maintained and has good interpersonal relationships, then the mem- bers will be able to work together effectively and get their job done. If not, they will spend all of their time infighting, sniping, and working at cross- purposes. Similarly, if the team is productive and successful in accomplishing its task, it will be easier to maintain a positive climate and good relations. Conversely, failing teams often take their lack of performance out on each other, and fighting teams often accomplish little.
376 Leadership Theory and pracTice
In virtual teams connected across time and space by electronic media, focus- ing on building team relationships is even more critical than in traditional co-located teams. Virtual team leaders must be able to “read” all the personal and contextual nuances in a world of electronic communications. They must be able to understand the possible causes of silence, misunderstanding, and slights without any of the usual signs to guide them. Leaders must be sensi- tive to the team process and must pay attention to even small matters that could interfere with the team’s success (Pauleen, 2004). Virtual teams place even greater demands on team leaders—50% more time investment—than the more traditional co-located team (Dyer, Dyer, & Dyer, 2007). As the prevalence of virtual teams expands, specific leadership issues and interven- tions related to these virtual teams are increasingly the focus of study (Berry, 2011; Cordery, Soo, Kirkman, Rosen, & Mathieu, 2009; Zaccaro, Ardison, & Orvis, 2004).
Leadership Decision 3: Should I intervene internally or externally? If a deci- sion was made to take action or intervene, the leader must make the third strategic leadership decision in Figure 14.1 and determine what level of the team process needs leadership attention: internal leadership actions or exter- nal leadership actions. Do I need to intervene inside of the team, or is the problem external to the team? Effective team leaders analyze and balance the internal and external demands of the team and react appropriately (Barge, 1996).
Is there internal conflict between members of the team? Then perhaps tak- ing an internal relational action to maintain the team and improve interper- sonal relationships would be most appropriate. Are the team goals unclear? Then perhaps an internal task intervention is needed to focus on goals. Is the organizational environment not providing proper support to the team to do its job? Then perhaps an external environmental intervention focusing on obtaining external support for the team might be the most appropriate intervention.
The current focus of research is on real-life organizational work teams that exist within a larger organizational environment. In addition to balancing the internal task and relational needs of the team, the leader has to help the team adapt to and function effectively in its environment. Most teams focus on the internal problems of the team. But it is increasingly important for teams to also be externally oriented to “reach across boundaries to forge dense networks of connection, both inside and outside the organization” so that they can deal effectively with the fast changing environment (Ancona, Bresman, & Caldwell, 2009).
relational actions
chapter 14 Team Leadership 377
Leadership Actions
The middle section of the Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) lists a number of specific leadership actions that can be performed internally (“Task” and “Relational”) or externally (“Environmental”). These lists are not exhaustive but are compiled from research on team excellence and team per- formance discussed earlier in this chapter. For example, teams that have clear goals, standards, effective structure, and decision making will have higher task performance. Teams that can manage conflict, collaborate well together, and build commitment will have good relationships. Teams that are well connected to and protected from their environment will also be more productive.
It is up to the leader to assess what action, if any, is needed and then inter- vene with the specific leadership function to meet the demands of the situ- ation. The leader needs the ability to perform these skills and to make a strategic choice as to the most appropriate function or skill for the interven- tion. For example, if the leader decided that team members were arguing, he or she might decide to initiate conflict management. To be an effective leader, one needs to respond with the action that is required of the situation. Thus, it is the job of the leader to analyze and mediate the situation to make the best decisions for the good of the team. A detailed knowledge of group dynamics and interpersonal processes is key to effective team leadership.
A team leader also needs to recognize and interpret what is getting in the way of the team’s goal accomplishment and then make a strategic choice and respond with the appropriate action (Gouran & Hirokawa, 1996). If a prob- lem is diagnosed as a team performance problem, then the leader needs to determine the appropriate action to solve this task problem (e.g., goal focus- ing, standard setting, or training). If a problem is diagnosed as a team devel- opment problem, then the leader needs to determine the appropriate action to solve this relational problem (e.g., managing conflict or building commit- ment). If a problem is diagnosed as an environmental problem, then the leader needs to determine the appropriate action to solve this context prob- lem (e.g., networking, advocating, or sharing information).
Internal Task Leadership Actions. The “Task” box in the Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) lists the set of skills or actions that the leader might perform to improve task performance. After monitoring the team’s performance, the leader might choose to intervene in one of the following task areas:
• Goal focusing (clarifying, gaining agreement) For example, if team members seem to be going off in different direc-
tions, the leader might intervene to clarify the team’s goals or work with members to obtain agreement on goals.
resourcing
378 Leadership Theory and pracTice
• Structuring for results (planning, visioning, organizing, clarifying roles, delegating)
For example, if the leader determines that the team is stuck in day- to-day affairs and not looking to or building for the future, then he or she might intervene by helping the team vision and plan for the future.
• Facilitating decision making (informing, controlling, coordinating, mediating, synthesizing, focusing on issues)
For example, if the leader determines that members are not ade- quately sharing information with each other, he or she might ask questions to seek out the information that is not being shared.
• Training team members in task skills (educating, developing)
For example, if the leader observes that the team members do not have the skills necessary to make well-reasoned decisions, the leader might provide a training seminar in decision making.
• Maintaining standards of excellence (assessing team and individual performance, confronting inadequate performance)
For example, if the leader observes that some team members are com- ing late to meetings or not attending meetings, the leader might have to take direct action and confront these members to address this inadequate performance.
Internal Relational Leadership Actions. The second set of internal lead- ership actions in Figure 14.1 reflects those that the leader needs to imple- ment to improve team relationships. After monitoring the team’s performance, the leader might choose to intervene in one of the following interpersonal areas:
• Coaching team members in interpersonal skills
For example, if the team leader observes that team members do not seem to be listening to one another, then he or she might intervene by leading team members in a listening exercise.
• Collaborating (including, involving)
For example, if the leader observes that some team members are not taking others’ opinions into account, then the leader might intervene to encourage compromise.
• Managing conflict and power issues (fighting or avoiding confrontation, questioning ideas, avoiding groupthink)
decision-Making
chapter 14 Team Leadership 379
For example, if the leader observes that the members are not ques- tioning ideas and are just agreeing with each other in order to move quickly to a decision, then the leader might intervene by providing a discussion on the negative aspects of groupthink (Neck & Manz, 1994).
• Building commitment and esprit de corps (being optimistic, innovating, envisioning, socializing, rewarding, recognizing)
For example, if the team seems to have low morale, the leader could intervene to build commitment and unity by recognizing past team successes.
• Satisfying individual member needs (trusting, supporting, advocating)
For example, if a team member seems stressed due to disrespect from other members, the leader might provide support to the upset mem- ber and advocate to the team on his or her behalf.
• Modeling ethical and principled practices (fair, consistent, normative)
For example, if a team leader monitors the team and observes that he or she is inconsistent vis-à-vis the members sometimes treating in- group members differently from out-group members, then the leader might intervene and change his or her own behavior to be fair and consistent to all members.
External Environmental Leadership Actions. The “External Leader- ship Actions” (Figure 14.1) reflect those actions the leader might implement to improve the environmental interface with the team. Real-life teams do not exist in a laboratory—they are subsystems of the larger organizational and societal context. To stay viable, the team needs to monitor this environment closely and determine what actions should be taken to enhance team effectiveness (Barge, 1996; Hyatt & Ruddy, 1997; Zaccaro et al., 2001). If environmental monitoring sug- gests a leadership intervention, then the leader needs to select from the following functions:
• Networking and forming alliances in environment (gathering informa- tion, increasing influence)
For example, if the leader observes that the team’s members are not well known or are not well connected throughout the organi- zation, then the leader might intervene by interacting and form- ing relationships with powerful and respected individuals in the organization.
Flat office structures
380 Leadership Theory and pracTice
• Advocating and representing team to environment
For example, if the leader learns that organizational superiors are unaware of the team’s successes, the leader might initiate an “FYI” policy, sending information about all successes upward as they happen. The leader can also initiate a team newsletter that chronicles team efforts to accomplish the same function but to a broader context.
• Negotiating upward to secure necessary resources, support, and recognition for team
For example, a leader might determine that the team does not have enough clerical support to accomplish its goals. The leader then negotiates with upper management to provide the needed support or, if failing in this, to persuade upper management to alter the team’s goals accordingly.
• Buffering team members from environmental distractions
For example, if the leader observes that the team is overloaded with tasks, then he or she might intervene by keeping unnecessary demands and distractions away from the team members so that they can concentrate on their goals.
• Assessing environmental indicators of team’s effectiveness (surveys, evalu- ations, performance indicators)
For example, if the leader observes that the members of the team have no way of knowing how well they are doing, the leader can provide data from the environment as to how their performance stacks up with other teams.
• Sharing relevant environmental information with team For example, if the team leader reviews the environment and finds
that the organization’s business is going in a new direction, he or she can share this information with the team to keep them in line with these new directions.
Team leadership is complex; there are no simple recipes for team success. Team leaders must learn to be open and objective in understanding and diagnosing team problems and skillful in selecting the most appropriate actions (or inactions) to help achieve the team’s goals. It is important to reemphasize that these critical functions need not be carried out only by the leader. Experienced members in a mature team might share these leadership behaviors. As long as the team’s critical needs have been met, the leadership behavior, whether enacted by the leader or team members, has been effective. The key assertion of the functional perspective is that the leader is to do whatever
Team Leadership and performance
chapter 14 Team Leadership 381
is necessary to take care of unmet needs of the team. If the team members are taking care of most of the needs, then the leader has to do very little.
How Does THe TeAm LeADersHip moDeL work?
Team leaders and team members can use the model to help them make decisions about the current state of their team and the specific actions they need to take, if any, to improve the team’s functioning. The model portrays leadership as a team oversight function in which the leader’s role is to do whatever is necessary to help the team achieve effectiveness. The model provides the leader with a cognitive map for identifying team needs, and offers suggestions about how to take appropriate corrective actions. The model helps the leader make sense of the complexity of teams and offers practical suggestions based on theory and research.
In using the model, the team leadership engages in the leader mediation process by deciding which option is most appropriate for the team: monitor- ing or taking action. If the monitoring reveals that all aspects of the team’s functioning are satisfactory, then the leadership should not take any direct actions but continue to monitor the internal and external environments in terms of team performance and development. If monitoring reveals that action is needed, then the leadership decides whether to take an internal- level action or an external-level action or both. Finally, the leadership decides which action is appropriate to meet the needs of the team.
Determining the exact intervention is not as easy as it sounds, however, and it clearly reflects the skills necessary for team leadership. For example, a leader monitoring the internal functioning of the team notices there is infighting for control and power. The leader might see this as an internal relationship prob- lem because of the authoritarian and autocratic behavior of one team member. Or perhaps the leader might see it as an internal task problem because the structure of the team is not appropriate and the roles and responsibilities of some members are unclear. The leader might also see the problem as an external environmental problem because the team is not given sufficient auton- omy from the organization; consequently, the members are fighting over what little power and control exist. Or perhaps the leader sees the conflict as tem- porary given the stage of group development (e.g., storming).
In any case, the leader can decide to keep monitoring the situation and not take any immediate action because of the group’s phase of development.
382 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Or the leader can decide at which level to intervene and then decide to enact the most appropriate leadership function at that level. The leader might decide to intervene at all three levels, addressing the authoritarian indi- vidual (internal, relational), clarifying team roles (internal, task), and negotiating more team autonomy with those higher up in the organization (external).
The team leadership model aids in team analysis and improvement, much like that of sports teams. In sports, the coach does not stop working just because the team is winning. The coach keeps working to build commit- ment, develop young players, share expertise, create new methods and strat- egies, and generally improve team functioning. The effective coach never rests on past successes, but works to improve the team’s functioning for the future. After a win or a loss, a football coach will have the team review videos of the game to determine areas of success and failure. Organizational team leaders could learn a great deal from sports team coaches. By comparing their own teams with established standards or criteria of team excellence, leaders can determine the areas of greatest weakness that might need critical intervention.
sTrengTHs
One of the strengths of this model is that it is designed to focus on the real-life organizational work group and the leadership needed therein. The model places the ongoing work group or team in an environmental context within the organization, industry, or society. In addition, the real- life focus on performance and team effectiveness enables leaders and members to diagnose and correct team problems. A team leader can pres- ent the model to his or her team as a teaching tool. By learning what constitutes excellent teams and applying these criteria to team perfor- mance, leaders and members can learn how to better lead teams to the highest levels of excellence.
A second strength of the model is that it provides a cognitive guide that helps leaders to design and maintain effective teams, especially when perfor- mance is below standards. Such an approach is consistent with the emerging theoretical notions of the leader as a medium whose job it is to process the complex information inherent in teamwork (Fisher, 1985). Any model or theory that tries to simplify such a complex process would be inappropriate and inadequate. The team leadership model is not simplistic, and it inte- grates in a manageable and practical form many complex factors that can help a leader be a good medium or processor of information.
chapter 14 Team Leadership 383
Another strength of the model is that it takes into account the changing role of leaders and followers in organizations (shared leadership). The model does not focus on the position of power of a leader, but instead focuses on the critical functions of leadership as diagnosis and action taking. Any team member can perform the critical leadership functions to assess the current effectiveness of the team and then take appropriate action. This approach is consistent with the current movement in organizations to rethink leadership responsibilities in work teams. The responsibilities or functions of team leadership—such as setting goals, coaching, and rewarding—historically have rested with the team’s formal leader, but now, with organizational restructuring, these duties and responsibilities often are distributed across the team.
In addition, this approach to team leadership can help in selection of team leaders and team members. If a leader must be chosen for the team, it might be best to select one who is perceptive, open, objective, analytical, and a good listener who has good diagnostic skills. In addition, it would be wise to select a leader who has a wide repertoire of action-taking skills and is comfortable intervening in the team’s processes in many ways, such as with negotiation, conflict resolution, problem solving, goal focusing, and influencing upward. Good leaders not only can diagnose the team’s problems, but also can reach into their bag of tricks and pull out the appropriate action or actions. For example, if a leader determines that two members of a team are in conflict with one another, he or she needs to be able to determine the root cause of that conflict and select the most appropriate action (or select nonaction).
criTicisms
The Hill Model for Team Leadership (Figure 14.1) is a conceptual frame- work to assist team-based leadership in its decision making. As such, it lists only some of the many skills that leadership might need to employ in mak- ing such decisions. Depending on the type of team or situation, additional skills might be needed that focus more on the environment (Cobb, 2012), coaching and training (Zaccaro, Heinen, & Shuffler, 2009), or preplanning and timing (Wageman et al., 2009). A team might need to modify the model to include skills that are particularly relevant to its effectiveness.
Even though the model does not include all possible leadership skills, it is still quite complex. Team leaders need to spend time adjusting to the frame- work so that it comes naturally to them when decisions are needed. This framework also does not provide on-the-spot answers to specific problems
384 Leadership Theory and pracTice
facing the team leader, such as “When is the best time to intervene?” “What do you say to a member who is upset and crying?” or “What specific action do you take to deal with an organizational culture that is not supporting teamwork?” The model only points the leader in the right direction and sug- gests skills needed to solve these complex problems. The model assumes that the leader is skilled in group process, decision making, interpersonal com- munication, conflict resolution, and other abilities.
To make matters worse, many teams have shared leadership necessitating that everyone who provides team leadership has a wide range of team-ori- ented skills. In addition, the roles of leaders and followers can change over time, making it very important for the team leader and team members to possess the requisite leadership skills. In immature teams leaders might need to take on more of the leadership roles, whereas in a mature team the leader might be able to sit back and let the team lead itself. Increasingly, scholars are providing instruction in diagnosing weaknesses in team leadership skills and offering methods for development and improvement (Cobb, 2012; Levi, 2011; Morgeson et al., 2010; Salas, Burke, & Stagl, 2004). Instruction in teamwork and team leadership needs to focus on team diagnosing and action taking so that team leadership skills can be developed throughout the team and be more easily implemented.
AppLicATion
There are many ways to apply the team leadership model to increase the effectiveness of organizational teams. The model is useful in helping the leader make decisions: Should I act? If so, how should I do so? For example, if the team is not performing effectively (team effectiveness), then the leader can make the first strategic choice by monitoring the situation or acting to improve team functioning. If an action seems warranted, then the leader needs to decide whether the action should be directed inward toward team functioning, outward toward the environment, or both. Once the context for the action is determined, then the leader needs to choose the most appropriate skill for the situation from his or her behavioral repertoire. It is important to continue monitoring the results of the intervention and adapt- ing accordingly, depending on these results.
The leader might choose to use an assessment tool such as the Team Excellence and Collaborative Team Leader Questionnaire included in this chapter to help conduct the team’s diagnosis and set the steps needed for taking action. Team members are asked to fill out the questionnaire, as is the
Team pep Talk
chapter 14 Team Leadership 385
team leader. The results are fed back to the team members and team leader, allowing them to see the areas of greatest strength and weakness. It is par- ticularly important that both team leaders and team members fill out the questionnaire. Research suggests that team leaders overestimate their effec- tiveness on these dimensions and often score themselves much higher than do team members (LaFasto & Larson, 2001). By comparing the scores by leaders and by members, the leader along with team members can determine which dimensions of team or leadership effectiveness need improvement. The team and leader can then prepare action plans to correct the highest-priority problems. Such a team assessment approach is very helpful in monitoring and diagnosing team problems. It aids in determining the complex factors affect- ing team excellence to build a committed team involved in action planning.
cAse sTUDies
To improve your understanding of the team leadership model, refer to the following case studies (Cases 14.1, 14.2, and 14.3). For each case, you will be asked to put yourself in the role of team leader and apply the team lead- ership model in analyzing and offering solutions to the team problems.
Case 14.1
can This Virtual Team work?
Jim Towne heads a newly formed information technology team for a major international corporation. The team is composed of 20 profession- als who live and work in canada, the United states, europe, south america, africa, and australia. all members of the team report to Jim. The team is a virtual team connected primarily via videoconference, group decision-support software, e-mail, text, and telephone. The team has met twice in a face-to-face setting to set goals and plan. all of the team members are quite competent in their respective technical areas. some team members have a long and valued history with the company; others have recently joined the company through a corporate merger. The team members have never worked together on any projects.
The task of the team is to develop and implement technology innova- tions for all global business units. The team members are excited about the importance and the innovative nature of their assignment. They
(Continued)
386 Leadership Theory and pracTice
respect each other and enjoy being part of this team. however, the team is having difficulty getting off the ground, and the members report being extremely overloaded. Most team members travel to business sites at least 2 weeks each month. The travel is important, but it causes team members to get farther behind.
The team has one half-time secretary, located in new york. her primary responsibility is to organize travel and meetings of team members. Team members are working on several projects at once and have great diffi- culty finishing any of the projects. one team member has 500 unread e-mail messages because each team member sends copies of all messages to everyone on the team. Jim is under great pressure to prove that this team can work and provide a valuable function to the organization.
Questions
1. Which of the eight characteristics (Table 14.1) of team excellence are lacking in this team?
2. Based on this analysis of team effectiveness, should Jim intervene at this time, or should he just keep monitoring the team? if you think he should take action, at what level should he intervene (internal or external)? if internal, should his action be task or relational?
3. What specific leadership functions should Jim implement to improve the team? Why?
(continued)
Case 14.2
They Dominated the conversation
The local cancer center has a health team designed to coordinate the care of children with cancer. The team is composed of a physician, dr. sherif hidyat (a clinical oncologist); a radiologist, dr. Wayne Linett; a nurse practitioner, sharon Whittling; a social worker, cathy ing; a phys- ical therapist, nancy crosby; and a child life worker, Janet Lewis. The team members meet on a weekly basis to discuss the 18 children under their care and agree on the best course of treatment for each child. cathy ing, the social worker, is the head of the team and is responsible for the case management of each child. however, when the team meets, drs. hidyat and Linett dominate the conversation. They feel that their
chapter 14 Team Leadership 387
medical background gives them greater knowledge and skill in treating cancer in children. They welcome input from the women on the team. When it comes to making a decision, however, they insist on doing it their way for the good of the patient. cathy ing (the social worker), Janet Lewis (the child life worker), nancy crosby (the physical therapist), and sharon Whittling (the nurse practitioner) resent this behavior because they are the health care workers who spend the most time with the children and feel that they know best how to handle their long-term care. as a result, the patients feel as if no one cares or understands them. The team is also having trouble working together, and no one on the team is satisfied with the outcome.
Questions
1. how would you assess the effectiveness of this team?
2. in monitoring this team, at what level and function do you see the most serious problems? internal task? internal relational? external?
3. Would you take action to improve team functioning? if so, how would you intervene? Why?
4. What specific leadership skill or skills would you use to improve team functioning?
Case 14.3
starts with a Bang, ends with a whimper
a faculty member, Kim Green from the Management department, was asked to chair a major university committee to plan the mission of the university for the next 20 years. Three other senior faculty and seven administrators from across the campus were also asked to serve on this committee. The president of the university, dr. sulgrave, gave the commit- tee its charge: What should northcoast University be like in the year 2020? dr. sulgrave told the committee that the work of this task force was of utmost importance to the future of the university, and the charge of this committee should take precedence over all other matters. The task force was allowed to meet in the president’s conference room and use the president’s secretary. The report of the committee was due in 2 months.
(Continued)
388 Leadership Theory and pracTice
The task force members felt very good about being selected for such an important team. The team met on a weekly basis for about 2 hours each time. at first, the members were very interested in the task and partici- pated enthusiastically. They were required to do a great deal of outside research. They came back to the meetings proud to share their research and knowledge. however, after a while the meetings did not go well. The members could not seem to agree on what the charge to the team meant. They argued about what they were supposed to accomplish and resented the time the committee was taking from their regular jobs. Week after week the team met but accomplished nothing. attendance became a problem, with people skipping several meetings, showing up late, or leaving early. Team members stopped working on their commit- tee assignments. Kim didn’t want to admit to the university president that the team didn’t know what it was doing; instead, she just got more and more frustrated. Meetings became sporadic and eventually stopped altogether. The president was involved in a crisis in the university and seemed to lose interest in the committee. The president never called for the report from the committee, and the report was never completed.
Questions
1. Which characteristics of excellence were lacking in this task force?
2. Which characteristics of excellence were evident in this task force?
3. how would you assess Kim as a leader?
4. What actions would you take (internally or externally) if you were the leader of this task force?
(continued)
chapter 14 Team Leadership 389
LeADersHip insTrUmenT
Larson and LaFasto developed an assessment tool to gauge team effective- ness (a team’s health) based on their study of many different types of excel- lent organizational teams (see Larson & LaFasto, 1989). Their research demonstrated eight criteria or factors that are consistently associated with team excellence and high performance that were discussed earlier in the chapter. The complete Team Excellence Survey contains more than 40 questions across the eight factors that are used to determine a team’s per- formance level and suggest areas that might need corrective action. The eighth factor on this instrument is principled leadership. Subsequent research by LaFasto and Larson led to the development of a 42-item questionnaire focusing on this criterion of leadership. The full Collaborative Team Leader Instrument and a discussion of its reliability and validity can be found in their latest text (LaFasto & Larson, 2001). The questionnaire included here provides a sample of questions from these two surveys so that the reader can see how team and team leadership effectiveness can be evaluated. (Readers who want to assess their own organizational teams are advised to use the complete versions of both surveys.)
The team members are given the questionnaire, and their scores are com- bined and averaged to obtain a team view; the leader fills out the same questionnaire. The responses from the team leader are then compared with the team members’ responses to determine the areas of greatest weakness, if any. Based on these comparisons, the team and its leader can plan the action steps needed to correct and improve the weak areas of team functioning. The action planning is done collaboratively with leader and team members work- ing together.
The Team Excellence and Collaborative Team Leader assessments are designed as diagnostic tools to help teams sort through any problems and to pinpoint areas for action taking. The Team Excellence and Collaborative Team Leader Questionnaire provided in this chapter combines sample ques- tions from the two instruments developed by LaFasto and Larson. The first seven questions are taken from the Team Excellence Survey, developed by LaFasto and Larson in 1987 (cited in Larson & LaFasto, 1989) to measure a team’s health in terms of the criteria of team excellence (goal, structure, team members, commitment, climate, standards, and external support). Leadership is measured by the next six questions, taken from the Collaborative Team Leader Instrument developed by LaFasto and Larson
390 Leadership Theory and pracTice
in 1996 (LaFasto & Larson, 2001, pp. 151–154). These six questions assess the effectiveness of the leader in goal focusing, ensuring a collaborative cli- mate, building confidence, demonstrating know-how, setting priorities, and managing performance. All of these team and leadership factors have been found to relate to team effectiveness.
As you fill out the sample questionnaire, think about a team to which you belong or have belonged as a member or as the leader. The items that you score as 1 or 2 (False or More false than true) are the areas of team weakness from your perspective. To obtain a team assessment, you would compare your scores on this instrument with the scores of the other team members. For example, if almost everyone on the team responds with a 1 or 2 to Item 3 (“Team members possess the essential skills and abilities to accomplish the team’s objectives”), then the team leader might need to provide training to increase the competence of team members. Such an instrument that assesses team effectiveness is particularly helpful to the team leader in iden- tifying areas of team or leadership weakness and suggesting solutions for improving team effectiveness.
chapter 14 Team Leadership 391
Team excellence and collaborative Team Leader Questionnaire
Instructions: This questionnaire contains questions about your team and the leadership within this team. indicate whether you feel each statement is true or not true of your team. Use the following scale:
Key: 1 = False 2 = More false than true 3 = More true than false 4 = True
1. There is a clearly defined need—a goal to be achieved 1 2 3 4 or a purpose to be served—that justifies the existence of our team. (team: clear, elevating goal)
2. We have an established method for monitoring 1 2 3 4 individual performance and providing feedback. (team: results-driven structure)
3. Team members possess the essential skills and abilities 1 2 3 4 to accomplish the team’s objectives. (team: competent team members)
4. achieving our team goal is a higher priority than any 1 2 3 4 individual objective. (team: unified commitment)
5. We trust each other sufficiently to accurately share 1 2 3 4 information, perceptions, and feedback. (team: collaborative climate)
6. our team exerts pressure on itself to improve performance. 1 2 3 4 (team: standards of excellence)
7. our team is given the resources it needs to get the job done. 1 2 3 4 (team: external support and recognition)
8. if it’s necessary to adjust the team’s goal, our team leader 1 2 3 4 makes sure we understand why. (leadership: focus on the goal)
9. our team leader creates a safe climate for team members 1 2 3 4 to openly and supportively discuss any issue related to the team’s success. (leadership: ensure collaborative climate)
10. our team leader looks for and acknowledges contributions 1 2 3 4 by team members. (leadership: build confidence)
11. our team leader understands the technical issues we must 1 2 3 4 face in achieving our goal. (leadership: demonstrate sufficient technical know-how)
12. our team leader does not dilute our team’s effort with too 1 2 3 4 many priorities. (leadership: set priorities)
392 Leadership Theory and pracTice
13. our team leader is willing to confront and resolve issues 1 2 3 4 associated with inadequate performance by team members. (leadership: manage performance)
soUrces: Questions 1–7: adapted from the Team excellence survey (copyright 1987 LaFasto and Larson; portions reprinted with permission of profact). Questions 8–13: adapted from the collaborative Team Leader instrument (copyright 1996 LaFasto and Larson; portions reprinted with permission).
scoring interpretation
in addition to such targeted questions on each of the criteria of excellence, the complete surveys also ask open-ended questions to allow team mem- bers to comment on issues that might not be specifically covered in the directed questions, such as strengths and weaknesses of the team and its leadership, necessary changes, problematic norms, or issues that need to be addressed. The complete version of the survey is given to team members and the team leader, and all are involved in the diagnosis and the resulting action planning. such a method is clearly consistent with the empowerment movement in organizational teams and helps address the enormous com- plexity involved in making teams effective.
chapter 14 Team Leadership 393
sUmmAry
The increased importance of organizational teams and the leadership needed for them has produced a growing interest in team leadership theory. The team leadership model provides a framework in which to study the systematic factors that contribute to a team’s outcomes or general effective- ness. Within this approach, the critical function of leadership is to help the team accomplish its goals by monitoring and diagnosing the team and tak- ing the requisite action.
A strategic decision model has been developed to reveal the various decisions team leaders must make to improve their team’s effectiveness. The model describes the decisions: What type of intervention should be used (monitor- ing or action taking)? At what level should the intervention be targeted (internal or external)? What leadership function should be implemented to improve team functioning?
Questionnaires filled out by team members and the team leader can aid in diagnosing specific areas of team problems and suggest action steps to be taken by the team.
The strength of this approach is its practical focus on real-life organizational teams and their effectiveness. The model also emphasizes the functions of leadership that can be shared and distributed within the work team. The model offers guidance in selecting leaders and team members with the appropriate diagnostic and action-taking skills. Furthermore, the model is appropriately complex, providing a cognitive model for understanding and improving organizational teams.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
reFerences
Aime, F., Humphrey, S., DeRue, D. S., & Paul, J. B. (2014). The riddle of heterarchy: Power transitions in cross-functional teams. Academy of Management Journal, 57(2), 327–352.
Amos, B., & Klimoski, R. J. (2014). Courage: Making teamwork work well. Group & Organizational Management, 39(1), 110–128.
Ancona, D., Bresman, H., & Caldwell, D. (2009). The x-factor: Six steps to leading high-performing x-teams. Organizational Dynamics, 38(3), 217–224.
394 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Barge, J. K. (1996). Leadership skills and the dialectics of leadership in group decision making. In R. Y. Hirokawa & M. S. Poole (Eds.), Communication and group deci- sion making (2nd ed., pp. 301–342). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Bergman, J. Z, Rentsch, J. R., Small, E. E., Davenport, S. W., & Bergman, S. M. (2012). The shared leadership process in decision-making teams. The Journal of Social Psychology, 152(1), 17–42.
Berry, G. R. (2011). Enhancing effectiveness on virtual teams: Understanding why traditional team skills are insufficient. Journal of Business Communication, 48(2), 186–206.
Burke, C. S., Stagl, K. C., Klein, C., Goodwin, G. F., Salas, E., & Halpin, S. M. (2006). What type of leadership behaviors are functional in teams? A meta-analysis. Lead- ership Quarterly, 17, 288–307.
Cobb, A. T. (2012). Leading project teams: The basics of project management and team leadership (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Cordery, J., Soo, C., Kirkman, B., Rosen, B., & Mathieu, J. (2009). Leading paral- lel global virtual teams: Lessons from Alcoa. Organizational Dynamics, 38(3), 204–216.
Day, D. V., Gronn, P., & Salas, E. (2004). Leadership capacity in teams. Leadership Quarterly, 15, 857–880.
Drecksel, G. L. (1991). Leadership research: Some issues. Communication Yearbook, 14, 535–546.
Dyer, W. G., Dyer, W. G., Jr., & Dyer, J. H. (2007). Team building: Proven strategies for improving team performance (4th ed.). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Fisher, B. A. (1985, May). Leadership as medium: Treating complexity in group com- munication research. Small Group Behavior, 16(2), 167–196.
Fleishman, E. A., Mumford, M. D., Zaccaro, S. J., Levin, K. Y., Korotkin, A. L., & Hein, M. B. (1991). Taxonomic efforts in the description of leader behavior: A synthesis and functional interpretation. Leadership Quarterly, 2(4), 245–287.
Gouran, D. S., & Hirokawa, R. Y. (1996). Functional theory and communication in decision-making and problem-solving groups: An expanded view. In R. Y. Hiro- kawa & M. D. Poole (Eds.), Communication and group decision making (2nd ed., pp. 55–80). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Hackman, J. R. (1990). Work teams in organizations: An orienting framework. In J. R. Hackman (Ed.), Groups that work (and those that don’t): Creating conditions for effective teamwork (pp. 1–14). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Hackman, J. R. (2002). Leading teams: Setting the stage for great performances. Boston: Harvard Business School Press.
Hackman, J. R. (2012). From causes to conditions in group research. Journal of Orga- nizational Behavior, 33, 428–444.
Hackman, J. R., & Walton, R. E. (1986). Leading groups in organizations. In P. S. Goodman & Associates (Eds.), Designing effective work groups (pp. 72–119). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Hoch, J. E., & Kozlowski, W. J. (2014). Leading virtual teams: Hierarchical leadership, structural supports, and shared team leadership. Journal of Applied Psychology, 99(3), 390–403.
Hughes, R. L., Ginnett, R. C., & Curphey, G. J. (1993). Leadership: Enhancing the lessons of experience. Homewood, IL: Irwin.
chapter 14 Team Leadership 395
Hyatt, D. E., & Ruddy, T. M. (1997). An examination of the relationship between work group characteristics and performance: Once more into the breach. Person- nel Psychology, 50, 553–585.
Ilgen, D. R., Hollenbeck, J. R., Johnson, M., & Jundt, D. (2005). Teams in organiza- tions: From input–process–output models to IMOI models. Annual Review of Psychology, 56, 517–543.
Ilgen, D. R., Major, D. A., Hollenbeck, J. R., & Sego, D. J. (1993). Team research in the 1990s. In M. M. Chemers & R. Ayman (Eds.), Leadership theory and research: Perspectives and directions (pp. 245–270). San Diego, CA: Academic Press.
Kinlaw, D. C. (1998). Superior teams: What they are and how to develop them. Hamp- shire, UK: Grove.
Kozlowski, S. W. J., Watola, D. J., Jensen, J. M., Kim, B. H., & Botero, I. C. (2009). Developing adaptive teams: A theory of dynamic team leadership. In E. Salas, G. F. Goodwin, & C. S. Burke (Eds.), Team effectiveness in complex organizations: Cross–disciplinary perspectives and approaches (pp. 113–155). New York: Taylor & Francis Group.
LaFasto, F. M. J., & Larson, C. E. (1987). Team excellence survey. Denver, CO: Author.
LaFasto, F. M. J., & Larson, C. E. (1996). Collaborative team leader survey. Denver, CO: Author.
LaFasto, F. M. J., & Larson, C. E. (2001). When teams work best: 6,000 team members and leaders tell what it takes to succeed. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Larson, C. E., & LaFasto, F. M. J. (1989). Teamwork: What must go right/what can go wrong. Newbury Park, CA: SAGE.
Levi, D. (2011). Group dynamics for teams. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE. Mankin, D., Cohen, S. G., & Bikson, T. K. (1996). Teams and technology. Boston:
Harvard Business School Press. Morgeson, F. P., DeRue, D. S., & Karam, E. P. (2010). Leadership in teams: A func-
tional approach to understanding leadership structures and processes. Journal of Management, 36(1), 5–39.
Muethel, M., Gehrlein, S., Hoegl, M. (2012). Socio-demographic factors and shared leadership behaviors in dispersed teams: Implications for human resource manage- ment. Human Resource Management, 51(4), 525–548.
Nadler, D. A. (1998). Executive team effectiveness: Teamwork at the top. In D. A. Nadler & J. L. Spencer (Eds.), Executive teams (pp. 21–39). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Neck, C. P., & Manz, C. C. (1994). From groupthink to teamthink: Toward the creation of constructive thought patterns in self-managing work teams. Human Relations, 47(8), 929–952.
Parker, G. M. (1990). Team players and teamwork. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass. Pauleen, D. J. (2004). An inductively derived model of leader-initiated relationship
building with virtual team members. Journal of Management Information Systems, 20(3), 227–256.
Pearce, C. L., Manz, C. C., & Sims, H. P. (2009). Where do we go from here? Is shared leadership the key to team success? Organizational Dynamics, 38(3), 234–238.
Porter, G., & Beyerlein, M. (2000). Historic roots of team theory and practice. In M. M. Beyerlein (Ed.), Work teams: Past, present and future (pp. 3–24). Dordrecht, Netherlands: Kluwer.
396 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Salas, E., Burke, C. S., & Stagl, D. C. (2004). Developing teams and team leaders: Strategies and principles. In D. V. Day, S. J. Zaccaro, & S. M. Halpin (Eds.), Leader development for transforming organizations: Growing leaders for tomorrow (pp. 325– 355). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Solansky, S. T. (2008). Leadership style and team processes in self-managed teams. Journal of Leadership and Organizational Studies, 14(4), 332–341.
Stagl, K. C., Salas, E., & Burke, C. S. (2007). Best practices in team leadership: What team leaders do to facilitate team effectiveness. In J. A. Conger & R. E. Riggio (Eds.), The practice of leadership: Developing the next generation of leaders (pp. 172– 197). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Stewart, G. L., & Manz, C. C. (1995). Leadership for self-managing work teams: A typology and integrative model. Human Relations, 48(7), 747–770.
Thomas, G., Martin, R., & Riggio, R. E. (2013). Leading groups: Leadership as a group process. Group Processes and Intergroup Relations, 16(1), 3–16.
Tuckman, B. W., & Jensen, M. A. C. (2010). Stages of small-group development revisited. Group Facilitation: A Research and Applications Journal, 10, 43–48.
Wageman, R., Fisher, C. M., & Hackman, J. R. (2009). Leading teams when the time is right: Finding the best moments to act. Organizational Dynamics, 38(3), 192–203.
Wageman, R., Gardner, H., & Mortensen, M. (2012). The changing ecology of teams: New directions for teams research. Journal of Organizational Behavior, 33, 301– 315.
Wang, D., Waldman, D. A., & Zhang, Z. (2014). A meta-analysis of shared leadership and team effectiveness. Journal of Applied Psychology, 99(2), 181–198.
Zaccaro, S. J., Ardison, S. D., & Orvis, K. L. (2004). Leadership in virtual teams. In D. V. Day, S. J. Zaccaro, & S. M. Halpin (Eds.), Leader development for transform- ing organizations: Growing leaders for tomorrow (pp. 267–292). Mahwah, NJ: Law- rence Erlbaum.
Zaccaro, S. J., Heinen, B., & Shuffler, M. (2009). Team leadership and team effective- ness. In E. Salas, G. F. Goodwin, & C. S. Burke (Eds.), Team effectiveness in complex organizations: Cross-disciplinary perspectives and approaches (pp. 83–111). New York: Taylor & Francis Group.
Zaccaro, S. J., Rittman, A. L., & Marks, M. A. (2001). Team leadership. Leadership Quarterly, 12, 451–483.
15
Gender and Leadership
Crystal L. Hoyt and Stefanie Simon
Description
When you meet a human being, the f irst distinction you make is “male or female?” and you are accustomed to make the distinction with unhesitating certainty.
—Sigmund Freud (1965, p. 141)
While academic researchers ignored issues related to gender and leadership until the 1970s (Chemers, 1997), the increasing number of women in leader- ship positions and women in academia brought about by dramatic changes in American society have fueled the now robust scholarly interest in the study of leadership and gender.
Scholars started out asking, “Can women lead?”—a question that is now moot. In addition to the increasing presence of women in corporate and political leadership roles, we can point to highly effective female leaders including former prime ministers such as Benazir Bhutto (Pakistan), Margaret Thatcher (UK), Gro Harlem Brundtland (Norway), and Indira Gandhi (India), and current world leaders such as Chancellor Angela Merkel of Germany and President Dilma Rousseff of Brazil. Beyond politics, there
Women in Leadership
398 Leadership Theory and pracTice
are many examples of highly effective female leaders including PepsiCo’s CEO Indra Nooyi, Xerox’s CEO Ursula Burns, retired Four-Star General Ann E. Dunwoody, and retired U.S. Supreme Court Justice Sandra Day O’Connor. The primary research questions now are “Do men and women lead differently?” and “Are men more effective leaders than women?” which are often subsumed under a larger question: “Why are women underrepre- sented in elite leadership roles?” This chapter explores empirical evidence related to these issues of gender and leadership by discussing the gender gap in leadership and prominent explanations for it, and addressing approaches to promoting women in leadership.
The Glass Ceiling Turned Labyrinth
We still think of a powerful man as a born leader and a powerful woman as an anomaly.
—Margaret Atwood (Hengen & Thomson, 2007, p. 336)
evidence of the Leadership Labyrinth
Although the predicament of female leaders has improved significantly in recent decades, there is still a long way to go. Women earn 57% of the bach- elor’s degrees, 60% of the master’s degrees, and more than half of the doc- toral degrees (National Center for Education Statistics, 2011), and they make up nearly half of the U.S. labor force (46.8%; Catalyst, 2014c). However, women are still underrepresented in the upper echelons of America’s corporations and political system. Women are among the leader- ship ranks in American organizations, occupying more than half of all man- agement and professional positions (51.4%; Catalyst, 2014c) and a quarter of all CEO positions (26.8%; U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, 2013). However, more elite leadership positions show a different story; women rep- resent only 4% of Fortune 500 CEOs (Catalyst, 2014a), and hold only 16.9% of the Fortune 500 board seats and a mere 14.6% of the Fortune 500 execu- tive officer positions (Catalyst, 2014c).
On the political front, women currently occupy 100 of the 535 seats in the U.S. Congress (18.7%; 20% in the Senate and 18.4% in the House of Representatives); women of color occupy just 31 seats (Center for American Women and Politics, 2014a, 2014b). Indeed, as of April 2014, the world average of women’s representation in national legislatures or parliaments was 21.9%, with the United States ranked 84th out of 189
"Glass ceiling" Misleading
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 399
countries (Inter-Parliamentary Union, 2014). Moreover, women represent just 6.9% of military officers at the level of brigadier general and rear admiral or higher (U.S. Department of Defense, 2014).
The invisible barrier preventing women from ascending into elite leadership positions was initially dubbed the glass ceiling, a term introduced into the American vernacular by two Wall Street Journal reporters in 1986 (Hymowitz & Schellhardt, 1986). Even in female-dominated occupations, women face the glass ceiling, whereas White men appear to ride a glass escalator to the top lead- ership positions (Maume, 1999; Williams, 1992, 1995). Eagly and Carli (2007) identified limitations with the glass ceiling metaphor, including that it implies that everyone has equal access to lower positions until all women hit this single, invisible, and impassable barrier. They put forward an alternative image of a leadership labyrinth conveying the impression of a journey riddled with chal- lenges all along the way—not just near the top—that can and has been success- fully navigated by women. Related, Facebook CEO Sheryl Sandberg recently proffered the metaphor of a jungle gym in her book Lean In (2013).
Understanding the Labyrinth
The gender gap in leadership is a global phenomenon whereby women are disproportionately concentrated in lower-level and lower-authority leader- ship positions compared to men (Powell & Graves, 2003). Discussions of women’s underrepresentation in high-level leadership positions generally revolve around three types of explanations (Figure 15.1). The first set of explanations highlights differences in women’s and men’s investments in human capital. The next category of explanations considers gender differ- ences between women and men. The final type of explanation focuses on prejudice and discrimination against female leaders.
Human Capital Differences. One prominent set of explanations for the labyrinth is that women have less human capital investment in education, training, and work experience than men (Eagly & Carli, 2004, 2007). This supposed lack of human capital is said to result in a dearth of qualified women, sometimes called a “pipeline problem.” However, a closer look at the numbers reveals that women are indeed in the pipeline but that the pipeline is leaking. As already discussed, women are obtain- ing undergraduate degrees at a far higher rate than men, and women are earning professional and doctoral degrees at a rate greater than or nearly equal to that of men, but women are still vastly underrepresented in top leadership positions. In the domain of law, although women earn 47.3%
Glass ceiling Women in politics
400 Leadership Theory and pracTice
of all law degrees and make up 45% of associates, they make up only 19.9% of partners (American Bar Association, 2013). And even though women represent about one third of those graduating with MBAs from the top 10 business schools (Catalyst, 2014b), their representation in the upper echelons of American business pales in comparison to men.
Women do have somewhat less work experience and employment continuity than men, driven largely by the disproportionate responsibility women assume for child rearing and domestic duties (Bowles & McGinn, 2005; Eagly & Carli, 2007). Although men’s participation in domestic labor has increased in recent years (Galinsky, Aumann, & Bond, 2008), women con- tinue to do the majority of the child care responsibilities and household chores (Belkin, 2008; Craig, 2006; Pailhe & Solaz, 2006). Women respond to these work–home conflicts in a variety of ways (Bowles & McGinn, 2005). Some women choose not to marry or have children, others choose to become “superwomen” and attempt to excel in every role, and others take leaves of absence, take sick days, or choose part-time employment to juggle these work–home conflicts (Hewlett, 2002; Nieva & Gutek, 1981). Antiquated workplace norms make it difficult for women to rise in the leadership ranks:
Figure 15.1 Understanding the Leadership Labyrinth
Education Work Experience
Developmental Opportunities Work–Home Conflict
Style and Effectiveness Commitment and Motivation
Self-Promotion Negotiation
Traits
Gender Stereotypes Biased Perception and Evaluations
Vulnerability and Reactance Cross-Pressures
Leadership Labyrinth
Gender Differences
Human Capital
Prejudice
Gender differences perceived differences
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 401
Those who take advantage of workplace leave and flexibility programs are often marginalized, and those who take time off from their careers often find reentry difficult, returning at a lower level than the level they left (Williams, 2010). A related explanation for the leadership gap is that this culturally prescribed division of labor leads women to self-select to take themselves out of leadership tracks by choosing “mommy track” positions that do not funnel into leadership positions (Belkin, 2003); however, research does not support this argument (Eagly & Carli, 2004; Williams, 2010).
Although women occupy more than half of all management and professional positions (Catalyst, 2014c), they have fewer developmental opportunities at work than do men. Many of these gender differences in developmental opportunities may be driven in part by the prejudice women experience in the domain of lead- ership. In addition to having fewer responsibilities in the same jobs as men, women are less likely to receive encouragement, be included in key networks, and receive formal job training than their male counterparts (Knoke & Ishio, 1998; Morrison & Von Glinow, 1990; Ohlott, Ruderman, & McCauley, 1994; Powell & Graves, 2003). One important developmental experience that affects career success is effective mentor relationships (Ensher & Murphy, 2005), and women confront greater barriers to establishing informal mentor relationships than men do (Powell & Graves, 2003). Additionally, women are disproportionately repre- sented in business positions that are less visible, have less responsibility, and do not lead to top leadership positions (Bowles & McGinn, 2005). Relatedly, when women are promoted to leadership positions, they are more likely than men are to be placed on a “glass cliff,” appointed to precarious leadership situations associ- ated with greater risk and criticism (Ryan, Haslam, Hersby, & Bongiorno, 2011).
In sum, there is scant support for the notions that women receive less educa- tion than men, that they quit their jobs more often than men do, or that they opt out of the leadership track for the mommy track. There is support for the notion that women have less work experience and more career interrup- tions than men, largely because women assume significantly more domestic responsibility. Finally, women receive less formal training and have fewer developmental opportunities at work than men, both of which likely are related to prejudice against female leaders.
GenDer DiFFerences in LeaDership styLes anD eFFectiveness
Other arguments attempting to explain the leadership gap revolve around the notion that women are just different from men. One argument in this
effectiveness Barriers
402 Leadership Theory and pracTice
vein is that women’s underrepresentation in elite leadership positions is a result of differences in leadership style and effectiveness.
Increasingly, writers in the mainstream press are asserting that there are indeed gender differences in leadership styles, and that women’s leadership is more effective in contemporary society (Book, 2000; Helgesen, 1990; Rosener, 1995). Rather than explaining the leadership gap, these assertions make the gap that much more perplexing. However, academic researchers have a greater diversity in their views; indeed, many argue that gender has little or no relationship to leadership style and effectiveness (Dobbins & Platz, 1986; van Engen, Leeden, & Willemsen, 2001; Powell, 1990).
Meta-analyses of research examining style differences between women and men found that, contrary to stereotypic expectations, women were not found to lead in a more interpersonally oriented and less task-oriented manner than men in organizational studies. One robust gender difference found across settings is that women led in a more democratic, or participative, manner than men (Eagly & Johnson, 1990; van Engen & Willemsen, 2004). It is important to consider these results in conjunction with findings from a large-scale meta-analysis of the literature on evaluations of female and male leaders showing that women were devalued compared to men when they led in a masculine manner, when they occupied a typically masculine leadership role, and when the evaluators were male (Eagly, Makhijani, & Klonsky, 1992). These findings indicate that women’s greater use of democratic style appears to be adaptive in that they are using the style that produces the most favorable evaluations.
More recent research has examined gender differences in transformational leadership (Bass, 1985; Burns, 1978; see Chapter 8). A meta-analysis by Eagly, Johannesen-Schmidt, and van Engen (2003) found small but robust differences between female and male leaders on these styles such that wom- en’s styles tend to be more transformational than men’s, and women tend to engage in more contingent reward behaviors than men. Although these styles predict effectiveness, recent findings suggest that the devaluation of female leaders by male subordinates has been shown to extend to female transformational leaders (Ayman, Korabik, & Morris, 2009).
In addition to leadership style, the relative effectiveness of male and female leaders has been assessed in a number of studies ( Jacobson & Effertz, 1974; Tsui & Gutek, 1984). In a meta-analysis comparing the effectiveness of female and male leaders, men and women were equally effective leaders, overall, but there were gender differences such that women and men were more effective in leadership roles that were congruent with their gender
Women in Transformational Leadership
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 403
(Eagly, Karau, & Makhijani, 1995). Thus, women were less effective to the extent that the leader role was masculinized. For example, women were less effective than men were in military positions, but they were somewhat more effective than men were in education, government, and social service orga- nizations, and substantially more effective than men were in middle man- agement positions, where communal interpersonal skills are highly valued. In addition, women were less effective than men were when they supervised a higher proportion of male subordinates or when a greater proportion of male raters assessed the leaders’ performance.
Another oft-cited barrier to women’s advancement is the presumed gender difference in commitment to employment and motivation to lead. However, research indicates that women show the same level of identifica- tion with and commitment to paid employment roles as men do, and both women and men view their roles as workers to be secondary to their roles as parents and partners (Bielby & Bielby, 1988; Thoits, 1992). Empirical research does indicate that women are less likely than men are to promote themselves for leadership positions (Bowles & McGinn, 2005). For exam- ple, women are more likely to take on informal, as opposed to official, leadership roles, and use terms such as facilitator or organizer instead of leader (Andrews, 1992; Fletcher, 2001). A meta-analytic review of the research literature on leader emergence revealed that although women were less likely than men were to emerge as group leaders, they were more likely to serve as social facilitators than men were (Eagly & Karau, 1991). Another gender difference that advantages men in leadership is that men are more likely than women to ask for what they want (Babcock & Laschever, 2003). Reaching elite leadership positions is not done in a vac- uum; people must negotiate with others to access the right positions, expe- riences, opportunities, resources, and assistance in both the professional and domestic spheres. Not only are women less likely to negotiate than men are (Small, Gelfand, Babcock, & Gettman, 2007), the negotiations needed to ascend the leadership hierarchy often are unstructured, ambigu- ous, and rife with gender triggers (factors that prompt gender-related behavioral responses)—exactly the type of situation that particularly dis- advantages women (Bowles & McGinn, 2005).
This research must be interpreted in light of the social costs, or backlash, women experience when they promote themselves or are competent in posi- tions of authority (Rudman & Glick, 2001). Women face significant gender biases and social disincentives when they self-promote and negotiate. Unlike men, for example, self-promoting women are seen as less socially attractive and less hirable (Rudman, 1998), and women face greater social costs for initiating negotiations than men do (Bowles, Babcock, & Lai, 2007).
Global Female Leaders
404 Leadership Theory and pracTice
In sum, empirical research supports small differences in leadership style and effectiveness between men and women. Women experience slight effective- ness disadvantages in masculine leader roles, whereas roles that are more feminine offer them some advantages. Additionally, women exceed men in the use of democratic or participatory styles, and they are more likely to use transformational leadership behaviors and contingent rewards, which are styles associated with contemporary notions of effective leadership. Women are no less effective at leading than men, and women are no less committed to their jobs or motivated for leadership roles than men. However, women are less likely to self-promote and negotiate than men. Furthermore, research shows a small gender difference such that women are more likely to focus on the welfare of others and ethical behavior.
Prejudice. One prominent explanation for the leadership gap revolves around gender biases stemming from stereotyped expectations that women take care and men take charge (Hoyt & Chemers, 2008). Stereotypes are cognitive shortcuts that influence the way people process information regarding groups and group members. People assign characteristics to groups, or individual members of groups, regardless of the actual variation in characteristics between the members (Hamilton, Stroessner, & Driscoll, 1994). Gender stereotypes are pervasive, well documented, and highly resistant to change (Dodge, Gilroy, & Fenzel, 1995; Heilman, 2001). Gen- der stereotypes both describe stereotypic beliefs about the attributes of women and men, and prescribe how men and women ought to be (Burgess & Borgida, 1999; Glick & Fiske, 1999). Men are stereotyped with agentic characteristics such as confidence, assertiveness, independence, rationality, and decisiveness, whereas women are stereotyped with communal charac- teristics such as concern for others, sensitivity, warmth, helpfulness, and nurturance (Deaux & Kite, 1993; Heilman, 2001).
Gender stereotypes are easily and automatically activated, and they often lead to biased judgments (Fiske, 1998; Kunda & Spencer, 2003). In addi- tion to facing gender-based prejudice, women of color often also confront racial or ethnic prejudice (Bell & Nkomo, 2001). A vivid illustration of gender-based prejudice can be seen in the evaluation of men and women auditioning for symphony orchestras. In the 1970s and 1980s, male- dominated symphony orchestras made one simple change: All applicants were asked to audition while hidden behind a screen. This small change greatly increased the proportion of women in symphony orchestras (Goldin & Rouse, 2000). Merely seeing the applicant’s sex evoked stereo- type-based expectations in the judges’ minds that resulted in a significant bias toward selecting men.
Military Leaders stereotypes
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 405
In leadership roles, gender stereotypes are particularly damaging for women because agentic, as opposed to communal, tendencies often are indispensable (Chemers & Murphy, 1995). According to role congruity theory, the agentic qualities thought necessary in the leadership role are incompatible with the predominantly communal qualities stereotypically associated with women, thus resulting in prejudice against female leaders (Eagly & Karau, 2002). Although the masculine construal of leadership has decreased somewhat over time, it remains pervasive and robust (Koenig, Eagly, Mitchell, & Ristikari, 2011). Thus, in the leadership role, women are confronted with cross-pressures: As leaders, they should be masculine and tough, but as women, they should not be “too manly.” These opposing expectations for women often result in the perception that women are less qualified for elite leadership positions than men, and in harsh evaluations of effective female leaders for not being “female enough.”
This prejudice against female leaders helps explain the numerous findings indicating less favorable attitudes toward female than male leaders, greater difficulty for women to attain top leadership roles, and greater difficulty for women to be viewed as effective in these roles (Eagly & Karau, 2002). The penalties for violating one’s gender stereotypes are clearly illustrated in the classic 1989 Supreme Court case Price Waterhouse v. Ann Hopkins. Price Waterhouse told Hopkins that she would not make partner because she was too masculine, going as far as advising her to go to charm school, wear jewelry and makeup, and be less aggressive. In the end, the Court ruled that Price Waterhouse was discriminating based on gender stereo- types (Fiske, Bersoff, Borgida, Deaux, & Heilman, 1991). Gender bias was also evident in the media coverage of the 2008 U.S. presidential pri- maries involving Hillary Clinton. As Katie Couric noted after Clinton bowed out of contention, “One of the great lessons of that campaign is the continued and accepted role of sexism in American life, particularly the media . . . if Senator Obama had to confront the racist equivalent of an ‘Iron My Shirt’ poster at campaign rallies or a Hillary nutcracker sold at airports . . . the outrage would not be a footnote, it would be front page news” (Couric & Co., 2008).
Gender biases can be particularly detrimental in the decision-making pro- cesses for selecting elite leaders, given that the generally unstructured nature of those decisions allows biased decisions without accountability (Powell & Graves, 2003). Not only are the decision makers influenced by the stereo- types that disadvantage women in the leadership role, but also they may succumb to homosocial reproduction, a tendency for a group to reproduce itself in its own image (Kanter, 1977). People prefer similar others and report
406 Leadership Theory and pracTice
the most positive decisions about and evaluations of people who are most like them, biases that can clearly disadvantage women when male leaders are looking for replacements.
These stereotypic expectations not only affect others’ perceptions and evaluations of female leaders, but also can directly affect the women them- selves. Women who make up a very small minority of a male-dominated group are seen as tokens representing all women; they experience signifi- cant pressure as their highly visible performance is scrutinized, and they are perceived through gender-stereotyped lenses (Kanter, 1977). Women often are very aware of their gender and the accompanying stereotypes (Sekaquaptewa & Thompson, 2003). Research shows that women respond in one of two ways to the gender-based leadership stereotype: Either they demonstrate vulnerability by assimilating to the stereotype, or they react against it by engaging in stereotype-countering behaviors (Hoyt, 2010; Simon & Hoyt, 2013). Whether the threat of the gender-leader stereotype is met with vulnerability or reactance responses depends on factors such as the leader’s self-efficacy, the explicitness of the stereotype, the type of task, the group sex-composition, and the power that the leader holds (Bergeron, Block, & Echtenkamp, 2006; Davies, Spencer, & Steele, 2005; Hoyt & Blascovich, 2007, 2010; Kray, Reb, Galinsky, & Thompson, 2004; Kray, Thompson, & Galinsky, 2001). Furthermore, although female leaders may demonstrate reactance to certain solitary gender stereotype threats, when such threats are combined, women are likely to demonstrate deleterious vulnerability responses (Hoyt, Johnson, Murphy, & Skinnell, 2010). In sum, substantial empirical evidence reveals that gender stereotypes can significantly alter the perception and evaluation of female leaders and directly affect women in or aspiring to leadership roles.
Navigating the Labyrinth
The number of women who successfully navigate the labyrinth is on the rise (Eagly & Carli, 2007). A confluence of factors contributes to this increase in effective female leaders (Figure 15.2). Changes in organizations are beginning to make it easier for women to reach top positions. The cul- ture of many organizations is changing; gendered work assumptions such as the male model of work, the notion of uninterrupted full-time careers, and the separation of work and family are being challenged (Cooper & Lewis, 1999; Williams, 2010). Moreover, many organizations are valuing flexible workers and diversity in their top echelons. These organizations can augment women’s career development by involving them in career develop- ment programs and formal networks, and offering work–life support. In
stereotypes of rhetoric
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 407
addition, assigning more women to high-visibility positions and developing effective and supportive mentoring relationships for women are key strate- gies for reducing the leadership gap (Bell & Nkomo, 2001; Ensher & Murphy, 2005; Ragins, Townsend, & Mattis, 1998).
As Gloria Steinem famously noted, “We’ve begun to raise daughters more like sons . . . but few have the courage to raise our sons more like our daughters.” Increasing parity in the involvement of women and men in child care and housework will go a long way in reducing the leadership gap (Eagly & Carli, 2007). In balancing work and home life, an appealing approach for women is structural role redefinition (Hall, 1972). This approach involves negotiating with both family and colleagues to renego- tiate role expectations both at work and at home. For example, at home women can negotiate workload between spouses, team up with friends and family members, and, if able, hire help when necessary (Bowles & McGinn, 2005). At work, women can work for family-friendly reforms such as job-protected maternity leaves.
Beyond work–home issues, negotiations for valued positions, experiences, and resources are important social interactions on the road to top leadership positions. Thus, another approach to reducing the leadership gap is to enhance women’s negotiation power and restructure negotiations to their advantage (Bowles & McGinn, 2005). For example, research has shown that
Figure 15.2 Leadership effectiveness
Promoting Leadership
Effectiveness
Promoting Effective Negotiations Use of Effective Leadership Styles
Decreasing Gender Stereotypes
Diversifying Leadership Equity in Paternity/
Maternity Leave
Gender Equity in Domestic
Responsibilities
Individual Level Interpersonal Level
Societal Level Organizational Level
removing Barriers
408 Leadership Theory and pracTice
the term negotiation is laden with gendered connotations, so one approach would be to reframe negotiation situations in nongendered terms such as “asking” situations.
Women who are aware of the labyrinth may circumvent barriers by starting their own ventures (Wirth, 2001). Women-owned businesses account for 40% of all privately owned businesses, employ more than 7 million people, and generate $1.3 trillion in sales (National Association of Women Business Owners Indianapolis, 2014). Women’s successful foray into entrepreneurship is working to change the face of business, and by extension leadership, as we know it.
Many of the impediments women face in the leadership domain stem from the incongruity between the female gender role and the leadership role. Women face a double standard in the leadership role; they must come across as extremely competent but also as appropriately “feminine,” a set of stan- dards men are not held to (Eagly & Carli, 2003). One way women can increase their perceived warmth and their influence is by combining com- munal qualities such as warmth and friendliness with agentic qualities such as exceptional competence and assertiveness (Carli, 2001; Rudman & Glick, 2001). Additionally, the transformational leadership style discussed in Chapter 8 is particularly beneficial for women because it is not a markedly masculine style. This style encompasses traditionally feminine behaviors such as being considerate and supportive, and is strongly associated with leadership effectiveness. Recent research suggests that blending individual- ized consideration with inspirational motivation is prudent for women seeking leadership advancement (Vinkenburg, van Engen, Eagly, & Johannesen- Schmidt, 2011). The incongruity between the leadership role and the female gender role does appear to be decreasing (Eagly & Carli, 2007). Recent research indicates that women have become significantly more masculine— for example, becoming more assertive and valuing leadership and power more as job attributes, without losing their femininity (Konrad, Ritchie, Lieb, & Corrigall, 2000; Twenge, 2001). In addition, evidence suggests that the leadership role is starting to be seen as less masculine and more androg- ynous (Koenig et al., 2011; Schein, 2001).
In sum, we likely will see more women in elite leadership roles with (1) changes in workplace norms and developmental opportunities for women, (2) greater gender equity in domestic responsibilities, (3) greater negotiation power of women, especially regarding the work–home balance, (4) the effectiveness and predominance of women-owned businesses, and (5) changes in the incongruity between women and leadership.
Women changing the Tone Gender and Workgroup performance
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 409
strenGths
Understanding the research into gender and leadership can help us promote more women into the upper echelons of leadership. Doing so will fulfill the promise of equal opportunity by allowing everyone the possibility of taking on leadership roles, from the boardroom to the Senate floor. This larger and more demographically diverse pool of candidates not only makes it easier to find talented people, but it also facilitates greater levels of organizational success. Furthermore, promoting a richly diverse group of women into lead- ership roles will not only help make societal institutions, businesses, and governments more representative, but it can also contribute to more ethical, productive, innovative, and financially successful organizations that demon- strate higher levels of collective intelligence and are less rife with conflict (Bernardi, Bosco, & Columb, 2009; Catalyst, 2004; Forsyth, 2010; Miller & Del Carmen Triana, 2009; Nielsen & Huse, 2010; Woolley, Chabris, Pentland, Hashmi, & Malone, 2010).
A consideration of the effects of gender on leadership has important implica- tions for a comprehensive understanding of leadership. Contemporary approaches to gender and leadership involve questions that directly affect lead- ership success, such as style and effectiveness differences between men and women, and the varied barriers confronting women. Gender is integral to con- temporary notions of effective leadership styles that have morphed from a tra- ditional masculine, autocratic style to the more feminine or androgynous styles of democratic and transformational leadership. Developing a more androgy- nous conception of leadership will enhance leadership effectiveness by giving people the opportunity to engage in the best leadership practices, and not by restricting people to those behaviors that are most appropriate for their gender.
Research on gender and leadership is productive in both dispelling myths about the gender gap and shining a light on aspects of the gender barriers that are difficult to see and therefore are often overlooked. For example, gender biases generally are no longer overt but more often take the form of subtle and implicit preconceptions and institutionalized discrimination, making them particularly potent and pernicious. These biases have a detri- mental impact on the perception and evaluation of women, and they limit the range of leadership behavior deemed appropriate for women. In addi- tion, the mere awareness of these gender biases can be detrimental to women performing in leadership roles. The changes needed to overcome these prob- lems within organizations and society can occur only when we are aware of these often subtle and disguised prejudices.
non-Traditional Gender Leader roles
Gender in organizations
410 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Understanding the many components of the labyrinth will give us the tools necessary to combat this inequality from many perspectives, including indi- vidual, interpersonal, organizational, and societal approaches. In addition, this research addresses larger, more significant considerations about gender and social systems. For example, it acknowledges the profound power divi- sion between men and women, and it opens up dialogue on structural ques- tions such as the gendered division of work in society. By acknowledging and attempting to understand issues of gender and leadership, rather than ignor- ing them, we can help ensure that women have equal opportunity in attain- ing influential leadership positions, that organizations and constituents have access to the greatest talent pool when selecting leaders, and that there is greater gender diversity in the ranks of leadership, which has been linked to organizational success.
criticisms
Issues of gender and leadership can be subsumed under a more general topic of leadership and diversity. This perspective involves an understanding of the impact of various demographic characteristics on leadership, includ- ing—but not limited to—gender, race, ethnicity, and sexual orientation (Chemers & Murphy, 1995; Hoyt & Chemers, 2008). However, unlike the research examining gender and leadership, research into minority leaders is scant (Hoyt & Chemers, 2008). Although some of the issues surrounding minorities in leadership may bear similarities to those surrounding women (e.g., minorities also face negative stereotypes and resulting difficulties ascending the leadership hierarchy), the underlying dynamics and mecha- nisms are no doubt distinct (Gurin, 1985; Stangor, Lynch, Duan, & Glass, 1992). Leadership researchers should put a greater emphasis on under- standing the role of race, ethnicity, sexual orientation, and other types of diversity, as well as important interactive effects between, for example, race and gender (Smith & Stewart, 1983), in leadership processes.
Much of the research examining gender in leadership has taken place in Western contexts; research on gender and leadership in other contexts is sparse. Because most of the findings regarding female leaders stem from the culturally defined role of women in society, many of the findings dis- cussed in this chapter will not generalize well across cultures in which the roles of women and men differ. Therefore, we must realize the limited generalizability of the extant literature on gender and leadership, and researchers should expand their purview to address gender and leadership from a cross-cultural perspective. A final criticism concerns the dearth of
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 411
essential, complementary research agendas on the domestic sphere. Research on gender and leadership focuses on decreasing the gender gap in leadership positions, thereby lessening gender segregation at work; how- ever, the leadership gap will not be closed without a concurrent focus on closing the gender gap at home.
appLication
Although the gender gap in influential leadership positions remains clearly visible, there is evidence that it is starting to close. Understanding the obstacles that make up the labyrinth and tactics to eradicate the inequality will make it easier for women to reach top positions. The labyrinth has many barriers, and the necessary changes occur at many levels, ranging from individual and interpersonal levels to organizational and societal levels. Prejudice plays an important role in the interpersonal and individual levels; the first step in dealing with these biases is to become aware of them in others and in ourselves. Women are faced with the problem of needing to bolster their leadership competence with appropriate “femaleness”: Adopting behaviors such as individualized consideration and inspirational motivation is a promising approach to overcome these biased expectations. In addition, women’s use of effective negotiation techniques can aid them in procuring the resources they need at work and at home to augment their leadership advancement.
Changes are also taking place at more macro-organizational and societal levels that will contribute to greater gender equality in leadership. For exam- ple, changes in organizational culture, women’s career development, mentor- ing opportunities for women, and increased numbers of women in strategic positions will increase the presence of women in prominent leadership roles. At the societal level, structural changes regarding a more equitable distribu- tion of child rearing and domestic duties are also contributing to the influx of women into elite positions.
case stUDies
In the following section, three case studies (Cases 15.1, 15.2, and 15.3) are presented to provide practice in diagnosing and making recommendations on situations confronting female leaders in organizations. The first case is about a market analyst in a Wall Street firm, the second case is about a
improving Gender equality
412 Leadership Theory and pracTice
meeting of probation managers, and the third case is about a senior manag- ing director at a manufacturing company. After each case, questions are provided to assist your analysis of the case. All cases were adapted from Blank and Slipp (1994).1
Case 15.1
the “Glass ceiling”
Lisa Weber never doubted that she would be a partner in her Wall street firm. a graduate of a prestigious business school with a doctorate in economics, she had taught briefly at a major university. she was the first woman hired as a market analyst in her well-regarded firm. Within two years, she has become one of four senior portfolio managers reporting directly to a senior partner. her clients give her the highest commenda- tions for her outstanding performance; over the past two years, she has brought in the largest number of new accounts to the firm.
despite the admiration of her colleagues and their seeming acceptance of her, there is a disturbing, if flattering, aspect to her job. Most of her peers and some of the partners visit her office during the day to discuss in private her opinions on market performance and financial projections. she enjoys these private sessions but is dismayed that at the weekly staff meetings the ceo, Michael Breyer, usually says something like, “oK, let’s get started and bring Lisa up to date on some of the trouble spots.” none of her peers or the partners mention that Lisa knows as much as they do about what’s going on in the firm. she never protests this slight to her competence and knowledge of firm business, nor does she mention the almost-daily private meetings where her advice is sought. as the only woman on the executive level, she prefers to be considered a team player and one of the boys.
in the past year, one of her peers has been promoted to partner, although Lisa’s performance clearly surpassed his, as measured by the success of her accounts and the amount of new business she brought to the firm. having heard no mention of partnership for herself, she approached her boss, one of the partners, and asked about the path to a partnership. he replied, “you’re doing great, Lisa, but professors do not partners make. What happens if you are a partner and you make a huge mistake? how would you take it? and what about our clients? There’s never been a female partner in the 103 years of our firm.”
shortly thereafter, another woman, pamela Tobias, was hired as a mar- keting analyst. once, when the ceo saw Lisa and pamela together, he called out to the men, “hey, guys, two women in one room. That’s scary.”
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 413
during the next six months, Lisa meets several times with the ceo to make her case for a partnership on the basis of her performance. she finally realizes that there is no possibility of change in the foreseeable future and decides to leave and form her own investment firm.
soUrce: adapted from Blank and slipp (1994).
Questions
1. What advancement barriers did Lisa encounter?
2. What should the firm’s top executives, including Michael, have done differently to retain Lisa?
3. What type of organizational policies and opportunities might have benefited Lisa and pamela?
4. What could the organization do to raise the gender consciousness of Michael and Lisa’s male colleagues?
Case 15.2
Lack of inclusion and credibility
Lori Bradley, an experienced probation officer, is meeting with Ted stolze and ian Bateson, two other probation officers, and their supervisor, Len duggan, the assistant chief of probation. They are planning an orienta- tion session for new probation officers on how to prepare investigative reports for the court.
as Lori enters the room, Ted and ian are throwing paper clips at each other and laughing about a major play in the previous night’s nFL championship game. They continue talking as she enters the room, ignoring her. When Len enters, the two men include him in their talk about the game.
after a few minutes, Len says, “oK, let’s get down to business and start planning the orientation session. any ideas?”
Lori says, “i looked again at the session prepared by columbia county, which was described at our last meeting, and i think we should use that. it worked well for them and seems to fit our county.” no one looks at
414 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Lori or responds to her, but Ted begins making some suggestions for a different idea, and the others follow up with questions to him. after problems arise with Ted’s suggestion, ian says, “My idea would be to go for the columbia county plan. That would work best here.” Len, the assistant chief, says, “ian, i’ll go with your judgment.” Ted says, “Me, too. Great idea, ian.”
Lori breaks in, “But that’s what i proposed initially, and you just ignored me.” ian says, “stop being so sensitive, Lori. We’re supposed to be a team here.”
soUrce: adapted from Blank and slipp (1994).
Questions
1. What advancement barriers is Lori encountering?
2. What should Lori’s male coworkers have done when Lori entered the room?
3. how should Len have behaved to provide a role model for Lori’s male colleagues? What should Len have said after ian made the same rec- ommendation that Lori did?
4. What could the organization do to foster the effectiveness of all four managers?
Case 15.3
pregnancy as a Barrier to Job status
Marina soslow is a senior managing director at a manufacturing com- pany. she has worked at the company for 10 years, gradually working her way up to a responsible position. she would like to win promotion to a top executive position and has recently finished an MBa, which sup- plements her master’s degree in chemical engineering.
several months ago, she found out she was pregnant. she is reluctant to tell her boss, roy Bond, the division head, because she knows several other women who were eased out of their positions before they gave birth or shortly thereafter.
after a meeting with roy about a new product, Marina mentions her pregnancy and says that she plans to take a three-month leave of absence
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 415
after her delivery. she begins describing the plans she has carefully worked out for distributing her work. roy cuts her short and says, “i knew this was going to happen sooner or later; it always does.” he says this as if a disaster is about to occur. “There’s no point in talking about this now. We’ll think about it later.”
Marina can tell that he’s very annoyed about what he thinks is going to happen. she can see his wheels spinning and worries about the implica- tions for her. she thinks, “doesn’t roy know about the Family and Medical Leave act of 1993? Legally, this company has to guarantee my job, but i know he can make it very rough for me.”
soUrce: adapted from Blank and slipp (1994).
Questions
1. What advancement barriers is Marina encountering?
2. What should roy have said when Marina told him she was pregnant?
3. What could roy do to ensure that Marina’s work will be covered dur- ing her absence and that taking this time off will not hurt her advancement?
4. What type of organizational changes can be made to benefit Marina and other pregnant women in this organization?
LeaDership instrUment
The Implicit Association Test (IAT) was developed by Anthony Greenwald, Mahzarin Banaji, and Brian Nosek to measure automatic associations by examining reaction times when people classify pictures or words (see Greenwald, McGhee, & Schwartz, 1998). This gender IAT was modified from a version developed by Dasgupta and Asgari (2004) to examine the gender stereotypical associations that contribute to the bias against women as leaders (Eagly & Karau, 2002).
416 Leadership Theory and pracTice
the Gender–Leader implicit association test
Instructions: This exercise begins with a practice trial. Using a pencil, clas- sify each of the words in the middle column into one of the two catego- ries indicated, Flower or Insect, by putting a check mark in the column to the left or the right. please do this task as quickly as possible, taking care not to skip over any words.
practice trial
Flower Insect
Rose
Lily
Dragonfly
Beetle
Gnat
Daffodil
Mosquito
Daisy
Roach
Tulip
you will now complete the two test trials; you will need a stopwatch for this portion of the test. For these test trials, the categories are Male or Female and Leader or supporter, and the categories will be combined. if the word you read belongs to the Male or the Leader category, put a check in the left col- umn; if it belongs to the Female or the Supporter category, put a check in the right column. you will record how long it takes you to complete this task by starting your stopwatch when you begin and stopping it after you make your final classification. remember to work as quickly as possible, without skipping any words.
test trial a
Male or Leader Female or Supporter
Emily
Josh
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 417
Male or Leader Female or Supporter
Supporter
Leader
Brandon
Ambitious
Peter
Determined
Donna
Debbie
Helpful
Dynamic
Understanding
Katherine
Ian
Sympathetic
Compassionate
Jane
Andrew
Assertive
Time to complete Test Trial a: _______________
you will do this same task a second time, but this time the combination of categories has been switched. if the word you read belongs to the Male or the Supporter category, put a check in the left column; if it belongs to the Female or the Leader category, put a check in the right column. again, use your stop- watch to time how long it takes you to complete the task.
test trial B
Male or Supporter Female or Leader
Supporter
Emily
Josh
Leader
(Continued)
418 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Male or Supporter Female or Leader
Ambitious
Brandon
Peter
Donna
Helpful
Determined
Dynamic
Assertive
Debbie
Katherine
Understanding
Ian
Sympathetic
Andrew
Compassionate
Jane
Time to complete Test Trial B: _______________
scoring
The logic behind the iaT is that the longer it takes to categorize the words when the categories have counterstereotypical pairings (i.e., Female and Leader, Male and Supporter) compared with stereotypical pairings, the more one automatically associates women with supportive qualities as opposed to leadership qualities.
The gender bias effect is computed by subtracting the time it took to complete Trial a (the stereotype congruent task) from the time to complete Trial B (the stereotype incongruent task). positive scores reflect automatic associations between Female and Supporter and between Male and Leader. Many people are surprised to find out that they have a biased association favoring males and leadership, especially when it is incompatible with their stated egalitarian values. This test is designed to show people that they might hold associations that they are unaware of and to make people aware of the broad reach of these stereotypes. please see the iaT website at harvard University (https:// implicit.harvard.edu) for more information on the iaT and a more detailed understanding of the results.
(Continued)
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 419
sUmmary
Women are significantly underrepresented in major leadership positions. The barriers women encounter on their leadership journey have been dubbed the leadership labyrinth. Removing these barriers will help ensure equal opportunity, access to the greatest talent pool, and diversity, which have been linked to organizational success. There are a number of explana- tions for the leadership gender gap. One set of explanations focuses on women’s lack of human capital investment in education, training, and work experience. There is no empirical support for the argument that women are less educated than men are or that they are more likely to quit their jobs or choose the mommy track. There is evidence that women assume signifi- cantly more domestic responsibility, which contributes to less work experi- ence and more career interruptions. Additionally, women receive less formal training and have fewer developmental opportunities at work than men.
Another set of explanations for the gender gap focuses on differences between women and men. Women are no less effective at leadership, com- mitted to their work, or motivated to attain leadership roles than men. However, women are less likely to self-promote than men are, and they are less likely to initiate negotiation, an important tool all leaders need in order to access the right opportunities and resources in both the profes- sional and domestic spheres. Investigations into leadership style have revealed that women are somewhat more likely to use democratic and transformational styles than men are. Research looking at leadership effec- tiveness indicates a greater use by women of effective transformational and contingent reward behaviors.
The prejudice explanation for the leadership gap is strongly supported. Gender stereotypes of women as communal and men as agentic are particularly dam- aging to women in leadership. The incongruity between the female gender role and the leadership role leads to prejudice against female leaders, who are evaluated and perceived more negatively than their male counterparts. These biases are particularly detrimental during unstructured decision-making pro- cesses that often occur when elite leaders are selected. Gender-based leader stereotypes can threaten women eliciting either a vulnerable or a reactance response. There is evidence that this discrepancy is on the decline as the leader role becomes more androgynous and women become more agentic.
Finally, there are a number of approaches to navigating the labyrinth. Significant organizational reform will make it easier for women to reach top positions—including changes in workplace norms, changes in organizational
420 Leadership Theory and pracTice
culture, increases in career development for women, increases in effective mentoring opportunities, and women taking more strategic positions lead- ing to higher leadership roles. Effective negotiations will help decrease the gender gap, especially negotiations regarding role expectations at work and at home. Additionally, the combination of warmth with agentic qualities and in particular the melding of individualized consideration with inspirational motivation can be effective for developing female leaders.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
note
1. Adapted from Voices of Diversity. Copyright 1994 by Renee Blank and Sandra Slipp. Reprinted by permission of AMACOM, a division of American Management Association International, New York, NY. All rights reserved. http://www.amanet.org.
reFerences
American Bar Association. (2013). Commission on women in the profession: A current glance at women in the law 2013. Retrieved from http://www.americanbar.org/ content/dam/aba/marketing/women/current_glance_statistics_feb2013.auth checkdam.pdf
Andrews, P. H. (1992). Sex and gender differences in group communication: Impact on the facilitation process. Small Group Research, 23, 74–94.
Ayman, R., Korabik, K., & Morris, S. (2009). Is transformational leadership always perceived as effective? Male subordinates’ devaluation of female transformational leaders. Journal of Applied Social Psychology, 39, 852–879.
Babcock, L., & Laschever, S. (2003). Women don’t ask: Negotiation and the gender divide. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Bass, B. M. (1985). Leadership: Good, better, best. Organizational Dynamics, 13, 26–40. Belkin, L. (2003, October 26). The opt-out revolution. The New York Times, p. 42. Belkin, L. (2008, June 15). When mom and dad share it all. The New York Times.
Retrieved from http://www.nytimes.com/2008/06/15/magazine/15parenting-t .html?ref=jobs&pagewanted=all
Bell, E., & Nkomo, S. (2001). Our separate ways: Black and white women and the struggle for professional identity. Boston: Harvard Business School Press.
Bergeron, D. M., Block, C. J., & Echtenkamp, B. A. (2006). Disabling the able: Ste- reotype threat and women’s work performance. Human Performance, 19, 133–158.
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 421
Bernardi, R. A., Bosco, S. M., & Columb, V. L. (2009). Does female representation on boards of directors associate with the “Most Ethical Companies” list? Corporate Reputation Review, 12, 270–280.
Bielby, D. D., & Bielby, W. T. (1988). She works hard for the money: Household responsibilities and the allocation of work effort. American Journal of Sociology, 93, 1031–1059.
Blank, R., & Slipp, S. (1994). Voices of diversity. New York: AMACOM. Book, E. W. (2000). Why the best man for the job is a woman. New York: HarperCollins. Bowles, H. R., Babcock, L., & Lai, L. (2007). Social incentives for gender differences
in the propensity to initiate negotiations: Sometimes it does hurt to ask. Organi- zational Behavior and Human Decision Processes, 103, 84–103.
Bowles, H. R., & McGinn, K. L. (2005). Claiming authority: Negotiating challenges for women leaders. In D. M. Messick & R. M. Kramer (Eds.), The psychology of leadership: New perspectives and research (pp. 191–208). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Burgess, D., & Borgida, E. (1999). Who women are, who women should be: Descrip- tive and prescriptive gender stereotyping in sex discrimination. Psychology, Public Policy, & Law, 5, 665–692.
Burns, J. M. (1978). Leadership. New York: Plenum. Carli, L. L. (2001). Gender and social influence. Journal of Social Issues, 57, 725–741. Catalyst. (2004). The bottom line: Connecting corporate performance and gender diversity.
New York: Author. Catalyst. (2014a). Fortune 500 CEO positions held by women. Retrieved from http://
www.catalyst.org/knowledge/fortune-500-ceo-positions-held-women Catalyst. (2014b). Women MBAs. Retrieved from http://www.catalyst.org/knowledge/
women-mbas Catalyst. (2014c). U.S. women in business. Retrieved from http://www.catalyst.org/
knowledge/us-women-business Center for American Women and Politics. (2014a). Women in elective off ice 2014.
Retrieved from http://www.cawp.rutgers.edu/fast_facts/levels_of_office/docu- ments/elective.pdf
Center for American Women and Politics. (2014b). Women of color in elective off ice 2014. Retrieved from http://www.cawp.rutgers.edu/fast_facts/levels_of_office/ documents/color.pdf
Chemers, M. M. (1997). An integrative theory of leadership. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Chemers, M. M., & Murphy, S. E. (1995). Leadership and diversity in groups and organizations. In M. M. Chemers, S. Oskamp, & M. A. Constanzo (Eds.), Diver- sity in organizations: New perspectives for a changing workplace (pp. 157–190). Thou- sand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Cooper, C. L., & Lewis, S. (1999). Gender and the changing nature of work. In G. N. Powell (Ed.), Handbook of gender and work (pp. 37–46). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Couric & Co. (2008). Katie Couric’s notebook: Sexism and politics. Retrieved from http://www.cbsnews.com/blogs/2008/06/11/couricandco/entry4174429.shtml
Craig, L. (2006). Does father care mean fathers share? A comparison of how mothers and fathers in intact families spend time with children. Gender and Society, 20, 259–281.
422 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Dasgupta, N., & Asgari, S. (2004). Seeing is believing: Exposure to counterstereotypic women leaders and its effect on automatic gender stereotyping. Journal of Exper- imental Social Psychology, 40, 642–658.
Davies, P. G., Spencer, S. J., & Steele, C. M. (2005). Clearing the air: Identity safety moderates the effects of stereotype threat on women’s leadership aspirations. Jour- nal of Personality and Social Psychology, 88, 276–287.
Deaux, K., & Kite, M. (1993). Gender stereotypes. In F. L. Denmark & M. Paludi (Eds.), Psychology of women: A handbook of theory and issues (pp. 107–139). Westport, CT: Greenwood.
Dobbins, G. H., & Platz, S. J. (1986). Sex differences in leadership: How real are they? Academy of Management Review, 11, 118–127.
Dodge, K. A., Gilroy, F. D., & Fenzel, L. M. (1995). Requisite management charac- teristics revisited: Two decades later. Journal of Social Behavior and Personality, 10, 253–264.
Eagly, A. H., & Carli, L. L. (2003). The female leadership advantage: An evaluation of the evidence. Leadership Quarterly, 14, 807–834.
Eagly, A. H., & Carli, L. L. (2004). Women and men as leaders. In J. Antonakis, R. J. Sternberg, & A. T. Cianciolo (Eds.), The nature of leadership (pp. 279–301). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Eagly, A. H., & Carli, L. L. (2007). Through the labyrinth: The truth about how women become leaders. Boston: Harvard Business School Press.
Eagly, A. H., Johannesen-Schmidt, M. C., & van Engen, M. (2003). Transformational, transactional, and laissez-faire leadership styles: A meta-analysis comparing women and men. Psychological Bulletin, 129, 569–591.
Eagly, A. H., & Johnson, B. T. (1990). Gender and leadership style: A meta-analysis. Psychological Bulletin, 108, 233–256.
Eagly, A. H., & Karau, S. J. (1991). Gender and the emergence of leaders: A meta- analysis. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 60, 685–710.
Eagly, A. H., & Karau, S. J. (2002). Role congruity theory of prejudice toward female leaders. Psychological Review, 109, 573–598.
Eagly, A. H., Karau, S. J., & Makhijani, M. G. (1995). Gender and the effectiveness of leaders: A meta-analysis. Psychological Bulletin, 117, 125–145.
Eagly, A. H., Makhijani, M., & Klonsky, B. (1992). Gender and the evaluation of leaders: A meta-analysis. Psychological Bulletin, 111, 3–22.
Ensher, E. A., & Murphy, S. E. (2005). Power mentoring: How successful mentors and protégés get the most out of their relationships. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Fiske, S. (1998). Stereotyping, prejudice, and discrimination. In D. T. Gilbert, S. T. Fiske, & G. Lindzey (Eds.), The handbook of social psychology (4th ed., Vol. 2, pp. 982–1026). Boston: McGraw-Hill.
Fiske, S., Bersoff, D. N., Borgida, E., Deaux, K., & Heilman, M. E. (1991). Social science research on trial: Use of sex stereotyping research in Price Waterhouse v. Hopkins. American Psychologist, 46, 1049–1060.
Fletcher, J. K. (2001). Disappearing acts: Gender, power, and relational practice at work. Boston: MIT Press.
Forsyth, D. R. (2010). Group dynamics (5th ed.). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth. Freud, S. (1965). New introductory lectures on psychoanalysis: Femininity. New York: Norton.
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 423
Galinsky, E., Aumann, K., & Bond, J. (2008). Times are changing: Gender and genera- tion at work and at home. Retrieved from http://familiesandwork.org/site/research/ reports/Times_Are_Changing.pdf
Glick, P., & Fiske, S. T. (1999). Sexism and other “isms”: Independence, status, and the ambivalent content of stereotypes. In W. B. Swann, Jr., & J. H. Langlois (Eds.), Sexism and stereotypes in modern society: The gender science of Janet Taylor Spence (pp. 193–221). Washington, DC: American Psychological Association.
Goldin, C., & Rouse, C. (2000). Orchestrating impartiality: The impact of “blind” auditions on female musicians. American Economic Review, 90, 715–741.
Greenwald, A. G., McGhee, D. E., & Schwartz, J. L. K. (1998). Measuring individual differences in implicit cognition: The implicit association test. Journal of Personal- ity and Social Psychology, 74, 1464–1480.
Gurin, P. (1985). Women’s gender consciousness. Public Opinion Quarterly, 49, 143– 163.
Hall, D. T. (1972). A model of coping with role conflict: The role behavior of college- educated women. Administrative Science Quarterly, 17, 471–486.
Hamilton, D. L., Stroessner, S. J., & Driscoll, D. M. (1994). Social cognition and the study of stereotyping. In P. G. Devine, D. L. Hamilton, & T. M. Ostrom (Eds.), Social cognition: Impact on social psychology (pp. 291–321). New York: Academic Press.
Heilman, M. E. (2001). Description and prescription: How gender stereotypes prevent women’s ascent up the organizational ladder. Journal of Social Issues, 57, 657–674.
Helgesen, S. (1990). The female advantage: Women’s ways of leadership. New York: Doubleday.
Hengen, S., & Thomson, A. (Eds.). (2007). Margaret Atwood: A reference guide, 1988– 2005. Lanham, MD: Scarecrow Press.
Hewlett, S. A. (2002). Creating a life: Professional women and the quest for children. New York: Talk Miramax.
Hoyt, C. L. (2010). Women, men, and leadership: Exploring the gender gap at the top. Social and Personality Psychology Compass, 4, 484–498.
Hoyt, C., & Blascovich, J. (2007). Leadership efficacy and women leaders’ responses to stereotype activation. Group Processes and Intergroup Relations, 10, 595–616.
Hoyt, C., & Blascovich, J. (2010). The role of self-efficacy and stereotype activation on cardiovascular, behavioral and self-report responses in the leadership domain. Leadership Quarterly, 21, 89–103.
Hoyt, C. L., & Chemers, M. M. (2008). Social stigma and leadership: A long climb up a slippery ladder. In C. L. Hoyt, G. R. Goethals, & D. R. Forsyth (Eds.), Leadership at the crossroads: Leadership and psychology (Vol. 1, pp. 165–180). West- port, CT: Praeger.
Hoyt, C., Johnson, S., Murphy, S., & Skinnell, K. (2010). The impact of blatant ste- reotype activation and group sex-composition on female leaders. Leadership Quar- terly, 21, 716–732.
Hymowitz, C., & Schellhardt, T. D. (1986, March 24). The glass ceiling: Why women can’t seem to break the invisible barrier that blocks them from the top jobs. The Wall Street Journal, pp. D1, D4–D5.
Inter-Parliamentary Union. (2014). Women in national parliaments. Retrieved from http://www.ipu.org/wmn-e/classif.htm
424 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Jacobson, M. B., & Effertz, J. (1974). Sex roles and leadership perceptions of the leaders and the led. Organizational Behavior and Human Performance, 12, 383–396.
Kanter, R. (1977). Men and women of the corporation. New York: Basic Books. Knoke, D., & Ishio, Y. (1998). The gender gap in company job training. Work and
Occupations, 25, 141–167. Koenig, A. M., Eagly, A. H., Mitchell, A. A., & Ristikari, T. (2011). Are leader ste-
reotypes masculine? A meta-analysis of three research paradigms. Psychological Bulletin, 137, 616–642.
Konrad, A. M., Ritchie, J. E., Jr., Lieb, P., & Corrigall, E. (2000). Sex differences and similarities in job attribute preferences: A meta-analysis. Psychological Bulletin, 126, 593–641.
Kray, L., Reb, J., Galinsky, A., & Thompson, L. (2004). Stereotype reactance at the bargaining table: The effect of stereotype activation and power on claiming and creating value. Personality and Social Psychology Bulletin, 30, 399–411.
Kray, L. J., Thompson, L., & Galinsky, A. (2001). Battle of the sexes: Gender stereo- type confirmation and reactance in negotiations. Journal of Personality & Social Psychology, 80, 942–958.
Kunda, Z., & Spencer, S. J. (2003). When do stereotypes come to mind and when do they color judgment? A goal-based theory of stereotype activation and application. Psychological Bulletin, 129, 522–544.
Maume, D. J., Jr. (1999). Glass ceilings and glass escalators. Work & Occupations, 26, 483. Miller, T., & Del Carmen Triana, M. (2009). Demographic diversity in the board-
room: Mediators of the board diversity-firm performance relationship. Journal of Management Studies, 46, 755–786.
Morrison, A., & Von Glinow, M. A. (1990). Women and minorities in management. American Psychologist, 45, 200–208.
National Association of Women Business Owners Indianapolis. (2014). Women- owned businesses key facts. Retrieved from http://www.nawboindy.org/pagesroot/ Pages/AboutWBOKeyFacts.aspx
National Center for Education Statistics. (2011). Table 317: Bachelor’s, master’s, and doctor’s degrees conferred by degree-granting institutions, by sex of student and discipline division: 2010–11. Digest of Education Statistics. Retrieved from http:// nces.ed.gov/programs/digest/d12/tables/dt12_317.asp
Nielsen, S., & Huse, M. (2010). The contribution of women on boards of directors: Going beyond the surface. Corporate Governance—An International Review, 18, 136–148.
Nieva, V. E., & Gutek, B. A. (1981). Women and work: A psychological perspective. New York: Praeger.
Ohlott, P. J., Ruderman, M. N., & McCauley, C. D. (1994). Gender differences in managers’ developmental job experiences. Academy of Management Journal, 37, 46–67.
Pailhe, A., & Solaz, A. (2006). Time with children: Do fathers and mothers replace each other when one parent is unemployed? European Journal of Population, 24, 211–236. doi:10.1007/s10680–007–9143–5
Powell, G. N. (1990). One more time: Do female and male managers differ? Academy of Management Executive, 4, 68–75.
chapter 15 Gender and Leadership 425
Powell, G. N., & Graves, L. M. (2003). Women and men in management (3rd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Ragins, B. R., Townsend, B., & Mattis, M. (1998). Gender gap in the executive suite: CEOs and female executives report on breaking the glass ceiling. Academy of Management Executive, 12, 28–42.
Rosener, J. (1995). America’s competitive secret: Utilizing women as a management strat- egy. New York: Oxford University Press.
Rudman, L. A. (1998). Self-promotion as a risk factor for women: The costs and benefits of counter-stereotypical impression management. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 74, 629–645.
Rudman, L. A., & Glick, P. (2001). Prescriptive gender stereotypes and backlash toward agentic women. Journal of Social Issues, 57, 743–762.
Ryan, M. K., Haslam, S. A., Hersby, M. D., & Bongiorno, R. (2011). Think crisis– think female: The glass cliff and contextual variation in the think manager–think male stereotype. Journal of Applied Psychology, 96, 470–484.
Sandberg, S. (2013). Lean in: Women, work, and the will to lead. New York: Knopf. Schein, V. E. (2001). A global look at psychological barriers to women’s progress in
management. Journal of Social Issues, 57, 675–688. Sekaquaptewa, D., & Thompson, M. (2003). Solo status, stereotype threat, and per-
formance expectancies: Their effects on women’s performance. Journal of Experi- mental Social Psychology, 39, 68–74.
Simon, S., & Hoyt, C. L. (2013). Exploring the effect of media images on women’s leadership self-perceptions and aspirations. Group Processes & Intergroup Rela- tions, 16, 232–245.
Small, D. A., Gelfand, M., Babcock, L., & Gettman, H. (2007). Who goes to the bargaining table? The influence of gender and framing on the initiation of nego- tiation. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 93, 600–613.
Smith, A., & Stewart, A. J. (1983). Approaches to studying racism and sexism in black women’s lives. Journal of Social Issues, 39, 1–15.
Stangor, C., Lynch, L., Duan, C., & Glass, B. (1992). Categorization of individuals on the basis of multiple social features. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 62, 207–218.
Thoits, P. A. (1992). Identity structures and psychological well-being: Gender and marital status comparisons. Social Psychology Quarterly, 55, 236–256.
Tsui, A. S., & Gutek, B. A. (1984). A role set analysis of gender differences in per- formance, affective relationship, and career success of industrial middle managers. Academy of Management Journal, 27, 619–635.
Twenge, J. M. (2001). Change in women’s assertiveness in response to status and roles: A cross-temporal meta-analysis, 1931–1993. Journal of Personality and Social Psy- chology, 81, 133–145.
U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics. (2013). Table 11: Employed persons by detailed occu- pation, sex, race, and Hispanic or Latino ethnicity. Current Population Survey, Annual Averages: Household Data. Retrieved from http://www.bls.gov/cps/cpsaat11.pdf
U.S. Department of Defense. (2014). Active duty military personnel by service by rank/ grade (for April 2014). Retrieved from https://www.dmdc.osd.mil/appj/dwp/ dwp_reports.jsp
426 Leadership Theory and pracTice
van Engen, M. L., Leeden, R., van der, & Willemsen, T. M. (2001). Gender, context and leadership styles: A field study. Journal of Occupational and Organizational Psychology, 74, 581–598.
van Engen, M. L., & Willemsen, T. M. (2004). Sex and leadership styles: A meta- analysis of research published in the 1990s. Psychological Reports, 94, 3–18.
Vinkenburg, C. J., van Engen, M. L., Eagly, A. H., & Johannesen-Schmidt, M. C. (2011). An exploration of stereotypical beliefs about leadership styles: Is transfor- mational leadership a route to women’s promotion? The Leadership Quarterly, 22, 10–21.
Williams, C. L. (1992). The glass escalator: Hidden advantages for men in the “female” professions. Social Problems, 39, 253–267.
Williams, C. L. (1995). Still a man’s world: Men who do “women’s work.” Berkeley: University of California Press.
Williams, J. (2010). Reshaping the work-family debate: Why men and class matter. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Wirth, L. (2001). Breaking through the glass ceiling: Women in management. Geneva: International Labour Office.
Woolley, A. W., Chabris, C. F., Pentland, A., Hashmi, N., & Malone, T. M. (2010). Evidence for a collective intelligence factor in the performance of human groups. Science, 330, 686–688.
16
Culture and Leadership
DesCription
As the title suggests, this chapter is about culture and leadership. Like the previous chapter, this one is multifaceted and focuses on a collection of related ideas rather than on a single unified theory. Our discussion in this chapter will center on research that describes culture, its dimensions, and the effects of culture on the leadership process.
Since World War II, globalization has been advancing throughout the world. Globalization is the increased interdependence (economic, social, technical, and political) between nations. People are becoming more interconnected. There is more international trade, cultural exchange, and use of worldwide telecommunication systems. In the past 10 years, our schools, organizations, and communities have become far more global than in the past. Increased globalization has created many challenges, including the need to design effective multinational organizations, to identify and select appropriate lead- ers for these entities, and to manage organizations with culturally diverse employees (House & Javidan, 2004). Globalization has created a need to understand how cultural differences affect leadership performance.
Globalization has also created the need for leaders to become competent in cross-cultural awareness and practice. Adler and Bartholomew (1992) con- tended that global leaders need to develop five cross-cultural competencies: First, leaders need to understand business, political, and cultural environ- ments worldwide. Second, they need to learn the perspectives, tastes, trends, and technologies of many other cultures. Third, they need to be able to work
Culture and Leadership Globalization
428 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
simultaneously with people from many cultures. Fourth, leaders must be able to adapt to living and communicating in other cultures. Fifth, they need to learn to relate to people from other cultures from a position of equality rather than cultural superiority (Adler & Bartholomew, 1992, p. 53). Additionally, Ting-Toomey (1999) said that global leaders need to be skilled in creating transcultural visions. They need to develop communication com- petencies that will enable them to articulate and implement their vision in a diverse workplace. In sum, today’s leaders need to acquire a challenging set of competencies if they intend to be effective in present-day global societies.
Culture Defined
Anthropologists, sociologists, and many others have debated the meaning of the word culture. Because it is an abstract term, it is hard to define, and dif- ferent people often define it in dissimilar ways. For our purposes, culture is defined as the learned beliefs, values, rules, norms, symbols, and traditions that are common to a group of people. It is these shared qualities of a group that make them unique. Culture is dynamic and transmitted to others. In short, culture is the way of life, customs, and script of a group of people (Gudykunst & Ting-Toomey, 1988).
Related to culture are the terms multicultural and diversity. Multicultural implies an approach or a system that takes more than one culture into account. It refers to the existence of multiple cultures such as African, American, Asian, European, and Middle Eastern. Multicultural can also refer to a set of subcultures defined by race, gender, ethnicity, sexual orienta- tion, or age. Diversity refers to the existence of different cultures or ethnici- ties within a group or an organization.
Related Concepts
Before beginning our discussion of the various facets of culture, this section describes two concepts that are closely related to culture and leadership: ethnocentrism and prejudice. Both of these concepts can have impacts on how leaders influence others.
ethnocentrism
As the word suggests, ethnocentrism is the tendency for individuals to place their own group (ethnic, racial, or cultural) at the center of their observations
Global Vs Local Leadership and Cultural diversity
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 429
of others and the world. People tend to give priority and value to their own beliefs, attitudes, and values, over and above those of other groups. Ethnocentrism is the perception that one’s own culture is better or more natural than the culture of others. It may include the failure to recognize the unique perspectives of others. Ethnocentrism is a universal tendency, and each of us is ethnocentric to some degree.
Ethnocentrism is like a perceptual window through which people from one culture make subjective or critical evaluations of people from another culture (Porter & Samovar, 1997). For example, some Americans think that the dem- ocratic principles of the United States are superior to the political beliefs of other cultures; they often fail to understand the complexities of other cultures. Ethnocentrism accounts for our tendency to think our own cultural values and ways of doing things are right and natural (Gudykunst & Kim, 1997).
Ethnocentrism can be a major obstacle to effective leadership because it prevents people from fully understanding or respecting the viewpoints of others. For example, if one person’s culture values individual achievement, it may be difficult for that person to understand another person whose culture emphasizes collectivity (i.e., people working together as a whole). Similarly, if one person believes strongly in respecting authority, that person may find it difficult to understand someone who challenges authority or does not eas- ily defer to authority figures. The more ethnocentric we are, the less open or tolerant we are of other people’s cultural traditions or practices.
A skilled leader cannot avoid issues related to ethnocentrism. Even though she recognizes her own ethnocentrism, a leader also needs to understand— and to a degree tolerate—the ethnocentrism of others. In reality, it is a bal- ancing act for leaders. On the one hand, they need to promote and be confident in their own ways of doing things; on the other hand, they need to be sensitive to the legitimacy of the ways of other cultures. Skilled leaders are able to negotiate the fine line between trying to overcome ethnocentrism and knowing when to remain grounded in their own cultural values.
prejudice
Closely related to ethnocentrism is prejudice. Prejudice is a largely fixed atti- tude, belief, or emotion held by an individual about another individual or group that is based on faulty or unsubstantiated data. It refers to judgments about others based on previous decisions or experiences. Prejudice involves inflexible generalizations that are resistant to change or evidence to the con- trary (Ponterotto & Pedersen, 1993). Prejudice often is thought of in the
reducing ethnocentrism
430 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
context of race (e.g., European American vs. African American), but it also applies in areas such as gender, age, sexual orientation, and other indepen- dent contexts. Although prejudice can be positive (e.g., thinking highly of another culture without sufficient evidence), it is usually negative.
As with ethnocentrism, we all hold prejudices to some degree. Sometimes our prejudices allow us to keep our partially fixed attitudes undisturbed and constant. Sometimes prejudice can reduce our anxiety because it gives us a familiar way to structure our observations of others. One of the main prob- lems with prejudice is that it is self-oriented rather than other-oriented. It helps us to achieve balance for ourselves at the expense of others. Moreover, attitudes of prejudice inhibit understanding by creating a screen that filters and limits our ability to see multiple aspects and qualities of other people. Prejudice often shows itself in crude or demeaning comments that people make about others. Both ethnocentrism and prejudice interfere with our ability to understand and appreciate the human experience of others.
In addition to fighting their own prejudice, leaders face the challenge of dealing with the prejudice of followers. These prejudices can be toward the leader or the leader’s culture. Furthermore, it is not uncommon for the leader to face followers who represent several culturally different groups, and these groups have their own prejudices toward each other. A skilled leader needs to find ways to negotiate with followers from various cultural backgrounds.
Dimensions of Culture
Culture has been the focus of many studies across a variety of disciplines. In the past 30 years, a substantial number of studies have focused specifically on ways to identify and classify the various dimensions of culture. Determining the basic dimensions or characteristics of different cultures is the first step in being able to understand the relationships between them.
Several well-known studies have addressed the question of how to characterize cultures. For example, Hall (1976) reported that a primary characteristic of cultures is the degree to which they are focused on the individual (individual- istic cultures) or on the group (collectivistic cultures). Taking a different approach, Trompenaars (1994) surveyed more than 15,000 people in 47 dif- ferent countries and determined that organizational cultures could be classi- fied effectively into two dimensions: egalitarian versus hierarchical, and person versus task orientation. The egalitarian–hierarchical dimension refers to the degree to which cultures exhibit shared power as opposed to hierarchical power. Person–task orientation refers to the extent to which cultures empha- size human interaction as opposed to stressing tasks to be accomplished.
interpreting GLoBe dimensions
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 431
Of all the research on dimensions of culture, perhaps the most referenced is the research of Hofstede (1980, 2001). Based on an analysis of question- naires obtained from more than 100,000 respondents in more than 50 coun- tries, Hofstede identified five major dimensions on which cultures differ: power distance, uncertainty avoidance, individualism–collectivism, mascu- linity–femininity, and long-term–short-term orientation. Hofstede’s work has been the benchmark for much of the research on world cultures.
In the specific area of culture and leadership, the studies by House, Hanges, Javidan, Dorfman, and Gupta (2004) offer the strongest body of findings to date, as published in the 800-page Culture, Leadership, and Organizations: The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies. These studies are called the GLOBE stud- ies, named for the Global Leadership and Organizational Behavior Effectiveness research program. The GLOBE studies have generated a very large number of findings on the relationship between culture and leadership.
The GLOBE research program, which was initiated by Robert House in 1991, is an ongoing program that has involved more than 160 investigators to date. The primary purpose of the project is to increase our understanding of cross-cultural interactions and the impact of culture on leadership effec- tiveness. GLOBE researchers have used quantitative methods to study the responses of 17,000 managers in more than 950 organizations, representing 62 different cultures throughout the world. GLOBE researchers have col- lected data in a variety of ways, including questionnaires, interviews, focus groups, and content analysis of printed media. The findings of the GLOBE studies will be provided in more detail throughout this chapter.
As a part of their study of culture and leadership, GLOBE researchers devel- oped their own classification of cultural dimensions. Based on their research and the work of others (e.g., Hofstede, 1980, 2001; Kluckhohn & Strodtbeck, 1961; McClelland, 1961; Triandis, 1995), GLOBE researchers identified nine cultural dimensions: uncertainty avoidance, power distance, institu- tional collectivism, in-group collectivism, gender egalitarianism, assertive- ness, future orientation, performance orientation, and humane orientation. In the following section, each of the dimensions is described.
Uncertainty Avoidance
This dimension refers to the extent to which a society, an organization, or a group relies on established social norms, rituals, and procedures to avoid uncertainty. Uncertainty avoidance is concerned with the way cultures use rules, structures, and laws to make things more predictable and less uncertain. For example, cultures that have a high tolerance for uncertainty, such as the
dimensions of Culture Cross-Cultural Leadership
432 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
United States, are more likely to have a thriving entrepreneurial culture, where individuals are willing to take risks and make quick business decisions. In Middle Eastern countries such as Kuwait and Egypt, taking risks and making daring decisions is not common; business deals are carefully thought through and examined before any decision can be made. As a result, business deals and negotiations take a long time, and require cultivation built on a level of trust and reliability that comes with a long-term commitment.
power Distance
This dimension refers to the degree to which members of a group expect and agree that power should be shared unequally. Power distance is concerned with the way cultures are stratified, thus creating levels between people based on power, authority, prestige, status, wealth, and material possessions. India, which still operates under the caste system, is a good example of a country that has high power distance in that it sees power and authority as facts of life and that everyone has a “rightful place.” Imagine the cultural issues that arise for an Indian software engineer who manages a department for a high- tech startup in Silicon Valley where his American subordinates, who come from a low power distance culture, openly approach and disagree with him on issues even though he is the boss.
institutional Collectivism
This dimension describes the degree to which an organization or a society encourages institutional or societal collective action. Institutional collectivism is concerned with whether cultures identify with broader societal interests rather than with individual goals and accomplishments. North Korea is an example of a culture with high institutional collectivism. The people are ruled by a Supreme Leader who oversees the development of the country’s values, which place a premium on collective efforts and nonmaterial incentives. As a result, group cohesion and loyalty is strictly required. This adherence may come partly through fear: Supreme Leader Kim Jong-il has placed the military at the center of the efforts to instill these values throughout North Korean society.
in-Group Collectivism
This dimension refers to the degree to which people express pride, loyalty, and cohesiveness in their organizations or families. In-group collectivism is concerned with the extent to which people are devoted to their organizations
Cross-Cultural Management
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 433
or families. For example, many Middle Eastern cultures, such as Pakistan and Iran, are high in in-group collectivism. They regard family and religious affiliation above all else; there are often honor killings of family members who have done something to disgrace or defy the paternal leader of the fam- ily. Religious divisions, such as that between the Sunni and Shia Muslims in such countries as Syria and Iraq, have led to civil war.
Gender egalitarianism
This dimension measures the degree to which an organization or a society minimizes gender role differences and promotes gender equality. Gender egalitarianism is concerned with how much societies deemphasize members’ biological sex in determining the roles that members play in their homes, organizations, and communities. Sweden is considered to be one of the world’s most gender-egalitarian countries, based on a firm belief that men and women should share power and influence equally. An extensive welfare system makes it easier for both sexes to balance work and family life. Contrast this with countries like Afghanistan where many girls are not allowed to go to school and are often killed for defying their families’ wishes.
Assertiveness
This dimension refers to the degree to which people in a culture are deter- mined, assertive, confrontational, and aggressive in their social relationships. Assertiveness is concerned with how much a culture or society encourages people to be forceful, aggressive, and tough, as opposed to encouraging them to be timid, submissive, and tender in social relationships. Germany is high in the assertiveness dimension. In a study on upper-level managers in Germany, Brodbeck, Frese, and Javidan (2002) found that German managers used straightforward and direct language and that conflict and confronta- tional debate were acceptable approaches in a work environment.
Future orientation
This concept refers to the extent to which people engage in future-oriented behaviors such as planning, investing in the future, and delaying gratification. Future orientation emphasizes that people in a culture prepare for the future as opposed to enjoying the present and being spontaneous. Many Middle Eastern countries are “past-oriented,” concerned with traditional values and ways of doing things. They tend to be conservative in management and slow to change
Leadership and Culture
434 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
those things that are tied to the past. Americans, on the other hand, believe they can plan and control the future and idealize change for the sake of changing.
performance orientation
This dimension describes the extent to which an organization or a society encourages and rewards group members for improved performance and excellence. Performance orientation is concerned with whether people in a culture are rewarded for setting and meeting challenging goals. Again, the United States is very high in performance orientation. One only has to look at how the country’s education department ranks schools as thriving or fail- ing based on the results of standardized testing of students. If schools are not making the mark, there are interventions and programs to try to bring the scores up. The United States also compares its academic success with that of other countries to see where it is falling short or succeeding.
Humane orientation
The ninth dimension refers to the degree to which a culture encourages and rewards people for being fair, altruistic, generous, caring, and kind to others. Humane orientation is concerned with how much a society or an organiza- tion emphasizes sensitivity to others, social support, and community values. Switzerland is a country that is often cited for its high humane orientation, based on the Swiss people’s helpfulness to others during and after World War I and World War II. The country espouses tolerance and responsibility as its central educational goals.
GLOBE researchers used these nine cultural dimensions to analyze the attributes of the 62 different countries in the study. These cultural dimen- sions formed the basis for studying how the countries varied in their approach to leadership.
Clusters of World Cultures
GLOBE researchers divided the data from the 62 countries they studied into regional clusters.1 These clusters provided a convenient way to analyze the similarities and differences between cultural groups (clusters), and to make meaningful generalizations about culture and leadership.
To create regional clusters, GLOBE researchers used prior research (e.g., Ronen & Shenkar, 1985), common language, geography, religion, and historical accounts. Based on these factors, they grouped countries into
Values and diversity
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 435
10 distinct clusters: Anglo, Germanic Europe, Latin Europe, Sub- Saharan Africa, Eastern Europe, Middle East, Confucian Asia, Southern Asia, Latin America, and Nordic Europe (Figure 16.1). These 10 regional clusters are the groupings that were used in all of the GLOBE studies.
To test whether the clusters, or groups of countries, were valid, researchers did a statistical analysis of questionnaire data collected from individuals in each of the clusters. Their results indicated that the scores of respondents within a cluster correlated with one another but were unrelated to the scores of respon- dents in different clusters. From these findings, they concluded that each clus- ter was unique. In sum, these regional clusters represented a valid and reliable way to differentiate countries of the world into 10 distinct groups.
Figure 16.1 Country Clusters According to GLOBE
Denm ark
Finland
Sw eden
Sin gapore
Hong Kong
Taiwan
China
South Korea
Japan
Philippines Indonesia Malaysia
India Thailand
Iran
Ecuador EI Salvador
ColombiaBoliviaBrazil Guatemala
Argentina Costa Rica
Venezuela Mexico
Ca na
da U.
S. A.
Au st
ra lia
Ire la
nd En
gl an
d So
ut h
Af ric
a (w
hi te
sa m
pl e)
Ne w
Z ea
la nd
Austri a
The N eth
erla nds
Sw itze
rland
Germ any
Israel Italy
Switzerland (Francophone)
Spain Portugal France
Tu rk
ey Ku
w ai
t Eg
yp t
M or
oc co
Q at
ar
Greece
Hungary
Albania
Slovenia
Poland
Russia
Georgia
Kazakhstan Zimbabwe Namibia
ZambiaNigeria South Africa
(black sample)
Latin Europe
Germanic E uro
pe
An gl
o
N ordic Europe
Latin America
Southern Asia
Co nfu
cia n Asia
M
id dl
e Ea
st
Eastern Europe
Sub-Saharan Africa
SOURCE: House, R.J., Hanges, P.J., Javidan, M., Dorfman, P. W., & Gupta, V., Culture, Leadership, and Organizations: The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies, copyright © 2004, Sage Publications, Inc. Reprinted with permission.
436 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Characteristics of Clusters
In an effort to characterize the regional clusters, GLOBE researchers ana- lyzed data from each of the regions using the dimensions of culture described earlier. Table 16.1 provides a classification of the cultural clusters in regard to how they scored on each cultural dimension. In the table, the nine cultural
table 16.1 Cultural Clusters Classified on Cultural dimensions
Cultural Dimension High-Score Clusters Low-Score Clusters
Assertiveness orientation
Eastern Europe Germanic Europe
Nordic Europe
Future orientation Germanic Europe Nordic Europe
Eastern Europe Latin America Middle East
Gender egalitarianism Eastern Europe Nordic Europe
Middle East
Humane orientation Southern Asia Sub-Saharan Africa
Germanic Europe Latin Europe
In-group collectivism Confucian Asia Eastern Europe Latin America Middle East Southern Asia
Anglo Germanic Europe Nordic Europe
Institutional collectivism Nordic Europe Confucian Asia
Germanic Europe Latin America Latin Europe
Performance orientation Anglo Confucian Asia Germanic Europe
Eastern Europe Latin America
Power distance No clusters Nordic Europe
Uncertainty avoidance Germanic Europe Nordic Europe
Eastern Europe Latin America Middle East
soUrCe: adapted from house, r. J., hanges, p. J., Javidan, M., dorfman, p. W., & Gupta, V. (eds.), Culture, Leadership, and Organizations: The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies, © 2004, saGe publications, inc. reprinted with permission.
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 437
dimensions are listed in the left-hand column; the high-score and low-score regional clusters are provided in the next two columns. These are the regional clusters that were significantly higher or lower on particular dimensions than other regions. From these data, several observations can be made about the characteristics of these regional cultures.
Anglo
The Anglo cluster consists of Canada, the United States, Australia, Ireland, England, South Africa (white sample), and New Zealand. These countries or populations were high in performance orientation and low in in-group collectivism. This means it is characteristic of these countries to be com- petitive and results oriented, but less attached to their families or similar groups than other countries.
Confucian Asia
This cluster, which includes Singapore, Hong Kong, Taiwan, China, South Korea, and Japan, exhibited high scores in performance orientation, institu- tional collectivism, and in-group collectivism. These countries are results driven, and they encourage the group working together over individual goals. People in these countries are devoted and loyal to their families.
eastern europe
Included in this cluster are Greece, Hungary, Albania, Slovenia, Poland, Russia, Georgia, and Kazakhstan. These countries scored high on assertive- ness, in-group collectivism, and gender egalitarianism. They scored low on performance orientation, future orientation, and uncertainty avoidance. People in this cluster tend to be forceful and supportive of their coworkers and to treat men and women equally. They are less likely to be achievement driven, to emphasize strategic planning, and to stress rules and laws as a way to maintain order.
Germanic europe
The Germanic Europe countries, which include Austria, the Netherlands, Switzerland, and Germany, scored high in performance orientation, assertiveness, future orientation, and uncertainty avoidance. They were
Chinese Culture and Leadership
438 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
low in humane orientation, institutional collectivism, and in-group col- lectivism. These countries value competition and aggressiveness and are more results oriented than people oriented. They enjoy planning and investing in the future and using rules and laws to give them control over their environment. At the same time, these countries are more likely to be individualistic and less group oriented. They tend not to emphasize broad societal groups.
Latin America
The Latin America cluster is made up of Ecuador, El Salvador, Colombia, Bolivia, Brazil, Guatemala, Argentina, Costa Rica, Venezuela, and Mexico. People in these countries scored high on in-group collectivism and low on performance orientation, future orientation, institutional collectivism, and uncertainty avoidance. People in these countries tend to be loyal and devoted to their families and similar groups but less interested in overall institutional and societal groups.
Latin europe
Comprising Israel, Italy, Francophone Switzerland, Spain, Portugal, and France, the Latin Europe cluster exhibited more moderate and fewer high scores on any of the cultural dimensions, but they scored low on humane orientation and institutional collectivism. It is characteristic of these coun- tries to value individual autonomy and to place less value on the greater societal collective. Individuals are encouraged to watch out for themselves and to pursue individual rather than societal goals.
Middle east
This cluster is made up of Qatar, Morocco, Egypt, Kuwait, and Turkey. These countries scored high on in-group collectivism and low on future orientation, gender egalitarianism, and uncertainty avoidance. People in these countries tend to show great pride in their families and organizations. They are devoted and loyal to their own people. Furthermore, it is common for these countries to treat people of different genders in distinctly different ways. Women often are afforded less status than men, and fewer women are in positions of authority than men. In the Middle East, orderliness and consistency are not stressed, and people do not place heavy reliance on
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 439
policies and procedures. There is a tendency to focus on current issues as opposed to attempting to control the future.
nordic europe
The Nordic Europe cluster, which includes Denmark, Finland, and Sweden, exhibited several distinctive characteristics. This cluster scored high on future orientation, gender egalitarianism, institutional collectivism, and uncertainty avoidance, and low on assertiveness, in-group collectivism, and power distance. The Nordic people place a high priority on long-term suc- cess. Women are treated with greater equality. The Nordic people identify with the broader society and far less with family groups. In Nordic Europe, rules, orderliness, and consistency are stressed. Assertiveness is downplayed in favor of modesty and tenderness, and power is shared equally among people at all levels of society. Cooperation and societal-level group identity are highly valued by the Nordic people.
southern Asia
The Philippines, Indonesia, Malaysia, India, Thailand, and Iran form the Southern Asia cluster. These countries exhibited high scores on humane orienta- tion and in-group collectivism. Southern Asia could be characterized as countries that demonstrate strong family loyalty and deep concern for their communities.
sub-saharan Africa
The Sub-Saharan Africa cluster consisted of Zimbabwe, Namibia, Zambia, Nigeria, and South Africa (black sample). These countries or populations expressed high scores on humane orientation. In Sub-Saharan Africa, people generally are very concerned for and sensitive to others. Concern for family and friends is more important than concern for self.
Leadership Behavior and Culture Clusters
The overall purpose of the GLOBE project was to determine how people from different cultures viewed leadership. In addition, researchers wanted to determine the ways in which cultural characteristics were related to culturally endorsed leadership behaviors. In short, they wanted to find out how differ- ences in cultures were related to differences in approaches to leadership.
Global Leaders
440 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
The conceptualization of leadership used by GLOBE researchers was derived in part from the work of Lord and Maher (1991) on implicit leader- ship theory. According to implicit leadership theory, individuals have implicit beliefs and convictions about the attributes and beliefs that distinguish lead- ers from nonleaders and effective leaders from ineffective leaders. From the perspective of this theory, leadership is in the eye of the beholder (Dorfman, Hanges, & Brodbeck, 2004). Leadership refers to what people see in others when they are exhibiting leadership behaviors.
To describe how different cultures view leadership behaviors in others, GLOBE researchers identified six global leadership behaviors: charismatic/ value based, team oriented, participative, humane oriented, autonomous, and self-protective (House & Javidan, 2004). These global leadership behaviors were defined in these studies as follows:
Charismatic/value-based leadership reflects the ability to inspire, to motivate, and to expect high performance from others based on strongly held core values. This kind of leadership includes being visionary, inspirational, self-sacrificing, trustworthy, decisive, and per- formance oriented.
Team-oriented leadership emphasizes team building and a common purpose among team members. This kind of leadership includes being collaborative, integrative, diplomatic, nonmalevolent, and administratively competent.
Participative leadership reflects the degree to which leaders involve others in making and implementing decisions. It includes being par- ticipative and nonautocratic.
Humane-oriented leadership emphasizes being supportive, considerate, compassionate, and generous. This type of leadership includes mod- esty and sensitivity to other people.
Autonomous leadership refers to independent and individualistic lead- ership, which includes being autonomous and unique.
Self-protective leadership reflects behaviors that ensure the safety and security of the leader and the group. It includes leadership that is self- centered, status conscious, conflict inducing, face saving, and procedural.
These six global leadership behaviors emerged from the GLOBE research and were used to assess the different ways in which various cultural clusters viewed leadership. From this analysis, the researchers were able to identify a leadership profile for each cluster. Each profile describes the relative
elaine Chao
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 441
importance and desirability that different cultures ascribe to different leadership behaviors. The leadership profiles for each of the 10 culture clusters follow.
eastern europe Leadership profile
For the Eastern European countries, an ideal example of a leader would be a person who was first and foremost independent while maintaining a strong interest in protecting his or her position as a leader (Figure 16.2). In addi- tion, the leader would be moderately charismatic/value based, team oriented, and humane oriented, yet largely uninterested in involving others in the decision-making process. To sum up, this culture describes a leader as one who is highly autonomous, makes decisions independently, and is to a cer- tain degree inspiring, team oriented, and attentive to human needs.
Figure 16.2 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: eastern europe
EA ST
ER N
E U
RO PE
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Latin America Leadership profile
Quite different from the Eastern European countries, the Latin American countries place the most importance on charismatic/value-based, team- oriented, and self-protective leadership, and the least importance on auton- omous leadership (Figure 16.3). In addition, this cluster is moderately interested in leadership that is participative and humane oriented. The pro- file for the Latin America cluster is of a leader who is charismatic/value based but somewhat self-serving, collaborative, and inspiring. These leaders
442 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
tend to be moderately interested in people and their participation in deci- sion making.
Figure 16.3 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: Latin america
LA TI
N A
M ER
IC A
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
Participative Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Latin europe Leadership profile
The Latin Europe cluster values leadership that is charismatic/value based, team oriented, participative, and self-protective (Figure 16.4). Independent leadership and the human side of leadership are downplayed in this cluster.
Figure 16.4 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: Latin europe
LA TI
N E
U RO
PE
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
Participative Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 443
In short, the profile of the Latin Europe cluster centers on leadership that is inspiring, collaborative, participative, and self-oriented, but not highly com- passionate.
Confucian Asia Leadership profile
The leadership profile of the Confucian Asia countries describes a leader who is self-protective, team oriented, and humane oriented (Figure 16.5). Though independent and to some extent inspiring, this type of leader typi- cally does not invite others to be involved in goal setting or decision making. In sum, the Confucian Asia profile describes a leader who works and cares about others but who uses status and position to make independent deci- sions without the input of others.
Figure 16.5 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: Confucian asia
CO N
FU CI
A N
A SI
A
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Participative Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
nordic europe Leadership profile
An ideal example of leadership for the Nordic European countries is leader- ship that is highly visionary and participative, while being somewhat inde- pendent and diplomatic (Figure 16.6). For these countries, it is of less importance that their leaders be humane oriented or self-protective. Nordic Europeans prefer leaders who are inspiring, and who involve others in deci- sion making. They do not expect their leaders to be exceedingly compassion- ate, nor do they expect them to be concerned with status and other self-centered attributes.
444 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Anglo Leadership profile
The profile of leadership for the Anglo countries emphasizes that leaders are especially charismatic/value based, participative, and sensitive to peo- ple (Figure 16.7). Stated another way, Anglo countries want leaders to be
Figure 16.6 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: nordic europe
N O
RD IC
E U
RO PE
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
Participative Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Figure 16.7 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: anglo
A N
G LO
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
Participative Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 445
exceedingly motivating and visionary, not autocratic, and considerate of others. Furthermore, they report that leaders should be team oriented and autonomous. The least important characteristic for Anglo countries is self-protective leadership. They believe it is ineffective if leaders are status conscious or prone to face saving.
sub-saharan Africa Leadership profile
For countries in Sub-Saharan Africa, an ideal leader is modest, compassionate, and sensitive to the people (Figure 16.8). In addition, a leader should be relatively charismatic/value based, team oriented, participative, and self- protective. Leaders who act independently or act alone are viewed as less effective in these countries. In short, the Sub-Saharan Africa profile characterizes effective leadership as caring leadership. Like many other countries, these countries or populations believe leaders should be inspirational, collaborative, and not excessively self-centered. Leaders who act autonomously are seen as ineffective in Sub-Saharan Africa countries.
Figure 16.8 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: sub-saharan africa
SU B-
SA H
A RA
N A
FR IC
A
Team-Oriented Leadership
Participative Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
southern Asia Leadership profile
The Southern Asia leadership profile is similar to the profile of Confucian Asia. They both place importance on self-protective, charismatic/value-based,
africa Changing perceptions
446 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
humane-oriented, and team-oriented leadership, and they both find partici- pative leadership ineffective (Figure 16.9). Southern Asia countries differ from Confucian Asia countries in believing that charisma is an important leader attribute. The Southern Asia countries characterize effective leadership as especially collaborative, inspirational, sensitive to people’s needs, and con- cerned with status and face saving. Furthermore, they believe leaders who tend to be autocratic are more effective than those who lead by inviting oth- ers into the decision-making process.
Figure 16.9 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: southern asia
SO U
TH ER
N A
SI A
Team-Oriented Leadership
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Participative Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Germanic europe Leadership profile
The ideal leader in the Germanic Europe cluster has a style that is very par- ticipative while also being inspirational and independent (Figure 16.10). The ideal leader would be a unique, visionary person who is autonomous, charis- matic/value based, participative, humane oriented, and team oriented, but not status conscious or concerned with face saving. In short, the Germanic European countries think effective leadership is based on participation, cha- risma, and autonomy but not on face saving and other self-centered attributes.
Middle east Leadership profile
The leadership profile for the Middle Eastern countries differs significantly from the profiles of the other cultural clusters (Figure 16.11). Middle Eastern countries find self-attributes such as face saving and status are important characteristics of effective leadership. They also value being independent and familial. However, they find charismatic/value-based, team-oriented, and
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 447
Figure 16.10 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: Germanic europe
G ER
M A
N IC
E U
RO PE
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Participative Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
Figure 16.11 Culture Clusters and desired Leadership Behaviors: Middle east
M ID
D LE
E A
ST
Humane-Oriented Leadership
Autonomous Leadership
Self-Protective Leadership
Charismatic/Value-Based Leadership
Participative Leadership
Team-Oriented Leadership
soUrCe: adapted from house et al. (2004).
participative decision making less essential for effective leadership. To sum up, the Middle Eastern profile of leadership emphasizes status and face saving, and deemphasizes charismatic/value-based and team-oriented leadership.
Universally Desirable and Undesirable Leadership Attributes
One of the most interesting outcomes of the GLOBE project was the iden- tification of a list of leadership attributes that were universally endorsed by 17,000 people in 62 countries as positive aspects of effective leadership.
448 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Respondents in the GLOBE studies identified 22 valued leadership attri- butes (Table 16.2). These attributes were universally endorsed as character- istics that facilitate outstanding leadership.
Based on the list of endorsed attributes, a portrait can be drawn of a leader whom almost everyone would see as exceptional. That portrait is of a leader who is high in integrity, is charismatic/value based, and has interpersonal skills (Dorfman et al., 2004).
The GLOBE project also identified a list of leadership attributes that were universally viewed as obstacles to effective leadership (Table 16.3). These characteristics suggest that the portrait of an ineffective leader is someone who is asocial, malevolent, and self-focused. Clearly, people from all cultures find these characteristics to hinder effective leadership.
Table 16.2 Universally desirable Leadership attributes
Positive Leader Attributes
Trustworthy Just Honest
Has foresight Plans ahead Encouraging
Positive Dynamic Motive arouser
Confidence builder Motivational Dependable
Intelligent Decisive Effective bargainer
Win–win problem solver Communicative Informed
Administratively skilled Coordinative Team builder
Excellence oriented
soUrce: adapted from house, r.J., hanges, p.J., Javidan, M., dorfman, p. W., & Gupta, V., culture, Leadership, and organizations: The GLoBe study of 62 societies, copyright © 2004, sage publications, inc. reprinted with permission.
Table 16.3 Universally Undesirable Leadership attributes
Negative Leader Attributes
Loner Asocial Noncooperative
Irritable Nonexplicit Egocentric
Ruthless Dictatorial
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 449
strenGtHs
Although this chapter on culture and leadership does not represent a single unified theory of leadership, it does present findings that have several strengths. First, the scope of this study is a major strength. For this study, data were collected by 170 social scientists, representing 62 countries from all regions of the world, and included responses from 17,300 managers in 951 organizations. The GLOBE project has been a massive undertaking; the findings that have emerged from this work make a powerful statement about how cultures around the world view leadership.
Second, the findings from GLOBE are valuable because they emerge from a well-developed quantitative research design. In the leadership literature, there are many qualitative studies that focus more narrowly on how people in certain countries view a small number of leadership concepts. Although these studies have contributed to our understanding of culture and leader- ship, they are limited in scope and generalizability. In contrast, the strength of the GLOBE project is that researchers used a quantitative design and administered standardized instruments to assess leadership and cultural dimensions in 62 countries. Thus, the results from the GLOBE studies about leadership are generalizable between cultures and within cultures around the world.
Third, the GLOBE studies provide a classification of cultural dimensions that is more expansive than the commonly used Hofstede classification sys- tem. Whereas Hofstede distinguishes between cultures based on five dimen- sions (power distance, uncertainty avoidance, individualism–collectivism, masculinity–femininity, and long-term–short-term orientation), the GLOBE studies identify nine cultural dimensions (uncertainty avoidance, power distance, institutional collectivism, in-group collectivism, gender egalitarianism, assertiveness, future orientation, performance orientation, and humane orientation). Although seven of the nine dimensions identified in the GLOBE studies have their origins in the dimensions identified by Hofstede, by expanding the classification system the GLOBE studies pro- vide a broader and more elaborate way of describing dimensions of culture.
Fourth, the GLOBE studies provide useful information about what is uni- versally accepted as good and bad leadership. Clearly, people from most cultures view good leadership as based on integrity, charisma, and interper- sonal ability. Conversely, they see bad leadership emerging from leaders who are self-focused, dictatorial, and asocial. These lists of positive and negative attributes provide a useful portrait of how people around the world concep- tualize leadership.
Global Mindset
450 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Last, the study of culture and leadership underscores the complexity of the leadership process and how it is influenced by culture. Data from the GLOBE studies highlight the need for each of us to expand our ethnocen- tric tendencies to view leadership from only our own perspective, and instead to “open our window” to the diverse ways in which leadership is viewed by people from different regions around the world. There are many ways to view leadership and the integration of culture; studies of leadership help us to expand and develop a richer understanding of the leadership process.
CritiCisMs
The body of research on culture and leadership also has several weaknesses. First, although the GLOBE research has resulted in a multitude of find- ings about perceptions of leadership in different cultures, this research does not provide a clear set of assumptions and propositions that can form a single theory about the way culture relates to leadership or influences the leadership process.
A second criticism, more narrow in scope, concerns the way researchers have labeled and defined certain cultural dimensions and leadership behaviors. For example, it is not easy to understand what power distance means, nor is the meaning of self-protective leadership clear. Because the meanings of these terms are somewhat vague, it is difficult at times to interpret or fully com- prehend the findings about culture and leadership.
Another criticism concerns the way in which leadership was conceptualized in the GLOBE studies. In these studies, researchers used a conceptualization of leadership that was based on the ideas set forth by Lord and Maher (1991) in their work on implicit leadership theory. This approach frames leadership from an information-processing perspective, as the implicit beliefs and convictions that individuals have about leaders. In other words, according to this theory, leadership is the process of being perceived by others as being a leader. However, conceptualizing leadership in this way is limited: It focuses on what people perceive to be leadership and ignores a large body of research that frames lead- ership in terms of what leaders do (e.g., transformational leadership, path–goal theory, skills approach). Research on how people from different cultures view leadership is valuable, but there is a need for further research on how leadership functions in different cultures.
A related criticism concerns the way in which researchers in the GLOBE studies measured leadership. They selected six global leadership behaviors
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 451
(i.e., charismatic/value-based, team-oriented, participative, humane- oriented, autonomous, and self-protective leadership) that were derived from an analysis of subjects’ responses to hundreds of other attributes believed to be related to outstanding leadership. Each of the six global leadership behav- iors was measured by a series of subscales. However, the subscales repre- sented a very broad range of behaviors, and as a result compromised the precision and validity of the leadership measures.
Finally, the GLOBE studies provide a provocative list of universally endorsed desirable and undesirable leadership attributes. The attributes identified in the GLOBE studies are comparable to the list of traits we discussed in Chapter 2. As with the trait approach, however, it is difficult to identify a set of universal attributes in isolation from the context in which the leadership occurs. The GLOBE studies tend to isolate a set of attributes that are char- acteristic of effective leaders without considering the influence of the situ- ational effects.
AppLiCAtion
Training programs about culture and diversity have been popular for many years. For example, in the training and development field, a wide variety of programs teach cultural sensitivity and address issues related to cultural dif- ferences. At the core of these programs, people are taught about the nuances and characteristics of different cultures, and how to be sensitive to people in other countries and cultures.
The findings in this chapter have implications for leadership training. Understanding issues about culture is useful in several ways (Bing, 2004). First, the findings about culture can help leaders understand their own cultural biases and preferences. Understanding their own preferences is the first step in understanding that people in other cultures might have different preferences.
Second, the findings help leaders to understand what it means to be a good leader. Different cultures have different ideas about what they want from their leaders. These findings help our leaders adapt their style to be more effective in different cultural settings.
Third, this chapter’s findings can help global leaders communicate more effectively across cultural and geographic boundaries. By understanding cul- tural differences, leaders can become more empathic and accurate in their communication with others.
Multinational Corporations
452 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Information on culture and leadership has also been applied in very practical ways (Bing, 2004). It has been used to build culturally sensitive websites, design new employee orientation programs, conduct programs in relocation training, improve global team effectiveness, and facilitate multinational merger implementation, to name a few. These examples clearly indicate the wide range of applications for research on culture and leadership in the workplace.
CAse stUDies
This section provides three case studies (Cases 16.1, 16.2, and 16.3) that describe leadership in various cultural contexts. The first case is about a college student who takes an internship at a Japanese-based automotive company. The second case describes how a small Midwestern bank devel- oped a unique Islamic financing program. The final case describes how two board members from a nonprofit organization developed a capital cam- paign to renovate a fire station for a Hispanic community. After each of the cases, questions are provided to help you think about how cultural issues are related to the leadership process.
Case 16.1
A Challenging Workplace
as a leader in campus organizations, samira Tanaka, a student, often led projects and took deadlines very seriously. her strong work ethic led to an internship offer at a Japanese automotive company.
at orientation for her internship, samira learned that Japanese compa- nies historically had little diversity in terms of race and gender. Women in Japan were not as prevalent in the workforce as in north america. in an effort to adapt to north american norms, Japanese subsidiaries had well-developed diversity policies. For example, samira tracked the usage of minority-owned businesses in the company’s supply base. This ensured that the company invested in local businesses that operated in tradition- ally economically disadvantaged areas. investing in the local community was already an important business value in Japan, so this was a simple adaptation for samira’s company.
The company culture was a unique blend of Japanese and north american work styles. The employees in north america worked fewer
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 453
hours than the employees in Japan. around the office, it was common for employees to hear Japanese and english. however, management still had some internal conflict. Japanese advisers were perceived as focusing on the creation of consensus in teams, often leading to slow decision making. north american workers were seen as rushing into projects without enough planning. Feedback was indirect from both Japanese and north american managers.
samira successfully completed two internship rotations and was about to graduate from college. her new manager often asked her to follow up with other team members to complete late tasks. as she had been taught in school, she was proactive with team members about complet- ing their work. samira thought she was great at consistently inviting others to participate in the decision-making process. she always offered her opinion on how things could be done better, and sometimes even initiated tasks to improve processes on her own. although she saw her- self as an emerging take-charge leader, samira always downplayed her ambitions. in school, she was often stereotyped in negative ways for being an assertive female leader, and she didn’t want to be seen in that way at work.
some of her peers at work advised her that it was important to con- sider working at a plant near her hometown because it would be closer to her family. however, she was not interested in following that advice. samira thought it was more exciting to work near a large city or to take a job that involved travel. she didn’t think it was appropriate to discuss with her peers her family concerns in relation to her future job needs.
Toward the end of her final internship, samira received a performance evaluation from a senior manager. her manager praised her as being very dependable, as planning deadlines well, and as being very compe- tent at her tasks overall. however, he also told her she was increasingly perceived as too pushy, not a team player, and often speaking out of turn. This often irritated her peers.
samira had never seen herself this way at work and did not understand why she was not seen as aligning with the company’s core value of work- ing with others. Good grades and campus leadership activities had got- ten her this far, but this evaluation led her to question whether she could work for this company after graduation.
samira ultimately realized that her workplace was different from the campus atmosphere she was used to. if she wanted to be an emerging leader in the workplace, she had to better adapt to her new environment.
(Continued)
454 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Questions
1. What similarities and differences can you identify between north american and Japanese working styles?
2. in what way did this company reflect the characteristics of other Confucian asia countries?
3. Why do you think samira was not seen as a team player?
4. What universal leadership attributes did samira exhibit?
5. What other suggestions would you have for samira in this situation?
(Continued)
Case 16.2
A special Kind of Financing
Central Bank is a small Midwestern savings and loan institution that manages $3 billion in assets. it competes with 16 other financial institu- tions for customers; most of those other institutions have substantially larger holdings. To better serve its customers and attract a larger cus- tomer base, Central Bank conducted a financial-need survey of the peo- ple who lived in the area.
The survey revealed some interesting and culturally relevant informa- tion. Muslims represented a sizable minority in the community, making up about 8% of the overall population. however, a review of the bank registry revealed that few Muslims, if any, banked at Central Bank. The results of the survey were puzzling. Given the large numbers of Muslims in the community, the management wondered why there were no Muslim customers at Central Bank.
To answer this question, Central Bank invited a group of local Muslims to meet and discuss their thoughts about financing and how their ideas related to the financial services offered by the bank. The meeting was a real eye-opener for the bank management. The Muslims’ ideas about bank- ing were very different from the traditional Western beliefs about banking.
during the discussion, the management learned that the principles of islam strongly influence the banking attitudes and behaviors of Muslims. The principles of islamic finance were set forth in the Koran more than 14 centuries ago. For instance, Koranic law forbids paying or receiving interest. These principles stress that money is only a medium of exchange and should not be used to make more money. From the islamic point of
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 455
view, the human element in a business venture is more important than the money used to finance the venture. Furthermore, according to islamic finance, the provider of capital and the user of capital should share equally in the risk of a business venture.
These ideas about finance were different from the way Central Bank thought about them. Central Bank was not accustomed to the way Muslims viewed money as a medium of exchange. having been enlight- ened through these discussions, the management at Central Bank felt challenged to develop a financing program that was more in line with the attitudes and values of islamic finance principles.
in order to attract the business of Muslim customers, Central Bank created and began offering two new types of mortgage financing, called ijara and murabaha. ijara is a finance plan in which the bank buys a home for a customer and leases it to the customer, who pays rent plus a portion of the property purchase. Murabaha is a transaction in which the bank buys the home and sells it to the customer at an agreed-upon markup, and the customer pays for the home in installments over 15 to 30 years. Both ijara and murabaha are consistent with islamic beliefs that prohibit Muslims from paying or receiving interest. in these two types of transactions, money is used to purchase something tangible, but money is not used to make money. Central Bank received favorable legal rulings (fatwas) from some of the leading islamic legal scholars in the United states and the world to validate these types of financing.
Central Bank’s islamic finance plans have become quite popular. although Central Bank has been successful with these plans, it has also met resist- ance. some people have expressed strong disapproval of special finance programs specifically geared to the Muslim population. others are against it because it mixes issues of faith and public finance. however, the resist- ance has not stopped Central Bank. Central Bank is very proud to be the only bank in the country to serve the needs of the Muslim community in this way.
Questions
1. Why do you think banks in the United states have been slow to offer financing expressly for Muslims?
2. do you think it is fair to offer one minority group a special banking opportunity?
3. how does ethnocentrism come into play in this case?
4. how does in-group collectivism relate to Central Bank’s finance plans?
5. how do you think the other banks in the community will react to Central Bank?
456 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Case 16.3
Whose Hispanic Center is it?
river City is a rapidly growing city in the Midwest with a population of 200,000 people, growing at about 5% annually. it is a diverse community with a racial composition that is 65% white, 20% african american, 13% hispanic, and 2% native american. The hispanic population in river City is one of the fastest growing of all segments, growing at about 10% annually.
The hispanic community is represented by the hispanic Center, a non- profit organization that serves the needs of the hispanic community and broader river City community through a variety of programs and ser- vices. a board of directors and an executive director manage the hispanic Center. Two newly appointed board members have led a transformation of the center, including renovating the physical facilities and shifting the focus of program services. The new members are Mary davis, who has experience in neighborhood development, and José reyna, who has experience in city government. The board of directors is made up of 15 people, 10 of whom identify themselves as hispanic and 5 of whom identify themselves as non-hispanic.
The hispanic Center owned an old building that was slated for renova- tion so the center could have more space for offices and community programs (e.g., educational programming, cultural competence and leadership training, and legal services). The need for the building was validated by what people expressed at a series of community forums. The building was an old fire station that had been mothballed for 15 years, and the hispanic Center bought the building from river City for $1. although the fire station needed a lot of renovation, it was located in a perfect place, at the center of the hispanic community. however, a com- plete renovation of the building was needed.
To raise funds for the renovation, the board of directors initiated a citywide capital campaign. The goal of the campaign was to raise $1.4 million, the estimated amount for a complete, first-class renovation of the building.
along with their regular jobs, Mary and José tackled the fund-raising campaign with a full head of steam. in just 6 months, using their wide array of skills, they successfully raised $1.3 million for the project (most of which came from private foundations and corporations). With just $100,000 still to be raised, the leaders and some board members were getting excited about the possibility of the new community center. This excitement was heightened because the renovated building was going to be constructed using the latest green building techniques. These tech- niques were environmentally sound and incorporated healthful and highly efficient models of construction.
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 457
in order to raise the final $100,000, Mary and José proposed a new series of fund-raising initiatives that would focus on smaller donors (e.g., $10, $20, or $30 donors), primarily from the hispanic community. To kick off a series of events, a formal event at a local hotel was proposed, with tickets costing $75 per person. Just before this event, Mary and José encountered some resistance and found out that their excitement about the renovation needed to be tempered.
during a scheduled board meeting, several members of the board expressed concern with the latest fund-raising efforts. some board mem- bers questioned the wisdom of targeting the fund-raising to the hispanic community, believing that hispanic people tended to give to their churches rather than to public not-for-profit organizations. others ques- tioned the price of the tickets to fund-raising events that was being sought from small donors, $75. These members argued for a smaller admission fee (e.g., $20) that would allow more members of the com- munity to attend. as the discussion proceeded, other board members expressed discontent with the fancy plans for the new green building. They argued that the renovation was becoming a special interest project and a pet project of a few ambitious visionaries.
Board members also started to question the transformation of the hispanic Center under Mary and José’s leadership. Board members expressed frustrations about the new goals of the center and about how things were proceeding. There was a sense that the request for commu- nity-based support was unreasonable and in conflict with cultural norms. in the past, the center moved slowly toward change, keeping the focus on one goal: to provide emergency services to the local community. When change came in the past, it was incremental. people were not aggressive, and they did not make trouble.
Under the leadership of Mary and José, there was a perception that the new center and programs were too grand and refined for the community they were intended to serve. The vision for the new center seemed to take things to a new sophisticated level that was not grounded in the common work or the people-oriented values of the center.
Questions
1. how would you describe the strengths and weaknesses of Mary’s and José’s leadership on this project?
2. do you see any problem in targeting part of the fund-raising cam- paign directly toward the hispanic community?
(Continued)
458 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
3. The Latin america leadership profile stresses the importance of team- oriented leadership and deemphasizes individualistic leadership. how does the leadership of Mary and José compare with the Latin america profile?
4. how do hispanic cultural dimensions help explain the resistance some people felt and expressed toward the renovation project?
5. if you were Mary or José, how would you temper your excitement about renovating the new fire station?
(Continued)
LeADersHip instrUMent
Culture and leadership are different concepts; when they are measured, they are measured in different ways using different questionnaires. Currently, there are no measures that assess culture and leadership simultaneously, nor are there measures of cultural leadership. There are questionnaires that measure culture, and as shown throughout the book, there are many mea- sures of leadership.
Perhaps the best-known measure of culture is Hofstede’s Culture in the Workplace™ questionnaire. This questionnaire measures a person’s cultural preferences on four dimensions: individualism, power distance, certainty, and achievement. People can use their profiles on these dimensions to learn about themselves and to compare themselves with the profiles of people in other cultures.
The Dimensions of Culture questionnaire that follows is an abbreviated version of the original culture questionnaire used in the GLOBE studies. This questionnaire is included in the chapter for illustrative purposes only and should not be used for research. The scores you receive on the ques- tionnaire are individual-level scores rather than societal- or organization- level scores. People who are interested in using the GLOBE scales for research should use the complete questionnaire, as referenced in House et al. (2004).
The Dimensions of Culture questionnaire will help you examine your perceptions about various characteristics of your culture. This questionnaire is not a personality measure (such as the Myers-Briggs instrument) but rather a measure of your attitudes and perceptions about culture.
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 459
Dimensions of Culture Questionnaire
Instructions: Using the following scales, circle the number that most accurately reflects your response to each of the 18 statements. There are no right or wrong answers, so provide your immediate impressions. (The items on this questionnaire are adapted from the items used in the GLoBe studies to assess the dimensions of culture, but the GLoBe studies used five items to analyze each of the cultural dimensions.)
Uncertainty Avoidance
1. in this society, orderliness and consistency are stressed, even at the expense of experimentation and innovation.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, societal requirements and instructions are spelled out in detail so citizens know what they are expected to do.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
power Distance
1. in this society, followers are expected to:
Question their leaders obey their leaders when in disagreement without question
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, power is:
shared throughout Concentrated at the society the top
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
institutional Collectivism
1. in this society, leaders encourage group loyalty even if individual goals suffer.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
460 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
2. The economic system in this society is designed to maximize:
individual interests Collective interests
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
in-Group Collectivism
1. in this society, children take pride in the individual accomplishments of their parents.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, parents take pride in the individual accomplishments of their children.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Gender egalitarianism
1. in this society, girls are encouraged more than boys to attain a higher education.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, who is more likely to serve in a position of high office?
Men Women
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Assertiveness
1. in this society, people are generally:
nonassertive assertive
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, people are generally:
Tender Tough
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 461
Future orientation
1. in this society the accepted norm is to:
accept the status quo plan for the future
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, people place more emphasis on:
solving current problems planning for the future
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
performance orientation
1. in this society, students are encouraged to strive for continuously improved performance.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, people are rewarded for excellent performance.
strongly disagree strongly agree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Humane orientation
1. in this society, people are generally:
not at all Very concerned concerned about others about others
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2. in this society, people are generally:
not at all Very sensitive sensitive to others toward others
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
soUrCe: adapted from house, r. J., hanges, p. J., Javidan, M., dorfman, p. W., & Gupta, V. (eds.), Culture, Leadership, and Organizations: The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies, © 2004, saGe publications.
462 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
table 16.4 Cultural dimensions and Mean scores for selected Cultural Clusters
Mean Scores* of Selected Cultural Clusters
GLOBE Cultural Dimensions Anglo
Latin America
Middle East
Southern Asia
Latin Europe
GLOBE Overall
Your Score
Uncertainty avoidance 4.42 3.62 3.91 4.10 4.18 4.16 ____
Power distance na na na na na 5.17 ____
Institutional collectivism 4.46 3.86 4.28 4.35 4.01 4.25 ____
In-group collectivism 4.30 5.52 5.58 5.87 4.80 5.13 ____
Gender egalitarianism 3.40 3.41 2.95 3.28 3.36 3.37 ____
Assertiveness 4.14 4.15 4.14 3.86 3.99 4.14 ____
Future orientation 4.08 3.54 3.58 3.98 3.68 3.85 ____
Performance orientation 4.37 3.85 3.90 4.33 3.94 4.10 ____
Humane orientation 4.20 4.03 4.36 4.71 3.71 4.09 ____
soUrCe: adapted from house, r. J., hanges, p. J., Javidan, M., dorfman, p. W., & Gupta, V. (eds.), Culture Leadership, and Organizations: The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies, © 2004, saGe publications, inc. reprinted with permission.
*The mean scores in this table represent societal practice scores for selected cultures on each of the nine cultural dimensions. in the GLoBe studies, mean scores were derived from subjects’ responses to five questions for each of the dimensions.
na = not available
scoring
The dimensions of Culture questionnaire is designed to measure your percep- tions of the different dimensions of your culture. score the questionnaire by doing the following. First, sum the two responses you gave for each of the items on each of the dimensions. second, divide the sum of the responses by two. The result is your mean score for the dimension.
Example. if for power distance you circled 3 in response to Question 1 and 4 in response to Question 2, you would score the dimension as follows:
3 + 4 = 7
7 ÷ 2 = 3.5
power distance mean score = 3.5
When you are finished scoring, you should have nine mean scores. after you have scored the questionnaire, place your mean scores for each of the dimen- sions in the table in “scoring interpretation.”
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 463
scoring interpretation
your scores on the dimensions of Culture questionnaire provide data on how you see the culture in which you live and work. Table 16.4 provides informa- tion from the GLoBe project about how subjects from different cultures describe the dimensions of those cultures. The table also provides an overall mean for how these dimensions were viewed by people from all of the cul- tures.
By entering your scores in the last column in Table 16.4, you can get a bet- ter understanding of how your perception of your own culture compares to that of others. you can also compare your scores to other spe- cific cultures (e.g., Middle east or Latin america). do you see your culture as more or less egalitarian than others? do you think your culture empha- sizes the future more than others? do people from other cultures stress performance less or more than your own culture? Like these questions, the table and your scores can be used to bring to the surface the ways in which your culture and the cultures of others are compatible or incompatible with each other. Understanding how your culture relates to other cultures is the first step to improved understanding between you and people from other cultures.
464 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
sUMMAry
Since World War II, there has been a dramatic increase in globalization throughout the world. Globalization has created a need for leaders with greater understanding of cultural differences and increased competencies in cross-cultural communication and practice. This chapter discusses research on culture, its dimensions, and its effects on the leadership process.
Culture is defined as the commonly shared beliefs, values, and norms of a group of people. Two factors that can inhibit cultural awareness are ethnocentrism and prejudice. Ethnocentrism is the human tendency to place one’s own group at the center of one’s observations of others and the world. It is problematic for leaders because it prevents them from fully understanding the world of others. Similarly, prejudice consists of judgments about others based on fixed attitudes and unsub- stantiated data. Prejudice has a negative impact because it is self-oriented and inhibits leaders from seeing the many facets and qualities of others.
In the past 30 years, many studies have focused on identifying various dimensions of culture. The best known is the work of Hofstede (1980, 2001), who identified five major dimensions: power distance, uncertainty avoidance, individualism–collectivism, masculinity–femininity, and long-term–short- term orientation. Expanding on Hofstede’s work, House and his colleagues (2004) delineated additional dimensions of culture, including in-group col- lectivism, institutional collectivism, future orientation, assertiveness, perfor- mance orientation, and humane orientation.
The GLOBE studies offer the strongest body of findings to date on culture and leadership. Using established quantitative research methods, GLOBE research- ers studied how 17,000 managers from 62 different countries viewed leadership. They analyzed the similarities and differences between regional clusters of cul- tural groups by grouping countries into 10 distinct clusters: Anglo, Latin Europe, Nordic Europe, Germanic Europe, Eastern Europe, Latin America, the Middle East, Sub-Saharan Africa, Southern Asia, and Confucian Asia. An analysis of each of the 10 clusters revealed the particular dimensions on which each region was strong or weak and unique from other regions.
In addition, GLOBE researchers identified six global leadership behaviors that could be used to characterize how different cultural groups view leader- ship: charismatic/value-based, team-oriented, participative, humane-ori- ented, autonomous, and self-protective leadership. Based on these behaviors, researchers created leadership profiles for each of the 10 cultural clusters that delineate the relative importance and desirability different cultures ascribe to different attributes and characteristics of leadership.
Chapter 16 Culture and Leadership 465
One outcome of the GLOBE project was the identification of a list of lead- ership attributes that were universally endorsed as positive and negative attributes of leadership. From this list, it appears that the universally endorsed portrait of an exceptional leader has a high degree of integrity, charisma, and interpersonal skill. The portrait of an ineffective leader is someone who is asocial, malevolent, self-focused, and autocratic.
The scope of the GLOBE project is its main strength. The findings from this project make a major statement about how cultures around the world view leadership. Other strengths are its quantitative research design, an expanded classification of cultural dimensions, a list of universally accepted leadership attributes, and the contribution it makes to a richer understanding of the leadership process. On the negative side, the GLOBE studies do not provide findings that form a single theory about the way culture relates to leadership. Furthermore, the definitions of the core cultural dimensions are unclear, the conceptualization of leadership used in the studies is limiting, the leadership measures are not exact, and the list of universally endorsed leadership attributes does not account for the various situations in which leaders operate. Regardless of these limitations, the GLOBE studies stand out because they offer so much valuable information about the unique ways culture influences the leadership process.
sharpen your skills with saGe edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouse7e
notes
1. The Czech Republic was excluded from the analysis because of problems in the data.
reFerenCes
Adler, N. J., & Bartholomew, S. (1992). Managing globally competent people. Acad- emy of Management Executive, 6, 52–65.
Bing, J. W. (2004). Hofstede’s consequences: The impact of his work on consulting and business practices. Academy of Management Executive, 18(1), 80–87.
Brodbeck, F. C., Frese, M., & Javidan, M. (2002). Leadership made in Germany: Low on compassion, high on performance. Academy of Management Executive, 16(1), 16–29.
466 Leadership Theory and praCTiCe
Dorfman, P. W., Hanges, P. J., & Brodbeck, F. C. (2004). Leadership and cultural variation: The identification of culturally endorsed leadership profiles. In R. J. House, P. J. Hanges, M. Javidan, P. W. Dorfman, V. Gupta, & Associates (Eds.), Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies (pp. 669– 722). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Gudykunst, W. B., & Kim, Y. Y. (1997). Communicating with strangers: An approach to intercultural communication (3rd ed.). New York: McGraw-Hill.
Gudykunst, W. B., & Ting-Toomey, S. (1988). Culture and interpersonal communica- tion. Newbury Park, CA: SAGE.
Hall, E. T. (1976). Beyond culture. New York: Doubleday. Hofstede, G. (1980). Culture’s consequences: International differences in work-related
values. Beverly Hills, CA: SAGE. Hofstede, G. (2001). Culture’s consequences: Comparing values, behaviors, institutions,
and organizations across nations. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE. House, R. J., Hanges, P. J., Javidan, M., Dorfman, P. W., & Gupta, V. (Eds.). (2004).
Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
House, R. J., & Javidan, M. (2004). Overview of GLOBE. In R. J. House, P. J. Hanges, M. Javidan, P. W. Dorfman, V. Gupta, & Associates (Eds.), Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies (pp. 9–28). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Kluckhohn, R. R., & Strodtbeck, F. L. (1961). Variations in value orientations. New York: HarperCollins.
Lord, R., & Maher, K. J. (1991). Leadership and information processing: Linking percep- tions and performance. Boston: Unwin-Everyman.
McClelland, D. C. (1961). The achieving society. Princeton, NJ: Van Nostrand. Ponterotto, J. G., & Pedersen, P. B. (1993). Preventing prejudice: A guide for counselors
and educators. Newbury Park, CA: SAGE. Porter, R. E., & Samovar, L. A. (1997). An introduction to intercultural communica-
tion. In L. A. Samovar & R. E. Porter (Eds.), Intercultural communication: A reader (8th ed., pp. 5–26). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth.
Ronen, S., & Shenkar, O. (1985). Clustering countries on attitudinal dimensions: A review and synthesis. Academy of Management Review, 10(3), 435–454.
Ting-Toomey, S. (1999). Communicating across cultures. New York: Guilford. Triandis, H. C. (1995). Individualism and collectivism. Boulder, CO: Westview. Trompenaars, F. (1994). Riding the waves of culture. New York: Irwin.
467
Author Index
Adams, J. A., 278 (figure), 279 Adler, N. J., 427, 428 Agrawal, A., 323 Aime, F., 364 Allen, S. J., 27, 28 Alliger, G. M., 19–20, 22, 23 (table) Amado, G., 300 Ambrose, M. L., 337 American Bar Association, 400 Amos, B., 365 Anand, S., 141, 147, 148 Ancona, D., 376 Anderson, R. A., 278 (figure), 279 Andrews, P. H., 403 Antonakis, J., 1, 161, 167, 187 Anzieu, D., 300 Ardison, S. D., 376 Aronson, E., 330 Arthur, M. B., 165, 176, 177 Asgari, S., 415 Atwater, L., 141 Aumann, K., 400 Avolio, B. J., 163, 164, 166–167,
168 (figure), 170, 172, 175, 177, 179, 180, 187, 195, 196, 200–205, 207, 209, 217, 334
Axelrod, R. H., 179 Ayman, R., 402
Babcock, L., 403 Bader, P., 22, 23, 23 (table)
Bailey, D. E., Jr., 278 (figure), 279 Bailey, J., 179 Bakker, A. B., 170 Bamforth, K., 298 Bandura, A., 204 Barge, J. K., 366, 374, 376, 379 Barling, J., 163, 180 Barron, J. W., 301 Bartholomew, S., 427, 428 Bass, B. M., 1, 5, 19, 20, 43, 161, 163,
166–167, 168 (figure), 170, 172, 177, 179, 180, 187, 190, 195, 201, 334, 335, 347, 402
Beauchamp, T. L., 337, 341, 342, 344 Belkin, L., 400, 401 Bell, E., 404, 407 Bennis, W. G., 14, 20, 172, 173,
190, 229, 309 Bergeron, D. M., 406 Bergman, J. Z., 365 Bergman, S. M., 365 Bernardi, R. A., 409 Berry, G. R., 374, 376 Bersoff, D. N., 405 Bess, J. L., 125 Beyerlein, M., 363 Bielby, D. D., 403 Bielby, W. T., 403 Bikson, T. K., 363–364 Bing, J. W., 451, 452 Bion, W., 298, 302
468 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Blake, R. R., 71, 72, 74, 75, 78, 79 (figure), 80, 81, 87
Blanchard, K., 93, 94, 95 (figure), 96, 100, 101, 229
Blanchard, K. H., 93, 94, 98, 100, 102 Blank, R., 412–415 Blascovich, J., 406 Block, C. J., 406 Block, P., 343 Boatwright, K. J., 100, 101 Bond, J., 400 Bongiorno, R., 401 Bono, J. E., 27 Book, E. W., 402 Borgida, E., 404, 405 Bosco, S. M., 409 Botero, I. C., 365 Bowers, D. G., 73 Bowie, N. E., 335, 337, 341, 342, 344 Bowles, H. R., 400, 401, 403, 407 Brazil, D. M., 100 Bresman, H., 376 Brodbeck, F. C., 433, 440, 448 Brown, M., 330 Bryman, A., 1, 7, 19, 81, 161, 164,
177, 178, 187 Bullis, R. C., 100 Burgess, D., 404 Burke, C. S., 365, 375, 384 Burns, J. M., 3, 4, 7, 11, 162, 163,
166, 177, 190, 195, 338, 339, 342, 347, 402
Caldwell, D., 376 Cameron, K. S., 208 Carew, P., 102 Carli, L. L., 399, 400, 401, 406,
407, 408 Carlson, D. S., 237, 337 Carmeli, A., 141 Cartwright, D., 73 Caruso, D. R., 27, 28 Castro, S. L., 123, 143, 147, 148 Catalyst, 398, 400, 401, 409 Center for American Women and
Politics, 398
Chabris, C. F., 409 Chace, S., 277 Chan, A., 196 Chemers, M. M., 397, 404, 410 Childress, J. F., 341, 342 Chonko, L. B., 237 Chow, C., 175 Christie, A., 163, 180 Cianci, A. M., 209 Ciulla, J. B., 329, 330, 338 Cobb, A. T., 383, 384 Cogliser, C. C., 147, 148 Cohen, S. G., 363–364 Collinson, D., 1 Columb, V. L., 409 Conger, J. A., 164, 165, 179, 339 Connelly, M. S., 48, 49, 52, 53 Coons, A. E., 72 Cooper, C., 201, 208 Cooper, C. L., 406 Copeland, N., 3 Cordery, J., 376 Corrigall, E., 408 Costa, P. T., 27 Couric & Co., 405 Covey, S. R., 204, 229, 343 Craig, L., 400 Craig, S. B., 355 Crain, W. C., 331–332, 333 Crits-Christoph, P., 302 Curphey, G. J., 368 Czander, W. M., 301, 306, 308
Dalla Costa, J., 346 Dansereau, F., 138–139 Darwin, C., 297 Dasgupta, N., 415 Davenport, S. W., 365 Davies, P. G., 406 Day, D. V., 1, 140, 365 Deaux, K., 404, 405 DeBoard, R., 301, 306 DeChurch, L. A., 123 Del Carmen Triana, M., 409 De Pree, M., 229, 343 DeRue, D. S., 364, 365, 384
author index 469
Dessler, G., 115 DeVader, C. L., 19–20, 22, 23 (table) Diamond, M. A., 303, 308 Dobbins, G. H., 402 Dodge, K. A., 404 Dorfman, P. W., 431, 436 (table),
440, 441–448 (figure), 448, 458, 462 (table), 464
Downton, J. V., 162 Drecksel, G. L., 366 Driscoll, D. M., 404 Duan, C., 410 Dubouloy, M., 308 Dutton, J. E., 208 Dyer, J. H., 376 Dyer, W. G., 376 Dyer, W. G., Jr., 376
Eagle, M. N., 301 Eagly, A. H., 196, 399, 400, 401, 402,
403, 405, 406, 407, 408, 415 Echtenkamp, B. A., 406 Effertz, J., 402 Ehrhart, M. G., 226, 237 Eilam, G., 196, 205 Eisold, K., 306 Emde, R. N., 297 Enriquez, E., 300 Ensher, E. A., 401, 407 Erikson, E. H., 297, 298 Eubank, D., 278 Evanecky, D., 147 Evans, M. G., 115, 124
Fayol, H., 13 Fenzel, L. M., 404 Fernandez, C. F., 99, 100 Fields, D. L., 226 Fisher, B. A., 8, 382 Fisher, C. M., 369, 371, 375, 383 Fiske, S., 404, 405 Fiske, S. T., 404 Fleishman, E. A., 5, 43, 47–48,
51–57, 66, 68, 366, 374 Fletcher, J. K., 403 Florent-Treacy, E., 323
Forsyth, D. R., 409 Foti, R. J., 8 Frankena, W., 336 French, J. R., 10, 12 (table),
23 (table) Frese, M., 433 Freud, S., 295, 298, 304, 305, 397 Fry, L. W., 201
Gabriel, Y., 301, 306, 308 Galanos, A. N., 279 Galinsky, A., 406 Galinsky, E., 400 Gardner, H., 363 Gardner, J. W., 1 Gardner, W. L., 161, 176, 196, 201,
202, 203, 207, 217 Geffken, D., 278 Gehrlein, S., 364, 365 Gelfand, M., 403 George, B., 197–200, 205–206, 220 Gergen, D., 241 Gerhardt, M. W., 27 Gerstner, C. R., 140 Gettman, H., 403 Gibbons, T. C., 164, 175 Gilbert, J. A., 49, 50, 52, 53 Gilligan, C., 343 Gilmore, T., 303 Gilroy, F. D., 404 Gini, A., 337 Ginnett, R. C., 368 Glass, B., 410 Glick, P., 403, 404, 408 Goldberg, L. R., 26, 27 (table) Goldin, C., 404 Goldman, P., 125 Goleman, D., 27, 28 Goodwin, G. F., 375 Gould, L., 303 Gouran, D. S., 377 Graeff, C. L., 99, 100, 102 Graen, G. B., 138–139, 138 (figure),
140, 142, 143 (figure), 145–149, 154
Graham, J. W., 226, 227, 239
470 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Grashow, A., 257, 258, 260, 265, 275, 277, 292
Graves, L. M., 399, 401, 405 Greenleaf, R. K., 225–229, 236,
239, 253, 343, 347 Greenwald, A. G., 415 Grint, K., 1 Gronn, P., 365 Gudykunst, W. B., 428, 429 Guilleux, F., 277 Gupta, V., 431, 436 (table),
441–448 (figure), 441 (figure), 458, 462 (table), 464
Gurin, P., 410 Gustafson, S. B., 355 Gutek, B. A., 400, 402
Hackman, J. R., 368, 369, 369 (table), 370, 371, 373, 373 (figure), 375, 383
Haga, W., 138–139 Hale, J. R., 226 Hall, D. T., 407 Hall, E. T., 430 Halpin, A. W., 117 Halpin, S. M., 375 Hamilton, D. L., 404 Hanges, P. J., 431, 436 (table), 440,
441–448 (figure), 448, 458, 462 (table), 464
Hannah, S. T., 209 Harding, F. D., 43, 47–48, 51–57,
66, 68 Harris, K. J., 141, 144 Harter, N., 147 Hartman, L. P., 330 Hartnell, C. A., 196, 201, 202, 207,
217, 226, 237 Hashmi, N., 409 Haslam, S. A., 401 Heifetz, R. A., 257, 258, 260, 263,
265, 266, 267, 275, 276, 277, 292, 337, 338
Heilman, M. E., 404, 405 Hein, M. B., 5, 366, 374 Heinen, B., 371, 383
Heinitz, K., 170 Helgesen, S., 209, 402 Heller, T., 7 Hemphill, J. K., 3, 72 Henderson, D., 231, 233, 236,
237, 239, 240, 242, 249 Hengen, S., 398 Hersby, M. D., 401 Hersey, P., 93, 94, 98, 100 Hesse, H., 227, 253 Hewlett, S. A., 400 Hickman, G. R., 1 Hinkin, T. R., 178, 187 Hirokawa, R. Y., 377 Hirschhorn, L., 297, 300,
303, 306 Hoch, J. E., 365 Hodges, P., 229 Hoegl, M., 364, 365 Hoffman, L. R., 9 Hofstede, G., 431, 464 Hogan, R., 339, 340 (figure) Hogg, M. A., 9 Hollander, E. P., 7 Hollenbeck, J. R., 364, 372 House, R. J., 115, 117, 118, 121, 123,
164–166, 176, 177, 427, 431, 436 (table), 440, 441–448 (figure), 448, 458, 462 (table), 464
Howell, J. M., 177, 179, 195 Hoyt, C., 406 Hoyt, C. L., 404, 406, 410 Hu, J., 141, 147, 148, 231,
232 (figure), 237, 253 Hughes, R. L., 368 Humphrey, S., 364 Hunt, J. G., 164 Huse, M., 409 Hyatt, D. E., 371, 379 Hymowitz, C., 399
Ilgen, D. R., 364, 372 Ilies, R., 27, 141, 142, 201 Indvik, J., 115, 123, 132 Inter-Parliamentary Union, 399 Ishio, Y., 401
author index 471
Jackson, G., 1 Jacobs, T. O., 43, 47–48, 51–57, 66, 68 Jacobson, M. B., 402 Jago, A. G., 7, 8, 19 Jaksa, J. A., 345 Jaques, E., 298, 303 Javidan, M., 427, 431, 433, 436 (table),
440, 441–448 (figure), 448, 458, 462 (table), 464
Jensen, J. M., 365 Jensen, M. A. C., 375 Jermier, J. M., 122, 124 Johannesen-Schmidt, M. C., 402, 408 Johnson, B. T., 402 Johnson, C. R., 330 Johnson, M., 364, 372 Johnson, R. W., 123 Johnson, S., 406 Judge, T. A., 27 Jundt, D., 364, 372 Jung, D. I., 20, 175, 181
Kacmar, K. M., 141, 144, 237 Kaës, R., 300 Kagan, J., 297 Kahn, R. L., 73, 74 Kaiser, R. B., 339, 340 (figure) Kanter, R., 405, 406 Kanungo, R. N., 165, 330, 335, 342 Karam, E. P., 365, 384 Karau, S. J., 403, 405, 415 Katz, D., 73, 141 Katz, R., 43–46, 49, 54, 56, 68 Keller, R. T., 170 Kellerman, B., 10 Kemp, C., 22, 23, 23 (table) Kernberg, O., 305 Kernis, M. H., 203 Kerr, S., 123 Kets de Vries, M. F. R., 296, 299,
301, 303, 304, 305, 306, 308, 309, 317, 323
Kidder, T., 25 Kim, B. H., 365 Kim, Y. Y., 429 Kinlaw, D. C., 375
Kirkman, B., 376 Kirkpatrick, S. A., 20, 22, 23 (table) Kitchener, K. S., 341, 342 Kite, M., 404 Klein, C., 375 Klimoski, R. J., 365 Klonsky, B., 402 Kluckhohn, R. R., 431 Knoke, D., 401 Koenig, A. M., 405, 408 Kohlberg, L., 297, 330, 331 (figure) Kohut, H., 304, 305 Komives, S. R., 341 Konrad, A. M., 408 Korabik, K., 402 Korotkin, A. L., 5, 366, 374 Korotov, K., 301, 308 Kotter, J. P., 9 (figure), 13, 14 Kouzes, J. M., 172, 174, 175, 190, 343 Kozlowski, S. W. J., 365 Kozlowski, W. J., 365 Krantz, J., 303, 306 Kray, L. J., 406 Kroeck, K. G., 169, 181 Kuhnert, K. W., 171 Kunda, Z., 404
LaFasto, F. M. J., 368, 369 (table), 370, 371, 372, 385, 389–390
Lai, L., 403 Lam, S. S. K., 240 Larson, C. E., 368, 369 (table),
370, 371, 372, 385, 389–390 Laschever, S., 403 Laurie, D. L., 257, 260, 263, 275, 277 Leeden, R., 402 Levi, D., 364, 384 Levin, K. Y., 5, 366, 374 Levinson, H., 301, 306 Lewis, P., 171 Lewis, S., 406 Liden, R. C., 140, 141, 147, 148, 231,
232 (figure), 233, 236, 237, 239, 240, 242, 249, 253
Lieb, P., 408 Likert, R., 73
472 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Linsky, M., 257, 258, 260, 265, 266, 275, 277, 292
Lipman-Blumen, J., 339 Liska, L. Z., 123 Locke, E. A., 20, 22, 23 (table) Locke, E. E., 334 Long, S., 298 Lord, R., 440, 450 Lord, R. G., 19–20, 22, 23 (table) Lowe, K. B., 161, 169, 176, 181 Luborsky, L., 302 Lucas, N., 341 Luthans, F., 200–205, 207, 209 Lynch, L., 410
Maccoby, M., 305 Maher, K. J., 440, 450 Major, D. A., 364 Makhijani, M. G., 402, 403 Malone, T. M., 409 Mankin, D., 363–364 Mann, R. D., 21, 22, 23 (table) Manz, C. C., 365, 379 Marion, R., 260 Marks, M. A., 48, 49, 52, 53, 365, 366,
368, 370, 371, 379 Marlowe, H. A., 22 Martin, R., 364 Maslyn, 147 Mathieu, J., 376 Mattis, M., 407 Maume, D. J., Jr., 399 May, D. R., 201, 203 Mayer, J. D., 27, 28 McCanse, A. A., 74, 80, 81, 87 McCauley, C. D., 401 McClane, W. E., 147 McClelland, D. C., 431 McCollough Vaillant, L., 308 McCrae, R. R., 27 McDougall, J., 301 McGhee, D. E., 415 McGinn, K. L., 400, 401, 403, 407 McKelvey, B., 260 McMahon, T. R., 341 Mendel, G., 300
Mendonca, M., 335, 342 Menninger, W., 299 Menzies Lyth, I., 298, 303 Meuser, J. D., 231, 232 (figure),
233, 236, 253 Miller, D., 296, 299, 301, 305, 306 Miller, T., 409 Mirvis, P., 308 Misumi, J., 74, 81 Mitchell, A. A., 405, 408 Mitchell, R. R., 115, 117,
118, 121, 123 Mitscherlich, A., 300 Mitscherlich, M., 300 Modell, A. H., 267 Moore, B. V., 2 Morgeson, F. P., 141, 142, 201,
365, 384 Morris, S., 402 Morrison, A., 401 Morrissey, L., 278 Mortensen, M., 363 Mouton, J. S., 71, 72, 74, 75,
78, 79 (figure), 80 Muethel, M., 364, 365 Mumford, M. D., 1, 5, 43, 47–48,
50, 51–57, 59, 66, 68, 366, 374 Murphy, S., 406 Murphy, S. E., 401, 407
Nadler, D. A., 20, 368 Nahrgang, J. D., 141, 142, 201 Nanus, B., 14, 20, 172, 173, 190 National Association of
Women Business Owners Indianapolis, 408
National Center for Education Statistics, 398
Neck, C. P., 379 Neider, L. L., 124 Nelson, R., 93, 96, 100, 101 Nemanich, L. A., 170 Neubert, M. J., 237 Neumann, J. E., 297, 306 Newton, J., 298 Nielsen, S., 409
author index 473
Nieva, V. E., 400 Nkomo, S., 404, 407 Noel, T. W., 337
Obholzer, A., 306 Oglensky, B., 297 Ohlott, P., 401 Oke, A., 196, 201, 202, 207,
217, 226, 237 Organ, D. W., 141 Orvis, K. L., 376 Orzano, J., 278 Ospina, S., 147
Padilla, A., 339, 340 (figure) Pailhe, A., 400 Panaccio, A., 231, 232 (figure), 253 Parisi-Carew, E., 102 Parker, G. M., 364 Parry, K. W., 355 Partners In Health, 25 Patterson, K. A., 229 Paul, J. B., 364 Pauleen, D. J., 376 Pearce, C. L., 365 Pedersen, P. B., 429 Peng, A. C., 240 Pentland, A., 409 Perrewe, P. L., 337 Peters, T. J., 4 Peterson, S. J., 196, 201, 202, 207, 217 Piaget, J., 297 Pillai, R., 178 Pine, F., 297 Platz, S. J., 402 Plutchick, R., 297 Pojman, L. P., 335, 336 Ponterotto, J. G., 429 Porter, G., 363 Porter, R. E., 429 Posner, B. Z., 172, 174, 175, 190, 343 Powell, G. N., 399, 401, 402, 405 Price, T., 330 Pritchard, M. S., 345 Proctor-Thomson, S. B., 355 Puig, M., 295
Quinn, R. E., 208
Ragins, B. R., 407 Raven, B. H., 10, 11, 12 (table),
23 (table) Rawls, J., 344 Reb, J., 406 Reddin, W. J., 93 Rentsch, J. R., 365 Ricci, R., 278 Rickman, J., 298 Riggio, R. E., 161, 163, 364 Ristikari, T., 405, 408 Ritchie, J. E., Jr., 408 Rittman, A. L., 365, 366, 368,
370, 371, 379 Roberts, J. A., 237 Roberts, R. P., 209 Ronen, S., 435 Rosen, B., 376 Rosener, J., 402 Rost, J. C., 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 14, 347 Rouse, C., 404 Rowold, J., 170 Ruddy, T. M., 371, 379 Ruderman, M. N., 401 Rudman, L. A., 403, 408 Russell, R. F., 229 Ryan, M. K., 401
Salas, E., 365, 375, 384 Salovey, P., 27, 28 Samovar, L. A., 429 Sandberg, S., 399 Santora, J. C., 232 Sarros, J. C., 232 Scandura, T. A., 147, 178, 201, 208 Schaubroeck, J., 240 Schein, V. E., 408 Schellhardt, T. D., 399 Schilling, J., 339 Schminke, M., 337 Schriesheim, C. A., 123, 124, 143, 147,
148, 187, 201, 208 Schriesheim, J. R., 123 Schumann, P. L., 334, 335
474 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Schwartz, J. L. K., 415 Schyns, B., 339 Sculley, J., 24 Seashore, S. E., 73 Seeman, M., 3 Sego, D. J., 364 Sekaquaptewa, D., 406 Sendjaya, S., 232 Senge, P. M., 229, 343 Shamir, B., 165, 176, 177, 196, 205 Shankman, M. L., 27, 28 Shenkar, O., 435 Shuffler, M., 371, 383 Sievers, B., 298 Simon, S., 406 Simonet, D. V., 14 Sims, H. P., 365 Sims, P., 197 Sinder, R. M., 257, 258, 260, 275, 277 Sivasubramaniam, N., 169, 181, 187 Skinnell, K., 406 Slipp, S., 412–415 Small, D. A., 403 Small, E. E., 365 Smith, A., 410 Smith, J. A., 8 Solansky, S. T., 365 Solaz, A., 400 Soo, C., 376 Sosik, J. J., 20, 163, 181 Spears, L. C., 226, 227, 228, 229, 253 Spencer, S. J., 404, 406 Stagl, D. C., 384 Stagl, K. C., 365, 375 Stangor, C., 410 Stapley, L., 303 Steele, C. M., 406 Steidlmeier, P., 163, 195, 201,
334, 335, 347 Stein, M., 303 Stewart, A. J., 410 Stewart, G. L., 365 Stilwell, D., 140 Stinson, J. E., 123 Stogdill, R. M., 2, 19, 20, 21,
23 (table), 31, 71, 72, 87
Stone, A. G., 229 Stone, B., 24 Stora, J. B., 300 Strodtbeck, F. L., 431 Stroessner, S. J., 404 Sutcliffe, K. M., 204
Tejeda, M. J., 178 Tett, R. P., 14 Thoits, P. A., 403 Thomas, G., 364 Thomas, R. J., 309 Thompson, G., 101 Thompson, L., 406 Thompson, M., 406 Thomson, A., 398 Thor, K. K., 50 Threlfall, K. V., 52 Thygeson, M., 278, 278 (figure), 279 Tims, M., 170 Ting-Toomey, S., 428 Tomkins, S. S., 297 Townsend, B., 407 Tracey, J. B., 178 Trevino, L. K., 330, 337 Triandis, H. C., 431 Trist, E., 298 Trompenaars, F., 430 Tsakumis, G. T., 209 Tsui, A. S., 402 Tuckman, B. W., 375 Turner, N., 163, 180 Tushman, M. L., 20 Twenge, J. M., 408
Uhl-Bien, M., 1, 138 (figure), 140, 142, 143 (figure), 145–148, 154, 260
Ulstad, V., 278 U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, 398 U.S. Department of Defense, 399
Van Dierendonck, D., 225, 230 (table), 241
Van Engen, M. L., 402, 408 Vansina, L., 300 Van Til, J., 7
author index 475
Vecchio, R. P., 99, 100, 101 Velasquez, M. G., 336 Vidyarthi, P. R., 141, 147, 148 Vinkenburg, C. J., 408 Vogus, T. J., 204 Volkan, V. D., 296 Von Glinow, M. A., 401 Vrignaud, P., 323 Vroom, V. H., 99, 116
Wageman, R., 363, 369, 371, 375, 383 Waldman, D. A., 365 Walton, R. E., 370, 373, 373 (figure) Walumbwa, F. O., 196, 201, 202, 203,
207, 217, 226, 237 Wang, D., 365 Waterman, R. H., 4 Watola, D. J., 365 Watson, C., 9 Wayne, L., 343 Wayne, S. J., 140, 231, 233, 236,
237, 239, 240, 242, 249 Weber, M., 164 Weber, T. J., 207 Wernsing, T. S., 196, 201, 202,
207, 217 Westen, D., 301 Wheatley, M., 229 Wheeler, A. R., 141, 144 Whittington, J. L., 201 Willemsen, T. M., 402
Williams, C. L., 399 Williams, J., 401, 406 Winer, B. J., 117 Wirth, L., 408 Wofford, J. C., 123 Wolfe, C. J., 27 Woolley, A. W., 409 Wu, A., 175
Xanthopoulou, D., 170
Yammarino, F. J., 43, 143, 148, 166 Yetton, P. W., 99 Yukl, G. A., 74, 81, 99, 100, 102, 147,
177, 179
Zaccaro, S. J., 5, 20, 22, 23, 23 (table), 43, 47–57, 66, 68, 365, 366, 368, 370, 371, 374, 376, 379, 383
Zagier Roberts, V., 306 Zaleznik, A., 15, 20, 299, 301, 306 Zander, A., 73 Zhang, Z., 365 Zhao, H., 231, 233, 237, 239,
240, 242, 249 Zhou, X., 123, 143, 148 Zhu, W., 163 Zigarmi, D., 93, 94, 95 (figure),
96, 100, 101 Zigarmi, P., 93, 94, 95 (figure),
96, 100
477
Subject Index
Achievement-oriented leadership, 117, 118, 122
Adams, John, 62–64 Adams, Rachel, 185–187 Adaptive challenges in adaptive
leadership, 262–263, 264–266 Adaptive leadership, 5 (box), 292–293
adaptive challenges in, 262–263, 264–266
adaptive work in, 273–274 application of, 277–279 case studies, 279–285 criticisms of, 276–277 defined, 258–260 description of, 257–260 getting on the balcony in,
263–264 giving work back to the people in,
270–271 holding environments in,
266–267, 273, 276 identifying adaptive challenges in,
264–266 leader behaviors in, 263–272 leadership instrument, 286–291 maintaining disciplined attention in,
269–270 model of, 260–274 in practice, 259 (table) prescriptive approach in, 275–276 process mechanism, 274
protecting leadership voices from below, 271–272
regulating distress and, 266–269 situational challenges and, 261–263 strengths, 275–276 systems perspective in, 258–259 technical challenges in,
261–262, 264 Adaptive work, 273–274 Advocacy, 380 Agreeableness, 27 Alger High School, 236 Alliance formation, 379 Altruism, 334–335, 342–343 Altruistic motive, 313 Angliss, Elizabeth, 235 Anglo cluster, 435–436 (figure), 437
leadership profile, 444–445 Antecedent conditions for servant
leadership, 231–233 Apple, 24 Applied clinical practice, 300 Aristotle, 336 Assertiveness, 433 Assigned versus emergent leadership,
8–10 Attention, disciplined, 269–270 Authentic leadership, 4 (box),
220–221 application of, 208–209 approaches to, 197–205
478 Leadership Theory and pracTice
balanced process mechanisms in, 203
case studies, 209–217 components of, 202–203 confidence in, 204 critical life events and, 205 criticisms of, 207–208 defined, 196 description of, 195–205 factors that influence, 203–205 hope in, 204 internalized moral
perspective in, 203 moral reasoning in, 204–205 optimism in, 204 practical approach to, 197–200 process mechanism, 205–206 relational transparency in, 203 resilience in, 204 self-awareness in, 201, 202–203 strengths, 206–207 theoretical approach to, 200–205
Authentic Leadership Questionnaire (ALQ), 207, 217–219
“Authentic Leadership Theory and Process: Origins, Effects and Development,” 200
Authority-compliance management style, 75, 76 (figure)
Avoidance, work, 265–266 Awareness in servant leaders, 228
Baines, Carol, 34–35 Baines Company, 34–35 Balanced process mechanisms, 203 Barelli, Harold, 181–183 Barrett, Colleen, 247–248 Barrett, Kyle, 281–283 Bates, Martina, 129–131 Behavioral approach, 89–90
application of, 81–82 case studies, 82–86 criticisms of, 81 description of, 71–78 leadership instrument, 87–89 Managerial Grid® in, 74–78, 80
Ohio State University studies, 71–73, 80
process mechanism, 78–80 strengths, 80–81 University of Michigan studies,
71–72, 73–74, 80 Behavioral flexibility, 50 Behavior Questionnaire, 87–89 Betty Ford Center, 216–217 Bhutto, Benazir, 397 Big Five traits, 27 Biological perspective in adaptive
leadership, 258–259 Bipolar dysfunction, 315–316 Bond, Roy, 414–415 Bradley, Lori, 413–414 Brako, 126–127 Breyer, Michael, 412 Brundtland, Gro Harlem, 397 Buffering of team members, 380 Builders, 320–321 Burns, J. M., 338–339 Burns, Ursula, 398 Bush, George W., 25
Career experiences in skills model, 54–55, 56 (figure)
Case studies adaptive leadership, 279–285 authentic leadership, 209–217 behavioral approach, 82–86 culture and leadership, 452–458 ethical leadership, 349–354 gender and leadership, 411–415 leader-member exchange (LMX)
theory, 149–154 path-goal theory, 125–131 psychodynamic approach,
313–316 servant leadership, 242–248 situational approach, 103–108 skills approach, 60–66 team leadership, 385–388 trait approach, 32–37 transformational leadership,
181–187
subject index 479
Cathartic experiences, 311 Center for Applied Ethics, 226 Central Asia Institute (CAI),
213–214 Central Bank (large), 36–37 Central Bank (small), 454–455 Challenging the process
mechanism, 174 Change catalysts, 319–320 Character Counts! program, 26 Charisma and transformational
leadership, 164–165 City Mortgage, 151–152 Clear, elevating goals, 368 Clinical Paradigm, 296–297 Clinton, Bill, 25, 335 Coaches, 322 Coaching
approach, 94 of team members in interpersonal
health, 378 Coercion and leadership, 11–13 Coercive power, 12 (table) Collaborative climate, 370, 378 Collaborative Team Leader
Instrument, 389 Collective learning, 312–313 Collectivism
in-group, 432–433 institutional, 432
Colluders, 339–340 Commitment to growth of people,
228–229, 234–235 Common Core State Standards,
273–274 Communicators, 322–323 Community
building, 229, 235–236, 346–347
real, 312–313 Compassion, 200 Competencies in skills model,
48–51, 48 (figure), 56 (figure) Competent team members, 369–370 Competing commitments, 265 Complexity Leadership Theory, 260
Conceptualization in servant leadership, 228, 233
Conceptual skill, 45–46 Conducive environments for
destructive leadership, 340–341 Confidence, 204 Conflict management, 268, 378–379 Conformers, 339–340 Confucian Asia cluster,
435–436 (figure), 437 leadership profile, 443
Conscientiousness, 27 Consideration behaviors, 72 Context and culture in servant
leadership, 231–232 Contingent reward, 171 Conventional morality stage,
331 (table), 332 Copy Center, The, 128–129 Core conflictual relationship themes,
301–302 Country-club management style,
75, 76 (figure) Creative deployment of self, 173 Critical life events and authentic
leadership, 205 Crosby, Nancy, 386–387 Crystallized cognitive ability, 52 Culture, 427–428, 464–465
application of research on, 451–452 assertiveness and, 433 case studies, 452–458 clusters of world, 434–439 criticisms of study of, 450–451 definition of, 428 dimensions of, 430–434 ethnocentrism and, 428–429 gender egalitarianism and, 433 human orientation and, 434 in-group collectivism and, 432–433 institutional collectivism and, 432 leadership behavior and, 439–448 leadership instrument, 458–463 performance orientation and, 434 power distance and, 432 prejudice and, 429–430
480 Leadership Theory and pracTice
related concepts, 428–430 strengths of research on, 449–450 uncertainty avoidance and,
431–432 universally desirable and undesirable
leadership attributes and, 448 Culture, Leadership, and Organizations:
The GLOBE Study of 62 Societies, 431, 434–439, 464–465
criticisms of, 450–451 leadership behavior and, 439–448 strengths of, 449–450
Dark side of leadership, 339–341 Decision making facilitation, 378 Delegating approach, 95–96 Dependency assumption, 302 Destructive leaders, 339–341 Determination, 24–25 Developmental perspective in
authentic leadership, 196 Development levels, 96 Dimensions of culture, 430–434 Dimensions of Culture Questionnaire,
458–463 Directing style, 94 Directive (task) behaviors, 94 Directive leadership, 117 Dirks, Angi, 350–351 Disciplined attention, 269–270 Distress, regulating, 266–269 Distributed leadership, 365 Duggan, Len, 413–414 Dunwoody, Ann E., 398 Dyadic relationship,
137–139, 139–140 (figure)
Eastern Europe cluster, 435–436 (figure), 437
leadership profile, 441 Effectiveness
gender and leadership, 401–408 team, 367–372
Elder Care Project, 60–62 Emergent versus assigned
leadership, 8–10
Emotional healing in servant leadership, 233–234
Emotional intelligence, 27–28 Empathy, 227 Employee orientation behaviors, 73 Empowerment, 235 Enabling others to act, 174 Encouraging the heart, 175 End of Leadership, The, 10 Enron, 25, 195 Environmental influences in skills
model, 55, 56 (figure) Espoused values, 265 Esprit de corps, 379 Essex High School, 243–244 Ethical egoism, 334 Ethical leadership, 341, 359–360
altruism in, 342–343 application of, 349 case studies, 349–354 community building in, 346–347 criticisms of, 348–349 fairness and justice in, 344–345 honesty in, 345–346 leadership instrument, 355–358 modeling, 379 respect in, 341–342 strengths, 347–348
Ethics Burns on, 338–339 centrality to leadership, 336–337 conventional morality and,
331 (table), 332 dark side of leadership and,
339–341 defined, 330–333 description of, 329–330 ethical behavior and, 235 Heifetz on, 337–338 postconventional morality and,
331 (table), 332–333 preconventional morality and,
331–332 principles of ethical leadership and,
341–347 theories, 333–336
subject index 481
Ethics, The Heart of Leadership, 329 Ethnocentrism, 428–429 Expectancy theory of motivation, 116 Expert power, 12 (table) Experts, 51 External environmental influences, 55 External environmental leadership
actions in team leadership, 379–381
External support and recognition, 371 Extraversion, 27
Facebook, 399 Facilitating decision making, 378 Fairness, 344–345 Farmer, Paul, 25, 242, 244–246 Fear of success, 314–315 Female Advantage: Women’s Ways of
Leadership, The, 209 Fight-flight assumption, 302 Five-factor personality model, 26–27 Focus of group process mechanisms, 5 Folie à deux, 304 Followers, 7
adaptive leadership and, 273, 275–276
characteristics, 118–119, 121 (table)
helped to grow and succeed, 234–235
performance and growth outcomes, 236–237
put first by servant leaders, 234 receptivity in servant leadership,
232–233 susceptible, 339–340
Ford, Betty, 209, 214–217 Foresight, 228 Formal authority system, 119–120 Four Is, 178 Fox, Terry, 198 Freud, Sigmund, 297–298,
300–301 Full Leadership Development:
Building the Vital Forces in Organizations, 166
Gandhi, Indira, 397 Gandhi, Mohandas, 162, 164 Garafallo, Andy, 64–66 Gender and leadership, 397–398,
419–420 application of research on, 411 case studies, 411–415 criticisms of research on, 410–411 human capital differences and,
399–401 leadership instrument, 415–418 leadership labyrinth and, 398–401 navigating the labyrinth of, 406–408 prejudice and, 404–406 strengths from understanding effects
of, 409–410 styles and effectiveness differences,
401–408 Gender egalitarianism, 433 General cognitive ability, 52 George approach to authentic
leadership, 197–200, 205–206 Germanic Europe cluster,
435–436 (figure), 437–438 leadership profile, 446, 447 (figure)
“Getting on the balcony,” 263–264 Giving work back to the people,
270–271 “Glacier project,” 298 Glass ceiling, 399, 412–413 Globalization, 427–428 GLOBE research program, 431,
434–439, 464–465 criticisms of, 450–451 leadership behavior and, 439–448 strengths of, 449–450
Goal focusing, 377 Golden Rule, 344 Gooding Public Schools, 283–285 Great Lakes Foods (GLF), 32–37 Green, Kim, 387–388 Greenleaf, Robert K., 226–229, 343 Greenleaf Center for Servant
Leadership, 226, 242 Group coaching, 309–313 Group theory, 3 (box)
482 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Halpert, Madeline, 279–281 Harvard Business Review, 43 Healing, 228 Heifetz, Ronald, 337–338 Helgesen, Sally, 209, 210–212 Hernandez, Jenny, 151–152 Heroic leadership, 179 Hidyat, Sherif, 386–387 High directive-high supportive
style, 94 High directive-low supportive style, 94 High supportive-low directive style, 95 High Tech Engineering (HTE),
181–183 Hill Model for Team Leadership,
366–381 criticisms of, 383–384 leadership actions and, 377–381 leadership decisions and, 372–376 team effectiveness and, 367–372
Hirschhorn, Larry, 300 Hitler, Adolf, 163 Holding environments, 266–267, 273,
276, 337–338 Honesty, 345–346 Hope, 204 Hughes, Michael, 26 Human capital differences and gender,
399–401 Humane orientation, 434 Human skill, 44–45 Hussein, Saddam, 163
Idealized influence, 163, 167–168 Identification with the aggressor, 304 Implicit Association Test (IAT),
415–418 Impoverished management style,
75–76, 76 (figure) Inability to Mourn, The, 300 Independent Center for Clinical
Research (ICCR), 185–187 Individual attributes in skills model,
48 (figure), 52–53, 56 (figure) Individualism and exchange
stage, 331–332
Individualized consideration, 163, 169–171
Individual member needs, 379 Industrial democracy, 298 Information power, 12 (table) Ing, Cathy, 386–387 In-group collectivism, 432–433 In-groups, 138–139, 140 (figure),
144–145 Initiating structure, 72 Inner theatre, 301–302 Innovators, 321 INSEAD, 310 Inspirational motivation,
163, 169 Institutional collectivism, 432 Integrity, 25–26 Intellectual stimulation,
163, 169 Intelligence, 23–24 Internal environmental influences, 55 Internalized moral perspective, 203 Internal relational leadership actions in
team leadership, 378–379, 381 Internal task leadership actions in
team leadership, 377–378, 381 International Journal of Human
Resource Management, 323 Interpersonal accord and conformity,
331 (table), 332 Interpersonal process mechanism in
authentic leadership, 196 Intrapersonal perspective of authentic
leadership, 196
Jobs, Steve, 24 Jones, David, 352–354 Journey to the East, The, 227, 253 Justice, 344–345
Kant, Immanuel, 341–342 Kelleher, Herb, 247–248 Kennedy, John F., 164 Kim, Yon, 234–235 Kim Jong-il, 432 King, Martin Luther, Jr., 164
subject index 483
Klein, Autumn, 234 Knowledge in skills model, 50–51 Kohlberg’s stages of moral
development, 330–333
Labyrinth, leadership, 398–401 navigating the, 406–408
Laissez-faire leadership, 166, 172 Latin America cluster,
435–436 (figure), 438 leadership profile, 441–442
Latin Europe cluster, 435–436 (figure), 438
leadership profile, 442–443 Leader Behavior Description
Questionnaire (LBDQ), 72, 87 Leader-follower relationships and
psychodynamic approach, 302–304
Leader-member exchange (LMX) theory, 149–154, 157–158
application of, 148–149 criticisms of, 146–148 description of, 137–144 early studies, 137–139,
139–140 (figure) later studies, 140–142 leadership instrument, 154–156 leadership making and, 142–144 process mechanism, 144–145 strengths, 145–146
Leadership assigned versus emergent, 8–10 behaviors, 117, 121 (table) centrality of ethics to, 336–337 coercion and, 11–13 components of, 6–7 dark side of, 339–341 defined, 2–7 described, 7–15 evolution of definitions of, 2–5 (box) flexibility in, 99 heroic, 179 labyrinth, 398–401 making, 142–144 management and, 13–15
narcissistic, 305 outcomes in skills model,
48 (figure), 53–54, 56 (figure) participative, 121–122 power and, 10–11 principled, 371–372 research attention on, 1–2 styles, 94–96, 401–408 supportive, 117–118, 121 trait versus process mechanism, 7–8 ways of conceptualizing, 5
Leadership Archetype Questionnaire (LAQ), 317–323
Leadership Grid, 74–78, 80, 87 Leadership instrument
adaptive leadership, 286–291 authentic leadership, 217–219 behavioral approach, 87–89 cultural dimensions, 458–463 ethics and morals, 355–358 gender and leadership, 415–418 leader-member exchange (LMX)
theory, 154–156 path-goal theory, 132–134 psychodynamic approach, 317–323 servant leadership, 249–252 situational approach, 108–111 skills approach, 66–68 team leadership, 389–392 trait approach, 37–39 transformational leadership,
187–189 Leadership Quarterly, 161, 176, 200 Leadership Trait Questionnaire
(LTQ), 37–39 Leadership Without Easy Answers,
257, 276 Legitimate power, 12 (table) Lens, psychodynamic, 311–312 Lewis, Janet, 386–387 Life events, critical, 205 Linett, Wayne, 386–387 Listening by servant leaders, 227 LMX 7 Questionnaire, 154–156 LMX theory. See Leader-member
exchange (LMX) theory
484 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Low neuroticism, 27 Low supportive-low directive style,
95–96
Madison, Jim, 152–154 Management and leadership, 13–15 Management-by-exception, 171–172 Managerial Grid®, 74–78, 80, 87 Mandela, Nelson, 168, 199 Marthan Sports, 84 Martinez, Rene, 97–98 Mayer-Salovey-Caruso Emotional
Intelligence Test (MSCEIT), 27–28
Men, Management and Mental Health, 299
Menninger Clinic, 299 Merkel, Angela, 397 Metts, Kelsey, 32 Middle East cluster, 435–436 (figure),
438–439 leadership profile, 446–447
Middle-of-the road management style, 76–77, 76 (figure)
Middletown School District, 129–131 Mills, Smith, & Peters, 150–151 Minnesota Multiphasic Personality
Inventory, 37 Mirroring and idealizing, 303–304 Mitscherlich, Alexander, 300 Modeling, 379 Model the way practice, 174 Monographs in Leadership and
Management, 200 Moore, Betsy, 85–86 Moral development stages,
330–333 Morality
conventional, 331 (table), 332 postconventional, 331 (table),
332–333 preconventional, 331–332
Moral reasoning, 204–205 Moral uplifting, 163 Mortenson, Greg, 212–214 Mother Teresa, 237–238
Motivation, 52–53 expectancy theory of, 116 inspirational, 163, 169 path-goal theory and, 122–123
Multifactor Leadership Questionnaire (MLQ), 177, 178, 180, 187–189
Mutual identification, 311 Myers-Briggs Type Indicator, 37
Narcissism, 305 Negotiation, 380 Nelson, Pat, 36–37 Networking, 379 Neuroticism, low, 27 Neurotic Organization, The, 299 “New Leadership” paradigm, 161 Nixon, Richard, 348 Noble, Sharon, 243–244 Nonleadership factor, 172 Nooyi, Indra, 398 Nordic Europe cluster,
435–436 (figure), 439 leadership profile, 443, 444 (figure)
Obama, Barack, 348 Obedience and punishment stage, 331 O’Connor, Sandra Day, 398 Ohio State University studies,
71–73, 80, 117 Openness, 27 Opportunism, 77–78, 78 (figure) Optimism, 204 Organizational citizenship behavior
(OCBs), 237 Organizational Diagnosis, 299 Organizational performance
outcomes, 237 Organizational role analysis, 298 Orientation, 267–268 Out-groups, 138–139,
140 (figure), 144–145
Pairing assumption, 303 Parks, Susan, 84 Participative approach, 117 Participative leadership, 121–122
subject index 485
Partners In Health, 25, 244–246 Passive-aggressives, 313–314 Paternalism/maternalism,
77, 78 (figure) Path-Goal Leadership Questionnaire,
132–134 Path-goal theory, 135
application of, 124–125 case studies, 125–131 components of, 116, 117 (figure) criticisms of, 123–124 description of, 115–120 follower characteristics and,
118–119, 121 (table) leader behaviors and,
117, 121 (table) leadership instrument, 132–134 process mechanism, 120–122 strengths, 122–123 task characteristics and,
119–120, 121 (table) Peer group coaching, 308–309 PepsiCo, 398 Perceived Leader Integrity Scale
(PLIS), 355–358 Perfect Plastics Incorporated (PPI),
351–352 Performance, 53–54
orientation, 434 Personal distress, 268–269 Personality
charisma and, 164–165 model, five-factor, 26–27 perspective of leadership, 5 in skills model, 53
Personal power, 11, 12 (table) Perspective taking, 49–50 Persuasion in servant leadership, 228 Peters, Carly, 150–151 Pillars of Leadership program, 26 Plato, 336 Position power, 11, 12 (table) Positive psychological attributes in
authentic leadership, 203–205 Postconventional morality, 331 (table),
332–333
Power bases of, 12 (table) coercive, 11 distance, 432 expert, 12 (figure), 51 leadership and, 10–11 management, 378–379 personal, 11, 12 (table) position, 11, 12 (table) relationships, 5
Power and the Corporate Mind, 299 Practical approach to authentic
leadership, 197–200 Practicality, 99 Preconventional morality, 331–332 Prejudice
culture and, 429–430 gender and, 404–406
Prescriptions, 99 Price Waterhouse v. Ann Hopkins, 405 Primary work group, 119–120 Principled leadership, 371–372, 389 Problem-solving skills, 48–49, 53 Process mechanism versus trait
leadership, 7–8 Processors, 321–322 Production orientation behaviors, 73 Productive norms, 268 Protection, 267
of leadership voices from below, 271–272
Providing direction, 267 Pseudotransformational leadership,
163, 339 Psychodynamic approach, 324
application of, 308–313 builders and, 320–321 case studies, 313–316 change catalysts and, 319–320 Clinical Paradigm, 296–297 coaches and, 322 communicators and, 322–323 criticisms of, 307–308 description of, 295–296 folie à deux in, 304 group coaching and, 309–313
486 Leadership Theory and pracTice
history of, 297–301 identification with the aggressor
and, 304 inner theater and, 301–302 innovators and, 321 key concepts and dynamics within,
301–305 leader-follower relationships and,
302–304 leadership instrument, 317–323 mirroring and idealizing and,
303–304 narcissism and, 305 process mechanism, 305–306 processors and, 321–322 social defense mechanisms and, 303 strategists and, 319 strengths, 306–307 transactors and, 320
Psychodynamic lens, 311–312 Psychotherapy perspective in adaptive
leadership, 260
Real community, 312 Reasoning, moral, 204–205 Referent power, 12 (table) Regulating distress, 266–269 Relational transparency, 203 Relationship behaviors, 71 Resilience, 204 Respect, 341–342 Results-driven structure, 369 Reward, contingent, 171 Reward power, 12 (table) Rogers, Scott, 283–285 Rosenfeld, Eva, 279–281 Rousseff, Dilma, 397
Sandberg, Sheryl, 399 Santiago, Thomas, 32–33 Self-awareness, 201, 202–203, 309 Self-confidence, 24 Self-discipline, 199–200 Self-regulation, 201 Servant leadership, 5 (box),
253–254, 343
antecedent conditions, 231–233 application of, 241–242 awareness in, 228 behaviors, 232 (figure), 233–236 building a theory about, 229–231 case studies, 242–248 characteristics of, 227–229 commitment to growth of people in,
228–229, 234–235 community building in,
229, 235–236 conceptualization in, 228, 233 criticisms of, 240–241 defined, 226 description of, 225–231 emotional healing and, 233–234 empathy in, 227 empowerment in, 235 ethical behavior in, 235 follower performance and growth
outcomes, 236–237 follower receptivity in, 232–233 foresight in, 228 healing in, 228 historical basis of, 226–227 leader attributes in, 232 leadership instrument, 249–252 listening in, 227 model of, 231–238 organizational performance
outcomes, 237 outcomes, 236–238 persuasion in, 228 process mechanism, 238–239 putting followers first, 234 societal impact of, 237–238 stewardship in, 228 strengths, 239–240
Servant Leadership Questionnaire (SLQ), 240, 249–252
Service orientation in adaptive leadership, 260
Shared leadership, 365 Shared vision, 174 Shivitz, Daniel, 128–129 Simpson, Kate, 233
subject index 487
Situational approach, 112–113 application of, 102–103 case studies, 103–108 criticisms of, 99–102 description of, 93–96 development levels and, 96 leadership instrument, 108–111 leadership styles and, 94–96 process mechanism, 97–98 strengths, 98–99
Situational challenges in adaptive leadership, 261–263
Situational Leadership® II (SLII®) model, 94, 100–102
development levels in, 96 leadership style in, 94–96
Situational Leadership® Questionnaire, 108–111
Skills approach, 68–69 application of, 59–60 case studies, 60–66 competencies in, 48–51, 48 (figure) conceptual skill in, 45–46 criticisms of, 58–59 description of, 43–56 human skill in, 44–45 leadership instrument, 66–68 process mechanism, 56–57 skills model, 47–56 strengths, 57–58 technical skill in, 44 three-skill, 44–47
Skills Inventory, 66–68 Skills model, 47–56
career experiences in, 54–55, 56 (figure)
competencies in, 48–51, 48 (figure), 56 (figure)
environmental influences in, 55, 56 (figure)
individual attributes in, 48 (figure), 52–53, 56 (figure)
leadership outcomes in, 48 (figure), 53–54, 56 (figure)
“Skills of an Effective Administrator,” 43
Skills perspective of leadership, 5 Smith, Alexa, 32 Sociability, 26 Social architects, 173 Social contract and individual rights,
331 (table), 332 Social defense mechanisms, 303 Social dreaming, 298 Social good, 53 Social intelligence, 22, 50 Social judgment skills, 49–50 Social order, 331 (table), 332 Social perceptiveness, 50 Social performance, 50 Social Security Administration,
152–154 Social systems as defense against
anxiety, 298 Societal impact of servant leadership,
237–238 Society Without the Father, 300 Sociotechnical systems, 298 Soslow, Marina, 414–415 Southern Asia cluster,
435–436 (figure), 439 leadership profile, 445–446
Southwest Airlines, 238, 242, 247–248
Speaking the unspeakable, 265 Spiritual leadership, 4 (box) Standards of excellence,
370–371, 378 Steinem, Gloria, 407 Stereotypes, gender, 404–406 Stewardship, 228 Stimulation, intellectual, 163, 169 Stolze, Ted, 413–414 Strategists, 319 Structuring for results, 378 Sub-Saharan Africa cluster,
435–436 (figure), 439 leadership profile, 445
Summerhill, 271 Supporting approach, 95 Supportive (relationship)
behaviors, 94
488 Leadership Theory and pracTice
Supportive leadership, 117–118, 121 Susceptible followers, 339–340 Systems perspective in adaptive
leadership, 258–259
Tanaka, Samira, 452–454 Task behaviors, 71 Task characteristics, 119–120,
121 (table) Team Excellence Survey, 389 Team leadership, 393
application of, 384–385 case studies, 385–388 criticisms of, 383–384 description of, 363–381 leadership actions and, 377–381 leadership decisions and,
372–376 leadership instrument, 389–392 model, 366–381 model mechanism, 381–382 shared or distributed, 365 strengths, 382–383 team effectiveness and, 367–372
Team management style, 76 (figure), 77
Technical challenges in adaptive leadership, 261–262, 264
Technical skill, 44 Thatcher, Margaret, 397 Theoretical approach to authentic
leadership, 200–205 3-D management style theory, 93 Three-skill approach, 44–47 Tipping points for change, 309 Tobias, Pamela, 412–413 Towne, Jim, 385–386 Training team members
in task skills, 378 Trait approach, 39–40
application of, 32 case studies, 32–37 criticisms of, 30–32 description of, 19–23 determination in, 24–25 emotional intelligence in, 27–28
five-factor personality model and, 26–27
integrity in, 25–26 intelligence in, 23–24 leadership instrument, 37–39 process mechanism, 29 self-confidence in, 24 sociability in, 26 social intelligence and, 22 strengths, 30
Trait versus process mechanism leadership, 7–8
Transactional leadership, 162–163, 169–170
factors, 171–172 Transactors, 320 Transformational leadership, 190
application of, 180–181 case studies, 181–187 challenging the process mechanism
in, 174 charisma and, 164–165 creative deployment of self in, 173 criticisms of, 178–180 defined, 162–163 description of, 161–175 enabling others to act in, 174 encouraging the heart in, 175 factors, 167–171 idealized influence in, 163, 167–168 individualized consideration in, 163,
169–171 inspirational motivation in, 163, 169 intellectual stimulation in, 163, 169 leadership instrument, 187–189 model of, 166–171 model the way practice in, 174 other perspectives in, 172–175 process mechanism, 175–176 pseudo-, 163, 339 social architects and, 173 strengths, 176–177 transactional leadership vs.,
162–163, 169–170, 171–172 trust in, 173 vision in, 173, 174, 176
subject index 489
Transformation process mechanism in leadership, 5
Transparency, relational, 203 “True North,” 198–199 Trust, 173
Uncertainty avoidance, 431–432 Unified commitment, 370 Universal principles, 331 (table), 333 University of Michigan studies,
71–72, 73–74, 80 Urbanez, Mercedes, 236 Utilitarianism, 334–335
Vertical dyad linkage (VDL) theory, 137–139, 157–158
Vicarious learning, 312 Virtual teams, 376, 385–386 Vision, 173, 176
inspiring a shared, 174
W. K. Kellogg Foundation, 329 Wall Street Journal, 399 Weber, Lisa, 412–413 White, Ryan, 162 Whittling, Sharon, 386–387 Willingness to experiment, 312 Women. See Gender and
leadership Wood, Adam, 60–62 Work avoidance, 265–266 Workplace Within: Psychodynamics
of Organizational Life, The, 300
WorldCom, 25, 195
Xerox, 398
Young, Mark, 83
Zaleznik, Abraham, 299–300
491
About the Author
Peter G. Northouse, PhD, is Professor Emeritus of Communication in the School of Communication at Western Michigan University. In addition to publica- tions in professional journals, he is the author of Introduction to Leadership: Concepts and Practice (now in its third edition) and coauthor of Health Communication: Strategies for Health Professionals (now in its third edi- tion). His scholarly and curricular interests include
models of leadership, leadership assessment, ethical leadership, and leader- ship and group dynamics. For more than 30 years, he has taught under- graduate and graduate courses in leadership, interpersonal communication, and organizational communication on both the undergraduate and gradu- ate levels. Currently, he is a consultant and lecturer on trends in leadership research, leadership development, and leadership education. He holds a doctorate in speech communication from the University of Denver, and master’s and bachelor’s degrees in communication education from Michigan State University.
493
About the Contributors
Alicia Cheak is a Research Associate at INSEAD Global Leadership Centre. Professionally, she has 15 years of research experience in the US and in France. Her research interests include problem solving, knowl- edge mapping, performance-based assessments, collaborative learning, simulation-based learning, and developing leadership instruments.
Susan E. Kogler Hill (PhD, University of Denver, 1974) is professor emeritus and former chair of the School of Communication at Cleveland State University. Her research and consulting have been in the areas of interpersonal and organizational communication. She specializes in group leadership, teamwork, empowerment, and mentoring. She is author of a text titled Improving Interpersonal Competence. In addition, she has written book chapters and published articles in many professional journals.
Crystal L. Hoyt completed her doctorate in social psychology at UC Santa Barbara and is an associate professor of Leadership Studies and Psychology at the University of Richmond. Her research reflects a commitment to con- ducting both basic and applied investigations. In her primary area of research, she explores the role of beliefs, such as self-efficacy, implicit theories, and political ideologies, in the experiences and the perceptions of women and minorities in leadership or STEM fields, or the overweight. In a more applied fashion, she examines factors, such as role models, that may or may not buffer individuals from the deleterious effects of stereotypes and discrimination. She has published nearly 50 journal articles and book chapters and she has co-edited two books.
Manfred F. R. Kets de Vries is the Distinguished Professor of Leadership Development and Organizational Change at INSEAD, France, Singapore, and Abu Dhabi. He is the author, co-author, or editor of more than 40 books, and more than 400 articles. As an educator and consultant he has
494 Leadership Theory and pracTice
worked in more than 40 countries. He is the chairman of the Kets de Vries Institute (KDVI), a leadership development consulting firm. In addition, Kets de Vries is also a psychoanalyst and a member of the International Psychoanalytic Association. He has been listed as one of the 50 most influ- ential management thinkers of the world. He is the recipient of many awards, including two honorary doctorates.
Stefanie Simon is currently a PhD graduate student in Psychology at Tulane University and NSF Predoctoral Fellow. She earned a BA in Psychology and Leadership Studies from the University of Richmond in 2007. Her research centers on the psychology of diversity, with a focus on prejudice, discrimination, and leadership. In her work, she focuses on both the perspective of the target of prejudice and discrimination, as well as the perspective of the perpetrator of prejudice and discrimination. She is par- ticularly interested in how leaders of diverse teams or groups can promote positive intergroup relations and reduce inequality in society.
“I have never really seen anything like this
product before, and I think it is really valuable.”
John Creswell, University of Nebraska–Lincoln
Find exactly what you are looking for,
from basic explanations to
advanced discussion
More content and new
features added this year!
Watch video interviews
with leading methodologists
Discover Methods Lists — methods readings
suggested by other users
Search a custom-designed
taxonomy with more than
1,400 qualitative, quantitative, and mixed methods
terms
Uncover more than 120,000
pages of book, journal, and reference
content to support your learning
Explore the Methods Map
to discover links between
methods
Find out more at www.sageresearchmethods.com
The essential online tool for researchers from the world’s leading methods publisher
- LEADERSHIP-FRONT COVER
- LEADERSHIP
- COPYRIGHT
- BRIEF CONTENTS
- DETAILED CONTENTS
- PREFACE
- CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION
- CHAPTER 2: TRAIT APPROACH
- CHAPTER 3: SKILLS APPROACH
- CHAPTER 4: BEHAVIORAL APPROACH
- CHAPTER 5: SITUATIONAL APPROACH
- CHAPTER 6: PATH–GOAL THEORY
- CHAPTER 7: LEADER–MEMBER EXCHANGE THEORY
- CHAPTER 8: TRANSFORMATIONAL LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 9: AUTHENTIC LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 10: SERVANT LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 11: ADAPTIVE LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 12: PSYCHODYNAMIC APPROACH
- CHAPTER 13: LEADERSHIP ETHICS
- CHAPTER 14: TEAM LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 15: GENDER AND LEADERSHIP
- CHAPTER 16: CULTURE AND LEADERSHIP
- AUTHOR INDEX
- SUBJECT INDEX
- ABOUT THE AUTHOR
- ABOUT THE CONTRIBUTORS
-
- 2015-05-28T22:48:01+0000
- Preflight Ticket Signature
,
Introduction to Leadership
Fourth Edition
2
To Madison and Isla
3
Introduction to Leadership
Concepts and Practice
Fourth Edition
Peter G. Northouse Western Michigan University
4
FOR INFORMATION:
SAGE Publications, Inc.
2455 Teller Road
Thousand Oaks, California 91320
E-mail: [email protected]
SAGE Publications Ltd.
1 Oliver’s Yard
55 City Road
London EC1Y 1SP
United Kingdom
SAGE Publications India Pvt. Ltd.
B 1/I 1 Mohan Cooperative Industrial Area
Mathura Road, New Delhi 110 044
India
SAGE Publications Asia-Pacific Pte. Ltd.
3 Church Street
#10-04 Samsung Hub
Singapore 049483
Copyright © 2018 by SAGE Publications, Inc.
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced or utilized in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by any information storage and retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publisher.
Printed in the United States of America
ISBN: 978-1-5063-3008-2
This book is printed on acid-free paper.
5
Acquisitions Editor: Maggie Stanley
Development Editor: Lauren Holmes
Editorial Assistant: Neda Dallal
eLearning Editor: Katie Ancheta
Production Editor: Libby Larson
Copy Editor: Melinda Masson
Typesetter: C&M Digitals (P) Ltd.
Proofreader: Theresa Kay
Indexer: Wendy Allex
Cover Designer: Gail Buschman
Marketing Manager: Ashlee Blunk
6
Brief Contents
1. Preface 2. About the Author 3. 1. Understanding Leadership 4. 2. Recognizing Your Traits 5. 3. Engaging Strengths 6. 4. Understanding Philosophy and Styles 7. 5. Attending to Tasks and Relationships 8. 6. Developing Leadership Skills 9. 7. Creating a Vision
10. 8. Establishing a Constructive Climate 11. 9. Embracing Diversity and Inclusion 12. 10. Listening to Out-Group Members 13. 11. Managing Conflict 14. 12. Addressing Ethics in Leadership 15. 13. Overcoming Obstacles 16. Glossary 17. Index
7
Detailed Contents
Preface About the Author 1. Understanding Leadership
Introduction Leadership Explained
“Leadership Is a Trait” “Leadership Is an Ability” “Leadership Is a Skill” “Leadership Is a Behavior” “Leadership Is a Relationship” “Leadership Is an Influence Process”
Global Leadership Attributes The Dark Side of Leadership Leadership Snapshot: Indra Nooyi Summary Application
1.1 Case Study 1.2 Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire 1.3 Observational Exercise 1.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 2. Recognizing Your Traits
Introduction Leadership Traits Explained
Intelligence Confidence Charisma Determination Sociability Integrity
Leadership Snapshot: Nelson Mandela Leadership Traits in Practice
George Washington (1732–1799) Winston Churchill (1874–1965) Mother Teresa (1910–1997) Bill Gates (1955–) Oprah Winfrey (1954–)
Summary Application
8
2.1 Case Study 2.2 Leadership Traits Questionnaire 2.3 Observational Exercise 2.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 3. Engaging Strengths
Introduction Strengths-Based Leadership Explained
Historical Background Identifying and Measuring Strengths
Strengths-Based Leadership in Practice Discovering Your Strengths Developing Your Strengths Addressing Your Weaknesses
Leadership Snapshot: Steve Jobs Recognizing and Engaging the Strengths of Others Fostering a Positive Strengths-Based Environment
Summary Application
3.1 Case Study 3.2 Leadership Strengths Questionnaire 3.3 Observational Exercise 3.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 4. Understanding Philosophy and Styles
Introduction Leadership Philosophy Explained
Theory X Theory Y
Leadership Styles Explained Authoritarian Leadership Style Democratic Leadership Style Laissez-Faire Leadership Style
Leadership Snapshot: Victoria Ransom Leadership Styles in Practice Summary Application
4.1 Case Study 4.2 Leadership Styles Questionnaire 4.3 Observational Exercise 4.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References
9
5. Attending to Tasks and Relationships Introduction Task and Relationship Styles Explained
Task Style Relationship Style
Leadership Snapshot: Mick Wilz Task and Relationship Styles in Practice
Task Leadership Relationship Leadership
Summary Application
5.1 Case Study 5.2 Task and Relationship Questionnaire 5.3 Observational Exercise 5.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 6. Developing Leadership Skills
Introduction Administrative Skills Explained
Administrative Skills in Practice Interpersonal Skills Explained
Interpersonal Skills in Practice Leadership Snapshot: Coquese Washington Conceptual Skills Explained
Conceptual Skills in Practice Summary Application
6.1 Case Study 6.2 Leadership Skills Questionnaire 6.3 Observational Exercise 6.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 7. Creating a Vision
Introduction Vision Explained
A Picture A Change Values
Leadership Snapshot: Rosalie Giffoniello A Map A Challenge
Vision in Practice
10
Articulating a Vision Implementing a Vision
Summary Application
7.1 Case Study 7.2 Leadership Vision Questionnaire 7.3 Observational Exercise 7.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 8. Establishing a Constructive Climate
Introduction Constructive Climate Explained Climate in Practice
Providing Structure Clarifying Norms Building Cohesiveness Promoting Standards of Excellence
Leadership Snapshot: Meg Whitman Summary Application
8.1 Case Study 8.2 Organizational Climate Questionnaire 8.3 Observational Exercise 8.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 9. Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
Introduction Diversity and Inclusion Explained
Definitions Brief Historical Perspective
Inclusion Framework Leadership Snapshot: Ursula Burns Diversity and Inclusion in Practice
Model of Inclusive Practices Leader Practices That Advance Diversity and Inclusion Barriers to Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
Summary Application
9.1 Case Study 9.2 Cultural Diversity Awareness Questionnaire 9.3 Observational Exercise 9.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
11
References 10. Listening to Out-Group Members
Introduction Out-Group Members Explained
How Out-Groups Form The Impact of Out-Group Members
Out-Group Members in Practice Strategy 1: Listen to Out-Group Members Strategy 2: Show Empathy to Out-Group Members Strategy 3: Recognize the Unique Contributions of Out-Group Members Strategy 4: Help Out-Group Members Feel Included Strategy 5: Create a Special Relationship With Out-Group Members Strategy 6: Give Out-Group Members a Voice and Empower Them to Act
Leadership Snapshot: Abraham Lincoln Summary Application
10.1 Case Study 10.2 Building Community Questionnaire 10.3 Observational Exercise 10.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 11. Managing Conflict
Introduction Conflict Explained
Communication and Conflict Conflict on the Content Level
Leadership Snapshot: Humaira Bachal Conflict on the Relational Level
Managing Conflict in Practice Fisher and Ury Approach to Conflict Communication Strategies for Conflict Resolution Kilmann and Thomas Styles of Approaching Conflict
Summary Application
11.1 Case Study 11.2 Conflict Style Questionnaire 11.3 Observational Exercise 11.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 12. Addressing Ethics in Leadership
12
Introduction Leadership Ethics Explained Leadership Ethics in Practice
1. The Character of the Leader 2. The Actions of the Leader
Leadership Snapshot: Warren Buffett and Bill and Melinda Gates 3. The Goals of the Leader 4. The Honesty of the Leader 5. The Power of the Leader 6. The Values of the Leader
Culture and Leadership Ethics Summary Application
12.1 Case Study 12.2 Sample Items From the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire 12.3 Observational Exercise 12.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References 13. Overcoming Obstacles
Introduction Obstacles Explained Overcoming Obstacles in Practice
Obstacle 1: Unclear Goals Obstacle 2: Unclear Directions Obstacle 3: Low Motivation
Leadership Snapshot: Bill Courtney Obstacle 4: Complex Tasks Obstacle 5: Simple Tasks Obstacle 6: Low Involvement Obstacle 7: Lack of a Challenge
Summary Application
13.1 Case Study 13.2 Path–Goal Styles Questionnaire 13.3 Observational Exercise 13.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
References Glossary Index
13
Preface
Leadership is a salient topic today. Given the volatility of global events and our national political climate, it is even more important now than it was when the third edition of this book was published. The public remains fascinated by who leaders are and what leaders do. People want to know what accounts for good leadership and how to become good leaders. Despite this strong interest in leadership, there are very few books that clearly describe the complexities of practicing leadership. I have written Introduction to Leadership: Concepts and Practice to fill this void.
Each chapter describes a fundamental principle of leadership and how it relates in practice to becoming an effective leader. These fundamentals are illustrated through examples, profiles of effective leaders, and case studies. The text comprises 13 chapters: Chapter 1, “Understanding Leadership,” analyzes how different definitions of leadership have an impact on the practice of leadership. Chapter 2, “Recognizing Your Traits,” examines leadership traits found to be important in social science research and explores the leadership traits of a select group of historical and contemporary leaders. Chapter 3, “Engaging Strengths,” discusses the emerging field of strengths-based leadership, looking at how several assessment tools can help one to recognize his or her own strengths and those of others and then put those strengths to work as an effective leader. Chapter 4, “Understanding Philosophy and Styles,” explores how a person’s view of people, work, and human nature forms a personal philosophy of leadership and how this relates to three commonly observed styles of leadership: authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire. Chapter 5, “Attending to Tasks and Relationships,” describes how leaders can integrate and optimize task and relationship behaviors in their leadership role. Chapter 6, “Developing Leadership Skills,” considers three types of leadership skills: administrative, interpersonal, and conceptual. Chapter 7, “Creating a Vision,” explores the characteristics of a vision and how a vision is expressed and implemented. Chapter 8, “Establishing a Constructive Climate,” focuses on how important it is for leaders who are running groups or organizations to provide structure, clarify norms, build cohesiveness, and promote standards of excellence. Chapter 9, “Embracing Diversity and Inclusion,” discusses the importance of inclusive leadership and the barriers that can be encountered when trying to embrace diversity and inclusion. Chapter 10, “Listening to Out-Group Members,” explores the nature of out-groups, their impact, and ways leaders should respond to out- group members. Chapter 11, “Managing Conflict,” addresses the question of how we can manage conflict and produce positive change. Chapter 12, “Addressing Ethics in Leadership,” explores six factors that are related directly to ethical leadership: character, actions, goals, honesty, power, and values. Finally, Chapter 13, “Overcoming Obstacles,” addresses seven obstacles that subordinates may face and how a leader can help to overcome these.
14
New to This Edition
This edition retains the chapters of the previous edition but has been expanded and enhanced in several ways:
First and foremost, it includes a new chapter on diversity and inclusion that examines the nature of diversity and inclusion, provides a model of inclusive behavior, describes communication practices to improve inclusion, and identifies barriers to effective inclusive leadership. Second, this edition premieres the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire, a self- assessment instrument that allows readers to learn what their ethical leadership behaviors tend to be. The questionnaire in this book is an abridged edition of a longer, more comprehensive assessment available to readers online. Third, several chapters include a look at the dark side of leadership in terms of the approaches explored in the book. Fourth, new case studies, examples, and research are integrated throughout the book. Fifth, this edition includes new “Ask the Author” videos that show Peter Northouse answering student questions.
15
Special Features
Introduction to Leadership: Concepts and Practice is designed to help the reader understand how to become a better leader. While the book is grounded in leadership theory, it describes the basics of leadership in an understandable and user-friendly way. Each chapter focuses on a fundamental aspect of leadership, discusses how it can be applied in real leadership situations, and provides a relevant profile of a leader.
Perhaps the most notable features of this book are the four applied activities included in every chapter, which allow the reader to explore leadership concepts and real-world applications:
Case studies illustrate the leadership concepts discussed in the chapter. At the end of each case, thought-provoking questions help the reader analyze the case using ideas presented in the chapter. Self-assessment questionnaires help the reader determine his or her own leadership style and preferences. Students may want to complete this questionnaire before reading the chapter’s content. By completing the questionnaire first, the reader will be more aware of how the chapter’s content specifically applies to his or her leadership tendencies. Observational exercises guide the reader in examining behaviors of leaders from his or her life experiences. Reflection and action worksheets stimulate the reader to reflect on his or her leadership style and identify actions to take to become more effective.
16
Audience
A practice-oriented book, Introduction to Leadership: Concepts and Practice is written in a user-friendly style appropriate for introductory leadership courses across disciplines. Specifically, it is well suited for programs in leadership studies and leadership courses in schools of agriculture, allied health, business, management, communication, education, engineering, military science, public administration, nursing, political science, social work, and religion. In addition, this book is appropriate for programs in continuing education, corporate training, executive development, in-service training, and government training. It is also useful for student extracurricular activities.
17
Digital Resources
SAGE coursepacks allow instructors to import high-quality online resources directly into Blackboard, Canvas, Moodle, or Brightspace by Desire2Learn (D2L) in an intuitive, simple format. Instructors who do not use an LMS platform can still access many of the online resources by visiting edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e.
SAGE coursepacks include, for each chapter:
A diverse range of test items with pretests, posttests, and test banks built on Bloom’s Taxonomy and AACSB standards, available with ExamView test generation Assignable SAGE Premium Video (available via the interactive eBook version, linked through SAGE coursepacks) that includes insights from Peter G. Northouse and other leadership experts, with corresponding multimedia assessment options that automatically feed to a gradebook A comprehensive Media Guide for the video resources Discussion questions to help launch classroom interaction SAGE journal articles to show how scholarship relates to chapter concepts Editable, chapter-specific PowerPoint® slides that offer flexibility when creating multimedia lectures Sample course syllabi with suggested models for structuring a leadership course Lecture notes that summarize key concepts for each chapter Ideas for class activities that can be used in class to reinforce active learning Web exercises that direct students to useful websites to complete creative activities and reinforce learning Suggested films to facilitate showing examples of leadership in action Case notes that include case summaries, analyses, and sample answers to case questions The Reflection and Action Worksheets and Observational Exercises from the text in downloadable Word document format for more flexibility in using these resources Tables and figures from the textbook
SAGE edge for students at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e enhances learning in an easy-to-use environment that offers, for each chapter, learning objectives, action plans to track progress, mobile-friendly flashcards and practice quizzes, SAGE Premium Video featuring author Peter G. Northouse, additional multimedia resources, and selected SAGE journal articles to strengthen learning.
18
Interactive eBook
An interactive eBook version of the text is available for students to provide a contemporary, multimedia-integrated presentation for learning. In addition to a fully electronic textbook, students can link directly to “Ask the Author” video, audio, additional enrichment readings from SAGE journals titles, and other relevant resources, bringing the subject matter to life in a way a traditional print text cannot.
The interactive eBook features exclusive Interactive Leadership Assessments to help students strengthen their leadership abilities by providing them with individualized feedback based on their responses to each questionnaire. After completing each questionnaire, a student using the interactive eBook will receive an in-depth analysis of her or his scores as well as personalized, pragmatic suggestions for further developing her or his leadership.
You can find the eBook icons in the print and electronic versions of the text. Below is a guide to the icons:
“Ask the Author” video icon
SAGE journal article icon
Video icon
Web icon
19
Acknowledgments
I would like to express my appreciation to many individuals who directly or indirectly played a role in the development of this book. First, I would like to thank the many people at SAGE Publications, in particular my editor, Maggie Stanley, who along with her leadership team (Liz Thornton, Lauren Holmes, Neda Dallal, Katie Ancheta, Ashlee Blunk, Georgia Mclaughlin, and Gail Buschman) has competently guided this revision from the beginning review phase through the production phase. In addition, I would like to thank copy editor Melinda Masson and production editor Libby Larson. In their own unique ways, each of these people made valuable contributions that enhanced the overall quality of the book. Collectively, they are an extraordinary team that demonstrates the very highest standards of excellence in all that they do.
For their thoughtful and constructive feedback on this latest edition, I would like to thank the following reviewers:
Jens Beyer, Hochschule Anhalt Standort Bernburg Carl Blencke, University of Central Florida Roger Clark, NWN Corporation Dan Cunningham, McDaniel College D. Keith Gurley, University of Alabama at Birmingham Sat Ananda Hayden, University of Southern Mississippi Sharon Kabes, Southwest Minnesota State University Lorin Leone, Independence University Douglas Micklich, Illinois State University Bryan Patterson, Johnson C. Smith University, Northeastern University Robert W. Robertson, Independence University Lou L. Sabina, Stetson University Stephanie Schnurr, University of Warwick Douglas Threet, Foothill College Simone Wesner, Birkbeck, University of London Paula White, Independence University Cecilia Williams, Independence University
For comprehensive reviews of past editions, I would like to thank the following reviewers:
Maureen Baldwin, Saint Ambrose University Barry L. Boyd, Texas A&M University Susan Bramlett Epps, East Tennessee State University Linda L. Brennan, Mercer University Shannon Brown, Benedictine University Lisa Burgoon, University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign
20
Tom Butkiewicz, University of Redlands Patricia Cane, Klamath Community College Stephen C. Carlson, Piedmont College Melissa K. Carsten, Winthrop University James R. “Chip” Coldren Jr., Governors State University Barbara Collins, Cabrini College Stacey A. Cook, College of Marin Ronald J. Cugno, Nova Southeastern University Greg Czyszczon, James Madison University Douglas Davenport, Truman State University Edward Desmarais, Salem State College Marco Dowell, California State University, Dominguez Hills Tiffany Erk, Ivy Tech Community College of Indiana Leon Fraser, Rutgers Business School Jim Fullerton, Idaho State University Jennifer Garcia, Saint Leo University Don Green, Lincoln Christian University Francesca Grippa, Northeastern University Yael Hellman, Woodbury University Vanessa Hill, University of Louisiana at Lafayette Martha A. Hunt, NHTI—Concord’s Community College Jean Gabriel Jolivet, Southwestern College Ruth Klein, Le Moyne College Renee Kosiarek, North Central College Robert Larison, Eastern Oregon University Karen A. Longman, Azusa Pacific University Maureen Majury, Bellevue Community College James L. Morrison, University of Delaware Terry W. Mullins, University of North Carolina at Greensboro Jane Murtaugh, College of DuPage Joanne E. Nottingham, University of North Carolina, Wilmington Ramona Ortega-Liston, University of Akron Ron Parlett, Nova Southeastern University Bruce Peterson, Sonoma State University Joseph W. T. Pugh, Immaculata University Deana Raffo, Middle Tennessee State University Melody Rawlings, Northern Kentucky University Bronte H. Reynolds, California State University, Northridge Louis Rubino, California State University, Northridge Laurie A. Schreiner, Azusa Pacific University Thomas Shields, University of Richmond Pearl Sims, Peabody College of Vanderbilt University
21
Bruce Tucker, Santa Fe Community College Mary Tucker, Ohio University John Tummons, University of Missouri Sameer Vaidya, Texas Wesleyan University Natalie N. Walker, Seminole State College Amy Wilson, University at Buffalo Laurie Woodward, University of South Florida
Critiques by these reviewers were invaluable in helping to focus my thinking and writing during the revision process.
I would like to thank Dr. Bernardo Ferdman for his helpful comments and suggestions on the “Embracing Diversity and Inclusion” chapter, and Terry Hammink for his assistance in the construction and scoring of the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire and James Ludema for his support.
For their outstanding work in developing creative resources for this edition, I am grateful to Isolde Anderson of Hope College, Matthew Creasy of the University of Delaware, Jeff Paul of the University of Tulsa, Lou Sabina of Stetson University, Andrea Smith-Hunter of Siena College, and Douglas Threet of Foothill College.
Finally, I wish to thank Marie Lee for her thorough editing and commitment and Laurel Northouse for her editorial insights and extraordinary support. It takes a lot of dedicated people to write a book, and I feel fortunate to have those people in my life.
In the electronic edition of the book you have purchased, there are several icons that reference links (videos, journal articles) to additional content. Though the electronic edition links are not live, all content referenced may be accessed at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e . This URL is referenced at several points throughout your electronic edition.
22
About the Author
Peter G. Northouse, PhD, is Professor Emeritus of Communication in the School of Communication at Western Michigan University. In addition to publications in professional journals, he is the author of Leadership: Theory and Practice (now in its seventh edition) and coauthor of Health Communication: Strategies for Health Professionals (now in its third edition) and Leadership Case Studies in Education. His scholarly and curricular interests include models of leadership, leadership assessment, ethical leadership, and leadership and group dynamics. For more than 30 years, he has taught undergraduate and graduate courses in leadership, interpersonal communication, and organizational
23
communication on both the undergraduate and graduate levels. Currently, he is a consultant and lecturer on trends in leadership research, leadership development, and leadership education. He holds a doctorate in speech communication from the University of Denver, and master’s and bachelor’s degrees in communication education from Michigan State University.
24
1 Understanding Leadership
25
Introduction
This book is about what it takes to be a leader. Everyone, at some time in life, is asked to be a leader, whether to lead a classroom discussion, coach a children’s soccer team, or direct a fund-raising campaign. Many situations require leadership. A leader may have a high profile (e.g., an elected public official) or a low profile (e.g., a volunteer leader in Big Brothers Big Sisters), but in every situation there are leadership demands placed on the individual who is the leader. Being a leader is challenging, exciting, and rewarding, and carries with it many responsibilities. This chapter discusses different ways of looking at leadership and their impacts on what it means to be a leader.
What is Leadership?
26
Leadership Explained
At the outset, it is important to address a basic question: What is leadership? Scholars who study leadership have struggled with this question for many decades and have written a great deal about the nature of leadership (Antonakis, Cianciolo, & Sternberg, 2004; Bass, 1990; Conger & Riggio, 2007). (See Box 1.1.)
In leadership literature, more than 100 different definitions of leadership have been identified (Rost, 1991). Despite these many definitions, a number of concepts are recognized by most people as accurately reflecting what it is to be a leader.
Leadership Basics
27
“Leadership Is a Trait”
First, leadership is thought of as a trait. A trait is a distinguishing quality of an individual, which is often inherited. Defining leadership as a trait means that each individual brings to the table certain qualities that influence the way he or she leads. Some leaders are confident, some are decisive, and still others are outgoing and sociable. Saying that leadership is a trait places a great deal of emphasis on the leader and on the leader’s special gifts. It follows the often-expressed belief “leaders are born, not made.” Some argue that focusing on traits makes leadership an elitist enterprise because it implies that only a few people with special talents will lead. Although there may be some truth to this argument, it can also be argued that all of us are born with a wide array of unique traits and that many of these traits can have a positive impact on our leadership. It also may be possible to modify or change some traits.
Through the years, researchers have identified a multitude of traits that are associated with leadership. In Chapter 2 we will discuss some key leadership traits, and in Chapter 3 we will explain how strength-based leadership is a variation of trait leadership. Although there are many important leadership traits, what is most important for leaders is having the required traits that a particular situation demands. For example, a chaotic emergency room at a hospital requires a leader who is insightful and decisive and can bring calm to the situation. Conversely, a high school classroom in which students are bored demands a teacher who is inspiring and creative. Effective leadership results when the leader engages the right traits in the right place at the right time.
28
“Leadership Is an Ability”
In addition to being thought of as a trait, leadership is conceptualized as an ability. A person who has leadership ability is able to be a leader—that is, has the capacity to lead. While the term ability frequently refers to a natural capacity, ability can be acquired. For example, some people are naturally good at public speaking, while others rehearse to become comfortable speaking in public. Similarly, some people have the natural physical ability to excel in a sport, while others develop their athletic capacity through exercise and practice. In leadership, some people have the natural ability to lead, while others develop their leadership abilities through hard work and practice.
Box 1.1 The Evolution of Leadership
Leadership has long intrigued humankind and has been the topic of extensive literature for centuries. The earliest writings include philosophies of leadership such as Machiavelli’s The Prince (1531/2005) and biographies of great leaders. With the development of the social sciences during the 20th century, inquiry into leadership became prolific. Studies on leadership have emerged from every discipline “that has had some interest in the subject of leadership: anthropology, business administration, educational administration, history, military science, nursing administration, organizational behavior, philosophy, political science, public administration, psychology, sociology, and theology” (Rost, 1991, p. 45).
As a result, there are many different leadership approaches and theories. While the words are often used interchangeably, approaches and theories are different conceptually. An approach is a general way of thinking about a phenomenon, not necessarily based on empirical research. A theory usually includes a set of hypotheses, principles, or laws that explain a given phenomenon. Theories are more refined and can provide a predictive framework in analyzing the phenomenon. For example, the spiritual leadership approach is a conceptualization of leadership that does not yet have a body of empirical research to validate it, while contingency leadership theory has a refined set of propositions based on the results of multiple research studies.
Not unlike fashion, approaches to leadership have evolved, changed focus and direction, and built upon one another during the past century. To understand this evolution, a brief historical view can be helpful:
29
Trait Approach The early trait approach theories were called “Great Man” theories because they focused on identifying the innate qualities and characteristics possessed by great social, political, and military leaders such as Catherine the Great, Mohandas Gandhi, Abraham Lincoln, Moses, and Joan of Arc. Studies of leadership traits were especially strong from 1900 to the early 1940s and enjoyed a renewed emphasis beginning in the 1970s as researchers began to examine visionary and charismatic leadership. In the 1980s, researchers linked leadership to the “Big Five” personality factors while interest in emotional intelligence as a trait gained favor in the 1990s. (For a discussion of emotional intelligence as a leadership skill, see Chapter 6, pages 126– 127.)
30
Behavior Approach In the late 1930s, leadership research began to focus on behavior—what leaders do and how they act. Groundbreaking studies by researchers at The Ohio State University and the University of Michigan in the 1940s and 1950s analyzed how leaders acted in small group situations. Behavior approach theories hit their heyday in the early 1960s with Blake and Moulton’s (1964) work exploring how managers use task and relationship behaviors in the organizational setting.
31
Situational Approach The premise of this approach is that different situations demand different kinds of leadership. Serious examination of situational approach theories began in the late 1960s by Hersey and Blanchard (1969) and Reddin (1967). Situational approaches continued to be refined and revised from the 1970s through the 1990s (Vecchio, 1987). One of these, path–goal theory, examines how leaders use employee motivation to enhance performance and satisfaction. Another approach, contingency theory, focuses on the match between the leader’s style and specific situational variables.
32
Relational Approach In the 1990s, researchers began examining the nature of relations between leaders and followers. This research ultimately evolved into the leader–member exchange (LMX) theory. LMX theory predicts that high-quality relations generate more positive leader outcomes than low-quality relations. Research in the relational approach to leadership continues to generate moderate interest today.
33
“New Leadership” Approach When these approaches began appearing in the mid-1980s—three decades ago—they were, and continue to be, called “new leadership” approaches (Bryman, 1992). Beginning with the work of Bass (1985, 1990), leadership studies generated visionary or charismatic leadership theories. From these approaches developed transformational leadership theory, which describes leadership as a process that changes people and organizations.
34
Emerging Leadership Approaches A diverse range of approaches to leadership is emerging during the 21st century:
Adaptive leadership examines how leaders help people address problems, face challenges, and adapt to change. Adaptive leadership stresses that the leaders don’t solve the problems, but rather encourage others to do the problem solving and adapt to change. Authentic leadership is an approach that looks at the authenticity of leaders and their leadership and is currently enjoying strong interest. Spiritual leadership considers how leaders use values, a sense of “calling,” and membership to motivate followers. Servant leadership emphasizes the “caring principle” with leaders as “servants” who focus on their followers’ needs in order to help these followers become more autonomous, knowledgeable, and like servants themselves. Gender-based studies, which have gained much momentum as women continue to become more dominant in the workforce, especially on a global level, view how one’s gender affects and differentiates one’s leadership.
The historical timeline in Figure 1.1 is not intended to represent these approaches as separate and distinct eras, only to disappear from the picture when a new theory appears. Instead, many of these theories occur concurrently, building upon one another. Even when a certain approach’s period of popularity has waned, the theory continues to influence further study and the development of new leadership approaches.
Figure 1.1 Development of Leadership Theories Through History
Source: Adapted from Antonakis, J., Cianciolo, A. T., & Sternberg, R. J. (Eds.). (2004). The nature of leadership. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage, p. 7.
Key Theories
An example of leadership as ability is the legendary University of California at Los Angeles
35
basketball coach John Wooden, whose teams won seven consecutive National Collegiate Athletic Association titles. Described first as a teacher and then as a coach, Wooden implemented four laws of learning into his coaching: explanation, demonstration, imitation, and repetition. His goal was to teach players how to do the right thing instinctively under great pressure. Less visible or well known, but also an example of leadership as ability, is the unheralded but highly effective restaurant manager who, through years of experience and learning, is able to create a successful, award-winning restaurant. In both of these examples, it is the individuals’ abilities that create outstanding leadership.
36
“Leadership Is a Skill”
Third, leadership is a skill. Conceptualized as a skill, leadership is a competency developed to accomplish a task effectively. Skilled leaders are competent people who know the means and methods for carrying out their responsibilities. For example, a skilled leader in a fund- raising campaign knows every step and procedure in the fund-raising process and is able to use this knowledge to run an effective campaign. In short, skilled leaders are competent— they know what they need to do, and they know how to do it.
Describing leadership as a skill makes leadership available to everyone because skills are competencies that people can learn or develop. Even without natural leadership ability, people can improve their leadership with practice, instruction, and feedback from others. Viewed as a skill, leadership can be studied and learned. If you are capable of learning from experience, you can acquire leadership.
37
“Leadership Is a Behavior”
Leadership is also a behavior. It is what leaders do when they are in a leadership role. The behavioral dimension is concerned with how leaders act toward others in various situations. Unlike traits, abilities, and skills, leadership behaviors are observable. When someone leads, we see that person’s leadership behavior.
Leadership Behaviors
Research on leadership has shown that leaders engage primarily in two kinds of general behaviors: task behaviors and process behaviors. Task behaviors are used by leaders to get the job done (e.g., a leader prepares an agenda for a meeting). Process behaviors are used by leaders to help people feel comfortable with other group members and at ease in the situations in which they find themselves (e.g., a leader helps individuals in a group to feel included). Since leadership requires both task and process behaviors, the challenge for leaders is to know the best way to combine them in their efforts to reach a goal.
38
“Leadership Is a Relationship”
Another, and a somewhat unusual, way to think about leadership is as a relationship. From this perspective, leadership is centered on the communication between leaders and followers rather than on the unique qualities of the leader. Thought of as a relationship, leadership becomes a process of collaboration that occurs between leaders and followers (Rost, 1991). A leader affects and is affected by followers, and both leader and followers are affected in turn by the situation that surrounds them. This approach emphasizes that leadership is not a linear one-way event, but rather an interactive event. In traditional leadership, authority is often top down; in the interactive type of leadership, authority and influence are shared. When leadership is defined in this manner, it becomes available to everyone. It is not restricted to the formally designated leader in a group.
Leadership and Change
Thinking of leadership as a relationship suggests that leaders must include followers and their interests in the process of leadership. A leader needs to be fully aware of the followers and the followers’ interests, ideas, positions, attitudes, and motivations. In addition, this approach has an ethical overtone because it stresses the need for leaders to work with followers to achieve their mutual purposes. Stressing mutuality lessens the possibility that leaders might act toward followers in ways that are forced or unethical. It also increases the possibility that leaders and followers will work together toward a common good (Rost, 1991).
39
“Leadership Is an Influence Process”
A final way of thinking about leadership is as an influence process. This is the perspective that will be emphasized in this book.
Leadership is a process whereby an individual influences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal.
Leadership Development
Defining leadership as an influence process means that it is not a trait or an ability that resides in the leader, but rather an interactive event that occurs between the leader and the followers. Influence is central to the process of leadership because leaders affect followers. Leaders direct their energies toward influencing individuals to achieve something together. Stressing common goals gives leadership an ethical dimension because it lessens the possibility that leaders might act toward followers in ways that use coercion or are unethical.
Finally, in explaining what leadership is, it is important to make a distinction between leadership and management. In discussing what leadership is and can be, the concepts of leadership and management sometimes overlap. Both leadership and management involve influence, but leadership is about seeking constructive change, and management is about establishing order. For example, it is often said that “managers are people who do things right, and leaders are people who do the right thing.” Since both leaders and managers are engaged in influencing people toward goal accomplishment, our discussion in this book will treat the roles of managers and leaders similarly and not emphasize the differences between them.
40
Global Leadership Attributes
We probably all wonder at the differences in leadership around the world. Why do some countries gravitate toward the distributed leadership of a democracy, while others seem content with the hierarchical leadership of a monarchy or dictatorship? The definition and concepts of leadership outlined in this chapter are from an American perspective. If you were to travel to nations across the world, you would no doubt encounter different views of leadership specific to those ethnic and political cultures.
Universal Leadership Attributes
In 2004, Robert House led a group of 160 researchers in an ambitious study to increase our understanding of the impact culture has on leadership effectiveness. The GLOBE (Global Leadership and Organizational Behavior Effectiveness) studies drew on the input of 17,000 people in 62 countries in determining how leadership varies across the world. Among the many findings generated by the GLOBE studies was the identification of positive and negative leadership characteristics that are universally accepted worldwide (see Table 1.1).
Table 1.1 Universal Leadership Attributes Table 1.1 Universal Leadership Attributes
Positive Leader Attributes
Trustworthy
Foresighted
Positive
Builds confidence
Intelligent
Win-win problem solver
Administratively skilled
Excellence oriented
Just
Plans ahead
Dynamic
Motivational
Decisive
Communicative
Coordinator
Honest
Encouraging
Motivator
Dependable
Effective bargainer
Informed
Team builder
Negative Leader Attributes
41
Loner
Irritable
Ruthless
Asocial
Nonexplicit
Dictatorial
Noncooperative
Egocentric
Source: Adapted from House, R. J., Hanges, P. J., Javidan, M., Dorfman, P. W., & Gupta, V. (Eds.). (2004). Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage, pp. 677–678. Reprinted with permission.
42
The Dark Side of Leadership
Those same characteristics and behaviors that distinguish leadership can also be used by leaders in nonpositive ways (Conger, 1990). The dark side of leadership is the destructive side of leadership where a leader uses his or her influence or power for personal ends. Lipman-Blumen (2005) suggests that such leaders are “toxic,” where their leadership leaves their followers worse off than they found them, often violating the basic human rights of others and playing to their followers’ basest fears. Dark leadership is able to thrive when three conditions exist, according to Padilla, Hogan, and Kaiser (2007): a destructive leader, susceptible followers, and a conducive environment. Destructive leaders will prevail when the checks and balances of an organization are weak and the rules of the institution are ineffective. While many cite Adolf Hitler as the prime example of the dark side of leadership, there are many current examples in the world today from the regime of Bashar al-Assad in Syria, whose leadership has led to violent civil war that has left hundreds of thousands dead, to religious extremist groups, such as ISIS and al-Qaeda, who use their followers to engage in mass murder of innocents.
The Dark Side of Leadership
The meaning of leadership is complex and includes many dimensions. For some people, leadership is a trait or an ability, for others it is a skill or a behavior, and for still others it is a relationship or a process. In reality, leadership probably includes components of all of these dimensions. Each dimension explains a facet of leadership.
Destructive Leadership
In considering these various definitions of leadership and based on the results of your Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire (page 14), which dimension seems closest to how you think of leadership? How would you define leadership? Answers to these questions are important because how you think about leadership will strongly influence how you practice leadership.
There is a strong demand for effective leadership in society today. This demand exists at the local and community levels, as well as at the national level, in this country and abroad. People feel the need for leadership in all aspects of their lives. They want leaders in their
43
personal lives, at school, in the work setting, and even in their spiritual lives. Everywhere you turn, people are expressing a need for strong leadership.
When people ask for leadership in a particular situation, it is not always clear exactly what they want. For the most part, however, they want effective leadership. Effective leadership is intended influence that creates change for the greater good. Leadership uses positive means to achieve positive outcomes. Furthermore, people want leaders who listen to and understand their needs and who can relate to their circumstances. The challenge for each of us is to be prepared to lead when we are asked to be the leader.
Leadership Snapshot: Indra Nooyi, CEO, PepsiCo
Mark Wilson/Staff/Getty Images News/Getty Images
44
The daughter of a conservative, middle-class family in southern India, Indra Nooyi didn’t seem destined to one day run one of the world’s largest snack food and beverage companies. But Nooyi does just that as the CEO and president of PepsiCo, making her one of the top female executives in the United States and probably the highest-ranking woman of Indian heritage in corporate America.
Nooyi, who grew up in Madras (now Chennai), India, admits she always pushed social conventions. She played on an all-girls cricket team and was a guitarist in a rock band at a time when it was deemed inappropriate for Indian girls to do such things. Despite graduating from college with bachelor’s degrees in chemistry, math, and physics from Madras Christian College in 1974 and a master of business administration from the Indian Institute of Management Calcutta, Nooyi was reportedly remembered for being only a “mediocre student” (Pandey, 2006).
Nooyi’s first job after college was for Tootal, a British textile company in India, but she was hired away as a brand manager for Johnson & Johnson to oversee the company’s Stayfree account in India. It was a job that would have challenged the most seasoned marketing executive because, at the time, advertising women’s feminine products was not allowed in her country (Murray, 2004).
By 1978, Nooyi felt she needed more preparation for the business world and applied to and was accepted to the Yale School of Management in the United States. To her surprise, her parents agreed to let her go, although it would essentially make her an unmarriageable commodity in her culture. She received financial aid from Yale, but still struggled to make ends meet, working as an overnight receptionist. She didn’t have the money to buy a business suit, so she wore her traditional sari to work and later in job interviews, choosing to be herself rather than adhere to expected cultural norms.
Nooyi did not earn an MBA from Yale, choosing instead to get a master’s degree in public and private management. Her first jobs after graduation were for the prestigious Boston Consulting Group and Motorola. In 1990, she joined ASEA Brown Boveri (ABB), a Swiss-Swedish industrial conglomerate. Her success in directing ABB’s North American operations caught the attention of PepsiCo CEO Wayne Calloway who wooed her away to become his company’s chief strategist.
Nooyi quickly left her mark at PepsiCo. She was the chief deal maker for two of PepsiCo’s most important acquisitions: the Tropicana orange juice brand in 1998 and Quaker Oats in 2001. The Quaker Oats deal added a huge range of cereals and snack foods to the PepsiCo empire. Nooyi also helped the company acquire beverage maker SoBe, beating out a competing offer from Coca-Cola. Her deal-making talents elevated her to the job of PepsiCo’s chief financial officer in 2000, and a year later she was given the title of president.
Nooyi’s vision for PepsiCo—that “for any part of the day, we will have a little snack for you” (Byrnes, 2001)—has been implemented through development of new products and acquisitions. The company now sells a wide range of foods and beverages from Cap’n Crunch and Doritos to Mountain Dew and Gatorade. The company’s 18 brands are sold in 200 countries, and it employs 198,000 people worldwide.
But the strategist in Nooyi has also foreseen the effect that growing lifestyle diseases such as obesity could have on her company. Again, she has chosen to follow an unconventional path, looking to create healthier products in an industry dominated by salt, fat, and sugar. She invested heavily in the creation of a research and development lab that took five years to complete, drawing criticism from stockholders and industry analysts. So far, the investment has had some success: PepsiCo introduced a “mid-calorie” cola, Pepsi True, which has 30% less sugar and uses stevia extract instead of artificial sweeteners, and has created potato chips that taste just as salty as the original but have less sodium. The company has also introduced a new line of craft sodas called Stubborn Soda, which contain natural flavors and sugarcane instead of high-fructose corn syrup.
45
Summary
All of us at some time in our lives will be asked to show leadership. When you are asked to be the leader, it will be both demanding and rewarding. How you approach leadership is strongly influenced by your definitions of and beliefs about leadership. Through the years, writers have defined leadership in a multitude of ways. It is a complex, multidimensional process that is often conceptualized in a variety of ways by different people. Some of the most common ways of looking at leadership are as a trait, as an ability, as a skill, as a behavior, as a relationship, and as a process. The way you think about leadership will influence the way you practice leadership.
46
Glossary Terms
ability 2 adaptive leadership 4 approach 3 authentic leadership 4 behavior approach 3 “Big Five” personality factors 3 contingency theory 4 dark side of leadership 9 emotional intelligence 3 gender-based studies 4 “Great Man” theories 3 leader–member exchange (LMX) theory 4 leadership 7 path–goal theory 4 process behaviors 6 relational approach 4 relationship behaviors 3 servant leadership 4 situational approach 4 skill 5 spiritual leadership 4 task behaviors 3, 6 theory 3 trait 2 trait approach 3 transformational leadership theory 4
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
47
1.1 Case Study: King of the Hill Denny Hill’s career as a high school swimming coach didn’t start out well. The seniors on his team quit in the first season because he required them to come to all the workouts. The team only won three meets the whole season. That was 40 years ago. Since that time, the high school chemistry teacher’s success as a swimming coach has been extraordinary; his winnings include more than 900 boys’ and girls’ dual meets and a phenomenal 31 state titles.
Denny is noted for creating a team effort out of what is usually considered an individual sport. He begins every season with a team sleepover, followed by “Hell Week,” a two-week grueling regimen in which team members swim at least 5 miles a workout and 10 miles a day. He acknowledges this is a bonding experience for the swimmers, regardless of their skill, because they are “all in the same boat.”
Denny passes the mantle of leadership onto his team members. Seniors are expected to be mature leaders who inform the freshmen of the team goals and expectations. Juniors are to be role models, while sophomores serve as quiet leaders who are still learning but have a foundation in the team culture. Even the freshmen members have a job: They are required to pay attention to the coaches and other team members as they learn the team’s culture and what’s expected.
Denny holds a 20-minute team meeting each Monday where every member has the opportunity to present a rose or a complaint to anyone on the team including the coaches. He is tough on swimmers and makes them work, but when they need support he is always there to put an arm around them. Denny also uses humor, often making jokes that help take the edge off long, hard workouts.
And despite his teams’ successes, Denny isn’t about winning; he’s more about preparing to win—telling his swimmers that by preparing to win, everything takes care of itself. When you do win, he says, you’ve done it the right way.
48
Questions 1. What leadership traits account for Denny Hill’s success? 2. How would you describe Denny Hill’s leadership abilities? 3. Leadership includes administrative skills, interpersonal skills, and conceptual skills. How does
Denny Hill stack up on these skills? 4. How does Denny Hill integrate task and relationship behaviors in his leadership? 5. From a relational perspective, how would you describe Denny Hill’s leadership? 6. In what way does Denny Hill’s coaching exemplify leadership as an influence process?
49
1.2 Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify how you view leadership 2. To explore your perceptions of different aspects of leadership
Directions
1. Consider for a moment your own impressions of the word leadership. Based on your experiences with leaders in your lifetime, what is leadership?
2. Using the scale below, indicate the extent to which you agree or disagree with the following statements about leadership.
Statement Strongly disagree
Disagree Neutral Agree Strongly agree
1. When I think of leadership, I think of a person with special personality traits.
1 2 3 4 5
2. Much like playing the piano or tennis, leadership is a learned ability.
1 2 3 4 5
3. Leadership requires knowledge and know- how.
1 2 3 4 5
4. Leadership is about what people do rather than who they are.
1 2 3 4 5
5. Followers can influence the leadership process as much as leaders.
1 2 3 4 5
6. Leadership is about the process of influencing others.
1 2 3 4 5
7. Some people are born to be leaders. 1 2 3 4 5
8. Some people have the natural ability to be leaders.
1 2 3 4 5
9. The key to successful leadership is having the right skills.
1 2 3 4 5
10. Leadership is best described by what leaders do.
1 2 3 4 5
11. Leaders and followers share in the leadership process.
1 2 3 4 5
50
12. Leadership is a series of actions directed toward positive ends.
1 2 3 4 5
13. A person needs to have certain traits to be an effective leader.
1 2 3 4 5
14. Everyone has the capacity to be a leader. 1 2 3 4 5
15. Effective leaders are competent in their roles.
1 2 3 4 5
16. The essence of leadership is performing tasks and dealing with people.
1 2 3 4 5
17. Leadership is about the common purposes of leaders and followers.
1 2 3 4 5
18. Leadership does not rely on the leader alone but is a process involving the leader, followers, and the situation.
1 2 3 4 5
19. People become great leaders because of their traits.
1 2 3 4 5
20. People can develop the ability to lead. 1 2 3 4 5
21. Effective leaders have competence and knowledge.
1 2 3 4 5
22. Leadership is about how leaders work with people to accomplish goals.
1 2 3 4 5
23. Effective leadership is best explained by the leader–follower relationship.
1 2 3 4 5
24. Leaders influence and are influenced by followers.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum scores on items 1, 7, 13, and 19 (trait emphasis) 2. Sum scores on items 2, 8, 14, and 20 (ability emphasis) 3. Sum scores on items 3, 9, 15, and 21 (skill emphasis) 4. Sum scores on items 4, 10, 16, and 22 (behavior emphasis) 5. Sum scores on items 5, 11, 17, and 23 (relationship emphasis) 6. Sum scores on items 6, 12, 18, and 24 (process emphasis)
Total Scores 1. Trait emphasis: _________________ 2. Ability emphasis: ________________ 3. Skill emphasis: __________________
51
4. Behavior emphasis: ______________ 5. Relationship emphasis: ___________ 6. Process emphasis: _______________
Scoring Interpretation
The scores you received on this questionnaire provide information about how you define and view leadership. The emphasis you give to the various dimensions of leadership has implications for how you approach the leadership process. For example, if your highest score is for trait emphasis, it suggests that you emphasize the role of the leader and the leader’s special gifts in the leadership process. However, if your highest score is for relationship emphasis, it indicates that you think leadership is centered on the communication between leaders and followers, rather than on the unique qualities of the leader. By comparing your scores, you can gain an understanding of the aspects of leadership that you find most important and least important. The way you think about leadership will influence how you practice leadership.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
52
1.3 Observational Exercise
53
Defining Leadership
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of the complexity of leadership 2. To become aware of the different ways people define leadership
Directions
1. In this exercise, select five people you know and interview them about leadership. 2. Ask each person to give you his or her definition of leadership, and to describe his or her personal
beliefs about effective leadership.
3. Record each person’s response on a separate sheet of paper. Person #1 (name) __________________________________________ Person #2 (name) _________________________________________ Person #3 (name) _________________________________________ Person #4 (name) _________________________________________ Person #5 (name) _________________________________________
Questions 1. What differences did you observe in how these people define leadership? 2. What seems to be the most common definition of leadership? 3. In what ways did people describe leadership differently from the definitions in Chapter 1,
“Understanding Leadership”? 4. Of the people interviewed, whose definition comes closest to your own? Why?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
54
1.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
55
Understanding Leadership
Reflection
1. Each of us has our own unique way of thinking about leadership. What leaders or people have influenced you in your thinking about leadership? Discuss what leadership means to you and give your definition of leadership.
2. What do the scores you received on the Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire suggest about your perspective on leadership? Of the six dimensions on the questionnaire (trait, ability, skill, behavior, relationship, and process), which one is the most similar to your own perspective? Which one is least like your own perspective?
3. Do you think leadership is something everyone can learn to do, or do you think it is a natural ability reserved for a few? Explain your answer.
Action
1. Based on the interviews you conducted with others about leadership, how could you incorporate others’ ideas about leadership into your own leadership?
2. Treating leadership as a relationship has ethical implications. How could adding the relationship approach to your leadership make you a better leader? Discuss.
3. Think about your own leadership. Identify one trait, ability, skill, or behavior that you could develop more fully to become a better leader.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
56
References Antonakis, J., Cianciolo, A. T., & Sternberg, R. J. (Eds.). (2004). The nature of leadership.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Bass, B. M. (1985). Leadership and performance beyond expectations. New York, NY: Free Press.
Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass and Stogdill’s handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York, NY: Free Press.
Blake, R. R., & Moulton, J. S. (1964). The managerial grid. Houston, TX: Gulf.
Bryman, A. (1992). Charisma and leadership in organizations. London, U K: Sage.
Byrnes, N. (2001, January 29). The power of two at Pepsi. Businessweek. Retrieved from http://www.bloomberg.com/news/articles/2001-01-28/the-power-of-two-at-pepsi
Conger, J. (1990). The dark side of leadership. Organizational Dynamics, 19(2), 44–55.
Conger, J. A., & Riggio, R. E. (Eds.). (2007). The practice of leadership: Developing the next generation of leaders. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Hersey, P., & Blanchard, K. H. (1969). Life-cycle theory of leadership. Training and Development Journal, 23(5), 26–34.
House, R. J., Hanges, P. J., Javidan, M., Dorfman, P. W., & Gupta, V. (2004). Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Lipman-Blumen, J. (2005). The allure of toxic leaders. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.
57
Machiavelli, N. (2005). The prince (W. J. Connell, trans.). Boston, MA: Bedford/St. Martin’s. (Original work published in 1531)
Murray, S. (2004, January 26). From poor Indian student to powerful U.S. business- woman. Financial Times, p. 3.
Padilla, A., Hogan, R., & Kaiser, R. B. (2007). The toxic triangle: Destructive leaders, susceptible followers, and conducive environments. The Leadership Quarterly, 18(3), 176–194.
Pandey, J. M. (2006, August 18). Nooyi: IIM-C’s “average” student turns role model. The Times of India. Retrieved from http://timesofindia.indiatimes.com/india/Nooyi-IIM- Cs-average-student-turns-role-model/articleshow/1902571.cms
Reddin, W. J. (1967, April). The 3-D management style theory. Training and Development Journal, pp. 8–17.
Rost, J. C. (1991). Leadership for the twenty-first century. Westport, CO: Praeger.
Vecchio, R. P. (1987). Situational leadership theory: An examination of a prescriptive theory. Journal of Applied Psychology, 72(3), 444–451.
58
2 Recognizing Your Traits
59
Introduction
Why are some people leaders while others are not? What makes people become leaders? Do leaders have certain traits? These questions have been of interest for many years. It seems that all of us want to know what characteristics account for effective leadership. This chapter will address the traits that are important to leadership.
Is Leadership a Trait?
Since the early 20th century, hundreds of research studies have been conducted on the traits of leaders. These studies have produced an extensive list of ideal leadership traits (see Antonakis, Cianciolo, & Sternberg, 2004; Bass, 1990). The list of important leadership traits is long and includes such traits as diligence, trustworthiness, dependability, articulateness, sociability, open-mindedness, intelligence, confidence, self-assurance, and conscientiousness. Because the list is so extensive, it is difficult to identify specifically which traits are essential for leaders. In fact, nearly all of the traits are probably related to effective leadership.
What traits are important when you are asked to be a leader? To answer this question, two areas will be addressed in this chapter. First, a set of selected traits that appear by all accounts to be strongly related to effective leadership in everyday life will be discussed. Second, the lives of several historical and contemporary leaders will be examined with a discussion of the traits that play a role in their leadership. Throughout this discussion, the unique ways that certain traits affect the leadership process in one way or another will be emphasized.
60
Leadership Traits Explained
From the beginning of the 20th century to the present day, researchers have focused a great deal of attention on the unique characteristics of successful leaders. Thousands of studies have been conducted to identify the traits of effective leaders. The results of these studies have produced a very long list of important leadership traits; each of these traits contributes to the leadership process.
Leadership Traits
For example, research studies by several investigators found the following traits to be important: achievement, persistence, insight, initiative, self-confidence, responsibility, cooperativeness, tolerance, influence, sociability, drive, motivation, integrity, confidence, cognitive ability, task knowledge, extroversion, conscientiousness, and openness (Judge, Bono, Ilies, & Gerhardt, 2002; Kirkpatrick & Locke, 1991; Stogdill, 1974). On the international level, House, Hanges, Javidan, Dorfman, and Gupta (2004), in a study of 17,000 managers in 62 different cultures, identified a list of 22 valued traits that were universally endorsed as characteristics of outstanding leadership in these countries. The list, which was outlined in Table 1.1 in Chapter 1, “Understanding Leadership,” includes such attributes as being trustworthy, just, honest, encouraging, positive, dynamic, dependable, intelligent, decisive, communicative, informed, and a team builder. As these findings indicate, research studies on leadership traits have identified a wide array of important characteristics of leaders.
Are There Certain Traits a Leader Needs?
However, these research findings raise an important question: If there are so many important leadership traits, which specific traits do people need to be successful leaders? While the answer to this question is not crystal clear, the research points to six key traits: intelligence, confidence, charisma, determination, sociability, and integrity. In the following section, we will discuss each of these traits in turn.
61
Intelligence
Intelligence is an important trait related to effective leadership. Intelligence includes having good language skills, perceptual skills, and reasoning ability. This combination of assets makes people good thinkers, and makes them better leaders.
While it is hard for a person to alter his or her IQ (intelligence quotient), there are certain ways for a person to improve intelligence in general. Intelligent leaders are well informed. They are aware of what is going on around them and understand the job that needs to be done. It is important for leaders to obtain information about what their leadership role entails and learn as much as possible about their work environment. This information will help leaders be more knowledgeable and insightful.
For example, a few years ago a friend, Chris, was asked to be the coach of his daughter’s middle school soccer team even though he had never played soccer and knew next to nothing about how the game is played. Chris took the job and eventually was a great success, but not without a lot of effort. He spent many hours learning about soccer. He read how-to books, instructors’ manuals, and coaching books. In addition, Chris subscribed to several soccer magazines. He talked to other coaches and learned everything he could about playing the game. By the time he had finished the first season, others considered Chris to be a very competent coach. He was smart and learned how to be a successful coach.
Regarding intelligence, few if any of us can expect to be another Albert Einstein. Most of us have average intelligence and know that there are limits to what we can do. Nevertheless, becoming more knowledgeable about our leadership positions gives us the information we need to become better leaders.
62
Confidence
Being confident is another important trait of an effective leader. Confident people feel self- assured and believe they can accomplish their goals. Rather than feeling uncertain, they feel strong and secure about their positions. They do not second-guess themselves, but rather move forward on projects with a clear vision. Confident leaders feel a sense of certainty and believe that they are doing the right thing. Clearly, confidence is a trait that has to do with feeling positive about oneself and one’s ability to succeed.
Confidence
If confidence is a central trait of successful leaders, how can you build your own confidence? First, confidence comes from understanding what is required of you. For example, when first learning to drive a car, a student’s confidence is low because he or she does not know what to do. If an instructor explains the driving process and demonstrates how to drive, the student can gain confidence because he or she now has an understanding of how to drive. Awareness and understanding build confidence. Confidence can also come from having a mentor to show the way and provide constructive feedback. This mentor may be a boss, an experienced coworker, or a significant other from outside the organization. Because mentors act as role models and sounding boards, they provide essential help to learn the dynamics of leadership.
Confidence also comes from practice. This is important to point out, because practice is something everyone can do. Consider Michael Phelps, one of the most well-known athletes in the world today. Phelps is a very gifted swimmer, with 23 Olympic gold medals and the record for winning the most medals, 28, of any Olympic athlete in history. But Phelps also spends an enormous amount of time practicing. His workout regimen includes swimming six hours a day, six days a week. His excellent performance and confidence are a result of his practice, as well as his gifts.
In leadership, practice builds confidence because it provides assurance that an aspiring leader can do what needs to be done. Taking on leadership roles, even minor ones on committees or through volunteer activities, provides practice for being a leader. Building one leadership activity on another can increase confidence for more demanding leadership roles. Those who accept opportunities to practice their leadership will experience increased confidence in their leadership abilities.
63
Charisma
Of all the traits related to effective leadership, charisma gets the most attention. Charisma refers to a leader’s special magnetic charm and appeal, and can have a huge effect on the leadership process. Charisma is a special personality characteristic that gives a leader the capacity to do extraordinary things. In particular, it gives the leader exceptional powers of influence. A good example of a charismatic leader is former president John F. Kennedy, who motivated the American people with his eloquent oratorical style (visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e to read one of his speeches). President Kennedy was a gifted, charismatic leader who had an enormous impact on others.
Charismatic Leadership
It is not unusual for many of us to feel challenged with regard to charisma because it is not a common personality trait. There are a few select people who are very charismatic, but most of us are not. Since charisma appears in short supply, the question arises: What do leaders do if they are not naturally charismatic?
Based on the writings of leadership scholars, several behaviors characterize charismatic leadership (Conger, 1999; House, 1976; Shamir, House, & Arthur, 1993). First, charismatic leaders serve as a strong role model for the values that they desire others to adopt. Mohandas Gandhi advocated nonviolence and was an exemplary role model of civil disobedience; his charisma enabled him to influence others. Second, charismatic leaders show competence in every aspect of leadership, so others trust their decisions. Third, charismatic leaders articulate clear goals and strong values. Martin Luther King Jr.’s “I Have a Dream” speech is an example of this type of charismatic leadership. By articulating his dream, he was able to influence multitudes of people to follow his nonviolent practices. Fourth, charismatic leaders communicate high expectations for followers and show confidence in their abilities to meet these expectations. Finally, charismatic leaders are an inspiration to others. They can excite and motivate others to become involved in real change, as demonstrated by John F. Kennedy and Martin Luther King Jr.
64
Determination
Determination is another trait that characterizes effective leaders. Determined leaders are very focused and attentive to tasks. They know where they are going and how they intend to get there. Determination is the decision to get the job done; it includes characteristics such as initiative, persistence, and drive. People with determination are willing to assert themselves, they are proactive, and they have the capacity to persevere in the face of obstacles. Being determined includes showing dominance at times, especially in situations where others need direction.
Determination
We have all heard of determined people who have accomplished spectacular things—the person with cancer who runs a standard 26.2-mile marathon, the blind person who climbs Mount Everest, or the single mom with four kids who graduates from college. A good example of determined leadership is Nelson Mandela, who is featured in the Leadership Snapshot in this chapter. Mandela’s single goal was to end apartheid in South Africa. Even though he was imprisoned for many years, he steadfastly held to his principles. He was committed to reaching his goal, and he never wavered from his vision. Mandela was focused and disciplined—a determined leader.
What distinguishes all of these leaders from other people is their determination to get the job done. Of all the traits discussed in this chapter, determination is probably the one trait that is easily acquired by those who lead. All it demands is perseverance. Staying focused on the task, clarifying the goals, articulating the vision, and encouraging others to stay the course are characteristics of determined leaders. Being determined takes discipline and the ability to endure, but having this trait will almost certainly enhance a person’s leadership.
65
Sociability
Another important trait for leaders is sociability. Sociability refers to a leader’s capacity to establish pleasant social relationships. People want sociable leaders—leaders with whom they can get along. Leaders who show sociability are friendly, outgoing, courteous, tactful, and diplomatic. They are sensitive to others’ needs and show concern for their well-being. Sociable leaders have good interpersonal skills and help to create cooperative relationships within their work environments.
Being sociable comes easier for some than for others. For example, it is easy for extroverted leaders to talk to others and be outgoing, but it is harder for introverted leaders to do so. Similarly, some individuals are naturally “people persons,” while others prefer to be alone. Although people vary in the degree to which they are outgoing, it is possible to increase sociability. A sociable leader gets along with coworkers and other people in the work setting. Being friendly, kind, and thoughtful, as well as talking freely with others and giving them support, goes a long way to establish a leader’s sociability. Sociable leaders bring positive energy to a group and make the work environment a more enjoyable place.
To illustrate, consider the following example. This scenario occurred in one of the best leadership classes I have had in 40 years of teaching. In this class, there was a student named Anne Fox who was a very sociable leader. Anne was an unusual student who dressed like a student from the 1960s, although it was more than two decades later. Even though she dressed differently than the others, Anne was very caring and was liked by everyone in the class. After the first week of the semester, Anne could name everyone in class; when attendance was taken, she knew instantly who was there and who was not. In class discussions, Anne always contributed good ideas, and her remarks were sensitive of others’ points of view. Anne was positive about life, and her attitude was contagious. By her presence, Anne created an atmosphere in which everyone felt unique but also included. She was the glue that held us all together. Anne was not assigned to be the leader in the class, but by the semester’s end she emerged as a leader. Her sociable nature enabled her to develop strong relationships and become a leader in the class. By the end of the class, all of us were the beneficiaries of her leadership.
66
Integrity
Finally, and perhaps most important, effective leaders have integrity. Integrity characterizes leaders who possess the qualities of honesty and trustworthiness. People who adhere to a strong set of principles and take responsibility for their actions are exhibiting integrity. Leaders with integrity inspire confidence in others because they can be trusted to do what they say they are going to do. They are loyal, dependable, and transparent. Basically, integrity makes a leader believable and worthy of our trust.
Integrity
Leadership Snapshot: Nelson Mandela, First Black President of South Africa
South Africa The Good News / www.sagoodnews.co.za CC BY 2.0 https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/2.0/deed.en
In 1990, when Nelson Mandela was released from prison after serving 27 long years, he was determined not to be angry or vindictive, but instead to work to unite his country of South Africa, which had been fractured by generations of apartheid.
67
The descendent of a tribal king, Mandela was born in 1918 in a small African village and grew up in a country where Whites ruled through subjugation and tyranny over Blacks and other races. Mandela attended Methodist missionary schools and put himself through law school, eventually opening the first Black law partnership in 1942. His firm represented the African National Congress (ANC), which was engaged in resisting South Africa’s apartheid policies, and during the 1950s, he became a leader of the ANC. Influenced by Mohandas Gandhi, Mandela was initially committed to nonviolent resistance but shifted to supporting violent tactics when the government refused to change its apartheid policies. In 1964, Mandela received a life sentence for plotting to overthrow the government by violence.
During the nearly three decades Mandela spent in prison, he became a symbolic figure for the anti- apartheid movement. But during those years, Mandela spent time examining himself, coming to see himself as others did: as an aggressive and militant revolutionary. He learned to control his temper and strong will, instead using persuasion and emphasis to convince others. He listened to others’ life stories, including those of the White guards, seeking to understand their perspectives. He was steadfast in maintaining his dignity, carefully refusing to be subservient while being respectful to the guards and others. As a result, he became a natural leader inside the prison, while outside, his fame framed him as a symbolic martyr not only to Black Africans but also to people across the globe. Free Mandela campaigns were building around the world, with other countries and international corporations being pressured by stockholders and citizens to “divest” in South Africa.
In 1990, South African president F. W. de Klerk, fearing civil war and economic collapse, released Mandela, at the time 71, from prison. Mandela emerged as a moral leader who stood by the principles of liberty and equal rights for all. He began speaking around the world, raising financial support for the ANC while seeking to bring peace to his fractured country. In 1992, the South African government instituted a new constitution and held a popular election with all parties represented including the ANC. The result? In 1994, Mandela was elected as the first Black president of South Africa, effectively ending apartheid. For his role in negotiations to abolish apartheid, Mandela received the Nobel Peace Prize, sharing it with de Klerk.
As president of South Africa from 1994 to 1999, Mandela’s mission was to transform a nation from minority rule and apartheid to a multiracial democracy. On the first day of his presidency, he set the tone with the predominantly White staff of the former president, telling them that those who wanted to keep their jobs were welcome to stay, stating “Reconciliation starts here.” He developed a multiracial staff and cabinet, using his friendly smiling style and tactic of listening to all viewpoints carefully before making decisions to keep the staff focused on problems and issues rather than on partisanship.
Mandela served his five-year term as president but, at 76 years old, chose not to seek another term. In retirement, he continued to advocate for social causes, serving as a mediator in disputes outside of South Africa, and to bring a message of peace and justice throughout the world. Mandela died in 2013. While it is difficult to summarize all that he accomplished, Mandela’s legacy is best described by former U.S. president Bill Clinton who in 2003 wrote, “Under a burden of oppression he saw through difference, discrimination and destruction to embrace our common humanity.”
Grown-ups often tell children, “Never tell a lie.” For children, the lesson is “Good children are truthful.” For leaders, the lesson is the same: “Good leaders are honest.” Dishonesty creates mistrust in others, and dishonest leaders are seen as undependable and unreliable. Honesty helps people to have trust and faith in what leaders have to say and what they stand for. Honesty also enhances a leader’s ability to influence others because they have confidence in and believe in their leader.
Integrity demands being open with others and representing reality as fully and completely as possible. However, this is not an easy task: There are times when telling the complete truth can be destructive or counterproductive. The challenge for leaders is to strike a
68
balance between being open and candid and monitoring what is appropriate to disclose in a particular situation. While it is important for leaders to be authentic, it is also essential for them to have integrity in their relationships with others.
Integrity undergirds all aspects of leadership. It is at the core of being a leader. Integrity is a central aspect of a leader’s ability to influence. If people do not trust a leader, the leader’s influence potential is weakened. In essence, integrity is the bedrock of who a leader is. When a leader’s integrity comes into question, his or her potential to lead is lost.
Former president Bill Clinton (1993–2001) is a good example of how integrity is related to leadership. In the late 1990s, he was brought before the U.S. Congress for misrepresenting under oath an affair he had engaged in with a White House intern. For his actions, he was impeached by the U.S. House of Representatives, but then was acquitted by the U.S. Senate. At one point during the long ordeal, the president appeared on national television and, in what is now a famous speech, declared his innocence. Because subsequent hearings provided information suggesting he might have lied during his television speech, many Americans felt Clinton had violated his duty and responsibility as a person, leader, and president. As a result, Clinton’s integrity was clearly challenged and the impact of his leadership substantially weakened.
Effective Traits
In conclusion, there are many traits related to effective leadership. The six traits discussed here appear to be particularly important in the leadership process. As will be revealed in subsequent chapters, leadership is a very complex process. The traits discussed in this chapter are important but are only one dimension of a multidimensional process.
69
Leadership Traits in Practice
Throughout history, there have been many great leaders. Each of them has led with unique talents and in different circumstances. The following section analyzes the accomplishments and the traits of five famous leaders. Although there are hundreds of equally distinguished leaders, these five are highlighted because they represent different kinds of leadership at different points in history. All of these leaders are recognized as being notable leaders: Each has had an impact on many people’s lives and accomplished great things.
Traits of Great Leaders
The leaders discussed below are George Washington, Winston Churchill, Mother Teresa, Bill Gates, and Oprah Winfrey. As you read about each of them, think about their leadership traits.
70
George Washington (1732–1799)
George Washington is considered to be the founding father of the United States of America. His leadership was pivotal in the development of this country’s government. He was truly respected by everyone, from low-ranking soldiers to feisty public officials. He was a man of great integrity who was a good listener. After the Revolutionary War, Washington was the reason that various factions did not splinter into small groups or nations. He became the United States’ first president because his leadership was so well suited for the times.
71
Gilbert Stuart /National Gallery of Art/Getty Images
Born into a prosperous Virginia family, he grew up on a large plantation. His father died when he was 11. Washington received formal schooling for seven years and then worked as a surveyor. He entered the military at the age of 20. During the French and Indian War, Washington learned about the difficulties of battle and experienced both victories and defeats. He served as commander in chief of the Continental Army from 1775 to 1783. His leadership was instrumental in leading the colonies to victory over Great Britain in the
72
Revolutionary War. After the war, he retired to farm for a short period. In 1787, however, his interests in politics and the nation took him to the Constitutional Convention in Philadelphia, where he was chosen to preside over the successful creation of the U.S. Constitution. After the Constitution was ratified, Washington was elected by 100% of the electoral college as the first president of the United States. Washington served two terms as president (1789–1793, 1793–1797); although he had the people’s support, he chose not to serve a third term. He retired to Mount Vernon in 1797 and died there from pneumonia at the age of 67. At his funeral, one of his officers, Henry Lee, eulogized him as an American who was “first in war, first in peace, and first in the heart of his countrymen.”
Traits and Characteristics
George Washington exhibited many special leadership traits (Brookhiser, 1996; Burns & Dunn, 2004; Fishman, 2001; Higginbotham, 2002). Researchers identify him as a modest man with great moral character who demonstrated integrity, virtuousness, and wisdom in his leadership. Though neither highly educated nor brilliant, he is reported to have read 10 newspapers each day. He was tall, and careful about his appearance. For much of his life, he kept a daily record of his work. Although reserved, as a military leader he was brave and tenacious. Rather than use power to his own ends, he gave up his position as commander in chief after the war. Washington provided stability, reason, and order after the American Revolution when the United States was in its formative stages. His evenness made him predictable to the American people, who considered him trustworthy. Above all, Washington was a prudent leader who made sound judgments and provided balance and wisdom to the new government. Washington was a special leader with many unique talents who, as Schwartz (1987, p. 147) has suggested, “was ‘great’ because he was ‘good.’”
73
Walter Stoneman/Stringer/Hulton Archive/Getty Images
74
Winston Churchill (1874–1965)
Winston Churchill was one of the greatest statesmen and orators of the 20th century. In addition, he was a talented painter and prolific writer; he received the Nobel Prize in Literature in 1953. Churchill served in the military during World War I, became prime minister of Great Britain in May 1940, and remained in that office through World War II, until 1945. It was at this time that his masterful leadership was most visible. When the Germans threatened to invade Britain, Churchill stood strong. He made many famous speeches that had far-reaching effects on the morale of the people of Great Britain and the Allied forces. On the home front, he was a social reformer. He served a second term as prime minister from 1951 to 1955. He died at the age of 90 in 1965.
Traits and Characteristics
Winston Churchill’s leadership was remarkable because it emerged from a man who was average in many respects and who faced challenges in his personal life. In his education, he did not stand out as superior to others. On a societal level, he was a loner who had few friends. On a personal level, he suffered from bouts of depression throughout his life. Despite these characteristics, Churchill emerged as a leader because of his other unique gifts and how he used them (Hayward, 1997; Keegan, 2002; Sandys & Littman, 2003). A voracious reader, Churchill was plain speaking, decisive, detail oriented, and informed (Hayward, 1997). Furthermore, he was very ambitious, but not out of self-interest: He wanted what was right for others, and he wanted the best for Great Britain. His most significant talent was his masterful use of language. In his oratory, the normally plainspoken Churchill used words and imagery in powerful ways that touched the hearts of many and set the moral climate of the war (Keegan, 2002). He had the ability to build hope and inspire others to rise to the challenge. His stoicism and optimism were an inspiration to his people and all of the Allied forces (Sandys & Littman, 2003).
75
Mother Teresa (1910–1997)
A Roman Catholic nun considered a saint by many, Mother Teresa received the Nobel Peace Prize in 1979 for her work with the poor and helpless in Kolkata, India, and throughout the world. Born in Macedonia, Mother Teresa came from a comfortable background. At the age of 18, she joined the Catholic Sisters of Loreto order and worked for 17 years as a high school teacher in Kolkata. Her awareness of poverty in Kolkata caused her to leave the convent in 1948 to devote herself to working full-time with the poorest of the poor in the slums of the city. In 1950, Mother Teresa founded a new religious order, the Missionaries of Charity, to care for the hungry, homeless, unwanted, and unloved.
Bettmann/Contributor/Bettmann/Getty Images
Today, there are more than 1 million workers affiliated with the Missionaries of Charity in more than 40 countries. The charity provides help to people who have been hurt by floods, epidemics, famines, and war. The Missionaries of Charity also operate hospitals, schools, orphanages, youth centers, shelters for the sick, and hospices. For her humanitarian work and efforts for peace, Mother Teresa has been recognized with many awards, including the
76
Pope John XXIII Peace Prize (1971), the Nehru Award (1972), the U.S. Presidential Medal of Freedom (1985), and the Congressional Gold Medal (1994). Although she struggled with deteriorating health in her later years, Mother Teresa remained actively involved in her work to the very end. She died at the age of 87 in 1997. In September 2016, Pope Francis declared Mother Teresa a saint, with the official name of Saint Teresa of Kolkata. In a statement announcing the canonization, the Vatican called her a “metaphor for selfless devotion and holiness” (Lyman, 2016).
Traits and Characteristics
Mother Teresa was a simple woman of small stature who dressed in a plain blue and white sari, and who never owned more than the people she served. Mirroring her appearance, her mission was simple—to care for the poor. From her first year on the streets of Kolkata where she tended to one dying person to her last years when thousands of people were cared for by the Missionaries of Charity, Mother Teresa stayed focused on her goal. She was a true civil servant who was simultaneously determined and fearless, and humble and spiritual. She often listened to the will of God. When criticized for her stand on abortion and women’s role in the family, or her approaches to eliminating poverty, Mother Teresa responded with a strong will; she never wavered in her deep-seated human values. Teaching by example with few words, she was a role model for others. Clearly, Mother Teresa was a leader who practiced what she preached (Gonzalez-Balado, 1997; Sebba, 1997; Spink, 1997; Vardey, 1995).
77
Bill Gates (1955–)
For many years, William (Bill) H. Gates III, cofounder and chair of Microsoft Corporation, the world’s largest developer of software for personal computers, was the wealthiest person in the world with assets estimated at more than $70 billion. A self-made man, Gates began his interest in computers at the age of 13 when he and a friend developed their first computer software program. He later attended Harvard University but left, without graduating, to focus on software development. He cofounded Microsoft in 1975. Under Gates’s leadership, Microsoft developed the well-known Microsoft Disk Operating System (MS-DOS), Windows operating system, and Internet Explorer browser. Microsoft is one of the fastest-growing and most profitable companies ever established. From the success of Microsoft, Gates and his wife established the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation in 2000 to reduce inequities and improve lives around the world. This foundation promotes education, addresses global health issues (such as malaria, HIV/AIDS, and tuberculosis), sponsors libraries, and supports housing and community initiatives in the Pacific Northwest. Beginning in 2006, Gates transitioned away from his day-to-day operating role at Microsoft to spend more time working with his foundation, but he remained the corporation’s chair. But in February 2014, Gates stepped down as the company’s board chairman in order to increase his involvement in the company’s operations, serving in a new role of technology adviser and mentor to the company’s new CEO Satya Nadella. Gates continues to tackle global challenges as co-chair of the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation, which has become the world’s largest private charitable foundation.
78
Yamaguchi Haruyoshi/Contributor/Corbis Historical/Getty Images
Traits and Characteristics
Bill Gates is both intelligent and visionary. When he cofounded Microsoft, he had a vision about how to meet the technological needs of people in the future, and he hired friends to help him accomplish that vision. Gates is also task oriented and diligent, often working 12
79
or more hours a day to promote his interest in software product development. Furthermore, Gates is focused and aggressive. When Microsoft was accused by the U.S. government of antitrust violations, Gates appeared before congressional hearings and strongly defended his company. When asked about whether he has a “win at all cost” mentality, he answered that you bring people together to work on products and make products better, but there is never a finish line—there are always challenges ahead (Jager & Ortiz, 1997, pp. 151–152). In his personal style, Gates is simple, straightforward, unpretentious, and altruistic: He has demonstrated a strong concern for the poor and underserved.
Intelligence in Leadership
80
Oprah Winfrey (1954–)
An award-winning television talk show host, Oprah Winfrey is one of the most powerful and influential women in the world. Born in rural Mississippi into a dysfunctional family, she was raised by her grandmother until she was 6. Winfrey learned to read at a very early age and skipped two grades in school. Her adolescent years were difficult: While living in inner-city Milwaukee with her mother who worked two jobs, Winfrey was molested by a family member. Despite these experiences, she was an honors student in high school and received national accolades for her oratory ability. She received a full scholarship to Tennessee State University, where she studied communication and worked at a local radio station. Winfrey’s work in the media eventually led her to Chicago where she became host of the highly acclaimed Oprah Winfrey Show. In 2007, Winfrey was the highest-paid entertainer in television, earning an annual salary estimated at $260 million. She also is an actor, a producer, a book critic, and a magazine publisher, and, in 2011, left her successful television show to concentrate on her television network, OWN. For years, Winfrey had publicly battled her weight, using her struggles as inspiration for her millions of fans to lead healthier lives. In 2015, Winfrey become a 10% stockholder and board member of the diet empire Weight Watchers. Winfrey, who has long shown an interest in health issues and dieting programs, serves as an adviser to the company, using her undeniable clout to further encourage others to engage in healthier lifestyles.
81
Frederick M. Brown/Stringer/Getty Images Entertainment/Getty Images
Her total wealth is estimated at more than $3.1 billion. Winfrey is also a highly regarded philanthropist: Her giving has focused on making a difference in the lives of the underprivileged and poor. Winfrey has paid special attention to the needs of people in Africa, raising millions of dollars to help AIDS-affected children there and creating a leadership academy for girls in a small town near Johannesburg, South Africa.
82
Traits and Characteristics
Oprah Winfrey’s remarkable journey from rural poverty to influential world leader can be explained by several of her strengths (Harris & Watson, 2007; Illouz, 2003; McDonald, 2007). Foremost, Winfrey is an excellent communicator. Since she was a little girl reciting Bible passages in church, she has been comfortable in front of an audience. On television, she is able to talk to millions of people and have each person feel as if she is talking directly to him or her. Winfrey is also intelligent and well read, with a strong business sense. She is sincere, determined, and inspirational. Winfrey has a charismatic style of leadership that enables her to connect with people. She is spontaneous and expressive, and has a fearless ability to self-disclose. Because she has “been in the struggle” and survived, she is seen as a role model. Winfrey has overcome many obstacles in her life and encourages others to overcome their struggles as well. Her message is a message of hope.
All of these individuals have exhibited exceptional leadership. While each of these leaders is unique, together they share many common characteristics. All are visionary, strong willed, diligent, and inspirational. As purpose-driven leaders, they are role models and symbols of hope. Reflecting on the characteristics of these extraordinary leaders will provide you with a better understanding of the traits that are important for effective leadership. Although you may not aspire to be another Bill Gates or Mother Teresa, you can learn a great deal from these leaders in understanding how your own traits affect your leadership.
83
Summary
This chapter describes the traits required of a leader. Social science research has provided insight into leadership traits. Thousands of leadership studies have been performed to identify the traits of effective leaders; the results of these studies point to a very long list of important leadership traits. From this list, the traits that appear to be especially important for effective leadership are intelligence, confidence, charisma, determination, sociability, and integrity.
Traits and Leadership Styles
From an examination of a select group of well-known historical and contemporary leaders including George Washington, Winston Churchill, Mother Teresa, Bill Gates, and Oprah Winfrey, it is clear that exemplary leaders exhibit many similar traits. In the main, these leaders were or are visionary, strong willed, diligent, inspirational, purpose driven, and hopeful. These leadership figures provide useful models for understanding the traits that are important and desirable for achieving effective leadership.
Because leadership is a complex process, there are no simple paths or guarantees to becoming a successful leader. Each individual is unique, and each of us has our own distinct talents for leadership. Those who are naturally strong in the six traits discussed in this chapter will be well equipped for leadership. If you are not strong on all of these traits but are willing to work on them, you can still become an effective leader.
Remember that there are many traits related to effective leadership. By becoming aware of your own traits and how to nourish them, you will be well on your way to becoming a successful leader.
84
Glossary Terms
charisma 24 confidence 23 determination 25 integrity 26 intelligence 22 sociability 25
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
85
2.1 Case Study: An Emerging Leader Tim T. portrays his life as a tension between “nature” and “nurture.” He sees it this way: He has two sets of DNA, and these two very different sets of characteristics have given him what he needs to be a leader. The first set of DNA, he says, comprises those “God-given genetic talents” that came from the biological parents who abandoned him at birth. The second set comes from the religious and caring family who adopted him two years later.
Tim’s nature is to be out in front of people and relating to them. These innate abilities of his have always been very public and people oriented: from his easy and eloquent speaking style and teaching skills to singing and acting. “As a baby, I was always an extrovert, and since age 2 or 3, people have told me that I would be either president of the United States, a preacher, or a comedian,” he says. “I didn’t intentionally work on these abilities; I have just always had them.”
His “other strand of DNA” came from his adoptive family whom he describes as gentle, unassuming, and quiet. Tim admits he ran in the “middle of the crowd,” while his family members were often silent bystanders standing off in a corner. They did, however, instill in him the strong values of “loving God, loving family, working hard, and giving back” that he embraces today.
Those two sets of characteristics allowed Tim to thrive early. Just out of high school, he was given an opportunity by baseball player Derek Jeter’s Turn 2 Foundation to create a new after-school program for second to fifth graders called Proud to Be Me. The goal of the pilot program was to build children’s self- esteem and self-concept by providing them with new and diverse experiences. Tim developed it with the goal of giving these children a larger lens of what the world could be, so they would be empowered to see more choices than what they found in their neighborhoods.
“My core belief and approach has been to help others by giving them things that nobody can take away,” he says.
When Tim went to college, he supported himself working part-time at a bank doing collections, calling people on the phone to try to convince them to make payments on their debts. It wasn’t fun, but Tim excelled at it. “I would use my powers of persuasion to get people to make payments, not because it was my job, but because I wanted to help them. These weren’t bad people; they just got in over their heads.”
It was in this job that Tim realized his talents only worked if there was a purpose. “I tried to sell vacuum cleaners once and couldn’t even sell one to my own mama,” he says. “Do you know why? Because there was no purpose in it. But yet, I could talk these people who are struggling and hurting into making a payment. That’s when I knew that I can’t walk on the face of this earth and not help somebody. My persuasion has to have a purpose.”
After finishing college, Tim went on to get a master’s degree in communication and, at the age of 28, became the executive director of the Douglass Community Association, a 90-year-old private, nonprofit, inner-city agency that provides opportunities for youth development, education, healthy living, and leadership. Tim managed the center’s $1.2 million budget and 24 people. He spent much of his time out in the larger community raising money and resources and putting out fires. Although Tim enjoyed his role as executive director, he admits he had difficulty handling the day-to-day personnel issues at the agency.
“I spent a lot of time managing external human resources, but not paying attention to the needs of internal human resources at the center. When my staff did an assessment of me, they consistently said, ‘He does a great job as a leader, but he is our boss and we need him here.’”
To enhance his skills, he took advanced leadership training at the Center for Creative Leadership in North Carolina and Harvard University in Cambridge, Massachusetts. Tim left the community center after four years to become an associate vice president at Southwest Michigan First, a regional agency focused on
86
catalyzing job creation and economic growth in an area that has been hard hit by job losses. For Tim, it’s an opportunity that makes the most of his double set of DNA.
“This is the place where my talent and my passions meet. I can help people. I can sift through problems and take big issues and break them down in ways people understand. I can persuade and motivate people and organizations to grow,” he says. “And I am still helping others in ways that people can’t take away.”
But Tim still wants to find more ways to help others by creating an independent foundation to help people and kids in need. “My experience has been that it is hard to help hurting people because there is so much bureaucracy and BS tied up in how we do it. I want to help people without strings. If you give people money to help them, don’t give it to them if you need it back. If you’re gonna do something for someone, just do it.”
87
Questions 1. What is your reaction to Tim’s story? 2. Nature and nurture play a significant role in Tim’s leadership journey. From your perspective,
which has the greatest impact on Tim? Discuss your answer. 3. Of the six major traits described in the chapter (i.e., intelligence, confidence, charisma,
determination, sociability, and integrity), which traits are Tim’s strongest, and which traits are his weakest?
4. What characteristics of Tim’s leadership would you like to incorporate into your own style of leadership?
88
2.2 Leadership Traits Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To gain an understanding of how traits are used in leadership assessment 2. To obtain an assessment of your own leadership traits
Directions
1. Make five copies of this questionnaire. It should be completed by you and five people you know (e.g., roommates, coworkers, relatives, friends).
2. Using the following scale, have each individual indicate the degree to which he or she agrees or disagrees with each of the 14 statements below regarding your leadership traits. Do not forget to complete this exercise for yourself.
3. ______________________________ (your name) is
Statements Strongly disagree
Disagree Neutral Agree Strongly agree
1. Articulate: Communicates effectively with others
1 2 3 4 5
2. Perceptive: Is discerning and insightful 1 2 3 4 5
3. Self-confident: Believes in oneself and one’s ability
1 2 3 4 5
4. Self-assured: Is secure with self, free of doubts
1 2 3 4 5
5. Persistent: Stays fixed on the goals, despite interference
1 2 3 4 5
6. Determined: Takes a firm stand, acts with certainty
1 2 3 4 5
7. Trustworthy: Is authentic, inspires confidence
1 2 3 4 5
8. Dependable: Is consistent and reliable 1 2 3 4 5
9. Friendly: Shows kindness and warmth 1 2 3 4 5
10. Outgoing: Talks freely, gets along well with others
1 2 3 4 5
11. Conscientious: Is thorough, organized, and careful
1 2 3 4 5
89
12. Diligent: Is industrious, hardworking 1 2 3 4 5
13. Sensitive: Shows tolerance, is tactful and sympathetic
1 2 3 4 5
14. Empathic: Understands others, identifies with others
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Enter the responses for Raters 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 in the appropriate columns on the scoring sheet on
this page. An example of a completed chart is provided on page 41. 2. For each of the 14 items, compute the average for the five raters and place that number in the
“average rating” column. 3. Place your own scores in the “self-rating” column.
Leadership Traits Questionnaire Chart
Rater 1
Rater 2
Rater 3
Rater 4
Rater 5 Average rating Self-rating
1. Articulate
2. Perceptive
3. Self-confident
4. Self-assured
5. Persistent
6. Determined
7. Trustworthy
8. Dependable
9. Friendly
10. Outgoing
11. Conscientious
12. Diligent
13. Sensitive
14. Empathic Summary and interpretation:
90
Scoring Interpretation
The scores you received on this questionnaire provide information about how you see yourself and how others see you as a leader. The chart allows you to see where your perceptions are the same as those of others and where they differ. There are no “perfect” scores for this questionnaire. The purpose of the instrument is to provide a way to assess your strengths and weaknesses and to evaluate areas where your perceptions are similar to or different from those of others. While it is confirming when others see you in the same way as you see yourself, it is also beneficial to know when they see you differently. This assessment can help you understand your assets as well as areas in which you may seek to improve.
Example 2.1 Leadership Traits Questionnaire Ratings
Rater 1
Rater 2
Rater 3
Rater 4
Rater 5 Average rating Self-rating
1. Articulate 4 4 3 2 4 3.4 4
2. Perceptive 2 5 3 4 4 3.6 5
3. Self-confident 4 4 5 5 4 4.4 4
4. Self-assured 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
5. Persistent 4 4 3 3 3 3.4 3
6. Determined 4 4 4 4 4 4 4
7. Trustworthy 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
8. Dependable 4 5 4 5 4 4.4 4
9. Friendly 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
10. Outgoing 5 4 5 4 5 4.6 4
11. Conscientious
2 3 2 3 3 2.6 4
12. Diligent 3 3 3 3 3 3 4
13. Sensitive 4 4 5 5 5 4.6 3
14. Empathic 5 5 4 5 4 4.6 3
Summary and interpretation: The scorer’s self-ratings are higher than the average ratings of others on articulate, perceptive, conscientious, and diligent. The scorer’s self-ratings are lower than the average ratings of others on self-confident, persistent, dependable, outgoing, sensitive, and empathic. The scorer’s self-ratings on self-assured, determined, trustworthy, and friendly are the same as the average ratings of others.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
91
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
92
2.3 Observational Exercise
93
Leadership Traits
Purpose
1. To gain an understanding of the role of traits in the leadership process 2. To examine the traits of selected historical and everyday leaders
Directions
1. Based on the descriptions of the historical leaders provided in the chapter, identify the three major leadership traits for each of the leaders listed below.
2. Select and briefly describe two leaders in your own life (e.g., work supervisor, teacher, coach, music director, business owner, community leader). Identify the three major leadership traits of each of these leaders.
94
Questions
1. Based on the leaders you observed, which leadership traits appear to be most important? 2. What differences, if any, did you observe between the historical and everyday leaders’ traits? 3. Based on your observations, what one trait would you identify as the definitive leadership trait? 4. Overall, what traits do you think should be used in selecting our society’s leaders?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
95
2.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
96
Leadership Traits
Reflection
1. Based on the scores you received on the Leadership Traits Questionnaire, what are your strongest leadership traits? What are your weakest traits? Discuss.
2. In this chapter, we discussed five leadership figures. As you read about these leaders, which leaders did you find most appealing? What was it about their leadership that you found remarkable? Discuss.
3. As you reflect on your own leadership traits, do you think some of them are more “you” and authentic than others? Have you always been the kind of leader you are today, or have your traits changed over time? Are you a stronger leader today than you were five years ago? Discuss.
Action
1. If you could model yourself after one or more of the historical leaders we discussed in this chapter, whom would you model yourself after? Identify two of their traits that you could and should incorporate into your own style of leadership.
2. Based on the case study of Tim T., which of his traits could you incorporate into your own leadership? Discuss.
3. Although changing leadership traits is not easy, which of your leadership traits would you like to change? Specifically, what actions do you need to take to change your traits?
4. All of us have problematic traits that inhibit our leadership but are difficult to change. Which single trait distracts from your leadership? Since you cannot easily change this trait, what actions can you take to “work around” this trait? Discuss.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
97
References Antonakis, J., Cianciolo, A. T., & Sternberg, R. J. (Eds.). (2004). The nature of leadership.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Asmal, K., Chidester, D., & Wilmot, J. (2003). Nelson Mandela: In his own words. New York, NY: Little, Brown.
Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass and Stogdill’s handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York, NY: Free Press.
Brookhiser, R. (1996). Founding father: Rediscovering George Washington. New York, NY: Free Press.
Burns, J. M., & Dunn, S. (2004). George Washington. New York, NY: Times Books.
Clinton, W. J. (2003). Foreword. In K. Asmal, D. Chidester, & J. Wilmot (Eds.), Nelson Mandela: In his own words (pp. xv–xvi). New York, NY: Little, Brown.
Conger, J. A. (1999). Charismatic and transformational leadership in organizations: An insider’s perspective on these developing streams of research. Leadership Quarterly, 10(2), 145–170.
Fishman, E. (2001). Washington’s leadership: Prudence and the American presidency. In E. Fishman, W. D. Pederson, & R. J. Rozell (Eds.), George Washington: Foundation of presidential leadership and character (pp. 125–142). Westport, CT: Praeger.
Gonzalez-Balado, J. L. (1997). Mother Teresa: Her life, her work, her message. Liguori, MO: Liguori.
Hadland, A. (2003). Nelson Mandela: A life. In K. Asmal, D. Chidester, & J. Wilmot (Eds.), Nelson Mandela: In his own words (pp. xxix–xxxvii). New York, NY: Little, Brown.
98
Harris, J., & Watson, E. (Eds.). (2007). The Oprah phenomenon. Lexington: The University Press of Kentucky.
Hayward, S. F. (1997). Churchill on leadership: Executive success in the face of adversity. Rocklin, CA: Prima.
Higginbotham, R. D. (2002). George Washington: Uniting a nation. Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield.
House, R. J. (1976). A 1976 theory of charismatic leadership. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership: The cutting edge (pp. 189–207). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
House, R. J., Hanges, P. J., Javidan, M., Dorfman, P. W., & Gupta, V. (2004). Leadership, culture, and organizations: The GLOBE study of 62 societies. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Illouz, E. (2003). Oprah Winfrey and the glamour of misery. New York, NY: Columbia University Press.
Jager, R. D., & Ortiz, R. (1997). In the company of giants: Candid conversations with the visionaries of the digital world. New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
Joseph, J. A. (2003). Promoting peace and practicing diplomacy. In K. Asmal, D. Chidester, & J. Wilmot (Eds.), Nelson Mandela: In his own words (pp. 499–506). New York, NY: Little, Brown.
Judge, T. A., Bono, J. E., Ilies, R., & Gerhardt, M. W. (2002). Personality and leadership: A qualitative and quantitative review. Journal of Applied Psychology, 87(4), 765–780.
Keegan, J. (2002). Winston Churchill. New York, NY: Viking.
Kirkpatrick, S. A., & Locke, E. A. (1991). Leadership: Do traits matter? The Executive, 5(2), 48–60.
99
Lyman, E. J. (2016). Mother Teresa declared a saint by Pope Francis. USA Today. Retrieved from http://www.usatoday.com
McDonald, K. B. (2007). Embracing sisterhood: Class, identity, and contemporary black women. Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield.
Sandys, C., & Littman, J. (2003). We shall not fail: The inspiring leadership of Winston Churchill. New York, NY: Penguin.
Schwartz, B. (1987). George Washington: The making of an American symbol. New York, NY: Free Press.
Sebba, A. (1997). Mother Teresa: Beyond the image. New York, NY: Doubleday.
Shamir, B., House, R. J., & Arthur, M. B. (1993). The motivational effects of charismatic leadership: A self-concept based theory. Organization Science, 4(4), 577–594.
Spink, K. (1997). Mother Teresa: A complete authorized bibliography. New York, NY: HarperCollins.
Stogdill, R. M. (1974). Handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York, NY: Free Press.
Turn 2 Foundation. (2010). Proud to Be Me. Retrieved from http://derekjeter.mlb.com/players/jeter_derek/turn2/proud_douglass.jsp
Vardey, L. (1995). Introduction. In L. Vardey (Ed.), Mother Teresa: A simple path (pp. xv–xxxviii). New York, NY: Ballantine.
Wills, G. (1994). Certain trumpets: The call of leaders. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.
100
3 Engaging Strengths
101
Introduction
Think of a time or circumstance when you were at the top of your game. Now, step back and try to explain why you were so effective in that situation. What was it about you or the way you presented yourself that made you feel good? What did you do that worked so well? Why did others respond to you the way they did? The answers to each of these questions are related to your strengths—the central theme of this chapter.
What Do You Mean By Strengths?
Every one of us has identifiable leadership strengths, areas in which we excel or thrive. But we often fail to recognize these strengths. As a result, many times our strengths are used ineffectively or not at all. The same is true for the strengths of our coworkers and followers; sometimes their strengths are known, but often they go untapped. The challenge we face as leaders is to identify our own strengths as well as the strengths of others and then use these to make our organizations and followers more efficient, productive, and satisfied.
Identifying individual strengths is a unique challenge because people often feel hesitant and inhibited about acknowledging positive aspects of themselves. In the American culture, expressing positive self-attributes is often seen as boastful or self-serving. In fact, focusing on self is disdained in many cultures, while showing humility and being self-deprecating is seen as virtuous. In this chapter, you will be asked to set aside your inhibitions about identifying your own strengths in an effort to better understand the inextricable role these strengths play in leading and working with others.
Our goal in this chapter is to explore how understanding strengths can make one a better leader. First, we will explain the concept by defining strengths and describing the historical background of strengths-based leadership. We will examine how to identify strengths, followed by a description of different measures that can be used to assess your strengths. The final section of the chapter will look at the concept of strengths-based leadership in practice, including specific strategies that leaders can employ to use strengths to become more effective leaders.
102
Strengths-Based Leadership Explained
Before discussing the development and principles of strength leadership, we first need to clarify what is meant by strengths. A strength is an attribute or quality of an individual that accounts for successful performance. It is the characteristic, or series of characteristics, we demonstrate when our performance is at its best. Strength researchers (Buckingham & Clifton, 2001; Rath, 2007) suggest that strengths are the ability to consistently demonstrate exceptional work. Similarly, Linley (2008) defines strength as a preexisting capacity that is authentic and energizing and enables peak performance. Simply put, strengths are positive features of ourselves that make us effective and help us flourish. For example, Antonio was born with a talent for drawing and design. He worked as a construction laborer for years while he attended a university to study architecture. As a result, when Antonio became an architect, his experiences in building made his design skills stronger because he more fully understood the concepts of actual construction. His clients often comment that one of his strengths is his “construction-friendly” designs.
What is Strengths-Based Leadership?
103
Historical Background
Studying leadership from the perspective of strengths is a new area of study, which came to the forefront in the late 1990s as a result of two overlapping research developments. First, researchers at the Gallup Organization initiated a massive study that included interviews of over 2 million people to describe what’s right with people—that is, their talents and what they are good at—rather than what’s wrong with people (Rath, 2007).
Second, academic research scholars began to question the exclusive focus in psychology on the disease model of human problems and started to study mentally and physically healthy people and what accounted for their well-being. From this work, a new field called positive psychology emerged (Peterson & Seligman, 2003). Each of these two developments helped to explain the rising popularity of strengths-based leadership.
Gallup Organization
Best known as a public opinion research organization that conducts political polling, the Gallup Organization also conducts research in other areas of the social sciences. For nearly 40 years, the study of people’s strengths has been a major research focus at Gallup. This work was spearheaded by the late Donald O. Clifton, under whose leadership millions of people were interviewed regarding their performance and human strengths. Based on these interview data, Gallup researchers designed and published the StrengthsFinder profile, an online assessment of people’s talents and potential strengths. This profile was subsequently titled the Clifton StrengthsFinder in honor of its chief designer and since 2007 has been called StrengthsFinder 2.0. Later in the chapter, we will discuss more extensively StrengthsFinder and the specific talent-based strengths it measures.
The Strengths Finder
StrengthsFinder is one of the most widely used self-assessment questionnaires in the world and has been completed by more than 10 million people to date. This assessment has been adopted by many universities and organizations to help individuals identify their strengths, become more engaged, and improve their performance. While Gallup has not published a theory about strengths, the widely accepted use of StrengthsFinder has elevated strengths as a key variable in discussions of factors that account for effective leadership development and performance.
Positive Psychology
104
At the same time Gallup’s StrengthsFinder profile was growing in popularity, a major change was occurring in the discipline of psychology. Researchers were challenging the discipline to expand its focus on not only what is wrong with people and their weaknesses, but also what is right with people and their positive attributes. This expanded focus, which was initiated by Martin Seligman in an address to the American Psychological Association in 1998 (see Fowler, Seligman, & Kocher, 1999), soon became the field of positive psychology. Since its inception a decade ago, positive psychology has grown exponentially and developed into a credible and important area of psychological research.
Positive Psychology
Specifically, positive psychology can be defined as “the ‘scientific’ study of what makes life most worth living” (Peterson, 2009, p. xxiii). Rather than study the frailties and flaws of individuals (the disease model), positive psychology focuses on individuals’ strengths and the factors that allow them to thrive (Fredrickson, 2001; Seligman, 2002; Seligman & Csikszentmihalyi, 2000). It addresses people’s positive experiences, such as their happiness and joy; people’s positive traits, such as their characteristics and talents; and people’s positive institutions, such as families, schools, and businesses that influence them (Cameron, Dutton, & Quinn, 2003).
Positive Psychology in Action
Most prominently, positive psychology is devoted to the study of people’s positive characteristics—their strengths. This makes it invaluable for understanding strengths-based leadership. Positive psychology launched the analysis of people’s strengths into the mainstream of scientific research (Linley, 2008). Concepts and theories from the field of positive psychology directly relate to learning how strengths-based leadership works.
105
Identifying and Measuring Strengths
As indicated in the historical background, most of the research on strengths has been done by scholars connected with Gallup and scholars studying positive psychology. This body of research has produced multiple ways of identifying strengths and a wide-ranging list of individual strengths. This section explores the way strengths have been identified by three major groups: (1) Gallup Organization, (2) Values in Action Institute, and (3) Centre of Applied Positive Psychology in Great Britain. Although there is much overlap in their work, each research group provides a unique perspective on identifying and measuring individual strengths. Collectively, this research provides an extensive list of specific strengths, a clear picture of how strengths can be measured, and an expansive view of how strengths can be used to understand human behavior.
Gallup and the StrengthsFinder Profile
Gallup researchers interviewed an enormous number of executives, salespeople, teachers, doctors, nurses, and other professionals about their strengths and what made them good at what they did. The goal of the interviews was to identify the qualities of high-performing individuals. From interviews, Gallup researchers extracted 34 patterns or themes that they thought did the best job at explaining excellent performance (see Table 3.1). These 34 items are “the most common themes that emerged from the study of human talent” (Buckingham & Clifton, 2001, p. 12). For the last decade, these themes have been the benchmark for discussing strengths in the workplace.
It is important to point out that Gallup researchers identified themes of human talent, not strengths. Talents are similar to personality traits—they are relatively stable, fixed characteristics that are not easily changed. From talents, strengths emerge. The equation for developing a strength is talent times investment (see Figure 3.1). Strengths are derived from having certain talents and then further developing those talents by gaining additional knowledge, skills, and practice (Rath, 2007). For example, you may have the talent for being able to communicate easily with others. If you were to invest time in learning more about the intricacies of effective communication and practicing it with the help of Toastmasters International, a club that helps individuals develop public speaking skills, you could enhance your communication strength. Similarly, if you were born with talent as an initiator, you could develop it further into one of your strengths by studying how to “think outside of the box” and then practicing this thought process in your organization. To summarize, talents are not strengths, but they provide the basis for developing strengths when they are coupled with knowledge, skills, and practice.
How are strengths measured from the Gallup perspective? Gallup’s StrengthsFinder is a 177-item questionnaire that identifies “the areas where you have the greatest potential to
106
develop strengths” (Rath, 2007, p. 31). After taking this questionnaire, you receive a list of your five strongest talents. You can build on these talents, furthering your personal growth and development. The questionnaire, which takes about 30 minutes to complete, is available through an access code that appears in the back of strengths books published by Gallup. It is also available on the organization’s website at www.strengthsfinder.com.
Becoming Influential
Table 3.1 34 Talent Themes Table 3.1 34 Talent Themes
Executing Influencing Relationship Building Strategic Thinking
Achiever
Arranger
Belief
Consistency
Deliberative
Discipline
Focus
Responsibility
Restorative
Activator
Command
Communication
Competition
Maximizer
Self-Assurance
Significance
Woo
Adaptability
Developer
Connectedness
Empathy
Harmony
Includer
Individualization
Positivity
Relator
Analytical
Context
Futuristic
Ideation
Input
Intellection
Learner
Strategic
Source: Copyright © 2008 Gallup, Inc. All rights reserved. The content is used with permission; however, Gallup retains all rights of republication.
Figure 3.1 Strength Equation
107
Source: Copyright © 2007 Gallup, Inc. All rights reserved. The content is used with permission; however, Gallup retains all rights of republication.
How can leaders use strengths in their leadership? In the book Strengths Based Leadership, Rath and Conchie (2008) explain how a leader’s scores on the StrengthsFinder profile can be interpreted. To facilitate understanding, they developed a configuration that depicts four domains of leadership strengths (see Table 3.2). The four domains are executing, influencing, relationship building, and strategic thinking. These domains were derived from information obtained during interviews with thousands of executive teams and from a factor analysis of the Gallup talent data set. Taken together, the four domains represent the four kinds of strengths that help create successful teams.
Effective teams possess broad groupings of strengths and work best when all four domains of leadership strengths are represented on their teams (Rath & Conchie, 2008). Effective teams are generally well rounded, and they have different group members who fulfill different needs of the group. Leaders bring unique strengths to teams, but leaders do not have to demonstrate strengths in all four domains. Strong and cohesive teams bring into play everyone’s strengths to make the team effective.
For example, Maria Lopez, who has owned a successful bridal shop for 10 years, took the StrengthsFinder profile and found her dominant strengths were in the strategic thinking domain. Maria is known for her futuristic thinking and deliberate planning. She is outstanding at forecasting trends in bridal wear and helping her team navigate the constantly changing bridal market. Maria hired Claudia, whose dominant strengths are in relationship building. Claudia is the most positive person on the staff and connects with everyone. It is Claudia who treats customers in the store like they are part of “the family.” To run the store on a day-to-day basis, Maria brought on Kristen who is a hard worker and
108
uses her strengths in executing to get the job done. She is highly disciplined and motivated to make the bridal shop the best in the city. Lastly, Maria hired Brianna because of her strengths in the domain of influencing. Brianna is always out in the community promoting the shop. She is seen as a credible professional by other shop owners because she is self- assured and knowledgeable. In the store, people like Brianna because she is not afraid to be in charge and give directions to others. In summary, Maria, the store’s owner, is a leader with strengths in one domain, but has the wisdom to hire personnel who have strengths in other domains. Collectively, the combined strengths of Maria and her team allow them to have a very successful bridal shop.
Table 3.2 Four Domains of Leadership Strength Table 3.2 Four
Domains of Leadership Strength
Executing
Influencing
Relationship Building
Strategic Thinking Source: Copyright © 2008 Gallup, Inc. All rights reserved. The content is used with permission; however, Gallup retains all rights of republication.
Values in Action Institute and Inventory of Strengths
At the same time the StrengthsFinder profile was gaining prominence, researchers at the Values in Action (VIA) Institute, led by Martin Seligman and Christopher Peterson, were engaged in a project to develop a framework for the field of positive psychology that defined and conceptualized character strengths. This classification focused on what is best in people rather than their weaknesses and problems. To develop the classification, they reviewed philosophical and spiritual literature in Confucianism, Buddhism, Hinduism, Judeo-Christianity, Ancient Greece, and Islam to determine whether there were commonalities that consistently emerged across cultures regarding virtues (Peterson & Park, 2009; Peterson & Seligman, 2004). From the review, they identified six universal core virtues: courage, justice, humanity, temperance, transcendence, and wisdom. These six virtues represent the basic structure around which Seligman and Peterson developed the Values in Action Classification of Character Strengths (see Table 3.3). The VIA Classification includes 24 strengths organized under these six basic virtues.
As illustrated in Table 3.3, the 24 character strengths identified in the VIA Classification are somewhat different from the strengths identified in Gallup’s StrengthsFinder profile
109
(see Table 3.1). For example, “justice” and “love,” which are strengths in the VIA Classification, seem more encompassing and virtue oriented than “connectedness” and “ideation,” which are strengths identified in the Gallup list. Furthermore, the strengths outlined by the StrengthsFinder are more closely tied to the workplace and helping individuals perform better, while VIA strengths are focused more directly on a person’s character and how one can become more virtuous.
Table 3.3 VIA Classification of Character Strengths Table 3.3 VIA Classification of Character Strengths
Classification Strengths
WISDOM & KNOWLEDGE
Cognitive Strengths
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Creativity
Curiosity
Open-mindedness
Love of learning
Perspective
COURAGE
Emotional Strengths
6.
7.
8.
9.
Authenticity
Bravery
Perseverance
Zest
HUMANITY
Interpersonal Strengths
10.
11.
12.
Kindness
Love
Social intelligence
JUSTICE
Civic Strengths
13.
14.
15.
Fairness
Leadership
Teamwork
16. Forgiveness
110
TEMPERANCE
Strengths Over Excess
17.
18.
19.
Modesty
Prudence
Self-regulation
TRANSCENDENCE
Strengths About Meaning
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
Appreciation of beauty and excellence
Gratitude
Hope
Humor
Religiousness Source: Adapted from A Primer in Positive Psychology, by Christopher Peterson, 2006, pp. 142–146.
Values in Action
From the VIA perspective, character strengths are measured with the Values in Action Inventory of Strengths (VIA-IS), a questionnaire designed to create a profile of your character strengths. It takes about 30 minutes to complete and is available free at www.viacharacter.org. After completing the questionnaire, you will receive reports and feedback identifying your top five character strengths as well as a rank order of your scores on all 24 character strengths.
Centre of Applied Positive Psychology and the R2 Strengths Profiler Assessment
Based on the principles of positive psychology, researchers at the Centre of Applied Positive Psychology (CAPP) in the United Kingdom developed an approach to strengths that differs from the approaches used in Gallup’s StrengthsFinder and the Values in Action perspectives. Rather than focusing exclusively on the identification of a specific number of strengths, CAPP researchers created a more dynamic model of strengths that emphasizes the changing nature of strengths (see Figure 3.2). They also examined different kinds of strengths and weaknesses. CAPP argued that strengths are more fluid than personality traits and can emerge over a lifetime through the different situations we experience.
From CAPP’s perspective, strengths were conceptualized as “the things that we are good at and that give us energy when we are using them” (Linley & Dovey, 2012, p. 4). The three
111
central elements of this definition became the criteria in CAPP’s questionnaire (R2 Strengths Profiler) for assessing strengths: (1) performance—how good we are at doing something; (2) energy—how much vitality we get out of it; and (3) use—how often we are able to do it. Therefore, the R2 Strengths Profiler assesses 60 strengths in relation to three dimensions of energy, performance, and use. Based on an individual’s combined scores across these dimensions, CAPP provides feedback that specifies the individual’s realized strengths, unrealized strengths, learned behaviors, and weaknesses. It takes about 20 minutes to complete the R2 Strengths Profiler, which is available for a fee at www.cappeu.com.
The CAPP strengths perspective is represented in the R2 Strengths Profiler Quadrant Model (see Figure 3.2). It is divided into quadrants labeled realized strengths, unrealized strengths, learned behaviors, and weaknesses. As you can see in Figure 3.2, each quadrant lists attributes based on the dimensions of performance, energy generation, and use. Each quadrant characterizes different individual attributes and how they can be put into use.
Realized Strengths. Realized strengths are personal attributes that represent our strongest assets. We are energized when we use them because they help us perform well. For example, one of Rachel’s strengths is narrator. She is a wonderful storyteller and uses these stories to convey her message and express her values. The model suggests that people should make every effort to maximize the use of these realized strengths, when it is appropriate to do so.
Unrealized Strengths. Unrealized strengths are personal attributes that are less visible. We feel good when we tap into unrealized strengths because they support our efforts and help us achieve our goals. One of Jason’s unrealized strengths is creativity. He is good at coming up with new ideas and concepts, but more often than not he just goes with the flow and does not express his creativity. The model challenges individuals to become more aware of these strengths and to use them more frequently—thus to marshal them as a resource.
Figure 3.2 R2 Strengths Profiler 4M Model
112
Source: Centre of Applied Positive Psychology (CAPP), Coventry, UK: CAPP Press.
Learned Behaviors. Learned behaviors represent those ingrained things we have learned throughout our life experience. Although valuable, they do not excite or inspire us. For example, one of Sunil’s learned behaviors is driver. As the eldest of five, he was driven to graduate from college. Highly self-motivated, Sunil constantly pushes himself to succeed in everything he does, often to the detriment of his own health. Many times Sunil doesn’t recognize when his goals are unrealistic, and not succeeding in these leads to feelings of self- doubt and worthlessness. The model suggests limiting, or moderating, the use of these behaviors because they are draining and do not energize us.
Weaknesses. Weaknesses are our limiting attributes. They often drain our energy and result in poor performance. One of Kaylee’s weaknesses is unconditionality. She finds it hard to genuinely accept people for who they are, without being judgmental about them and expecting them to change to meet her ideals. As a leader, she is constantly frustrated by others because they don’t meet her standards in a number of areas. The model suggests that effective people try to minimize their weaknesses so as to make them irrelevant or of less concern.
Unlike the previous approaches to strengths, the CAPP model is prescriptive and pragmatic. The R2 Strengths Profiler suggests ways people can be more effective by increasing their strengths and minimizing their weaknesses. The model recommends that individuals use their realized strengths when possible, but also intentionally look for ways to increase use of their unrealized strengths. Stated another way, we should capitalize on our
113
strengths but also seek out ways to express our unrealized strengths. In addition, the model recommends that we try to moderate our use of learned behaviors and minimize our use of our weaknesses. We are energized by our strengths (the top two quadrants), and we lose energy when we express our weaknesses and learned behavior (the bottom two quadrants).
A good example of using the CAPP model is Tamaria, who has recently taken on the role of project manager for a team that is developing a new website for her company. Tamaria’s realized strength is her focus on details and organization; her weakness is that she isn’t as technically skilled as some of the members of her team. As a child, Tamaria struggled in school, and one of her coping mechanisms was to ask a lot of questions so that she thoroughly understood assignments. That has become a learned behavior she still employs. Finally, one of Tamaria’s unrealized strengths is her ability to problem-solve and mediate in conflict.
In order for her team to succeed, Tamaria will need to maximize the use of her realized strengths of organization and attention to detail in outlining the tasks and deadlines for the project. To deal with her weakness in technical skills, she will need to minimize her involvement in the technical development of the website, relying on other team members’ technical skills. By employing her learned behavior of asking her team members a lot of questions about what they are doing and why, Tamaria will slow down the team’s progress and frustrate team members who may feel she’s micromanaging them. In this case, she will need to moderate her inquisitiveness, identifying the questions that she really needs answered or finding a way to research the questions on her own. Finally, working within a team can result in disparate opinions and ideas, and Tamaria will need to marshal her unrealized strength in the mediation and problem solving so the team works smoothly together and meets deadlines while creating a dynamic website.
To summarize, researchers have developed three unique assessment tools to identify strengths: (1) StrengthsFinder, (2) Values in Action Inventory of Strengths, and (3) R2 Strengths Profiler (see Table 3.4). Each of these assessments provides a unique approach to strengths, and together they help to define and clarify the meaning of strengths. All of the questionnaires are accessible online, and they are worthwhile self-assessment tools for identifying and exploring your personal strengths.
114
Strengths-Based Leadership in Practice
How are strengths used in leadership? Although there are no established leadership theories on how to practice leadership from a strengths perspective, many useful applications can be made from strengths research in everyday leadership situations. In this section, we discuss several specific ways to incorporate strengths in your personal and work settings. The steps include (1) discovering your strengths, (2) developing your strengths, (3) recognizing and engaging the strengths of others, and (4) fostering a positive strengths-based environment around you. Following these steps will not be a panacea for becoming a perfect strengths- based leader, but they will most certainly help you, as a leader, to maximize the use of your strengths as well as those of others.
Using Strengths in a Pharmacy
115
Discovering Your Strengths
As we discussed earlier in this chapter, strengths emerge from our basic personality traits. We all have unique personality traits, and therefore we all have unique strengths. No one is without strengths. As suggested by psychologist Howard Gardner (1997), extraordinary individuals are “distinguished less by their impressive ‘raw power’ than by their ability to identify their strengths and then exploit them” (p. 15). MacKie (2016) suggests that our leadership capability is enhanced when we are able to discover our fully utilized strengths, underutilized strengths, and weaknesses. The challenge we face is identifying our strengths and then employing them effectively in our leadership and personal lives.
Table 3.4 Approaches to Identifying Strengths Table 3.4 Approaches to Identifying Strengths
Approach Purpose Number of Strengths
Strengths of Competence
Gallup
To identify traits/strengths of peak performers
24
Strengths of Character
Values in Action (VIA-IS)
To identify virtuous/moral character strengths
36
Strengths Fully Realized
CAPP R2 Strengths Profiler
To identify strengths and weaknesses to improve performance
60+
Discovering your strengths requires you to concentrate on your positive attributes and those times when you feel inspirited. To do so, you need to pay attention to your successes rather than focusing on your weaknesses or failures. For example, when are you at the top of your game? What is it about you or your interactions with others that contributes to that feeling? What accounts for your best performance? When things are going really well for you, what attributes are behind this success? Answering these questions will help you discover your strengths. They are the first and most important step in practicing strengths-
116
based leadership.
Discovering Strengths
There are several ways you can discover your strengths. First, you can complete one or more of the strengths questionnaires (e.g., StrengthsFinder 2.0, VIA-IS, and R2 Strengths Profiler) that are available online. Each questionnaire gives a unique snapshot of your greatest strengths. Second, you can fill out the Leadership Strengths Questionnaire that appears in this chapter. This questionnaire will provide you with specific feedback regarding your relative strengths in the areas of implementation, innovation, encouragement, analysis, and mediation. Third, you can complete the Reflected Best Self Exercise (RBSE) (Quinn, Dutton, & Spreitzer, 2003), which can be found at http://positiveorgs.bus.umich.edu/cpo-tools/reflected-best-self-exercise-2nd-edition/. The RBSE can assist you in identifying unrecognized and unexplored area of strengths (Roberts et al., 2005). Fourth, you can complete the “discovering your strengths” exercise that appears at the end of this chapter in Reflection and Action Worksheet 3.4. This exercise allows people you know to tell you what they see as your strengths when you are performing at your best. It is a powerful exercise you can use to become more aware of your strengths, and it may help you learn about some you have not recognized. Fifth, you can engage in a self-assessment of what you believe to be your strongest attributes. Intuitively, we all have a sense of what we do well, but taking the time to intentionally contemplate and consider our own strengths leads us to become more fully aware of our strengths.
This myriad of methods for discovering strengths will allow you to painlessly develop a definitive list of your major strengths. This process is not only enlightening but is also a vital first step in developing strengths-based leadership.
117
Developing Your Strengths
Once you have discovered your strengths, what do you do with that knowledge? How do you make use of this information to be a stronger leader? Developing one’s strengths is a multifaceted process that involves several steps. First, you must acknowledge your strengths and be prepared to reveal them to others. As we discussed at the beginning of this chapter, it is often difficult to share our strengths with others because we may feel inhibited about openly and verbally acknowledging positive aspects of ourselves. But expressing our strengths is essential to making others aware of our leadership.
Telling others about our strengths is important because it lets them know how we can be most useful when working or collaborating together, clarifying the unique contributions we can make to others and their work. In essence, disclosing strengths declares “this is what I bring to the table, this is what I am best at, this is what I can do for you,” and that allows others to know what they can expect from us. For example, when Tanya lets others know that her strongest quality is that she is an achiever, others learn that Tanya is not likely to allow mediocrity in their work. She is going to be demanding and push others toward excellence. Similarly, when Jason tells his staff that his strength is listening, his staff learns that Jason will have an open door and be willing to hear their problems or concerns. Putting our strengths out in the open makes us more transparent to others, and this helps others predict how we are going to act and how they might want to act toward us.
Developing Strengths
People use a variety of ways to reveal their strengths. Some people post their top five strengths on Facebook or LinkedIn, add them to their email signature, or list them on their résumé as a way of making their strengths more visible to others. Several unique examples of how some people share their strengths are illustrated in Figure 3.3. Disclosing our strengths to others does not need to be a daunting or embarrassing task, but can be done in a fairly simple, straightforward manner.
Expressing strengths has a cultural element to it as well. What one culture may see as a strength that should be revealed, another may see as something to be kept hidden. For example, many Western cultures encourage women to recognize and celebrate their intelligence. In some cultures, such as those in religiously conservative, patriarchal societies of the Middle East, women expressing intelligence is not seen as a strength. Many girls are prohibited from attending school.
In addition to revealing your strengths, practice working consistently with others based on
118
your strengths. For example, if your strength is being an innovator, find ways to be creative in your leadership. For example, do not hesitate to engage in activities like brainstorming or creating a vision for your group or organization. Similarly, if your strength is that you are deliberative, place yourself in a position where your strength in providing structure and order to a project can be put to use. Add your well-thought-out perspective by being vigilant and practical when people around you are coming up with ideas that have never been tested. The point is that you should lead from your strengths; your strengths represent the best you have to offer in influencing others. As Anderson (2004) from the Gallup Organization has suggested, “The best of the best invent ways of developing and applying strengths in areas where they want to improve, achieve, and become more effective” (p. 7).
Figure 3.3 Examples of Ways to Express Strengths
A good example of practicing strengths is Warren Buffett, one of the wealthiest people in the world. Buffett is known for his patience, practicality, and trustfulness, and he used these strengths to make Berkshire Hathaway, a multinational conglomerate, successful (Buckingham & Clifton, 2001). His patience led him to adopt the now famous “20-year perspective” on investing only in companies that he believed would be successful for the long term. His practicality explains how he selected specific companies whose services and products he understood (e.g., American Express). Finally, Buffett’s trustfulness allowed him to select senior managers who were reputable and dependable to run his company. Clearly, Buffett recognized his strengths and carved out a role for himself that allowed him to practice these strengths every day (Buckingham & Clifton, 2001).
119
Addressing Your Weaknesses
Leaders must not only recognize and capitalize on their strengths, but also be able to identify their weaknesses and address them (MacKie, 2016). Harvard leadership professor John P. Kotter states, “Great leadership doesn’t mean running away from reality . . . sharing difficulties can inspire people to take action that will make the situation better” (Blagg & Young, 2001).
While some of the models discussed here advocate minimizing your weaknesses, understanding them can allow you to work to improve them and to recognize situations where your weaknesses can be a liability to your leadership. For example, Lisa owns a small business developing e-commerce websites for companies that sell products online. Her strengths are her structural and process-oriented thinking and technical expertise. She is adept at anticipating and managing the many small details for creating a website that is secure and provides a good user experience. However, Lisa can’t describe what she does in normal “layperson” terms for clients. In her proposals and presentations, she tends to lose clients with her use of technical language and minutiae of detail. In Lisa’s case, it isn’t enough that she minimize her weakness—she can’t not talk to clients because that’s how she generates new business. She must find a way to communicate better with her clients.
Leadership Snapshot: Steve Jobs, Founder, Apple Inc.
120
© Bloomberg/Contributor/Bloomberg/Getty Images
While Steve Jobs was undoubtedly brilliant, he didn’t possess the technical abilities to be a computer genius. In fact, Jobs didn’t know how to write computer code or program a computer. But he succeeded—twice— in building one of the most successful and profitable computer companies in the world.
Jobs had many notable strengths, including his creativity, team building, strategic vision, and influencing. He had intuitive vision, imagining products and applications of which no one else dared to dream. When he created Apple in 1976 with partner Steve Wozniak, he sought to create an attractive, simple, inexpensive computer marketed as the first home computer. Jobs micromanaged every detail of the computer’s creation from its unique operating software to the color of its casing.
Jobs was an influencer, using his indomitable will and charisma to convince himself and others of almost anything. He believed rules were meant to be broken, and in 1984, Apple did just that, introducing a truly revolutionary product, the Macintosh. It used graphics, icons, a mouse, and the point-and-click technology that is still standard. It was innovative and influential.
But Jobs wasn’t perfect. He could be confrontational, and this quality eventually resulted in him being booted out of his own company by Apple’s board of directors.
121
Jobs moved on, using his visionary skills and passion for perfection to create NeXT Computer, recognized as a great product that never caught on with consumers.
Undaunted, Jobs branched out into movie animation by acquiring Pixar Animation Studios, bringing his vision, passion, and influencing skills to a new industry. Under his leadership, Pixar revolutionized movie animation and made Jobs a multibillionaire.
His old company, Apple, hadn’t done so well. A decade after Jobs exited, Apple was nearly bankrupt. It decided to buy NeXT Computer and the services of Jobs as a consultant. But he would soon take over as CEO. His first move was to employ another of his strengths—focus. He took the two-dozen products Apple was producing—printers, computers, and software—and winnowed them down to only laptop and desktop computers for the professional and home consumer.
Jobs didn’t stop there. Over the next 14 years, he dreamt up the iPod, the iPad, and the iPhone. By combining creativity, technology, and feats of engineering, Apple produced new devices that consumers hadn’t even thought of or knew they needed. Jobs insisted these devices be intuitive and simple to use and oversaw every detail of design from creating specialized glass for the screens to the width of their metal casings.
In the end, Jobs’s vision revolutionized seven industries: personal computers, animated movies, music, telephones, tablet computing, digital publishing, and retail stores. When he returned to Apple in 1997, he personally created the company’s new ad campaign—“Think Different”—which was as much a statement of his own strengths as a leader as it was a mission statement for Apple.
After losing out on several possible projects, Lisa listened to the feedback of the clients when they said that what she was proposing was “too complicated.” Lisa brought in a marketing professional, Julie, to help her develop and pitch proposals to clients. Julie understands enough of the technical parts of Lisa’s work to be able to put it in easier-to- understand terms for potential clients. Julie is very strong in communication and social interactions, and Lisa is finding that by observing and working with Julie, she is learning to communicate more effectively with clients.
While making the most of our strengths is important for leaders, recognizing our weaknesses is also important in effective leadership. In the case of Lisa, she had to address her communication problems; there was no way around it. Working to improve on your weaknesses or using them as opportunities for others to contribute their strengths will improve your leadership.
122
Recognizing and Engaging the Strengths of Others
In addition to employing their own strengths, leaders need to recognize and engage the strengths of their followers. They need to determine what followers are good at doing and help them to do it. Educators who study group dynamics and the roles individuals play in effective groups often say “people do what they do best.” What they mean by this is that individuals often become engaged and contribute positively to groups when they are allowed to do what they are good at and feel comfortable doing. People feel comfortable in groups when they can contribute to the group from their strengths.
How do leaders know what people are good at? Sometimes people are very up front and freely express their strengths. Mia, for example, often says when she joins a new work project, “I’m a good note taker, so you can plan on me to be the record keeper for our meetings.” Similarly, Josh often says on the first day of a roofing project, “I am pretty fast with the nail gun, so you might want me on the roof nailing shingles.” Clearly, sometimes followers openly inform leaders of their strengths. When this occurs, it is important for leaders to acknowledge these individuals’ strengths if possible and assign them to roles in the work setting that capitalize on these strengths.
While recognizing strengths sounds simple, it is not uncommon for leaders to overlook followers’ strengths. Oftentimes, the strengths of followers are not evident to leaders or even to the followers themselves. This becomes a challenging situation, because leaders need to ascertain followers’ strengths from what they observe rather than what followers explicitly express to them. Cordelia was a struggling graduate student who was just plodding along, uncertain about her direction and goals. When she received an A++ on a challenging reaction paper, she became excited and was surprised to learn that her strength was creativity, particularly in writing. Cordelia and her instructor both became aware of her strengths in writing by the work she did on her assignment. Juan is good with solving computer glitches in the office, suggesting his strengths lie in the area of technology. When he was assisting a staff member who was having a problem downloading a file from the web, he found that he liked the challenge of solving these problems. Or consider Ashley, who is a good worker, always present, and never oppositional. She is a wonderful team member whose strengths are consistency, kindness, and being fun-loving. She fosters the esprit de corps in the athletic center where she works. In each of these examples, an effective leader tries to identify the followers’ strengths and then incorporate them into building a more productive team.
However, it is important to note that others’ strengths may not always be directly recognizable. Followers may have strengths that are not observable because their situations don’t allow for many facets of their overall abilities to emerge. Therefore, it is important to find opportunities outside followers’ normal realm of duties or activities that will allow
123
their strengths to emerge. For example, Jeff works on an assembly line at a golf cart manufacturer attaching seats to the chassis of golf carts. The position is very repetitive and structured, and Jeff, like the other assembly line employees, spends most of his workday at his station with limited interaction with other workers. However, with the blessing of his supervisor, Jeff recently organized a softball team made up of other plant workers to play in a local league. Jeff has recruited team members, arranged all the practices, communicated practice and game schedules to the team, organized the purchase of team uniforms, and promoted the team’s games in the plant through flyers and the company newsletter. As a result, many individuals who work with Jeff have observed his strengths in organization, inclusion, and communication, which would not be observable through his day-to-day work on the assembly line.
As we discussed earlier in this chapter, high-performing teams and work groups possess strengths in four domains: executing, influencing, relationship building, and strategic thinking (see Table 3.2). When leaders become aware of their followers’ strengths as well as their own, they can use this information to design work groups that have individuals with strengths representing each of the domains. Knowing followers’ unique strengths allows leaders to make work assignments that maximize each individual’s contribution to the collective goals of the group (Rath & Conchie, 2008). If a leader is strong on executing and knows how to make new ideas come to fruition, but is not as strong in building relationships, the leader should identify followers with strengths in that area. Or if a leader has strengths in connecting with people and taking command, the leader can identify others who are strong in executing and strategic thinking. Knowledge of followers’ strengths is a valuable tool to help leaders to build effective groups.
Leadership and Followership
124
Fostering a Positive Strengths-Based Environment
A final way to practice strengths-based leadership is to create and promote a positive work environment in which people’s strengths play an integral role. Multiple studies by researchers in positive organizational scholarship indicate that companies and organizations that create positive work environments have a positive physiological impact on employees and, in turn, this has an advantageous impact on their performance (Cameron, 2012; Dutton & Ragins, 2007). Similarly, research suggests that when employees have the opportunity to engage their strengths, they are more productive and more loyal, and their companies experience less turnover (Clifton & Harter, 2003). In short, people feel better and work better when the climate in which they work is positive.
In his book Positive Leadership, Cameron (2012) argues that leaders who want to create a positive work environment should attend to four areas: climate, relationships, communication, and meaning. To create a positive climate, leaders should foster among their employees virtues such as compassion, forgiveness, and gratitude. When these qualities are present, people feel encouraged and are more productive. Leaders can also promote celebrating people’s strengths. Doing so helps people feel valued as individuals and respected for their contribution to the organization. To build positive relationships, leaders need to highlight individuals’ positive images and strengths rather than their negative images and weaknesses. Acknowledging and building on people’s strengths encourages others to do the same, and this results in the development of an environment where positive relationships flourish. To develop positive communication, leaders must be supportive, make more positive than negative statements, and be less negatively evaluative of others. Positive communication helps people feel connected and encourages them to capitalize on their strengths. Finally, leaders can foster positive meaning in their organizations by emphasizing the connection between employees’ values and the long-term impact of their work. Employees who find meaning in their work and see it as valuable are more engaged and productive.
A Positive Climate
Fostering a positive strengths-based organizational environment is embraced by a multitude of organizations. For example, more than 500 colleges and universities have integrated dimensions of a strengths-based perspective into their student learning, faculty, and culture, including Baylor University, Texas A&M University, Azusa Pacific University, University of Arkansas, Texas Tech University, San Jose State University, and University of Minnesota. Among the many companies that have adopted strengths as a systematic
125
program are Fortune 500 companies Pfizer, Hilton, Facebook, Chick-fil-A, Coca-Cola, Cisco, Microsoft, and Best Buy.
126
Summary
Strengths-based leadership has been given much attention in recent years because researchers believe it can have a significant impact on the way leaders choose to lead and on the performance of followers. In this chapter, we explored people’s strengths and how leaders can make use of these strengths to become more effective leaders. Although we all have strengths, they often go unrecognized and unused. Understanding strengths can make one a better leader.
A strength is defined as an attribute or quality of an individual that accounts for successful performance. In simple terms, a strength is what we do when we are performing at our best. Strengths often begin with our inborn talents and can be further developed through knowledge, skills, and practice. The equation for developing a strength is talent times investment (Rath, 2007).
Strengths-based leadership has come to the forefront in recent years as a result of two research developments. First, spearheaded by Donald O. Clifton, the Gallup Organization interviewed millions of people about their strengths and what made them good at what they did. From interviews, Gallup extracted 34 themes that best explained excellent performance. Second, academic scholars created a new field called positive psychology that focused less on the disease model and more on the study of healthy people and what accounted for their well-being. Prominent in this new field is the study of people’s positive characteristics—their strengths. Taken together, research at Gallup and in positive psychology explains the rising popularity of strengths-based leadership.
People’s strengths have been measured in different ways. The benchmark is Gallup’s StrengthsFinder, which is a 177-item questionnaire that identifies an individual’s five strongest talents across four domains (i.e., executing, influencing, relationship building, and strategic thinking). Strengths can also be measured using the Values in Action Inventory of Strengths, which provides an individual’s top five character strengths as well as a rank order of his or her scores on 24 virtue-derived character strengths. A third measure, the R2 Strengths Profiler, assesses 60 strengths in relationship to an individual’s energy, performance, and use, and provides feedback on an individual’s realized strengths, unrealized strengths, learned behaviors, and weaknesses.
Although there are no established theories about the practice of strengths-based leadership, there are several straightforward ways for individuals to incorporate strengths into their leadership. First, leaders need to discover their own strengths. They can do this through completing questionnaires and other self-assessment activities. The goal is to develop a definitive list of one’s strengths. Second, leaders need to be prepared to acknowledge their strengths and reveal them to others. Although we may feel inhibited about disclosing our strengths to others, it is essential for making others aware of our capabilities. We need to
127
make ourselves transparent to others and lead from our strengths. Third, leaders must make a concerted effort to recognize and engage the strengths of others. Because “people do what they do best,” leaders have an obligation to help uncover others’ strengths and then integrate these strengths into building more productive teams. Finally, leaders can practice strengths-based leadership by fostering work environments in which people’s strengths play an integral role. Leaders can do this by creating for their followers a positive climate, positive relationships, positive communication, and positive meaning (Cameron, 2012). Research shows that people feel better and work better when the climate in which they work is positive.
To summarize, strengths-based leadership is a new area of research that offers a unique approach to becoming a more effective leader. Not a panacea, strengths concepts provide an innovative and valuable perspective to add to our leadership toolbox.
128
Glossary Terms
Gallup Organization 49 learned behaviors 56 positive psychology 50 realized strengths 55 strengths 48 themes of human talent 51 unrealized strengths 55 weaknesses 56
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
129
3.1 Case Study: Ready to Be CEO? Christine Jorgens was shocked when the board of Begin the Future Foundation, the nonprofit organization she worked for, asked her to apply for the position of CEO of the organization. For 40 years, Begin the Future Foundation had provided programs in a nine-county region to help children living in poverty in urban and rural areas succeed in school and life, and the CEO’s job was a big one.
Christine had never aspired to be a CEO. She had grown up on a small farm in a rural area, one of seven children in a family that struggled financially. In high school, she worked at a local restaurant, first as a dishwasher and then as a waitress, continuing to work there while she attended college studying social work.
In her senior year of college, she landed an internship at Begin the Future Foundation overseeing an after- school program for middle school students. Christine ended up working for Begin the Future Foundation for 12 more years, with many of her colleagues joking that she was “the intern who never left.” Friendly and approachable, she eagerly took on whatever work the organization had for her to do. She worked as a receptionist, became a grant writer, helped out in public relations and marketing, and then was given a position developing and initiating new programs and working with donors to fund those programs.
She thrived at program development, finding ways to implement community resources that were often overlooked. Her program, Study Buddies, paired up volunteer tutors from a local college with children to meet three times a week for a half-hour of tutoring followed by a half-hour of recreation and games. Christine also initiated Girl Power, a program allowing middle school girls to spend an afternoon each week shadowing a local female professional or businesswoman who worked in a career that they were interested in pursuing.
Christine’s enthusiasm was contagious, especially with donors. Her programs were all successfully funded, and potential donors often approached Christine with ideas they had for new initiatives that they were willing to fund.
But despite all her successes, Christine wasn’t sure she was CEO material. She saw herself as a local girl who had lucked into some great opportunities. The board had been clear about what credentials a new CEO must have: strategic thinking, experience running a nonprofit organization, ability to work with people on all levels of society from the poorest to the richest, ability to manage people, and a commitment to the organization’s mission of helping kids escape poverty. Christine didn’t have direct experience overseeing a nonprofit and felt she needed more experience in the day-to-day management of the organization.
At the suggestion of the board members, she took a strengths assessment and learned her strengths were in strategic planning, relationship building, creativity, compassion, and influencing. In addition, the board members pointed out that she had a deep knowledge and commitment to the organization and the children they served. Despite Christine’s hesitancy, the board was convinced Christine was the right candidate.
130
Questions 1. Strengths are considered inborn traits that can be enhanced with experience. What experiences in
Christine’s background helped her develop her strengths? 2. Of the strengths identified by the assessment, which were directly observable in Christine’s work?
Were there any that were not? 3. Christine admitted having some weaknesses, especially in day-to-day management of the
organization. Which of her strengths could she put into use to help her deal with that, and how? 4. What strengths should Christine seek from others that would complement her own and fill some
gaps?
131
3.2 Leadership Strengths Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of your leadership strengths 2. To rank your strengths in selected areas of performance
Directions
1. Please answer the statements below in terms of whether the statement describes what you are like. 2. For each of the statements, circle the number that indicates the degree to which you feel the
statement is like you.
Statements Very Much Unlike Me
UnlikeMe Neutral LikeMe
Very Much Like Me
1. I am an energetic participant when working with others.
1 2 3 4 5
2. Brainstorming is one of my strengths. 1 2 3 4 5
3. I am good at encouraging coworkers when they feel frustrated about their work.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I want to know “why” we are doing what we are doing.
1 2 3 4 5
5. I look for common ground in opposing opinions of others.
1 2 3 4 5
6. I enjoy implementing the details of projects.
1 2 3 4 5
7. I like to explore creative approaches to problems.
1 2 3 4 5
8. I go out of my way to help others feel good about their accomplishments.
1 2 3 4 5
9. Examining complex problems or issues is one of my strengths.
1 2 3 4 5
10. I am a mediator in conflict situations.
1 2 3 4 5
11. I stick with the task until the work is
132
completed. 1 2 3 4 5
12. I can initiate change, if it is needed, when working with others.
1 2 3 4 5
13. I show concern for the personal well- being of others.
1 2 3 4 5
14. I like to consider various options for doing things.
1 2 3 4 5
15. I am effective communicating with people who are inflexible.
1 2 3 4 5
16. I try to follow through with ideas so that the work gets done.
1 2 3 4 5
17. I enjoy creating a vision for a work- related project.
1 2 3 4 5
18. I am the “glue” that helps hold the group together.
1 2 3 4 5
19. I like exploring the details of a problem before trying to solve it.
1 2 3 4 5
20. I can draw the best out of people with diverse opinions.
1 2 3 4 5
21. I like making to-do lists so that the work gets completed.
1 2 3 4 5
22. I can “think outside of the box.” 1 2 3 4 5
23. Encouraging others comes easily for me.
1 2 3 4 5
24. I like thinking things through before engaging in work projects.
1 2 3 4 5
25. I am good at finding common ground when a conflict is present.
1 2 3 4 5
26. I enjoy scheduling and coordinating activities so the work is completed.
1 2 3 4 5
27. I am good at developing new ideas for others to consider.
1 2 3 4 5
28. I am good at encouraging others to participate on projects.
1 2 3 4 5
133
29. I like to explore problems from many different perspectives.
1 2 3 4 5
30. I am effective at helping coworkers reach consensus.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the responses on items 1, 6, 11, 16, 21, and 26 (implementer score). 2. Sum the responses on items 2, 7, 12, 17, 22, and 27 (innovator score). 3. Sum the responses on items 3, 8, 13, 18, 23, and 28 (encourager score). 4. Sum the responses on items 4, 9, 14, 19, 24, and 29 (analytic score). 5. Sum the responses on items 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, and 30 (mediator score).
Total Scores: _________ _________ _________ _________ ___________
Implementer Innovator Encourager Analytic Mediator
Scoring Interpretation
The Leadership Strengths Questionnaire is designed to measure your strengths in the areas of implementation, innovation, encouragement, analysis, and mediation. By assessing the rank order of your scores, you can determine the areas in which you have the greatest strengths and the areas in which you are weaker. A high score in a certain area indicates where you are strong; a low score shows where you are weak. As discussed in this chapter, every person has multiple strengths. In addition to the strengths revealed by the Leadership Strengths Questionnaire, you may wish to complete other strengths assessments to obtain a more complete picture of all of your strengths.
If your score is 26–30, you are in the very high range. If your score is 21–25, you are in the high range. If your score is 16–20, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 11–15, you are in the low range. If your score is 6–10, you are in the very low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
134
3.3 Observational Exercise
135
Strengths
Purpose
1. To learn to recognize people’s strengths 2. To gain an understanding of the role of strengths in the leadership process
Directions
1. In this exercise, your task is to observe a leader in action. The leader can be a teacher, a supervisor, a coach, a manager, or anyone who has a position that involves leadership.
2. Based on your observations of the leader in action, identify areas in which the leader has strengths and areas in which the followers have strengths.
Questions
1. Based on the virtue-based strengths listed in Table 3.3, identify two strengths you observed the leader exhibit. How did these strengths affect his or her followers?
2. Discuss what strengths group members appeared to exhibit and how these strengths may complement or distract from the leader’s leadership.
3. Do you think the followers in this situation would feel comfortable expressing their own strengths to others? Discuss.
4. If you were coaching the leader in this situation, what specific things could she or he do to create a positive environment where the expression of people’s strengths was welcomed?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
136
3.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
137
Strengths
Reflection
1. For this exercise, you are being asked to interview several people you know about your strengths. Instructions:
First, identify three people (e.g., friends, coworkers, colleagues, family members) from whom you feel comfortable asking for feedback about yourself.
Second, ask each of these individuals to do the following: a. Think of a time or situation when they saw you at your best b. Tell a brief story about what you were doing c. Describe why they thought you were performing well in this situation d. Based on this story, describe what unique benefits you offered others in this
situation Third, from the answers the individuals gave, identify two or three recurring themes. These themes represent your strengths.
2. What is your reaction to what others (in Step 1) have identified as your strengths? Are the strengths others identified about you consistent with your own perceptions of your strengths? In what way are they consistent with your scores on the Leadership Strengths Questionnaire?
3. This chapter suggests that it is important for leaders to reveal their strengths to others. As a leader, how do you feel about disclosing your strengths to others? How do you react when others express their strengths to you?
Action
1. Based on the questionnaire in this chapter and your own insights, create a business card for yourself that lists your five signature strengths.
2. Of the four domains of leadership strengths (see Table 3.2), which are your strongest? Describe how you could solicit support from followers to complement these areas of strength.
3. Imagine you are the leader of a classroom group required to do a semester-long service learning project. Identify and discuss specific things you could do to create a positive climate, positive relationships, positive communication, and positive meaning.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
138
References Anderson, E. C. (2004). StrengthsQuest: Curriculum outline and learning activities.
Princeton, NJ: Gallup Organization.
Biswas-Diener, R. (2010). Practicing positive psychology coaching: Assessment, activities, and strategies for success. Hoboken, NJ: John Wiley & Sons.
Blagg, D., & Young, S. (2001, February 1). What makes a good leader. Harvard Business School Alumni Stories. Retrieved from https://www.alumni.hbs.edu/stories/Pages/story- bulletin.aspx?num=3059
Buckingham, M., & Clifton, D. (2001). Now, discover your strengths. New York, NY: Free Press.
Cameron, K. S. (2012). Positive leadership: Strategies for extraordinary performance (2nd ed.). San Francisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
Cameron, K. S., Dutton, J. E., & Quinn, R. E. (2003). Foundations of positive organizational scholarship. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 3–14). San Francisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
Clifton, D. O., & Harter, J. K. (2003). Investing in strengths. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 111–121). San Francisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
Dutton, J. E., & Ragins, B. R. (2007). Exploring positive relationships at work. Mahwah, NJ: Erlbaum.
Fowler, R. D., Seligman, M. E. P., & Kocher, G. P. (1999). The APA 1998 annual report. American Psychologist, 54(8), 537–568.
Fredrickson, B. L. (2001). The role of positive emotions in positive psychology: The broaden-and-build theory of positive emotions. American Psychologist, 56, 218–226.
139
Gardner, H. (1997). Extraordinary minds: Portraits of exceptional individuals and an examination of our extraordinariness. New York, NY: Basic Books.
Kaplan, R. E., & Kaiser, R. B. (2010). Toward a positive psychology for leaders. In P. A. Linley, S. A. Harrington, & N. Garcea (Eds.), Oxford handbook of positive psychology and work (pp. 107–117). Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.
Lewis, S. (2011). Positive psychology at work: How positive leadership and appreciative inquiry create inspiring organizations. Oxford, UK: Wiley-Blackwell.
Linley, A. (2008). Average to A+: Realising strengths in yourself and others. Coventry, UK: CAPP Press.
Linley, A., & Dovey, H. (2012). Technical manual and statistical properties for Realise2. Coventry, UK: CAPP Press.
Luthans, F., & Avolio, B. J. (2002). Authentic leadership development. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 241–258). San Francisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
MacKie, D. (2016). Strength-based leadership coaching in organizations: An evidence- based guide to positive leadership development. London, UK: Kogan Page.
Peterson, C. (2006). A primer in positive psychology. New York, NY: Oxford University Press.
Peterson, C. (2009). Foreword. In S. J. Lopez & C. R. Snyder (Eds.), Oxford handbook of positive psychology (p. xxiii). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.
Peterson, C., & Park, N. (2009). Classifying and measuring strengths of character. In S. J. Lopez & C. R. Snyder (Eds.), Oxford handbook of positive psychology (pp. 25–34). New York, NY: Oxford University Press.
Peterson, C., & Seligman, M. E. P. (2003). Positive organizational studies: Lessons from
140
positive psychology. In K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational scholarship (pp. 14–28). San Francisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
Peterson, C., & Seligman, M. E. P. (2004). Character strengths and virtues: A handbook and classification. New York, NY: Oxford University Press; Washington, DC: American Psychological Association.
Quinn, R. E., Dutton, J., & Spreitzer, G. (2003). Reflected Best Self Exercise: Assignment and instructions to participants (Product number 001B). Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Regents, Positive Organizational Scholarship Research Group.
Rath, T. (2007). Strengths Finder 2.0. New York, NY: Gallup Press.
Rath, T., & Conchie, B. (2008). Strengths based leadership: Great leaders, teams, and why people follow. New York, NY: Gallup Press.
Roberts, L. M., Spreitzer, G., Dutton, J., Quinn, R., Heaphy, E., & Barker, B. (2005, January). How to play to your strengths. Harvard Business Review, pp. 75–80.
Seligman, M. E. P. (2002). Authentic happiness: Using the new positive psychology to realize your potential for lasting fulfillment. New York, NY: Free Press.
Seligman, M. E. P., & Csikszentmihalyi, M. (2000). Positive psychology. American Psychologist, 55(1), 5–14.
141
4 Understanding Philosophy and Styles
142
Introduction
What is your philosophy of leadership? Are you an in-charge type of leader who closely monitors followers? Or are you a laid-back type of leader who gives followers a lot of rein? Whether you are one or the other or somewhere in between, it is important to recognize your personal philosophy of leadership. This philosophy affects how others respond to you, how they respond to their work, and, in the end, how effective you are as a leader.
What Does “Philosophy of Leadership” Mean?
In this chapter, we will discuss how a person’s view of people, work, and human nature forms a personal philosophy of leadership. In addition, this chapter will examine how that philosophy is demonstrated in three of the most commonly observed styles of personal leadership: the authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire styles. We will discuss the nature of these styles and the implications each has for effective leadership performance.
143
Leadership Philosophy Explained
Each of us approaches leadership with a unique set of beliefs and attitudes about the nature of people and the nature of work. This is the basis for our philosophy of leadership. For example, some think people are basically good and will happily work if given the chance. Others think people are prone to be a bit lazy and need to be nudged to complete their work. These beliefs about people and work have a significant impact on an individual’s leadership style and probably come into play in every aspect of a person’s leadership.
Understanding Leadership Philosophy
Do you think people like work, or do you think people find work unpleasant? This was one of the central questions addressed by Douglas McGregor in his famous book The Human Side of Enterprise (1960). McGregor believed that managers need to understand their core assumptions about human nature and assess how these assumptions relate to their managerial practice.
In particular, McGregor was interested in how managers view the motivations of workers and their attitudes toward work. He believed that understanding these motivations was central to knowing how to become an effective manager. To explain the ways that managers approach workers, McGregor proposed two general theories—Theory X and Theory Y. McGregor believed that by exploring the major assumptions of each of these theories people could develop a better understanding of their own viewpoints on human behavior and the relationship of these viewpoints to their leadership style. Below is a description of both theories. As you read, ask yourself if the assumptions of the theory are consistent or inconsistent with your own attitudes and philosophy of leadership.
144
Theory X
Theory X is made up of three assumptions about human nature and human behavior (see Table 4.1). Taken together, these assumptions represent a philosophy of leadership that many leaders exhibit to one degree or another.
Assumption #1. The average person dislikes work and will avoid it if possible.
This assumption argues that people do not like work; they view it as unpleasant, distasteful, or simply a necessary evil. According to this assumption, if given the chance, people would choose not to work. An example of this assumption is the worker who says, “I only go to work to be P-A-I-D. If I didn’t need to pay my bills, I would never work.” People with this philosophy would avoid work if they could.
Table 4.1 Assumptions of McGregor’s Theory X Table 4.1 Assumptions of McGregor’s Theory
X
McGregor’s Theory X
1. People dislike work.
2. People need to be directed and controlled.
3. People want security, not responsibility.
Theory X
Assumption #2. People need to be direct and controlled.
This assumption is derived directly from the first assumption. Since people naturally do not like work, management needs to set up a system of incentives and rewards regarding work that needs to be accomplished because workers are often unwilling or unable to motivate themselves. This assumption says that without external direction and incentives people would be unmotivated to work. An example of this is the high school teacher who persuades students to hand in homework assignments by threatening them with bad grades.
145
The teacher forces students to perform because the teacher thinks that the students are unwilling to do it or incapable of doing it without that force being applied. From the perspective of Theory X, leaders play a significant role in encouraging others to accomplish their work.
Assumption #3. People want security, not responsibility.
The picture this assumption paints is of workers who want their leaders to take care of them, protect them, and make them feel safe. Because it is too difficult to set their own goals, workers want management to do it for them. This can only happen when managers establish the guidelines for workers. An example of this assumption can be observed at a fast-food restaurant where the employees only have to focus on completing the specific tasks set before them (e.g., cleaning the shake machines or making fries) and are not required to take initiative on their own. In general, many fast-food restaurant workers are not required to accept many challenging responsibilities. Instead, they are told what to do, and how and when to do it. Consistent with this assumption, this example highlights how some workers are not ambitious but want job security above everything else.
So what does it mean if a person’s personal leadership style or philosophy is similar to Theory X? It means these leaders have a tendency to view workers as lazy and uninterested in work because they do not value work. As a result, Theory X leaders tend to be directive and controlling. They supervise followers closely and are quick to both praise and criticize them as they see fit. At times, these leaders remind workers of their goal (e.g., to be P-A-I- D) or threaten them with punishment to persuade them to accomplish tasks. As the person in charge, a Theory X leader sees his or her leadership role as instrumental in getting the job done. Theory X leaders also believe it is their role to motivate followers because these workers have little self-motivation. Because of this belief, these leaders take on the responsibility for their followers’ actions. From the Theory X perspective, it is clear that followers have a need for leadership.
146
Theory Y
Like Theory X, Theory Y is based on several specific assumptions about human nature and behavior (see Table 4.2). Taken together, the assumptions of Theory Y present a distinctly different perspective from the ideas set forth in Theory X. It is a perspective that can be observed to a degree in many leaders today.
Theory X and Theory Y
Assumption #1. The average person does not inherently dislike work. Doing work is as natural as play.
Rather than viewing work as a burden or bad, this assumption suggests people see work as satisfying and not as a punishment. It is a natural activity for them. In fact, given the chance, people are happy to work. An example of this can be seen in what former president Jimmy Carter has done in his retirement. He has devoted much of his time and energy to constructing homes throughout the United States and around the world with Habitat for Humanity. Certainly, the former president does not need to work: He does so because work is natural for him. All his life, Carter has been used to making a contribution to the well-being of others. Working with Habitat for Humanity is another opportunity for him to contribute. Some people view work as a natural part of their lives.
Assumption #2. People will show responsibility and self- control toward goals to which they are committed.
As opposed to Theory X, which suggests that people need to be supervised and controlled, Theory Y suggests that people can and will make a conscious choice to work on their own.
Table 4.2 Assumptions of McGregor’s Theory Y Table 4.2 Assumptions of McGregor’s
Theory Y
McGregor’s Theory Y
1. People like work.
147
2. People are self-motivated.
3. People accept and seek responsibility.
People can be committed to the objectives of their work. Consider some examples from the sports world. Successful athletes are often highly committed to their goals and usually do not need to be controlled or supervised closely. Coaches design training plans for these athletes, but the athletes do the work themselves. A successful long-distance runner does not need to be pushed to run 60 training miles a week in preparation for a marathon because the runner is already motivated to run long distances. Similarly, an Olympic swimmer does not need to be forced to do daily 3-mile pool workouts at 5:00 A.M. because the swimmer chooses to do this independently of any coach’s urging. These athletes are self-directed because they are committed to their goals. This is the point of Theory Y. When people can find commitment in their work, they will work without needing leaders to motivate or cajole them. Put another way, when people have a passion for their work, they will do it even without outside direction.
Assumption #3. In the proper environment, the average person learns to accept and seek responsibility.
While Theory X argues that people lack ambition, prefer to be directed, and want security, Theory Y assumes that the average person is inherently resourceful and, if given the chance, will seek to take responsibility. If given the chance, people have the capacity to engage in a wide range of goal-setting and creative problem-solving activities. Theory Y argues that, given the opportunity, people will act independently and be productive.
For example, two university students working in the main stacks section of the library were required to complete a checklist whenever they worked to be sure that they correctly carried out various sorting and shelving activities. The checklist was long, cumbersome, and repetitious, however. Frustrated by the checklist, the students took it upon themselves to design an entirely new, streamlined checklist. The new checklist for sorting and shelving was very clear and concise, and was playful in appearance. After reviewing the checklist and giving it a short trial period, management at the library adopted the new checklist and required that it be implemented throughout the entire library. In this example, library management provided an environment where students felt comfortable suggesting a rather major change in how their work was to be completed. In addition, management was willing to accept and adopt a student-initiated work change. It is not unrealistic to imagine that these students will be more confident initiating ideas or taking on new challenges in other work settings in the future.
So if a leader’s philosophy of leadership is similar to Theory Y, what does it mean? It means that the leader views people as capable and interested in working. Even though Theory Y
148
leaders may define work requirements, they do not try to control workers. To these leaders, followers are not lazy; on the contrary, they naturally want to work. In addition, these leaders do not think they need to try to motivate followers or make them work since workers are capable of motivating themselves. Using coercion or external reinforcement schemes is not a part of their leadership repertoire. Theory Y leaders are very attuned to helping followers find their passion for what they want to do. These leaders know that when followers are committed to their work, they are more motivated to do the job. Allowing followers to seek and accept responsibilities on their own comes easily for Theory Y leaders. In short, Theory Y leadership means supporting followers without the need to direct or control them.
In the late 1970s and 1980s, a new leadership theory tangentially related to Theory X and Theory Y was developed by William Ouchi (1981). Ouchi contrasted the collectivistic culture of Japanese companies—which had begun to dominate markets, especially in automobiles and electronics—with the individualism stressed in American organizations and developed an approach that was a hybrid of the two called Theory Z. A Theory Z organization is one that emphasizes common cultural values, beliefs, and objectives among its members with a focus on communication, collaboration, and consensual decision making. At the same time, some of the individualistic values of American organizations are also incorporated. Theory Z organizations still maintain formal authority structures and an emphasis on individual contributions and recognizing individual achievements. However, the individual decision making of the leader that is found in both Theory X and Theory Y is not a characteristic of a Theory Z organization.
Leadership in Challenging Times
In summary, all of us maintain certain basic beliefs and assumptions about human nature and work that form our leadership philosophy. The next section discusses how that philosophy impacts your behaviors as a leader, or your leadership style. Whether a person’s philosophy is similar to Theory X or similar to Theory Y, it affects his or her style of leadership. The challenge is to understand the philosophical underpinnings of your own leadership style.
149
Leadership Styles Explained
What behaviors do you exhibit as a leader? Do you like to be in control and keep up on the activities of your followers? Or do you believe in a more hands-off approach in leading others, letting them make decisions on their own?
Whatever your behaviors are as a leader, they are indicative of your leadership style. Leadership style is defined as the behaviors of leaders, focusing on what leaders do and how they act. This includes leaders’ actions toward followers in a variety of contexts. As noted in the previous section, your leadership style is driven by your personal leadership philosophy. In the following section, we discuss the most commonly observed leadership styles associated with Theory X and Theory Y: authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire. While none of these styles emerges directly from Theory X or Theory Y, the authoritarian and democratic styles closely mirror the ideas set forth in these theories, respectively.
Styles of Leaders and Managers
The primary work on styles of leadership was by Lewin, Lippitt, and White (1939), who analyzed the impact of various leadership styles on small group behavior. Using groups of 10-year-old boys who met after school to engage in hobby activities, the researchers analyzed what happened when their adult leaders used one of three styles: authoritarian, democratic, or laissez-faire. The groups of boys experienced each of the three styles of leadership for a six-week period.
The outcome of the study by Lewin and colleagues was a detailed description of the nature of the leadership behaviors used for each of the three styles (White & Lippitt, 1968). They also described the impact each of these three styles had on group members.
The following sections describe and elaborate on their findings and the implications of using each of these leadership styles. Be aware that these styles are not distinct entities (e.g., like personality traits). They overlap each other. That is, a leader can demonstrate more than one style in any given situation. For example, a leader may be authoritarian about some issues and democratic about others, or a leader may be authoritarian at some points during a project and democratic at others. As leaders, we may display aspects of all of these styles.
150
Authoritarian Leadership Style
In many ways, the authoritarian leadership style is very similar to Theory X. For example, authoritarian leaders perceive followers as needing direction. The authoritarian leader needs to control followers and what they do. Authoritarian leaders emphasize that they are in charge, exerting influence and control over group members. They determine tasks and procedures for group members but may remain aloof from participating in group discussions. Authoritarian leaders do not encourage communication among group members; instead, they prefer that communication be directed to them. In evaluating others, authoritarian leaders give praise and criticism freely, but it is given based on their own personal standards rather than based on objective criticism.
Some have argued that authoritarian leadership represents a rather pessimistic, negative, and discouraging view of others. For example, an authoritarian leader might say something like “Because my workers are lazy, I need to tell them what to do.” Others would argue that authoritarian leadership is a much-needed form of leadership—it serves a positive purpose, particularly for people who seek security above responsibility. In many contexts, authoritarian leadership is used to give direction, set goals, and structure work. For example, when employees are just learning a new job, authoritarian leadership lets them know the rules and standards for what they are supposed to do. Authoritarian leaders are very efficient and successful in motivating others to accomplish work. In these contexts, authoritarian leadership is very useful.
The Authoritarian Leadership Style
What are the outcomes of authoritarian leadership? Authoritarian leadership has both pluses and minuses. On the positive side, it is efficient and productive. Authoritarian leaders give direction and clarity to people’s work and accomplish more in a shorter period. Furthermore, authoritarian leadership is useful in establishing goals and work standards. On the negative side, it fosters dependence, submissiveness, and a loss of individuality. The creativity and personal growth of followers may be hindered. It is possible that, over time, followers will lose interest in what they are doing and become dissatisfied with their work. If that occurs, authoritarian leadership can create discontent, hostility, and even aggression.
In addition, authoritarian leadership can become abusive leadership, where these leaders use their influence, power, and control for their personal interests or to coerce followers to engage in unethical or immoral activities. For example, a coach who withholds playing time from athletes who openly disagree with his play calls or a boss who requires salaried
151
employees to work up to 20 hours of overtime each week or “be replaced with someone who will” are both examples of the dark side of authoritarian leadership.
While the negative aspects of authoritarian leadership appear to outweigh the positive, it is not difficult to imagine contexts where authoritarian leadership would be the preferred style of leadership. For example, in a busy hospital emergency room, it may be very appropriate for the leader in charge of triaging patients to be authoritarian with various types of emergencies. The same could be true in other contexts, such as the chaperone of a middle school canoe trip, or the coach of a high school team during the state finals basketball tournament. Despite the negatives of authoritarian leadership, this form of leadership is common and necessary in many situations.
152
Democratic Leadership Style
The democratic leadership style strongly resembles the assumptions of Theory Y. Democratic leaders treat followers as fully capable of doing work on their own. Rather than controlling followers, democratic leaders work with followers, trying hard to treat everyone fairly, without putting themselves above followers. In essence, they see themselves as guides rather than as directors. They give suggestions to others, but never with any intention of changing them. Helping each follower reach personal goals is important to a democratic leader. Democratic leaders do not use “top-down” communication; instead, they speak on the same level as their followers. Making sure everyone is heard is a priority. They listen to followers in supportive ways and assist them in becoming self-directed. In addition, they promote communication between group members and in certain situations are careful to draw out the less-articulate members of the group. Democratic leaders provide information, guidance, and suggestions, but do so without giving orders and without applying pressure. In their evaluations of followers, democratic leaders give objective praise and criticism.
The Democratic Leadership Style
The outcomes of democratic leadership are mostly positive. First, democratic leadership results in greater group member satisfaction, commitment, and cohesiveness. Second, under democratic leadership there is more friendliness, mutual praise, and group mindedness. Followers tend to get along with each other and willingly participate in matters of the group, making more “we” statements and fewer “I” statements. Third, democratic leadership results in stronger worker motivation and greater creativity. People are motivated to pursue their own talents under the supportive structure of democratic leadership. Finally, under a democratic leader group members participate more and are more committed to group decisions. The downside of democratic leadership is that it takes more time and commitment from the leader. Work is accomplished, but not as efficiently as if the leader were authoritarian.
153
Laissez-Faire Leadership Style
The laissez-faire leadership style is dissimilar to both Theory X and Theory Y. Laissez-faire leaders do not try to control followers as Theory X leaders do, and they do not try to nurture and guide followers as Theory Y leaders do. Laissez-faire stands alone as a style of leadership; some have labeled it nonleadership. The laissez-faire leader is a nominal leader who engages in minimal influence. As the French phrase implies, laissez-faire leadership means the leader takes a “hands-off, let it ride” attitude toward followers. These leaders recognize followers but are very laid back and make no attempt to influence their activities. Under laissez-faire leadership, followers have freedom to do pretty much what they want to do whenever they want to do it. Laissez-faire leaders make no attempt to appraise or regulate the progress of followers.
Destructive Laissez-Faire Leadership
Given that laissez-faire leadership involves nominal influence, what are the effects of laissez- faire leadership? Laissez-faire leadership tends to produce primarily negative outcomes. The major effect is that very little is accomplished under a laissez-faire leader. Because people are directionless and at a loss to know what to do, they tend to do nothing. Giving complete freedom results in an atmosphere that most followers find chaotic. Followers prefer some direction; left completely on their own, they become frustrated. Without a sense of purpose and direction, group members have difficulty finding meaning in their work; they become unmotivated and disheartened. As a result, productivity goes down.
The Laissez-Faire Leadership Style
However, there are situations where the laissez-faire style is successful. People who are self- starters, who excel at individualized tasks and don’t require ongoing feedback, may prefer working under laissez-faire leaders.
For example, Angela is the president of a website development company who uses independent contractors from across the globe. In certain respects, you could describe her leadership style as laissez-faire. The programmers who develop the websites’ code are in Poland, the designer is in India, the content writer is in the United Kingdom, and Angela is in the United States. When developing a site, Angela maps out and communicates the basic
154
framework for the website and then relies on all of the individual contractors to determine the tasks they need to do for the site’s development. Because their tasks can be dependent upon another’s—for example, the designer needs the programmers to write the code to make the page display graphics and images in a certain way—they do communicate with one another, but because of time zone differences, this is mostly done by email. As their leader, Angela is kept apprised of issues and developments through an electronic project management system they share, but because all of the contractors are experts at what they do and trust the other team members to do what they do best, she lets them problem-solve issues and concerns with one another and rarely gets involved.
While there are a few situations where laissez-faire leadership is effective, in a majority of situations, it proves to be unsuccessful and unproductive.
Leadership Snapshot: Victoria Ransom, Chief Executive, Wildfire
155
© Bloomberg/Contributor/Bloomberg/Getty Images
“I don’t believe in hierarchy or creating hierarchy. I believe in earning respect.”
That comes from Victoria Ransom, cofounder of social media software company Wildfire Interactive, which grew from an idea to a company with 400 employees and 21,000 clients. The company, which Ransom cofounded with Alain Chuard in 2008, helps companies reach customers over social networks, and was acquired in 2012 by Google for $350 million.
Wildfire’s success is largely due to the leadership style and philosophy of Ransom, who serves as the
156
company’s chief executive. Ransom grew up in Scotts Ferry, a rural village in New Zealand where her father was an asparagus farmer and her mother was an office manager for a farming equipment company. Ransom worked in the fields, and it was there that she learned the values of hard work, leading by example, and humility that she brings to Wildfire.
Wildfire was actually an afterthought, created to solve a problem that Ransom and Chuard had encountered in running the first company they had formed, Access Trips. Access Trips was an adventure travel company that took small groups of travelers, ages 20–45, to remote destinations, and Ransom and Chuard were looking for a way to promote Access Trips online by giving away a trip on Facebook. They discovered, however, that no software existed to do what they wanted, so they developed their own software to design sweepstakes, contests, or other promotions that could run on Facebook.
The software, and Wildfire, was profitable within a year. Clients soon ranged from two-person catering businesses to Sony and Unilever (Coster, 2012).
The company grew very quickly, which put Ransom’s values-based culture to the test.
“I’ve learned as the company grows, you’re only as good as the leaders you have underneath you,” she says. “You might think that because you’re projecting our values, then the rest of the company is experiencing the values. . . . [D]irect supervisors become the most important influence on people in the company. Therefore, a big part of leading becomes your ability to pick and guide the right people” (Bryant, 2013).
In order to find those right people, it was critical that Wildfire spell out its values and company culture to employees from the outset. To do so, Ransom and Chuard identified what they valued in the people at Wildfire and then met with all the employees in small groups to get their feedback on these values. What resulted was a list of values that the company instilled and demonstrated: passion, team player, humility, and integrity. Also on the list were having the courage to speak up and curiosity.
“We really encourage people to constantly question, to stay on top of what’s happening in our industry, to learn what other people in the company are doing. The hope was to break down these walls of ‘them versus us,’” Ransom says (Bryant, 2013).
Ransom says a final value they identified was to “do good, and do right by each other” (Bryant, 2013).
The values a company purports to have, however, are not so readily maintained. Values and culture have to be universally embraced, or they will crumble.
“I think the best way to undermine a company’s values is to put people in leadership positions who are not adhering to the values,” Ransom says, noting that others begin to lose faith in the values. “Until you take action and move those people out, and then everyone gets faith in the values again” (Bryant, 2013).
Ransom says one way the company showed its values was when it would let employees go who didn’t live up to the values. Making these hard decisions about people, even if they were good performers, showed employees that “yeah, this company actually puts its money where its mouth is” (Bryant, 2013).
157
Leadership Styles in Practice
Each leader has a unique style of leadership. Some are very demanding and assertive while others are more open and participative. Similarly, some leaders could be called micromanagers, while others could be labeled nondirective leaders. Whatever the case, it is useful and instructive to characterize your leadership regarding the degree to which you are authoritarian, democratic, or laissez-faire.
Leadership and Collaboration
It is important to note that these styles of leadership are not distinct entities; it is best to think of them as occurring along a continuum, from high leader influence to low leader influence (see Figure 4.1). Leaders who exhibit higher amounts of influence are more authoritarian. Leaders who show a moderate amount of influence are democratic. Those who exhibit little to no influence are laissez-faire. Although we tend to exhibit primarily one style over the others, our personal leadership styles are not fixed and may vary depending on the circumstances.
Figure 4.1 Styles of Leadership
Consider what your results of the Leadership Styles Questionnaire on page 95 tell you about your leadership style. What is your main style? Are you most comfortable with authoritarian, democratic, or laissez-faire leadership? If you are the kind of leader who likes to structure work, likes to lay out the ground rules for others, likes to closely supervise your followers, thinks it is your responsibility to make sure followers do their work, wants to be “in charge” or to know what others are doing, and believes strongly that rewarding and punishing followers is necessary, then you are authoritarian. If you are the kind of leader who seldom gives orders or ultimatums to followers, instead trying to work with followers and help them figure out how they want to approach a task or complete their work, then you are primarily democratic. Helping each follower reach his or her own personal goals is important to a democratic leader.
158
In some rare circumstances, you may find you are showing laissez-faire leadership. Although not a preferred style, it is important to be aware when one is being laissez-faire. Laissez-faire leaders take a very low profile to leadership. What followers accomplish is up to them. If you believe that your followers will thrive on complete freedom, then the laissez-faire style may be the right style for you. However, in most situations, laissez-faire leadership hinders success and productivity.
159
Summary
All of us have a philosophy of leadership that is based on our beliefs about human nature and work. Some leaders have a philosophy that resembles Theory X: They view workers as unmotivated and needing direction and control. Others have a philosophy similar to Theory Y: They approach workers as self-motivated and capable of working independently without strong direct influence from a leader.
Our philosophy of leadership is played out in our style of leadership. There are three commonly observed styles of leadership: authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire. Similar to Theory X, authoritarian leaders perceive followers as needing direction, so they exert strong influence and control. Resembling Theory Y, democratic leaders view followers as capable of self-direction, so they provide counsel and support. Laissez-faire leaders leave followers to function on their own, providing nominal influence and direction.
Effective leadership demands that we understand our philosophy of leadership and how it forms the foundations for our style of leadership. This understanding is the first step to becoming a more informed and competent leader.
160
Glossary Terms
authoritarian leadership style 83 democratic leadership style 85 laissez-faire leadership style 85 leadership style 82 philosophy of leadership 78 Theory X 78 Theory Y 80 Theory Z 82
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
161
4.1 Case Study: Many Managers, Different Styles Vanessa Mills was recently hired to work at a branch of Lakeshore Bank as a personal banker. The branch is very busy and has a large staff, including three on-site managers. As a new employee, Vanessa is trying to figure out how to succeed as a personal banker while meeting the expectations of her three very different managers.
Vanessa is paid a salary, but also receives a commission for activities including opening new accounts and selling new services to customers such as credit cards, lines of credit, loans, and stock accounts. Personal bankers are expected to open a certain number of accounts each month and build relationships with customers by exploring their various banking needs and offering services to meet those needs.
Marion Woods is one of the managers at Vanessa’s branch. She has worked for Lakeshore Bank for 10 years and prides herself on the success of the branch. Marion openly talks about employees’ progress in terms of the number of accounts opened or relationships established, and then commends or scolds people depending on their productivity. Marion stresses to Vanessa the importance of following procedures and using the scripts that Marion provides to successfully convince customers to open new accounts or accept new services with the bank.
As a new banker, Vanessa has not opened many accounts and feels very uncertain about her competence. She is intimidated by Marion, believing that this manager is continually watching and evaluating her. Several times Marion has publically criticized Vanessa, commenting on her shortcomings as a personal banker. Vanessa tries hard to get her sales numbers up so she can keep Marion off her back.
Bruce Dexter, another manager at Vanessa’s branch, has been with Lakeshore Bank for 14 years. Bruce started out as a teller and worked his way up to branch manager. As a manager, Bruce is responsible for holding the bank staff’s Monday morning meetings. At these staff meetings, Bruce relays the current numbers for new accounts as well as the target number for new accounts. He also lists the number of new relationships the personal bankers have established. After the meetings, Bruce retreats back into his office where he sits hidden behind his computer monitor. He rarely interacts with others. Vanessa likes when Bruce retreats into his office because she does not have to worry about having her performance scrutinized. However, sometimes when Vanessa is trying to help customers with a problem that falls outside of her banking knowledge, she is stressed because Bruce does not provide her with any managerial support.
The third manager at the branch is Heather Atwood. Heather just started at Lakeshore Bank within the last year, but worked for nine years at another bank. Vanessa finds Heather to be very helpful. She often pops in when Vanessa is with a customer to introduce herself and make sure everything is going well. Heather also allows Vanessa to listen in when she calls disgruntled customers or customers with complicated requests, so Vanessa can learn how to manage these types of interactions. Heather trusts her staff and enjoys seeing them grow, encouraging them by organizing games to see who can open the most accounts and offering helpful feedback when customer interactions do not go as planned. Vanessa is grateful for the advice and support she receives from Heather, and looks up to her because she is competent and kind.
Vanessa is coming up on her three-month review and is very nervous that she might get fired based on her low sales record and the negative feedback she has received from Bruce and Marion regarding her performance. Vanessa decides to talk to Heather about her upcoming review and what to expect. Heather assures Vanessa that she is doing fine and shows promise even if her numbers have not reached that of a seasoned banker. Still, Vanessa is concerned about Bruce and Marion. She has hardly had more than two conversations with Bruce and feels intimidated by Marion who, she perceives, manages by running around barking numbers at people.
162
Questions 1. Based on the assumptions of Theory X and Theory Y, how would you describe each manager’s
philosophy and style of leadership? In what way do their attitudes about Vanessa affect their leadership?
2. In this type of customer service setting, which leadership style would be most effective for the bank to meet its goals? From the bank’s perspective, which (if any) manager exhibits the most appropriate leadership? Discuss.
3. What advice would you give to each of the managers to enhance their leadership skills within the bank?
4. What do you think Vanessa can do to prepare herself for her three-month review?
163
4.2 Leadership Styles Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your style of leadership 2. To examine how your leadership style relates to other styles of leadership
Directions
1. For each of the statements below, circle the number that indicates the degree to which you agree or disagree.
2. Give your immediate impressions. There are no right or wrong answers.
Statements Strongly disagree
Disagree Neutral Agree Strongly agree
1. Employees need to be supervised closely, or they are not likely to do their work.
1 2 3 4 5
2. Employees want to be a part of the decision-making process.
1 2 3 4 5
3. In complex situations, leaders should let followers work problems out on their own.
1 2 3 4 5
4. It is fair to say that most employees in the general population are lazy.
1 2 3 4 5
5. Providing guidance without pressure is the key to being a good leader.
1 2 3 4 5
6. Leadership requires staying out of the way of followers as they do their work.
1 2 3 4 5
7. As a rule, employees must be given rewards or punishments in order to motivate them to achieve organizational objectives.
1 2 3 4 5
8. Most workers prefer supportive communication from their leaders.
1 2 3 4 5
9. As a rule, leaders should allow followers to appraise their own work.
1 2 3 4 5
10. Most employees feel insecure about their work and need direction.
1 2 3 4 5
11. Leaders need to help followers accept responsibility for completing their work. 1 2 3 4 5
164
12. Leaders should give followers complete freedom to solve problems on their own.
1 2 3 4 5
13. The leader is the chief judge of the achievements of the members of the group.
1 2 3 4 5
14. It is the leader’s job to help followers find their “passion.”
1 2 3 4 5
15. In most situations, workers prefer little input from the leader.
1 2 3 4 5
16. Effective leaders give orders and clarify procedures.
1 2 3 4 5
17. People are basically competent and if given a task will do a good job.
1 2 3 4 5
18. In general, it is best to leave followers alone.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the responses on items 1, 4, 7, 10, 13, and 16 (authoritarian leadership). 2. Sum the responses on items 2, 5, 8, 11, 14, and 17 (democratic leadership). 3. Sum the responses on items 3, 6, 9, 12, 15, and 18 (laissez-faire leadership).
Total Scores Authoritarian Leadership ________ Democratic Leadership _________ Laissez-Faire Leadership ________
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to measure three common styles of leadership: authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire. By comparing your scores, you can determine which styles are most dominant and least dominant in your own style of leadership.
If your score is 26–30, you are in the very high range. If your score is 21–25, you are in the high range. If your score is 16–20, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 11–15, you are in the low range. If your score is 6–10, you are in the very low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
165
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
166
4.3 Observational Exercise
167
Leadership Styles
Purpose
1. To become aware of authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire styles of leadership 2. To compare and contrast these three styles
Directions
1. From all of the coaches, teachers, music directors, or managers you have had in the past 10 years, select one who was authoritarian, one who was democratic, and one who was laissez-faire.
Authoritarian leader (name) __________________________________________________ Democratic leader (name) __________________________________________________ Laissez-faire leader (name) __________________________________________________
2. On another sheet of paper, briefly describe the unique characteristics of each of these leaders.
Questions
1. What differences did you observe in how each leader tried to influence you? 2. How did the leaders differ in their use of rewards and punishment? 3. What did you observe about how others reacted to each leader? 4. Under which leader were you most productive? Why?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
168
4.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
169
Leadership Styles
Reflection
1. As you reflect on the assumptions of Theory X and Theory Y, how would you describe your own philosophy of leadership?
2. Of the three styles of leadership (authoritarian, democratic, and laissez-faire), what style comes easiest for you? Describe how people respond to you when you use this style.
3. One of the aspects of democratic leadership is to help followers take responsibility for themselves. How do you assess your own ability to help others help themselves?
Action
1. If you were to try to strengthen your philosophy of leadership, what kinds of changes would you have to make in your assumptions about human nature and work?
2. As you look at your results on the Leadership Styles Questionnaire, what scores would you like to change? What would you have to do to make those changes?
3. List three specific activities you could use to improve your leadership style. 4. If you make these changes, what impact will this have on others?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
170
References Bryant, A. (2013, January 26). If supervisors respect the values, so will everyone else. The
New York Times. Retrieved from http://www.nytimes.com/2013/01/27/business/victoria-ransom-of-wildfire-on-instilling- a-companys-values.html?_r=0
Coster, H. (2012, October 19). Victoria Ransom’s wild ride. Fortune. Retrieved from http://tech.fortune.cnn.com/2012/10/19/victoria-ransom-wildfire/
Lewin, K., Lippitt, R., & White, R. K. (1939). Patterns of aggressive behavior in experimentally created “social climates.” Journal of Social Psychology, 10, 271–299.
McGregor, D. (1960). The human side of enterprise. New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
Ouchi, W. G. (1981). Theory Z: How American business can meet the Japanese challenge. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
White, R., & Lippitt, R. (1968). Leader behavior and member reaction in three “social climates.” In D. Cartwright & A. Zander (Eds.), Group dynamics (pp. 318–335). New York, NY: Harper & Row.
171
5 Attending to Tasks and Relationships
172
Introduction
Most people would agree that good doctors are experts at treating disease and, at the same time, care about their patients. Similarly, good teachers are informed about the subject matter and, at the same time, are sensitive to the personal lives of their students. In leadership, the same is true. Good leaders understand the work that needs to be done and, at the same time, can relate to the people who help them do the job.
When we look at what leaders do—that is, at their behaviors—we see that they do two major things: (1) They attend to tasks, and (2) they attend to their relationships with people. The degree to which leaders are successful is determined by how these two behaviors are exhibited. Situations may differ, but every leadership situation needs a degree of both task and relationship behaviors.
Which Behaviors Are Central to Leadership?
Through the years, many articles and books have been written on how leaders behave (Blake & McCanse, 1991; Kahn, 1956; Misumi, 1985; Stogdill, 1974). A review of these writings underscores the topic of this chapter: The essence of leadership behavior has two dimensions—task behaviors and relationship behaviors. Certain circumstances may call for strong task behavior, and other situations may demand strong relationship behavior, but some degree of each is required in every situation. Because these dimensions are inextricably tied together, it is the leader’s challenge to integrate and optimize the task and relationship dimensions in his or her leadership role.
Task and Relationship Theories
One way to explore our own task and relationship perspectives on leadership is to explore our personal styles in these two areas. All of us have developed unique habits regarding work and play, which have been ingrained over many years, probably beginning as far back as elementary school. Rooted in the past, these habits regarding work and play form a very real part of who we are as people and of how we function. Many of these early habits stay with us over the years and influence our current styles.
173
Analyzing Leadership Styles
In considering your personal style, it is helpful to describe in more detail your task-oriented and relationship-oriented behaviors. What is your inclination toward tasks and relationships? Are you more work oriented or people oriented in your personal life? Do you find more rewards in the process of “getting things done” or in the process of relating to people? We all have personal styles that incorporate some combination of work and play. Completing the Task and Relationship Questionnaire on page 113 can help you identify your personal style. Although these descriptions imply that individuals have either one style or the other, it is important to remember that each of us exhibits both behaviors to some degree.
174
Task and Relationship Styles Explained
175
Task Style
Task-oriented people are goal oriented. They want to achieve. Their work is meaningful, and they like things such as to-do lists, calendars, and daily planners. Accomplishing things and doing things is the raison d’être for this type of person. That is, these individuals’ reason for being comes from doing. Their “in-box” is never empty. On vacations, they try to see and do as much as they possibly can. In all avenues of their lives, they find meaning in doing.
In his book titled Work and Love: The Crucial Balance (1980), psychiatrist Jay Rohrlich showed how work can help people organize, routinize, and structure their lives. Doing tasks gives people a sense of control and self-mastery. Achievement sharpens our self-image and helps us define ourselves. Reaching a goal, like running a race or completing a project, makes people feel good because it is a positive expression of who they are.
Some clear examples of task-oriented people include those who use color codes in their daily planners, who have sticky notes in every room of their house, or who, by 10:00 on Saturday morning, have washed the car, done the laundry, and cleaned the apartment. Task-oriented people also are likely to make a list for everything, from grocery shopping to the series of repetitions in their weight-lifting workouts. Common to all of these people is their interest in achieving the goal and accomplishing the work.
176
Relationship Style
Relationship-oriented people differ from task-oriented people because they are not as goal directed. The relationship-oriented person finds meaning in being rather than in doing. Instead of seeking out tasks, relationship-oriented people want to connect with people. They like to celebrate relationships and the pleasures relationships bring.
Relationship Style
Furthermore, relationship-oriented people often have a strong orientation in the present. They find meaning in the moment rather than in some future objective to be accomplished. In a group situation, sensing and feeling the company of others is appealing to these people. They have been described by some as “relationship junkies.” They are the people who are the last to turn off their cell phones as the airplane takes off and the first to turn the phones back on when the airplane lands. Basically, they are into connectedness.
In a work setting, the relationship-oriented person wants to connect or attach with others. For example, the relationship-oriented person would not be afraid to interrupt someone who was working hard on a task to talk about the weather, sports, or just about anything. When working out a problem, relationship-oriented people like to talk to and be associated with others in addressing the problem. They receive satisfaction from being connected to other people. A task-oriented friend described a relationship-oriented person perfectly when he said, “He is the kind of person who stands and talks to you, coffee mug in hand, when you’re trying to do something like mow the lawn or cover the boat.” The meaning in “doing” is just not paramount in the relationship-oriented person’s style.
Leadership Snapshot: Mick Wilz, Director of Enterprise Excellence, Sur-Seal
177
© Terry Duffy
Innovation is key to survival in manufacturing, and Mick Wilz has the accolades to prove it. As the director of enterprise excellence at Sur-Seal in Cincinnati, Ohio, Wilz made changes to the manufacturing process that led to the company receiving the Excellence Award from the Association for Manufacturing Excellence in 2012. Working within an industry where task and routine are absolutely critical, it was actually Wilz’s unique relationship-oriented approach to those tasks that made the most difference.
Wilz is dyslexic and finds reading, writing, and spelling to be very difficult. Not a lot was known about this condition when he was growing up during the late 1950s and 1960s, and Wilz says his childhood was lonely and hard. But his mother was very supportive, advocating for him with teachers and shifting him to five different grammar schools in order to find the best help.
After high school, Wilz began working in building maintenance at the family business, Sur-Seal, a manufacturer of rubber and plastic gaskets. In the 1990s he became the company’s head of operations, and in 2006 he took on the position of director of enterprise excellence charged with reaching peak efficiencies in the manufacturing process. One of his efforts was to initiate a redesign of the factory’s layout, moving work groups to new locations on the manufacturing floor to improve production (www.sur-seal.com).
Because of his difficulties, Wilz relies heavily on visual communication, which was one reason he decided to inform employees about the redesign by showing, rather than telling, them. He used children’s Lego blocks to set up a mock version of the current factory arrangement, right down to using Lego figurines to represent each individual worker. With the employees watching, he changed the Lego layout to show the new design. As the employees stood in front of this demonstration, they were able to see for themselves the plan, make suggestions, and become involved in the redesign.
Wilz took his visual communication efforts elsewhere in the factory, making Sur-Seal a visual workplace. Large posters and signs providing safety directions, instructions on operating the equipment, and diagrams of the products are posted at every machine.
Wilz’s struggles and achievements have made him a more compassionate boss. “Because I had a difficult time when I was young, I believe in treating others as I would like to have been treated. I give employees
178
second chances because I know what it’s like to struggle,” Wilz says. As an example, he talks about the time when one of the company’s maintenance workers was given several chances to improve his work habits and succeeded, becoming the head of his department and a leader in Sur-Seal’s manufacturing initiatives.
“We hire a lot of high school graduates who aren’t inclined to try college because they feel it would be too difficult,” Wilz says. “You have to find a seat on the bus for everyone. I’m a perfect example” (Wilz, 2012).
179
Task and Relationship Styles in Practice
In the previous section, you were asked to consider your personal style regarding tasks and relationships. In this section, we are going to consider the task and relationship dimensions of your leadership style.
Focusing on Tasks and People
Figure 5.1 illustrates dimensions of leadership along a task–relationship continuum. Task- oriented leadership, which appears on the left end of the continuum, represents leadership that is focused predominantly on procedures, activities, and goal accomplishments. Relationship-oriented leadership, which appears on the right end of the continuum, represents leadership that is focused primarily on the well-being of followers, how they relate to each other, and the atmosphere in which they work. Most leadership falls midway between the two extremes of task- and relationship-oriented leadership. This style of leadership is represented by the midrange area, a blend of the two types of leadership.
As discussed at the beginning of this chapter, good leaders understand the work that needs to be done, as well as the need to understand the people who will do it. The process of “doing” leadership requires that leaders attend to both tasks and relationships. The specific challenge for the leader is to decide how much task and how much relationship is required in a given context or situation.
180
Task Leadership
Task leadership behaviors facilitate goal accomplishment—they are behaviors that help group members to achieve their objectives. Researchers have found that task leadership includes many behaviors. These behaviors are frequently labeled in different ways, but are always about task accomplishment. For example, some have labeled task leadership as initiating structure, which means the leader organizes work, defines role responsibilities, and schedules work activities (Stogdill, 1974). Others have labeled task leadership as production orientation, which means the leader stresses the production and technical aspects of the job (Bowers & Seashore, 1966). From this perspective, the leader pays attention to new product development, workload matters, and sales volume, to name a few aspects. A third label for task leadership is concern for production (Blake & Mouton, 1964). It includes policy decisions, new product development, workload, sales volume, or whatever the organization is seeking to accomplish.
Figure 5.1 Task–Relationship Leadership Continuum
Task Leadership
In short, task leadership occurs anytime the leader is doing something that assists the group in reaching its goals. This can be something as simple as handing out an agenda for an upcoming meeting or as complex as describing the multiple quality control standards of a product development process. Task leadership includes many behaviors: Common to each is influencing people toward goal achievement.
As you would expect, people vary in their ability to show task-oriented leadership. There are those who are very task oriented and those who are less task oriented. This is where a person’s personal style comes into play. Those who are task oriented in their personal lives are naturally more task oriented in their leadership. Conversely, those who are seldom task oriented in their personal lives will find it difficult to be task oriented as a leader.
Whether a person is very task oriented or less task oriented, the important point to
181
remember is that, as a leader, he or she will always be required to exhibit some degree of task behavior. For certain individuals this will be easy and for others it will present a challenge, but some task-oriented behavior is essential to each person’s effective leadership performance.
182
Relationship Leadership
Relationship leadership behaviors help followers feel comfortable with themselves, with each other, and with the situation in which they find themselves. For example, in the classroom, when a teacher requires each student to know every other student’s name, the teacher is demonstrating relationship leadership. The teacher is helping the students to feel comfortable with themselves, with other students, and with their environment.
Relationship Leadership
Researchers have described relationship leadership in several ways that help to clarify its meaning. It has been labeled by some researchers as consideration behavior (Stogdill, 1974), which includes building camaraderie, respect, trust, and regard between leaders and followers. Other researchers describe relationship leadership as having an employee orientation (Bowers & Seashore, 1966), which involves taking an interest in workers as human beings, valuing their uniqueness, and giving special attention to their personal needs. Another line of research has simply defined relationship leadership as concern for people (Blake & Mouton, 1964). Within an organization, concern for people includes building trust, providing good working conditions, maintaining a fair salary structure, and promoting good social relations.
Essentially, relationship leadership behavior is about three things: (1) treating followers with dignity and respect, (2) building relationships and helping people get along, and (3) making the work setting a pleasant place to be. Relationship leadership behavior is an integral part of effective leadership performance.
Ethical Leadership and Relationships
In our fast-paced and very diverse society, the challenge for a leader is finding the time and energy to listen to all followers and do what is required to build effective relationships with each of them. For those who are highly relationship oriented in their personal lives, being relationship oriented in leadership will come easily; for those who are highly task oriented, being relationship oriented in leadership will present a greater challenge. Regardless of your personal style, every leadership situation demands a degree of relationship leadership behavior.
183
As discussed earlier in this chapter, task and relationship leadership behaviors are inextricably tied together, and a leader’s challenge is to integrate the two in an optimal way while effectively adapting to followers’ needs. For example, task leadership is critically important in a company or an organization with a large number of newly hired employees or at a charter school with a cadre of new faculty members. It is also called for in an adult fitness class when the instructor is introducing a new exercise. Or, consider the family members of a patient going home after a major heart surgery who have to learn how to change dressings and give medications; they want the health professionals to tell them exactly what to do and how to do it. In situations like these, the followers feel uncertain about their roles and responsibilities, and they want a leader who clarifies their tasks and tells them what is expected of them. In fact, in nearly every group or situation there are some individuals who want and need task direction from their leader, and in these circumstances it is paramount that the leader exhibit strong task-oriented leadership.
Box 5.1 Student Perspectives on Task and Relationship Styles
The following examples are personal observations written by college students. These papers illuminate the distinct differences task and relationship orientations can have in real-life experiences.
184
Taken to Task I am definitely a task-oriented person. My mother has given me her love of lists, and my father has instilled in me the value of finishing things once you start them. As a result, I am highly organized in all aspects of my life. I have a color-coded planner with all of the activities I need to do, and I enjoy crossing things off my lists. Some of my friends call me a workaholic, but I don’t think that is accurate. There are just a lot of things I have to do.
My roommate Steph, however, is completely different from me. She will make verbal lists for her day, but usually will not accomplish any of them [the items listed]. This drives me crazy when it involves my life. For example, there were boxes all over the place until about a month after we moved into our house. Steph would say every day that she was going to focus and get her room organized that day, but she’d fail miserably most of the time. She is easily distracted and would pass up the opportunity to get unpacked to go out with friends, get on Facebook, or look at YouTube videos.
No matter how much Steph’s life stresses me out, I have learned from it. I’m all about having a good time in the right setting, but I am coming to realize that I don’t need to be so planned and scheduled. No matter how carefully you do plan, something will always go awry. I don’t know that Steph is the one who has taught me that or if I’m just getting older, but I’m glad I’m learning that regardless.
—Jessica Lembke
185
Being Rather Than Doing I am an extremely relationship-oriented person. While I know that accomplishing tasks is important, I believe the quality of work people produce is directly related to how they feel about themselves and their leader.
I had the privilege of working with fifth graders in an after-school program last year. There was a range of issues we dealt with including academic, behavioral, and emotional problems, as well as kids who did not have safe homes (i.e., no running water or electricity, physical and emotional abuse, and drug addictions within the home). The “goal” of our program was to help these kids become “proficient” students in the classroom.
The task-oriented leaders in administration emphasized improving students’ grades through repetition of school work, flash cards, and quizzes. It was important for our students to improve their grades because it was the only way statistically to gauge if our program was successful. Given some of the personal trials these young people were dealing with, the last thing in my “relationship-oriented” mind was working on their academics. These young people had so much potential and wisdom that was stifled when they were asked to blindly follow academic assignments. In addition, they did not know how to self-motivate, self-encourage, or get the work done with so many of life’s obstacles in their way.
Instead of doing school work, which the majority of my students struggled with and hated, I focused on building relationships with and between the students. We used discussion, role play, dance parties, and leadership projects to build their self-confidence and emotional intelligence. The students put together service projects to improve their school and community including initiating a trash pickup and recycling initiative at the school and making cards for a nearby nursing home. By the end of the year almost every one of my students had improved his or her grades significantly. More important, at our daily “cheer-for-each- other” meetings, the students would beam with pride for their own and others’ successes.
I guess my point in telling this story is that relationship-oriented leadership is more important to me than task. I much prefer “being” than “doing.” I am not an organized, goal-oriented person. I rarely make it out of my house without going back two or three times to grab something I forgot, and my attention span is shorter than that of a fruit fly. However, I feel that my passion for relationships and human connection is what motivates me.
—Elizabeth Mathews
186
A Blend of Both The Style Approach categorizes leaders as being either task oriented or relationship oriented. While I agree that there are these styles of leadership, I disagree that everyone can be placed concretely into one or the other. The Ohio State study says it well by stating that there are “two different continua.” When it comes to determining where I stand on each continuum, I’d have to say I’m about even. Not surprisingly, my results of the Task and Relationship Questionnaire reflect these thoughts: I scored a solid 41 in both task- and relationship-oriented styles; I’m equally task and relationship oriented, with each of these styles becoming more prevalent in certain situations.
While I truly enjoy being around other people, making sure everyone is happy and that we all enjoy our time, I’m very focused and goal oriented. If I’m at the movies with my friends, I’m not worrying about a to- do list; alternatively, if I’m working on a group project for school, I’m not as concerned about making friends with the group members.
Completing tasks is very important to me. I have an agenda that I keep with me at all times, partly because without it I would never remember anything, and partly because it provides satisfaction and peace of mind. I make to-do lists for myself: groceries, household chores, homework, and goals. I thrive when I’m busy, but not if I’m disorganized. For example, this semester I’m taking 20 credits, applying to graduate schools, taking the GRE, and working at the bookstore. For me it is comforting to have so many responsibilities. If I have downtime, I usually waste it, and I hate that feeling.
I also feel, however, that I’m very relationship oriented. My task-oriented nature doesn’t really affect how I interact with people. I like to make sure people are comfortable and confident in all situations. While I pressure myself to get things done and adhere to a schedule, I’d never think of pushing those pressures onto someone else. If I were the leader of a group that wasn’t getting things done, I’d set an example, rather than tell someone what he or she should be doing.
For me, the idea of “two continua” really makes sense. Whether I am task or relationship focused depends on the situation. While I certainly want to have fun with people, I’m a proponent of the “time and place” attitude, in which people remember when it is appropriate to socialize and when it is appropriate to get a job done.
—Sally Johnson
On the other hand, it is also true that many groups or situations will have individuals who want to be affiliated with or connected to others more than they want direction. For example, in a factory, in a classroom, or even at a workplace like McDonald’s, there are individuals who want the leader to befriend them and relate to them on a human level. The followers are willing to work, but they are primarily interested in being recognized and feeling related to others. An example would be individuals who attend a cancer support group. They like to receive information from the leader, but even more importantly, they want the leader to relate to them. It is similar with individuals who attend a community- sponsored reading club. They want to talk about the book, but they also want the leader to relate to them in a more familiar way. Clearly, in these situations, the leader needs to connect with these followers by utilizing relationship-oriented behaviors.
187
Team Experiences
In addition to task and relationship behaviors, Yukl, Gordon, and Taber (2002) identified a third category of leader behaviors relevant to effective leadership, which they labeled change behaviors. Based on an analysis of a large number of earlier leadership measures, the researchers found that change behaviors included visioning, intellectual stimulation, risk taking, and external monitoring. This category of behaviors has been less prominent in the leadership literature but still is a valuable way to characterize what leaders do. Change behaviors are closely related to leadership skills and creating a vision, which we discuss in the next two chapters of the book.
In society, the most effective leaders recognize and adapt to followers’ needs. Whether they are team leaders, teachers, or managers, they appropriately demonstrate the right degrees of task and relationship leadership. This is no small challenge because different followers and situations demand different amounts of task and relationship leadership. When followers are unclear, confused, or lost, the leader needs to show direction and exhibit task-oriented leadership. At the same time, a leader needs to be able to see the need for affiliation and attachment in followers and be able to meet those needs, without sacrificing task accomplishment.
In the end, the best leader is the leader who helps followers achieve the goal by attending to the task and by attending to each follower as a person. We all know leaders who do this: They are the coaches who force us to do drills until we are blue in the face to improve our physical performance, but who then caringly listen to our personal problems. They are the managers who never let us slack off for even a second but who make work a fun place to be. The list goes on, but the bottom line is that the best leaders get the job done and care about others in the process.
Leaders’ Value Systems
188
Summary
Good leaders are both task oriented and relationship oriented. Understanding your personal styles of work and play can provide a better recognition of your leadership. Task- oriented people find meaning in doing, while relationship-oriented people find meaning in being connected to others. Effective leadership requires that leaders be both task oriented and relationship oriented.
189
Glossary Terms
concern for people 105 concern for production 104 consideration behavior 105 employee orientation 105 initiating structure 103 personal styles 100 production orientation 104 relationship-oriented leadership 103 task-oriented leadership 103
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
190
5.1 Case Study: From Two to One Mark Schmidt runs Co-Ed Cleaners, a business that employs college students to clean offices and schools during the night hours. Due to an economic downturn, Co-Ed Cleaners has lost customers, and although Mark has trimmed everywhere he can think of, he has come to the conclusion that he has to cut back further. This will require letting one of his two managers go and consolidating responsibilities under the other manager’s leadership.
Dan Cali manages groups of students who clean school buildings. Dan is always on the go, visiting cleaning teams at each school while they are working. His employees describe him as an efficient taskmaster with checklists they are all required to follow and sign off on as they complete each job. Dan initiates most ideas for changing processes based on efficiency. When something goes wrong on a job, Dan insists he be alerted and brought in to solve it. “Dan is a very task-oriented guy,” says one of his team members. “There is no one who works harder than he does or knows more about our jobs. This guy gets more done in an hour than most guys do in a day. In the two years I’ve been here, I don’t think I’ve ever seen him stop and take a break or even have a cup of coffee.” Dan’s efforts have helped Co-Ed Cleaners be recognized as “The Best Professional Cleaning Service” for three years running.
Asher Roland is the manager of groups of students who clean small offices and businesses. Asher has up to 10 teams working a night and relies on his employees to do their jobs and keep him apprised of problems. He takes turns working alongside his teams to understand the challenges they may face, getting to know each of his employees in the process. Once a month, he takes the teams to a restaurant for a “Great Job Breakfast” where they talk about sports, the weather, politics, their relationships and families, and, when they have time, work issues. One of his employees describes him this way: “Asher is a really good guy. Never had a better boss. If I am having problems, I would go to Asher first. He always advocates for us and listens when we have ideas or problems, but allows us to manage our own jobs the way we think best. He trusts us to do the right things, and we trust him to be fair and honest with us.”
Mark likes both Dan and Asher, and in their own way they are both good managers. Mark worries, however, about how each manager’s individual style will affect his ability to take on the responsibilities of the manager he replaces. He must let one go, but he doesn’t know which one.
191
Questions 1. Using ideas from the chapter, describe Dan’s and Asher’s styles of leadership. 2. How will Asher’s employees, who are used to being able to manage themselves in their own way,
respond to Dan’s task-oriented style? 3. How will Dan’s employees, who are used to being given clear direction and procedures, respond to
Asher’s more relationship-oriented style? 4. If you were an employee at Co-Ed Cleaners, would you want Mark to let Dan or Asher go? Explain
your choice.
192
5.2 Task and Relationship Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify how much you emphasize task and relationship behaviors in your life 2. To explore how your task behavior is related to your relationship behavior
Directions
For each item below, indicate on the scale the extent to which you engage in the described behavior. Move through the items quickly. Do not try to categorize yourself in one area or another.
Statements Never Rarely Sometimes Often Always
1. Make a to-do list of the things that need to be done.
1 2 3 4 5
2. Try to make the work fun for others. 1 2 3 4 5
3. Urge others to concentrate on the work at hand.
1 2 3 4 5
4. Show concern for the personal well-being of others.
1 2 3 4 5
5. Set timelines for when the job needs to be done.
1 2 3 4 5
6. Help group members get along. 1 2 3 4 5
7. Keep a checklist of what has been accomplished.
1 2 3 4 5
8. Listen to the special needs of each group member.
1 2 3 4 5
9. Stress to others the rules and requirements for the project.
1 2 3 4 5
10. Spend time exploring other people’s ideas for the project.
1 2 3 4 5
11. Pay close attention to project deadlines. 1 2 3 4 5
12. Act friendly toward other group members. 1 2 3 4 5
13. Clarify each group member’s job responsibilities.
1 2 3 4 5
193
14. Express support for other group members’ ideas.
1 2 3 4 5
15. Emphasize performance standards for the group.
1 2 3 4 5
16. Talk with other group members about their personal concerns.
1 2 3 4 5
17. Keep other group members focused on goals.
1 2 3 4 5
18. Emphasize everyone’s unique contributions to the group.
1 2 3 4 5
19. Follow rules and regulations closely. 1 2 3 4 5
20. Express positive feelings toward others in the group.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum scores for the odd-numbered statements (task score). 2. Sum scores for the even-numbered statements (relationship score).
Total Scores Task score: ________________________ Relationship score: __________________
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to measure your task-oriented and relationship-oriented leadership behavior. By comparing your scores, you can determine which style is more dominant in your own style of leadership. If your task score is higher than your relationship score, you tend to give more attention to goal accomplishment and somewhat less attention to people-related matters. If your relationship score is higher than your task score, your primary concern tends to be dealing with people, and your secondary concern is directed more toward tasks. If your scores are very similar to each other, it suggests that your leadership is balanced and includes an equal amount of both behaviors.
If your score is 45–50, you are in the very high range. If your score is 40–44, you are in the high range. If your score is 35–39, you are in the moderately high range. If your score is 30–34, you are in the moderately low range. If your score is 25–29, you are in the low range. If your score is 10–24, you are in the very low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
194
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
195
5.3 Observational Exercise
196
Task and Relationship
Purpose
1. To understand how leadership includes both task and relationship behaviors 2. To contrast different leaders’ task and relationship behaviors
Directions
1. Over the next couple of days, observe the leadership styles of two different leaders (e.g., teacher, athletic coach, choir director, restaurant manager, work supervisor).
2. Record your observations of the styles of each person.
Leader #1 (name) _____________________________________________________________________
Task behaviors Relationship behaviors
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
Leader #2 (name) ________________________________________________________________________
Task behaviors Relationship behaviors
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
• _________________________________________
Questions
1. What differences did you observe between the two leaders? 2. What did you observe about the leader who was most task oriented?
197
3. What did you observe about the leader who was most relationship oriented? 4. How effective do you think you would be in each of these leadership positions?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
198
5.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
199
Task and Relationship
Reflection
1. As you reflect on what has been discussed in this chapter and on your own leadership style, how would you describe your own style in relation to task and relationship orientations? What are your strengths and weaknesses?
2. What biases do you maintain regarding task style and relationship style? How do your biases affect your leadership?
3. One of the most difficult challenges leaders face is to integrate their task and relationship behaviors. Do you see this as a challenge in your own leadership? How do you integrate task and relationship behaviors?
Action
1. If you were to change in an effort to improve your leadership, what aspect of your style would you change? Would you try to be more task oriented or more relationship oriented?
2. Identify three specific task or relationship changes you could carry out. 3. What barriers will you face as you try to make these changes? 4. Given that you believe this change will improve your overall leadership, what can you do (i.e., what
strategies can you use) to overcome the barriers you cite in Action Item #3 above?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
200
References Blake, R. R., & McCanse, A. A. (1991). Leadership dilemmas: Grid solutions. Houston,
TX: Gulf.
Blake, R. R., & Mouton, J. S. (1964). The managerial grid. Houston, TX: Gulf.
Bowers, D. G., & Seashore, S. E. (1966). Predicting organizational effectiveness with a four-factor theory of leadership. Administrative Science Quarterly, 11(2), 238–263.
Kahn, R. L. (1956). The prediction of productivity. Journal of Social Issues, 12(2), 41–49.
Misumi, J. (1985). The behavioral science of leadership: An interdisciplinary Japanese research program. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press.
Rohrlich, J. B. (1980). Work and love: The crucial balance. New York, NY: Summit Books.
Stogdill, R. M. (1974). Handbook of leadership: A survey of theory and research. New York, NY: Free Press.
Wilz, M. (2012, December 29). Don’t just talk about change. Show it [as told to P. R. Olsen]. The New York Times. Retrieved from http://www.nytimes.com/2012/12/30/jobs/the-visual-workplace-and-how-to-build- it.html
Yukl, G., Gordon, A., & Taber, T. (2002). A hierarchical taxonomy of leadership behavior: Integrating a half century of behavior research. Journal of Leadership & Organizational Studies, 9(1), 15–32.
201
6 Developing Leadership Skills
202
Introduction
Whether it is playing the guitar, a video game, or the stock market, most of life’s activities require us to have skills if we are to be successful. The same is true of leadership—skills are required. As discussed in the first chapter, leadership skills refer to learned competencies that leaders are able to demonstrate in performance (Katz, 1955). Leadership skills give people the capacity to influence others. They are a critical component in successful leadership.
What Types of Skills Should Leaders Seek to Develop?
Even though skills play an essential role in the leadership process, they have received little attention by researchers (Lord & Hall, 2005; T. Mumford, Campion, & Morgeson, 2007). Leadership traits rather than leadership skills have been the focus of research for more than 100 years. However, in the past 10 years a shift has occurred, and leadership skills are now receiving far more attention by researchers and practitioners alike (M. Mumford, Zaccaro, Connelly, & Marks, 2000; Yammarino, 2000).
Figure 6.1 Model of Primary Leadership Skills
203
Developing Skills
Although there are many different leadership skills, they are often considered as groups of skills. In this chapter, leadership skills are grouped into three categories: administrative skills, interpersonal skills, and conceptual skills (see Figure 6.1). The next section describes each group of skills and explores the unique ways they affect the leadership process.
204
Administrative Skills Explained
While often devalued because they are not glamorous or exciting, administrative skills play a primary role in effective leadership. Administrative skills help a leader to accomplish the mundane but critically important aspects of showing leadership. Some would even argue that administrative skills are the most fundamental of all the skills required of a leader.
Administrative Skills
What are administrative skills? Administrative skills refer to those competencies a leader needs to run an organization in order to carry out the organization’s purposes and goals. These involve planning, organizing work, assigning the right tasks to the right people, and coordinating work activities (Mann, 1965).
205
Administrative Skills in Practice
For purposes of our discussion, administrative skills are divided into three specific sets of skills: (1) managing people, (2) managing resources, and (3) showing technical competence.
Managing People
Any leader of a for-profit or nonprofit organization, if asked what occupies the most time, will reply, “Managing people.” Few leaders can do without the skill of being able to manage people. The phrase management by walking around captures the essence of managing people. An effective leader connects with people and understands the tasks to be done, those skills required to perform them, and the environment in which people work. The best way to know this is to be involved rather than to be a spectator. For a leader to deal effectively with people requires a host of abilities such as helping employees to work as a team, motivating them to do their best, promoting satisfying relationships among employees, and responding to their requests. The leader also needs to find time to deal with urgent staff matters. Staff issues are a daily fact of life for any leader. Staff members come to the leader for advice on what to do about a problem, and the leader needs to respond appropriately.
Working in Teams
A leader must also pay attention to recruiting and retaining employees. In addition, leaders need to communicate effectively with their own board of directors, as well as with any external constituencies such as the public, stockholders, or other outside groups that have a stake in the organization.
Consider the leadership of Nate Parker, the director of an after-school recreation program serving 600 kids in a large metropolitan community. Nate’s program is funded by an $800,000 government grant. It provides academic, fitness, and enrichment activities for underserved children and their families. Nate has managers who assist him in running the after-school program in five different public schools. Nate’s own responsibilities include setting up and running staff meetings, recruiting new staff, updating contracts, writing press releases, working with staff, and establishing relationships with external constituencies. Nate takes great pride in having created a new and strong relationship between the city government and the school district in which he works. Until he came on board, the relationship between the schools and city government was tense. By communicating effectively across groups, Nate was able to bring the entire community
206
together to serve the children. He is now researching the possibility of a citywide system to support after-school programming.
Managing Resources
Although it is not obvious to others, a leader is often required to spend a significant amount of time addressing resource issues. Resources, the lifeblood of an organization, can include people, money, supplies, equipment, space, or anything else needed to operate an organization. Managing resources requires a leader to be competent in both obtaining and allocating resources. Obtaining resources can include a wide range of activities such as ordering equipment, finding work space, or locating funds for special projects. For example, a middle school cross-country coach wanted to replace her team’s outdated uniforms, but had no funds to do so. In order to buy new uniforms, the coach negotiated with the athletic director for additional funds. The coach also encouraged several parents in the booster club to sponsor a few successful fund-raisers.
Decision Making
In addition to obtaining resources, a leader may be required to allocate resources for new staff or new incentive programs, or to replace old equipment. While a leader may often engage staff members to assist in managing resources, the ultimate responsibility of resource management rests on the leader. As the sign on President Harry S. Truman’s desk read, “The buck stops here.”
Showing Technical Competence
Technical competence involves having specialized knowledge about the work we do or ask others to do. In the case of an organization, it includes understanding the intricacies of how an organization functions. A leader with technical competence has organizational know- how—he or she understands the complex aspects of how the organization works. For example, a university president should be knowledgeable about teaching, research, student recruitment, and student retention; a basketball coach should be knowledgeable about the basics of dribbling, passing, shooting, and rebounding; and a sales manager should have a thorough understanding of the product the salespeople are selling. In short, a leader is more effective when he or she has the knowledge and technical competence about the activities followers are asked to perform.
Technical competence is sometimes referred to as “functional competence” because it means a person is competent in a particular function or area. No one is required to be
207
competent in all avenues of life. So, too, a leader is not required to have technical competence in every situation. Having technical skills means being competent in a particular area of work, the area in which one is leading.
The importance of having technical competence can be seen in the example of an orchestra conductor. The conductor’s job is to direct rehearsals and performances of the orchestra. To do this, the conductor needs technical competence pertaining to rhythm, music composition, and all the many instruments and how they are played. Technical competence gives the conductor the understanding required to direct the many different musicians to perform together successfully.
208
Interpersonal Skills Explained
In addition to administrative skills, effective leadership requires interpersonal skills (see Figure 6.1). Interpersonal skills are people skills—those abilities that help a leader to work effectively with followers, peers, and superiors to accomplish the organization’s goals. While some people downplay the importance of interpersonal skills or disparage them as “touchy- feely” and inconsequential, leadership research has consistently pointed out the importance of interpersonal skills to effective leadership (Bass, 1990; Blake & McCanse, 1991; Katz, 1955).
Interpersonal Skills
209
Interpersonal Skills in Practice
Interpersonal skills are divided into three parts: (1) being socially perceptive, (2) showing emotional intelligence, and (3) managing interpersonal conflicts.
Being Socially Perceptive
To successfully lead an organization toward change, a leader needs to be sensitive to how her or his own ideas fit in with others’ ideas. Social perceptiveness includes having insight into and awareness of what is important to others, how they are motivated, the problems they face, and how they react to change. It involves understanding the unique needs, goals, and demands of different organizational constituencies (Zaccaro, Gilbert, Thor, & Mumford, 1991). A leader with social perceptiveness has a keen sense of how employees will respond to any proposed change in the organization. In a sense, you could say a socially perceptive leader has a finger on the pulse of employees on any issue at any time.
Leadership is about change, and people in organizations often resist change because they like things to stay the same. Novel ideas, different rules, or new ways of doing things are often seen as threatening because they do not fit in with how people are used to things being done. A leader who is socially perceptive can create change more effectively if he or she understands how the proposed change may affect all the people involved.
One example that demonstrates the importance of social perceptiveness is illustrated in the events surrounding the graduation ceremonies at the University of Michigan in the spring of 2008. The university anticipated 5,000 students would graduate, with an expected audience of 30,000. In prior years, the university traditionally held spring graduation ceremonies in the football stadium, which, because of its size, is commonly known as “the Big House.” However, because the stadium was undergoing major renovations, the university was forced to change the venue for graduation and decided to hold the graduation at the outdoor stadium of nearby Eastern Michigan University. When the university announced the change of location, the students, their families, and the university’s alumni responded immediately and negatively. There was upheaval as they made their strong opinions known.
Clearly, the leadership at the university had not perceived the significance to seniors and their families of where graduation ceremonies were to be held. It was tradition to graduate in the Big House, so changing the venue was offensive to many. Phone calls came into the president’s office, and editorials appeared in the press. Students did not want to graduate on the campus of another university. They thought that they deserved to graduate on their own campus. Some students, parents, and alumni even threatened to withhold future alumni support.
210
To correct the situation, the university again changed the venue. Instead of holding the graduation at Eastern Michigan University, the university spent $1.8 million to set up a temporary outdoor stage in the center of campus, surrounded by the University of Michigan’s classroom buildings and libraries. The graduating students and their families were pleased that the ceremonies took place where their memories and traditions were so strong. The university ultimately was successful because it adapted to the deeply held beliefs of its students and their families. Clearly, if the university had been more socially perceptive at the outset, the initial dissatisfaction and upheaval that arose could have been avoided.
Showing Emotional Intelligence
Another important skill for a leader is being able to show emotional intelligence. Although emotional intelligence emerged as a concept less than 20 years ago, it has captivated the interests of many scholars and practitioners of leadership (Caruso & Wolfe, 2004; Goleman, 1995; Mayer & Salovey, 1995). Emotional intelligence is concerned with a person’s ability to understand his or her own and others’ emotions, and then to apply this understanding to life’s tasks. Specifically, emotional intelligence can be defined as the ability to perceive and express emotions, to use emotions to facilitate thinking, to understand and reason with emotions, and to manage emotions effectively within oneself and in relationships with others (Mayer, Salovey, & Caruso, 2000).
Emotional Intelligence and Performance
The underlying premise of research on emotional intelligence is that people who are sensitive to their own emotions and the impact their emotions have on others will be more effective leaders. Since showing emotional intelligence is positively related to effective leadership, what should a leader do to enhance his or her emotional skills?
First, leaders need to work on becoming aware of their own emotions, taking their emotional pulse, and identifying their feelings as they happen. Whether it is mad, glad, sad, or scared, a leader needs to assess constantly how he or she is feeling and what is causing those feelings.
Leadership Snapshot: Coquese Washington, Head Coach, Penn State Women’s Basketball
211
© Jeff Golden/Contributor/Getty Images Sport/Getty Images
It was apparent early on that Coquese Washington had skills that would take her places. She grew up in Flint, Michigan, where she played seven musical instruments in high school, was an All-State selection for girls’ basketball two years in a row, and was awarded a scholarship to attend Notre Dame. She finished Notre Dame in three years, earning a bachelor’s degree in history. After taking a year off to be a high school special education teacher in her hometown, she returned to her alma mater to earn a juris doctorate from the Notre Dame Law School.
But where she ended up . . . well, not even she saw that coming.
Washington was a gifted basketball player, and although she excelled at the sport in high school and it is what brought her to play at Notre Dame, she says her dream was always to practice law.
But after law school, she took a left turn, being recruited and chosen to play for the Portland Power of the ABL (American Basketball League), a short-lived women’s professional basketball league. A year later she joined the WNBA (Women’s National Basketball Association), playing first for the New York Liberty and then moving to Houston, helping the Comets win the WNBA title. She was traded to the Indiana Fever and guided that team to its first ever playoff berth, becoming the first player in WNBA history to lead three different teams to the postseason tournament.
Former teammate Rebecca Lobo describes Washington as “a smart teammate who liked to learn. She could fit in with any crowd and had everyone’s respect because she could blend without compromising who she was” (Haverbeck, 2007).
The WNBA season is in the summer, which allowed Washington to begin coaching at Notre Dame as an assistant under her former coach Muffet McGraw in the off-season. “She did not have any experience, but I thought she’d be great at it,” McGraw says. “I wanted to give her that opportunity and just see if I could try to talk her into trying it out and she was just good at it. I think she found her passion” (McKenna, 2013).
It was also during this time that Washington’s legal skills were called into action. She had been working as an attorney for a New York law firm, so when the WNBA players decided to form a union, she brought her
212
litigation skills to the effort. She became the founding president of the Women’s National Basketball Players’ Association and negotiated the players’ first collective bargaining agreement. Lobo said that Washington was “a godsend” during the negotiations. “She was levelheaded and bright and also had her law degree” (Haverbeck, 2007).
It was in law school that she learned to research, analyze situations, and develop strategies, and Washington admits she always thought she would return to being a lawyer, but somewhere along the way that changed.
“I thought ‘Man, I like coaching, you know. I like the relationships that I have with the players. I like being in the gym,’” Washington said. “I loved basketball. I love being around basketball. I never thought I would enjoy coaching as much as I have, but I really do enjoy it” (McKenna, 2013).
In 2007, Washington was tapped to be the head coach of Penn State’s women’s basketball team. Her success there has been steady; by 2013, she led the Lady Lions to three consecutive appearances at the National Collegiate Athletic Association Women’s Division I Basketball Championships.
But the winning isn’t what’s keeping Washington on the court. It’s the opportunity to be a mentor and leader to her players.
“Mentoring them and helping them learn to become powerful, dynamic women—that’s the thing I love best of all.
“We use basketball as a vehicle, but I’m probably most proud of our kids’ ability to achieve. I’ve learned over the years that that is a skill that’s developed, not something you’re born with. Perseverance, persistence, belief—there are so many skills that have to be nurtured to become an achiever” (Nilsen, 2009).
It’s a philosophy her players respond to. “I think the biggest thing that coach does is not only tell us what to do, she does it herself,” says Penn State player Alex Bentley. “She has been through the WNBA, she has been through coaching at the top institutions already. She knows the game and I have been picking her brain ever since I was a freshman stepping on the court.
“She is the epitome of a great woman. We just see that and want to be like that, she is a role model and a mentor. Us as women, we want to be like that one day” (McKenna, 2013).
Second, a leader should train to become aware of the emotions of others. A leader who knows how to read others’ emotions is better equipped to respond appropriately to these people’s wants and needs. Stated another way, a leader needs to have empathy for others. He or she should understand the feelings of others as if those feelings were his or her own. Salovey and Mayer (1990) suggested that empathy is the critical component of emotional intelligence. Empathy, and how to demonstrate it, is discussed further in Chapter 10, “Listening to Out-Group Members.”
Third, a leader needs to learn how to regulate his or her emotions and put them to good use. Whenever a leader makes a substantial decision, the leader’s emotions are involved. Therefore, emotions need to be embraced and managed for the good of the group or organization. When a leader is sensitive to others and manages his or her own emotions appropriately, that leader increases the chances that the group’s decisions will be effective. For example, a high school principal sensed that she was becoming extremely angry with some students who pulled a prank during an assembly. Instead of expressing her anger —“losing it”—she maintained her composure and helped to turn the prank into a learning experience. The key point here is that people with emotional intelligence understand
213
emotions and incorporate these in what they do as leaders. To summarize, a leader with emotional intelligence listens to his or her own feelings and the feelings of others, and is adept at regulating these emotions in service of the common good.
Handling Conflict
A leader also needs to have skill in handling conflict. Conflict is inevitable. Conflict creates the need for change and occurs as the result of change. Conflict can be defined as a struggle between two or more individuals over perceived differences regarding substantive issues (e.g., the correct procedure to follow) or over perceived differences regarding relational issues (e.g., the amount of control each individual has within a relationship). When confronted with conflict, leaders and followers often feel uncomfortable because of the strain, controversy, and stress that accompany conflict. Although conflict is uncomfortable, it is not unhealthy, nor is it necessarily bad. If conflict is managed in effective and productive ways, the result is a reduction of stress, an increase in creative problem solving, and a strengthening of leader–follower and team-member relationships.
Because conflicts are usually very complex, and addressing them is never simple, Chapter 11, “Managing Conflict,” provides a more thorough examination of the components of conflict and offers several practical communication approaches that a leader can take to constructively resolve differences.
214
Conceptual Skills Explained
Whereas administrative skills are about organizing work, and interpersonal skills are about dealing effectively with people, conceptual skills are about working with concepts and ideas. Conceptual skills involve the thinking or cognitive aspects of leadership and are critical to such things as creating a vision or strategic plan for an organization. A leader with conceptual skills is able to conceive and communicate the ideas that shape an organization from its goals and mission to how to best solve problems.
Traits and Conceptual Skills
215
Conceptual Skills in Practice
Conceptual skills for leaders can be divided into three parts: (1) problem solving, (2) strategic planning, and (3) creating vision.
Problem Solving
We all know people who are especially good at problem solving. When something goes wrong or needs to be fixed, they are the first ones to jump in and address the problem. Problem solvers do not sit idly by when there are problems. They are quick to ask, “What went wrong?” and they are ready to explore possible answers to “How can it be fixed?” Problem-solving skills are essential for effective leadership.
Problem-Solving Skills
What are problem-solving skills? Problem-solving skills refer to a leader’s cognitive ability to take corrective action in a problem situation in order to meet desired objectives. The skills include identifying the problem, generating alternative solutions, selecting the best solution from among the alternatives, and implementing that solution (see Table 6.1). These skills do not function in a vacuum, but are carried out in a particular setting or context.
Table 6.1 Steps in Problem Solving Table 6.1 Steps in Problem
Solving
1. Identify the problem
2. Generate alternative solutions
3. Select the best solution
4. Implement the solution
Step 1: Identify the problem. The first step in the problem-solving process is to identify or recognize the problem. The importance of this step cannot be understated. Seeing a problem and addressing it is at the core of successful problem solving. All of us are confronted with many problems every day, but some of us fail to see those problems or
216
even to admit that they exist. Others may recognize that something is wrong but then do nothing about it. People with problem-solving skills see problems and address them.
Some problems are simple and easy to define, while others are complex and demand a great deal of scrutiny. Problems arise when there is a difference between what is expected and what actually happens. Identifying the problem requires awareness of these differences. The questions we ask in this phase of problem solving are “What is the problem?” “Are there multiple aspects to it?” and “What caused it?” Identifying the exact nature of the problem precedes everything else in the problem-solving process.
Step 2: Generate alternative solutions. After identifying the problem and its cause or causes, the next step in problem solving is to generate alternative solutions where there is more than one possible resolution to the problem. Because problems are often complex, there are usually many different ways of trying to correct them. During this phase of problem solving, it is important to consider as many solutions as possible and not dismiss any as unworthy. For example, consider a person with a major health concern (e.g., cancer or multiple sclerosis). There are often many ways to treat the illness, but before choosing a course of treatment it is important to consult a health professional and explore all the treatment options. Every treatment has different side effects and different probabilities for curing the illness. Before choosing an option, people often want to be sure that they have fully considered all of the possible treatment options. The same is true in problem solving. Before going forward, it is important to consider all the available options for dealing with a problem.
Step 3: Select the best solution. The next step in problem solving is to select the best solution to the problem. Solutions usually differ in how well they address a particular problem, so the relative strengths and weaknesses of each solution need to be addressed. Some solutions are straightforward and easy to enact, while others are complex or difficult to manage. Similarly, some solutions are inexpensive while others are costly. Many criteria can be used to judge the value of a particular solution as it applies to a given problem. Selecting the best solution is the key to solving a problem effectively.
The importance of selecting the best solution can be illustrated in a hypothetical example of a couple with marital difficulties. Having struggled in their marriage for more than two years, the couple decides that they must do something to resolve the conflict in their relationship. Included in the list of what they could do are attend marital counseling, receive individual psychiatric therapy, separate, date other people even though they are married, and file for divorce. Each of these solutions would have a different impact on what happens to the couple and their marital relationship. While not exhaustive, the list highlights the importance in problem solving of selecting the best solution to a given problem. The solutions we choose have a major impact on how we feel about the outcome of our problem solving.
217
Step 4: Implement the solution. The final step in problem solving is implementing the solution. Having defined the problem and selected a solution, it is time to put the solution into action. Implementing the solution involves shifting from thinking about the problem to doing something about the problem. It is a challenging step: It is not uncommon to meet with resistance from others when trying to do something new and different to solve a problem. Implementing change requires communicating with others about the change, and adapting the change to the wants and needs of those being affected by the change. Of course, there is always the possibility that the chosen solution will fail to address the problem; it might even make the problem worse. Nevertheless, there is no turning back at this phase. There is always a risk in implementing change, but it is a risk that must be taken to complete the problem-solving process.
To clarify what is meant by problem-solving skills, consider the following example of John and Kristen Smith and their troublesome dishwasher. The Smiths’ dishwasher was five years old, and the dishes were no longer coming out clean and sparkling. Analyzing the situation, the Smiths determined that the problem could be related to several possible causes: their use of liquid instead of powdered dish detergent, a bad seal on the door of the dishwasher, ineffective water softener, misloading of the dishwasher, or a defective water heater. Not knowing what the problem was, John thought they should implement all five possible solutions at once. Kristen disagreed, and suggested they address one possible solution at a time to determine the cause. The first solution they tried was to change the dish detergent, but this did not fix the problem. Next, they changed the seal on the door of the dishwasher—and this solved the problem. By addressing the problem carefully and systematically, the Smiths were able to find the cause of the dishwasher malfunction and to save themselves a great deal of money. Their problem-solving strategy was effective.
Strategic Planning
A second major kind of conceptual skill is strategic planning. Like problem solving, strategic planning is mainly a cognitive activity. A leader needs to be able to think and consider ideas to develop effective strategies for a group or an organization. Being strategic requires developing careful plans of action based on the available resources and personnel to achieve a goal. It is similar to what generals do in wartime: They make elaborate plans of how to defeat the enemy given their resources, personnel, and the mission they need to accomplish. Similarly, athletic coaches take their knowledge of their players and their abilities to create game plans for how to best compete with the opposing team. In short, strategic planning is about designing a plan of action to achieve a desired goal.
Strategic Planning
218
In their analysis of research on strategic leadership, Boal and Hooijberg (2000) suggested that strategic leaders need to have the ability to learn, the capacity to adapt, and managerial wisdom. The ability to learn includes the capability to absorb new information and apply it toward new goals. It is a willingness to experiment with new ideas and even to accept failures. The capacity to adapt is about being able to respond quickly to changes in the environment. A leader needs to be open to and accepting of change. When competitive conditions change, an effective leader will have the capacity to change. Having managerial wisdom refers to possessing a deep understanding of the people with whom and the environment in which a leader works. It is about having the good sense to make the right decisions at the right time, and to do so with the best interests of everyone involved.
To illustrate the complexity of strategic planning, consider the following example of how NewDevices, a startup medical supply company, used strategic thinking to promote itself. NewDevices developed a surgical scanner to help surgical teams reduce errors during surgery. Although there were no such scanners on the market at that time, two companies were developing a similar product. The potential market for the product was enormous and included all the hospitals in the United States (almost 8,000 hospitals). Because it was clear that all hospitals would eventually need this scanner, NewDevices knew it was going to be in a race to capture the market ahead of the other companies.
NewDevices was a small company with limited resources, so management was well aware of the importance of strategic planning. Any single mistake could threaten the survival of the company. Because everyone at NewDevices, including the sales staff, owned stock in the company, everyone was strongly motivated to work to make the company succeed. Sales staff members were willing to share effective sales approaches with each other because, rather than being in competition, they had a common goal.
Every Monday morning the management team met for three hours to discuss the goals and directions for the company. Much time was spent on framing the argument for why hospitals needed the NewDevices scanner more than its competitors’ scanners. To make this even more challenging, the NewDevices scanner was more expensive than the competition, although it was also safer. NewDevices chose to sell the product by stressing that it could save money in the long run for hospitals because it was safer and would reduce the incidence of malpractice cases.
Managers also developed strategies about how to persuade hospitals to sign on to their product. They contacted hospitals to inquire as to whom they should direct their pitch for the new product. Was it the director of surgical nursing or some other hospital administrator? In addition, they analyzed how they should allocate the company’s limited resources. Should they spend more money on enhancing their website? Did they need a director of advertising? Should they hire more sales representatives? All of these questions were the subject of much analysis and debate. NewDevices knew the stakes were very high; if management slipped even once, the company would fail.
219
This example illustrates that strategic planning is a multifaceted process. By planning strategically, however, leaders and their employees can increase the likelihood of reaching their goals and achieving the aims of the organization.
Creating Vision
Similar to strategic planning, creating vision takes a special kind of cognitive and conceptual ability. It requires the capacity to challenge people with compelling visions of the future. To create vision, a leader needs to be able to set forth a picture of a future that is better than the present, and then move others toward a new set of ideals and values that will lead to the future. A leader must be able to articulate the vision and engage others in its pursuit. Furthermore, the leader needs to be able to implement the vision and model the principles set forth in the vision. A leader with a vision has to “walk the walk,” and not just “talk the talk.” Building vision is an important leadership skill and one that receives extensive discussion in Chapter 7, “Creating a Vision.”
220
Summary
In recent years, the study of leadership skills has captured the attention of researchers and practitioners alike. Skills are essential to being an effective leader. Unlike traits that are innate, leadership skills are learned competencies. Everyone can learn to acquire leadership skills. In this chapter, we considered three types of leadership skills: administrative skills, interpersonal skills, and conceptual skills.
Often thought of as unexciting, administrative skills play a primary role in effective leadership. These are the skills a leader needs to run the organization and carry out its purposes. These are the skills needed to plan and organize work. Specifically, administrative skills include managing people, managing resources, and showing technical competence.
A second type of skills is interpersonal skills, or people skills. These are the competencies that a leader needs to work effectively with followers, peers, and superiors to accomplish the organization’s goals. Research has shown unequivocally that interpersonal skills are of fundamental importance to effective leadership. Interpersonal skills can be divided into being socially perceptive, showing emotional intelligence, and managing interpersonal conflict.
A leader also needs conceptual skills. Conceptual skills have to do with working with concepts and ideas. These are cognitive skills that emphasize the thinking ability of a leader. Although these cover a wide array of competencies, conceptual skills in this chapter are divided into problem solving, strategic planning, and creating vision.
In summary, administrative, interpersonal, and conceptual skills play a major role in effective leadership. Through practice and hard work, we can all become better leaders by improving our skills in each of these areas.
221
Glossary Terms
administrative skills 118 conceptual skills 125 interpersonal skills 121 problem-solving skills 126 social perceptiveness 121 strategic planning 128 technical competence 120
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
222
6.1 Case Study: Sweet Caroline’s It started with cupcakes. As a teacher at Oak Park Elementary, Caroline would often make cupcakes for the school’s teachers and staff. Everyone raved about her baking expertise, and a colleague asked Caroline to make cupcakes for her son’s birthday party. The treats were such a hit that many of the parents at the party asked Caroline for her phone number, and she quickly found herself baking for multiple parties a week.
After a year of baking for private parties, an opportunity arose for Caroline to take her business to the next level. After a local coffee shop went out of business, Caroline signed a contract for its space and opened Sweet Caroline’s, a bakery featuring her cupcakes, muffins, Danish, and other baked goods.
Starting small with birthday parties and graduations and growing to wedding receptions and banquets, Sweet Caroline’s quickly became the most sought-after caterer in the city. As the demand for catering cupcakes and cakes outside of regular business hours grew, Caroline expanded her staff and the services they offered. In just five years, Sweet Caroline’s morphed from a small bakery into a full-service restaurant and catering company.
Although Caroline had no plans of ever going into business, Sweet Caroline’s has been very successful. Caroline is very personable and genuine, which has been instrumental in creating a large and loyal customer base. Furthermore, Caroline’s intuitive sense for how to tailor her services to fit the needs of the community has fueled the company’s growth. Despite her success, however, Caroline has struggled with certain aspects of running Sweet Caroline’s.
Now five years after Sweet Caroline’s opened, it has become a highly complex operation to keep organized. Caroline’s staff has grown to 40 employees, some who work in the bakery, some in the restaurant, and some in both places. There are five drivers who deliver cupcakes, cakes, and other catered goods to private parties and businesses six days a week. In addition, Caroline runs weekly ads in the local media, on the radio, and on the Web. Her 22-year-old daughter manages the company’s Facebook page and Twitter account, which boasts more than 3,000 followers.
Caroline is a skilled baker, but she is finding that the demands of her growing business and client base are creating challenges that are out of her area of expertise. Many of these fall into the administrative area where she hasn’t the patience or knowledge to deal with detail-oriented aspects of managing her business.
For example, Dale, Sweet Caroline’s delivery driver, is often frustrated because the company does not have a system for how orders are to be delivered throughout the city. Dale worked for another company that had a “zone system” so that each driver delivered all orders in one specific area on a given day. In addition, Caroline has opted not to use computers at her company, so all delivery orders are written by hand and then rewritten on clipboards for the drivers when the order is ready. There are often mistakes including duplicate deliveries or a delivery that gets missed completely.
Caroline also struggles with scheduling. Employees’ work schedules are developed the weekend before the start of a workweek so that employees often are unaware of their upcoming shifts. As a result, Sweet Caroline’s is constantly understaffed. The food and baked goods are so good that patrons rarely complain about the wait, but staff members get frustrated with the lack of notice regarding their schedules, the lack of staffing, and the stresses these issues cause.
When it comes to catering events, there is often chaos as Caroline chooses to work on food preparation, while leaving staff members, who are not trained to do so, to plan the events, manage client concerns and issues, and execute the event. While the quality of the food is consistently superb, clients are often surprised by the disorganized style of the catering staff. The staff feels it, too; many have commented that they feel like they are “running blind” when it comes to the events because Caroline gives very little direction and is often not around to help when issues arise.
223
Caroline, however, has a good working rapport with her staff, and they acknowledge that Sweet Caroline’s can be a fun place to work. For her part, Caroline knows that working in a bakery can be difficult and demanding, and she consistently praises the efforts and dedication of her staff members. Caroline is also very good about pitching in and working with staff on the production of cupcakes, cakes, and food items, working side-by-side with them on big orders, while providing them with positive encouragement.
Caroline truly enjoys the novelty of being a business owner and handles all the accounting and payroll duties for the company. Unfortunately, this aspect of the job is becoming more demanding, and Caroline spends an increasing amount of time on these duties, leaving more and more of the day-to-day operations and catering to her staff.
Caroline has been approached about opening a second Sweet Caroline’s in a neighboring town, and while she would like to build on her success, she already feels overwhelmed at times by her current operation and is not sure she can take on more. But she also knows the opportunity to expand won’t last forever.
224
Questions 1. Based on the Model of Primary Leadership Skills (Figure 6.1), how would you describe Caroline’s
skills? In what skills is she strongest, and in what skills is she weakest? 2. Sweet Caroline’s bakery and restaurant seemed to emerge out of nowhere. What role did Caroline
play in this? Do you think Caroline could improve her business with more strategic planning? 3. Have you ever worked at a place that was very successful but felt quite chaotic and disorganized?
How did you handle it? 4. If you were a consultant to Caroline, would you recommend she open a second location? If so, what
three specific skills would you have Caroline develop in order to help manage her business better?
225
6.2 Leadership Skills Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your leadership skills 2. To provide a profile of your leadership skills showing your strengths and weaknesses
Directions
1. Place yourself in the role of a leader when responding to this questionnaire. 2. For each of the statements below, circle the number that indicates the degree to which you feel the
statement is true.
Statements Not true
Seldom true
Occasionally true
Somewhat true
Very true
1. I am effective with the detailed aspects of my work.
1 2 3 4 5
2. I usually know ahead of time how people will respond to a new idea or proposal.
1 2 3 4 5
3. I am effective at problem solving. 1 2 3 4 5
4. Filling out forms and working with details come easily for me.
1 2 3 4 5
5. Understanding the social fabric of the organization is important to me.
1 2 3 4 5
6. When problems arise, I immediately address them.
1 2 3 4 5
7. Managing people and resources is one of my strengths.
1 2 3 4 5
8. I am able to sense the emotional undercurrents in my group.
1 2 3 4 5
9. Seeing the big picture comes easily for me. 1 2 3 4 5
10. In my work, I enjoy responding to people’s requests and concerns.
1 2 3 4 5
11. I use my emotional energy to motivate others.
1 2 3 4 5
12. Making strategic plans for my company 1 2 3 4 5
226
appeals to me.
13. Obtaining and allocating resources is a challenging aspect of my job.
1 2 3 4 5
14. The key to successful conflict resolution is respecting my opponent.
1 2 3 4 5
15. I enjoy discussing organizational values and philosophy.
1 2 3 4 5
16. I am effective at obtaining resources to support our programs.
1 2 3 4 5
17. I work hard to find consensus in conflict situations.
1 2 3 4 5
18. I am flexible about making changes in our organization.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the responses on items 1, 4, 7, 10, 13, and 16 (administrative skill score). 2. Sum the responses on items 2, 5, 8, 11, 14, and 17 (interpersonal skill score). 3. Sum the responses on items 3, 6, 9, 12, 15, and 18 (conceptual skill score).
Total Scores Administrative skill: ___________________ Interpersonal skill: ____________________ Conceptual skill: _____________________
Scoring Interpretation
The Leadership Skills Questionnaire is designed to measure three broad types of leadership skills: administrative, interpersonal, and conceptual. By comparing your scores, you can determine where you have leadership strengths and where you have leadership weaknesses.
If your score is 26–30, you are in the very high range. If your score is 21–25, you are in the high range. If your score is 16–20, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 11–15, you are in the low range. If your score is 6–10, you are in the very low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
227
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
228
6.3 Observational Exercise
229
Leadership Skills
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of different types of leadership skills 2. To examine how leadership skills affect a leader’s performance
Directions
1. Your task in this exercise is to observe a leader and evaluate that person’s leadership skills. This leader can be a supervisor, a manager, a coach, a teacher, a fraternity or sorority officer, or anyone who has a position that involves leadership.
2. For each of the groups of skills listed below, write what you observed about this leader.
Name of leader: ________________
Administrative skills 1 2 3 4 5
Managing people
Managing resources
Showing technical competence
Poor
Poor
Poor
Weak
Weak
Weak
Average
Average
Average
Good
Good
Good
Very good
Very good
Very good
Comments:
Interpersonal skills 1 2 3 4 5
Being socially perceptive
Showing emotional intelligence
Managing conflict
Poor
Poor
Poor
Weak
Weak
Weak
Average
Average
Average
Good
Good
Good
Very good
Very good
Very good
Comments:
Conceptual skills 1 2 3 4 5
Problem solving
Strategic planning
Creating vision
Poor
Poor
Poor
Weak
Weak
Weak
Average
Average
Average
Good
Good
Good
Very good
Very good
Very good
Comments:
Questions
230
1. Based on your observations, what were the leader’s strengths and weaknesses? 2. In what setting did this leadership example occur? Did the setting influence the kind of skills that
the leader used? Discuss. 3. If you were coaching this leader, what specific things would you tell this leader about how he or she
could improve leadership skills? Discuss. 4. In another situation, do you think this leader would exhibit the same strengths and weaknesses?
Discuss.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
231
6.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
232
Leadership Skills
Reflection
1. Based on what you know about yourself and the scores you received on the Leadership Skills Questionnaire in the three areas (administrative, interpersonal, and conceptual), how would you describe your leadership skills? Which specific skills are your strongest, and which are your weakest? What impact do you think your leadership skills could have on your role as a leader? Discuss.
2. This chapter suggests that emotional intelligence is an interpersonal leadership skill. Discuss whether you agree or disagree with this assumption. As you think about your own leadership, how do your emotions help or hinder your role as a leader? Discuss.
3. This chapter divides leadership into three kinds of skills (administrative, interpersonal, and conceptual). Do you think some of these skills are more important than others in some kinds of situations? Do you think lower levels of leadership (e.g., supervisor) require the same skills as upper levels of leadership (e.g., CEO)? Discuss.
Action
1. One unique aspect of leadership skills is that they can be practiced. List and briefly describe three things you could do to improve your administrative skills.
2. Leaders need to be socially perceptive. As you assess yourself in this area, identify two specific actions that would help you become more perceptive of other people and their viewpoints. Discuss.
3. What kind of problem solver are you? Are you slow or quick to address problem situations? Overall, what two things could you change about yourself to be a more effective problem solver?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
233
References Bass, B. M. (1990). Bass & Stogdill’s handbook of leadership: Theory, research, and
managerial applications (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Free Press.
Blake, R. R., & McCanse, A. A. (1991). Leadership dilemmas: Grid solutions. Houston, TX: Gulf.
Boal, K. B., & Hooijberg, R. (2000). Strategic leadership research: Moving on. Leadership Quarterly, 11(4), 515–549.
Caruso, D. R., & Wolfe, C. J. (2004). Emotional intelligence and leadership development. In D. V. Day, S. J. Zaccaro, & S. M. Halpin (Eds.), Leader development for transforming organizations: Growing leaders for tomorrow (pp. 237–266). Mahwah, NJ: Erlbaum.
Goleman, D. (1995). Emotional intelligence. New York, NY: Bantam Books.
Haverbeck, M. J. (2007, December 19). The making of Coquese Washington: The Lady Lions’ new coach goes from humble beginnings in Flint, Mich., to Happy Valley. BlueWhite Illustrated. Retrieved June 7, 2013, from http://www.personal.psu.edu/mjh11/CoqueseWashington.html
Katz, R. L. (1955). Skills of an effective administrator. Harvard Business Review, 33(1), 33–42.
Lord, R. G., & Hall, R. J. (2005). Identity, deep structure and the development of leadership skill. Leadership Quarterly, 16(4), 591–615.
Mann, F. C. (1965). Toward an understanding of the leadership role in formal organization. In R. Dubin, G. C. Homans, F. C. Mann, & D. C. Miller (Eds.), Leadership and productivity (pp. 68–103). San Francisco, CA: Chandler.
Mayer, J. D., & Salovey, P. (1995). Emotional intelligence and the construction and
234
regulation of feelings. Applied and Preventive Psychology, 4(3), 197–208.
Mayer, J. D., Salovey, P., & Caruso, D. R. (2000). Models of emotional intelligence. In R. J. Sternberg (Ed.), Handbook of intelligence (pp. 396–420). Cambridge, MA: Cambridge University Press.
McKenna, K. (2013, March 1). Women’s basketball: Coquese Washington transforms program with leadership. The Daily Collegian. Retrieved June 7, 2013, from http://collegian.psu.edu/archive/2013/03/01/WE_ARE_Coquese_Washington.aspx
Miller, C. C. (2010, October 10). Why Twitter’s C.E.O. demoted himself. The New York Times, p. BU1.
Mumford, M. D., Zaccaro, S. J., Connelly, M. S., & Marks, M. A. (2000). Leadership skills: Conclusions and future directions. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 155–170.
Mumford, T. V., Campion, M. A., & Morgeson, F. P. (2007). The leadership skills strataplex: Leadership skill requirements across organizational levels. Leadership Quarterly, 18(2), 154–166.
Nilsen, D. (2009, November 13). Flint Hall inductee Coquese Washington followed folks’ advice to explore, excel. Flint Journal. Retrieved June 7, 2013, from http://www.mlive.com/sports/flint/index.ssf/2009/11/flint_hall_inductee_coquese_wa.html#
Salovey, P., & Mayer, J. D. (1990). Emotional intelligence. Imagination, Cognition, and Personality, 9(3), 185–221.
Yammarino, F. J. (2000). Leadership skills: Introduction and overview. Leadership Quarterly, 11(1), 5–9.
Zaccaro, S. J., Gilbert, J., Thor, K. K., & Mumford, M. D. (1991). Leadership and social intelligence: Linking social perceptiveness and behavioral flexibility to leader effectiveness. Leadership Quarterly, 2(4), 317–331.
235
7 Creating a Vision
236
Introduction
An effective leader creates compelling visions that guide people’s behavior. In the context of leadership, a vision is a mental model of an ideal future state. It offers a picture of what could be. Visions imply change and can challenge people to reach a higher standard of excellence. At the same time, visions are like a guiding philosophy that provides people with meaning and purpose.
Why Do I Have to Create a Vision to Become a Leader?
In developing a vision, a leader is able to visualize positive outcomes in the future and communicate these to others. Ideally, the leader and the members of a group or an organization share the vision. Although this picture of a possible future may not always be crystal clear, the vision itself plays a major role in how the leader influences others and how others react to his or her leadership.
For the past 25 years, vision has been a major topic in writings on leadership. Vision plays a prominent role in training and development literature. For example, Covey (1991) suggested that vision is one of seven habits of highly effective people. He argued that effective people “begin with the end in mind” (p. 42), that they have a deep understanding of their goals, values, and mission in life, and that this understanding is the basis for everything they do. Similarly, Loehr and Schwartz (2001), in their full-engagement training program, stressed that people are a mission-specific species, and their goal in life should be to mobilize their sources of energy to accomplish their intended mission. Kouzes and Posner (2003), whose Leadership Practices Inventory is a widely used leadership assessment instrument, identified vision as one of the five practices of exemplary leadership. Clearly, vision has been an important aspect of leadership training and development in recent years.
Positive Visionary Leadership
Vision also plays a central role in many of the common theories of leadership (Zaccaro & Banks, 2001). For example, in transformational leadership theory, vision is identified as one of the four major factors that account for extraordinary leadership performance (Bass & Avolio, 1994). In charismatic leadership theories, vision is highlighted as a key to organizational change (Conger & Kanungo, 1998; House, 1977). Charismatic leaders
237
create change by linking their vision and its values to the self-concept of followers. For example, through her charisma Mother Teresa linked her vision of serving the poor and disenfranchised to her followers’ beliefs of personal commitment and self-sacrifice. Some theories are actually titled visionary leadership theories (see Nanus, 1992; Sashkin, 1988, 2004) because vision is their defining characteristic of leadership.
To better understand the role of vision in effective leadership, this chapter will address the following questions: “What are the characteristics of a vision?” “How is a vision articulated?” and “How is a vision implemented?” In our discussion of these questions, we will focus on how you can develop a workable vision for whatever context you find yourself in as a leader.
238
Vision Explained
Given that it is essential for a leader to have a vision, how are visions formed? What are the main characteristics of a vision? Research on visionary leadership suggests that visions have five characteristics: a picture, a change, values, a map, and a challenge (Nanus, 1992; Zaccaro & Banks, 2001).
Visionary Leadership
239
A Picture
A vision creates a picture of a future that is better than the status quo. It is an idea about the future that requires an act of faith by followers. Visions paint an ideal image of where a group or an organization should be going. It may be an image of a situation that is more exciting, more affirming, or more inspiring. As a rule, these mental images are of a time and place where people are working productively to achieve a common goal. Although it is easier for followers to comprehend a detailed vision, a leader’s vision is not always fully developed. Sometimes a leader’s vision provides only a general direction to followers or gives limited guidance to them. At other times, a leader may have only a bare-bones notion of where he or she is leading others; the final picture may not emerge for a number of years. Nevertheless, when a leader is able to paint a picture of the future that is attractive and inspiring, it can have significant impact on his or her ability to lead others effectively.
Vision and Organization Change
240
A Change
Another characteristic of a vision is that it represents a change in the status quo, and moves an organization or a system toward something more positive in the future. Visions point the way to new ways of doing things that are better than how things were done in the past. They take the best features of a prior system and strengthen them in the pursuit of a new goal.
Changes can occur in many forms: rules, procedures, goals, values, or rituals, to name a few. Because visions imply change, it is not uncommon for a leader to experience resistance to the articulated vision. Some leaders are even accused of “stirring the pot” when promoting visionary changes. Usually, though, visions are compelling and inspire others to set aside old ways of doing things and to become part of the positive changes suggested by a leader’s vision.
241
Values
A third characteristic of a vision is that it is about values, or the ideas, beliefs, and modes of action that people find worthwhile or desirable. To advocate change within a group or an organization requires an understanding of one’s own values, the values of others, and the values of the organization. Visions are about changes in those values. For example, if a leader creates a vision that emphasizes that everyone in the company is important, the dominant value being expressed is human dignity. Similarly, if a leader develops a vision that suggests that everyone in the company is equal, the dominant value being expressed is fairness and justice. Visions are grounded in values. They advocate a positive change and movement toward some new set of ideals. In so doing, they must address values.
Inspiring Action Through Values
Leadership Snapshot: Rosalie Giffoniello, Cofounder, Empower the Children
242
© Rosalie Giffoniello
When New Jersey schoolteacher Rosalie Giffoniello decided to travel to India in the summer of 1999, she had no idea that one trip would propel her into a life dedicated to educating India’s impoverished children.
In India, Giffoniello volunteered for a summer at Daya Dan, Mother Teresa’s orphanage for children with disabilities in Kolkata. Using her special education background, she taught some children to feed themselves and walk for the first time. It was then that she made a life-changing decision. “When I went home, I took early retirement from my job, gave away my possessions and returned to Kolkata for good,” Giffoniello says (O’Neil, 2004).
243
She returned to Daya Dan and spent two years working with the Missionaries of Charity to implement programs in language and teaching the children to feed, dress, and bathe themselves.
The next year, she and a friend, Janet Grosshandler, cofounded Empower the Children (ETC), a Jackson, New Jersey–based nonprofit, to raise funds for Daya Dan. At first Giffoniello’s work and ETC’s funds were channeled toward a number of efforts including an orphanage for boys, a school for the disadvantaged, a home for young adults with mental disabilities, and a tutorial center for teenage girls.
However, when Giffoniello observed that the children with disabilities in the Kolkata orphanages were fed each day and clothed while the homeless “street” children often went without food and the most basic necessities, she decided to broaden ETC’s and her own efforts to address the city’s poorest and most vulnerable citizens (Empower the Children, 2004).
She began working with Reena Das, a local woman who was educating homeless street urchins during her lunch hour on the steps of a nearby office building. Das provided her students with a healthy snack and introduction to the Bengali and English alphabets (Weir, 2012).
In January 2006, under the auspices of ETC, Giffoniello and Das opened their first school in a single-room slum building, which they named Preyrona, the Bengali word for inspiration. Four years later, they moved the school to a two-story building and incorporated vocational education including sewing instruction for teenage girls and neighborhood women.
Two years after Preyrona 1 opened, they opened a second school, Preyrona 2 School, in a one-room building with a leaky roof and no windows. For the 90 students who attended it, however, it was better than no school at all (Weir, 2012).
Within three years, they opened a third school, this time in a clean three-story building they were able to buy. Housed in this multistoried building, Preyrona 3 opened its doors in January 2009 and provides three separate educational programs for 60 children while also providing vocational programs for older students and their mothers.
Giffoniello teaches at the Preyrona schools, where she has instilled her teaching methodology of self- empowerment and love. In a nation where educators still discipline with a switch, her philosophy was a challenge for some teachers.
“I tell them ‘If you love the children, then they’ll work for you. They’ll want to please you and make you proud. It’s our responsibility to give them the right kind of attention,’” Giffoniello explains. “Happy children become smart children. That’s why we give the children only love” (Weir, 2012).
ETC’s work has attracted many volunteers from different countries and walks of life, who do everything from working on-site in Kolkata, to helping develop curriculum, to raising money in their home countries.
Giffoniello returns to the United States for six months each year, speaking around the country and raising money for ETC. Now more than a decade old, the organization donates funds for teachers’ salaries, clothing and hot meals for children, and supplies, and sponsors cultural drama, dance, and art programs in more than a dozen different institutions, including some in the United States, Mexico, and Kenya.
The following example illustrates the centrality of values in visionary leadership. Chris Jones was a new football coach at a high school in a small rural community in the Midwest. When Jones started coaching, there were barely enough players to fill the roster. His vision was to have a strong football program that students liked and that instilled pride in the parents and school community. He valued good physical conditioning, self-discipline, skills in all aspects of the game, esprit de corps, and an element of fun throughout the process. In essence, he wanted a top-notch, high-quality football program.
244
Over a period of five years, the number of players coming out for football grew from 15 to 95. Parents wanted their kids to go out for football because Jones was such a good coach. Players said they liked the team because Coach Jones treated them as individuals. He was very fair with everyone. He was tough about discipline but also liked to have fun. Practices were always a challenge but seldom dull or monotonous. Because of his program, parents formed their own booster club to support team dinners and other special team activities.
Although Coach Jones’s teams did not always win, his players learned lessons in football that were meaningful and long lasting. Coach Jones was an effective coach whose vision promoted individual growth, competence, camaraderie, and community. He had a vision about developing a program around these strong values, and he was able to bring his vision to fruition.
245
A Map
A vision provides a map—a laid-out path to follow—that gives direction so followers know when they are on track and when they have slipped off course. People often feel a sense of certainty and calmness in knowing they are on the right course, and a vision provides this assurance. It is also comforting for people to know they have a map to direct them toward their short- and long-term goals.
Vision as a Map
At the same time, visions provide a guiding philosophy for people that gives them meaning and purpose. When people know the overarching goals, principles, and values of an organization, it is easier for them to establish an identity and know where they fit within the organization. Furthermore, seeing the larger purpose allows people to appreciate the value of their contributions to the organization and to something larger than their own interests. The value of a vision is that it shows others the meaningfulness of their work.
246
A Challenge
A final characteristic of a vision is that it challenges people to transcend the status quo to do something to benefit others. Visions challenge people to commit themselves to worthwhile causes. In his inaugural address in 1961, President John F. Kennedy challenged the American people by saying, “Ask not what your country can do for you—ask what you can do for your country.” This challenge was inspiring because it asked people to move beyond self-interest to work for the greater good of the country. Kennedy’s vision for America had a huge impact on the country.
Vision and Conflict
An example of an organization that has a vision with a clear challenge component is the Leukemia and Lymphoma Society’s Team In Training program. The primary goal of this program is to raise funds for cancer research, public education, and patient aid programs. As a part of Team In Training, participants who sign up to run or walk a marathon (26.2 miles) are asked to raise money for cancer research in return for the personalized coaching and fitness training they receive from Team In Training staff. Since its inception in the late 1980s, the program has raised more than $600 million for cancer research. A recent participant said of Team In Training, “I was inspired to find something I could do both to push myself a little harder and to accomplish something meaningful in the process.” When people are challenged to do something good for others, they often become inspired and committed to the task. Whether it is to improve their own group, organization, or community, people like to be challenged to help others.
To summarize, a vision has five main characteristics. First, it is a mental picture or image of a future that is better than the status quo. Second, it represents a change and points to new ways of doing things. Third, it is grounded in values. Fourth, it is a map that gives direction and provides meaning and purpose. Finally, it is a challenge to change things for the better.
247
Vision in Practice
It is one thing for a leader to have a vision for an organization. But making that vision a reality requires communication and action. In this section, we explore how a leader can articulate a vision to others and what specific actions a leader can take to make the vision clear, understandable, and a reality.
248
Articulating a Vision
Although it is very important for a leader to have a vision, it is equally important for a leader to be able to articulate—explain and describe—the vision to others. Although some are better than others at this, there are certain ways all leaders can improve the way they communicate their visions.
Explaining a Vision to Followers
First, a leader must communicate the vision by adapting the vision to his or her audience. Psychologists tell us that most people have a drive for consistency and when confronted with the need to change will do so only if the required change is not too different from their present state (Festinger, 1957). A leader needs to articulate the vision to fit within others’ latitude of acceptance by adapting the vision to the audience (Conger & Kanungo, 1987). If the vision is too demanding and advocates too big a change, it will be rejected. If it is articulated in light of the status quo and does not demand too great a change, it will be accepted.
A leader also needs to highlight the values of the vision by emphasizing how the vision presents ideals worth pursuing. Presenting the values of the vision helps individuals and group members find their own work worthwhile. It also allows group members to identify with something larger than themselves, and to become connected to a larger community (Shamir, House, & Arthur, 1993).
Articulating a vision also requires choosing the right language. A leader should use words and symbols that are motivating and inspiring (Sashkin, 2004; Zaccaro & Banks, 2001). Words that describe a vision need to be affirming, uplifting, and hopeful, and describe the vision in a way that underscores its worth. The inaugural speech by President John F. Kennedy (see edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e) is an example of how a leader used inspiring language to articulate his vision.
Symbols are often adopted by leaders in an effort to articulate a vision and bring group cohesion. A good illustration of this is how, in 1997, the University of Michigan football team and coaching staff chose to use Jon Krakauer’s book Into Thin Air and “conquering Mount Everest” as a metaphor for what they wanted to accomplish. Krakauer provided a firsthand account of a team’s challenging journey up Mount Everest that was successful, although five climbers lost their lives in the process. One of the Michigan coaches said, “It’s amazing how many similarities there are between playing football and climbing a mountain. . . . The higher you get on a mountain, the tougher it gets. The longer you play
249
during the season, the harder it gets to keep playing the way you want to play.” Throughout the season, the coaches frequently emphasized that achieving great feats required tremendous discipline, perseverance, strength, and teamwork. In the locker room, real climbing hooks and pitons were hung above the door to remind everyone who exited that the mission was to “conquer the mountain”—that is, to win the title. The imagery of mountain climbing in this example was a brilliant way to articulate the vision the coaches had for that season. This imagery proved to be well chosen: The team won the 1997 National Collegiate Athletic Association championship.
Visions also need to be described to others using inclusive language that links people to the vision and makes them part of the process. Words such as we and our are inclusive and better to use than words such as they or them. The goal of this type of language is to enlist participation of others and build community around a common goal. Inclusive language helps bring this about.
In general, to articulate a vision clearly requires that a leader adapt the content to the audience, emphasize the vision’s intrinsic value, select words and symbols that are uplifting, and use language that is inclusive. If a leader is able to do these things, he or she will increase the chances that the vision will be embraced and the goal achieved.
250
Implementing a Vision
In addition to creating and articulating a vision, a leader needs to implement the vision. Perhaps the real test of a leader’s abilities occurs in the implementation phase of a vision. Implementing a vision requires a great deal of effort by a leader over an extended period. Although some leaders can “talk the talk,” leaders who implement the vision “walk the walk.” Most important, in implementing a vision the leader must model to others the attitudes, values, and behaviors set forth in the vision. The leader is a living example of the ideals articulated in the vision. For example, if the vision is to promote a deeply humanistic organization, the leader needs to demonstrate qualities such as empathy and caring in every action. Similarly, if the vision is to promote community values, the leader needs to show interest in others and in the common good of the broader community. When a leader is seen acting out the vision, he or she builds credibility with others. This credibility inspires people to express the same kind of values.
Maintaining High Standards
Implementing a vision also requires a leader to set high performance expectations for others. Setting challenging goals motivates people to accomplish a mission. An example of setting high expectations and worthwhile goals is illustrated in the story of the Marathon of Hope (see Box 7.1). Terry Fox was a cancer survivor and amputee who attempted to run across Canada to raise awareness and money for cancer research. Fox had a vision and established an extremely challenging goal for himself and others. He was courageous and determined. Unfortunately, he died before completing his journey, but his vision lives on. Today, the Terry Fox Foundation continues to thrive.
Box 7.1 Marathon of Hope
251
Photograph by Ian Muttoo, https://www.flickr.com/photos/20741443@N00/1416171954/ CC BY-SA 2.0 https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/2.0/
Terry Fox was born in Winnipeg, Manitoba, and raised in Port Coquitlam, British Columbia, a community near Vancouver on Canada’s west coast. An active teenager involved in many sports, Fox was only 18 years old when he was diagnosed with osteogenic sarcoma (bone cancer). In order to stop the spread of the cancer, doctors amputated his right leg 15 centimeters (6 inches) above the knee in 1977.
While in the hospital, Fox was so overcome by the suffering of other cancer patients—many of them young children—that he decided to run across Canada to raise money for cancer research. He called his journey the Marathon of Hope.
After 18 months and running more than 5,000 kilometers (3,107 miles) to prepare, Fox started his run in St. John’s, Newfoundland, on April 12, 1980, with little fanfare. Although it was difficult to garner attention in the beginning, enthusiasm soon grew, and the money collected along his route began to mount. He ran 42 kilometers (26 miles) a day through Canada’s Atlantic provinces, through Quebec, and through part of Ontario. It was a journey that Canadians never forgot.
On September 1, 1980, after 143 days and 5,373 kilometers (3,339 miles), Fox was forced to stop running outside Thunder Bay, Ontario, because cancer had appeared in his lungs. An entire nation was saddened when he passed away on June 28, 1981, at the age of 22.
The heroic Canadian was gone, but his legacy was just beginning. To date, more than $600 million has been raised worldwide for cancer research in his name through the annual Terry Fox Run, held in Canada and in countries around the world.
The process of carrying out a vision does not happen rapidly but takes continuous effort. It
252
is a step-by-step process, and not one that occurs all at once. For this reason, it is imperative for a leader’s eyes to stay on the goal. By doing so, the leader encourages and supports others in the day-to-day efforts to reach the larger goal. A leader alone cannot implement a vision. The leader must work with others and empower them in the implementation process. It is essential that leaders share the work and collaborate with others to accomplish the goal.
253
Summary
A competent leader will have a compelling vision that challenges people to work toward a higher standard of excellence. A vision is a mental model of an ideal future state. It provides a picture of a future that is better than the present, is grounded in values, and advocates change toward some new set of ideals. Visions function as a map to give people direction. Visions also challenge people to commit themselves to a greater common good.
First, an effective leader clearly articulates the vision to others. This requires the leader to adapt the vision to the attitudes and values of the audience. Second, the leader highlights the intrinsic values of the vision, emphasizing how the vision presents ideals worth pursuing. Third, a competent leader uses language that is motivating and uplifting to articulate the vision. Finally, the leader uses inclusive language that enlists participation from others and builds community.
A challenge for a leader is to carry out the difficult processes of implementing a vision. To implement a vision, the leader needs to be a living model of the ideals and values articulated in the vision. In addition, he or she must set high performance expectations for others, and encourage and empower others to reach their goals.
254
Glossary Terms
challenge 146 change 143 map 146 picture 142 status quo 142 value 143 vision 141
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
255
7.1 Case Study: A Clean Slate Nick Gibbons was described by his classmates at Columbia University’s prestigious School of Journalism as a “hard-core newshound with ink running in his blood.” After working as a beat reporter for 10 years, Nick became city editor of a newspaper in a midsized Midwest town of about 100,000, overseeing a large staff of local reporters and writers.
So when the president of the large media group that owned his newspaper asked Nick to come to its headquarters for a meeting, he was excited. Until he heard what was said. The company was going to stop printing daily newspapers, instead publishing digital editions. Nick’s newspaper would only be printed three days a week; the other days the news would be delivered in an electronic edition. As a result, 75% of the newspaper’s workforce would lose their jobs. As the president witnessed Nick’s shock and dismay, he said, “Nick, we think you are the only editor at your newspaper that can make this happen.”
On the three-hour drive home, Nick realized that change at the newspaper was inevitable. Newspapers had been losing subscribers and revenue for a decade as readers turned to the Internet to get their news. Digital versions of newspapers were cheaper to produce and deliver. Although he did not like the idea of going digital, Nick knew in his heart that he still believed strongly in the importance of reporting the news and informing the community, no matter the format.
To succeed in taking the newspaper to a digital format, Nick was going to have to change an entrenched culture and belief system about newspapers, not only within his staff but among the public as well. To do this, he had to start from the ground up, creating something entirely new. This would require bringing aboard people who were energized about the future and not mourning the past.
His plan employed a three-prong approach. First, he informed the entire newspaper staff that they would lose their current jobs in three months and they would have to reapply for new jobs within the newspaper. The first required qualification was a willingness to “forge the future for local journalism and make a contribution to this movement.” If you can’t let go of the past, he told his coworkers, then you can’t move forward. In the end, almost 80% of the new positions were filled by former staffers whom Nick believed to be the “best and brightest” people the newspaper had.
Second, Nick moved the company’s offices out of the building it had been in for 120 years to a smaller, very public space on the first floor of a downtown building. The offices were located on a corner completely sided by windows, the inner workings of the newspaper on display to passersby. Nick wanted the newspaper’s operations to be very visible so that it didn’t seem like it had just “disappeared.”
Nick’s third approach was what he called a “high forgiveness factor.” What they were creating was new and untried, and he knew there would be plenty of missteps along the way. He stressed to his new staffers that he didn’t expect perfection, just dedication and determination. For example, one of those missteps was the elimination of the newspaper’s exhaustive list of local events, which resulted in a huge community outcry. To correct this, staffers determined they could satisfy the community’s frustrations by creating a dedicated website for a local events calendar with event organizers submitting the information electronically. A staff member would oversee college interns in editing the submissions and updating the website.
When the newspaper announced its change to a digital format, the reaction was harsh: Readers canceled subscriptions, and advertisers dropped away like flies. It’s been four years since the change, and the newspaper is slowly gaining back readers and experiencing more visits to its website. The sales staff is starting to be successful teaching advertisers how to create digital ads that can reach the right audiences by using behavioral targeting and social media.
256
Questions 1. What is Nick Gibbons’s vision in this case study? How is it similar to or different from the vision of
the owners of the paper? Discuss the unique challenges a leader faces when required to implement a vision of his or her superiors.
2. Why do you think Nick wanted to open the workings of the paper up to the public? How is this related to his vision?
3. Visions usually require changing people’s values. What desired changes in values are highlighted by this case study?
4. How well did Nick Gibbons articulate his vision for the paper? If you were in Nick’s shoes, how would you articulate your vision in this case?
5. Do you think the newspaper will thrive under Nick’s leadership? Why?
257
7.2 Leadership Vision Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To assess your ability to create a vision for a group or an organization 2. To help you understand how visions are formed
Directions
1. Think for a moment of a work, school, social, religious, musical, or athletic organization of which you are a member. Now, think what you would do if you were the leader and you had to create a vision for the group or organization. Keep this vision in mind as you complete the exercise.
2. Using the following scale, circle the number that indicates the degree to which you agree or disagree with each statement.
Statements Strongly disagree
Disagree Neutral Agree Strongly agree
1. I have a mental picture of what would make our group better.
1 2 3 4 5
2. I can imagine several changes that would improve our group.
1 2 3 4 5
3. I have a vision for what would make our organization stronger.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I know how we could change the status quo to make things better.
1 2 3 4 5
5. It is clear to me what steps we need to take to improve our organization.
1 2 3 4 5
6. I have a clear picture of what needs to be done in our organization to achieve a higher standard of excellence.
1 2 3 4 5
7. I have a clear picture in my mind of what this organization should look like in the future.
1 2 3 4 5
8. It is clear to me what core values, if emphasized, would improve our organization.
1 2 3 4 5
9. I can identify challenging goals that should be emphasized in my group.
1 2 3 4 5
10. I can imagine several things that would
258
inspire my group to perform better.
Scoring Sum the numbers you circled on the questionnaire (visioning ability skill).
Total Scores Visioning ability skill: _______
Scoring Interpretation
The Leadership Vision Questionnaire is designed to measure your ability to create a vision as a leader.
If your score is 41–50, you are in the very high range. If your score is 31–40, you are in the high range. If your score is 21–30, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 10–20, you are in the low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
259
7.3 Observational Exercise
260
Leadership Vision
Purpose
1. To understand the way visions are constructed by leaders in ongoing groups and organizations 2. To identify strategies that leaders employ to articulate and implement their visions
Directions
1. For this exercise, select two people in leadership positions to interview. They can be leaders in formal or informal positions at work, at school, or in society. The only criterion is that the leader influences others toward a goal.
2. Conduct a 30-minute interview with each leader, by phone or in person. Ask the leaders to describe the visions they have for their organizations. In addition, ask, “How do you articulate and implement your visions?”
Leader #1 (name) ________________________________________ Vision content Vision articulation Vision implementation Leader #2 (name) ________________________________________ Vision content Vision articulation Vision implementation
Questions 1. What differences and similarities did you observe between the two leaders’ visions? 2. Did the leaders advocate specific values? If yes, what values? 3. Did the leaders use any unique symbols to promote their visions? If yes, what symbols? 4. In what ways did the leaders’ behaviors model their visions to others?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
261
7.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
262
Leadership Vision
Reflection
1. Stephen Covey (1991) contended that effective leaders “begin with the end in mind.” These leaders have a deep understanding of their own goals and mission in life. How would you describe your own values and purpose in life? In what way is your leadership influenced by these values?
2. Creating a vision usually involves trying to change others by persuading them to accept different values and different ways of doing things. Are you comfortable influencing people in this way? Discuss.
3. As we discussed in this chapter, effective visions can be articulated with strong symbols. How do you view yourself as being able to do this? Are you effective at generating language and symbols that can enhance a vision and help make it successful?
Action
1. Based on your score on the Leadership Vision Questionnaire, how do you assess your ability to create a vision for a group? Identify specific ways you could improve your abilities to create and carry out visions with others.
2. Good leaders act out the vision. Describe what ideals and values you act out or could act out as a leader.
3. Take a few moments to think about and describe a group or an organization to which you belong presently or belonged in the past. Write a brief statement describing the vision you would utilize if you were the leader of this group or organization.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
263
References Bass, B. M., & Avolio, B. J. (1994). Improving organizational effectiveness through
transformational leadership. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Conger, J. A., & Kanungo, R. N. (1987). Toward a behavioral theory of charismatic leadership in organizational settings. Academy of Management Review, 12(4), 637–647.
Conger, J. A., & Kanungo, R. N. (1998). Charismatic leadership in organizations. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Covey, S. R. (1991). Principle-centered leadership. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.
Empower the Children. (2004). How one person made a difference. Retrieved June 8, 2013, from http://www.etc-empowerchildren.org/Organization.htm#OnePerson
Festinger, L. (1957). A theory of cognitive dissonance. Stanford, CA: Stanford University Press.
House, R. J. (1977). A 1976 theory of charismatic leadership. In J. G. Hunt & L. L. Larson (Eds.), Leadership: The cutting edge (pp. 189–207). Carbondale: Southern Illinois University Press.
Kouzes, J. M., & Posner, B. Z. (2003). The leadership challenge (3rd ed.). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Loehr, J., & Schwartz, T. (2001). The power of full engagement: Managing energy, not time, is the key to high performance and personal renewal. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.
Nanus, B. (1992). Visionary leadership: Creating a compelling sense of direction for your organization. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
264
O’Neil, J. (2004, February 1). Going global: Want to see the world—and help kids read at the same time? These NEA-Retired members are continuing a lifetime of public service —while seeing the world with new eyes. NEA Today. Retrieved August 21, 2013, from http://www.accessmylibrary.com/coms2/summary_0286-20297851_ITM
Sashkin, M. (1988). The visionary leader. In J. A. Conger & R. N. Kanungo (Eds.), Charismatic leadership: The elusive factor in organizational effectiveness (pp. 122–160). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Sashkin, M. (2004). Transformational leadership approaches: A review and synthesis. In J. Antonaki, A. T. Cianciolo, & R. J. Sternberg (Eds.), The nature of leadership (pp. 171–196). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Shamir, B., House, R. J., & Arthur, M. B. (1993). The motivational effects of charismatic leadership: A self-concept based theory. Organization Science, 4(4), 577–594.
Weir, R. M. (2012, February). Empowering Calcutta’s children. Encore Magazine, pp. 35–37.
Zaccaro, S. J., & Banks, D. J. (2001). Leadership, vision, and organizational effectiveness. In S. J. Zaccaro & R. J. Klimoski (Eds.), The nature of organizational leadership: Understanding the performance imperatives confronting today’s leaders (pp. 181–218). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
265
8 Establishing a Constructive Climate
266
Introduction
As discussed in earlier chapters, a leader needs to attend to tasks and to people. A leader also has to have a vision that he or she can express and implement. Equally important, a leader must be able to establish a constructive climate for the people in a group or an organization.
What Is a Climate and What Does It Mean for Leadership?
267
Constructive Climate Explained
Climate refers to the atmosphere of a team or an organization. It is defined as people’s shared perceptions of the way things are in an organization (Reichers & Schneider, 1990). Related to climate are the rituals, values, procedures, and underlying assumptions of a group (Schein, 2010). It is the shared perception individuals have about the activities, procedures, and assumptions of a group. A positive climate is shaped by the degree to which people feel they are supported, appreciated, and encouraged for their roles in the organization. A constructive climate is just that: an atmosphere that promotes group members’ satisfaction and achieving their personal best.
Transformational Leadership in Groups
Establishing a constructive climate demands that a leader provide structure, clarify norms, build cohesiveness, and promote standards of excellence. By establishing a constructive climate for the group, a leader ensures that members work more effectively together.
When a leader creates a constructive climate, he or she helps group members perform at their highest levels of excellence (Larson & LaFasto, 1989).
268
Climate in Practice
In order to create a constructive climate, a leader needs to consider four factors: providing structure, clarifying norms, building cohesiveness, and promoting standards of excellence.
269
Providing Structure
Because working in groups can be chaotic and challenging, it is helpful when a leader provides a sense of structure for group members. Providing structure is much like giving group members an architectural blueprint for their work. The drawing gives form and meaning to the purposes of the group’s activities. Instilling structure into the organization provides people with a sense of security, direction, and stability. It helps them to understand where they fit in and what goals they need to accomplish. For example, it would be frightening to be in a group climbing Mount Everest if team members did not know their roles and follow a clear plan for the ascent. Working in a group without structure is more difficult for everyone involved.
How does a leader give structure to a group? First, a leader needs to communicate to the group the group’s goals. When a leader gives a clear picture of assignments and responsibilities, group members gain a better sense of direction. For example, soldiers in the military are given orders to carry out a specific mission. The mission is the goal toward which they are working, and it provides organization to the rest of their activities. Another example is a group meeting where the leader provides an agenda.
In most college classrooms on the first day of class, professors hand out and discuss syllabi. Going over the syllabus is important to students because it provides information about the structure of the class. The syllabus also gives details about the professor, the course objectives, reading and writing assignments, tests, attendance requirements, and exam schedules. Some professors even include a calendar of lecture topics for each week to help students prepare more effectively. The syllabus sets the tone for the class by giving a structure for what will be accomplished. Students usually leave the first class feeling confident about what the class is going to be like and what will be required of them.
Structure
A leader also provides structure by identifying the unique ways that each individual member can contribute to the group. The leader helps followers understand their roles within the group and how to be productive group members. Effective groups use the talents of each individual and, as a result, accomplish a great deal. This is known as synergy, when the group outcome is greater than the sum of the individual contributions. The challenge for a leader is to find how each individual group member can contribute to the group’s mission, and to encourage the group to recognize these contributions. For example, some people are good at generating ideas, while others are skilled at building consensus.
270
Additionally, some people are good at setting agendas, and others are adept at making sure the proper supplies are available at meetings. Each person has a distinctive talent and can make a unique contribution. Effective leaders know how to discover these talents to benefit the entire group. (See Chapter 3, “Engaging Strengths,” for an extended discussion of how leaders can help followers capitalize on their strengths.)
271
Clarifying Norms
In addition to structuring the group, a leader needs to clarify group norms. Norms are the rules of behavior that are established and shared by group members. Social psychologists have argued for years that norms play a major role in the performance and effectiveness of groups (Cartwright & Zander, 1968; Harris & Sherblom, 2007; Napier & Gershenfeld, 2004). Norms are like a road map for navigating how we are supposed to behave in a group. They tell us what is appropriate or inappropriate, what is right or wrong, and what is allowed or not allowed (Schein, 1969). Norms do not emerge on their own—they are the outcome of people interacting with each other and with the leader. For example, in a daylong training seminar, the participants and seminar leader might mutually decide that everyone will turn off their cell phones and no one will leave early. Or staff members in an insurance agency might determine that a “business casual” dress code is appropriate during the week and jeans are OK on Fridays. Norms emerge as a result of how leaders treat followers and followers treat each other.
The reason norms are important is because they have such a strong impact on how the group functions and whether the group is successful or not. For example, a classroom setting with an established norm that students do not raise their hands or offer comments to the discussion can be very boring. A weekly staff meeting where people are allowed to constantly whisper with the person next to them will create an atmosphere that lacks cohesiveness and most likely be very unproductive. On the positive side, when a norm of helping others with their work develops in a small business setting, it can be very helpful and inspiring. Leaders need to be aware that norms always exist, and even when they are subtle or not verbally expressed, they do impact the productivity of the group.
Understanding Norms
A leader can have a significant impact on establishing group norms as well as recognizing norms and working to make them constructive. When a leader brings about constructive norms, it can have a positive effect on the entire group. The following example illustrates how a leader positively influences group norms. Home from college for the summer, Matt Smith was asked to take over as coach of his little brother’s baseball team because the previous coach was leaving. Before taking over coaching the team, Matt observed several practices and became aware of the norms operating on the team. Among other things, he observed that team members frequently arrived 15 to 30 minutes late for practice, they often came without their baseball shoes or gloves, and they goofed off a lot during drills. Overall, Matt observed that the kids did not seem to care about the team or have much
272
pride in what they were doing. Matt knew that coaching this team was going to be a real challenge.
After Matt had coached for a few weeks, the team’s norms gradually changed. Matt continually stressed the need to start practice on time, encouraged players to “bring their stuff” to practice, and complimented players when they worked hard during drills. By the end of the summer, they were a different team. Players grew to enjoy the practice sessions, they worked hard, and they performed well. Most important, they thought their baseball team was “the greatest.”
In this situation, the norms the players were operating under with the old coach interfered with the team and its goals. Under Matt’s leadership, the players developed new norms that enabled them to function better.
Norms are an important component of group functioning. They develop early in a group and are sometimes difficult to change. A leader should pay close attention to norm development and try to shape norms that will maximize group effectiveness.
273
Building Cohesiveness
The third way a leader establishes a constructive climate is to build cohesiveness. Cohesiveness is often considered an elusive but essential component of highly functioning groups. Cohesiveness is described as a sense of “we-ness,” the cement that holds a group together, or the esprit de corps that exists within a group. Cohesiveness allows group members to express their personal viewpoints, give and receive feedback, accept opinions different from their own, and feel comfortable doing meaningful work (Corey & Corey, 2006). When a group is cohesive, the members feel a special connection with each other and with the group as a whole. Members appreciate the group, and in turn are appreciated by the group. Group members identify with the group and its goals and find satisfaction in being an accepted member of the group.
Team Cohesiveness
Cohesiveness has been associated with a number of positive outcomes for groups (see Table 8.1) (Cartwright, 1968; Shaw, 1976). First, high cohesiveness is frequently associated with increased participation and better interaction among members. People tend to talk more readily and listen more carefully in cohesive groups. They also are more likely to express their own opinion and be open to listening to the opinions of others.
Second, in highly cohesive groups, membership tends to be more consistent. Members develop positive feelings toward one another and are more willing to attend group meetings. For example, in an Alcoholics Anonymous group that is cohesive, members often express strong support for each other, and attendance at meetings is very consistent.
Third, highly cohesive groups are able to exert a strong influence on group members. Members conform more closely to group norms and engage in more goal-directed behavior for the group. On a highly successful cross-country track team, all the members support each other and push one another to do their personal best.
Fourth, member satisfaction is high in cohesive groups; members tend to feel more secure and find enjoyment participating in the group. Think of the best class you have ever been in as a student. It was probably very cohesive, and you probably enjoyed it so much that you were sorry when the semester ended.
Table 8.1 Positive Outcomes of Cohesive Groups Table 8.1 Positive Outcomes of Cohesive Groups
274
• There is increased participation from members.
• There is better interaction among members.
• Group membership is more consistent.
• Members develop positive feelings toward one another.
• Members are more willing to attend group meetings.
• Members influence each other.
• Members conform more closely to group norms.
• Group behavior is more goal directed.
• Member satisfaction is high.
• Members are more productive. Sources: Cartwright, 1968; Shaw, 1976.
Finally, members of a cohesive group usually are more productive than members of a group that is less cohesive. Members of groups with greater cohesion can direct their energies toward group goals without spending a lot of time working out interpersonal issues and conflicts. For example, when a project team is cohesive, there are no social loafers. Everyone is together in pursuit of the team goals.
As described by Daniel Brown in his book, Boys in the Boat, the University of Washington rowing team is a good example of how a group of disparate individuals built a cohesive climate and experienced success because of it. Rowing is a sport in which every member of the nine-member team must be in perfect synergy with his teammates as they oar in and move across the water. The sons of loggers, shipyard workers, and farmers, the UW team defeated elite rivals first from eastern and British universities and finally the German crew rowing for Adolf Hitler in the 1936 Olympic Games in Berlin, Germany. Pivotal to their success was that each member of the team had a role and adapted to those roles in sync with one another. “All were merged into one smoothly working machine; they were, in fact, a poem of motion, a symphony of swinging blades” (Brown, 2013, p. 249).
In addition, the team members shared a common goal, which led them to abandon their own self-interest in pursuit of the unified goal of winning. But ultimately it was the trust they had in each other that made them a victorious team.
275
Cohesiveness in Multicultural Organizations
Given the positive outcomes of cohesiveness, how can a leader help groups become cohesive? Group cohesiveness does not develop instantaneously, but is created gradually over time. A leader can assist a group in building cohesiveness by incorporating the following actions in his or her leadership:
Help groups to create a climate of trust Invite group members to become active participants Encourage passive or withdrawn members to become involved Be willing to listen and accept group members for who they are Help group members to achieve their individual goals Promote the free expression of divergent viewpoints in a safe environment Allow group members to share the leadership responsibilities Foster and promote member-to-member interaction instead of only leader-to- follower interaction (Corey & Corey, 2006)
When a leader is able to do some of the things described on this list, it increases the chance that the group will build a sense of cohesiveness.
Consider the following example of a service-learning group of five students who had a goal of raising money for Special Olympics by sponsoring a rock concert. The group included John, a student who was hard of hearing, and who felt alienated and excluded from college life; Emily, an energetic student with high hopes of earning an A in the class; Bill, an older student with very definite opinions; Abby, a free spirit with a strong interest in rock bands; and Dane, a talented student who resented having to work with others on a group project.
During its initial meetings, the group was very disjointed and had low group cohesion. The two people in the group with musical talent (Emily and Abby) thought they would have to do all of the work to put on the concert to raise $200. John never spoke, and Bill and Dane had attitudes that put them on the sidelines. During these early meetings, the group members were unenthusiastic and had negative feelings about each other. However, after the professor for the class encouraged Emily to reach out to John and try to include him in the group, a gradual change started to take place, and the group began moving in a more positive direction. Emily found it difficult to communicate with John because he could only hear if people spoke directly into a special handheld microphone. Emily spent an hour or so with John outside the group and soon established a meaningful association with him. At the same time, Bill, who initially was certain that John could not contribute to the group, started to change his mind when he saw how well Emily and John were getting along. Since Emily was talking to John through the microphone, Bill thought he should try it, too.
Because Abby knew people in three local bands, she put her energies into finding a good
276
band to play for their concert. When John, who was an engineering student, came up with the idea of making posters and handing out flyers to advertise the concert, the energies in the group became focused. Within two weeks of John’s offer, the group had completed a massive promotion throughout the community. The rekindled energies of John, Bill, and Dane were put to good use, and the group far exceeded its previous expectations.
By the end of the project, the group had raised $450 for Special Olympics, and walked away as friends. John claimed that this group project was one of the most meaningful experiences in his college education. Dane wanted to take credit for knowing the most people who came to the concert. Bill was ecstatic that the group had far exceeded his expectations. Abby was pleased to have hired the band and that the concert was a great hit, and Emily was proud of her leadership and the success of the group.
The service-learning group in the above example was a group with low cohesion when it started, but was highly cohesive by the end of the project. Cohesiveness was created because group members developed trust, and withdrawn and passive members were encouraged to participate and become involved. Group members learned to listen and respect one another’s opinions, and to accept each other as unique people. From this example, the lesson for leaders is to help their group to build cohesiveness. When they do, the results can far exceed expectations.
277
Promoting Standards of Excellence
Finally, a leader establishes a constructive climate by promoting standards of excellence. In a classic study, Larson and LaFasto (1989) analyzed the characteristics of 75 highly successful teams. Included in their study were famous teams such as the DeBakey-Cooley cardiac surgery team, the Challenger disaster investigation team, the 1966 Notre Dame championship football team, and even the McDonald’s Chicken McNugget team. In their analysis, researchers found that standards of excellence were a crucial factor associated with team success.
Leading a High-Performance Team
What are standards of excellence? These standards are the expressed and implied expectations for performance that exist within a group or an organization. Standards of excellence include six factors that are essential for members to function effectively:
1. What group members need to know and what skills they need to acquire 2. How much initiative and effort they need to demonstrate 3. How group members are expected to treat one another 4. The extent to which deadlines are significant 5. What goals they need to achieve 6. What the consequences are if they achieve or fail to achieve these goals (Larson &
LaFasto, 1989, p. 95)
In essence, standards of excellence refer to the established benchmarks of desired performance for a group. A good example of standards of excellence can be seen in the slogan (see Figure 8.1) of The Upjohn Company, a pharmaceutical manufacturing firm in Kalamazoo, Michigan. Founded in 1885, Upjohn was known for revolutionizing the drug industry through its invention of the “friable pill,” which can crumble under the pressure of a person’s thumb. In addition to this innovation, over the years Upjohn made many other drug discoveries, and grew to become one of the largest pharmaceutical companies in the world. For many years, the internal slogan promoted throughout the company was “Keep the quality up.”
Figure 8.1 Standard of Excellence Slogan
278
Sources: Used as Courtesy of the WMU Archives and Regional History Collections
“Keep the quality up” captures the essence of what standards of excellence are all about. This slogan is clear, direct, and forceful. It puts responsibility on employees to work toward maintaining quality—a standard of excellence. The slogan strongly suggests that employees should work consistently toward these standards over time. In addition, “Keep the quality up” stresses a positive expectation that has value for both employees and the company; quality is the valued benchmark of the company’s desired performance for its employees.
Based on studies of more than 600 team leaders and 6,000 team members, LaFasto and Larson (2001) identified several specific ways that a leader can influence performance and promote standards of excellence. To influence performance, the authors contend that a leader must stress the “three Rs”: (1) Require results, (2) Review results, and (3) Reward results.
1. Require results. A leader needs to articulate clear, concrete expectations for team members. Working together, a leader and team members should establish mutual goals and identify specific objectives for achieving the results associated with those goals. Without clear expectations, team members flounder and are uncertain about what is required of them. They are unsure what results they are expected to achieve. Requiring results is the critical first step in managing performance (LaFasto & Larson, 2001).
Requiring Results
For example, students in a research course were expected to form a group with four or five of their classmates and work together to complete a “utilization project” by the end of the course. Although the professor had a clear idea of what she wanted students to accomplish, students had no idea what a utilization project was or how to go about developing it. After
279
a number of students expressed frustration at the lack of clear guidelines, the professor explained that a utilization project involved taking findings from a research study and applying them to a real-world situation. She developed evaluation criteria for the project that outlined what students were supposed to do, the level of depth required for the project, and the key elements of the project that needed to be reported in the evaluation paper. With these explicit instructions, students’ anxiety about the utilization project decreased, and they were able to work more effectively in their groups.
Leadership Snapshot: Meg Whitman, CEO, Hewlett Packard Enterprise
© epa european pressphoto agency b.v. / Alamy Stock Photo.
When Meg Whitman took over as CEO of Hewlett-Packard (HP) in 2011, she was walking into a company that could best be described as “a complete mess” (Winkler, 2012).
HP was once the undisputed ruler of Silicon Valley, rising from its humble beginnings in a one-car garage to becoming a technology giant that produced computers, software, printers, and other information technology services and products. Even though it is the world’s largest tech company with $120 billion in annual revenue and 330,000 employees, the company has spiraled downward in the past decade, creating a revolving door of CEOs that began in 1999.
Whitman was the fourth new CEO for HP in less than a decade. A graduate of both Princeton and Harvard universities, she has an impressive track record. As eBay’s CEO, she marshaled its growth into an online auction giant that went from sales of $86 million her first year to $7.7 billion a decade later, when Whitman stepped down as CEO. After an unsuccessful run for the California governor’s office in 2010, Whitman, who was serving on HP’s board of directors, was asked to run the struggling company.
280
Described as blunt, folksy, and persistent, Whitman’s leadership style harkens back to that of HP’s original founders, William Hewlett and David Packard. During their reign, the company created a culture known as The HP Way, which emphasized integrity, teamwork, and innovation and resulted in the deep employee loyalty. But after the founders left and subsequent leadership changes, that revered culture slipped away.
While Whitman knows in today’s competitive tech world she can’t re-create the culture that was, she is intent on reviving the integrity, innovation, and loyalty from those earlier days. Known as being informal, she is the antithesis of the executive. Her first move was to remove the barbed wire and locked gates that separated executive parking from the general employee lot. “We should enter the building the same way everyone else does,” she says (Anders, 2013). Inside, Whitman removed executive vice presidents from their plush offices, including herself, and placed them in cubicles. “This is not a fancy pants kind of company,” she says (Vance & Ricadela, 2013).
Described as a being “decisive without being abrasive, persuasive without being slick,” Whitman is a team builder who is aiming to fix the hundreds of small problems that riddle the company rather than looking for one miracle acquisition or cure. “Problems are good, as long as you solve them quickly,” she says (Anders, 2013).
Inside her organization, she preaches frugality and humility. When HP rival Dell was awarded a $350 million order for Microsoft Bing, Whitman was on the phone to the Microsoft CEO to ask why. “Tell me where we came up short,” Whitman asked. “Don’t sugarcoat it, I’d like to know so we can do better next time.” What resulted was a multipage memo that listed nine ways HP had fallen short. Whitman didn’t take that as an insult—she saw it as a battle plan (Anders, 2013).
“Run to the fire, don’t hide from it,” she tells employees.
Externally, Whitman has personally reached out to the company’s customers and partners, traveling to more than 300 one-on-one meetings and 42 roundtable chats in one year alone. At those meetings she heard complaints and problems, and worked quickly to solve a number of those back in Silicon Valley. “She’s made herself more available than her predecessor ever did,” said one customer (Anders, 2013). “There’s quite a bit of pride in being part of something that means so much to the Valley and this country. It’s a nice company. Nice people,” she says (Anders, 2013).
Whitman admits that what attracted her to the job was the opportunity to revive an iconic company. And while many felt she achieved that, Whitman now sees the company’s future in innovating its services, which harkens back to the company’s early days of leading the computer revolution. In 2014, she split the company into two companies: HP Inc., which is the printer and PC side of the business, and Hewlett Packard Enterprise (HPE), an information technology unit catering to business customers. Whitman is now the head of HPE, leading the company in a new direction.
In this example, the professor initially required results that were unclear. When she clarified her expectations, the students were able to produce the results. Giving clear objectives and instructions is the first step to high-quality performance.
2. Review results. In addition to requiring results, a leader needs to review results. According to LaFasto and Larson (2001), a leader does this by giving constructive feedback and resolving performance issues.
Reviewing Performance
281
Giving constructive feedback is a must for a leader if he or she is going to help group members maintain standards of excellence (see Table 8.2). Constructive feedback is honest and direct communication about a group member’s performance. It is not mean-spirited or paternalistic, nor is it overly nice or patronizing. Constructive feedback helps group members know if they are doing the right things, in the right way, at the right speed. Although it is not easy to do, giving constructive feedback is a skill that everyone can learn. When done correctly, constructive feedback allows group members to look at themselves honestly and know what they need to maintain or improve (LaFasto & Larson, 2001).
Consider the following example of two restaurant managers (Managers A and B) and their waitstaff. Manager A was known for being very blunt and sometimes even mean. Although he wanted the best for the restaurant, his performance reviews were always disasters. Manager A was brutally honest; he did not know how to be diplomatic. If a server was slow or inefficient, he let the person know it in no uncertain terms. In fact, staff members often thought Manager A was attacking them. Although Manager A wanted people to perform well, he did not know how to make that behavior happen. As he frequently told his employees, “Around this place, I don’t sugarcoat anything. If your performance is poor, you’re going to hear about it!”
In contrast, Manager B was very careful in how she treated the waitstaff. Manager B cared about staff, and it showed in how she did performance reviews. If waitstaff did something wrong, Manager B would always comment on it, but never in a mean way. When giving praise or criticism, the feedback was always objective and never extreme; the feedback never attacked the person. Manager B consistently evaluated her staff, but always in a way that made them feel better about themselves and that made them want to try harder.
Manager A and Manager B were very different in how they gave feedback to their staff. Manager A’s feedback was destructive and debilitating, while Manager B’s feedback was constructive and helped to improve performance. As a result, the waitstaff liked working for Manager B and disliked working for Manager A. Staff performed better when Manager B was in charge and worse when Manager A was in charge.
Resolving performance issues is the second part of reviewing results. LaFasto and Larson (2001) found that, more than anything else, the distinguishing characteristic of effective leaders was their willingness to confront and resolve inadequate performance by team members. Clearly, individuals in groups want their leaders to keep other group members “on track.” If some group members are slacking off, or not doing their part, the leader needs to address the situation.
Table 8.2 Tips for Giving Constructive Feedback Table 8.2 Tips for Giving Constructive Feedback
People benefit greatly from feedback that is delivered in a nonconfrontational,
282
constructive manner. Unfortunately, not many of us have the innate skill for delivering feedback this way. There are, however, some simple communication methods that can improve your ability to provide constructive feedback.
1. Address behaviors.
Use facts to describe the behavior that is problematic, rather than focusing on personal traits. For example, a leader might say, “Jane, I have noticed that you have been late for the past three mornings. Can you explain why?” rather than “Why aren’t you able to arrive on time?”
2. Describe specifically what you have observed.
Observations are what you have seen occur; an interpretation is your analysis or opinion of what has occurred. By telling the person what you have seen and not what you think of what you have seen, you provide observations that are more factual and less judgmental. For example, a leader might say, “Dan, I noticed and highlighted several factual and grammatical errors in the report you submitted,” rather than “Dan, all these mistakes make me wonder if you were doing this report at the last minute.”
3. Use “I” language.
Employing “I” statements rather than “you” statements will help reduce the defensiveness of the person you are addressing. For example, if you say, “Joe, because our cubicles are so close together I have a hard time concentrating when you play music on your computer,” rather than “It is really inconsiderate of you to play music when other people are trying to work,” you are more likely to elicit the change you would like.
4. Give the feedback in calm, unemotional language.
Avoid “need to” phrases (e.g., “You need to improve this . . .”) or using a tone that implies anger, frustration, or disappointment. Rather than saying, “If you’d just learn the software, you’d do a better job,” a leader should say, “I am sure you will be much faster now that you understand how to use this software.”
5. Check to ensure clear communication has occurred.
Solicit feedback from the other person to ensure he or she understands what you have been trying to communicate to him or her. For example, a leader might say,
283
“Ann, do you know the procedure for ordering the supplies? Can you go over it to be sure I covered everything?” rather than “Ann, you got all that, didn’t you?”
Giving Feedback
Working in groups is a collective effort—everyone must be involved. Group members are interdependent, and all members share the responsibility of trying to achieve group goals. When some members do not pull their own weight, it affects everyone in the group. This is why a leader must address the inadequate performance of any group members. If the leader fails to do so, contributing group members will feel angry and slighted, as if their work does not really matter.
Confronting inadequate performance by group members is a challenging and emotionally charged process that requires much of leaders (LaFasto & Larson, 2001). It is not easy, but it is a necessary part of leadership. An effective leader is proactive and confronts problems when they occur. In problem situations, a leader has to communicate with low-performing group members and explain how their behaviors hinder the group from meeting its goals. The leader also has to explain what needs to be done differently. After the changes have been clearly identified, the leader needs to monitor the behaviors of the low-performing group members. If the group members make satisfactory changes, they can remain in the group. If a group member refuses to change, the leader needs to counsel him or her about leaving the group. When a leader addresses behavioral problems in a timely fashion, it is beneficial both to the person with the performance problem and to the entire group.
An example of a performance review can be seen in the story of Sam Wilson, a principal at a private, suburban high school. Sam is a highly effective leader who is respected by students, teachers, and parents of his school. As principal, he is responsible for hiring all the teachers at the school. During one fall semester, Sam noticed that Michelle Long, a teacher he had hired to teach geometry, appeared to be slacking off in her work. Michelle was coming to work late, was skipping faculty meetings, and did not seem very excited about teaching. Seeing that she was underperforming, Sam called Michelle into his office to discuss his concerns. During the meeting, Sam described thoroughly his concerns about Michelle’s work and asked Michelle to give her point of view on these concerns. After a long discussion, Sam identified several changes Michelle needed to make if she wanted to continue to teach at the high school.
Following the meeting, Michelle temporarily changed her behavior. She came to school on time, attended some of the faculty meetings, and improved her teaching plans. This positive behavior lasted for about a month, and then she fell back into her old habits. In
284
March, when Sam gave Michelle her annual performance review, he told her that her teaching contract would not be renewed for the following year. Although Michelle was not pleased, she understood why she was being let go.
In the ensuing months, Michelle finished the school year and then found a job at another school. While letting Michelle go was not easy, Sam was comfortable with what he had done. Although some teachers at the school were surprised that Michelle had been let go, they also expressed some relief because they realized that her work was not up to the standards of the school.
3. Reward results. Finally, an effective leader rewards group members for achieving results (LaFasto & Larson, 2001). Many of the behaviors required to be an effective leader are abstract (such as establishing norms) and challenging (such as building group cohesion). However, that is not the case when it comes to rewarding results. Rewarding results is a very practical, straightforward process. It is something that every leader can do.
In their well-known consulting work on leadership effectiveness, Kouzes and Posner (2002) claimed that rewarding results is one of the five major practices of exemplary leaders. They argued that a leader needs to recognize the contributions of group members and express appreciation for individual excellence. This includes paying attention to group members, offering them encouragement, and giving them personalized appreciation. These expressions can be dramatic, such as a dinner celebration, or simple, such as a short email of praise. When a leader recognizes group members and gives encouragement, members feel valued, and there is a greater sense of group identity and community spirit.
A good example of how to effectively reward performance can be seen in how the leader of a nonprofit organization rewarded one of its members, Christopher Wolf. Christopher was an active member of the board who willingly shared his insights and expertise for 15 consecutive years. To show appreciation for his work, the board president had T-shirts made that characterized Christopher’s contributions. On the front of the shirt was a caricature of a wolf in sheep’s clothing symbolizing Christopher’s many positive contributions to the board. On the back of the shirt were the words “The Wolf Pack” and a list of the names of each of the other board members. Both Christopher and each member of the board were given a shirt, which was a big hit with everyone. Although the shirts were simple and inexpensive, they were a unique way of positively recognizing Christopher and all his fellow board members.
285
Summary
Establishing a constructive climate is a subtle but essential aspect of effective leadership that plays a major role in whether groups or organizations function effectively. Establishing a constructive climate is similar to creating a positive climate for workers in a company. It requires that a leader provide structure, clarify norms, build cohesiveness, and promote standards of excellence.
A leader provides structure by establishing concrete goals, giving explicit assignments, and making responsibilities clear. Helping each group member feel included and know that he or she contributes to the overall goals of the group also provides structure.
Facilitative Leadership
A leader plays a significant role in helping to develop positive group norms. Effective groups establish positive norms that allow them to work productively. When norms for a group are negative or unproductive, the leader needs to help group members to change and develop new norms. By assisting groups in establishing positive norms, a leader facilitates the group in maximizing its performance.
Building cohesiveness is the third facet of establishing a constructive climate. Cohesiveness is a special quality of high-functioning groups that feel a strong sense of connectedness and esprit de corps. Associated with many positive outcomes, cohesiveness is established by a leader who assists group members in trusting each other, listening to and respecting one another’s opinions, and accepting each other as unique people.
Finally, to establish a constructive climate a leader promotes standards of excellence. Highly effective teams have strong standards of excellence—they have established benchmarks for desired performance. Standards of excellence are best achieved when the leader requires results, reviews results, and rewards results.
To summarize, establishing a constructive climate is a complex process that involves a great deal of work by a leader. A leader who sets a positive tone will find payoffs in remarkable group performance.
286
Glossary Terms
cohesiveness 163 mission 160 norms 161 standards of excellence 166 structure 160 synergy 161
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
287
8.1 Case Study: A Tale of Two Classes Ebony Ellis has two communication classes back-to-back in the same room, but they couldn’t be more different.
The first, a class on interpersonal communication, is taught by Steve Gardner, an older professor who has taught at the university for 20 years. The first day of class he verbally explained the rules for class conduct, which were also distributed in a printed handout—cell phones off, no texting, and, unless a student needs to use one for taking notes, laptops closed. Class starts on time and ends on time, and students should try not to leave early.
Ebony’s second class, an organizational communication course taught by Marissa Morgan, a younger professor in her 40s, has different rules. There aren’t any. This professor doesn’t care if the students use their laptops during class. Texting and talking are unrestrained. Professor Morgan announced on the first day that all students are responsible for their own learning in the class, and she trusts them to know how they learn best. When students walk in late or leave early, she always says hello or goodbye to them.
Ebony likes her interpersonal communication class a lot. Professor Gardner’s manner has succeeded in getting the class of 75 students to engage with him and listen to one another. Personal disclosures by students and the professor alike are frequent, and there is often much humor and laughter. Even though it is a large class, most people know each other’s names, as does Professor Gardner. Many of the students do things with each other outside of class. In his course, students write a reflection paper every other week, and they have a midterm and final exams.
The atmosphere in the organizational communication class is strikingly different to Ebony. It is spontaneous and uncontrolled. Sometimes professor Morgan lectures, but most of the time she just comes to class and invites students to discuss whatever they want to talk about. Students do not know each other’s names and seldom connect with each other outside of class. Professor Morgan also assigns papers, but they are short, personal observation papers that aren’t given grades but are marked as turned in or not. Students’ final grades for the class are dependent on a presentation each student must give on an interpersonal communication topic of his or her choice.
Ebony thinks the two differing styles of the professors would make a great topic for her organizational communication class presentation. To get more information, she interviews both instructors to learn why their classroom management styles are so different.
Professor Gardner describes his teaching philosophy this way: “I want students to think that this class is unique and the subject is important and has value. I know all students by name, and I allow them to call me by my first name or my title. I really want them to be on board with the direction the train is going from the start. I try to build a community by getting the students to listen to one another. The fun and spirit of the class comes from the camaraderie they establish. In order to listen to one another, however, they have to be fully present. To be fully present, they have to be paying full attention. Texting and open laptops suggest to me that the students are disassociated and disconnected from the group. The attention is on self, rather than the community.”
Professor Morgan says her goal is to be sure to cover the required course content and still enjoy the teaching experience. “I give the students just enough freedom in class that they will either sink or swim. This freedom allows me to present my ideas, and then they are free to discuss them as they wish. I think today’s students are so multifaceted that they can find their own way to learn, even if it involves texting or using their laptops during class. Many times a student will bring up something valuable that he or she has found while surfing the Internet during class that really adds to our discussions. As I see it, my role as a professor is to present the material to be learned, while the students are responsible for how much of it they can absorb.”
288
Ebony also interviewed two students, like herself, who are enrolled in both classes. Ian said he is very pleased with Professor Gardner’s class because he knows what is expected of him and what the norms for class behavior are, noting “He’s the only prof at the U who knows my name.” Professor Gardner’s grading structure is similar to that of most other classes Ian has had, and he likes that there are several graded assignments that allow him to know how he is doing through the course of the semester. As for Professor Morgan’s class, he thinks it is “OK” but finds it distracting when people are texting in class. Ian is also stressed about his grade being dependent on one big assignment.
Professor Gardner’s class is also BreeAnn’s favorite. She says that Professor Morgan’s class feels “a little wild,” the discussions are not controlled by the professor so the class does not stay on topic, and you learn very little. While Professor Morgan writes thoughtful comments on each of their papers, it is unclear how the papers are related to her lectures and more importantly the student’s final grade. BreeAnn finds the final presentation assignment to be an interesting challenge but irrelevant to the class and her major.
“They are both good,” Ian says, “just very, very different.”
289
Questions 1. In establishing a constructive climate for his or her class, what kind of structure has each professor
put in place? 2. How would you describe the group norms for each class? 3. What actions has each professor taken to establish cohesiveness in his or her class? 4. What standards of excellence has each professor established for his or her course? 5. Which class atmosphere would you do best in? Why?
290
8.2 Organizational Climate Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of how your leadership affects others 2. To help you understand your strengths and weaknesses in establishing the climate for a group or an
organization
Directions
1. For each of the statements below, indicate the frequency with which you engage in the behavior listed.
2. Give your immediate impressions. There are no right or wrong answers.
When I am the leader . . . Never Seldom Sometimes Often Always
1. I give clear assignments to group members. 1 2 3 4 5
2. I emphasize starting and ending group meetings on time.
1 2 3 4 5
3. I encourage group members to appreciate the value of the overall group.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I encourage group members to work to the best of their abilities.
1 2 3 4 5
5. I make the goals of the group clear to everyone.
1 2 3 4 5
6. I model group norms for group members. 1 2 3 4 5
7. I encourage group members to listen and to respect each other.
1 2 3 4 5
8. I make a point of recognizing people when they do a good job.
1 2 3 4 5
9. I emphasize the overall purpose of the group assignment to group members.
1 2 3 4 5
10. I demonstrate effective communication to group members.
1 2 3 4 5
11. I encourage group members to respect each other’s differences.
1 2 3 4 5
12. I promote standards of excellence. 1 2 3 4 5
291
13. I help group members understand their purpose for being in the group.
1 2 3 4 5
14. I encourage group members to agree on the rules for the group.
1 2 3 4 5
15. I encourage group members to accept each other as unique individuals.
1 2 3 4 5
16. I give group members honest feedback about their work.
1 2 3 4 5
17. I help group members understand their roles in the group.
1 2 3 4 5
18. I expect group members to listen when another group member is talking.
1 2 3 4 5
19. I help group members build camaraderie with each other.
1 2 3 4 5
20. I show group members who are not performing well how to improve the quality of their work.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the responses on items 1, 5, 9, 13, and 17 (providing structure). 2. Sum the responses on items 2, 6, 10, 14, and 18 (clarifying norms). 3. Sum the responses on items 3, 7, 11, 15, and 19 (building cohesiveness). 4. Sum the responses on items 4, 8, 12, 16, and 20 (promoting standards of excellence).
Total Scores Providing structure: ____________ Clarifying norms: ____________ Building cohesiveness: ____________ Promoting standards of excellence: _________
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to measure four factors related to establishing a constructive climate: providing structure, clarifying norms, building cohesiveness, and promoting standards of excellence. By comparing your scores, you can determine your strengths and weaknesses in establishing a constructive climate as a leader.
If your score is 20–25, you are in the high range. If your score is 15–19, you are in the high moderate range. If your score is 10–14, you are in the low moderate range. If your score is 5–9, you are in the low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
292
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
293
8.3 Observational Exercise
294
Establishing a Constructive Climate
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of how leaders establish a constructive climate for a group or an organization
2. To identify how specific factors contribute to effective group performance
Directions
1. For this exercise, you will observe a leader running a meeting, a practice, a class, or some other group-related activity.
2. Attend a full session of the group and record your observations below.
Name of the leader: ___________________________________________________ Name of the group: ____________________________________________________ Observations about the structure (organization) of the group: Observations about the group’s norms: Observations about the cohesiveness of the group: Observations about the group’s standards of excellence:
Questions 1. In what ways did the leader make the goals of the group clear to group members? 2. How did the leader utilize the unique talents of different group members? 3. What were some of the positive and negative norms of this group? How did the leader reinforce
these norms? 4. How would you evaluate, on a scale from 1 (low) to 5 (high), the cohesiveness of this group? In
what ways did the leader promote or fail to promote the esprit de corps in the group? 5. A key factor in promoting standards of excellence is rewarding results. How did the leader reward
group members for achieving results?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
295
8.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
296
Establishing a Constructive Climate
Reflection
1. Based on the scores you received on the Organizational Climate Questionnaire, what are your strengths and weaknesses regarding establishing a constructive climate for a group or an organization? Discuss.
– Strengths: – Weaknesses:
2. How did you react to the example in this chapter (pp. 167–168) of the service-learning group that developed cohesiveness? In what way do you think cohesiveness plays an important role in groups? Have you ever experienced cohesiveness in a group yourself? Discuss.
3. In this chapter, group rules and norms are stressed as being very important to effective teams. Do you agree with this? Explain your answer. Briefly comment on your own desire and ability to adapt to the rules of a group.
4. An important aspect of establishing a constructive climate is giving recognition to others. Is rewarding or praising others something that would come easily for you as a leader? Discuss.
Action
1. Imagine that you have been chosen to lead a group project for your class and are preparing for the first meeting. Based on what you have read in this chapter, identify five important actions you could take to help establish a constructive climate for the group.
2. This chapter argues that establishing a constructive climate demands that the leader be a role model for how group members should act. What three values are important to you in a group? How would you demonstrate these values to group members?
3. High-performing teams have strong standards of excellence. Discuss your level of comfort with encouraging others to “keep the quality up.” What leadership behaviors could you strengthen to encourage others to work to the best of their ability?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
297
References Anders, G. (2013, June 10). The reluctant savior of Hewlett-Packard. Forbes, 191(8),
64–76.
Brown, D. J. (2013). The boys in the boat: Nine Americans and their epic quest for gold at the 1936 Berlin Olympics. New York, NY: Viking.
Cartwright, D. (1968). The nature of group cohesiveness. In D. Cartwright & A. Zander (Eds.), Group dynamics: Research and theory (3rd ed., pp. 91–109). New York, NY: Harper & Row.
Cartwright, D., & Zander, A. (Eds.). (1968). Group dynamics: Research and theory (3rd ed.). New York, NY: Harper & Row.
Corey, M. S., & Corey, G. (2006). Groups: Process and practice (7th ed.). Pacific Grove, CA: Brooks/Cole.
Harris, T. E., & Sherblom, J. C. (2007). Small group and team communication (4th ed.). Boston, MA: Pearson.
Kouzes, J. M., & Posner, B. Z. (2002). The leadership challenge (3rd ed.). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
LaFasto, F. M. J., & Larson, C. E. (2001). When teams work best: 6,000 team members and leaders tell what it takes to succeed. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Larson, C. E., & LaFasto, F. M. J. (1989). Teamwork: What must go right/what can go wrong. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Napier, R. W., & Gershenfeld, M. K. (2004). Groups: Theory and experience (7th ed.). Boston, MA: Houghton Mifflin.
298
Reichers, A. E., & Schneider, B. (1990). Organizational climate and culture. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Schein, E. H. (1969). Process consultation: Its role in management development. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
Schein, E. H. (2010). Organizational culture and leadership (4th ed.). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Shaw, M. E. (1976). Group dynamics: The psychology of small group behavior (2nd ed.). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
Vance, A., & Ricadela, A. (2013, January 10). Can Meg Whitman reverse Hewlett- Packard’s free fall? Bloomberg Businessweek. Retrieved from http://www.businessweek.com/articles/2013-01-10/can-meg-whitman-reverse-hewlett- packards-free-fall#p1
Winkler, R. (2012, November 20). Another fine mess for H-P. The Wall Street Journal. Retrieved from http://online.wsj.com/article/SB10001424127887324712504578131252852902768.html
299
9 Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
300
Introduction
Leadership requires skill, a clear vision, and a strong commitment to establishing a constructive organizational climate. It also requires that leaders understand diversity and inclusion, and the essential role these play in organizational outcomes. While many of the leadership concepts discussed in this text so far (e.g., task behavior, goal setting, and strengths) involve rather straightforward leadership efforts, addressing diversity and inclusion is a multilayered process that requires a wider range of leadership practices. Although the terms diversity and inclusion seem to represent distinctly different concepts, they are actually interrelated processes, and while not usually discussed as core leadership concepts, diversity and inclusion play a seminal role in effective leadership.
Why Should Leaders Embrace Diversity?
Hearing the word diversity conjures up a multitude of different reactions in people. To some, the word diversity suggests being enriched by the different perspectives, attitudes, and life experiences that people bring to a situation. For others, the word stirs up feelings of unfairness, injustice, and exclusion. Furthermore, some people embrace the positive outcomes of diversity, while others resent the burden of having to adapt to those who are different from themselves. Whatever your reaction is to the word diversity, when you are in a leadership role, you must be prepared to address diversity. How you approach diversity and inclusion will have an impact on your success as a leader.
In this chapter, we explore how embracing diversity and inclusion can make you a more effective leader. First, we define diversity and inclusion and discuss common usages for these terms. Next, we provide a brief history of how these concepts have become more important in society over time. Additionally, we provide a framework to conceptualize inclusion and a model of inclusive practices. Last, we discuss communication practices to improve inclusion and the barriers that can be encountered when trying to embrace diversity and inclusion.
301
Diversity and Inclusion Explained
302
Definitions
Diversity and inclusion are general terms that represent complex processes. A closer look at each of the terms will help explain why they are closely related and why leaders need to be aware of both concepts when addressing diversity within their group or organization.
Understanding Diversity
Diversity. In the most general sense, diversity is about variety or difference. Researchers have defined diversity in a multitude of ways (Mor Barak, 2014). For example, diversity is often used to refer to the mixture of races, genders, or religions that make up a group of people. Harrison and Sin (2006) define diversity as “the collective amount of differences among members within a social unit” (p. 196). Ferdman (2014), a diversity scholar, suggests that diversity is the representation of multiple groups of individuals with different identities and cultures within a group or organization. Similarly, Herring and Henderson (2015) suggest that diversity refers to policies and practices that are designed to include people who are different in some way from the traditional group members. From this perspective, diversity means creating an organizational culture that embraces the values and skills of all of its members. Herring and Henderson contend that diversity is about more than valuing differences between groups; it includes addressing issues of parity, equity, and inequality.
According to a study by Deloitte and the Billie Jean King Leadership Initiative (Dishman, 2015), of 3,700 individuals from a variety of backgrounds, Millennials (born 1980–2000) define diversity differently than Boomers (born 1946–1964) and Gen-Xers (born 1965– 1979). Millennials look at diversity as the mixing of different backgrounds and perspectives within a group. Boomers and Gen-Xers, on the other hand, see diversity as a process of fairness and protection for all group members, regardless of gender, race, religion, ethnicity, or sexual orientation. Millennials are more likely than non-Millennials to focus on the unique experiences of individuals, teamwork, and collaboration than issues of justness.
In this chapter, we define diversity as the amount of difference among members of a group or organization. As set forth by Loden (1996), the core dimensions of diversity include age, ethnicity, gender, mental/physical abilities and characteristics, race, and sexual orientation (see Table 9.1). Secondary dimensions include communication style, education, family status, military experience, organizational role and level, religion, first language, geographic location, income, work experience, and work style. The primary dimensions of diversity are more powerful and less changeable, while the secondary dimensions can change, are less
303
visible, and are less influential in how they impact our lives.
Inclusion. Inclusion is the process of incorporating differing individuals into a group or organization. It is creating an environment where people who are different feel they are part of the whole. For example, inclusion is represented by making accommodations so that a student with disabilities can feel involved and accepted in regular school classes. Similarly, inclusion is about the majority incorporating the opinions of the minority and giving voice to the people who are seldom heard. Booysen (2014) suggests that when inclusion exists in a workplace, “all people from diverse backgrounds will feel valued, respected, and recognized” and “no one will feel that he or she . . . does not have a place in the organization; no one will ask: ‘What about me?’” (p. 299). Furthermore, Ferdman (2014) suggests that people experience inclusion not only when they feel they are treated well individually but also when groups of people who share their identity are respected and valued.
Table 9.1 Dimensions of Diversity Table 9.1 Dimensions of Diversity
Primary Dimensions Secondary Dimensions
Age Geographic Location
Gender Military and Work Experience
Race Family Status
Mental and Physical Abilities Income
Ethnicity Religion
Sexual Orientation
Education
First Language
Organizational Role and Level
Communication and Work Style Source: Based on Loden (1996).
The underpinnings of inclusion are described in the work of Schutz (1958), who posited that inclusion (along with control and affection) is a basic human need that people experience in their interpersonal relationships. It is our need to belong, feel accepted, and
304
be connected to others, but not to the extent that we lose a sense of ourselves as unique individuals. Inclusion means feeling like you are a full member of the group but at the same time maintaining your own identity. It requires a balance between belonging and uniqueness (Shore et al., 2011).
The Importance of Inclusion
Schutz (1958) argued that we express our need to be included by how we communicate with others and we experience less anxiety if our need to be “in the group” matches the degree to which we want others to “include us.” This suggests that leaders should open their arms to include others, but not so much that the individual differences of others get smothered or lost.
In short, diversity focuses on recognizing differences, and inclusion is concerned with embracing those differences. As Myers (2012) aptly suggests, diversity is about “being invited to the party,” and inclusion is about “being asked to dance” (p. 13). Leaders often recognize the value of diversity but struggle with creating supportive, inclusive environments. It is one thing to have a diverse group or organization, but another to make sure each individual is included in the group or organization in a positive manner. Later in the chapter, we provide an inclusion framework to help leaders understand how to approach diversity in different settings.
305
Brief Historical Perspective
Approaches to Diversity
To better understand the complexity of diversity, it is useful to briefly describe how diversity has been addressed in the past, and then to discuss how these descriptions influence the meaning of diversity today. Addressing issues of diversity is not unique; it has been a central challenge for leaders of every generation.
In the United States, diversity was at the foundation of the country’s democratic system. The United States was originally formed by people seeking to escape religious persecution elsewhere. This ideal of seeking freedom drove to the country many groups of immigrants, all of whom had different values, traditions, and religions. As the country evolved, diversity also came to mean addressing the needs of people who are marginalized in the United States, including African Americans whose descendants originally came as slaves as well as Native Americans who were already living in the country. Even today, the diversity of the country continues to shift and change as waves of newcomers enter the United States and continue to alter the social landscape of the nation (Healey & Stepnick, 2017). Building a democratic nation is only possible by acknowledging and addressing issues of diversity.
While there is a lot written on multiculturalism, intergroup relations, and diversity in society, much of the information we present in this chapter comes from diversity and inclusion research as it has occurred in the realm of the workplace. While this research may be workplace specific, it is salient to leaders of any organization. This is especially true of the research on the historical development of workplace diversity in the United States as it reflects how perspectives on diversity evolved in wider society. Harvey (2015) suggests that the approach to diversity in the workplace has changed and evolved over three periods: the early years of diversity (1960s and 1970s), the era of valuing diversity (1980s and 1990s), and diversity management and inclusion in the 21st century (2000 to present) (see Table 9.2).
Moving Beyond an Exclusionary Culture
Early years—1960s and 1970s. This was the period of the civil rights movement in the United States. During this time, efforts were made to end discrimination against African Americans and to secure their legal rights as spelled out in the U.S. Constitution. It was also a time when the federal government passed a series of landmark equal employment opportunity laws: (1) the Equal Pay Act (1963), which stated that women and men must
306
receive equal pay for equal work; (2) the Civil Rights Act (1964), which prohibited discrimination in employment based on race, sex, national origin, religion, and color; (3) the Executive Orders (1961–1965), which required organizations that accepted federal funds to submit affirmative action plans that demonstrated their progress in hiring and promoting groups of people who had been discriminated against previously; and (4) the Age Discrimination Act (1975), which protected workers over 40 years of age from being discriminated against at work because of their age.
Table 9.2 Changing Perspectives on Diversity Table 9.2 Changing Perspectives on Diversity
Time Period
Perspective Metaphor Emphasis
1960s and 1970s
Government Addresses Inequalities
Melting Pot Assimilation
1980s and 1990s
Advantages of Accepting Differences Recognized
Salad Differentiation (Multiculturalism)
2000 to present
Different Opinions and Insights Valued
Smorgasbord Inclusion (Integration)
Source: Adapted from Harvey, C. P. (2015). Understanding workplace diversity: Where have we been and where are we going? In C. P. Harvey & M. J. Allard (Eds.), Understanding and managing diversity: Readings, cases, and exercises (pp. 1–7). Boston, MA: Pearson; Thomas, D. A., & Ely, R. J. (1996, September–October). Making differences matter: A new paradigm for managing diversity. Harvard Business Review.
During these early years, the focus of diversity was on “righting the wrongs” experienced by people who were perceived as different because of their race or gender (Harvey, 2015) and who were also the targets of discrimination and exclusion. It was also a time when the government began forcing organizations to confront inequities between individuals and groups in the workplace. Thomas and Ely (1996) contend that these early years were focused on discrimination and fairness. Because of prejudice, certain demographic groups were not treated the same as other groups. To comply with federal mandates, it was important for organizations to ensure that all people were treated equally and that no one was given an unfair advantage over another person.
It was common during the early years to think of diversity using the term melting pot, a metaphor for a blending of many into one, or a heterogeneous society becoming homogeneous. Sociologically, diversity was thought of as an assimilation process where those from different cultures were expected to adapt to and, in many cases, adopt the customs of the majority group (Blaine, 2013). Assimilation focused on the process of making people from diverse cultures come together to create one American culture. Healey
307
and Stepnick (2017) point out that while assimilation is often thought of as a gradual and fair blending of diverse cultures, in fact it requires different cultures to blend in with the predominant English language and British cultural style. Although assimilation helps to bring diverse individuals together, it requires that those in the minority culture give up many, if not most, of their own values and traditions in order to adopt the dominant culture.
Assimilation
Era of valuing diversity—1980s and 1990s. This period was marked by a new approach to diversity that emphasized the acceptance and celebration of differences (Thomas & Ely, 1996). The approach to diversity at this time broadened beyond an emphasis on race and gender to include many dimensions (sexual orientation, age, physical and mental abilities, etc. [see Table 9.1]). In addition to stressing fairness and equality, organizations recognized that society was becoming more multicultural and that supporting diversity in the workforce could have competitive advantages. Research focused on how diversity in the workplace was related to positive outcomes for an organization, such as reduced turnover, better creative thinking, enhanced problem solving, and improved decision making. Organizations found that diversity was not just about fairness; it made economic sense (Thomas & Ely, 1996).
Emotional and Cultural Intelligence
Rather than a melting pot, the metaphor for diversity during this time was more of a salad composed of different ingredients, made by mixing different individuals or cultures and their unique characteristics into one. A multicultural approach acknowledges and accepts differences. The emphasis was on the individual unique contributions that each person or culture brings to an organization, rather than blending (“melting”) differences into a single whole (Harvey, 2015). Furthermore, diversity during this period emphasized pluralism, the recognition that people of different cultures did not need to sacrifice their own traditions and values to become a part of one society. Pluralism means that people of all races, classes, religions, and backgrounds can coexist in one society without giving up their identities, customs, or traditions. A pluralistic society appreciates and celebrates differences.
308
Diversity Management
Diversity management and inclusion in the 21st century—2000 to present. Diversity during this period continues to be a major concern for organizations and society in general. Inequities between individuals and groups in regard to differences in race, gender, ethnicity, sexual orientation, and other dimensions remain unresolved. The laws of the 1960s and 1970s still occupy an important role in trying to achieve diversity in the workplace. At the same time, multiculturalism is more widely accepted and celebrated today.
What is new in the last 20 years regarding diversity is an emphasis on creating inclusive organizations. Harvey (2015) points out that people today are recognizing that both organizations and individuals can benefit from diversity. Furthermore, she points out that diversity today is broader in scope and harder to manage because of a changing composition of workers, the need to acknowledge multiple social identities, and the challenge of trying to establish and maintain an inclusive organizational culture. The new way of approaching diversity acknowledges differences among people and values those differences, integrating them into the organization. People feel they are all on the same team because of their differences, not despite their differences (Thomas & Ely, 1996).
As opposed to being like a melting pot that blends many into one or a salad that mixes differences together, diversity today could be thought of as a smorgasbord that celebrates the unique qualities of a variety of different dishes. Diversity from this perspective means that people’s unique qualities are accepted and enjoyed, and that people do not need to downplay their own unique characteristics for the benefit of others. It also means that people do not need to deny their own cultural identities to be a part of the larger group or organization. Diversity means that an organization is composed of many unique elements and, when taken together, these elements make the organization unique.
While our perspectives on diversity have changed over the last 50 years, society’s need to address matters of diversity has remained constant. The current approach to diversity places the inclusion process at center stage as the pathway to addressing concerns about diversity. Inclusion means allowing people with different cultural characteristics to have a voice and feel integrated and connected with others (Ferdman, 2014). In the next section, we describe a framework for understanding the inclusion process.
309
Inclusion Framework
Social psychologist Brewer (1991) argued that individuals have two opposing needs in regard to being a part of a group. First, they have a desire to assimilate and be included; second, they have a need to differentiate themselves from the group. Similar to Schutz’s (1958) early work on inclusion, people seek an optimal balance between inclusion and differentiation.
Inclusion, Diversity, and Leadership
To better understand how people balance these needs, Shore and colleagues (2011) developed an inclusion framework. The framework, depicted in Table 9.3, illustrates how varying levels of belongingness (i.e., the desire to be included) interact with uniqueness (i.e., the desire to maintain one’s own identity) and result in the four quadrants shown below.
The Exclusion quadrant (top left) represents individuals in a group or organization who feel left out and excluded; they do not feel a part of things, and they do not feel valued. Exclusion occurs when organizations fail to see and value the unique qualities of diverse employees and fail to accept them as organizational insiders. An example might be a female vice president of a bank whose ideas are discounted by her male counterparts and who is seldom invited to corporate planning meetings. In effect, exclusion represents a complete failure to deal with matters of diversity.
The Differentiation quadrant (lower left) describes individuals who feel unique and respected but who also feel left out and not a part of the in-group. Differentiation occurs when organizations accept and value the unique qualities of members who are different but then fail to let these individuals become full members of the organization. For example, this might occur when a customer service center hires several Spanish-speaking representatives because the center is working with more Spanish-speaking customers. But those representatives are not asked for their input on organizational issues such as the scripting they use for complaint calls. In terms of diversity, differentiation goes halfway—it recognizes different individuals, but does not fully accept them.
Table 9.3 Inclusion Framework Table 9.3 Inclusion Framework
Low Belongingness High Belongingness
310
Low Value in Uniqueness
Exclusion
Individual is not treated as an organizational insider with unique value in the work group, but there are other employees or groups who are insiders.
Assimilation
Individual is treated as an insider in the work group when he or she conforms to organizational/ dominant culture norms and downplays uniqueness.
High Value in Uniqueness
Differentiation
Individual is not treated as an organizational insider in the work group, but his or her unique characteristics are seen as valuable and required for group/organization success.
Inclusion
Individual is treated as an insider and also allowed/encouraged to retain uniqueness within the work group.
Source: Shore, L. M., Randel, A. E., Chung, B. G., Dean, M. A., Holcombe Ehrhard, K., & Singh, G. (2011). Inclusion and diversity in work groups: A review and model for future research. Journal of Management, 37(4), 1266.
The Assimilation quadrant (top right) represents people who feel they are insiders and in the organizational in-group but whose unique characteristics are not really valued by the organization. An example of assimilation could be a Native American college student who is 100% involved and accepted in the classroom but whose unique heritage is not acknowledged by the others, who expect him to give up that heritage to blend into the dominant group. In terms of diversity, assimilation represents an attempt by organizations to open their arms and bring everyone in; however, the same organizations can be faulted for failing to acknowledge the uniqueness of their members—they accept different individuals, but do not fully value them.
The Inclusion quadrant (lower right) describes individuals who feel they belong and are valued for their unique beliefs, attitudes, values, and background. This quadrant represents the optimal way to address diversity. It means, in short, accepting others and at the same time valuing them for who they are without requiring them to give up valued identities or cultural features (Ferdman, 1992). For example, inclusion occurs when students at a small rural high school welcome three new students who are Arabic refugees who have come to live with families in the area. The students establish an “international club” in which they learn Syrian from the new students while helping the Syrian students with their English and discuss one another’s culture. The social sciences teacher incorporated a research project on Syria for all his students based on a presentation that one of the Syrian students gave about his experiences. Another of the Syrian students is a gifted singer and is in the
311
choir, and the choir teacher asked her to pick out a song from her native country that the choir is learning to sing for its winter program. Most important of all, students at the school feel accepted, engaged, and comfortable. The camaraderie they have has produced a new sense of community.
Leadership Snapshot: Xerox Corporation
When Xerox named Ursula Burns its CEO in 2009, it became the first Fortune 500 company to have a successive female CEO. Burns’s ascendency to the top position at the $22 billion company is evidence of the diversity and inclusion efforts that began at Xerox more than 40 years before.
In 1964, as race riots were occurring near Xerox’s Rochester, New York, headquarters, the company’s founder, Joe Wilson, met with Black leaders and learned people were rioting because they didn’t have access to jobs. Xerox pledged to change that, sending out a company-wide directive, condemning racial discrimination, mandating minority recruitment, and holding managers responsible for the success of the minorities they hired (“Xerox a Success,” 1991). In addition, Xerox funded and provided consulting to a minority-owned and -operated plant in Rochester’s Black community, which made parts for Xerox, to provide jobs for the community’s unemployed (Friedman & Deinard, 1990).
312
Xerox’s program was about more than recruitment; it was about a company-wide commitment to diversity and inclusion on all levels from the manufacturing floor to the executive offices. By 1974, Xerox had increased its minority workforce from 3% to 14.6% (Friedman & Deinard, 1990).
It wasn’t as simple as hiring more Black employees however. Despite the company-wide mandate, Black employees at Xerox still experienced unequal treatment, especially when it came to promotions. In addition, Black employees weren’t part of the informal networks that White employees enjoyed where they shared support, information, and mentoring, which often inhibited the Black employees’ knowledge of job openings and promotion opportunities. Because of this, Black Xerox workers in various company locations began meeting together at one another’s homes as informal support groups. These Black caucuses not only advocated and fought for equal treatment for Black employees within the company, but they also created what would become a hallmark of the company’s Managing for Diversity program: minority caucus groups.
Caucus groups engage in self-advocacy, informing management on issues that keep minorities from progressing within the company. The company now has 6 caucus groups to meet the needs of employees who are Black, Hispanic, Asian, women, Black women, and LGBT.
By 1991, the company’s efforts had succeeded in increasing the minority ranks of Xerox’s U.S. workforce to 25.7%. Among its senior executives, 17% were minorities. But even though the program had been effective, there was more to be done. Only 8.5% of the company’s senior executives were women, and more minorities and women were employed in lower- and middle-level jobs than upper-level jobs. Burns, who is African American and was recruited by Xerox in 1980 as part of its summer minority internship program, said that back then the diversity efforts “didn’t extend to gender.
“We looked up one day, and all the African American men were doing better . . . they were leaders of the company. But there were very few women of any race. So we said, ‘Oh my God,’ then we have to do something about women,” says Burns. “What we’ve learned during that time is this idea of inclusion can’t be inclusion of one group. Because as soon as you focus on one group only, then you actually exclude the other groups” (Solman, 2014).
It was through a woman’s caucus group that Xerox management learned one obstacle in the way of women obtaining and retaining top positions in its manufacturing divisions was the rigid hours of shift schedules. These schedules made it difficult for women who were also primary caregivers to their children to work in manufacturing. Executives learned that “women weren’t dumb in manufacturing, [but] they need more flexibility” than the company allowed them, says Burns (Solman, 2014).
Today, Xerox has 140,000 employees and does business in more than 180 countries. In the United States, minorities make up 30.2% of the company’s workforce. Among company officials and managers, 22% are minorities, and minorities hold 18% of the company’s vice president positions. Women make up nearly 30% of the company’s vice presidents while the company’s U.S. workforce is 36% female (Xerox, 2016).
Xerox rose to dominance as maker of copy machines, but watched that market shrivel with competition from digital imaging. As a result, Xerox dramatically changed its business model. It is now in the business of client services and has become more globally oriented. In doing so, the company found that its suppliers, customers, and partners came from diverse cultures, backgrounds, and experiences. In order to be able to connect with them, Xerox had to connect with the diversity within its own ranks.
Xerox officials contend that its diversity has allowed the company to successfully shift to new markets because it is able to approach issues and challenges from different perspectives. “Xerox found out a while ago that including more of the resources of the world to attack problems or address opportunities is better than including fewer,” says Burns.
“The entire approach here is not to have diversity just because we think it’s a nice thing to do. It’s a good business result. The way to stay in front, if you are a tech company, is to engage as much difference and as much breadth as you can in thinking and approach and background and language and culture” (Solman, 2014)
313
The inclusion framework presented in Table 9.3 is useful for understanding ways to address diversity because it illustrates inclusion as an integration of two factors: (1) an individual’s connectedness (i.e., belonging) to others and (2) a person’s individuality (i.e., uniqueness). In addition, the inclusion framework is helpful because it underscores that differentiation focuses primarily on people’s differences and assimilation focuses primarily on people’s connectedness to the whole.
314
Diversity and Inclusion in Practice
315
Model of Inclusive Practices
Since inclusion is essential for integrating everyone into a group or organization, the next question is, how does the inclusion process work in practice?
Benefits of Diverse Leadership
To understand this process, Ferdman (2014) suggests treating inclusion as a multilevel process centered on each individual’s experience of inclusion. Simply put, inclusion exists when individuals experience it. This occurs as a result of inclusion practices on many levels, including interpersonal, group, leader, organizational, and societal (see Figure 9.1). Ferdman’s framework illustrates how inclusion at one level is related to the way inclusion is practiced at other levels.
As shown at the top of the model in Figure 9.1, the way a society or community thinks about and addresses inclusion affects the way an individual experiences it. For example, if the city commission in a community such as Dearborn, Michigan, which has a large percentage of Arab Americans, were to promote the recognition of the Muslim holy month of Ramadan, then Dearborn residents of Middle Eastern descent might feel that their Muslim heritage is being valued and recognized.
Moving down the model, organizational policies and practices also influence the inclusion experience. For instance, if a new employee training program at a retail store fosters acceptance of customers who are lesbian, gay, bisexual, or transgender, it may help these customers feel welcome shopping at the store.
At the leadership level, which is indispensable to promoting inclusion at all levels, leaders need to set the tone for inclusion and hold followers accountable for inclusion practices. For example, if, during a staff meeting of a department that is predominantly male, the department head gives a disgruntled female staff member time to voice her opinions to the others, that staff member will feel that her opinions matter. It will also model to the group’s members how to listen to others and value their opinions, even if those opinions are different from their own.
Figure 9.1 Systems of Inclusion: A Multilevel Analytic Framework
316
Source: Adapted from Ferdman, B. M. (2014). The practice of inclusion in diverse organizations. In B. M. Ferdman, & B. R. Deane (Eds.), Diversity at work: The practice of inclusion (pp. 3–54). San Francisco, CA: Wiley.
Challenges for Women in Leadership
Another form of inclusion occurs at the group level. Groups promote inclusion when they establish enabling norms that give everyone in the group an equal chance to voice his or her opinion, acknowledge and respect individuals’ differences, promote collaborative work on tasks, and address conflicts productively. There is an old axiom regarding people in groups: “By the group are you sickened, by the group are you healed.” When a group is functioning inclusively, it is positive to group members, not toxic. The members feel accepted, comfortable, unique, valued, and inspirited. This is the strength of inclusive group practices.
The interpersonal level is perhaps the most common place where inclusive practices are played out. Through our interpersonal communication with others, we let them know our need to be included, our willingness to include others, and our willingness to have others
317
include us. For example, a first-year foreign student living on campus may want her roommate to invite her to parties, but when the roommate does invite her, the student makes an excuse for not being able to attend. The student expresses a need to be included, but when she is included, the student becomes uncomfortable and wants to pull back. Interpersonal inclusion happens when we ask others for their opinions and are interested in who they are, but still enable them to maintain their personal space as individuals.
The individual inclusion experience is the foundation of the framework illustrated in Figure 9.1. Ferdman, Barrera, Allen, and Vuong (2009) describe this experience “as the degree to which individuals feel safe, trusted, accepted, respected, supported, valued, fulfilled, engaged, and authentic in their working environment, both as individuals and as members of particular identity groups” (p. 6). The experience of individual inclusion is affected by the inclusion practices at other levels, and individual inclusion can also impact these other levels (see Figure 9.1).
To understand how the different levels of inclusion in the framework can influence the other levels, consider, for example, in the United States, same-sex marriage has been legalized, giving same-sex couples the same legal rights as those in heterosexual marriages. This can influence other inclusive practices down the line. At the organizational level, this new legal status allows same-sex couples the same benefits as heterosexual couples, such as health insurance and family leave. If the leader of an organization engages in inclusive practices of same-sex couples, such as encouraging same-sex couples to openly attend organizational events together and inviting them to dinner with other staff members and their spouses, that leader is modeling inclusive behavior for his followers. At the group level, the coworkers of same-sex spouses host a baby shower when the same-sex couple welcomes a child into their family. On the interpersonal level, coworkers will talk with the same-sex spouse about her partner, and establish bonds the same as they would with another coworker. Finally, you can see how this inclusion would lead to the same-sex spouse feeling that her sexual orientation and her marriage are accepted and respected by those with whom she works every day. As a result, she feels her opinions and input are valued because she is not regarded in a negative way or as different by others because of her sexual orientation. Inclusion comes from the top down—starting with society and community and ending with the individual.
As shown in Figure 9.1, Ferdman’s framework also identifies that the influence of inclusion travels back up the levels from individual to societal. The same-sex couple example from above also works to show this upward influence of inclusion. Because the individual described above feels accepted and respected, she is more likely to engage in inclusive behaviors with others who are different from her. Through their example, same-sex couples inclusive behaviors can help foster acceptance and respect for others among the members of groups to which the individuals belong. If a group’s majority is engaged in inclusive behaviors, it can influence its leaders to adopt those same inclusive practices. To illustrate this, we will again use an example of an individual in a same-sex relationship who wants to
318
have the same health and leave benefits as her married coworkers. This coworker talks about her desires with other members of her department, who are accepting of her relationship. As a result, at a department meeting, the employees approach their leader about changing the company’s benefit policy to include same-sex couples. The boss takes the matter to his superiors, and ultimately the issue is put before the company’s owners, who adopt the policy. As a result of the company’s acceptance of same-sex couples, the community in which the company operates is influenced by the company’s inclusive practices. Because of the company’s inclusive practices, more gay and lesbian employees may choose to join the company, which will bring more same-sex couples into the community. As same-sex couples become engaged in the community as neighbors, friends, and community members, the society around them will become more accepting and respecting of same-sex relationships.
While this example shows that inclusion can and should happen at many levels, as a leader, the challenge is to foster that sense of inclusion among one’s followers as well as influence the organization’s approach to diversity and inclusion. In the next section, we discuss some practices leaders can engage in that help to do just that.
319
Leader Practices That Advance Diversity and Inclusion
A questionnaire to measure inclusion in work groups developed by Ferdman and his colleagues (Ferdman, 2014; Ferdman et al., 2009; Hirshberg & Ferdman, 2011) identified six key components of the experience of inclusion (see Table 9.4). Components are like the ingredients of inclusion. When followers experience these components, they feel included. These components provide a good blueprint for actions and behaviors and communication that leaders should engage in to provide inclusion for others.
1. Feeling Safe
To help individuals feel safe, it is important for leaders to treat followers in nonthreatening ways. In situations where one person feels different from others, the leader plays a fundamental role in letting that person know that he or she will not be hurt physically or psychologically if his or her ideas differ from others and that he or she will not be ridiculed or criticized for expressing these ideas. Even if a person’s opinions go directly against the majority opinion, that individual can feel safe that he or she will not experience negative repercussions. Leaders need to communicate with each of their followers in such a way that all of them feel they are a part of the whole. It is a safe feeling for individuals to know they will not be rejected by the group for their uniqueness.
Feeling Safe
Table 9.4 Components of the Inclusion Experience Table 9.4 Components of the Inclusion Experience
Components Examples
1
Feeling Safe
• Do I help others feel physically and psychologically safe?
• Do I help others feel like they are a full member of the group?
• Do I help others express opposing opinions without fear of negative repercussion?
• Do I treat others as full participants—as
320
2
Feeling Involved and Engaged
insiders?
• Do I give others access to information and resources to do their work?
• Do I help others feel like they are part of our team?
3
Feeling Respected and Valued
• Do I treat others as I would like to be treated myself?
• Do I let others know I trust and care about them?
• Do I treat others like they are a valued group member?
4
Feeling Influential
• Do I let others’ ideas and perspectives influence the group?
• Do I let others participate in decision making?
• Do I listen to others’ perspectives on substantive issues?
5
Feeling Authentic and Whole
• Do I allow others to be truly themselves in the group?
• Do I let others know they can be completely open with the group?
• Do I encourage others to be honest and transparent?
6
Recognizing, Attending to, and Honoring Diversity
• Do I treat everyone fairly without discrimination?
• Do I let others know I trust and care about them?
• Do I encourage others to be honest and transparent?
Source: Adapted from Ferdman, B. M. (2014). The practice of inclusion in diverse organizations. In B. M. Ferdman & B. R. Deane (Eds.), Diversity at work: The practice of inclusion (pp. 3–54). San Francisco, CA: Wiley.
321
2. Feeling Involved and Engaged
In addition to a feeling of safety, inclusion comes from feeling involved and engaged. Helping followers find this feeling is a challenge for leaders, but worthwhile because engaged and involved followers are more productive and satisfied. It is inspiriting to be around them. Leaders must find ways to help individuals become involved and immersed in the larger group’s efforts. When an individual likes her work, participates freely in it, and enjoys being a part of the team, she is more likely to feel involved and engaged. As discussed in Chapter 3, “Engaging Strengths,” recognizing people’s strengths is a wonderful way for leaders to help followers feel engaged. In addition, leaders should treat followers as if they are insiders, as people who are important and deserve to know what is going on within the organization. Leaders need to share information freely so that followers feel like full participants in the workings of the group or organization. People feel involved and engaged when they know they are full-fledged group members and that their participation matters.
3. Feeling Respected and Valued
Practicing the Golden Rule—“Treat others as you would like to be treated”—is at the core of how leaders can help followers feel respected and valued. When leaders put themselves in the shoes of their followers, they can get in touch with what it means to be well thought of, worthy, and wanted. None of us like to be judged, stereotyped, ridiculed, singled out, disconfirmed, ignored, or belittled. Followers want to feel that they belong and are connected to the group, that the leader trusts and cares about them, and that they are intrinsic to the group.
Women in Leadership
4. Feeling Influential
Another component contributing to the inclusion experience is a feeling of having influence. All of us have unique ideas and positions on issues. When people express their ideas and are heard, they feel like they exist and that they are meaningful. When an individual is in a staff meeting and others listen to his or her ideas, it makes that individual feel significant. If that person’s comments influence the direction of the group, it really makes the person feel significant. We all want to be influential, to put our stamp on things, to touch the world and have our efforts mean something.
It is critically important for leaders to recognize that followers have a need to have an
322
impact—to express themselves in a way that affects others. Effective leaders help followers feel influential when they recognize that followers want to be heard and have an impact. Letting followers participate in important organizational discussions and acknowledging their comments and suggestions as substantive and valuable makes those followers feel influential. Another way of allowing followers to feel influential is by including them in the decision making of a group. When followers are able to participate in decisions, they feel a sense of significance; they feel agency. To have agency is to affect the process, to feel alive, to feel influential. It is having agency that helps followers to feel included.
5. Feeling Authentic and Whole
In any group or organization, there is always a certain amount of pressure to assimilate to that group or organization’s mission, norms, and values. This pressure creates tension within individuals because in order to be accepted with the larger group, they often find it necessary to hide or downplay unique characteristics of themselves or the group with whom they identify. For example, to be accepted as an autoworker at a Ford plant in Detroit, an individual might try to hide the fact that he or she drives a foreign-made car. Or, if your partner’s parents are quite liberal and against the National Rifle Association’s stance on gun rights, you might not want to disclose to them that you are an avid hunter and longtime NRA member.
This tension between wanting to be yourself while also wanting to be a part of the group can be counterproductive to one’s feeling authentic and whole. Leaders can address this tension for followers by creating an atmosphere where individuals feel free to be as honest and transparent as they are comfortable being. To be transparent and authentic, followers need to feel trust from the leader. Leaders need to establish environments where being fully transparent with one another is rewarded and not punished. When you are in this kind of group or organization, you feel unique and connected at the same time. It is a situation where assimilating to the larger entity does not require losing one’s own sense of self.
For example, Angie is a multiracial college student at a small private university who, because of her very light skin color, knows that most of her fellow students assume she is White. Even though she is very involved in campus activities, the topic of her race rarely comes up, and Angie doesn’t feel a need to discuss it with other students. However, she often wants to speak up when she hears students making biased or stereotypical comments based on ethnicity, but doesn’t do so. The college’s president recently asked Angie to join the school’s antiracism committee representing students of color on the campus. Angie is hesitant to do so because it would mean being open about her race, which could change how some of the other students treat her. However, she also knows that she would be more true to herself if she did participate on the committee, because she could effect change in some of the racist attitudes on campus. The president has talked with her at length about the importance of being acknowledged by others for her unique multiracial perspective,
323
encouraging her to be authentic and transparent with others. He has expressed that he believes because she is already a very respected and active member of the campus community, she would be influential in helping the other students to embrace change regarding racism.
6. Recognizing, Attending to, and Honoring Diversity
The last component of the inclusion experience is directly related to leaders and diversity. In any group or organization, people want to be treated fairly; they do not want to be discriminated against because of their social identity or the identity of their social groups. As a leader, each of us has the responsibility to be fair-minded and open-minded toward all of our followers. But dealing with diversity is not just about fairness. It is also about acknowledging differences and fully embracing them even if it produces conflict. Leaders need to work through conflicts related to differences in mutually beneficial ways. Last, leaders need to be attentive to recognizing the ways people differ and honoring the individuality of each of them.
324
Barriers to Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
Unfortunately, in the effort to successfully embrace diversity and inclusion, a leader can run into four common barriers—both on an individual level and on an organizational level— that can hinder this: ethnocentrism, prejudice, stereotypes, and privilege. Leaders must confront these barriers head-on in order to effectively address diversity and develop inclusion in their organization.
Ethnocentrism
As the word suggests, ethnocentrism is the tendency for individuals to place their own group (ethnic, racial, or cultural) at the center of their observations of others and the world. Ethnocentrism is the perception that one’s own culture is better or more natural than the culture of others. Because people tend to give priority and value to their own beliefs, attitudes, and values over and above those of other groups, they often fail to recognize the unique perspectives of others. Ethnocentrism is a universal tendency, and each of us is ethnocentric to some degree.
Ethnocentrism is a perceptual window through which people make subjective or critical evaluations of people from cultures other than their own (Porter & Samovar, 1997). For example, some Americans think that the democratic principles of the United States are superior to the political beliefs of other countries; they often fail to understand the complexities of other cultures. Ethnocentrism accounts for our tendency to think our own cultural values and ways of doing things are right and natural (Gudykunst & Kim, 1997).
Ethnocentrism can be a major obstacle to effective leadership because it prevents people from fully understanding or respecting the viewpoints of others. For example, if a person’s culture values individual achievement, it may be difficult for that person to understand someone from a culture that emphasizes collectivity (i.e., people working together as a whole). Similarly, if a person believes strongly in respecting authority, that person may find it difficult to understand someone who challenges authority or does not easily defer to authority figures. The more ethnocentric we are, the less open or tolerant we are of other people’s cultural traditions or practices.
A skilled leader cannot avoid issues related to ethnocentrism. A leader must recognize his or her own ethnocentrism, as well as understand—and to a degree tolerate—the ethnocentrism of others. In reality, it is a balancing act for leaders. On the one hand, leaders need to promote and be confident in their own ways of doing things; on the other, they need to be sensitive to the legitimacy of the ways of other cultures. Skilled leaders are able to negotiate the fine line between trying to overcome ethnocentrism and knowing when to remain grounded in their own cultural values.
325
Prejudice
Closely related to ethnocentrism is prejudice. Prejudice is a largely fixed attitude, belief, or emotion held by an individual about another individual or group that is based on faulty or unsubstantiated data. Prejudice refers to judgments we make about others based on previous decisions or experiences and involves inflexible generalizations that are resistant to change or evidence to the contrary (Ponterotto & Pedersen, 1993).
Prejudice
Prejudice often is thought of in the context of race or ethnicity (e.g., European American vs. African American), but it also applies in areas such as gender, age, sexual orientation, and other independent contexts. Although prejudice can be positive (e.g., thinking highly of another culture without sufficient evidence such as “the Swiss are the best skiers”), it is usually negative (e.g., “women are too emotional”).
As with ethnocentrism, we all hold prejudices to some degree. Sometimes our prejudices allow us to keep our partially fixed attitudes undisturbed and constant. Sometimes prejudice can reduce people’s anxiety because it gives them a familiar way to structure their observations of others. One of the main problems with prejudice is that it is self-oriented rather than other-oriented. It helps us to achieve balance for ourselves at the expense of others. Moreover, attitudes of prejudice inhibit understanding by creating a screen that limits one’s ability to see multiple aspects and qualities of other people. Prejudice is often expressed in crude or demeaning comments that people make about others. Both ethnocentrism and prejudice interfere with our ability to understand and appreciate the human experience of others.
In addition to fighting their own prejudices, leaders face the challenge of dealing with the prejudice of their followers. These prejudices can be toward the leader or the leader’s culture. Furthermore, it is not uncommon for a leader to have followers who represent several culturally different groups that have their own prejudices toward each other. Prejudice can result in advantages for some groups over others and in systemic discrimination, which occurs when patterns of discriminatory behavior, policies, or practices become a part of an organization and continue to perpetuate disadvantage to those being discriminated against. Systemic discrimination can have a broad impact on an industry, profession, or geographic area.
A skilled leader needs to think about, recognize, and address when systemic discrimination exists within his or her organization and find ways to create inclusion with followers and groups who exhibit a multitude of differences.
326
Stereotypes
A stereotype is a fixed belief held by an individual that classifies a group of people with a similar characteristic as alike. Stereotypes allow people to respond to complex information and make meaning from it by either generalizing it or putting a blanket category around it. It is a way of processing information quickly.
Stereotypes label a group of individuals as the same at the expense of recognizing the uniqueness of each individual. Labeling everyone the same results in assuming things about some individuals that are not true. Stereotypes provide a way to generalize information, but during the process, “overgeneralizing” can occur, and individuals may get labeled with characteristics or qualities that do not apply to them. For example, if you say, “Nightshift workers are lazy,” you are characterizing every worker who works that shift as lazy, when in fact it may be only one or two workers. If you stereotype the members of a certain ethnic or cultural group as terrorists, you may be correct for some individuals in that group, but not all of them.
In a small way, stereotypes can be useful. Stereotypes can reduce uncertainty in some situations because they provide partial information to us about others. For example, if you see some people wearing jerseys for the New England Patriots and you are also a Patriots fan, you will feel comfortable sitting next to them at a Patriots football game. You already assume, based on their clothing, that they have beliefs similar to yours. Similarly, if you tell your parents, who are of Dutch heritage, that they’ll like your new partner because she is a “good Dutch woman,” you are using a positive stereotype that will give your parents some information about your partner. This kind of stereotype provides limited information and begs to be challenged with phrases such as “What else can you tell me about this person?” Each individual is much more than a stereotype, so we must constantly challenge our mental assessments to look for the unique qualities of every person.
For leaders, stereotypes are a barrier to diversity and inclusion because stereotypes categorize individual followers into a single classification, which prevents the leader from seeing each individual’s unique merits and qualifications. Because stereotypes are a mental shortcut, leaders can avoid thinking more deeply about individual followers. For example, if a college professor who teaches three classes labels one class as “a good class” and the other two as “bad classes” based on experiences he has had with some students in those classes, the stereotype will prevent him from seeing the many good qualities of individuals in the “bad” classes and also the negative qualities of the students in the “good” class.
Stereotypes have a significant impact on how leaders treat followers. To include followers and embrace them fully, leaders need to be attentive and open to the individual nuances of each of their followers. For Jane Doe to be included requires more than recognition of her gender. It requires understanding that she is a single mom with four kids, a part-time college student, a wife who lost her husband in the Iraq War, and a woman who is
327
struggling with breast cancer. Calling Jane Doe a woman classifies her, but fails completely in accurately describing the uniqueness of her situation. When leaders stereotype followers, they box them in and trap them under simplistic and empty labels.
Privilege
A final barrier to inclusion is privilege. Privilege is an advantage held by a person or group that is based on age, race, ethnicity, gender, class, or some other cultural dimension, which gives those who have it power over those who don’t. Privilege has been described as an unfair advantage that some people have in comparison to others. In situations where it exists, privilege excludes others and puts them at a disadvantage. For example, in many countries around the world, privileged people in the ruling class have political, economic, and social power over the poor, who are exploited and lack opportunities to transcend their circumstances. Or, to consider another example, during the Jim Crow period in the United States, privileged White citizens had power over Black citizens, and as a result, Black citizens suffered tremendously on all levels from employment and economics to education. Privilege is something that often goes unrecognized by those who have it, but usually is very apparent to those who do not have it.
Because privilege is a barrier to inclusion, leaders need to be introspective and determine if they are privileged in some way in comparison to others, including their followers. Because leadership involves a power differential between the leader and followers, leaders can often be blinded to the privilege they have. In addition, privilege can be very difficult for those without it to address because leaders may deny they have privilege or not acknowledge it because they do not want to weaken their power.
Those with privilege sometimes argue that the status and power they have is not privilege. Rather, they believe it is the result of their hard work, competence, and experience. For example, individuals who are born to affluent parents and go to good schools are likely to land good jobs when they graduate from college (Rivera, 2015). If one were to challenge privileged individuals about their privilege, they might say they obtained a good job because they worked hard and put in long hours. Rivera (2015) points out that it is often the connections that privileged individuals have with others of influence that lead them to find better jobs.
Unfortunately, those with privilege are many times unaware of how that privilege makes their lives different from the lives of those without privilege. Some people may believe that those in poverty are lazy and undeserving because they have not worked hard enough to pull themselves out of their circumstances. They may not be aware that poverty is a difficult condition to transcend. For example, imagine being the mother of two children, and as the result of a car accident, your spouse has developed a chronic health condition that keeps him from working and requires he have constant care. His medical bills wipe out any extra money you have. Even with welfare and disability income, it’s a struggle to make rent and
328
utility payments and buy enough food to feed your family. You want to work, but you can only work during school hours on weekdays when your children are in school. You do not have a car, so you must walk or take public transportation, which limits how far away your job can be from your home. Any small thing can upset the fragile balance you have established: a trip to the doctor, an unexpected bill, an increase in expenses. The road out of poverty for this mother and her family seems nearly impossible. Her situation seems so intractable that no amount of motivation or hard work could resolve it.
Privilege
Having privilege blinds individuals to the experience of the underprivileged. Without the ability to understand, without judgment, individuals and their unique situations, leaders end up excluding rather than including them.
Collectively, the barriers to embracing diversity and inclusion (i.e., ethnocentrism, prejudice, stereotypes, and privilege) underscore the difficulty in accepting and confirming those who are different from ourselves. Leaders must not only address these barriers as they occur with their followers, but must also take a critical look at their own biases regarding diversity and work to eliminate these barriers in their own lives. As we have learned from Ferdman’s framework, inclusion is a fluid process and must occur at the individual as well as societal level.
329
Summary
This chapter discusses how leaders can embrace diversity and inclusion in their organizations. Diversity plays a seminal role in effective leadership; it is defined as the differing individuals in a group or organization. Inclusion is defined as the process of incorporating others who are different into a group or organization in a way that allows them to feel they are part of the whole. Diversity focuses on recognizing differences, and inclusion is concerned with embracing those differences.
The historical development of workplace diversity in the United States has emerged over three periods. The early years (1960s and 1970s), which included the creation of landmark equal employment laws, focused on discrimination and fairness. Second, the era of valuing diversity (1980s and 1990s) emphasized pluralism and the competitive advantages of diversity in the workplace. Third, the era of diversity management and inclusion in the 21st century (2000 to present) emphasizes acknowledging, valuing, and integrating people’s differences into the organization and places inclusion at center stage in addressing concerns about diversity.
An inclusion framework was developed by researchers to describe how the process of inclusion works. This framework illustrates inclusion as an interaction of an individual’s levels of belongingness (i.e., the desire to be connected) and uniqueness (i.e., the desire to maintain one’s own identity). For leaders, managing diversity is about managing the tension followers experience between connectedness and individuality. The individual experience of inclusion occurs as a result of inclusion practices on many levels, including interpersonal, group, leader, organizational, and societal. Inclusion travels from the societal level down to the individual and back up the levels from the individual to societal.
Researchers have identified six components of the inclusion experience that provide a blueprint of how leaders should behave and communicate to provide inclusion for followers. To help followers feel safe, leaders need to treat them in nonthreatening ways. To help followers feel involved and engaged, leaders should recognize followers’ strengths and let them know they are full-fledged members of the organization. To help followers feel respected and valued, leaders should practice the Golden Rule and show trust and care for followers. To help followers feel influential, leaders should recognize followers’ need to have an impact on others and enable them to participate in decision making. To help followers feel authentic and whole, leaders should create an atmosphere where followers can feel free to be as honest and transparent as they are comfortable being. Finally, to help followers feel recognized, attended to, and honored, leaders should exhibit open-mindedness toward all followers, honoring the individuality of each of them.
Barriers that can inhibit leaders and followers from embracing diversity are ethnocentrism, prejudice, stereotypes, and privilege. The challenge for leaders is to remove or mitigate these
330
barriers. Although addressing diversity is an interactive process between leaders and followers, the burden of effectively addressing diversity and building inclusion rests squarely on the shoulders of the leader. Effective leaders recognize the importance of diversity and make it a focal point of their leadership.
331
Glossary Terms
assimilation 188 differentiation 190 diversity 184 ethnocentrism 201 inclusion 185 melting pot 188 multiculturalism 187 pluralism 189 prejudice 202 privilege 204 stereotypes 203 systemic discrimination 202
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
332
9.1 Case Study: What’s in a Name? Springfield High School’s athletic teams have been called the Redskins since the school opened in 1944. The small town of 7,000, which is roughly 95% White, is located in an area of the Midwest that once had thriving Native American tribes, a fact the community is proud to promote in its tourism brochures. So when the members of a local family with Native American ancestry came before the school board to ask that the name of Springfield High School’s athletic teams be changed because they found the use of the word Redskins to be offensive, it created a firestorm in the town.
The school’s athletic teams had competed as Redskins for 70 years, and many felt the name was an integral part of the community. People personally identified with the Redskins, and the team and the team’s name were ingrained in the small town’s culture. Flags with the Redskins logo flew outside homes and businesses, and decals with the image of the smiling Redskins mascot adorned many car windows.
“Locals would come before the board and say, ‘I was born a Redskin and I’ll die a Redskin,’” recalls one board member. “They argued that the name was never intended to be offensive, that it was chosen for the teams before ‘political correctness’ was a thing, and that it honored the area’s relatively strong Native American presence.”
But several other local Native American families and individuals also came forward in support of changing the name. One pointed out that “the use of the word Redskin is essentially a racial slur, and as a racial slur, it needs to be changed.” The issue drew national attention, and speakers came in from outside the state to discuss the negative ramifications of Native American mascots.
However, the opposition to change was fierce. T-shirts and bumper stickers started appearing around town sporting the slogans “I’m a Redskin and Proud” and “Don’t tell me I’m not a Redskin.” At board meetings, those in favor of keeping the name would boo and talk over those speaking in favor of changing it, and argue that speakers who weren’t from Springfield shouldn’t even be allowed to be at the board meetings.
The board ultimately approved a motion, 5-2, to have the students at Springfield High School choose a new name for their athletic teams. The students immediately embraced the opportunity to choose a new name, developing designs and logos for their proposed choices. In the end, the student body voted to become the Redhawks.
There was still an angry community contingent, however, that was festering over the change. They began a petition to recall the school board members and received enough signatures for the recall to be put up for an election.
“While the kids are going about the business of changing the name and the emblem, the community holds an election and proceeds to recall the five members of the board who voted in favor of it,” one of the recalled board members said.
The remaining two board members, both of whom were ardent members of the athletic booster organization, held a special meeting of the board (all two of them) and voted to change the name back to the Redskins.
That’s when the state Department of Civil Rights and the state’s Commission for High School Athletics stepped in. They told the Springfield School Board there could not be a reversal of the name change and that the high school’s teams would have to go for four years without one, competing only as Springfield.
Over the course of those four years, new school board members were elected, and the issue quieted down. At the end of that period, the students again voted to become the Springfield Redhawks. “You know, the kids were fine with it,” says one community member. “It’s been ten years, and there’s an entire generation of kids who don’t have a clue that it was ever different. They are Redhawks and have always been
333
Redhawks.
“It was the adults who had the problem. There’s still a small contingent today that can’t get over it. A local hardware store still sells Springfield Redskins T-shirts and other gear. There is just this group of folks who believe there was nothing disrespectful in the Redskins name.”
334
Questions 1. Do you agree with the assertion the athletic team name should be changed? 2. Describe how Ferdman’s model of inclusion practices (Table 9.4) worked in this case. Did the
influence for inclusive practices travel both up and down the model? 3. What barriers to embracing diversity and inclusion did the school board and community experience
in this case? 4. Using the inclusion framework in Table 9.3, where would you place the Native American residents
in the town of Springfield? What about Native American students at Springfield High School? 5. By changing the name of the athletic teams, do you believe the school board was showing inclusive
practices? If so, which ones? 6. What role does privilege play in the resistance of community members to change the athletic teams’
name?
335
9.2 Cultural Diversity Awareness Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your attitudes and perspectives regarding cultural diversity 2. To help you become aware of and understand your prejudices and biases 3. To help you understand the potential consequences of your approach to diversity in the workplace
Directions
1. Read each statement and circle the number that best describes your belief or behavior. 2. Be as candid as possible with your responses; there are no right or wrong answers.
Almost Never
Never Sometimes Almost Always
Always
1. I am aware of my own biases and how they affect my thinking.
1 2 3 4 5
2. I can honestly assess my strengths and weaknesses in the area of diversity and try to improve myself.
1 2 3 4 5
3. I assume good intent and ask for clarification when I don’t understand what was said or implied.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I challenge others when they make racial/ethnic/sexually offensive comments or jokes.
1 2 3 4 5
5. I speak up if I witness another person being humiliated or discriminated against.
1 2 3 4 5
6. I do not participate in jokes that are derogatory to any individual group.
1 2 3 4 5
7. I don’t believe that my having a friend of color means that I’m culturally competent.
1 2 3 4 5
8. I understand why a lack of diversity in my social circle may be perceived as excluding others.
1 2 3 4 5
9. I realize that people of other cultures have a need to support one another and connect as a group.
1 2 3 4 5
10. I do not make assumptions about a person
336
or individual group until I have verified the facts on my own.
1 2 3 4 5
11. I have multiple friends from a variety of ethnicities and abilities.
1 2 3 4 5
12. I connect easily with people who look different than me and am able to communicate easily with them.
1 2 3 4 5
13. I’m interested in the ideas and beliefs of people who don’t think and believe as I do, and I respect their opinions even when I disagree.
1 2 3 4 5
14. I work to make sure people who are different from me are heard and accepted.
1 2 3 4 5
15. I recognize and avoid language that reinforces stereotypes.
1 2 3 4 5
16. I know others’ stereotypes associated with my ethnicity.
1 2 3 4 5
17. I encourage People culturally different from myself to speak out on their issues and concerns and I validate their issues and concerns.
1 2 3 4 5
18. I avoid assuming that others will have the same reaction as me when discussing or viewing an issue.
1 2 3 4 5
19. I understand that I’m a product of my upbringing and believe there are valid beliefs other than my own.
1 2 3 4 5
20. I do not take physical characteristics into account when interacting with others or when making decisions about others’ competence or ability.
1 2 3 4 5
21. I recognize that others stereotype me and I try to overcome their perceptions.
1 2 3 4 5
22. I include people culturally different from myself in team decision-making processes that impact them.
1 2 3 4 5
23. I actively seek opportunities to connect with people different than me and seek to build rapport with them.
1 2 3 4 5
337
24. I believe “color blindness” is counterproductive and devalues a person’s culture or history.
1 2 3 4 5
25. I avoid generalizing behaviors or attitudes of one individual in a group to others.
1 2 3 4 5
26. I actively convey that employees or students of varying backgrounds are as skilled and competent as others.
1 2 3 4 5
27. I do not try to justify acts of discrimination to make the victim feel better. I validate his/her assessment of what occurred.
1 2 3 4 5
28. I try to learn about and appreciate the richness of other cultures and honor their holidays and events.
1 2 3 4 5
29. I believe there are policies and practices in place that negatively impact people outside the majority culture.
1 2 3 4 5
30. I understand the definition of internalized racism and how it impacts people of color.
1 2 3 4 5
31. I believe that race is a social construct, not a scientific fact.
1 2 3 4 5
32. I know and accept that [people’s] experiences and background impact how they interact and trust me.
1 2 3 4 5
Source: Adapted from Special Populations and CTE Illinois Leadership Project. (2016). Cultural Diversity Self-Assessment. Retrieved from http://illinoiscte.org/index.php/resources/cultural- competency-module
Scoring Sum the numbers you circled on the questionnaire. This number is your cultural diversity awareness score.
Total Score Cultural diversity awareness score: ________
Scoring Interpretation
This self-assessment is designed to measure your beliefs and behavior regarding cultural diversity and inclusion. A higher score on the assessment indicates that you are acutely aware of prejudice and bias, and that you are very aware of the impact of your behavior on others. Individuals who score high relate to others in ways that value diversity. A lower score on the assessment suggests that you are unaware of prejudice and bias, and that you are not fully aware of the impact of your biased behavior on others. Individuals who score low communicate with others in ways that do not value diversity.
338
If your score is 130–160, you are in the very high range. If your score is 100–129, you are in the high range. If your score is 70–99, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 40–69, you are in the low range. If your score is 0–39, you are in the very low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
339
9.3 Observational Exercise
340
Diversity and Inclusion
Purpose
1. To become aware of the dimensions of diversity and inclusion 2. To develop an understanding of how leaders address diversity and inclusion in the workplace
Directions
1. Your task in this exercise is to interview a leader about her or his views on diversity and inclusion. The individual you interview should have a formal position of authority in a company (e.g., supervisor, manager), a school (e.g., teacher, principal), or the community (e.g., director of social work, bank vice president, small business owner).
2. Conduct a 30-minute semistructured interview with this individual by phone or in person. 3. Develop your own interview questions. If necessary, you may incorporate ideas from the following
questions:
Tell me about your job. How long have you held this position, and how did you get it? What comes to your mind when you hear the word diversity? How is diversity addressed within your organization? How important do you think diversity is in your place of work? Why? Are there areas within your organization that have less diversity than other areas? Do you think the organization should address this? What challenges do you face regarding diversity among those whom you supervise? How do you treat employees/followers who are different from others? Do you allow everyone to participate in decision making? What is the best way to make an employee/follower who is a minority feel genuinely included with others?
Questions 1. Based on your observations, how important is diversity and inclusion to the leader you interviewed? 2. Which metaphor in Table 9.2 (i.e., melting pot, salad, or smorgasbord) would you use to describe
the way the leader approaches his or her followers? Give examples to illustrate this metaphor. 3. Do you think the leader holds any stereotypes about others? In what way do these affect his or her
leadership? 4. In what way does the leader try to make individuals who are different feel a part of the organization?
Give specific examples where relevant. 5. Do you think privilege is in any way related to how this person leads? Defend your answer.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
341
9.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
342
Diversity and Inclusion
Reflection
1. What is your response to the word diversity? Do you think it is a significant problem in our society, or do you think it is overemphasized? Explain your thoughts on diversity.
2. Reflect on the six primary dimensions of cultural diversity shown in Table 9.1 (i.e., age, gender, race, mental and physical abilities, ethnicity, and sexual orientation). Which type of diversity is easiest for you to embrace, and which is hardest for you to embrace? Why? Explain your answers.
3. One way to explore the concept of inclusion is to reflect on your own personal feelings about inclusion. In a group situation, how much do you want to be included by others? Using a personal example, discuss a time when you were in a group or on a team when you felt included by others and a time when you felt excluded. Why did you feel included in one situation and not the other? Elaborate and discuss.
4. Think about what circumstances got you to where you are today. Do you have a past that some would describe as privileged? Or, would you say you are not privileged? Do you see your colleagues or coworkers as having privilege? Discuss your thoughts on privilege.
Action
1. Explore your answers on the Cultural Diversity Awareness Questionnaire. Select three items on which you chose almost never or never. Based on your responses to these items, discuss what you could do in your own leadership to be more inclusive toward others.
2. Imagine for a moment that you have been selected to lead a group service-learning project. What will you say to make others in your group feel psychologically safe? In what way will you let them participate in decision making? How will you encourage those individuals who are most different from the group to feel like insiders yet still unique? Discuss.
3. As discussed in the chapter, stereotypes often get in the way of including others who differ from us. What common stereotypes do you sometimes attribute to others (e.g., a White male police officer, a Muslim woman wearing a hijab, or a transgender man)? How can you change these stereotypes? What messages will you give yourself to eliminate these stereotypes? Discuss.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
343
References Blaine, B. E. (2013). Understanding the psychology of diversity (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks,
CA: Sage.
Booysen, L. (2014). The development of inclusive leadership practice and processes. In B. M. Ferdman & B. R. Deane (Eds.), Diversity at work: The practice of inclusion (pp. 296–329). San Francisco, CA: Wiley.
Brewer, M. B. (1991). The social self: On being the same and different at the same time. Personality and Social Psychology Bulletin, 17(5), 475–482.
Dishman, L. (2015, May 18). Millennials have a different definition of diversity and inclusion. Fast Company. Retrieved from http://www.fastcompany.com/3046358/the- new-rules-of-work/millennials-have-a-different-definition-of-diversity-and-inclusion
Ferdman, B. M. (1992). The dynamics of ethnic diversity in organizations: Toward integrative models. In K. Kelly (Ed.), Issues, Theory, and Research in Industrial/Organizational Psychology (pp. 339-384). Amsterdam, The Netherlands: Elsevier Science Publishers.
Ferdman, B. M. (2014). The practice of inclusion in diverse organizations. In B. M. Ferdman & B. R. Deane (Eds.), Diversity at work: The practice of inclusion (pp. 3–54). San Francisco, CA: Wiley.
Ferdman, B. M., Barrera, V., Allen, A., & Vuong, V. (2009, August). Inclusive behaviors and the experience of inclusion. In B. G. Chung (Chair), Inclusion in organizations: Measures, HR practices, and climate. Symposium presented at the 69th Annual Meeting of the Academy of Management, Chicago.
Ferdman, B. M., & Deane, B. R. (Eds.). (2014). Diversity at work: The practice of inclusion. San Francisco, CA: Wiley.
Friedman, R. A. & Deinard, C. (1990). Black Caucus Groups at Xerox Corporation (A). HBS No. 9-491-047. Boston, MA: Harvard Business School Publishing.
344
Gudykunst, W. B., & Kim, Y. Y. (1997). Communicating with strangers: An approach to intercultural communication (3rd ed.). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
Harrison, D. A., & Sin, H. (2006). What is diversity and how should it be measured? In A. M. Konrad, P. Prasad, & J. K. Pringle (Eds.), Handbook of workplace diversity (pp. 191–216). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Harvey, C. P. (2015). Understanding workplace diversity: Where have we been and where are we going? In C. P. Harvey & M. J. Allard (Eds.), Understanding and managing diversity: Readings, cases, and exercises (pp. 1–7). Boston, MA: Pearson.
Harvey, C. P., & Allard, M. J. (2015). Understanding and managing diversity: Readings, cases, and exercises. Boston, MA: Pearson.
Healey, J. P., & Stepnick, A. (2017). Diversity and society: Race, ethnicity, and gender (5th ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Herring, C., & Henderson, L. (2015). Diversity in organizations: A critical examination. New York, NY: Routledge.
Hirshberg, J. J., & Ferdman, B. M. (2011, August 16). Leader-member exchange, cooperative group norms, and workplace inclusion in workgroups. In M. Shuffler, S. Burke, & D. Diaz-Granados (Chairs), Leading across cultures: Emerging research trends from multiple levels. Symposium presented at the 71st Annual Meeting of the Academy of Management, San Antonio, TX.
Loden, M. (1996). Implementing diversity. Boston, MA: McGraw-Hill.
Mor Barak, M. E. (2014). Managing diversity: Toward a globally inclusive workplace (3rd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Myers, V. A. (2012). Moving diversity forward: How to go from well-meaning to well- doing. Washington, DC: American Bar Association.
345
Ponterotto, J. G., & Pedersen, P. B. (1993). Preventing prejudice: A guide for counselors and educators. Newbury Park, CA: Sage.
Porter, R. E., & Samovar, L. A. (1997). An introduction to intercultural communication. In L. A. Samovar & R. E. Porter (Eds.), Intercultural communication: A reader (8th ed., pp. 5–26). Belmont, CA: Wadsworth.
Rivera, L. A. (2015) Pedigree: How elite students get elite jobs. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Schutz, W. C. (1958). FIRO: A three dimensional theory of interpersonal behavior. New York, NY: Holt, Rinehart & Winston.
Shore, L. M., Randel, A. E., Chung, B. G., Dean, M. A., Holcombe Ehrhard, K., & Singh, G. (2011). Inclusion and diversity in work groups: A review and model for future research. Journal of Management, 37(4), 1262–1289.
Solman, P. (2014, September 15). How Xerox became a leader in diversity—and why that’s good for business. PBS Newshour [Television broadcast]. New York, NY: Newshour Productions.
Special Populations and CTE Illinois Leadership Project. (2016). Cultural Diversity Self- Assessment. Retrieved from http://illinoiscte.org/index.php/resources/cultural- competency-module
Thomas, D. A., & Ely, R. J. (1996, September–October). Making differences matter: A new paradigm for managing diversity. Harvard Business Review. Retrieved from https://hbr.org/1996/09/making-differences-matter-a-new-paradigm-for-managing- diversity
Xerox. (2016). Xerox diversity: Different ideas. Diverse people. Dramatic results. Retrieved from https://www.xerox.com/assets/pdf/Xerox_Diversity_Brochure.pdf
Xerox a success in diversifying its work force. (1991, November 3). Boston Globe.
346
Retrieved from http://articles.sun-sentinel.com/1991-11- 03/business/9102140547_1_affirmative-action-xerox-minorities
347
10 Listening to Out-Group Members
348
Introduction
In general, humans do not like conflict. And so when there are individuals in a group or an organization who do not identify with the larger group—an out-group—we tend to look at them as “troublemakers” or “malcontents.” But in fact, all of us have been out-group members at one time or another. The term itself is descriptive, not derogatory. Out-groups are common and inevitable, and listening and responding to out-group members is one of the most difficult challenges facing a leader. When a leader fails to meet this challenge, out- group members feel devalued, and their unique contributions go unexpressed for the common good. Good leaders know the importance of listening to all members of a group, especially the out-group members.
Why is it Important for Leaders to Listen to Out-Group Members?
It is common to find out-groups in any context where a group of individuals is trying to reach a goal. Out-groups are a natural occurrence in everyday life. They exist in all types of situations at the local, community, and national levels. In nearly all of these situations, when one or more individuals are not “on board,” the performance of the group is adversely affected. Since out-group members are so common, it is important for anyone who aspires to be a leader to know how to work with them.
Out-group members can be identified in many everyday encounters. At school, out-group members are often those kids who do not see themselves as a part of the student body. For instance, they may want to participate in music, clubs, sports, and so on, but for a host of reasons do not do so. At work, there are out-groups comprising people who are at odds with management’s vision, or who are excluded from important decision-making committees. On project teams, some out-group members are those who simply refuse to contribute to the activities of the larger group. On a broader scale, in the United States, the Tea Party is an out-group representing people who are disenchanted with taxes and big government.
Using Inclusive Language
The important thing to remember about out-group members is that, in spite of their seeming opposition to the larger group, they often have valuable contributions to make,
349
and effort should be made to create an inclusive environment that will facilitate their contributions. As we discussed in Chapter 9, “Embracing Diversity and Inclusion,” inclusion is the process of incorporating others into a group or organization by helping people who are different feel they are part of the whole. Rather than being viewed as “difficult,” out-group members should be seen as being “different” than the whole, with different values and skills that can be recognized—and embraced—by other group members. Admittedly, this can be hard, but it starts with listening to out-group members.
This chapter will examine why it is important for a leader to listen to out-group members. The questions it will address are “Who is in the out-group?” “Why do out-groups form?” “What is the impact of out-groups?” and “How should a leader respond to out-groups?” This discussion of out-groups will emphasize specific strategies that leaders can employ to build a sense of belonging and community, and advance the goals of the larger group. And despite the negativity that is often associated with out-groups, there is a value implied in the direction taken in this chapter that out-groups aren’t evil and that leaders have an obligation and a responsibility to listen to out-group members and “bring them in” to the efforts of the larger group. Some will argue with this position, and others will say it is naïve; but the unique inherent value of every single member of a group or an organization cannot go understated. Although there will be times when out-group members need to be abandoned because they are too extreme, it is inefficient to deal with them, or they just simply do not want to be included, this chapter will argue that in most situations leaders have a duty to listen to and include out-group members.
350
Out-Group Members Explained
There are many different ways to define out-group members. For our purposes, the term out-group members refers to those individuals in a group or an organization who do not identify themselves as part of the larger group. They are individuals who are disconnected and not fully engaged in working toward the goals of the group. They may be in opposition to the will of a larger group or simply disinterested in the group’s goals. They may feel unaccepted, alienated, and even discriminated against such as the class “bully” who acts out because she feels left out. In addition, they may think they are powerless because their potential resources have not been fully accepted by the larger group.
Out-groups come in many forms: They can be minorities who think their voice is not being heard, or people who think their ideas are unappreciated. They can be those who simply do not identify with the leader or other members of the primary group. Sometimes out-group members are social loafers—group members who are inclined to goof off or work below their capacity when they are in a group. In short, out-group members sense themselves to be at odds with the larger group. For example, the single female on an all- male board of trustees might feel that the other board members do not take her ideas seriously or appreciate her perspective on issues.
351
How Out-Groups Form
There are many different reasons that out-groups form. First, some out-groups form because people disagree with the social, political, or ethical position of the majority—they sense that they are in opposition to the larger group. When decisions need to be made in organizational settings, consensus is often difficult to achieve because of time constraints and the need to move forward. Without consensus, individuals align themselves either with the majority viewpoint or with the minority. This minority is often seen as an out-group. Even when decisions are made by taking a vote, the results often produce winners and losers, and the losers frequently perceive themselves as members of the out-group. Although voting on a decision is often seen as a desirable democratic approach to reaching an outcome, the downside is that it always results in individuals feeling they are not in concert with the rest of the group.
A second reason that out-groups form is explained by social identity theory. This theory suggests that out-groups come about because some individuals cannot identify with the beliefs, norms, or values of the dominant group members. Research on groups (Hogg & Abrams, 1988; Tajfel & Turner, 1979, 1986) indicates that individuals in groups often share a social identity and act toward each other in terms of that identity (Abrams, Frings, & Randsley de Moura, 2005). In group settings, members embrace the social identity of other group members and make the group’s concerns their own. For example, in a support group for people with cancer, group members are likely to embrace a common identity—as cancer survivors who are coping with the disease. People find meaning in belonging to the group and sharing their experiences with others. They see one another as having a shared experience. However, if one of the members is struggling with a more serious form of cancer and does not feel like a survivor, then that person may become an out-group member. Out-groups are created when individuals in a group cannot identify with the group and, as a result, do not embrace the dominant group’s reality.
Group Identity
Closely related to the identity issue, a third reason out-groups form is because people sense that they are being excluded by the larger group. They do not know where they fit in or whether they are needed by others in the group. Group members may think they are too old, too young, too conservative, too liberal, or just plain different from the larger group. For example, on a college soccer team, freshman players might wonder how they fit in with the upperclassmen. Similarly, in a college nursing class made up mostly of women, a male student might feel different from the other nursing students and wonder how he fits in the
352
program. In situations such as these, people often sense that they are alienated from the larger group. In addition, they may think of themselves as powerless and weak. It is no fun to think you are not a part of the group and to feel excluded from it. We all have a need for inclusion, and when those needs go unmet, we feel anxiety.
Understanding Out-Group Members
A fourth reason for out-group development is that some people lack communication skills or social skills that are needed to relate to a larger group. In any group of people, there are often one or two people who set themselves apart from the group through their actions. For example, in an undergraduate group project team, there may be a student who talks excessively or dominates group discussions and consequently alienates himself from the rest of the group. Or there could be a student who acts very dogmatic, or another who consistently makes off-the-wall remarks. These types of individuals distinguish themselves as different from the rest of the group by how they talk or act. It is as if they are unable to adapt to the norms of the group. As much as they try, these people often find themselves on the outside looking in. Even though they may want to join the larger group, they have difficulty doing so because they do not know how to fit in. In these situations, their lack of communication and social skills often leads them to becoming out-group members. In reality, there are many possible reasons for out-groups. Any one reason is as legitimate as another. Developing an understanding of these reasons is the first step in trying to resolve out-group issues.
353
The Impact of Out-Group Members
Out-group members can have many adverse effects on others. Some of the downsides of out-groups are relatively insignificant, such as causing minor inefficiencies in organizational productivity. Other downsides are more important, such as creating conflict or causing a strike to be called.
So why should a leader be concerned about the negative impact of out-group members? First, out-group members run counter to building community. The essence of community is encouraging everyone to be on the same page and moving everyone in the same direction. Community brings people together and provides a place where they can express similar ideas, values, and opinions, and where they can be heard by members of their team. Community allows people to accomplish great things. It enables people to work hand in hand in pursuit of a shared vision that supports the common good. Through community, people can promote the greater good of everyone in the group.
However, by their very nature, out-group members are either in conflict with or avoiding community. Because the community may seem threatening, unfamiliar, or uninteresting to them, some people have a need to pull away from community. Their action detracts from the community being able to use all of its resources to reach a common goal.
The following example occurred in a college social work class; it illustrates how out-groups can have a negative impact on community. Introduction to Social Work is a popular class with a good reputation on campus. Every semester, the major assignment in the class is a group service project in which everyone is required to participate.
One semester a few months after Hurricane Katrina had wreaked havoc in the South, several members of the class proposed a service project doing relief work in New Orleans over spring break. Clearly, there was a need for the project, and the project would utilize everyone’s talents and skills. To pull it off, the class would need to do a lot of planning and fund-raising. Committees were to be formed and T-shirts designed. There seemed to be agreement that a good theme would be “Together—We Can Make Things Better.”
Problems arose for the class when some of the students did not want to participate. One student pointed out that he thought it was the government’s job to provide relief, not the private sector’s. Another student argued that there were already many volunteers in New Orleans, and maybe the class could better serve others by doing cleanup work on the south side of their own city. Two others in the class did not like the idea of working for the poor over spring break because they wanted to go to Cancún, Mexico.
These students could not find common ground. The trip to New Orleans was canceled, there were no T-shirts printed, and the students ended up doing 40 hours each of tutoring
354
at the local grade school as their service project. The class could not come to an agreement with the out-group members, whose wants and needs prevented the rest of the class from pursuing the project in New Orleans. The interests of the out-group prevented the class from experiencing community and all its benefits.
A second reason that leadership should be concerned with out-groups is that out-groups have a negative impact on group synergy. Group synergy is the positive energy created by group members who are working toward a common goal. It is an additive kind of energy that builds on itself. Group synergy is one of the most miraculous features of effective groups and of highly functioning teams. Groups with synergy accomplish far more than groups without it. Group synergy is not just the sum of each person’s contribution; it is the sum of each person’s contribution and then some. It is the “plus more” that allows high- functioning groups to achieve far beyond what would be expected.
Unfortunately, out-groups prevent groups from becoming synergistic. Out-groups take energy away from the group rather than adding energy to the group. If out-group members are upset and demanding, they take even more energy from the group. This energy is not directed toward the goals of the group and so has a negative impact on productivity. Rather than working together to accomplish a common goal, out-group members stand alone and seek to do their own thing. This is harmful for the group because the unique contributions of out-group members are not expressed, discussed, or utilized for the common good. Every person in a group brings singular talents and abilities that can benefit the group. When out- groups form, the individual contributions of some group members are not utilized, and group synergy is compromised.
This example about a team of marketing executives at a publishing company may help to illustrate this issue. The team was charged with developing concepts for a new publication on food and dining in their city. Two of the team members had worked on magazines before and had some strong ideas about the content for the new publication. Another team member worked in the restaurant industry for a number of years and had a different idea for the magazine’s content based on his experience. A marketing executive who had neither magazine nor food industry experience had been put in charge of the team based on her seniority with the company. The fifth team member was a new hire who had just started at the agency.
Relationships Among Group Members
Unfortunately, there were strained relationships between different groups on the committee from the outset. The two former magazine executives wanted the publication to be a dining
355
guide with reviews of local area restaurants and a detailed listing of every eatery in town. The writer from the food industry felt it should be more upscale, a glossy publication with feature stories on food trends and local chefs and beautiful, mouth-watering photographs created by a food stylist. The new hire, still learning the company’s culture, was hesitant to offer an opinion, instead saying he would support what the team leader thought best. The team leader, who was four months from retirement, believed that the group members should work things out among themselves and come to a consensus on the best concept with which to move forward. The two magazine executives took the new hire to lunch several times, trying to convince him to come to their side. After several weeks of meetings, the team had to present a concept to the publishing company’s board of directors. Because the team could not agree on a direction for the new publication, each side presented its concept to the board. The company president became incensed that the team was unable to put together a solid plan for a magazine and released all members from the project.
In the above example, the team leader failed to pull the divergent out-group members together into a single group. She needed to recognize the unique contributions of each of the out-group members (e.g., previous magazine experience, food industry knowledge, marketing expertise) and use those contributions for the benefit of the entire group. Because the leader was not successful in responding to the out-group members, group synergy was diminished, and the project was placed on hold.
A third reason out-groups are of concern to a leader is that out-group members do not receive the respect they deserve from others. A central tenet of ethical leadership is the duty to treat each member with respect. As Beauchamp and Bowie (1988) pointed out, people need to be treated as autonomous individuals with their own goals, and not as the means to another person’s goals. Being ethical means treating other people’s decisions and values with respect: Failing to do so would signify that they are being treated as means to another’s ends.
Respecting Out-Group Members
A leader has an ethical responsibility to respond to out-group members. These individuals are not in the out-group without reason. They may have valid grounds for feeling alienated, unaccepted, or discriminated against, or for choosing simply to be uninvolved. No matter what the reasons are, out-group members are people who deserve to be heard by the leader and the other group members.
In summary, the impact of out-groups is substantial. When out-groups exist, they have a negative impact on community, group synergy, and the out-group members themselves. The challenge for every leader is to respond to out-group members in a way that enhances
356
the group and its goals.
357
Out-Group Members in Practice
While many ideas about effective leadership are abstract, these strategies for how a leader should respond to out-group members are tangible. They are concrete steps that a leader can take to handle out-group members more effectively. In reading these strategies, ask yourself how you could adopt them to improve your own leadership.
358
Strategy 1: Listen to Out-Group Members
More than anything else, out-group members want to be heard. Whether they perceive themselves to be powerless, alienated, or discriminated against, out-group members have a need for others to listen to them. Clearly, the fact that some people sense that they are not being heard is at the very center of why out-groups exist. Out-group members have ideas, attitudes, and feelings that they want to express; when they believe they have not been able to or will not be able to express them, they pull away and disassociate from the group.
Listening is one of the most important ways that a leader can respond to out-group members. While it requires paying attention to what people say, it also requires being attentive to what people mean. Listening is both a simple and a complex process that demands concentration, open-mindedness, and tolerance. Listening requires that a leader set aside his or her own biases in order to allow out-group members to express their viewpoints freely. When out-group members think that the leader has heard them, they feel confirmed and more connected to the larger group. Clearly, listening should be a top priority of a leader.
359
Strategy 2: Show Empathy to Out-Group Members
Similar to listening, a leader also needs to show empathy to out-group members. Empathy is a special kind of listening that is more demanding than just listening. It requires a leader to try standing in the shoes of out-group members, and to see the world as the out-group member does. Empathy is a process in which the leader suspends his or her own feelings in an effort to understand the feelings of the out-group member.
Empathy
While showing empathy comes more naturally to some than to others, it is a skill anyone can learn to improve. Techniques for showing empathy include restatement, paraphrasing, reflection, and giving support (see Table 10.1). Through the use of these techniques, a leader can assist out-group members to be understood.
360
Strategy 3: Recognize the Unique Contributions of Out- Group Members
Expectancy theory (Vroom, 1964) tells us that the first step in motivating others is to let workers know they are competent to do their jobs. Motivation builds when people know they are able to do the work. This is particularly true for out-group members. Out-group members become more motivated when a leader acknowledges their contributions to the larger group. All of us want to know that our contributions are legitimate and that others take us seriously. Out-group members want to believe that their ideas matter and that they are important to the group.
Recognizing Contributions
Table 10.1 How to Demonstrate Empathy Table 10.1 How to Demonstrate Empathy
A leader can demonstrate empathy through four communication techniques:
1. Restatement
By restating what another person has verbalized without adding any of your own personal thoughts and beliefs, you directly acknowledge and validate another person’s point of view. For example, say, “I hear you saying . . .” or “It sounds as if you feel . . .”
2. Paraphrasing
This communication technique involves summarizing in your own words what another person has verbalized. It helps to communicate to the other person that you understand what he or she is saying. For example, say, “In other words, you’re saying that . . .” or “Stated another way, you’re suggesting that . . .”
3. Reflection
By serving as a mirror or sounding board for another person’s expressed or unexpressed emotions and attitudes, you focus on how something has been
expressed, or the emotional dimension behind the words. This technique helps
361
others gain an understanding of their emotions and assists them in identifying and describing those emotions. For example, say, “So you are pretty confused and angry by it all . . .” or “Am I correct in saying that you are frightened and intimidated by the process?”
4. Support
This communication technique expresses understanding, reassurance, and positive regard to let the other person know that he or she is not “in the boat alone.” For example, say, “With your attitude, I know you’ll do well . . .” or “I’m impressed with the progress you are making.”
In many situations, it is common for out-group members to believe others do not recognize their strengths. To address these concerns, it is important for a leader to identify out-group members’ unique abilities and assets, and to integrate these into the group process. For example, if an out-group member suggests a radical but ultimately successful approach to accomplish a difficult task, the leader should express appreciation to the out-group member and let her or him know that the idea was creative and worthwhile. A leader needs to let out-group members know that what they do matters—that it is significant to the larger group.
Another example of a college class in which students had to do a service-learning project helps illustrate the importance of recognizing the unique contributions of out-group members. For their project, one team in this small group communication class chose to build a wheelchair ramp for an elderly woman in the community. In the initial stages of the project, morale in the group was down because one group member (Alissa) chose not to participate. Alissa said she was quite uncomfortable using hand tools, and she chose not to do manual labor. The other team members, who had done a lot of planning on the project, wanted to proceed without her help. As a result, Alissa felt rejected and soon became isolated from the group. Feeling disappointed with her group, Alissa began to criticize the purpose of the project and the personalities of the other team members.
At that point, one of the leaders of the group decided to start being more attentive to Alissa and what she was saying. After carefully listening to many of her concerns, the leader figured out that although Alissa could not work with her hands, she had two amazing talents: She was good with music, and she made wonderful lunches.
Once the leader found this out, things started to change in the group. Alissa started to participate. Her input into the construction of the ramp consisted of playing each group member’s and the elderly woman’s favorite music for 30 minutes while the other group members worked on the ramp. In addition, Alissa provided wonderful sandwiches and drinks that accommodated each of the group members’ unique dietary interests. By the last
362
day, Alissa felt so included by the group, and was so often praised for providing great food, that she decided to help with the manual labor: She began raking up trash around the ramp site with a smile on her face.
Although Alissa’s talents had nothing to do directly with constructing a ramp, she made a real contribution to building a successful team. Everybody was included and useful in a community-building project that could have turned sour if one out-group member’s talents had not been identified and utilized.
363
Strategy 4: Help Out-Group Members Feel Included
William Schutz (1966) pointed out that, in small group situations, one of our strongest interpersonal needs is to know whether we belong to the group. Are we “in” or “out”? The very nature of out-groups implies that their members are on the sidelines and peripheral to the action. Out-group members do not feel as if they belong, are included, or are “in.” Schutz suggested that people have a need to be connected to others. They want to be in a group, but not so much a part of the group that they lose their own identity. They want to belong, but do not want to belong so much that they lose their sense of self.
Although it is not always easy, a leader can help out-group members be more included. A leader can watch the communication cues given by out-group members and try to respond in appropriate ways. For example, if a person sits at the edge of the group, the leader can put the chairs in a circle and invite the person to sit in the circle. If a person does not follow the group norms (e.g., does not go outdoors with everyone else during breaks), the leader can personally invite the out-group member to join the others outside. Similarly, if a group member is very quiet and has not contributed, a leader can ask for that group member’s opinion. Although there are many different ways to help out-group members to be included, the bottom line is that a leader needs to be sensitive to out-group members’ needs and try to respond to them in ways that help the out-group members know that they are part of the larger group.
364
Strategy 5: Create a Special Relationship With Out-Group Members
The most well-known study on out-groups was conducted by a group of researchers who developed a theory called leader–member exchange (LMX) theory (Dansereau, Graen, & Haga, 1975; Graen & Uhl-Bien, 1995). The major premise of this theory, introduced in Chapter 1, is that a leader should create a special relationship with each follower. An effective leader has a high-quality relationship with all group members; this results in out- group members becoming a part of the larger group.
Lead-Member Exchange Theory
Special relationships are built on good communication, respect, and trust. They are often initiated when a leader recognizes out-group members who are willing to step out of scripted roles and take on different responsibilities. In addition, special relationships can develop when a leader challenges out-group members to be engaged and to try new things. If an out-group member accepts these challenges and responsibilities, it is the first step in forging an improved relationship between the leader and the out-group member. The result is that the out-group member feels validated and more connected to everyone else in the group.
An example of how special relationships benefit out-group members can be seen in the following example. Margo Miller was the school nurse at Central High School. She was also the unofficial school counselor, social worker, conflict mediator, and all-around friend to students. Margo noticed that there were a number of very overweight students who were not in any of the groups at school. To address this situation, she began to invite some of these students and others to exercise with her at the track after school. For some of them, it was the first time they had ever taken part in an extracurricular school program. The students and Margo called themselves the Breakfast Club because, like the characters in the movie by the same name, they were a motley crew. At the end of the semester, the group sponsored a school-wide 5K run/walk that was well attended. One overweight girl who finished the 5K said that Margo and the Breakfast Club were the best thing that had ever happened to her. Clearly, it was the special relationships that Margo created with her students that allowed out-group students to become involved and feel good about their involvement in the high school community.
365
Strategy 6: Give Out-Group Members a Voice and Empower Them to Act
Giving out-group members a voice lets them be on equal footing with other members of the group. It means the leader and the other group members give credence to the out-group members’ ideas and actions. When out-group members have a voice, they know their interests are being recognized and that they can have an impact on the leader and the group. It is quite a remarkable process when a leader is confident enough in his or her own leadership to let out-group members express themselves and have a voice in the affairs of the group.
Building a Collaborative Team
Empowering others to act means a leader allows out-group members to be more involved, independent, and responsible for their actions. It includes letting them participate in the workings of the group (e.g., planning, decision making). True empowerment requires that a leader relinquish some control, giving out-group members more control. This is why empowerment is such a challenging process for a leader. Finally, empowering others is one of the larger challenges of leadership, but it is also one of the challenges that offers the most benefits for members of the out-group.
Leadership Snapshot: Abraham Lincoln, 16th President of the United States
366
http://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/File:Abraham_Lincoln_head_on_shoulders_photo_portrait.png.
Abraham Lincoln, a backwoods circuit lawyer from Springfield, Illinois, was an unlikely choice to become the 16th president of the United States. His mother died when he was 9, and he was distant from his father. As a youngster, he had little formal education but was an avid reader. Although he had a melancholy temperament, he was known for his storytelling ability and inspiriting sense of humor. After graduating from law school, he served one term in the U.S. House of Representatives and then proceeded to lose two subsequent contests for the U.S. Senate.
In 1860, he won the Republican nomination for president after ousting three formidable candidates:
367
William Seward, a New York senator; Salmon Chase, an Ohio governor; and Edward Bates, a Missouri statesman. No one expected that a soft-spoken, unknown lawyer from rural Illinois could win the nomination, but at the convention, after three rounds of voting, Lincoln emerged as the Republican nominee. Lincoln won the presidential election, and before he took office, six southern states seceded from the Union to form the Confederate States of America.
Lincoln began his presidency in a nation torn apart by the issue of slavery and whether slavery should be expanded, maintained, or abolished. In this context, Lincoln made a bold leadership decision: He selected for his cabinet the four archrivals who had opposed him in the presidential primary, as well as three Democrats. All of them were better known and more educated than Lincoln (Goodwin, 2005).
Lincoln’s cabinet was a group of disparate politicians with strong egos who challenged the president’s decisions repeatedly. Each of them had very different philosophies about the nation and slavery in particular. Some argued strongly for restricting the spread of slavery. Others argued for its abolition. Initially, the cabinet members did not view the president positively. For example, Attorney General Bates viewed Lincoln as well-meaning but an incompetent administrator. Edwin Stanton, the secretary of war, initially treated him with contempt but eventually learned to respect his competencies as commander in chief (Goodwin, 2005).
Lincoln had a remarkable ability to work with those with whom he disagreed and bring together those with disparaging opinions (Goodwin, 2005). For example, at the onset of the Civil War, Secretary of State Seward directly challenged in writing Lincoln’s response to the battle at Fort Sumter, claiming the administration was without a policy and should abandon its approach. In response, Lincoln wrote a letter to Seward explaining his own position, without insulting Seward. Instead of sending the letter, Lincoln delivered it to Seward personally. Such behavior was Lincoln’s “hallmark in dealing with recalcitrant but important subordinates, generals or senators: a firm assertion of his own policy and responsibility for it, done in such as way as to avoid a personal rebuff that might create an enemy” (McPherson, 2005). Over time, Seward actually grew close to the president and became one of Lincoln’s strongest supporters.
In a larger sense, Lincoln’s leadership was also about bringing together a nation that was deeply divided. In 1858, well before he was elected president, Lincoln delivered his famous “House Divided” speech at the Illinois State Capitol in accepting his nomination for U.S. Senate. Based on a New Testament Bible passage (Mark 3:25), he stated, “A house divided against itself cannot stand. I believe this government cannot endure permanently half slave and half free. I do not expect the Union to be dissolved—I do not expect the house to fall—but I do expect it will cease to be divided. It will become all one thing, or all the other.” In some ways, this speech foreshadowed Lincoln’s style of leading and his role in addressing the debilitating and devastating impact of slavery on the country.
368
Summary
In today’s society, out-group members are a common occurrence whenever people come together to solve a problem or accomplish a task. In general, the term out-group refers to those people in a group who do not sense that they are a part of the larger group. Out- group members are usually people who feel disconnected, unaccepted, discriminated against, or powerless.
Out-groups form for many reasons. Some form because people are in opposition to the larger group. Others form because individuals in a group cannot identify with the larger group or cannot embrace the larger group’s reality. Sometimes they form because people feel excluded or because out-group members lack communication and social skills.
Regardless of why they form, the negative impact of out-group members can be substantial. We need to be concerned about out-groups because they run counter to building community and have a negative impact on group synergy. Furthermore, out-group members do not receive the respect they deserve from those in the “in-group.”
There are several specific strategies that a leader can use to respond effectively to out-group members. A leader needs to listen to out-group members, show them empathy, recognize their unique contributions, help them become included, create a special relationship with them, give them a voice, and empower them to act. A leader who uses these strategies will be more successful in his or her encounters with out-groups, and will be a more effective group leader.
369
Glossary Terms
empathy 224 listening 224 out-group members 219 social identity theory 219
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
370
10.1 Case Study: Next Step Next Step is a student organization run by graduate students in the School of Communication at a large West Coast university. The mission of Next Step is to provide students with opportunities that will help them prepare for the workforce or for more schooling. Some of the annual events that the group sponsors are résumé development workshops, a professional development day in which people from the community discuss their career paths, and workshops on interviewing skills.
Next Step has two annual bake sales to raise funds to pay for expenses such as renting meeting space, compensating speakers, and providing refreshments at group workshops. After a lukewarm fall semester bake sale, some Next Step members suggest finding a new fund-raising method, arguing that bake sales cost members money and require a lot of work for little profit.
Next Step’s president, James, decides to put new fund-raising initiatives on the agenda for discussion at the group’s next meeting. At that meeting, Brenna, a marketing and graphic design major, proposes that the group sell T-shirts as the winter semester’s fund-raiser. Brenna believes that the college population likes to buy T-shirts and is confident that she can create a design that will appeal to students. Mallory, also a marketing major, volunteers to help promote the T-shirts. Group member Mark offers to use his employee discount at the screen shop where he works to have the shirts printed affordably.
Other Next Step members voice approval for the T-shirt fund-raiser, and the discussion moves to talking about designs for the shirts. James assigns Brenna and Mallory to survey students on their interest in buying the shirts and at what price. Brenna will also develop mock-ups of the shirt’s design and bring them to the next meeting while Mark is assigned to get pricing options.
James leaves the meeting feeling positive about the direction the new fund-raiser is going, but as he loads his book back into his car, he overhears a conversation nearby. Next Step’s treasurer, Nichole, calls the plan to sell T-shirts “stupid.” She states she personally would never order a shirt from a student group and that Next Step is going to lose money printing the shirts. Ursula, Next Step’s secretary, agrees with Nichole, calling other Next Group members “a bunch of Kool-Aid–drinking nerds” and remarking that nobody is going to buy those shirts. James is shocked. Not only does he not remember Nichole or Ursula voicing any objections to the plan at the meeting; he doesn’t remember them saying anything during the meeting at all. James is concerned that two Next Step officers would talk so negatively about the group and wonders if it is fueled by the shift to selling T-shirts or something else. He makes a mental note to build an anonymous vote into the next meeting to make sure that members who don’t like the idea have an opportunity to oppose it without being put in a public position.
Meanwhile, Brenna, Mallory, and Mark succeed in canvassing students, finding a reasonable price for T- shirts, and developing attractive mock-ups for Next Step members to consider. James feels confident that the positive outcome of the T-shirt committee’s efforts will help Nichole and Ursula change their minds about the T-shirt sale.
However, the next day, James is working in a cubicle at the student center when Nichole enters. Before he gets a chance to leave his booth to say hi to her, Next Step’s student liaison Todd comes up to Nichole and says, “Can you believe how much work those brownnosers are putting into selling T-shirts? Honestly, it’s so dumb—at least no one expects us to pitch in though!” As student liaison, Todd has a pivotal role in the group and is responsible for promoting the group’s efforts at other student meetings and for recruiting new members. His comments further alarm James.
James decides to act, and approaches Nichole and Todd, who were unaware that he was nearby. James makes small talk, and then reminds them about the Next Step meeting coming up in two days. Nichole rolls her eyes and says she knows about the meeting. James asks her if everything is OK. Nichole responds, “Everything is fine. I just think that it’s silly to get so involved in this T-shirt sale. We all have a lot going
371
on for school, and this group is really just something to put on my résumé. I don’t understand why we can’t just stick with the easy, mindless bake sale.” Todd nods in agreement and says, “Yeah, James, you can’t tell me that you became president of a student group because you believe so much in its mission. We both know it’s just because you want to look good when you apply for jobs this summer.” Although taken aback by their attitudes, James responds that he believes in Next Step’s mission and will make sure any and all concerns’ regarding the fund-raiser are raised at the next meeting.
As he prepares for the upcoming meeting, James concludes that there seems to be a division, at least among the board’s officers, between those who are excited about the group’s mission and efforts and those who are not supportive. He wonders if other Next Step members share the attitudes expressed by Nichole, Ursula, and Todd or if they are in a minority. If they aren’t, thinks James, and the division goes deeper, what does that mean for Next Step?
372
Questions 1. This chapter discusses several reasons that out-groups form. What is the best explanation for why
Ursula, Nichole, and Todd appear to be out-group members? What impact are they having on Next Step? Do they have legitimate concerns? Discuss.
2. How could the initial meeting about fund-raising strategies have been conducted so that all members were included in the decision?
3. Of the six strategies for how leaders should respond to out-group members, do you think that certain strategies might be more appropriate or effective in this situation given the verbalized feelings about Next Step from the out-group members?
4. How could other members of the group besides James help to build the group identity and sense of cohesion in Next Step?
5. In this situation, do you think it is worth the time and effort to try to include Ursula, Nichole, and Todd? Defend your answer.
373
10.2 Building Community Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your attitudes toward out-group members 2. To explore how you, as a leader, respond to members of the out-group
Directions
1. Place yourself in the role of a leader when responding to this questionnaire. 2. For each of the statements below, circle the number that indicates the degree to which you agree or
disagree.
Statements Strongly disagree
Disagree Neutral Agree Strongly agree
1. If some group members do not fit in with the rest of the group, I usually try to include them.
1 2 3 4 5
2. I become irritated when some group members act stubborn (or obstinate) with the majority of the group.
1 2 3 4 5
3. Building a sense of group unity with people who think differently than I is essential to what I do as a leader.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I am bothered when some individuals in the group bring up unusual ideas that hinder or block the progress of the rest of the group.
1 2 3 4 5
5. If some group members cannot agree with the majority of the group, I usually give them special attention.
1 2 3 4 5
6. Sometimes I ignore individuals who show little interest in group meetings.
1 2 3 4 5
7. When making a group decision, I always try to include the interests of members who have different points of view.
1 2 3 4 5
8. Trying to reach consensus (complete agreement) with out-group members is often a waste of time.
1 2 3 4 5
9. I place a high priority on encouraging everyone in the group to listen to the 1 2 3 4 5
374
minority point of view.
10. When differences exist between group members, I usually call for a vote to keep the group moving forward.
1 2 3 4 5
11. Listening to individuals with extreme (or radical) ideas is valuable to my leadership.
1 2 3 4 5
12. When a group member feels left out, it is usually his or her own fault.
1 2 3 4 5
13. I give special attention to out-group members (i.e., individuals who feel left out of the group).
1 2 3 4 5
14. I find certain group members frustrating when they bring up issues that conflict with what the rest of the group wants to do.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the even-numbered items, but reverse the score value of your responses (i.e., change 1 to 5, 2
to 4, 4 to 2, and 5 to 1, with 3 remaining unchanged). 2. Sum the responses of the odd-numbered items and the converted values of the even-numbered
items. This total is your leadership out-group score.
Total Score Out-group score: ___________
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to measure your response to out-group members.
A high score on the questionnaire indicates that you try to help out-group members feel included and become a part of the whole group. You are likely to listen to people with different points of view and to know that hearing a minority position is often valuable in effective group work. An average score on the questionnaire indicates that you are moderately interested in including out- group members in the group. Although interested in including them, you do not make out-group members’ concerns a priority in your leadership. You may think of out-group members as having brought their out-group behavior on themselves. If they seek you out, you probably will work with them when you can.
A low score on the questionnaire indicates you most likely have little interest in helping out-group members become a part of the larger group. You may become irritated and bothered when out- group members’ behaviors hinder the majority or progress of the larger group. Because you see helping the out-group members as an ineffective use of your time, you are likely to ignore them and make decisions to move the group forward without their input.
If your score is 57–70, you are in the very high range. If your score is 50–56, you are in the high range. If your score is 45–49, you are in the average range. If your score is 38–44, you are in the low range. If your score is 10–37, you are in the very low range.
375
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
376
10.3 Observational Exercise
377
Out-Groups
Purpose
1. To learn to recognize out-groups and how they form 2. To understand the role of out-groups in the leadership process
Directions
1. Your task in this exercise is to identify, observe, and analyze an actual out-group. This can be an out- group at your place of employment, in an informal group, in a class group, in a community group, or on a sports team.
2. For each of the questions below, write down what you observed in your experiences with out- groups.
Name of group: _____________________________________________ Identify and describe a group in which you observed an out-group. Observations of out-group members’ actions: Observations of the leader’s actions:
Questions 1. What is the identity of out-group members? How do they see themselves? 2. How were out-group members treated by the other members in the group? 3. What is the most challenging aspect of trying to deal with members of this out-group? 4. What does the leader need to do to integrate the out-group members into the larger group?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
378
10.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
379
Out-Groups
Reflection
1. Based on the score you received on the Building Community Questionnaire, how would you describe your attitude toward out-group members? Discuss.
2. As we discussed in this chapter, out-groups run counter to building community in groups. How important do you think it is for a leader to build community? Discuss.
3. One way to engage out-group members is to empower them. How do you see your own competencies in the area of empowerment? What keeps you from empowering others? Discuss.
Action
1. Using items from the Building Community Questionnaire as your criteria, list three specific actions you could take that would show sensitivity to and tolerance of out-group members.
2. In the last section of this chapter, six strategies for responding to out-group members were discussed. Rank these strategies from strongest to weakest with regard to how you use them in your own leadership. Describe specifically what you could do to become more effective in all six strategies.
3. Imagine for a moment that you are doing a class project with six other students. The group has decided by taking a vote to do a fund-raising campaign for the local Big Brothers Big Sisters program. Two people in the group have said they are not enthused about the project and would rather do something for an organization like Habitat for Humanity. While the group is moving forward with the agreed-upon project, the two people who did not like the idea have started missing meetings, and when they do attend, they are very negative. As a leader, list five specific actions you could take to assist and engage this out-group.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
380
References Abrams, D., Frings, D., & Randsley de Moura, G. (2005). Group identity and self-
definition. In S. A. Wheelan (Ed.), Handbook of group research and practice (pp. 329–350). London, United Kingdom: Sage.
Beauchamp, T. L., & Bowie, N. E. (1988). Ethical theory and business (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Dansereau, F., Graen, G. G., & Haga, W. (1975). A vertical dyad linkage approach to leadership in formal organizations. Organizational Behavior and Human Performance, 13(1), 46–78.
Goodwin, D. K. (2005). Team of rivals: The political genius of Abraham Lincoln. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.
Graen, G. B., & Uhl-Bien, M. (1995). Relationship-based approach to leadership: Development of leader–member exchange (LMX) theory of leadership over 25 years: Applying a multi-level, multi-domain perspective. Leadership Quarterly, 6(2), 219–247.
Hogg, M. A., & Abrams, D. (1988). Social identifications: A social psychology of intergroup relations and group processes. London, UK: Routledge.
McPherson, J. M. (2005, November 6). “Team of rivals”: Friends of Abe. The New York Times. Retrieved from http://www.nytimes.com/2005/11/06/books/review/06mcpherson.html? pagewanted=all&_r=0
Schutz, W. (1966). The interpersonal underworld. Palo Alto, CA: Science & Behavior Books.
Tajfel, H., & Turner, J. C. (1979). An integrative theory of intergroup conflict. In S. Worchel & W. G. Austin (Eds.), The social psychology of intergroup relations (pp. 33–47). Monterey, CA: Brooks-Cole.
381
Tajfel, H., & Turner, J. C. (1986). The social identity theory of inter-group behavior. In S. Worchel & L. W. Austin (Eds.), Psychology of intergroup relations (pp. 7–24). Chicago, IL: Nelson-Hall.
Vroom, V. H. (1964). Work and motivation. New York, NY: Wiley.
382
11 Managing Conflict
383
Introduction
Conflict is inevitable in groups and organizations, and it presents both a challenge and a true opportunity for every leader. In the well-known book Getting to Yes, Fisher and Ury (1981) contend that handling conflict is a daily occurrence for all of us. People differ, and because they do, they need to negotiate with others about their differences (pp. xi–xii). Getting to Yes asserts that mutual agreement is possible in any conflict situation—if people are willing to negotiate in authentic ways.
Is Conflict Really Inevitable?
When we think of conflict in simple terms, we think of a struggle between people, groups, organizations, cultures, or nations. Conflict involves opposing forces, pulling in different directions. Many people believe that conflict is disruptive, causes stress, and should be avoided.
As we stated in Chapter 6, while conflict can be uncomfortable, it is not unhealthy, nor is it necessarily bad. Conflict will always be present in leadership situations, and surprisingly, it often produces positive change. The important question we address in this chapter is not “How can we avoid conflict and eliminate change?” but rather “How can we manage conflict and produce positive change?” When leaders handle conflict effectively, problem solving increases, interpersonal relationships become stronger, and stress surrounding the conflict decreases.
Communication plays a central role in handling conflict. Conflict is an interactive process between two or more parties that requires effective human interaction. By communicating effectively, leaders and followers can successfully resolve conflicts to bring positive results.
What Are Some Strategies for Handling Conflict?
This chapter will emphasize ways to handle conflict. First, we will define conflict and describe the role communication plays in conflict. Next, we will discuss different kinds of conflict, followed by an exploration of Fisher and Ury’s (1981) ideas about effective negotiation as well as other communication strategies that help resolve conflict. Last, we will examine styles of approaching conflict and the pros and cons of these styles.
384
Conflict Explained
Conflict has been studied from multiple perspectives, including intrapersonal, interpersonal, and societal. Intrapersonal conflict refers to the discord that occurs within an individual. It is a topic often studied by psychologists and personality theorists who are interested in the dynamics of personality and factors that predispose people to inner conflicts. Interpersonal conflict refers to the disputes that arise between individuals. This is the type of conflict we focus on when we discuss conflict in organizations. Societal conflict refers to clashes between societies and nations. Studies in this field focus on the causes of international conflicts, war, and peace. The continuing crisis between the Israelis and the Palestinians is a good example of social conflict. This chapter focuses on conflict as an interpersonal process that plays a critical role in effective leadership.
The following definition, based on the work of Wilmot and Hocker (2011, p. 11), best describes conflict. Conflict is a felt struggle between two or more interdependent individuals over perceived incompatible differences in beliefs, values, and goals, or over differences in desires for esteem, control, and connectedness. This definition emphasizes several unique aspects of conflict (Wilmot & Hocker, 2011).
First, conflict is a struggle; it is the result of opposing forces coming together. For example, there is conflict when a leader and a senior-level employee oppose each other on whether or not all employees must work on weekends. Similarly, conflict occurs when a school principal and a parent disagree on the type of sex education program that should be adopted in a school system. In short, conflict involves a clash between opposing parties.
Second, there needs to be an element of interdependence between parties for conflict to take place. If leaders could function entirely independently of each other and their followers, there would be no reason for conflict. Everyone could do their own work, and there would be no areas of contention. However, leaders do not work in isolation. Leaders need followers, and followers need leaders. This interdependence sets up an environment in which conflict is more likely.
When two parties are interdependent, they are forced to deal with questions such as “How much influence do I want in this relationship?” and “How much influence am I willing to accept from the other party?” Because of our interdependence, questions such as these cannot be avoided. In fact, Wilmot and Hocker (2011) contend that these questions permeate most conflicts.
Third, conflict always contains an affective element, the “felt” part of the definition. Conflict is an emotional process that involves the arousal of feelings in both parties of the conflict (Brown & Keller, 1979). When our beliefs or values on a highly charged issue (e.g., the right to strike) are challenged, we become upset and feel it is important to defend our
385
position. When our feelings clash with others’ feelings, we are in conflict.
The primary emotions connected with conflict are not always anger or hostility. Rather, an array of emotions can accompany conflict. Hocker and Wilmot (1995) found that many people report feeling lonely, sad, or disconnected during conflict. For some, interpersonal conflict creates feelings of abandonment—that their human bond to others has been broken. Feelings such as these often produce the discomfort that surrounds conflict.
Fourth, conflict involves differences between individuals that are perceived to be incompatible. Conflict can result from differences in individuals’ beliefs, values, and goals, or from differences in individuals’ desires for control, status, and connectedness. The opportunities for conflict are endless because each of us is unique with particular sets of interests and ideas. These differences are a constant breeding ground for conflict.
In summary, these four elements—struggle, interdependence, feelings, and differences—are critical ingredients of interpersonal conflict. To further understand the intricacies of managing conflict, we’ll look at the role of communication in conflict and examine two major kinds of conflict.
386
Communication and Conflict
When conflict exists in leadership situations, it is recognized and expressed through communication. Communication is the means that people use to express their disagreements or differences. Communication also provides the avenue by which conflicts can be successfully resolved, or worsened, producing negative results.
Using Conversation
To understand conflict, we need to understand communication. When human communication takes place, it occurs on two levels. One level can be characterized as the content dimension and the other as the relationship dimension (Watzlawick, Beavin, & Jackson, 1967). The content dimension of communication involves the objective, observable aspects such as money, weather, and land; the relationship dimension refers to the participants’ perceptions of their connection to one another. In human communication, these two dimensions are always bound together.
To illustrate the two dimensions, consider the following hypothetical statement made by a supervisor to an employee: “Please stop texting at work.” The content dimension of this message refers to rules and what the supervisor wants the employee to do. The relationship dimension of this message refers to how the supervisor and the employee are affiliated—to the supervisor’s authority in relation to the employee, the supervisor’s attitude toward the employee, the employee’s attitude toward the supervisor, and their feelings about one another. It is the relationship dimension that implicitly suggests how the content dimension should be interpreted, since the content alone can be interpreted in different ways. The exact meaning of the message to the supervisor and employee is interpreted as a result of their interaction. If a positive relationship exists between the supervisor and the employee, then the content “please stop texting at work” will probably be interpreted by the employee as a friendly request by a supervisor who is honestly concerned about the employee’s job performance. However, if the relationship between the supervisor and the employee is superficial or strained, the employee may interpret the content of the message as a rigid directive, delivered by a supervisor who enjoys giving orders. This example illustrates how the meanings of messages are not in words alone but in individuals’ interpretations of the messages in light of their relationships.
The content and relationship dimensions provide a lens for looking at conflict. As illustrated in Figure 11.1, there are two major kinds of conflict: conflict over content issues and conflict over relationship issues. Both kinds of conflict are prevalent in groups and
387
organizational settings.
388
Conflict on the Content Level
Content conflicts involve struggles between leaders and others who differ on issues such as policies and procedures. Debating with someone about the advantages or disadvantages of a particular rule is a familiar occurrence in most organizations. Sometimes these debates can be very heated (e.g., an argument between two employees about surfing the Internet while working). These disagreements are considered conflicts on the content level when they center on differences in (1) beliefs and values or (2) goals and ways to reach those goals.
Figure 11.1 Different Kinds of Content and Relational Conflicts
Conflict Regarding Beliefs and Values
Each of us has a unique system of beliefs and values that constitutes a basic philosophy of life. We have had different family situations as well as educational and work experiences. When we communicate with others, we become aware that others’ viewpoints are often very different from our own. If we perceive what another person is communicating as incompatible with our own viewpoint, a conflict in beliefs or values is likely to occur.
Conflicts arising from differences in beliefs can be illustrated in several ways. For example, members of PETA (People for the Ethical Treatment of Animals) are in conflict with researchers in the pharmaceutical industry who believe strongly in using animals to test new drugs. Another example of a conflict of beliefs can occur when teachers or nurses believe they have the right to strike because of unfair working conditions, while others feel that these kinds of employees should not be allowed to withhold services for any reason. In each of these examples, conflict occurs because one individual feels that his or her beliefs are incompatible with the position taken by another individual on the issue.
Conflicts can also occur between people because they have different values. When one person’s values come into conflict with another’s, it can create a difficult and challenging situation. To illustrate, consider the following example of an issue between Emily, a first-
389
generation college student, and her mother. At the beginning of her senior year, Emily asks her mother if she can have a car to get around campus and to get back and forth to work. In order to pay for the car, Emily says she will take fewer credits, work more often at her part-time job, and postpone her graduation date to the following year. Emily is confident that she will graduate and thinks it is “no big deal” to extend her studies for a fifth year. However, Emily’s mother does not feel the same. She doesn’t want Emily to have a car until after she graduates. She thinks the car will be a major distraction and get in the way of Emily’s studies. Emily is the first person in her family to get a college degree, and it is extremely important to her mother that Emily graduates on time. Deep down, her mother is afraid that the longer Emily goes to school, the more student loan debt Emily will have to pay back when she finishes.
Leadership Snapshot: Humaira Bachal, Pakistani Educator
© Photo courtesy of Humaira Bachal.
Humaira Bachal is a 30-year-old woman who has a dangerous passion: She wants to educate children, especially girls, in her home country of Pakistan where only 57% of the children ever enter primary school.
It’s hard not to worry about Bachal in the wake of the 2012 shooting of Malala Yousafzai, a teenage Pakistani girl attacked by the Taliban for speaking out in support of girls’ education. But she’s not afraid.
When Bachal was in ninth grade, she looked around her village of Moach Goth and saw children playing in the streets instead of being in school or studying, and at all of 14, she thought that was wrong. There were no private or government schools in her neighborhood, and Bachal had received education only because her
390
mother had sewn clothing or sold bundles of wood for 2 cents a piece to send her children to schools elsewhere.
Bachal knew what it meant to have to fight to be educated. Her father did not want her to go to school, saying that she “was only going to get married and have children” (Rahi, 2010).
But her mother had other ideas. She wasn’t educated, but believed her children should be. She labored to pay for her daughter’s education herself and had to sneak her off to school, hiding Bachal’s whereabouts from her father. When he found out Bachal was going to take her ninth-grade entrance exams, he became furious and beat her mother, breaking her arm. Despite this, her mother gathered her daughter’s school bag and sent her on her way to the exam, which she passed.
“My mother’s support at that critical moment was essential in making me who I am today,” Bachal says (Faruqi & Obaid-Chinoy, 2013).
That same year while she was still being educated, Bachal started recruiting students in her neighborhood to come to a small, private school she had opened. She even went door-to-door to convince parents to send their children to the school. More than once she had a door slammed in her face and her life threatened.
“Education is a basic need and fundamental right for every human being,” she says. “I want to change the way my community looks at education and I will continue to do this until my last breath” (Temple-Raston, 2013).
Pakistan has a dismal education rate: It spends half as much as neighboring India on education, and if you are a young girl in rural Pakistan, you are unlikely to ever see the inside of a classroom. There are more than 32 million girls under the age of 14 in Pakistan; fewer than 13 million of them go to school (Faruqi & Obaid-Chinoy, 2013).
In 2003, Bachal and five friends created their school, the Dream Foundation Trust Model Street School, in a two-room building with mud floors. In just over a decade, Dream Foundation has grown into a formal school with 22 teachers and 1,200 students. Children pay a rupee a day to attend classes. There are four shifts at the school, including computer classes and one for “labour boys” who work all day and attend classes in the evening. The Dream Foundation Trust also offers adult literacy classes for men and women.
But Bachal and the school are specifically interested in educating girls. Bachal will often visit fathers at their workplaces to convince them to send their daughters to school. She asks why, when the girls become teenagers, they stop coming to school. The fathers talk about honor and culture and how the girls are looked at by men as they go to school, and the men say things about them. Bachal can relate; at one point the men in her village called her immoral for becoming educated, and her brothers and father wanted to relocate to put an end to their shame (Faruqi & Obaid-Chinoy, 2013).
Bachal reaches out to mothers to make them allies in her crusade. She asks them if they want their daughters to be treated as unjustly as they have been and urges the women to help their daughters have better lives by insisting that they get an education.
Bachal’s mother has no regrets about the sacrifices she made to ensure her daughters were educated, saying, “Education is essential for women. They (her daughters) have reached this potential because of their education. Otherwise they would have been slaving away for their husbands somewhere” (Rahi, 2010).
And despite the attack against Malala Yousafzai, Bachal says she isn’t worried for her own safety.
“Just the opposite,” she says. “It is not just one Malala or one Bachal who has raised a voice to change this situation. There are a lot of other girls who are trying to change things. Even if they kill 100 Humairas, they won’t be able to stop us” (Temple-Raston, 2013).
The value conflict between Emily and her mother involves Emily’s desire to have a car. In
391
this case, both individuals are highly interdependent of one another: To carry out her decision to get a car, Emily needs her mother’s agreement; to have her daughter graduate in four years, Emily’s mother needs cooperation from Emily. Both individuals perceive the other’s values as incompatible with their own, and this makes conflict inevitable. Clearly, the conflict between Emily and her mother requires interpersonal communication about their different values and how these differences affect their relationship.
Conflict Regarding Goals
A second common type of content-related conflict occurs in situations where individuals have different goals (see Figure 11.1). Researchers have identified two types of conflict that occur regarding group goals: (1) procedural conflict and (2) substantive conflict (Knutson, Lashbrook, & Heemer, 1976).
Procedural conflict refers to differences between individuals with regard to the approach they wish to take in attempting to reach a goal. In essence, it is conflict over the best means to an agreed-upon goal; it is not about what goal to achieve. Procedural conflicts can be observed in many situations such as determining how to best conduct job interviews, choose a method for identifying new sales territories, or spend advertising dollars. In each instance, conflict can occur when individuals do not agree on how to achieve a goal.
Substantive conflict occurs when individuals differ with regard to the substance of the goal itself, or what the goal should be. For example, two board members of a nonprofit human service agency may have very different views regarding the strategies and scope of a fund- raising campaign. Similarly, two owners of a small business may strongly disagree about whether or not to offer their part-time employees health care benefits. On the international level, in Afghanistan, the Taliban and those who are not members of the Taliban have different perspectives on whether or not girls should be educated. These illustrations by no means exhaust all the possible examples of substantive conflict; however, they point out that conflict can occur as a result of two or more parties disagreeing on what the goal or goals of a group or an organization should be.
392
Conflict on the Relational Level
Have you ever heard someone say, “I don’t seem to get along with her [or him]; we have a personality clash”? The phrase personality clash is another way of describing a conflict on the relational level. Sometimes we do not get along with another person, not because of what we are talking about (conflict over content issues) but because of how we are talking about it. Relational conflict refers to the differences we feel between ourselves and others concerning how we relate to each other. For example, at a staff meeting, a manager interrupts employees and talks to them in a critical tone. The employees begin texting on their phones, ignoring the manager. A conflict erupts because both the manager and the employees feel unheard and disrespected. It is typically caused by neither one person nor the other, but arises in their relationship. Relational conflict is usually related to incompatible differences between individuals over issues of (1) esteem, (2) control, and (3) affiliation (see Figure 11.1).
Relational Conflict and Issues of Esteem
The need for esteem and recognition has been identified by Maslow (1970) as one of the major needs in the hierarchy of human needs. Each of us has needs for esteem—we want to feel significant, useful, and worthwhile. We desire to have an effect on our surroundings and to be perceived by others as worthy of their respect. We attempt to satisfy our esteem needs through what we do and how we act, particularly in how we behave in our relationships with our coworkers.
The Need for Esteem
When our needs for esteem are not being fulfilled in our relationships, we experience relational conflict because others do not see us in the way we wish to be seen. For example, an administrative assistant can have repeated conflicts with an administrator if the assistant perceives that the administrator fails to recognize his or her unique contributions to the overall goals of the organization. Similarly, older employees may be upset if newer coworkers do not give them respect for the wisdom that comes with their years of experience. So, too, younger employees may want recognition for their innovative approaches to problems but fail to get it from coworkers with more longevity who do not think things should change.
At the same time that we want our own esteem needs satisfied, others want their esteem needs satisfied as well. If the supply of respect we can give each other seems limited (or
393
scarce), then our needs for esteem will clash. We will see the other person’s needs for esteem as competing with our own or taking that limited resource away from us. To illustrate, consider a staff meeting in which two employees are actively contributing insightful ideas and suggestions. If one of the employees is given recognition for her input but the other is not, conflict may result. As this conflict escalates, the effectiveness of their working relationship and the quality of their communication may diminish. When the amount of available esteem (validation from others) seems scarce, a clash develops.
All of us are human and want to be recognized for the contributions we make to our work and our community. When we believe we’re not being recognized or receiving our “fair share,” we feel slighted and conflicted on the relational level with others.
Relational Conflict and Issues of Control
Struggles over issues of control are very common in interpersonal conflict. Each one of us desires to have an impact on others and the situations that surround us. Having control, in effect, increases our feelings of potency about our actions and minimizes our feelings of helplessness. Control allows us to feel competent about ourselves. However, when we see others as hindering us or limiting our control, interpersonal conflict often ensues.
Conflict Over Control
Interpersonal conflict occurs when a person’s needs for control are incompatible with another’s needs for control. In a given situation, each of us seeks different levels of control. Some people like to have a great deal, while others are satisfied (and sometimes even more content) with only a little. In addition, our needs for control may vary from one time to another. For example, there are times when a person’s need to control others or events is very high; at other times, this same person may prefer that others take charge. Relational conflict over control issues develops when there is a clash between the needs for control that one person has at a given time (high or low) and the needs for control that others have at that same time (high or low). If, for example, a friend’s need to make decisions about weekend plans is compatible with yours, no conflict will take place; however, if both of you want to control the weekend planning and your individual interests are different, then you will soon find yourselves in conflict. As struggles for control ensue, the communication among the participants may become negative and challenging as each person tries to gain control over the other or undermine the other’s control.
A graphic example of a conflict over relational control is provided in the struggle between Lauren Smith, a college sophomore, and her parents, regarding what she will do on spring
394
break. Lauren wants to go to Cancún, Mexico, with some friends to relax from the pressures of school. Her parents do not want her to go. Lauren thinks she deserves to go because she is doing well in her classes. Her parents think spring break in Cancún is just a “big party” and nothing good will come of it. As another option, her parents offer to pay Lauren’s expenses to go on an alternative spring break to clean up an oil spill in the Gulf of Mexico. Lauren is adamant that she “is going” to Cancún. Her parents, who pay her tuition, threaten that if she goes to Cancún, they will no longer pay for college.
Clearly, in the above example, both parties want to have control over the outcome. Lauren wants to be in charge of her own life and make the decisions about what she does or does not do. At the same time, her parents want to direct her into doing what they think is best for her. Lauren and her parents are interdependent and need each other, but they are conflicted because they each feel that the other is interfering with their needs for control of what Lauren does on spring break.
Conflicts over control are common in leadership situations. Like the parents in the above example, the role of leader brings with it a certain inherent level of control and responsibility. When leaders clash with one another over control or when control issues exist between leaders and followers, interpersonal conflicts occur. Later in this chapter, we present some conflict management strategies that are particularly helpful in coping with relational conflicts that arise from issues of control.
Leaders’ Essential Role in Conflict Management
Relational Conflict and Issues of Affiliation
In addition to wanting relational control, each of us has a need to feel included in our relationships, to be liked, and to receive affection (Schutz, 1966). If our needs for closeness are not satisfied in our relationships, we feel frustrated and experience feelings of conflict. Of course, some people like to be very involved and very close in their relationships, while others prefer less involvement and more distance. In any case, when others behave in ways that are incompatible with our own desires for warmth and affection, feelings of conflict emerge.
Relational conflict over affiliation issues is illustrated in the following example of a football coach, Terry Jones, and one of his players, Danny Larson. Danny, a starting quarterback, developed a strong relationship with Coach Jones during his junior year in high school. Throughout the year, Danny and Coach Jones had many highly productive conversations inside and outside of school about how to improve the football program. In the summer,
395
the coach employed Danny in his painting business, and they worked side by side on a first-name basis. Both Danny and Terry liked working together and grew to know each other quite well. However, when football practice started in the fall, difficulties emerged between the two. During the first weeks of practice, Danny acted like Coach Jones was his best buddy. He called him Terry rather than Coach Jones, and he resisted the player–coach role. As Coach Jones attempted to withdraw from his summer relationship with Danny and take on his legitimate responsibilities as a coach, Danny experienced a sense of loss of closeness and warmth. In this situation, Danny felt rejection or a loss of affiliation, and this created a relational conflict.
Relational conflicts—whether they are over esteem, control, or affiliation—are seldom overt. Due to the subtle nature of these conflicts, they are often not easy to recognize or address. Even when they are recognized, relational conflicts are often ignored because it is difficult for many individuals to openly communicate that they want more recognition, control, or affiliation.
According to communication theorists, relational issues are inextricably bound to content issues (Watzlawick et al., 1967). This means that relational conflicts will often surface during the discussion of content issues. For example, what may at first appear to be a conflict between two leaders regarding the content of a new employee fitness program may really be a struggle over which one of the leaders will ultimately receive credit for developing the program. As we mentioned, relational conflicts are complex and not easily resolved. However, when relational conflicts are expressed and confronted, it can significantly enhance the overall resolution process.
396
Managing Conflict in Practice
Communication is central to managing different kinds of conflict in organizations. Leaders who are able to keep channels of communication open with others will have a greater chance of understanding others’ beliefs, values, and needs for esteem, control, and affiliation. With increased understanding, many of the kinds of conflict discussed in the earlier part of this chapter will seem less difficult to resolve and more open to negotiation.
In this section, we will explore three different approaches to resolving conflict: Fisher and Ury’s principled negotiation; the communication strategies of differentiation, fractionation, and face saving; and the Kilmann–Thomas styles of approaching conflict. As we discussed previously, conflict can be multifaceted and complex, and while there is no magic bullet for resolving all conflicts, knowing different approaches can help a leader employ the effective strategies for solving conflict.
397
Fisher and Ury Approach to Conflict
One of the most recognized approaches of conflict negotiation in the world was developed by Roger Fisher and William Ury. Derived from studies conducted by the Harvard Negotiation Project, Fisher and Ury (1981) provide a straightforward, step-by-step method for negotiating conflicts. This method, called principled negotiation, emphasizes deciding issues on their merits rather than through competitive haggling or through excessive accommodation. Principled negotiation shows you how to obtain your fair share decently and without having others take advantage of you (Fisher & Ury, 1981).
A Win-Win Situation
As illustrated in Figure 11.2, the Fisher and Ury negotiation method comprises four principles. Each principle directly focuses on one of the four basic elements of negotiation: people, interests, options, and criteria. Effective leaders frequently understand and utilize these four principles in conflict situations.
Figure 11.2 Fisher and Ury’s Method of Principled Negotiation
Source: Adapted from Fisher, R., & Ury, W. (1981). Getting to yes: Negotiating agreement without giving in. New York, NY: Penguin Books, p. 15.
Principle 1: Separate the People From the Problem
In the previous section of this chapter, we discussed how conflict has a content dimension and a relationship dimension. Similarly, Fisher and Ury (1981) contend that conflicts comprise a problem factor and a people factor. To be effective in dealing with conflicts, both of these factors need to be addressed. In particular, Fisher and Ury argue that the people factor needs to be separated out from the problem factor.
398
Separating people from the problem during conflict is not easy because they are entangled. For example, if a supervisor and her employee are in a heated conversation over the employee’s negative performance review, it is very difficult for the supervisor and the employee to discuss the review without addressing their relationship and personal roles. Our personalities, beliefs, and values are intricately interwoven with our conflicts. However, principled negotiation says that people and the problem need to be disentangled.
By separating people from the problem, we enable ourselves to recognize others’ uniqueness. Everyone has his or her own distinct thoughts and feelings in different situations. Because we all perceive the world differently, we have diverse emotional responses to conflict. By focusing directly on the people aspect of the problem, we become more aware of the personalities and idiosyncratic needs of those with whom we are in conflict.
Perhaps most important, separating people from the problem encourages us to be attentive to our relationships during conflict. Conflicts can strain relationships, so it is important to be cognizant of how one’s behavior during conflict affects the other party. Rather than “beat up” on each other, it is useful to work together, alongside each other, and mutually confront the problem. When we separate people from the problem, we are more inclined to work with others to solve problems. Fisher and Ury (1981) suggest that people in conflict need to “see themselves as working side by side, attacking the problem, not each other” (p. 11). Separating the people from the problem allows us to nurture and strengthen our relationships rather than destroy them.
Consider the earlier example of the supervisor and employee conflict over the negative performance review. In order to separate the people from the problem, both the supervisor and the employee need to discuss the negative review by focusing on performance criteria and behavior issues rather than personal attributes. The review indicated that the employee didn’t meet performance objectives—the boss could say, “You didn’t get your work done,” but in separating the people from the problem, the boss would instead explain how the employee was unable to meet the requirements (“The number of contacts you made was below the required number”). The employee, on the other hand, may feel the objectives were unrealistic. Rather than telling her boss it was his fault (“You set unobtainable objectives”), the employee should make her point by providing facts about how these standards are not realistic (“The economic downturn wasn’t considered when these objectives were developed”). By focusing on the problem in this way, the employer and the employee are maintaining their relationship but also confronting directly the performance review issues.
Principle 2: Focus on Interests, Not Positions
The second principle, which is perhaps the most well known, emphasizes that parties in a
399
conflict must focus on interests and not just positions. Positions represent our stand or perspective in a particular conflict. Interests represent what is behind our positions. Stated another way, positions are the opposing points of view in a conflict while interests refer to the relevant needs and values of the people involved. Fisher and Ury (1981) suggest that “your position is something you have decided upon. Your interests are what caused you to so decide” (p. 42).
Focusing on interests expands conflict negotiation by encouraging individuals to explore the unique underpinnings of the conflict. To identify interests behind a position, it is useful to look at the basic concerns that motivate people. Some of our concerns include needs for security, belonging, recognition, control, and economic well-being (Fisher & Ury, 1981). Being attentive to these basic needs and helping people satisfy them is central to conflict negotiation.
Concentrating on interests also helps opposing parties to address the “real” conflict. Addressing both interests and positions helps to make conflict negotiation more authentic. In his model of authentic leadership, Robert Terry (1993) advocates that leaders have a moral responsibility to ask the question “What is really, really going on in a conflict situation, and what are we going to do about it?” Unless leaders know what truly is going on, their actions will be inappropriate and can have serious consequences. Focusing on interests is a good way to find out what is at the heart of a conflict.
Consider the following conflict between a college professor, Dr. Smith, and his student, Erin Crow, regarding class attendance. Dr. Smith has a mandatory attendance policy, but allows for two absences during the semester. A student’s grade is lowered 10% for each additional absence. Erin is a very bright student who has gotten As on all of her papers and tests. However, she has five absences and does not want to be penalized. Based on the attendance policy, Dr. Smith would lower Erin’s grade 30%, from an A to a C. Erin’s position in this conflict is that she shouldn’t be penalized because she has done excellent work despite her absences. Dr. Smith’s position is that the attendance policy is legitimate and Erin’s grade should be lowered.
In this example, it is worthwhile to explore some of the interests that form the basis for each position. For example, Erin is very reticent and does not like to participate in class. She is carrying 18 credit hours and works two part-time jobs. On the other hand, Dr. Smith is a popular professor who has twice received university-wide outstanding teaching awards. He has 20 years of experience and has a strong publication record in the area of classroom learning methodology. In addition, Dr. Smith has a need to be liked by students, and does not like to be challenged.
Given their interests, it is easy to see that the conflict between Erin and Dr. Smith over class attendance is more complex than meets the eye. If this conflict were to be settled by negotiating positions alone, the resolution would be relatively straightforward, and Erin
400
would most likely be penalized, leaving both parties unsatisfied. However, if the interests of both Erin and Dr. Smith were fully explored, the probability of a mutually agreeable outcome would be far more likely. Dr. Smith is likely to recognize that Erin has numerous obligations that impact her attendance but are important for her economic well-being and security. On the other hand, Erin may come to realize that Dr. Smith is an exemplary teacher who fosters cohesiveness among students by expecting them to show up and participate in class. His needs for control and recognition are challenged by Erin’s attendance and lack of class participation.
The challenge for Erin and Dr. Smith is to focus on their interests, communicate them to each other, and remain open to unique approaches to resolving their conflict.
Principle 3: Invent Options for Mutual Gains
The third strategy in effective conflict negotiation presented by Fisher and Ury (1981) is to invent options for mutual gains. This is difficult to do because humans naturally see conflict as an either-or proposition. We either win or lose; we get what we want, or the other side gets what it wants. We feel the results will be favorable either to us or to the other side, and we do not see any other possible options.
However, this tendency to see conflict as a fixed choice proposition needs to be overcome by inventing new options to resolve the conflict to the satisfaction of both parties. The method of principled negotiation emphasizes that we need to brainstorm and search hard for creative solutions to conflict. We need to expand our options and not limit ourselves to thinking there is a single best solution.
Focusing on the interests of the parties in conflict can result in this kind of creative thinking. By exploring where our interests overlap and dovetail, we can identify solutions that will benefit both parties. This process of fulfilling interests does not need to be antagonistic. We can help each other in conflict by being sensitive to each other’s interests and making it easier, rather than more difficult, for both parties to satisfy their interests. Using the earlier example of Dr. Smith and Erin, Erin could acknowledge Dr. Smith’s need for a consistent attendance policy and explain that she understands that it is important to have a policy to penalize less-than-committed students. She should make the case that the quality of her papers indicates she has learned much from Dr. Smith and is as committed to the class as she can be, given her other obligations. Dr. Smith should explain that he is not comfortable ignoring her absences and that it is unfair to other students who have also been penalized for missing class. They could agree that Erin’s grade will be lowered to a B, rather than a C. While neither party would be “victorious,” both would feel that the best compromise was reached given each person’s unique interests.
Principle 4: Insist on Using Objective Criteria
401
Finally, Fisher and Ury (1981) say that effective negotiation requires that objective criteria be used to settle different interests. The goal in negotiation is to reach a solution that is based on principle and not on pressure. Conflict parties need to search for objective criteria that will help them view their conflict with an unbiased lens. Objective criteria can take many forms, including
precedent, which looks at how this issue has been resolved previously; professional standards, which determine if there are rules or standards for behavior based on a profession or trade involved in the conflict; what a court would decide, which looks at the legal precedent or legal ramifications of the conflict; moral standards, which consider resolving the conflict based on ethical considerations or “doing what’s right”; tradition, which looks at already established practices or customs in considering the conflict; and scientific judgment, which considers facts and evidence.
For example, if an employee and his boss disagree on the amount of a salary increase the employee is to receive, both the employee and the boss might consider the raises of employees with similar positions and work records. When criteria are used effectively and fairly, the outcomes and final package are usually seen as wise and fair (Fisher & Ury, 1981).
In summary, the method of principled negotiation presents four practical strategies that leaders can employ in handling conflicts: separate the people from the problem; focus on interests, not positions; invent options for mutual gains; and insist on using objective criteria. None of these strategies is a panacea for all problems or conflicts, but used together they can provide a general, well-substantiated approach to settling conflicts in ways that are likely to be advantageous to everyone involved in a conflict situation.
402
Communication Strategies for Conflict Resolution
Throughout this chapter, we have emphasized the complexity of conflict and the difficulties that arise in addressing it. There is no universal remedy or simple path. In fact, except for a few newsstand-type books that claim to provide quick cures to conflict, only a few sources give practical techniques for resolution. In this section, we describe several practical communication approaches that play a major role in the conflict resolution process: differentiation, fractionation, and face saving. Using these communication strategies can lessen the angst of the conflict, help conflicting parties to reach resolution sooner, and strengthen relationships.
The Importance of Listening
Differentiation
Differentiation describes a process that occurs in the early phase of conflict; it helps participants define the nature of the conflict and clarify their positions with regard to each other. It is very important to conflict resolution because it establishes the nature and parameters of the conflict. Differentiation requires that individuals explain and elaborate their own position, frequently focusing on their differences rather than their similarities. It is essential to working through a conflict (Putnam, 2010). Differentiation represents a difficult time in the conflict process because it is more likely to involve an escalation of conflict rather than a cooling off. During this time, fears may arise that the conflict will not be successfully resolved. Differentiation is also difficult because it initially personalizes the conflict and brings out feelings and sentiments in people that they themselves are the cause of the conflict (Folger, Poole, & Stutman, 1993).
The value of differentiation is that it defines the conflict. It helps both parties realize how they differ on the issue being considered. Being aware of these differences is useful for conflict resolution because it focuses the conflict, gives credence to both parties’ interests in the issue that is in conflict, and, in essence, depersonalizes the conflict. Consistent with Fisher and Ury’s (1981) method of negotiation, differentiation is a way to separate the people from the problem.
An example of differentiation involves a group project. Members of the group have complained to the instructor that one member, Jennifer, seldom comes to meetings; when she does come, she does not contribute to the group discussions. The instructor met with Jennifer, who defended herself by stating that the group constantly set meeting times that
403
conflict with her work schedule. She believes they do so on purpose to exclude her. The teacher arranged for the students to sit down together, and then had them explain their differing points of view to one another. The group members said that they believed that Jennifer cared less about academic achievement than they did because she did not seem willing to adjust her work schedule to meet with them. Jennifer, on the other hand, said she believed the others did not respect that she had to work to support herself while going to school, and that she was not in total control of her work schedule.
Resolving Intergroup Conflict
In the above example, differentiation occurred among group members as they attempted to assess the issues. It was a difficult process because it demanded that each participant talk about his or her feelings about why the group was having conflict. Both sides ultimately understood the other’s differing viewpoints. The group and Jennifer set aside a definite time each week when they would meet, and Jennifer made sure her supervisor did not schedule her to work at that time.
Fractionation
Fractionation refers to the technique of breaking down large conflicts into smaller, more manageable pieces (Fisher, 1971; Wilmot & Hocker, 2011). Like differentiation, fractionation usually occurs in the early stages of the conflict resolution process. It is an intentional process in which the participants agree to “downsize” a large conflict into smaller conflicts and then confront just one part of the larger conflict. Fractionating conflict is helpful for several reasons. First, fractionation reduces the conflict by paring it down to a smaller, less complex conflict. It is helpful for individuals to know that the conflict they are confronting is not a huge amorphous mass of difficulties, but rather consists of specific and defined difficulties. Second, it gives focus to the conflict. By narrowing down large conflicts, individuals give clarity and definition to their difficulties instead of trying to solve a whole host of problems at once. Third, downsizing a conflict helps to reduce the emotional intensity of the dispute. Smaller conflicts carry less emotional weight (Wilmot & Hocker, 2011). Last, fractionation facilitates a better working relationship between participants in the conflict. In agreeing to address a reduced version of a conflict, the participants confirm their willingness to work with one another to solve problems.
An example of fractionation at work involves David Stedman, an experienced director of a private school that was on the verge of closing due to low enrollment. School board
404
members were upset with David’s leadership and the direction of the school, and David was disappointed with the board. The school had been running on a deficit budget for the previous three years and had used up most of the endowment money it had set aside. The school’s board members saw the problem one way: The school needed more students. David knew it was not that simple. There were many issues behind the low enrollment: the practices for recruitment of students, retention of students, fund-raising, marketing, and out-of-date technology at the school, as well as bad feelings between the parents and the school. In addition to these concerns, David had responsibility for day-to-day operations of the school and decisions regarding the education of students. David asked the board members to attend a weekend retreat where, together, they detailed the myriad problems facing the school and narrowed the long list down to three difficulties that they would address together. They agreed to work on an aggressive recruitment plan, fund-raising efforts, and internal marketing toward parents so they would keep their children at the school.
In the end, the retreat was beneficial to both David and the board. The big conflict of “what to do about the school” was narrowed down to three specific areas they could address. In addition, the school board developed an appreciation for the complexity and difficulties of running the school, and David softened his negative feelings about the school board and its members’ input. As a result of fractionating their conflict, David Stedman and the school board developed a better working relationship and confirmed their willingness to work on problems in the future.
Face Saving
A third skill that can assist a leader in conflict resolution is face saving. Face saving refers to communicative attempts to establish or maintain one’s self-image in response to threat (Folger et al., 1993; Goffman, 1967; Lulofs, 1994). Face-saving messages help individuals establish how they want to be seen by others. The goal of face-saving messages is to protect one’s self-image.
In conflict, which is often threatening and unsettling, participants may become concerned about how others view them in regard to the positions they have taken. This concern for self can be counterproductive to conflict resolution because it shifts the focus of the conflict away from substantive issues and onto personal issues. Instead of confronting the central concerns of the conflict, face-saving concerns force participants to deal with their self- images as they are related to the conflict.
Face Saving
405
Interpersonal conflicts can be made less threatening if individuals communicate in a way that preserves the self-image of the other. Conflict issues should be discussed in a manner that minimizes threat to the participants. By using face-saving messages, such as “I think you are making a good point, but I see things differently,” one person acknowledges another’s point of view without making the other person feel stupid or unintelligent. The threat of conflict is lessened if participants try to support each other’s self-image rather than to damage it just to win an argument. It is important to be aware of how people want to be seen by others, how conflict can threaten those desires, and how our communication can minimize those threats (Lulofs, 1994).
In trying to resolve conflicts, face saving should be a concern to participants for two reasons. First, if possible, participants should try to avoid letting the discussions during conflict shift to face-threatening issues. Similar to Fisher and Ury’s (1981) principle of separating the people from the problem, this can be done by staying focused on content issues and maintaining interactions that do not challenge the other person’s self-image. Second, during the later stages of conflict, face-saving messages can actually be used to assist participants in giving each other validation and support for how they have come across during conflict. Face-saving messages can confirm for others that they have handled themselves appropriately during conflict and that their relationship is still healthy.
The following example illustrates how face saving can affect conflict resolution. At a large university hospital, significant disruptions occurred when 1,000 nurses went on strike after contract negotiations failed. The issues in the conflict were salary, forced overtime, and mandatory coverage of units that were short-staffed. There was much name-calling and personal attacks between nurses and administrators. Early negotiations were inhibited by efforts on both sides to establish an image with the public that what they were doing was appropriate, given the circumstances. As a result, these images and issues of right and wrong, rather than the substantive issues of salary and overtime, became the focus of the conflict. If the parties had avoided tearing each other down, perhaps the conflict could have been settled sooner.
Despite these difficulties, face-saving messages did have a positive effect on this conflict. During the middle of the negotiations, the hospital ran a full-page advertisement in the local newspaper describing its proposal and why it thought this proposal was misunderstood. At the end of the ad, the hospital stated, “We respect your right to strike. A strike is a peaceful and powerful means by which you communicate your concern or dissatisfaction.” This statement showed that the administration was trying to save face for itself, but also it was attempting to save face for nurses by expressing that their being on strike was not amoral, and that the hospital was willing to accept the nurses’ behavior and continue to have a working relationship with them. Similarly, the media messages that both parties released at the end of the strike included affirmation of the other party’s self-image. The nurses, who received a substantial salary increase, did not try to claim victory or point out what the hospital lost in the negotiations. In turn, the hospital, which retained control
406
of the use of staff for overtime, did not emphasize what it had won or communicate that it thought the nurses were unprofessional because they had gone out on strike. The point is that these gentle face-saving messages helped both sides to feel good about themselves, reestablish their image as effective health care providers, and salvage their working relationships.
All in all, there are no shortcuts to resolving conflicts. It is a complex process that requires sustained communication. By being aware of differentiation, fractionation, and face saving, leaders can enhance their abilities and skills in the conflict resolution process.
407
Kilmann and Thomas Styles of Approaching Conflict
There’s no doubt that people have different ways of handling conflict and that these different styles affect the outcomes of conflict. A conflict style is defined as a patterned response or behavior that people use when approaching conflict. One of the most widely recognized models of conflict styles was developed by Kilmann and Thomas (1975, 1977), based on the work of Blake and Mouton (1964), and is the basis for our Conflict Style Questionnaire on pages 269–271.
The Kilmann–Thomas model identifies five conflict styles: (1) avoidance, (2) competition, (3) accommodation, (4) compromise, and (5) collaboration. This model (see Figure 11.3) describes conflict styles along two dimensions: assertiveness and cooperativeness. Assertiveness refers to attempts to satisfy one’s own concerns, while cooperativeness represents attempts to satisfy the concerns of others. Each conflict style is characterized by how much assertiveness and how much cooperativeness an individual shows when confronting conflict.
In conflict situations, a person’s individual style is usually a combination of these five different styles. Nevertheless, because of past experiences or situational factors, some people may rely more heavily on one conflict style than on others. Understanding these styles can help you select the conflict style that is most appropriate to the demands of the situation.
Figure 11.3 Styles of Approaching Conflict
408
Sources: Reproduced with permission of authors and publisher from Kilmann, R. H., & Thomas, K. W. Interpersonal conflict-handling behavior as reflections of Jungian personality dimensions. Psychological Reports, 1975, 37, 971–980. © Psychological Reports, 1975.
Avoidance
Avoidance is both an unassertive and an uncooperative conflict style. Those who favor the avoidance style tend to be passive and ignore conflict situations rather than confront them directly. They employ strategies such as denying there is a conflict, using jokes as a way to deflect conflict, or trying to change the topic. Avoiders are not assertive about pursuing their own interests, nor are they cooperative in assisting others to pursue theirs.
Advantages and Disadvantages. Avoidance as a style for managing conflict is usually counterproductive, often leading to stress and further conflict. Those who continually avoid conflict bottle up feelings of irritation, frustration, anger, or rage inside themselves, creating more anxiety. Avoidance is essentially a static approach to conflict; it does nothing to solve
409
problems or to make changes that could prevent conflicts.
However, there are some situations in which avoidance may be useful—for example, when an issue is of trivial importance or when the potential damage from conflict would be too great. Avoidance can also provide a cooling-off period to allow participants to determine how to best resolve the conflict at a later time. For example, if Jan is so angry at her girlfriend that she throws her cell phone at the wall, she might want to go for a ride in her car or take a walk and cool down before she tries to talk to her girlfriend about the problem.
Competition
Competition is a conflict style of individuals who are highly assertive about pursuing their own goals but uncooperative in assisting others to reach theirs. These individuals attempt to resolve a struggle by controlling or persuading others in order to achieve their own ends. A competitive style is essentially a win-lose conflict strategy. For example, when Wendy seeks to convince Chris that he is a bad person because he habitually shows up late for meetings, regardless of his reasons for doing so, it is a win-lose conflict style.
Advantages and Disadvantages. In some situations, competition can produce positive outcomes. It is useful when quick, decisive action is needed. Competition can also generate creativity and enhance performance because it challenges participants to make their best efforts.
Generally, though, competitive approaches to conflict are not the most advantageous because they are more often counterproductive than productive. Resolution options are limited to one party “beating” another, resulting in a winner and a loser. Attempts to solve conflict with dominance and control will often result in creating unstable situations and hostile and destructive communication. Finally, competition is disconfirming; in competition, individuals fail to recognize the concerns and needs of others.
Accommodation
Accommodation is an unassertive but cooperative conflict style. In accommodation, an individual essentially communicates to another, “You are right, I agree; let’s forget about it.” An approach that is “other directed,” accommodation requires individuals to attend very closely to the needs of others and ignore their own needs. Using this style, individuals confront problems by deferring to others.
Advantages and Disadvantages. Accommodation allows individuals to move away from the uncomfortable feelings that conflict inevitably produces. By yielding to others, individuals can lessen the frustration that conflict creates. This style is productive when the
410
issue is more important to one party than the other or if harmony in the relationship is the most important goal.
The problem with accommodation is that it is, in effect, a lose-win strategy. Although accommodation may resolve conflict faster than some of the other approaches, the drawback is that the accommodator sacrifices his or her own values and possibly a higher- quality decision in order to maintain smooth relationships. It is a submissive style that allows others to take charge. Accommodators also lose because they may fail to express their own opinions and feelings and their contributions are not fully considered.
For example, Jenny’s boyfriend is a sports fanatic and always wants to stay home and watch televised sports while Jenny would like to do something like go to a movie or to a club. But to make him happy, Jenny stays home and watches football.
Compromise
As Figure 11.3 indicates, compromise occurs halfway between competition and accommodation and involves both a degree of assertiveness and a degree of cooperativeness. Many see compromise as a “give and take” proposition. Compromisers attend to the concerns of others as well as to their own needs. On the diagonal axis of Figure 11.3, compromise occurs midway between the styles of avoidance and collaboration. This means that compromisers do not completely ignore confrontations, but neither do they struggle with problems to the fullest degree. This conflict style is often chosen because it is expedient in finding middle ground while partially satisfying the concerns of both parties.
Compromise
Advantages and Disadvantages. Compromise is a positive conflict style because it requires attending to one’s goals as well as others’. Compromise tends to work best when other conflict styles have failed or aren’t suitable to resolving the conflict. Many times, compromise can force an equal power balance between parties.
Among the shortcomings of the compromise style is that it does not go far enough in resolving conflict and can become “an easy way out.” In order to reach resolution, conflicting parties often don’t fully express their own demands, personal thoughts, and feelings. Innovative solutions are sacrificed in favor of a quick resolution, and the need for harmony supersedes the need to find optimal solutions to conflict. The result is that neither side is completely satisfied. For example, Pat wants to go on a camping vacation, and Mike wants to have a “staycation,” hanging around the house. In the end, they agree to spend their vacation taking day trips to the beach and the zoo.
411
Collaboration
Collaboration, the most preferred style of conflict, requires both assertiveness and cooperation. It is when both parties agree to a positive settlement to the conflict and attend fully to the other’s concerns while not sacrificing or suppressing their own. The conflict is not resolved until each side is reasonably satisfied and can support the solution. Collaboration is the ideal conflict style because it recognizes the inevitability of human conflict. It confronts conflict, and then uses conflict to produce constructive outcomes.
Advantages and Disadvantages. The results of collaboration are positive because both sides win, communication is satisfying, relationships are strengthened, and negotiated solutions are frequently more cost-effective in the long run.
Unfortunately, collaboration is the most difficult style to achieve. It demands energy and hard work among participants as well as shared control. Resolving differences through collaboration requires individuals to take time to explore their differences, identify areas of agreement, and select solutions that are mutually satisfying. This often calls for extended conversation in which the participants explore entirely new alternatives to existing problems. For example, residents of a residential neighborhood seek to have an adult entertainment facility in their midst close or leave. The owner refuses. The residents work with city officials to find an alternative location to relocate the facility, and the city gives the facility’s owner tax breaks to move.
The five styles of approaching conflict—avoidance, competition, accommodation, compromise, and collaboration—can be observed in various conflict situations. Although there are advantages and disadvantages to each style, the conflict-handling style that meets the needs of the participants while also fitting the demands of the situation will be most effective in resolving conflict.
412
Summary
For leaders and followers alike, interpersonal conflict is inevitable. Conflict is defined as a felt struggle between two or more individuals over perceived incompatible differences in beliefs, values, and goals, or over differences in desires for esteem, control, and connectedness. If it is managed in appropriate ways, conflict need not be destructive but can be constructive and used to positive ends.
Communication plays a central role in conflict and in its resolution. Conflict occurs between leaders and others on two levels: content and relational. Conflict on the content level involves differences in beliefs, values, or goal orientation. Conflict on the relational level refers to differences between individuals with regard to their desires for esteem, control, and affiliation in their relationships. Relational conflicts are seldom overt, which makes them difficult for people to recognize and resolve.
One approach to resolving conflicts is the method of principled negotiation by Fisher and Ury (1981). This model focuses on four basic elements of negotiation—people, interests, options, and criteria—and describes four principles related to handling conflicts: Principle 1—Separate the People From the Problem; Principle 2—Focus on Interests, Not Positions; Principle 3—Invent Options for Mutual Gains; and Principle 4—Insist on Using Objective Criteria. Collectively, these principles are extraordinarily useful in negotiating positive conflict outcomes.
Three practical communication approaches to conflict resolution are differentiation, fractionation, and face saving. Differentiation is a process that helps participants to define the nature of the conflict and to clarify their positions with one another. Fractionation refers to the technique of paring down large conflicts into smaller, more manageable conflicts. Face saving consists of messages that individuals express to each other in order to maintain each other’s self-image during conflict. Together or singly, these approaches can assist leaders in making the conflict resolution process more productive.
Finally, researchers have found that people approach conflict using five styles: (1) avoidance, (2) competition, (3) accommodation, (4) compromise, and (5) collaboration. Each of these styles characterizes individuals in terms of the degree of assertiveness and cooperativeness they show when confronting conflict. The most constructive approach to conflict is collaboration, which requires that individuals recognize, confront, and resolve conflict by attending fully to others’ concerns without sacrificing their own. Managing conflicts effectively leads to stronger relationships among participants and more creative solutions to problems.
413
Glossary Terms
accommodation 261 avoidance 260 collaboration 262 competition 261 compromise 262 conflict 240 conflict style 259 content conflicts 242 content dimension 242 differentiation 255 face saving 257 fractionation 256 principled negotiation 250 relational conflicts 247 relationship dimension 242
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
414
11.1 Case Study: Office Space The five members of the Web programming department at a marketing company are being relocated to a new space in their building. The move came as a big surprise; the head of the company decided to cut costs by leasing less space, and with just a few days’ notice, the department was relocated.
The new space is a real change from what the programmers are used to. Their old space was a big open room with one wall of floor-to-ceiling windows. Their desks all faced each other, which allowed them to easily talk and collaborate with one another. The new office space has a row of five cubicles along a wall in a long, narrow room. Four of the cubicles have windows; the fifth, which is slightly larger than the others, is tucked into a windowless corner. The cubicle walls are 6 feet tall, and when they are at their desks working, the programmers can no longer see one another.
The team leader, Martin, assigned the cubicles that each programmer has moved into. He put himself in the first cubicle with Rosa, Sanjay, and Kris in the next three cubicles with windows. Bradley was given the larger cubicle in the corner.
Bradley is the first to complain. When he sees his new space, he goes to Martin and asks for a different cubicle, one with a window. He argues that he has been employed there longer than the other programmers and should get to choose his cubicle rather than be told where he is going to be. Because he and Martin work very closely on a number of projects, Bradley feels he should be in the cubicle next to Martin, rather than the one farthest away.
Sanjay is also upset. He is in the middle cubicle with Rosa and Kris on either side of him. Rosa and Kris used to have desks next to each other in the bigger space and would banter back and forth with one another while working. Now that they are in the row of cubicles, they still try to chat with one another, but to do so, they more or less shout to each other over Sanjay’s space. When Martin offers to let him trade places with Bradley as a solution, Sanjay says he doesn’t want to give up his window.
Martin leaves everyone where they are. He hasn’t told them, but he purposely put Sanjay between Rosa and Kris in order to discourage their constant chatting, which he viewed as a time-wasting activity. Martin also felt like the larger cube was better for Bradley because he has more computer equipment than the other programmers.
During the next two months, the Web programming department starts to experience a lot of tension. Sanjay seems to be in a bad mood on a daily basis. When Rosa and Kris start chatting with each other over the cubicles, he asks them loudly, “Will you please just work and stop shouting to each other?” or says sarcastically, “I’m trying to work here!” As a result, either Rosa or Kris will leave her cubicle to walk down to the other’s space to chat, having conversations that last longer than their old bantering back and forth used to.
Bradley stays in his corner cubicle and avoids talking to the other programmers. He believes that Martin purposely gave him what Bradley perceives is the worst cubicle but doesn’t know what he did to deserve being treated this way. He is resentful of the other staff members who have windows in their cubicles and feels like Martin must think more highly of Rosa, Kris, and Sanjay than he does of Bradley. As Bradley observes Rosa and Kris spending more time talking and less time working and the crabbiness from Sanjay, he becomes very upset with Martin. It seems Martin is rewarding the programmers who behave the worst!
Bradley becomes even more reclusive at work and avoids talking to the other programmers, especially Martin. He communicates with them mainly by email messages, even though he’s only a few yards away from some of them. He no longer collaborates closely with Martin; instead he tries to work on projects without involving Martin. Unfortunately, if he encounters a problem that he needs Martin’s help for, Bradley will try to solve it himself. Often, Martin won’t even know there is a problem that needs to be
415
solved until Bradley realizes he can’t solve it alone and the problem becomes a crisis.
The only time all five of the programmers actually see one another is in weekly staff meetings, which are held in a conference room with a large table and a dozen chairs. In their old space, they didn’t have weekly meetings because they were able to talk about projects and schedules with each other whenever it was needed. In their new staff meetings, it seems like Martin is doing all the talking. Rosa and Kris sit on one side of the table and try to ignore Sanjay who sits by himself across from them. Bradley sits at the far end of the table at least two chairs away from everyone else.
After another unproductive staff meeting where no one spoke or looked at one another, Martin sits at the head of the conference table after the other programmers have left with his head in his hands. He doesn’t know what has happened to the cohesive team he used to lead and why things changed. It seems absolutely ridiculous to him that this is all about space.
416
Questions 1. How would you describe the conflict that has arisen between the members of the Web
programming department? 2. Is the conflict a relational conflict? If so, what type of relational conflict? Is there a content
dimension to this conflict? 3. Using Fisher and Ury’s method of principled negotiation, how would you separate the people from
the problem? What do you think is really, really going on in this conflict? 4. Using the Kilmann and Thomas conflict styles, how would you characterize Sanjay’s conflict style?
What about Bradley’s? Do Rosa and Kris have a style as well? 5. How could Martin use fractionation and face saving in attempting to resolve this conflict?
417
11.2 Conflict Style Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your conflict style 2. To examine how your conflict style varies in different contexts or relationships
Directions
1. Think of two different situations (A and B) where you have a conflict, a disagreement, an argument, or a disappointment with someone, such as a roommate or a work associate. Write the name of the person for each situation below.
2. According to the scale below, fill in your scores for Situation A and Situation B. For each question, you will have two scores. For example, on Question 1 the scoring might look like this: 1. 2 | 4
3. Write the name of each person for the two situations here: Person A ______________________________ Person B _______________________________ 1 = never 2 = seldom 3 = sometimes 4 = often 5 = always
Person A Person B
1. _____|____ I avoid being “put on the spot”; I keep conflicts to myself.
2. _____|____ I use my influence to get my ideas accepted.
3. _____|____ I usually try to “split the difference” in order to resolve an issue.
4. _____|____ I generally try to satisfy the other’s needs.
5. _____|____ I try to investigate an issue to find a solution acceptable to both of us.
6. _____|____ I usually avoid open discussion of my differences with the other.
7. _____|____ I use my authority to make a decision in my favor.
8. _____|____ I try to find a middle course to resolve an impasse.
9. _____|____ I usually accommodate the other’s wishes.
10. _____|____ I try to integrate my ideas with the other’s to come up with a decision jointly.
11. _____|____ I try to stay away from disagreement with the other.
12. _____|____ I use my expertise to make a decision that favors me.
13. _____|____ I propose a middle ground for breaking deadlocks.
418
14. _____|____ I give in to the other’s wishes.
15. _____|____ I try to work with the other to find solutions that satisfy both our expectations.
16. _____|____ I try to keep my disagreement to myself in order to avoid hard feelings.
17. _____|____ I generally pursue my side of an issue.
18. _____|____ I negotiate with the other to reach a compromise.
19. _____|____ I often go with the other’s suggestions.
20. _____|____ I exchange accurate information with the other so we can solve a problem together.
21. _____|____ I try to avoid unpleasant exchanges with the other.
22. _____|____ I sometimes use my power to win.
23. _____|____ I use “give and take” so that a compromise can be made.
24. _____|____ I try to satisfy the other’s expectations.
25. _____|____ I try to bring all our concerns out in the open so that the issues can be resolved. Source: Adapted from “Confirmatory Factor Analysis of the Styles of Handling Interpersonal Conflict: First-Order Factor Model and Its Invariance Across Groups,” by M. A. Rahim and N. R. Magner, 1995, Journal of Applied Psychology, 80(1), 122–132. In W. Wilmot and J. Hocker (2011), Interpersonal Conflict (pp. 146–148). Published by the American Psychological Association.
Scoring: Add up your scores on the following questions:
A | B A | B A | B A | B A | B
1. ____|____
6. ____|____
11. ____|____
16. ____|____
21. ____|____
2. ____|____
7. ____|____
12. ____|____
17. ____|____
22. ____|____
3. ____|____
8. ____|____
13. ____|____
18. ____|____
23. ____|____
4. ____|____
9. ____|____
14. ____|____
19. ____|____
24. ____|____
5. ____|____
10. ____|____
15. ____|____
20. ____|____
25. ____|____
____|____
A | B
Avoidance Totals
____|____
A | B
Competition Totals
____|____
A | B
Compromise Totals
____|____
A | B
Accommodation Totals
____|____
A | B
Collaboration Totals
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to identify your conflict style and examine how it varies in different contexts
419
or relationships. By comparing your total scores for the different styles, you can discover which conflict style you rely most heavily upon and which style you use least. Furthermore, by comparing your scores for Person A and Person B, you can determine how your style varies or stays the same in different relationships. Your scores on this questionnaire are indicative of how you responded to a particular conflict at a specific time and therefore might change if you selected a different conflict or a different conflict period. The Conflict Style Questionnaire is not a personality test that labels or categorizes you; rather, it attempts to give you a sense of your more dominant and less dominant conflict styles.
Scores from 21 to 25 are representative of a very strong style. Scores from 16 to 20 are representative of a strong style. Scores from 11 to 15 are representative of an average style. Scores from 6 to 10 are representative of a weak style. Scores from 0 to 5 are representative of a very weak style.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical suggestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
420
11.3 Observational Exercise
421
Managing Conflict
Purpose
1. To become aware of the dimensions of interpersonal conflict 2. To explore how to use Fisher and Ury’s (1981) method of principled negotiation to address actual
conflict
Directions
1. For this exercise, you are being asked to observe an actual conflict. Attend a public meeting at which a conflict is being addressed. For example, you could attend a meeting of the campus planning board, which has on its agenda changes in student parking fees.
2. Take notes on the meeting, highlighting the positions and interests of all the people who participated in the meeting.
Questions
1. How did the participants at the meeting frame their arguments? What positions did individuals take at the meeting?
2. Identify and describe the interests of each of the participants at the meeting. 3. Discuss whether the participants were able to be objective in their approaches to the problem.
Describe how the people involved were able to separate themselves from the problem. 4. In what ways did the participants seek to find mutually beneficial solutions to their conflict?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
422
11.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
423
Managing Conflict
Reflection
1. How do you react to conflict? Based on the Conflict Style Questionnaire, how would you describe your conflict style? How has your past history influenced your conflict style?
2. This chapter describes three kinds of relational conflict (i.e., esteem, control, affiliation). Of the three kinds, which is most common in the conflicts you have with others? Discuss.
Action
1. Briefly describe an actual conflict you had with a family member, roommate, or coworker in the recent past. Identify the positions and interests of both you and the other person in the conflict. (Note: Individuals’ positions may be easier to identify than their interests. Be creative in detailing your interests and the other person’s.)
2. Describe how you could fractionate the conflict. 3. Using Fisher and Ury’s (1981) methods, describe how you could separate the person from the
problem and how you could work together to address the conflict. During your discussions, how could you help the other party in the conflict save face? How could the other party help you save face?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
424
References Blake, R. R., & Mouton, L. S. (1964). The managerial grid. Houston, TX: Gulf.
Brown, C. T., & Keller, P. W. (1979). Monologue to dialogue: An exploration of interpersonal communication. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Faruqi, A. (Producer), & Obaid-Chinoy, S. (Director). (2013). Humaira: The dreamcatcher [Motion picture]. Pakistan: SOC films.
Fisher, R. (1971). Fractionating conflict. In C. G. Smith (Ed.), Conflict resolution: Contributions of the behavioral sciences (pp. 157–159). South Bend, IN: University of Notre Dame Press.
Fisher, R., & Ury, W. (1981). Getting to yes: Negotiating agreement without giving in. New York, NY: Penguin Books.
Folger, J. P., Poole, M. S., & Stutman, R. K. (1993). Working through conflict: Strategies for relationships, groups, and organizations (2nd ed.). Glenview, IL: Scott, Foresman.
Goffman, E. (1967). Interaction ritual: Essays on face-to-face behavior. New York, NY: Anchor Books.
Hocker, J. L., & Wilmot, W. W. (1995). Interpersonal conflict (4th ed.). Dubuque, IA: W. C. Brown.
Kilmann, R. H., & Thomas, K. W. (1975). Interpersonal conflict-handling behavior as reflections of Jungian personality dimensions. Psychological Reports, 37(3), 971–980.
Kilmann, R. H., & Thomas, K. W. (1977). Developing a forced-choice measure of conflict handling behavior: The “mode” instrument. Educational and Psychology Measurement, 37(2), 309–325.
425
Knutson, T., Lashbrook, V., & Heemer, A. (1976). The dimensions of small group conflict: A factor analytic study. Paper presented to the annual meeting of the International Communication Association, Portland, OR.
Lulofs, R. S. (1994). Conflict: From theory to action. Scottsdale, AZ: Gorsuch Scarisbrick.
Maslow, A. (1970). Motivation and personality (2nd ed.). New York, NY: Harper & Row.
Putnam, L. L. (2010). Communication as changing the negotiation game. Journal of Applied Communication Research, 38(4), 325–335.
Rahi, S. (Producer). (2010, December 10). Humaira Bachal documentary [Motion picture]. Dawn News. Retrieved June 10, 2013, from www.youtube.com/watch? v=3Hs2hxrY_HI
Schutz, W. C. (1966). The interpersonal underworld. Palo Alto, CA: Science and Behavior Books.
Temple-Raston, D. (2013, January 3). After fighting to go to school, a Pakistani woman builds her own. Weekend Edition Sunday [Radio news program]. Retrieved from http://www.npr.org/2013/01/06/168565152/after-fighting-to-go-to-school-a-pakistani- woman-builds-her-own
Terry, R. W. (1993). Authentic leadership: Courage in action. San Francisco, CA: Jossey- Bass.
Watzlawick, P., Beavin, J., & Jackson, D. D. (1967). Pragmatics of human communication. New York, NY: Norton.
Wilmot, W. W., & Hocker, J. (2011). Interpersonal conflict (8th ed.). New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
426
12 Addressing Ethics in Leadership
427
Introduction
Leadership has a moral dimension because leaders influence the lives of others. Because of this influential dimension, leadership carries with it an enormous ethical responsibility. Hand in hand with the authority to make decisions is the obligation a leader has to use his or her authority for the common good. Because the leader usually has more power and control than followers have, leaders have to be particularly sensitive to how their leadership affects the well-being of others.
What is Ethical Leadership and Why is it Relevant?
In recent years, there have been an overwhelming number of scandals in the public and private sectors. Accounting and financial scandals have occurred at some of the largest companies in the world, including Adelphia, Enron, Tyco International, and WorldCom. In addition, there have been stories of sexual abuse in the Catholic Church, sexual assaults within the U.S. military, and a multitude of sexual scandals in the lives of public figures including governors, U.S. senators, and mayors, to name but a few. As a result of such high-profile scandals, people are becoming suspicious of public figures and what they do. The public strongly seeks moral leadership.
As mentioned in Chapter 1, “Understanding Leadership,” the overriding purpose of this book is to discover “what it takes to be a leader.” Closely related to this question, and perhaps even more important, is “what it takes to be an ethical leader.” That query is the focus of this chapter. This means our emphasis will be on describing how people act when they show ethical leadership. While it is always intriguing to know whether one is or is not perceived by others to be ethical, our emphasis will not be directed toward whether you are or are not ethical, but rather we will focus on the properties and characteristics of ethical leadership. The assumption we are making is that if you understand the nature of ethical leadership, you will be better equipped to engage in ethical leadership.
Before we discuss the factors that account for ethical leadership, you may want to go to the end of the chapter and take the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire (12.2). It will help you understand your own ethical leadership style and at the same time introduce you to the ideas we will be discussing in this chapter.
428
Leadership Ethics Explained
To begin, it is important to first define ethical leadership. In the simplest terms, ethical leadership is the influence of a moral person who moves others to do the right thing in the right way for the right reasons (Ciulla, 2003). Put another way, ethical leadership is a process by which a good person rightly influences others to accomplish a common good: to make the world better, fairer, and more humane.
Defining Ethical Leadership
Ethics is concerned with the kind of values and morals an individual or society finds desirable or appropriate. In leadership, ethics has to do with what leaders do and the nature of leaders’ behavior, including their motives. Because leaders often have control, power, and influence over others, their leadership affects other individuals and organizations. Because of this, it is the leader’s ethics—through his or her behavior, decisions, and interactions— that establish the ethical climate for an organization.
429
Leadership Ethics in Practice
Leadership ethics is a complex phenomenon with multiple parts that overlap and are interconnected. When trying to practice ethical leadership, there are six factors (Figure 12.1) that should be of special importance to leaders. Each of these factors plays a role in who leaders are and what they do when they are engaged in ethical leadership.
Figure 12.1 Factors Related to Ethical Leadership
1. The character of the leader 2. The actions of the leader 3. The goals of the leader 4. The honesty of the leader 5. The power of the leader 6. The values of the leader
430
1. The Character of the Leader
The character of the leader is a fundamental aspect of ethical leadership. When it is said that a leader has strong character, that leader is seen as a good and honorable human being. The leader’s character refers to the qualities, disposition, and core values of the leader. More than 2,000 years ago, Aristotle argued that a moral person demonstrates the virtues of courage, generosity, self-control, honesty, sociability, modesty, fairness, and justice (Velasquez, 1992). Today, all these qualities still contribute to a strong character.
The Philosopher Leader
Character is something that is developed. In recent years, the nation’s schools have seen a growing interest in character education. Misbehavior of public figures has led to mistrust of public figures, which has led to the public demanding that educators do a better job of training children to be good citizens. As a result, most schools today teach character education as part of their normal curriculum. A model for many of these programs was developed by the Josephson Institute (2008) in California, which frames instruction around six dimensions of character: trustworthiness, respect, responsibility, fairness, caring, and citizenship (see Table 12.1). Based on these and similar character dimensions, schools are emphasizing the importance of character and how core values influence an individual’s ethical decision making.
Although character is clearly at the core of who you are as a person, it is also something you can learn to strengthen and develop. A leader can learn good values. When practiced over time, from youth to adulthood, good values become habitual, and a part of people themselves. By telling the truth, people become truthful; by giving to the poor, people become charitable; and by being fair to others, people become just. Your virtues, and hence your character, are derived from your actions.
An example of a leader with strong character is Nobel Peace Prize winner Nelson Mandela (see page 27). Mandela was a deeply moral man with a strong conscience. When fighting to abolish apartheid in South Africa, he was unyielding in his pursuit of justice and equality for all. When he was in prison and was offered the chance to leave early in exchange for denouncing his viewpoint, he chose to remain incarcerated rather than compromise his position. In addition to being deeply concerned for others, Mandela was a courageous, patient, humble, and compassionate man. He was an ethical leader who ardently believed in the common good.
431
Mandela clearly illustrates that character is an essential component of moral leadership. Character enables a leader to maintain his or her core ethical values even in times of immense adversity. Character forms the centerpiece of a person’s values, and is fundamental to ethical leadership.
432
2. The Actions of the Leader
In addition to being about a leader’s character, ethical leadership is about the actions of a leader. Actions refer to the ways a leader goes about accomplishing goals. Ethical leaders use moral means to achieve their goals. The way a leader goes about his or her work is a critical determinant of whether he or she is an ethical leader. We may all be familiar with the Machiavellian phrase “the ends justify the means,” but an ethical leader keeps in mind a different version of this and turns it into a question: “Do the ends justify the means?” In other words, the actions a leader takes to accomplish a goal need to be ethical. They cannot be justified by the necessity or importance of the leader’s goals. Ethical leadership involves using morally appropriate actions to achieve goals.
Table 12.1 The Six Pillars of Character Table 12.1 The Six Pillars of Character
Trustworthiness
Trustworthiness is the most complicated of the six core ethical values and concerns a variety of qualities like honesty, integrity, reliability, and loyalty.
• Be honest
• Be reliable: do what you say you’ll do
• Have the courage to do the right thing
• Don’t deceive, cheat, or steal
• Build a good reputation
Respect
While we have no ethical duty to hold all people in high esteem,
• Be tolerant of differences
• Use good manners
433
we should treat everyone with respect. • Be considerate of others
• Work out disagreements
Responsibility
Ethical people show responsibility by being accountable, pursuing excellence, and exercising self-restraint. They exhibit the ability to respond to expectations.
• Do your job
• Persevere
• Think before you act
• Consider the consequences
• Be accountable for your choices
Fairness
Fairness implies adherence to a balanced standard of justice without relevance to one’s own feelings or indications.
• Play by the rules
• Be open- minded
• Don’t take advantage of others
• Don’t blame others
Caring
• Be kind
434
Caring is the heart of ethics and ethical decision making. It is scarcely possible to be truly ethical and yet unconcerned with the welfare of others. This is because ethics is ultimately about good relations with other people.
compassionate
• Forgive others
• Help people in need
Citizenship
The good citizen gives more than she takes, doing more than her “fair” share to make society work, now and for future generations. Citizenship includes civic virtues and duties that prescribe how we ought to behave as part of a community.
• Share with your community
• Get involved
• Stay informed: vote
• Respect authority
• Protect the environment
Source: © 2008 Josephson Institute. The definitions of the Six Pillars of Character are reprinted with permission. www.charactercounts.org
To illustrate the importance of ethical actions, consider what happened at the Abu Ghraib prison in Iraq in 2004. Because of the atrocities on 9/11, national security and intelligence gathering became a high priority. Rules and standards of interrogation were expanded, and harsh interrogation methods were approved. The government’s goal was to obtain information for purposes of national security.
Problems at the prison became evident when the media reported that prisoners were being sexually abused, humiliated, and tortured by prison personnel and civilian contract employees. Gruesome photographs of demeaning actions to prisoners appeared in the media and on the Internet. To obtain intelligence information, some U.S. Army soldiers used means that violated military regulations and internationally held rules on the humane treatment of prisoners of war established by the Geneva Convention in 1948.
In the case of the Abu Ghraib prison, the goal of maintaining national security and intelligence gathering was legitimate and worthwhile. However, the means that were used
435
criminal. Many believe that the goals did not justify the means.
In everyday situations, a leader can act in many different ways to accomplish goals; each of these actions has ethical implications. For example, when a leader rewards some employees and not others, it raises questions of fairness. If a leader fails to take into consideration an employee’s major health problems and instead demands that a job be completed on short notice, it raises questions about the leader’s compassion for others. Even a simple task such as scheduling people’s workload or continually giving more favorable assignments to one person over another reflects the ethics of the leader. In reality, almost everything a leader does has ethical overtones.
Given the importance of a leader’s actions, what ethical principles should guide how a leader acts toward others? Ethical principles for leaders have been described by many scholars (Beauchamp & Bowie, 1988; Ciulla, 2003; Johnson, 2005; Kanungo, 2001; Kanungo & Mendonca, 1996). These writings highlight the importance of many ethical standards. In addition, there are three principles that have particular relevance to our discussion of the actions of ethical leaders: (1) showing respect, (2) serving others, and (3) showing justice.
1. Showing respect. To show respect means to treat others as unique human beings and never as means to an end. It requires treating others’ decisions and values with respect. It also requires valuing others’ ideas and affirming these individuals as unique human beings. When a leader shows respect to followers, followers become more confident and believe their contributions have value.
Ethical Principles
2. Serving others. Clearly, serving others is an example of altruism, an approach that suggests that actions are ethical if their primary purpose is to promote the best interest of others. From this perspective, a leader may be called on to act in the interest of others, even when it may run contrary to his or her self-interests (Bowie, 1991). In the workplace, serving others can be observed in activities such as mentoring, empowering others, team building, and citizenship behaviors (Kanungo & Mendonca, 1996). In practicing the principle of service, an ethical leader must be willing to be follower centered. That is, the leader tries to place others’ interests foremost in his or her work, and act in ways that will benefit others.
3. Showing justice. Ethical leaders make it a top priority to treat all of their followers in an equal manner. Justice demands that a leader place the issue of fairness at the center of decision making. As a rule, no one should receive special treatment or special consideration
436
except when a particular situation demands it. When individuals are treated differently, the grounds for different treatment must be clear, reasonable, and based on sound moral values.
In addition, justice is concerned with the Golden Rule: Treat others as you would like to be treated. If you expect fair treatment from others, then you should treat others fairly. Issues of fairness become problematic because there is always a limit on goods and resources. As a result, there is often competition for scarce resources. Because of the real or perceived scarcity of resources, conflicts often occur between individuals about fair methods of distribution. It is important for a leader to establish clearly the rules for distributing rewards. The nature of these rules says a lot about the ethical underpinnings of the leader and the organization.
The challenge of treating everyone fairly is illustrated in what happened to Richard Lee when he coached his son’s Little League baseball team. His son, Eric, was an outstanding pitcher with a lot of natural ability. During one of the games, Eric became frustrated with his performance and began acting very immaturely, throwing his bat and kicking helmets. When Richard saw Eric’s inappropriate behavior, he immediately took his son out of the game and sat him on the bench. The player who replaced Eric in the lineup was not as good a pitcher, and the team lost the game.
Leadership Snapshot: Warren Buffett and Bill and Melinda Gates, Founders, The Giving Pledge
© Getty image 71299964 by Spencer Platt.
It started with three billionaires promising to give away half their fortune during their lifetimes and now encompasses more than 150 other super-rich families from around the world promising to do the same thing (Giving Pledge, 2016).
437
The Giving Pledge was spearheaded in 2010 by Bill and Melinda Gates and Warren Buffett, Nos. 1 and 2 respectively on the Forbes list of the world’s richest people, to encourage a new era in philanthropy. Instead of waiting until they die to give away their money, billionaires are encouraged by the Giving Pledge to make donations earlier in their lives while they can still choose how to spend it.
“I don’t know anyone who can’t live on $500 million,” Buffet has said (Frank, 2011).
The pledge is simple: The signers have to be billionaires, and they have to promise to give away at least half of their fortunes during their lifetimes. There are no constraints on where the money goes; causes supported by the pledge thus far have ranged from helping farmers in Appalachia to developing a major drug used to treat breast cancer to funding Jewish schools.
The pledge is less about the financial promise than it is about a public statement meant to inspire others, say the organizers. The pledge has also created a de facto “club” of sorts, where the signers get together on a regular basis to compare notes and share ideas.
“The goal is to raise the visibility of philanthropy and the great things it can do,” says Bill Gates, the founder of Microsoft. Through these gatherings, billionaires swap experiences and frustrations and debate strategies for how to give away their wealth. “People are collaborating more than they would have otherwise,” Gates says (Fowler, 2012).
The pledge is just that: a nonbinding promise to give away at least half of one’s fortune while alive or in a will. It doesn’t impose any penalties for failing to give it away. The Giving Pledge is coordinated by the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation, but the foundation doesn’t keep track of signatories’ donations.
Gates, however, doesn’t think the pledge will have a problem with signatories keeping their promises. “They are making a commitment in the court of public opinion,” he says (Fowler, 2012).
For some critics, the pledge has raised questions about the power of the super-wealthy using these donations to shape issues of public concern like education and health care. Some have said that the pledge is a reminder of the economic disparities between the haves and have-nots and that if you have money you can control things, including charities.
“There is already a wide financial disparity between large and small nonprofits and between those institutions that serve disadvantaged populations and those that cater to more established constituencies,” writes Pablo Eisenberg of the Georgetown McCourt School of Public Policy’s Center for Public & Nonprofit Leadership. “The pledges will invariably increase that gap, broadening the inequities in our nonprofit and charitable system” (Eisenberg, 2011).
But one young billionaire, 28-year-old Facebook founder Mark Zuckerberg, signed the pledge and immediately made good on it by donating $100 million to Newark, New Jersey’s public schools.
“There’s so much that needs to be done, it would be better to start now,” he says (Guth & Fowler, 2010).
Fellow billionaire and Giving Pledge signer Nicolas Berggruen agrees. “Wealth is an advantage, but it also is frankly a responsibility” (Guth & Fowler, 2010).
After the game, Richard received a lot of criticism. In addition to Eric being mad at him, the parents of the other players were very angry. Some of the parents came to Richard and told him that he should not have pulled his son out of the game because it caused the team to lose.
In this example, the other players’ parents failed to recognize what Richard was doing as a coach. Richard made a strong effort to be fair to all the players by treating his son the way he would treat any player who acted out. He set a standard of good sportsmanship; when
438
his own son violated the rules, he was disciplined. Richard’s actions were ethical, but coaching the team as he did was not easy. He did the right thing, but there were repercussions.
This example underscores the importance of the actions of a leader. A leader’s actions play a significant role in determining whether that leader is ethical or unethical.
439
3. The Goals of the Leader
The goals that a leader establishes are the third factor related to ethical leadership. How a leader uses goals to influence others says a lot about the leader’s ethics. For example, Adolf Hitler was able to convince millions of people that the eradication of the Jews was justified. It was an evil goal, and he was an immoral leader. The al-Qaeda terrorists’ attack on targets in the United States was motivated by a goal to seek retribution for the United States’ stance on Middle East affairs. On the positive side, Mother Teresa’s goal to help the poor and disenfranchised was moral. Similarly, Habitat for Humanity’s goal to build houses for the disadvantaged is moral. All of these examples highlight the significant role that goals play in determining whether leadership is ethical. The goals a leader selects are a reflection of the leader’s ethics.
Goals and Unethical Leadership
Identifying and pursuing just and worthy goals are the most important steps an ethical leader will undertake. In choosing goals, an ethical leader must assess the relative value and worth of his or her goals. In the process, it is important for the leader to take into account the interests of others in the group or organization and, in some cases, the interests of the community and larger culture in which he or she works. An ethical leader tries to establish goals on which all parties can mutually agree. An ethical leader with ethical goals will not impose his or her will on others.
Jacob Heckert, president of a regional health insurance company, is an example of a leader who used his leadership for worthwhile goals. Jacob believed in community service and advocated, but did not demand, that his employees engage in community service as well. Because he had several friends with diabetes and two of his employees had died of end-stage renal disease, Jacob was particularly interested in supporting the National Kidney Foundation. To promote his cause, he urged his entire company of 4,000 employees to join him in raising money for the National Kidney Foundation’s 5K. Each employee who signed up was responsible for raising $100. Everyone who participated received a free water bottle and T-shirt.
On the day of the rally, Jacob was surprised when more than 1,800 employees from his company showed up to participate. The rally was a great success, raising more than $180,000 for the National Kidney Foundation. The employees felt good about being able to contribute to a worthy cause, and they enjoyed the community spirit that surrounded the event. Jacob was extremely pleased that his goals had been realized.
440
4. The Honesty of the Leader
Another major factor that contributes to ethical leadership is honesty. More than any other quality, people want their leaders to be honest. In fact, it could be said that being honest is synonymous with being ethical.
When we were children, we were frequently told by grown-ups to “never tell a lie.” To be good meant telling the truth. For leaders, the lesson is the same. To be an ethical leader, a leader needs to be honest.
Dishonesty is a form of lying, a way of misrepresenting reality. Dishonesty may bring with it many negative outcomes, the foremost of which is that it creates distrust. When a leader is not honest, others come to see that leader as undependable and unreliable. They lose faith in what the leader says and stands for, and their respect for this individual is diminished. As a result, the leader’s impact is compromised because others no longer trust and believe what he or she says.
Dishonesty also has a negative effect on a leader’s interpersonal relationships. It puts a strain on how the leader and followers are connected to each other. When a leader lies to others, the leader in essence is saying that manipulation of others is acceptable. For example, when a boss does not come forth with a raise he promised, an employee will begin to distrust the boss. The long-term effect of this type of behavior, if ongoing, is a weakened relationship. Dishonesty, even when used with good intentions, contributes to the breakdown of relationships.
Emerging From Scandal
But being honest is not just about the leader telling the truth. It also has to do with being open with others and representing reality as fully and completely as possible. This is not an easy task because there are times when telling the complete truth can be destructive or counterproductive. The challenge for a leader is to strike a balance between being open and candid, and at the same time monitoring what is appropriate to disclose in a particular situation.
An example of this delicate balance can be seen in a story about Dan Johnson. Dan was hired to work as an executive with a large manufacturing company. The new job required Dan and his family to leave the small Michigan community they lived in, giving up jobs and friends, to move to Chicago. The family put its house on the market and began
441
looking for a new home and jobs in Chicago. A few days after Dan started, his boss, Justin Godfrey, took him aside and told him that he should not sell his Michigan house at that time. Justin suggested that Dan postpone his move by using his wife’s job as an excuse when people inquired why the family had not moved to Chicago. Justin could not tell him any more, but Dan knew something major was about to happen. It did. The company announced a merger a few months later, and Dan’s job in Chicago was eliminated. Justin was required to keep the merger news quiet, but if he had not confided the little information that he did, members of Dan’s family would have uprooted their lives only to have them uprooted again. They would have experienced not only financial losses but emotional ones as well.
This example illustrates that it is important for a leader to be authentic. At the same time, it is essential that leaders be sensitive to the attitudes and feelings of others. Honest leadership involves a wide set of behaviors, which includes being truthful in appropriate ways.
442
5. The Power of the Leader
Another factor that plays a role in ethical leadership is power. Power is the capacity to influence or affect others. A leader has power because he or she has the ability to affect others’ beliefs, attitudes, and courses of action. Religious leaders, managers, coaches, and teachers are all people who have the potential to influence others. When they use their potential, they are using their power as a resource to effect change in others.
The most widely cited research on power is French and Raven’s (1959) work on the bases of social power. French and Raven identified five common and important bases of power: referent power, expert power, legitimate power, reward power, and coercive power (see Table 12.2). Each of these types of power increases a leader’s capacity to have an impact on others, and each has the potential to be abused.
Power and Ethics
Since power can be used in positive ways to benefit others or in destructive ways to hurt others, a leader needs to be aware of and sensitive to how he or she uses power. How a leader uses power says a great deal about that leader’s ethics. Power is not inherently bad, but it can be used in negative ways.
As discussed in Chapter 1, “Understanding Leadership,” there is dark side of leadership where a leader uses his or her influence or power for personal ends. Unfortunately, there are many examples in the world of such leaders. One example was Saddam Hussein, the president of Iraq from 1979 to 2003. Recognized widely as a brutal dictator, Hussein was a Sunni Muslim (a minority in Iraq), a sect of Islam that has a centuries-old conflict with the country’s majority Shi’a Muslims and ethnic Kurds. When Hussein assumed power, he used his security forces to systematically murder anyone who opposed him. Many of these were genocidal massacres of innocent Iraqi citizens who were Shi’a Muslims and ethnic Kurds. The number of Iraqis murdered by Hussein’s forces is unknown, but it is believed to be more than 250,000. Another example of a leader using power in unethical and destructive ways is Jim Jones, an American who set up a religious cult in the country of Guyana, and who led more than 900 of his followers to commit suicide by drinking cyanide-laced punch. While these are extreme examples, power can also be abused in everyday leadership. For example, a supervisor who forces an employee to work every weekend by threatening to fire the worker if she or he does not comply is being unethical in the use of power. Another example is a high school cross-country track coach who is highly admired by his runners, but who requires them to take costly health food supplements even
443
though the supplements are not proven effective by standard medical guidelines. There are many ways that power can be abused by a leader. From the smallest to the largest forms of influence, a leader needs to try to be fair and caring in his or her leadership.
Table 12.2 Five Bases of Power Table 12.2 Five Bases of Power
1. Referent power
Based on followers’ identification and liking for the leader
Example: A college professor who is highly admired by students
2. Expert power
Based on the followers’ perceptions of the leader’s competence
Example: A person with strong knowledge about a software program
3. Legitimate power
Associated with having status or formal job authority
Example: A judge who presides over a court case
4. Reward power
Derived from having the capacity to provide benefits to others
Example: A supervisor who can give bonuses to employees
5. Coercive power
Derived from being able to penalize or punish others
Example: A teacher who can lower a student’s grade for missing class
Source: Based on French and Raven (1959).
The key to not misusing power is to be constantly vigilant and aware of the way one’s leadership affects others. An ethical leader does not wield power or dominate, but instead takes into account the will of the followers, as well as the leader’s own will. An ethical leader uses power to work with followers to accomplish their mutual goals.
444
6. The Values of the Leader
A final factor that contributes to understanding ethical leadership is values. Values are the ideas, beliefs, and modes of action that people find worthwhile or desirable. Some examples of values are peace, justice, integrity, fairness, and community. A leader’s ethical values are demonstrated in everyday leadership.
Values and Leadership
Scholar James MacGregor Burns suggested that there are three kinds of leadership values: ethical values, such as kindness and altruism; modal values, such as responsibility and accountability; and end values, such as justice and community (Ciulla, 2003). Ethical values are similar to the notion of character discussed earlier in this chapter. Modal values are concerned with the means or actions a leader takes. End values describe the outcomes or goals a leader seeks to achieve. End values are present when a person addresses broad issues such as liberty and justice. These three kinds of values are interrelated in ethical leadership.
In leadership situations, both the leader and the follower have values, and these values are seldom the same. A leader brings his or her own unique values to leadership situations, and followers do the same. The challenge for the ethical leader is to be faithful to his or her own leadership values while being sensitive to the followers’ values.
For example, a leader in an organization may value community and encourage his or her employees to work together and seek consensus in planning. However, the leader’s followers may value individuality and self-expression. This creates a problem because these values are seemingly in conflict. In this situation, an ethical leader needs to find a way to advance his or her own interests in creating community without destroying the followers’ interests in individuality. There is a tension between these different values; an ethical leader needs to negotiate through these differences to find the best outcome for everyone involved. While the list of possible conflicts of values is infinite, finding common ground between a leader and followers is usually possible, and is essential to ethical leadership.
In the social services sector, where there are often too few resources and too many people in need, leaders constantly struggle with decisions that test their values. Because resources are scarce, a leader has to decide where to allocate the resources; these decisions communicate a lot about the leader’s values. For example, in mentoring programs such as Big Brothers Big Sisters, the list of children in need is often much longer than the list of available mentors. How do administrators decide which child is going to be assigned a mentor? They decide
445
based on their values and the values of the people with whom they work. If they believe that children from single-parent households should have higher priority, then those children will be put at the top of the list. As this example illustrates, making ethical decisions is challenging for a leader, especially in situations where resources are scarce.
446
Culture and Leadership Ethics
The world today is globally connected in ways it never has been before. Through your lifetime, you will undoubtedly be exposed to and work with individuals from cultures very different than your own. As a leader, it is important to recognize that not every culture shares the same ethical ideals as yours. Different cultures have different rules of conduct, and as a result, leadership behaviors that one culture deems ethical may not be viewed the same way by another culture.
Culture and Ethics
For example, Resick, Hanges, Dickson, and Mitchelson (2006) found that Nordic European cultures such as Denmark and Sweden place more importance on a leader’s character and integrity—defined as a leader behaving in a manner that is just, honest, sincere, and trustworthy—than Middle Eastern cultures such as those in Egypt, Turkey, and Qatar.
Another example is the use of bribery in business practices. Bribery (offering money or gifts in exchange for favorable treatment or influence) to obtain business is forbidden for U.S. companies, no matter where on the globe they are doing business, and offenders can face jail terms and large fines. However, in some countries, bribery is a norm, and business can’t be transacted without it. In China, for example, it is expected in business relationships that there will be the giving of carefully chosen gifts to convey respect and that the business relationship is valued by the giver. It is considered a matter of business etiquette (Pitta, Fung, & Isberg, 1999). And, until 1999, bribes were tax deductible and seen as a necessary part of conducting business in Germany.
447
Summary
There is a strong demand for ethical leaders in our society today. This chapter answers the question “What does it take to be an ethical leader?” Ethical leadership is defined as a process in which a good person acts in the right ways to accomplish worthy goals. There are six factors related to ethical leadership.
First, character is fundamental to ethical leadership. A leader’s character refers to who the leader is as a person and his or her core values. The Six Pillars of Character are trustworthiness, respect, responsibility, fairness, caring, and citizenship.
Second, ethical leadership is explained by the actions of the leader—the means a leader uses to accomplish goals. An ethical leader engages in showing respect, serving others, and showing justice.
Third, ethical leadership is about the goals of the leader. The goals a leader selects reflect his or her values. Selecting goals that are meaningful and worthwhile is one of the most important decisions an ethical leader needs to make.
Fourth, ethical leadership is concerned with the honesty of the leader. Without honesty, a leader cannot be ethical. In telling the truth, a leader needs to strike a balance between openness and sensitivity to others.
Fifth, power plays a role in ethical leadership. A leader has an ethical obligation to use power for the influence of the common good of others. The interests of followers need to be taken into account, and the leader needs to work with followers to accomplish mutual ends.
Finally, ethical leadership is concerned with the values of the leader. An ethical leader has strong values and promotes positive values within his or her organization. Because leaders and followers often have conflicting values, a leader needs to be able to express his or her values and integrate these values with others’ values.
In summary, ethical leadership has many dimensions. To be an ethical leader, you need to pay attention to who you are, what you do, what goals you seek, your honesty, the way you use power, and your values.
448
Glossary Terms
actions 276 character 275 end values 285 ethical leadership 274 ethical values 285 goals 282 honesty 282 modal values 285 power 284 values 285
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
449
12.1 Case Study: The Write Choice Each semester, community college professor Julia Ramirez requires her students to do a 10-hour community service project at a nonprofit agency of their choice and write a paper about the experience. In the paper, they are to discuss their volunteer experience and incorporate concepts presented in class into this reflection. This is the sixth semester that Professor Ramirez has used this assignment, and she has always received positive feedback about the benefits of the assignment from her students and the nonprofits.
The community college that Professor Ramirez works at is making an effort to be “green” and, in order to cut down on paper usage, requests that faculty and staff utilize online tools for giving and receiving assignments and providing feedback to students. Professor Ramirez takes advantage of these green initiatives, requiring her community learning papers to all be turned in electronically at noon on the last Friday before exams. She likes having the papers turned in electronically because it has significantly cut down on late papers and it is now very easy to check student work for plagiarism.
That day has arrived, and Professor Ramirez downloads her student papers from the class webpage and begins to grade them. The papers are informal in nature, written in first-person narrative as if the students were talking directly to Professor Ramirez. After grading a number of papers, Professor Ramirez comes to the paper written by student Kelly Declan. Kelly’s paper reads less like a personal narrative and more like a brochure for the organization where she volunteered. At first, Professor Ramirez is impressed with the amount of detail that Kelly retained from volunteering, but after reading part of the paper, she becomes suspicious. To be safe, Professor Ramirez decides to copy a passage from Kelly’s paper into her Internet search engine to see if it matches any other published sources. It does; in fact, it is a direct match for an online brochure of a similar organization in a neighboring state. Professor Ramirez tests a few more sections from Kelly’s paper and finds that 90% of it was plagiarized from this one source on the Internet.
Plagiarism is taken very seriously at the college. Students accused of plagiarism are reported to the student review board, and if the board confirms that a student’s work is not his or her own, the student is dismissed from the college. Students who have been dismissed for plagiarism are able to reapply to the college after waiting one semester, and if they are readmitted, they are placed on academic probation for a year.
Despite the college’s policy, Professor Ramirez is conflicted about how to deal with this situation. She knows that Kelly had a very difficult semester. Her mother is ill with cancer, and during the semester, Kelly drove twice a week to her hometown two hours away to take her mother to doctor’s appointments and chemotherapy. Knowing this, Professor Ramirez accommodated Kelly’s schedule during the semester so that she did not have to drop the course. This is also Kelly’s last semester before graduation, and she will be the first person in her family to graduate from college. Kelly also has a job lined up after graduation, for which Professor Ramirez wrote her a letter of recommendation, and if she does not graduate, she will most likely lose the job. Losing the job will be certain if Kelly is ejected from the college.
Professor Ramirez decides not to report the incident of plagiarism to the review board right away. She chooses instead to approach Kelly one-on-one and will proceed based on what Kelly has to say. During their meeting, it is apparent to Professor Ramirez that Kelly did complete the required service hours but was overwhelmed when it came to writing the paper. Kelly had let the assignment go until the very end and then when she had to write it, she could only come up with one page rather than the three pages required. She added the plagiarized information to make the paper reach the required length. Kelly is genuinely remorseful and admits she is terrified of the consequences.
In the end, Professor Ramirez gave Kelly a zero for the assignment, but she still passed the class with a grade of a B. She did not feel that having Kelly kicked out of school would benefit the college or Kelly. Despite going against college policy, Professor Ramirez believes her behavior is consistent with her personal values of acknowledging that people make mistakes and deserve second chances. She personally felt that this behavior was out of character for Kelly and, had Kelly not been under tremendous personal and academic stress, she
450
wouldn’t have acted in this way.
451
Questions 1. Even though Professor Ramirez deviated from the college’s policy regarding plagiarism, do you feel
that she acted ethically? 2. If you were a student in this class and learned Professor Ramirez made an exception for this student,
would you think she acted ethically? Explain. 3. In Table 12.1, the Six Pillars of Character are detailed. Which of these six pillars did Professor
Ramirez display in consideration for her student, and how? 4. Professor Ramirez’s actions ultimately brought into question whether or not the ends justify the
means. Do you feel that her leniency in this case made her a stronger or more ethical leader? Explain.
452
12.2 Sample Items From the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of your ethical leadership style 2. To understand how your preferred ethical leadership style relates to other ethical leadership styles
Directions
1. Please read the following 10 hypothetical situations in which a leader is confronted with an ethical dilemma.
2. Place yourself in the role of the leader or manager in the situation. 3. For each situation, indicate with an “X” your most preferred response. Your most preferred response is
the response that best describes why you would do what you would do in that particular situation. Choose only one response. There are no right or wrong answers.
Response alternatives explained:
I would do what is right: this option means you follow a set of moral rules and do what is expected of you when facing an ethical dilemma. You focus on fulfilling your moral obligations and doing your duty. I would do what benefits the most people: this option means you try to do what is best for the most people overall when facing an ethical dilemma. You focus on what will result in happiness for the largest number of individuals. I would do what a good person would do: this option means that you pull from who you are (your character) when facing an ethical dilemma. You act out of integrity and you are faithful to your own principles. I would do what shows that I care about my close relationships: this option means that you give attention to your relationships when facing an ethical dilemma. You may give special consideration to those with whom you share a personal bond or commitment. I would do what benefits me the most: this option means that you do what is best for accomplishing your personal goals and objectives when facing an ethical dilemma. You are not afraid to assert your own interests when resolving problems. I would do what is fair: this option means that you focus on treating others fairly when facing an ethical dilemma. You try to make sure the benefits and burdens of decisions are shared equitably between everyone concerned.
Situations
1. You are the leader of a manufacturing team and learn that your employees are falsifying product quality results to sell more products. If you report the matter, most of them will lose their jobs, you may lose yours, and your company will take a significant hit to its reputation. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
453
2. You have an employee who has been having performance problems, which is making it hard for your group to meet its work quota. This person was recommended to you as a solid performer. You now believe the person’s former manager had problems with the employee and just wanted to get rid of the person. If you give the underperforming employee a good recommendation, leaving out the performance problems, you will have an opportunity to pass the employee off to another group. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
3. Your team is hard-pressed to complete a critical project. You hear about a job opening that would be much better for one of your key employees’ career. If this individual leaves the team, it would put the project in danger. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
4. An employee of yours has a child with a serious illness and is having trouble fulfilling obligations at work. You learn from your administrative assistant that this employee claimed 40 hours on a timesheet for a week when the employee actually only worked 30 hours. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
5. You are a manager, and some of your employees can finish their quotas in much less than the allotted time to do so. If upper management becomes aware of this, they will want you to increase the quotas. Some of your employees are unable to meet their current quotas. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
6. You are an organization’s chief financial officer, and you are aware that the chief executive officer and other members of the senior leadership team want to provide exaggerated financial information to keep the company’s stock price high. The entire senior management team holds significant stock positions. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
454
7. Two new employees have joined your accounting team right out of school. They are regularly found surfing the Internet or texting on their phones. Your accounting work regularly requires overtime at the end of the month to get the financial reports completed. These employees refuse to do any overtime, which shifts work to other team members. The other team members are getting resentful and upset. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
8. You are the director of a neighborhood food cooperative. A member—a single parent with four children—is caught shoplifting $30 in groceries from the co-op. You suspect this person has been stealing for years. You consider pressing charges. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
9. You have been accused of discriminating against a particular gender in your hiring practices. A new position opens up, and you could hire a candidate of the gender you’ve been accused of discriminating against over a candidate of another gender, even though the latter candidate has slightly better qualifications. Hiring the former candidate would let you address this accusation and improve your reputation in the company. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
10. You are a professor. One of your best students buys an essay online and turns it in for a grade. Later in the term, the student begins to feel guilty and confesses to you that the paper was purchased. It is the norm at the university to fail a student guilty of plagiarism. You must decide if you will flunk the student. What would you do in this situation?
□ A. I would do what is right. □ B. I would do what benefits the most people. □ C. I would do what a good person would do. □ D. I would do what shows that I care about my relationships. □ E. I would do what benefits me the most. □ F. I would do what is fair.
455
Scoring To score the questionnaire, sum the number of times you selected items A, B, C, D, E, or F. The sum of A responses represents your preference for Duty Ethics, the sum of B responses represents your preference for Utilitarian Ethics, the sum of C responses represents your preference for Virtue Ethics, the sum of D responses represents your preference for Caring Ethics, the sum of E responses represents your preference for Egoism Ethics, and the sum of F responses represents your preference for Justice Ethics. Place these sums in the Total Scores section that follows.
Total Scores
A. Duty Ethics: ______________ B. Utilitarian Ethics: __________ C. Virtue Ethics: ______________ D. Caring Ethics: ____________ E. Egoism Ethics: ____________ F. Justice Ethics: ____________
Scoring Interpretation
The scores you received on this questionnaire provide information about your ethical leadership style; they represent your preferred way of addressing ethical dilemmas. Given a situation with an ethical dilemma, this questionnaire points to what ethical perspective is behind the choices you would make to resolve the dilemma. As you look at your total scores, your highest score represents your primary or dominant ethical leadership style, your second-highest score is the next most important, and so on. If you scored 0 for a category, it means that you put lower priority on that particular ethical approach to guide your decision making when facing ethical dilemmas.
If you scored higher on Duty Ethics, it means you follow a set of moral rules and do what is expected of you when facing an ethical dilemma. You focus on fulfilling your moral obligations and doing your duty. If you scored higher on Utilitarian Ethics, it means that you try to do what is best for the most people overall when facing an ethical dilemma. You focus on what will result in happiness for the largest number of individuals. If you scored higher on Virtue Ethics, it means that you pull from who you are (your character) when facing an ethical dilemma. You act out of integrity and you are faithful to your own principles. If you scored higher on Caring Ethics, it means that you give attention to your relationships when facing an ethical dilemma. You may give special consideration to those with whom you share a personal bond or commitment. If you scored higher on Egoism Ethics, it means that you do what is best for accomplishing your personal goals and objectives when facing an ethical dilemma. You are not afraid to assert your own interests when resolving problems. If you scored higher on Justice Ethics, it means that you focus on treating others fairly when facing an ethical dilemma. You try to make sure the benefits and burdens of decisions are shared equitably between everyone concerned.
By comparing your scores regarding each of these ethical perspectives, you can get a sense of what is important to you when addressing an ethical concern. Obviously, if you scored low on in any of these categories, it suggests that you give less priority to that ethical perspective. All of the ethical perspectives have merit, so there is no “best” perspective to maintain.
This questionnaire is intended as a self-assessment exercise. Although each ethical approach is presented as a
456
discrete category, it is possible that one category may overlap with another category. It is also possible that you may have an ethical leadership style that is not fully captured in this questionnaire. Since this questionnaire is an abridged version of an expanded questionnaire, you may wish to take the entire questionnaire to gain a more accurate reflection of your ethical approach. It can be taken at www.leaderdecisionmakingsurvey.com.
Source: Adapted from Walter R. Baehrend Jr. Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire. http://www.leaderdecisionmakingsurvey.com/index.php
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
457
12.3 Observational Exercise
458
Ethical Leadership
Purpose
1. To become aware of the dimensions of ethical leadership 2. To assess how actual leaders exhibit ethical leadership
Directions
1. For this exercise, you must observe a public presentation of a leader in your community. This can be a pastor, a college president, a mayor, a city commissioner, the head of a social service agency, or some other community leader.
2. Record what you observe about the leader’s ethics in the categories that follow. Try to be thorough in your descriptions of the leader’s presentation.
Leader’s name: ____________________________ Leader’s title: ______________________________________
Occasion: ___________________________________
1. The character of the leader: What was the leader like? What kind of person was the leader? What were the leader’s strengths and weaknesses?
2. The actions of the leader: How does this leader go about accomplishing goals? Where does the leader stand on (1) showing respect, (2) serving others, and (3) showing justice?
3. The goals of the leader: What were the leader’s main goals? Were the leader’s goals clear to you and others in the audience? How would you assess the value and worth of those goals?
4. The honesty of the leader: What did you observe about this leader’s honesty? Was the leader open and forthright? How authentic did you find this leader to be?
5. The power of the leader: Based on French and Raven’s (1959) types of power, what kind of power did this leader exhibit? What did you observe about how this leader would use his or her power with others?
6. The values of the leader: Based on the presentation, what do you think this leader values? What is important to this leader? What values did this leader promote in his or her presentation?
Questions 1. What is your overall assessment of this leader’s ethics? 2. What specific examples in the leader’s presentation were particularly revealing of the leader’s ethics?
459
3. Which factors of ethical leadership (character, actions, goals, honesty, power, and values) were most apparent in the leader’s presentation? Discuss.
4. On a scale from 1 to 10, how would you describe this speaker’s ethical leadership? Defend your answer.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
460
12.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
461
Ethical Leadership
Reflection
1. This chapter suggests that leadership has a moral dimension and that leaders have a responsibility to use their authority for the common good. Do you agree? Discuss.
2. When you consider the character of a leader and what a leader does (the leader’s actions), which of these two factors is more important with regard to ethical leadership? Can a person with bad character be an ethical leader? Discuss your answers.
3. In this chapter, the circumstances at Abu Ghraib prison are used as an example of unethical leadership. Do you agree with this assessment? How do you view what happened at Abu Ghraib? What factors explain the leadership ethics in this situation?
4. This chapter includes a story about Richard Lee, the father who coached his son’s Little League baseball team. What was your reaction to the story? Do you think Richard was an ethical leader? How would you have responded in this situation?
Action
1. Based on your responses to the Ethical Leadership Styles Questionnaire, what are your core values? Do you think other people know your core values? Are you comfortable talking about these values with others? In your planning for the future (e.g., next five years), how will your values influence what you do? Discuss.
2. Character is a fundamental aspect of ethical leadership. What are your character strengths and weaknesses? List three specific actions you could take to strengthen your character.
3. In the Observational Exercise (12.3), you observed and analyzed the ethical leadership of a specific leader. If you were to apply the same analysis to your own leadership, how would you describe yourself? What factors best explain the ethics of your own leadership? If you were to try to become a more ethical leader, what specific changes should you make in your leadership? Discuss.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
462
References Baehrend, W. R., Jr. (2017). Ethical leadership style questionnaire. Retrieved from
http://www.leaderdecisionmakingsurvey.com/index.php
Beauchamp, T. L., & Bowie, N. E. (1988). Ethical theory and business (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Bowie, N. E. (1991). Challenging the egoistic paradigm. Business Ethics Quarterly, 1(1), 1–21.
Ciulla, J. B. (2003). The ethics of leadership. Belmont, CA: Wadsworth/Thomson Learning.
Eisenberg, P. (2011, January 11). Unintended consequences of Giving Pledge’s good intentions. Chronicle of Philanthropy. Retrieved from http://onphilanthropy.com/2011/pablo-eisenberg-unintended-consequences-of-giving- pledges-good-intentions/
Fowler, G. (2012, September 19). More billionaires sign on to giving money away. The Wall Street Journal. Retrieved from http://online.wsj.com/article/SB10000872396390443995604578003043533208534.html
Frank, R. (2011, October 27). The biggest gift in the world. WSJ Magazine. Retrieved from http://online.wsj.com/article/SB10001424052970204644504576653510801826824.html
French, J. R., Jr., & Raven, B. (1959). The bases of social power. In D. Cartwright (Ed.), Studies in social power (pp. 150–167). Ann Arbor, MI: Institute for Social Research.
Giving Pledge. (2016). Current pledgers. Retrieved from http://givingpledge.org/index.html
Guth, R. A., & Fowler, G. A. (2010, December 9). 16 tycoons agree to give away fortunes.
463
The Wall Street Journal. Retrieved from http://online.wsj.com/article/SB10001424052748703493504576007982500939482.html
Johnson, C. R. (2005). Meeting the ethical challenges of leadership (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Josephson Institute. (2008). The Six Pillars of Character. Los Angeles, CA: Author.
Kanungo, R. N. (2001). Ethical values of transactional and transformational leaders. Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences, 18(4), 257–265.
Kanungo, R. N., & Mendonca, M. (1996). Ethical dimensions of leadership. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Pitta, D. A., Fung, H.-G., & Isberg, S. (1999). Ethical issues across cultures: managing the differing perspectives of China and the USA. Journal of Consumer Marketing, 16(3), 240–256.
Resick, C. J., Hanges, P. J., Dickson, M. W., & Mitchelson, J. A. (2006). A cross-cultural examination of the endorsement of ethical leadership. Journal of Business Ethics, 63(4), 345–359.
Velasquez, M. G. (1992). Business ethics: Concepts and cases (3rd ed.). Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
464
13 Overcoming Obstacles
465
Introduction
“Life is difficult.” That is the first sentence in Scott Peck’s famous book The Road Less Traveled (1978). Although hard for some to accept, Peck told us that life is not going to be easy. Obstacles and struggles are an integral part of life. In the work setting, the same is true. Because obstacles always will be present, one of the most important things a leader can do is to help others overcome these obstacles.
Should Leaders Help Their Followers Around Obstacles?
466
Obstacles Explained
What is an obstacle? It is a hindrance, problem, or hurdle that gets in the way of followers and makes it difficult for followers to reach their goal. Obstacles get in the way of what followers intend to do. Obstacles come in many forms. It could be a physical thing (e.g., bad work space), a psychological issue (e.g., closed-mindedness), or a task-related issue (e.g., a complex work process). In essence, anything that has a negative impact on follower performance could be called an obstacle. There are many examples of obstacles. For a busy person who wants to learn to play the guitar, an obstacle could be finding enough time to practice. For a new employee in a large hospital, an obstacle could be learning where the different departments in the building are located. Or, for a fifth-year senior who isn’t going to graduate, an obstacle could be a lack of motivation.
Obstacles are important for leaders to recognize because they provide clear cues for what leaders can do to help followers. Addressing obstacles can be very direct and practical. While some leadership theories are rather esoteric and prescribe certain leadership strategies (e.g., be authentic), addressing obstacles is a very concrete approach to leadership. For example, if a leader asks followers “How can I help you?” or “What problems are you having?” their answers will point directly to how the leader can adapt his or her behavior to help the followers with their work. Maybe followers want more direction or need to be challenged more; either way, if the leader asks them about their concerns, the obstacles can be remedied. Learning about and dealing with obstacles is a very effective way to improve your leadership.
467
Overcoming Obstacles in Practice
Whether it is by listening to their complaints, encouraging them, or providing counsel, there are many ways a leader can be helpful to his or her followers. The first challenge in helping people with obstacles is to figure out what the problems are; the second challenge is determining what should be done to solve them. If a leader does this, followers will be more motivated, productive, and satisfied with their work.
Engaging With Obstacles
Research conducted by House (1971, 1996) on path–goal leadership directly addresses how a leader can assist others in overcoming obstacles that hinder productivity. Path–goal leadership suggests that a leader should choose a style that best fits the needs of individual group members and the work they are doing. The leader should help these individuals define their goals and the paths they wish to take to reach those goals. When obstacles arise, the leader needs to help individuals confront them. This may mean helping them to navigate around the obstacles, or it may mean helping them remove the obstacles. The leader’s job is to help group members reach their goals by directing, guiding, and coaching them along the way.
Based on ideas set forth in path–goal leadership theory, this chapter addresses the obstacles that followers may face and how a leader can help followers overcome them. Although people encounter many obstacles in their lives, this chapter highlights seven major obstacles derived from path–goal theory (see Figure 13.1). In the following section, each of the obstacles will be described, and the various ways leaders can respond to these obstacles will be explored.
Figure 13.1 Obstacles Hindering Goal Achievement
468
Obstacle 1: Unclear Goals
We have all known people who selected their career goals early in life. You may remember a grade school friend who said she was going to be a doctor and then subsequently went to college and medical school and became a neurosurgeon. You may remember a high school friend who said he was going to be in the movies and subsequently made it big in Hollywood. These people stand out because they were especially goal oriented—they knew what they wanted to do, and they did it. The problem is that these people are the exception and not the rule. For most people, finding their life goal is a real challenge.
Clarifying Goals
The same is true in leadership situations. It is not uncommon for individuals to be unclear or confused about their goals. Whether it is the salesperson who is required to meet a new sales quota, a hospital volunteer who is supposed to help patients, or a high school student who must write a term paper, people are often unclear about the goal or how to reach it.
Sometimes the goal is not known, sometimes it is obscure, and sometimes it is hidden among a tangle of competing goals. When goals are not clearly articulated and understood, individuals are less likely to be successful in achieving them. Furthermore, they will be less excited about their work and less gratified about their accomplishments.
It cannot be stressed enough that the leader needs to make goals clear and understandable. Just as leaders need to provide a map in articulating their vision (see Chapter 7, “Creating a Vision”), they must help others see the goal, the end toward which everything else is being directed. All members of a group deserve a clear picture of where their efforts are being directed. When the goal is vague, the leader needs to clarify it. Similarly, if the goal is embedded in a complex set of related goals, the leader needs to identify a specific goal for group members and explain how it fits with all the other goals.
The following list provides a few examples of leaders expressing clear goals. The examples may not be glamorous, but they exemplify good leadership.
Football coach to team: “The goal for the defensive team this season is to try to sack the opposing quarterback at least two times in every game.” High school physical education teacher to students: “At the beginning of every class you are required to jog one lap around the track.” Orchestra conductor to orchestra: “Our upcoming rehearsals are going to be difficult because the pieces we are playing are really challenging. If we practice together every
469
week for five hours, this concert could be our best all year.” Staff supervisor at a geriatric facility to volunteer staff: “By helping the staff to fold the laundry of the patients living here, you will help to reduce the spiraling costs of our facility.” College speech teacher to students: “In this speech assignment, you must make sure to do three things: (1) tell the audience what you are going to tell them, (2) tell them, and (3) tell them what you have told them.”
In each of these examples, the leaders are helping individuals identify and clarify the goals of their work. The individuals doing the work will be more effective and more satisfied as a result of knowing their goals.
470
Obstacle 2: Unclear Directions
Anyone who has ever bought something that needed to be assembled (e.g., a computer table or futon frame) knows how frustrating it is when the directions are missing from the box, impossible to follow, or written in a foreign language. No matter how much you want to put the product together, you cannot do it. This is what happens in work situations when leaders are not clear with their directions. Bad directions lead to ineffective performance.
The Need for Clear Directions
A leader needs to define the path to the goal by giving clear directions. Directions that are vague, confusing, rambling, imprecise, or incomplete are not helpful to anyone. In fact, unclear directions can have a debilitating effect on individuals. People lose their capacity to move forward when they do not have clear directions on how to proceed. Some individuals are lost without directions. They may have a picture of where they are headed, but they do not know how to get there.
Giving clear directions takes thought and skill. For example, students in a classroom want clear directions for their assignments. If the assignment is a term paper, an effective teacher describes in detail the required components. The teacher might require a two-paragraph introduction, a thesis sentence, a conceptual framework, a review of the literature, a discussion section, a conclusion, and a bibliography. When clear directions are given, students have a sense of personal control because they know what is required of them. When people know what they are supposed to do and when they are supposed to do it, they can accomplish their work more easily.
While giving clear directions is important, it is also important to be aware that individuals vary in their need for direction. Some people want very elaborate, specific instructions, while others want general directions that allow them to proceed on their own. It is the leader’s job to adapt directions to the needs of each individual.
Much like drivers who are relieved to have the navigation system tell them what interstate exit to take, followers want direction from a calm leader who tells them what they need to do and when they need to do it. When they make a mistake or lose their way, they want the leader to redirect them. Most important, group members want directions that are not evaluative or critical. If they make mistakes, they want to be corrected in a kind manner. A good leader will give directions that are helpful but not judgmental. People appreciate straightforward directions, and like to hear the leader say they “have arrived” when they get
471
their work done.
472
Obstacle 3: Low Motivation
What should a leader do when individuals are not motivated? How does a leader encourage followers to work when they do not want to work? How can a leader make people excited about work? Answers to questions such as these have been of interest to leaders for a long time. In fact, hundreds of articles and books have been written in an effort to explain the underpinnings of human motivation (see Herzberg’s motivation-hygiene theory, 1968; Maslow’s hierarchy of needs theory, 1954; and Skinner’s work on behaviorism, 1953). All these writings point to the complexity and challenges leaders face in trying to motivate others.
Overcoming Low Motivation
Path–goal leadership incorporates expectancy theory as a way to motivate others (House, 1996; Vroom, 1964). Expectancy theory suggests that people will be more highly motivated when the effort they put into a task leads to an expected outcome that they value. This occurs for individuals when they feel competent, they get what they expect, and they value what they do. If a leader can help individuals in these three areas, then motivation will be high.
Help Others Feel Competent
All of us have a need to feel competent. We want to present ourselves in a way that suggests to others (and ourselves) that we know what we are doing. Whether it is learning how to play the guitar, how to swing a golf club, or how to play blackjack, we all want to give a good performance. Letting individuals know that they are competent is the first step in helping them become more highly motivated. For example, after completing a complex assignment, an employee would be gratified to hear the manager say, “You did that assignment exactly the way it needed to be done.”
Help Others Get What They Expect
People are also more highly motivated when their expectations are met. Knowing that effort will lead to an expected outcome is very important. Achieving an expected result makes the effort worthwhile, but it is disheartening and unmotivating when work does not lead to an expected outcome. In a sense, when individuals do not achieve the results they expect, they distrust the way the system works.
473
A leader should make sure the outcome that individuals expect from their effort is achievable and will likely occur. A leader must be aware of what outcome individuals expect, and confirm if those outcomes are realistic.
For example, if a salesperson is given a new quota to meet, he or she may expect a pay increase or financial reward for achieving that goal. It is up to the leader to clarify for the salesperson whether or not that reward is possible.
Another example that illustrates this point involves a university instructor who taught a course in public relations. The instructor assigned each group in the class a client for which the student was to develop a campaign, and gave the students a basic outline from which to work. One group struggled with the assignment; the instructor met often with these students outside class to help them develop their plan. At the end of the semester, the group submitted a very basic plan that met the minimum requirements for the assignment and received a C grade. Members of the group were very upset with their grade and argued that they deserved a higher score because they had done a lot of work, completed every task the instructor had given them in their meetings, and met the requirements for the assignment outlined in the syllabus. The instructor pointed out that higher grades were given to those who went beyond the minimum requirements. It was clear to the teacher that her expectations and those of her students were not the same. As a result, when she taught the class again, the teacher specified that the requirements outlined in the syllabus were only a starting point: Higher grades were for those who met and exceeded these requirements in developing their campaign plans. This example illustrates the importance of a leader and the group members having a mutual understanding of the expected outcomes.
Leadership Snapshot: Bill Courtney, Head Coach, Manassas High School Football
474
© Matt Carr/Contributor/Getty Images Entertainment/Getty Images.
Football coaches have challenges as part of the job: finding and grooming talented players, tough opposing defenses, injured team members. But in 2002, when Bill Courtney volunteered to coach Manassas High School’s struggling football team in North Memphis, Tennessee, an inner-city community, he faced some huge obstacles.
Manassas had had a record of 5–95 for the past 10 years, a roster of only 17 players, a lack of equipment, and a reputation for the being the district’s “doormat team.” It was rumored that larger schools would pay to have Manassas be their homecoming game’s opponent so they would be guaranteed a win.
But Courtney found the personal obstacles faced by his players just as daunting. The players all lived in poverty, most didn’t have a father at home, and some lived with a single grandparent or other relative. All of them had close family members who had gone to jail, but few had any who had been to college.
475
“When you’re in generational abject poverty and just hopelessness and loss and you’re surrounded by it, and that’s all you see coming up, then that’s all that you expect life is,” said Courtney. “If that’s what your reality is and that’s all you see and you’ve never traveled more than 10 miles from the neighborhood you were born in, then why would anyone expect [you] to have a road map to success?” (Ward-Henninger, 2013).
For Courtney, it became more than just teaching the basics of block, hit, and tackle. A man who knows what it is to grow up without a father, he found the job morphed into becoming a coach of his players’ character, resolve, and integrity. As he quoted often to his players, “The measure of a man’s character is determined not by how he handles his wins, but by how he handles his failures.”
One of Courtney’s players, Chavis Daniels, joined the team after spending 15 months in a juvenile detention facility and had serious anger issues. At one point, he was suspended for several games during the team’s season for fighting with an assistant coach. The fact Daniels wasn’t just kicked off the team speaks to Courtney’s commitment to the individuals and to the impact it ultimately has on those young men. Despite the suspension, Daniels wanted to remain on the team because “without football I’ve got nothing” (Lindsay & Martin, 2012).
But coaching doesn’t come without sacrifices for Courtney. The owner of a successful lumber company and the father of four children of his own, he admits that neither of these gets the attention it deserves during football season.
In 2009, the team did the unthinkable: They went 9–1. While the players were winning on the field, the coach was fighting other battles off the field. Linebacker O. C. Brown, at 6-foot-2 and 315 pounds, had a real shot at playing college football, but academically couldn’t qualify. The coaching staff tried to arrange for tutors, only to be told no one would come to Brown’s North Memphis neighborhood to tutor him. The coaches hit upon a unique solution: Brown would live during the week with one of the assistant coaches at his suburban home and receive tutoring there. They succeeded: Brown achieved the required score on his college entrance exam and was signed to play at the University of Southern Mississippi.
Another student, Montrail Brown, was an academic standout, but an undersized football player. He, too, dreamt of college. After suffering a midseason knee injury that took him off the field, he stopped coming to school. Courtney reached out to him, reminding him that football doesn’t build character; it reveals character, and character is about how you handle your failures. Williams continued his physical therapy and was ultimately able to play in the playoff game. One of the team’s assistant coaches, Jeff Germany, successfully found a donor willing to pay 100% of Montrail’s college expenses.
“There’s a story under every helmet,” Courtney says. All of his players are “equally important to me” and “willing to lay it on the line for [me].
“The only way you do that is to build a relationship with your players and find out who they are: what their fears are, what excites them and what hurts them and how you can yell at one kid to motivate him but you have to pat another on the fanny right next to him because they’re motivated by different stimulus. I believe you surround yourself with good talent and you let players win games after you’ve won your players” (Ward-Henninger, 2013).
Not only does a leader need to be sensitive to what others expect from his or her work and make sure these expectations are realistic, but he or she must also ensure that these expected outcomes are realized. For example, if a student is promised additional points for doing an extra-credit assignment, the teacher must make sure the student receives them. Similarly, if a worker expects a raise in pay if he or she meets the new sales quota, the leader needs to make sure the employee receives the pay increase.
476
Help Others Value What They Do
The third aspect of motivating others has to do with outcomes. When people place a high value on what they are doing, they are more motivated. Without a valued outcome, people are not motivated to put effort toward a goal.
An example about playing a musical instrument may illustrate this. When Judy, a high school student, takes up a musical instrument (the trumpet), her first concern is about competence. She wonders, “Can I play this thing?” After taking lessons for a period, Judy’s thoughts turn to whether or not she can do a solo recital. With long and hard practice, she is successful in the recital. Finally, she asks herself, “What is all of this worth?” This final phase is about the value of the outcome. If Judy really wants to become a good trumpet player, she will continue to be motivated to practice and play. If she does not find real value in playing, her motivation will subside, and she may quit playing altogether.
As a leader, the challenge is to help others see the value in their work performance. Whether this is done through monetary rewards, positive personal feedback, or giving special achievement awards, the key is to help others feel good about those things toward which they are directing their energies.
In summary, the leader’s challenge to motivate others is threefold: to help others feel competent, to help others get what they expect, and to help others see the overall value of their work. When all three of these conditions are met, individuals will be more highly motivated about their work.
Leadership and Problem Solving
477
Obstacle 4: Complex Tasks
Sometimes the obstacle facing people is the task itself. When a task is unstructured, ambiguous, or complex, it creates an obstacle for individuals. People are often frustrated and threatened when confronting complex tasks. Some individuals may even be overwhelmed.
When a task is complex, the leader needs to use a directive leadership style—to “take charge” and clarify the path to the goal. Directive leaders give others instruction, including what is expected of them, how it is to be done, and a timeline for when it should be completed. Being directive means setting clear standards of performance and making rules and regulations clear for others. When a leader simplifies complex tasks, it helps followers to feel more competent about their work.
Being Directive
The following example illustrates how a supervisor effectively used directive leadership to help one employee become more productive in her work. Jill Jones was one of four administrative staff working for a team of 45 people in product development at a large corporation. Her job was to do payroll, scheduling, requisitions, and a number of other secretarial tasks as needed. Jill had multiple tasks to coordinate but often seemed overwhelmed about which task to do first. Jill’s supervisor recognized that she was having difficulty with her job and decided that Jill needed some guidance in managing her work demands. To reduce Jill’s stress, the supervisor reassigned one of Jill’s overdue work assignments to another employee. Next, the supervisor met with Jill and asked her to list all of her work responsibilities and the day of the month that each had to be completed. The supervisor had Jill fill out a calendar detailing the days of the week when each specific task needed to be completed (e.g., Monday 9 A.M. to noon—payroll; Tuesday, 3–5 P.M.— requisitions). Jill felt relieved after she worked through this process with her supervisor, and the whole process was win-win. Jill felt better about her work, and her boss was getting more work done. The manager had removed obstacles that were keeping Jill from adequately carrying out her job assignments.
To summarize, Jill was facing a complex group of tasks, and her supervisor responded appropriately with directive leadership. By reducing the complexity of the task, the supervisor effectively assisted Jill in feeling competent and successful about her work.
478
Obstacle 5: Simple Tasks
Sometimes the obstacle to people’s success is not complexity but simplicity. Like complex tasks, simple and repetitive tasks can have a negative impact on motivation. There is little excitement in doing the same job over and over again. With no variety or nuance, simple tasks become dull and uninteresting.
For work like this, it is important for a leader to use a supportive leadership style. The supportive style provides what is missing—the human connection—by encouraging others when they are engaged in tasks that are boring and unchallenging. Supportive leadership offers a sense of human touch for those engaged in mundane mechanical activity.
Being Supportive
If you have ever observed people in a weight room at a fitness center, you have seen how support works to counter the unpleasantness of mundane work. People who lift weights are usually engaged in a very simple activity. Doing repetitions is not complex. However, weight rooms are often marked by camaraderie and supportiveness between the people lifting. People spot for each other and often engage in friendly banter and conversation. Their social interaction works to make their repetitive tasks more tolerable and interesting.
To identify situations that involve mundane tasks, you need not look very far. Consider the following situations: working on an assembly line in an automobile plant, swimming laps as part of training for a swim team, washing dishes at a restaurant, or studying vocabulary cards for a foreign-language quiz. Many jobs and many aspects of nearly every job have a simplicity to them that can be negative.
The solution to this problem is for a leader to be supportive and nurturing. A good leader senses when jobs are mundane and tries to give people the missing ingredient—social support. Although social support can take a variety of forms (e.g., being friendly, talking about the other’s family, or giving compliments), the bottom line is that social support shows care for the well-being and personal needs of the follower. When the task is not challenging, an effective leader will provide stimulation in the form of social support.
479
Obstacle 6: Low Involvement
Having a voice in what happens is very important to people. When people are not involved in a group or an organization, their productivity goes down, and the group or organization suffers. People want to have an identity that is unique from others’, but they also want to be included and to fit in with others. By expressing their own thoughts and opinions on different issues, individuals are able to sense that they are contributing to a group. When individuals sense they are not heard, their participation decreases, they contribute less, and often they disengage from the group.
Low Involvement
Leaders should use a participative leadership style to address the issue of low involvement. Participative leaders invite others to share in the ways and means of getting things done. They work to establish a climate that is open to new and diverse opinions. This leader consults with others, obtains their ideas and opinions, and integrates their suggestions into the decisions regarding how the group or organization will proceed.
A brief example may help to illustrate the importance of involvement. Oakwood Bistro is a small, upscale restaurant in a college town. It employs about 20 people as bartenders, cooks, and waitstaff. The bistro has two managers, whom we will call Managers A and B. Manager A is very authoritarian and strict. She stresses rules and procedures. She interacts very little with the staff and seldom asks anyone for opinions or feedback. Although Manager A is very competent and runs a tight ship, very few employees like working shifts when she is in charge.
The opposite is true when Manager B is in charge. Manager B is a democratic leader who is friendly with everyone. He is as interested in what the staff and customers are saying as he is in the rules and procedures of the place. He has nicknames for everyone who works at the bistro. In addition, he holds weekly “gripe” sessions during which staff members can express their opinions and make suggestions for how to improve things. Needless to say, individuals like to work for Manager B, and he is effective in his role.
Clearly, Manager B in the above example is a participative leader who allows people to be involved in the workings of the restaurant. The staff appreciates this involvement. In groups or organizations where everyone is involved, there are synergistic effects that create remarkable outcomes. Commitment to the group goes up, and group cohesiveness grows exponentially.
480
Obstacle 7: Lack of a Challenge
Some people do not work well because they are not challenged by what they are doing. Without a challenge, these people find work uninteresting and not worthwhile. As a result, these people work less hard, or they quit and move on to something that they find more engaging.
The Need for a Challenge
A leader should adopt an achievement-oriented leadership style in dealing with individuals who are not challenged. Achievement-oriented leadership is characterized by a leader who challenges individuals to perform at the highest level possible. This leader establishes a high standard of excellence and seeks continuous improvement. In addition to expecting a lot from followers, an achievement-oriented leader shows a high degree of confidence that people can reach those challenging goals.
An achievement-oriented leader continually challenges others to excel and pushes people to higher levels of success. He or she sets standards of excellence and challenges others to meet those standards. In the classroom, these leaders are the teachers who use an A+ grade as a way of coaxing students to do superior work. On the football field, they are the coaches who promote effort by placing stars on players’ helmets for outstanding performance. At work, they are the managers who give end-of-the-year bonuses for individuals who go the extra mile or do more than they are expected to do. An achievement-oriented leader is always looking for ways to challenge people to perform at the highest level possible.
It is important to point out that, while achievement-oriented leadership is good for some people, it is not for everyone. Although some people thrive on competition and like being pushed to do their best, there are those who are internally motivated and do not need a nudge from the achievement-oriented leader. It is the leader’s responsibility to assess followers’ needs to determine when achievement-oriented leadership is indicated and for whom.
481
Summary
Challenges and difficulties will always be present for people in the workplace. A leader plays a critical role in helping people overcome these obstacles. Most important, effective leaders help individuals define their goals and the paths they wish to take to meet those goals. Based on expectancy theory, leaders can help others be motivated by helping them to feel competent, to receive what they expect from their work, and to see the overall value of their work.
If the obstacle a person faces is a complex task, the leader should provide directive leadership. If the obstacle is a task that is too simple or mundane, however, the leader needs to give supportive leadership. Sometimes leaders have followers who are uninvolved in the group or organization; for these individuals, the leader should adopt a participative leadership style. At other times, for followers who are not challenged, the leader should incorporate an achievement-oriented leadership style.
Obstacles will always exist and present a challenge in all endeavors. The sign of a good leader is one who is willing to help individuals overcome these obstacles so that they can more effectively move toward and accomplish their goals.
482
Glossary Terms
achievement-oriented leadership 312 competent 306 directive leadership 309 expectancy theory 305 obstacles 302 participative leadership 311 path–goal leadership 302 supportive leadership 310
Sharpen your skills with SAGE edge at edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e
SAGE edge for students provides a personalized approach to help you accomplish your coursework goals in an easy-to-use learning environment.
Application
483
13.1 Case Study: Book Quiz Blues? As a community service project, Trey Morgan volunteered to coach a Book Quiz team of fourth graders at a local elementary school. As a college student majoring in education, Trey was excited for the opportunity to work one-on-one with children to prepare them for the competition. He felt it would give him a good indication of how much he would like teaching and whether he would be a good teacher.
The Book Quiz is a competition where teams of students read 10 books and compete with other teams, answering questions about the books. The teams have 10 weeks to prepare by reading the books and doing practice quizzes.
Trey’s team members were selected by their teacher, who mandated that all students in her class be on a team. Trey spent an hour each week with his team. He made a chart, and as the students finished reading the books, he would put a star next to their name. He also established that the first student to finish all the books would get a prize.
After three weeks, one of the team members, Claire, had finished five of the books already and was moving way ahead of the other team members. Shelby had admitted to starting to read four of the books, but “they were boring” so she stopped reading them. Marco, who announced at the first meeting that he would win the prize for reading all 10 books first, had read three of them, but his progress had slowed considerably. Every time a new star was added to Claire’s name on the chart, Marco became visibly discouraged and frustrated. Garrett, on the other hand, wasn’t progressing at all. He was still reading the same 80-page book he started the first week. Trey observed that during their meetings Garrett would get up frequently and move around the room. He also liked to spin in circles, often hitting the other kids accidentally with his swinging arms. When Trey tried to encourage Garrett to go for the prize, he shrugged and said, “I can’t win that. I don’t read fast like Claire and Marco.”
At the six-week point, Trey panicked. His Book Quiz guidebook said that each team member should have read at least five of the books by now. Claire had only read one additional book in the past three weeks because she had joined the track team and had little time after track practice and homework for reading. Marco had read four books, but didn’t seem interested in any of the remaining books. Garrett finally finished the one he started, and Shelby had started them all but not completed one. Trey hadn’t even begun to quiz the students on the books because there was no point if they hadn’t read them. He did have Marco and Claire work together on the four books they had both read, writing questions and quizzing each other.
With four weeks left, Trey has to figure out a way to get his team motivated and focused. He has given up any hopes of winning, but does want his team to at least make a good showing. As he tries to give them a pep talk, encouraging them to focus so they “won’t look like idiots in the competition,” Garrett interrupts.
“Who cares if we look like idiots?” he asks. “I didn’t ask to be on this team. I got put on this team. It’s a stupid competition.”
Marco gets mad. “Garrett, we are going to lose because you and Shelby won’t read. I don’t like losing, and when we do, it will be your fault.”
Shelby and Claire both start to cry, with Claire saying she feels awful because she can’t read as much anymore and she is letting everyone down. “I have too much to do,” she wails.
Garrett gets up and spins in circles.
Marco looks at Trey. “Aren’t you going to do something?” he demands angrily.
Trey thinks to himself that if he does anything it will be to change his major to business.
484
Questions 1. Obviously, things are not working out well for Trey and his team. If you were Trey, how would you
have proceeded from the beginning to help the team avoid or overcome its obstacles? 2. Based on the seven obstacles discussed in this chapter, identify which obstacles each of the team
members (Claire, Shelby, Marco, and Garrett) is facing. 3. Some of Trey’s team members seem to lack motivation. Based on expectancy theory, how could Trey
help his team members feel competent, get what they expect, and value what they do? 4. Based on how his team is feeling and doing, identify three specific things Trey could do to help his
students.
485
13.2 Path–Goal Styles Questionnaire
Purpose
1. To identify your path–goal styles of leadership 2. To examine how your use of each style relates to other styles of leadership
Directions
1. For each of the statements below, circle the number that indicates the frequency with which you engage in the expressed behavior.
2. Give your immediate impressions. There are no right or wrong answers.
When I am the leader . . . Never Seldom Sometimes Often Always
1. I give clear explanations of what is expected of others.
1 2 3 4 5
2. I show interest in followers’ personal concerns.
1 2 3 4 5
3. I invite followers to participate in decision making.
1 2 3 4 5
4. I challenge followers to continuously improve their work performance.
1 2 3 4 5
5. I give followers explicit instructions for how to do their work.
1 2 3 4 5
6. I show concern for the personal well-being of my followers.
1 2 3 4 5
7. I solicit followers’ suggestions before making a decision.
1 2 3 4 5
8. I encourage followers to consistently raise their own standards of performance.
1 2 3 4 5
9. I give clear directions to others for how to proceed on a project.
1 2 3 4 5
10. I listen to others and give them encouragement.
1 2 3 4 5
11. I am receptive to ideas and advice from others.
1 2 3 4 5
486
12. I expect followers to excel in all aspects of their work.
1 2 3 4 5
Scoring 1. Sum the responses on items 1, 5, and 9 (directive leadership). 2. Sum the responses on items 2, 6, and 10 (supportive leadership). 3. Sum the responses on items 3, 7, and 11 (participative leadership). 4. Sum the responses on items 4, 8, and 12 (achievement-oriented leadership).
Total Scores Directive leadership: ______________________ Supportive leadership: ____________________ Participative leadership: __________________ Achievement-oriented leadership: __________
Scoring Interpretation
This questionnaire is designed to measure four types of path–goal leadership: directive, supportive, participative, and achievement-oriented. By comparing your scores on each of the four styles, you can determine which style is your strongest and which is your weakest. For example, if your scores were directive leadership = 21, supportive leadership = 10, participative leadership = 19, and achievement-oriented leadership = 7, your strengths would be directive and participative leadership, and your weaknesses would be supportive and achievement-oriented leadership. While this questionnaire measures your dominant styles, it also indicates the styles you may want to strengthen or improve.
If your score is 13–15, you are in the high range. If your score is 6–12, you are in the moderate range. If your score is 3–5, you are in the low range.
Improve Your Leadership Skills
If you have the interactive eBook version of this text, log in to access the interactive leadership assessment. After completing this chapter’s questionnaire, you will receive individualized feedback and practical sugsgestions for further strengthening your leadership based on your responses in this questionnaire.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this questionnaire.
487
13.3 Observational Exercise
488
Obstacles
Purpose
1. To develop an understanding of the practical value of path–goal leadership as a strategy for helping followers reach their goals
2. To identify Obstacles that limit group effectiveness 3. To investigate how a leader’s style helps followers overcome obstacles to goal achievement
Directions
1. Observe a meeting, practice, or session of one the following groups (or a similar group): a sports team practice, a class project group meeting, a weekly staff meeting at work, a fraternity or sorority council meeting, or a planning meeting for a nonprofit organization.
2. Record what you observe at the meeting. Be specific in your descriptions. General observations of the meeting: Observations of the leader’s behavior: Observations of group members’ behaviors:
Questions 1. What are the goals of the individuals or group you observed? Are the goals clear? 2. What are the major obstacles confronting the individuals in the group? 3. What style of leadership did the leader exhibit? Was it appropriate for the group? 4. If you were leading the group, how would you lead to help group members?
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this exercise.
489
13.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
490
Obstacles
Reflection
1. When it comes to helping people who are having problems, how do you view your own abilities? Are you comfortable with setting goals and giving directions to others?
2. One of the central responsibilities of a leader is to help his or her followers become motivated. This means helping them feel competent, helping them meet their expectations, and helping them value what they do. How would you apply these three principles in a leadership situation?
3. As you reflect on the obstacles discussed in the chapter, which obstacles would you be most and least effective at addressing? Why?
Action
1. To be an effective leader requires that you clarify the goal and define the path to the goal. What specific things could you do in an upcoming leadership situation to clarify the goal and define the path for others?
2. As you look at your results on the Path–Goal Styles Questionnaire, what scores would you like to change? Which styles would you like to strengthen? How can you make sure you exhibit the most effective style the next time you are leading a group?
3. People vary regarding their need to be helped. Some want a lot of assistance, and others like to be independent. Are you prepared to adapt your leadership to be helpful to those who need it? Discuss.
Visit edge.sagepub.com/northouseintro4e for a downloadable version of this worksheet.
491
References Hart, B. (2005, June 10). GPS voice fine for some of life’s roads but not for others. Deseret
News (Salt Lake City, UT). Retrieved from http://www.deseretnews.com/article/600140296/GPS-voice-fine-for-some-of-lifes-roads- but-not-for-others.html?pg=all
Herzberg, F. (1968). Work and the nature of man. New York, NY: World.
House, R. J. (1971). A path-goal theory of leader effectiveness. Administrative Science Quarterly, 16(3), 321–328.
House, R. J. (1996). Path-goal theory of leadership: Lessons, legacy, and a reformulated theory. Leadership Quarterly, 7(3), 323–352.
Lindsay, D. [Producer], & Martin, T. J. [Director]. (2012). Undefeated [Motion picture]. United States: Spitfire Studios.
Maslow, A. H. (1954). Motivation and personality. New York, NY: Harper & Row.
Peck, M. S. (1978). The road less traveled. New York, NY: Simon & Schuster.
Skinner, B. F. (1953). Science and human behavior. New York, NY: Free Press.
Vroom, V. H. (1964). Work and motivation. New York, NY: Wiley.
Ward-Henninger, C. (2013, February 19). Coach Bill Courtney and Manassas make “Undefeated” a true underdog story. MaxPreps.com. Retrieved from http://www.maxpreps.com/news/pPAP2YAMCEmkJtpd2TK7Bg/coach-bill-courtney- and-manassas-make-undefeated-a-true-underdog-story.htm
492
Glossary
ability a natural or acquired capacity to perform a particular activity
accommodation an unassertive but cooperative conflict style that requires individuals to attend very closely to the needs of others and ignore their own needs
achievement-oriented a leader who challenges individuals to perform at the highest level possible, establishes a high standard of excellence, and seeks continuous improvement
actions the ways one goes about accomplishing goals
administrative skills competencies a leader needs to run an organization in order to carry out the organization’s purposes and goals
authentic leadership an emerging leadership approach that looks at the authenticity of leaders and their leadership
authoritarian leadership style a style of leadership in which leaders perceive subordinates as needing direction and need to control subordinates and what they do
avoidance a conflict style that is both unassertive and uncooperative, and characterized by individuals being passive and ignoring conflict situations rather than confronting them directly
behavior approach an approach to leadership research that focuses on behavior and examines what leaders do and how they act
challenge to stimulate people to commit themselves to change
change a move toward something different; a shift away from the way things currently are
493
character one’s qualities, disposition, and core values
charisma magnetic charm and appeal; a special personality characteristic that gives people the capacity to do extraordinary things
cohesiveness a sense of “we-ness”; the cement that holds a group together, or the esprit de corps that exists within a group
collaboration a conflict style that requires both assertiveness and cooperation and occurs when both parties agree to a positive settlement to the conflict and attend fully to the other’s concerns while not sacrificing or suppressing their own
competent a leader who presents himself in a way that suggests to others (and himself) that he knows what he is doing
competition a conflict style of individuals who are highly assertive about pursuing their own goals but uncooperative in assisting others to reach their goals
compromise a conflict style that involves both a degree of assertiveness and a degree of cooperativeness
conceptual skills capabilities that involve working with concepts and ideas, the thinking or cognitive aspects of leadership
concern for people refers to how a leader attends to the people in the organization who are trying to achieve its goals
concern for production refers to how a leader is concerned with achieving organizational goals
confidence feeling positive about oneself and one’s ability to succeed
conflict a felt struggle between two or more interdependent individuals over perceived
494
incompatible differences in beliefs, values, and goals, or over differences in desires for esteem, control, and connectedness
conflict style a patterned response or behavior that people use when approaching conflict
consideration behavior a relationship leadership behavior in which the leader creates camaraderie, respect, trust, and regard with followers
content conflicts involve struggles between leaders and others who differ on issues such as policies and procedures
content dimension involves the objective, observable aspects of communication
contingency theory a leadership theory that focuses on the match between the leader’s style and specific situational variables
democratic leadership style a style of leadership in which leaders treat subordinates as fully capable of doing work on their own and work with subordinates, trying hard to treat everyone fairly, without putting themselves above subordinates
determination being focused and attentive to tasks; showing initiative, persistence, and drive
differentiation an interaction process that occurs in the early phase of conflict that helps participants define the nature of the conflict and clarify their positions with regard to each other
directive leadership a leader sets clear standards of performance and makes rules and regulations clear for others
emotional intelligence concerned with a person’s ability to understand his or her own and others’ emotions, and then to apply this understanding to life’s tasks; the ability to perceive and express emotions, to use emotions to facilitate thinking, to understand and reason with emotions, and to manage emotions effectively within oneself and in relationships with others
495
empathy a process in which an individual suspends his or her own feelings in an effort to fully understand the feelings of another individual
employee orientation a relationship leadership behavior in which the leader takes an interest in workers as human beings, values their uniqueness, and gives special attention to their personal needs
end values the outcomes or goals a leader seeks to achieve
ethical leadership a process by which a good person rightly influences others to accomplish a common good
ethical values concerned with the character or virtuousness of the leader
expectancy theory people will be more highly motivated when they are capable of performing their work, the effort they put into a task leads to an expected outcome, and they value the outcome
face saving communicative attempts to establish or maintain one’s self-image or another’s self- image in response to threat
fractionation the technique of breaking down large conflicts into smaller, more manageable pieces
Gallup Organization a public opinion research organization that conducts political polling and research in other areas of the social sciences
goals the aims or outcomes an individual seeks to achieve
“Great Man” theories early trait theories of leadership that focused on identifying the innate qualities and characteristics possessed by great social, political, and military leaders (see also trait approach)
honesty
496
telling the truth and representing reality as fully and completely as possible
initiating structure task leadership in which the leader organizes work, defines role responsibilities, and schedules work activities
integrity adhering to a strong set of principles and taking responsibility for one’s actions; being honest and trustworthy
intelligence having good language skills, perceptual skills, and reasoning ability
interpersonal skills people skills; those abilities that help a leader to work effectively with subordinates, peers, and superiors to accomplish the organization’s goals
laissez-faire leadership style a style of leadership, sometimes labeled nonleadership, in which leaders ignore workers and their work motivations and engage in minimal influence
leader-member exchange (LMX) theory conceptualizes leadership as a process that is centered on the interactions between leaders and followers
leadership a process whereby an individual influences a group of individuals to achieve a common goal
leadership style the behaviors of leaders, focusing on what leaders do and how they act
learned behaviors actions or behaviors people acquire through experience; ingrained things they come to understand throughout their life
listening paying attention to what people say while being attentive to what people mean
map a laid-out path to follow to direct people toward their short- and long-term goals
mission the goal toward which a group is working, which provides organization to the rest of its activities
497
modal values concerned with the means or actions a leader takes
norms the rules of behavior that are established and shared by group members
obstacle a problem that hinders group productivity
out-group individuals in a group or an organization who do not identify themselves as part of the larger group, and who are disconnected and not fully engaged in working toward the goals of the group
participative leadership a leader invites others to share in the ways and means of getting things done
path-goal leadership leadership in which a leader should choose a style that best fits the needs of individual group members and the task they are doing
path-goal theory a leadership theory that examines how leaders use employee motivation to enhance performance and satisfaction
personal style unique habits regarding work and play, which have been ingrained over many years and influence one’s current style
philosophy of leadership a unique set of beliefs and attitudes about the nature of people and the nature of work that have a significant impact on an individual’s leadership style
picture an ideal image of where a group or an organization should be going
positive psychology the “scientific” study of what makes life most worth living
power the capacity to influence or affect others
principled negotiation an approach to conflict that decides issues on their merits rather than through competitive haggling or through excessive accommodation
498
problem-solving skills one’s cognitive ability to take corrective action in a problem situation in order to meet desired objectives
process behaviors behaviors used by leaders to help group members feel comfortable with each other and at ease in the situations in which they find themselves
production orientation task leadership in which the leader stresses the production and technical aspects of the job
realized strengths personal attributes that represent our strongest assets
relational approach an approach to leadership research that examines the nature of relations between leaders and followers
relational conflicts refer to the differences we feel between ourselves and others concerning how we relate to each other
relationship behaviors behaviors used by leaders that help subordinates feel comfortable with themselves, with each other, and with the situation they find themselves in
relationship dimension refers to the participants’ perceptions of their connection to one another
relationship-oriented leadership leadership that is focused primarily on the well-being of subordinates, how they relate to each other, and the atmosphere in which they work
servant leadership an emerging leadership approach that emphasizes the “caring principle” with leaders as “servants” who focus on their followers’ needs in order to help these followers become more autonomous, knowledgeable, and like servants themselves
situational approach an approach to leadership research based on the premise that different situations demand different kinds of leadership
skill
499
a competency developed to accomplish a task effectively
sociability capable of establishing pleasant social relationships; being sensitive to others’ needs and concerned for their well-being
social identity theory explains why and how individuals identify with particular social groups and how these identifications affect their behavior
social perceptiveness having insight into and awareness of what is important to others, how they are motivated, the problems they face, and how they react to change
spiritual leadership an emerging leadership approach that examines how leaders use values, a sense of “calling,” and membership to motivate followers
standards of excellence the expressed and implied expectations for performance that exist within a group or an organization
status quo the current situation; the way things are now
strategic planning a conceptual skill, the cognitive ability to think and consider ideas to develop effective strategies for a group or an organization
strengths attributes or qualities of an individual that account for successful performance; positive features of ourselves that make us effective and help us flourish
structure a blueprint for the work of a particular group that gives form and meaning to the purposes of its activities
supportive a leader who provides what is missing—the human connection—by encouraging others when they are engaged in tasks that are boring and unchallenging; offers a sense of human touch for those engaged in mundane mechanical activity
synergy the group energy created from two or more people working together, which creates
500
an outcome that is different from and better than the sum of the individual contributions
task behaviors behaviors used by leaders to get the job done
task-oriented leadership leadership that is focused predominantly on procedures, activities, and goal accomplishments
technical competence having specialized knowledge about the work we do or ask others to do
themes of human talent relatively stable, fixed characteristics—similar to personality traits—that are not easily changed
Theory X a general theory created by Douglas McGregor in which leaders assume that people dislike work, that they need to be directed and controlled, and that they want security—not responsibility
Theory Y a general theory created by Douglas McGregor in which leaders assume that people like work, that they are self-motivated, and that they accept and seek responsibility
trait a distinguishing personal quality that is often inherited (e.g., intelligence, confidence, charisma, determination, sociability, or integrity)
trait approach an approach to leadership research that focuses on identifying the innate qualities and characteristics possessed by individuals (see also “Great Man” theories)
transformational leadership theory a theory that describes leadership as a process that changes people and organizations
unrealized strengths personal attributes that are less visible
values the ideas, beliefs, and modes of action that people find worthwhile or desirable
vision a mental model of an ideal future state
501
weaknesses limiting attributes that often drain our energy and result in poor performance
502
Index
Ability, 2, 128–129, 321 Abu Ghraib prison, 278 Access Trips, 87 Accommodation, 261–262, 321 Achievement-oriented leadership, 312, 321 Actions, 276–279, 281, 321 Adapt, capacity to, 129 Adaptive leadership, 4 (box) Administrative skills, 118–120, 118 (figure), 321 Affiliation issues, 249 African American employees, 192–193 African National Congress, 27–28 Age Discrimination Act (1975), 188 Allen, A., 196 Anderson, E. C., 61 Apple, 62–63 Approaches:
behavior, 3 (box), 6, 321 defined, 3 (box) to diversity, 186–190, 187 (table) “new leadership”, 4 (box) relational, 4 (box), 6–7, 324 situational, 3–4 (box), 324 trait, 3 (box), 325
Aristotle, 275 Assertiveness, 259 Assimilation, 188, 191, 191 (table), 194 Attributes. See Traits Audience, adapting vision to, 147 Authentic, feeling, 198 (table), 200 Authentic leadership, 4 (box), 321 Authoritarian leadership style, 83–84, 321 Avoidance, 260–261, 321
Bachal, Humaira, 244–245 Barrera, V., 196 Bass, B. M., 4 (box) Bates, Edward, 229
503
Beauchamp, T. L., 223 Behavior approach, 3 (box), 6, 321 Behaviors:
change, 108 consideration, 105, 322 learned, 56, 56 (figure), 323 process, 6, 324 relationship, 3 (box), 324 task, 3 (box), 6, 324
Belief conflicts, 243, 245–246 Bentley, Alex, 124 Berggruen, Nicolas, 281 Berkshire Hathaway, 61 Big Brothers Big Sisters, 286 “Big Five” personality factors, 3 (box) Billie Jean King Leadership Initiative, 184–185 Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation, 33, 280 Blake, R. R., 3 (box), 259 Blanchard, K. H., 4 (box) Boal, K. B., 128–129 Book Quiz, 314–315 Boomers, 185 Booysen, L., 185–186 Bowie, N. E., 223 Breakfast Club, 228 Brewer, M. B., 190 Bribery, 286–287 Brown, Montrail, 308 Brown, O. C., 308 Buffett, Warren, 61, 280 Building Community Questionnaire, 234–235 Burns, James MacGregor, 285 Burns, Ursula, 192–193
Cameron, K. S., 65–66 Capacity to adapt, 129 CAPP. See Centre of Applied Positive Psychology Caring, 277 (table) Caring ethics, 294 Carter, Jimmy, 80 Case studies:
climate, 175–176
504
conflict, 265–266 diversity and inclusion, 208–209 ethical leadership, 289–290 leadership, understanding, 13 leadership styles, 91–92 obstacles, 314–315 out-group members, 232–233 skills, 132–133 strengths, 69–70 task-oriented and relationship-oriented leadership, 110 traits, 37–38 vision, 152–153
Centre of Applied Positive Psychology (CAPP), 55–58, 56 (figure) Challenge, 146–147, 312, 321 Change, 143, 321 Change behaviors, 108 Character, 275–276, 277 (table), 286, 321 Charisma, 24–25, 321 Charismatic leadership, 142 China, 287 Chuard, Alain, 87, 88 Chung, B. G., 191, 191 (table) Churchill, Winston, 30–31 Citizenship, 277 (table) Civil Rights Act (1964), 188 Clifton, Donald O., 49 Climate:
about, 159–160 case study, 175–176 cohesiveness and, 162–166, 163 (table) defined, 159 norms and, 161–162 positive, 65–66 questionnaire, 177–178 standards of excellence and, 166–173, 167 (figure), 171 (table) structure and, 160–161
Clinton, Bill, 28–29 Coercive power, 284 (table) Cohesiveness, 162–166, 163 (table), 321 Collaboration, 262–263, 321 Communication:
conflict and, 241–242
505
conflict resolution and, 255–259 positive, 66 skills in, 220 visual, 102
Community, 221–222, 234–235 Competence, 120, 305, 306, 321, 324 Competition, 261, 321 Compromise, 262, 321 Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire, 14–16 Conceptual skills:
about, 118 (figure), 125–126 defined, 125–126, 321 problem solving, 126–128, 126 (table) strategic planning, 128–130 vision, creating, 130
Concern for people, 105, 321 Concern for production, 104, 321 Conchie, Barry, 52, 53 (table) Confidence, 23–24, 321 Conflict:
about, 239–240, 243 (figure) affective element to, 241 belief, 243, 245–246 case study, 265–266 communication and, 241–242 communication strategies for resolving, 255–259 content, 242–243, 245–246 defined, 240, 322 differences and, 241 elements of, 240–241 Fisher and Ury approach to, 250–255, 251 (figure) goal, 246 handling, as interpersonal skill, 125 interdependence and, 241 interpersonal, 240 intrapersonal, 240 Kilmann and Thomas styles of approaching, 259–263, 260 (figure) procedural, 246 questionnaire, 267–269 relational, 246–250, 323 societal, 240 as struggle, 240
506
substantive, 246 value, 243, 246
Conflict Style Questionnaire, 267–269 Conflict styles:
about, 259, 260 (figure) accommodation, 261–262 avoidance, 260–261 collaboration, 262–263 competition, 261 compromise, 262 defined, 259, 322
Consideration behavior, 105, 322 Constructive climate. See Climate Constructive feedback, 170, 171 (table) Content conflict, 242–243, 245–246, 322 Content dimension, 242, 322 Contingency theory, 4 (box), 322 Contributions, recognizing, 225–226 Control issues, 248–249 Cooperativeness, 259 Courtney, Bill, 307–308 Covey, S. R., 141–142 Criteria, in principled negotiation, 254–255 Cultural Diversity Questionnaire, 210–212 Culture, 47–48, 60, 286–287
Daniels, Chavis, 307 Dark side of leadership, 8–9 Das, Reena, 144–145 Daya Dan (orphanage), 144 Dean, M. A., 191, 191 (table) Deloitte, 184–185 Democratic leadership style, 85, 322 Determination, 25, 322 Dickson, M. W., 286 Differentiation, 189, 190, 191 (table), 194, 255–256, 322 Directions, unclear, 304–305 Directive leadership, 309, 322 Discrimination, systemic, 202 Diversity:
approaches to, 186–190, 187 (table) defined, 184–185, 185 (table)
507
recognizing, attending to, and honoring, 198 (table), 200–201 See also Diversity and inclusion
Diversity and inclusion: about, 183–184 barriers to, 201–205 case study, 208–209 historical perspective, 186–190, 187 (table) inclusion framework, 190–191, 191 (table), 194 inclusive practices model, 194–197, 195 (figure) leader practices advancing, 197–201, 198 (table) questionnaire, 210–212 as terms, 183–184 Xerox Corporation, 192–193
Dorfman, P. W., 22 Dream Foundation Trust Model Street School, 245 Duty ethics, 294 Dyslexia, 102
Eastern Michigan University, 122 Education in Pakistan, 244–245 Egoism ethics, 294 Eisenberg, Pablo, 281 Ely, R. J., 188 Emotional intelligence, 3 (box), 122, 124–125, 322 Empathy, 124–125, 224, 225 (table), 322 Employee orientation, 105, 322 Empowerment, 228 Empower the Children (ETC), 144–145 End values, 285, 322 Engagement, 197, 198 (table) Equal employment opportunity laws, 187–188 Equal Pay Act (1963), 188 Esteem issues, 247 Ethical leadership:
about, 273–274 actions in, 276–279, 281 case study, 289–290 character in, 275–276, 277 (table), 286 culture and, 286–287 defined, 274, 322 factors, 274–286 goals in, 281–282
508
honesty in, 282–283 power in, 284–285, 284 (table) questionnaire, 291–294 values in, 285–286
Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire, 291–294 Ethical values, 285, 322 Ethnocentrism, 201–202 Excellence, standards of, 166–173, 167 (figure), 171 (table), 324 Exclusion, 190, 191 (table) Executive Orders (1961–1965), 188 Expectancy theory, 225, 305, 322 Expert power, 284 (table)
Face saving, 257–259, 322 Fairness, 277 (table), 279, 285 Feedback, constructive, 170, 171 (table) Feelings, 241 Ferdman, B. M., 184, 186, 194, 196, 197, 198 (table) Fisher, Roger, 239, 240, 250–255, 251 (figure), 256, 258 Fisher and Ury approach to conflict:
about, 250, 251 (figure) criteria, 254–255 interests, 252–253 options, 253–254 people, 251–252
Fox, Anne, 26 Fox, Terry, 149–150 (box) Fractionation, 256–257, 322 Francis, Pope, 32 French, J. R., Jr., 284
Gallup Organization, 48–49, 50–53, 51 (table), 52 (figure), 53 (table), 322 Gandhi, Mohandas, 24–25 Gardner, Howard, 58–59 Gates, Bill, 32–33, 280 Gates, Melinda, 280 Gender-based studies, 4 (box) Gen-Xers, 185 Getting to Yes (Fisher & Ury), 239 Giffoniello, Rosalie, 144–145 Giving Pledge, 280–281 Global Leadership and Organizational Behavior Effectiveness (GLOBE) studies, 8, 8
509
(table) Goals, 246, 281–282, 303–304, 322 Golden Rule, 279 Gordon, A., 108 “Great Man” theories, 3 (box), 322
See also Trait approach Group inclusive practices, 195–196, 195 (figure) Group synergy, 222–223 Gupta, V., 22
Hanges, P. J., 22, 286 Harrison, D. A., 184 Harvey, C. P., 189 Healey, J. P., 188 Henderson, L., 184 Herring, C., 184 Hersey, P., 4 (box) Hewlett-Packard (HP), 168–169 Hewlett, William, 168 Hocker, J. L., 240, 241 Hogan, R., 9 Holcombe Ehrhard, K., 191, 191 (table) Honesty, 282–283, 322 Hooijberg, R., 128–129 House, Robert, 8, 22, 302 “House Divided” speech (Lincoln), 230 Human Side of Enterprise, The (McGregor), 78 Hussein, Saddam, 284–285
“I” language, 171 (table) Inclusion:
defined, 185–186 framework for, 190–191, 191 (table), 194 of out-group members, 227 See also Diversity and inclusion
Inclusive practices model, 194–197, 195 (figure) Individual inclusive practices, 195 (figure), 196, 197 Influence, 7, 88, 89 (figure), 198 (table), 199 Initiating structure, 103–104, 322 Integrity, 26, 29, 286, 322 Intelligence, 22–23, 323 Interdependence, 241
510
Interests, 252–253 Interpersonal conflict, 240 Interpersonal inclusive practices, 195 (figure), 196 Interpersonal skills, 118 (figure), 121–122, 125, 323 Into Thin Air (Krakauer), 148 Intrapersonal conflict, 240 Involvement, 198–199, 198 (table), 311
Javidan, M., 22 Jay, Rohrlich, 101 Jobs, Steve, 62–63 Johnson, Sally, 107 (box) Josephson Institute, 276, 277 (table) Justice, 279, 285 Justice ethics, 294
Kaiser, R. B., 9 Kennedy, John F., 24, 146, 147 Kilmann, R. H., 259, 260 (figure) Kilmann and Thomas conflict styles:
about, 259, 260 (figure) accommodation, 261–262 avoidance, 260–261 collaboration, 262–263 competition, 261 compromise, 262
King, Martin Luther, Jr., 25 Kotter, John P., 61 Kouzes, J. M., 142, 173 Krakauer, Jon, 148
LaFasto, F. M. J., 166, 170 Laissez-faire leadership style, 85–86, 323 Language, 148 Larson, C. E., 166, 170 Leader influence, 88, 89 (figure) Leader–member exchange (LMX) theory, 4 (box), 227–228, 323 Leadership:
as ability, 2,5 as behavior, 3 (box), 6 dark side of, 8–9 defined, 323 evolution of, 3–4 (box), 5 (figure)
511
as influence process, 7 as relationship, 4 (box), 6–7 as skill, 5–6 as trait, 2, 3 (box) See also specific topics; specific types
Leadership inclusive practices, 195 (figure), 196 Leadership skills. See Skills Leadership Skills Questionnaire, 134–135 Leadership Snapshots:
Bachal, Humaira, 244–245 Courtney, Bill, 307–308 Giffoniello, Rosalie, 144–145 Giving Pledge, 280–281 Jobs, Steve, 62–63 Lincoln, Abraham, 229–230 Mandela, Nelson, 27–28 Nooyl, Indra, 10–11 Ransom, Victoria, 87–88 Washington, Coquese, 123–124 Whitman, Meg, 168–169 Wilz, Mick, 102–103 Xerox Corporation, 192–193
Leadership Strengths Questionnaire, 71–73 Leadership styles:
about, 82–83 authoritarian, 83–84, 321 case study, 91–92 defined, 82–83, 323 democratic, 85, 322 laissez-faire, 85–86, 323 leader influence and, 88, 89 (figure) questionnaire, 93–94
Leadership Styles Questionnaire, 93–94 Leadership traits. See Traits Leadership Traits Questionnaire, 39–41 Leadership Vision Questionnaire, 154–155 Learn, ability to, 128–129 Learned behaviors, 56, 56 (figure), 323 Legal precedent/ramifications, 254 Legitimate power, 284 (table) Lembke, Jessica, 106 (box) Leukemia and Lymphoma Society’s Team In Training, 146–147
512
Lewin, K., 83 Lincoln, Abraham, 229–230 Linley, A., 48 Lipman-Blumen, J., 9 Lippitt, R., 83 Listening, 224, 323 LMX theory. See Leader–member exchange theory Lobo, Rebecca, 123 Loden, M., 185, 185 (table) Loehr, J., 142
Machiavelli, N., 3 (box) MacKie, D., 59 Management by walking around, 119 Managerial wisdom, 129 Managing people, 119 Managing resources, 119–120 Manassas High School (North Memphis, TN), 307–308 Mandela, Nelson, 25, 276 Maps, 146, 323 Marathon of Hope, 149–150 (box) Maslow, A., 247 Mathews, Elizabeth, 106–107 (box) Mayer, J. D., 124 McGraw, Muffet, 123 McGregor, Douglas, 78
See also Theory X; Theory Y Meaning, positive, 66 Melting pot metaphor, 188 Microsoft Corporation, 32, 33 Millennials, 185 Mission, 160, 323 Missionaries of Charity, 31–32, 144 Mitchelson, J. A., 286 Modal values, 285, 323 Moral standards, 254 Motivation, low, 305–306, 308–309 Mouton, J. S., 3, 259 Myers, V. A., 186
“New leadership” approach, 4 (box) NeXT Computer, 62
513
Nooyl, Indra, 10–11 Norms, 161–162, 323 Notre Dame, 123
Observations, 171 (table) Obstacles:
about, 302–303, 303 (figure) case study, 314–315 challenge, lack of, 312 defined, 301, 323 directions, unclear, 304–305 goals, unclear, 303–304 involvement, low, 311 motivation, low, 305–306, 308–309 questionnaire, 316–317 tasks, complex, 309–310 tasks, simple, 310–311
Options, in principled negotiation, 253–254 Organizational Climate Questionnaire, 177–178 Organizational inclusive practices, 194, 195 (figure), 197 Ouchi, William, 82 Outcomes, valued, 308 Out-group members:
about, 217–218 case study, 232–233 contributions, recognizing, 225–226 defined, 219, 323 empathy for, 224, 225 (table) empowering, 228 formation of out-groups, 219–220 impact of, 221–223 including, 227 listening to, 224 questionnaire, 234–235 special relationship with, 227–228 voice, giving, 228
Packard, David, 168 Padilla, A., 9 Pakistan, 244–245 Paraphrasing, 225 (table) Participative leadership, 313, 323
514
Path–goal leadership, 302–303, 316–317, 323 Path–Goal Styles Questionnaire, 316–317 Path–goal theory, 4 (box), 323 Peck, Scott, 301 Penn State, 123–124 People:
concern for, 105, 321 managing, 119 in principled negotiation, 251–252
PepsiCo, 10–11 Performance issues, resolving, 170 Performance reviews, 172 Personality clash, 246
See also Relational conflict Personal styles, 100, 323 Phelps, Michael, 24 Philanthropy, 280–281 Philosophy of leadership:
about, 78 defined, 78, 323 Theory X, 78–80, 79 (table) Theory Y, 80–82, 80 (table)
Pictures, 142–143, 323 Pixar Animation Studios, 62 Plagiarism, 289–290 Planning, strategic, 128–130, 324 Pluralism, 189 Positive Leadership (Cameron), 65–66 Positive psychology, 49–50, 323 Posner, B. Z., 142, 173 Power, 284–285, 284 (table), 323 Practice, 24 Precedent, 254 Prejudice, 202–203 Principled negotiation:
about, 250, 251 (figure) criteria, 254–255 defined, 250, 323 interests, 252–253 options, 253–254 people, 251–252
Privilege, 204–205
515
Problem factor, 251–252 Problem identification, 126–127 Problem-solving skills, 126–128, 126 (table), 323 Procedural conflict, 246 Process behaviors, 6, 323 Production, concern for, 104, 321 Production orientation, 104, 323 Productivity, 164 Professional standards, 254
Questionnaires: climate, 177–178 conflict, 267–269 diversity and inclusion, 210–212 ethical leadership, 291–294 leadership styles, 93–94 obstacles, 316–317 out-group members, 234–235 skills, 134–135 traits, 39–41 vision, 154–155
R2 Strengths Profiler, 55–58, 56 (figure) Randel, A. E., 191, 191 (table) Ransom, Victoria, 87–88 Rath, Tom, 52, 53 (table) Raven, B., 284 Realized strengths, 55, 56 (figure), 323 Reddin, W. J., 4 (box) Referent power, 284 (table) Reflected Best Self Exercise, 59 Reflection, 225 (table) Relational approach, 4 (box), 6–7, 323 Relational conflict:
about, 246–247, 249–250 affiliation issues and, 249 control issues and, 248–249 defined, 246–247, 323 esteem issues and, 247
Relationship behaviors, 3 (box), 324 Relationship dimension, 242, 324 Relationship-oriented leadership, 104–105, 104 (figure), 106–107 (box), 108, 110,
516
324 Relationships, positive, 66 Relationship style, 101, 107 (box) Resick, C. J., 286 Resources, managing, 119–120 Respect, 198 (table), 199, 223, 277 (table), 279 Responsibility, 79, 81, 277 (table) Restatement, 225 (table) Results:
requiring, 170 reviewing, 170–173, 171 (table) rewarding, 173
Reward power, 284 (table) Rivera, L. A., 205 Road Less Traveled, The (Peck), 301
Safety, 198, 198 (table) Salad metaphor, 189 Salovey, P., 124 Same-sex couples, 196–197 Scandals, 273–274 Schutz, William, 186, 190, 227 Schwartz, B., 30 Schwartz, T., 142 Scientific judgment, 255 Servant leadership, 4 (box), 324 Serving others, 279 Seward, William, 229–230 Shore, L. M., 191, 191 (table) Sin, H., 184 Singh, G., 191, 191 (table) Situational approach, 3–4 (box), 324 Skills:
about, 117–118, 118 (figure) administrative, 118–120, 118 (figure), 321 case study, 132–133 communication, 220 conceptual, 118 (figure), 125–130, 321 defined, 5, 324 interpersonal, 118 (figure), 121–122, 125, 323 leadership as, 5–6 problem-solving, 126–128, 126 (table), 323
517
questionnaire, 134–135 social, 220
Smorgasbord metaphor, 189 Sociability, 25–26, 324 Social identity theory, 219–220, 324 Social perceptiveness, 121–122, 324 Social skills, 220 Societal conflict, 240 Societal inclusive practices, 194, 195 (figure), 196–197 Solutions, 127–128 South Africa, 27–28 Special relationship with out-group members, 227–228 Spiritual leadership, 4 (box), 324 Standards:
of excellence, 166–173, 167 (figure), 171 (table), 324 moral, 254 professional, 254
Status quo, 142, 324 Stepnick, A., 188 Stereotypes, 203–204 Strategic planning, 128–130, 324 Strength equation, 51, 52 (figure) Strengths:
about, 47–48 case study, 69–70 culture and, 47–48, 60 defined, 48, 55, 324 developing your, 59–61, 61 (figure) domains of, 52, 53 (table) historical background, 48–58 identifying your, 58–59, 58 (table) questionnaire, 71–73 realized, 55, 56 (figure), 323 recognizing/engaging strengths of others, 63–65 teams and, 52–53 unrealized, 55–56, 56 (figure), 325 work environment and, 65–66 See also Weaknesses
StrengthsFinder, 49, 51–53, 52 (figure) Structure, 103–104, 160–161, 324 Struggle, conflict as, 240 Style:
518
personal, 100, 323 relationship, 101, 107 (box) task, 100–101, 106 (box), 107 (box) See also Conflict styles; Leadership styles
Substantive conflict, 246 Support, 225 (table) Supportive leadership, 310, 324 Sur-Seal, 102–103 Syllabi, 160–161 Symbols, 148 Synergy, 161, 222–223, 324 Systemic discrimination, 202
Taber, T., 108 Talent themes, 50–51, 51 (table), 324 Task and Relationship Questionnaire, 111–112 Task behaviors, 3 (box), 6, 324 Task-oriented leadership, 103–104, 104 (figure), 106, 108, 110, 324 Tasks:
complex, 309–310 simple, 310–311
Task style, 100–101, 106 (box), 107 (box) Team In Training, 146–147 Teams, 52–53 Technical competence, 120, 324 Teresa, Mother, 31–32, 142 Terry, Robert, 252 Themes of human talent, 50–51, 51 (table), 324 Theories, defined, 3 (box)
See also specific theories Theory X, 78–80, 79 (table), 324 Theory Y, 80–82, 80 (table), 324 Theory Z, 82 Thomas, D. A., 188 Thomas, K. W., 259, 260 (figure) Three Rs, 167, 169–173 Tradition, 255 Trait approach, 3 (box), 325 Traits:
about, 22 case study, 37–38 charisma, 24–25
519
confidence, 23–24 defined, 2, 325 determination, 25 global leadership, 8, 8 (table), 22 integrity, 26, 29 intelligence, 22–23 leadership as, 2, 3 (box) in practice, 29–35 questionnaire, 39–41 sociability, 25–26
Transformational leadership theory, 4 (box), 325 Trustworthiness, 277 (table)
Understanding, 23–24 University of Michigan, 121–122, 148 University of Washington rowing team, 164 Unrealized strengths, 55–56, 56 (figure), 325 Upjohn Company, 166, 167 (figure) Ury, William, 239, 240, 250–255, 251 (figure), 256, 258 Utilitarian ethics, 294
Valued, feeling, 198 (table), 199, 309 Values:
conflict regarding, 243, 246 defined, 143, 325 end, 285, 322 ethical, 285, 322 ethical leadership, 285–286 modal, 285, 323 vision as, 143, 145–146, 147 Wildfire Interactive, 87–88
Values in Action Classification of Character Strengths, 53–54, 54 (table) Values in Action (VIA) Institute, 53–55, 54 (table) Values in Action Inventory of Strengths (VIA-IS), 54–55 Virtue ethics, 294 Vision:
about, 141–142 adapting to audience, 147 articulating, 147–148 case study, 152–153 as challenge, 146–147 as change, 143
520
as conceptual skill, 130 defined, 141, 325 implementing, 148–149, 149–150 (box) as map, 146 as picture, 142–143 questionnaire, 154–155 as values, 143, 145–146, 147
Visual communication, 102 Voice, giving to out-group members, 228 Vuong, V., 196
Washington, Coquese, 123–124 Washington, George, 29–30 Weaknesses, 56–57, 56 (figure), 61, 63, 325
See also Strengths White, R. K., 83 Whitman, Meg, 168–169 Whole, feeling, 198 (table), 200 Wildfire Interactive, 87–88 Wilmot, W. W., 240, 241 Wilz, Mick, 102–103 Winfrey, Oprah, 33–34 Wisdom, managerial, 129 Women employees, 192–193 Women’s National Basketball Association (WNBA), 123 Wooden, John, 5 Work, attitudes toward, 78–79, 80 Work and Love (Rohrlich), 101 Work environment, positive, 65–66
Xerox Corporation, 192–193
Yousafzai, Malala, 244, 245 Yukl, G., 108
Zuckerberg, Mark, 281
521
- Preface
- About the Author
- 1. Understanding Leadership
- Introduction
- Leadership Explained
- “Leadership Is a Trait”
- “Leadership Is an Ability”
- “Leadership Is a Skill”
- “Leadership Is a Behavior”
- “Leadership Is a Relationship”
- “Leadership Is an Influence Process”
- Global Leadership Attributes
- The Dark Side of Leadership
- Leadership Snapshot: Indra Nooyi
- Summary
- Application
- 1.1 Case Study
- 1.2 Conceptualizing Leadership Questionnaire
- 1.3 Observational Exercise
- 1.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 2. Recognizing Your Traits
- Introduction
- Leadership Traits Explained
- Intelligence
- Confidence
- Charisma
- Determination
- Sociability
- Integrity
- Leadership Snapshot: Nelson Mandela
- Leadership Traits in Practice
- George Washington (1732–1799)
- Winston Churchill (1874–1965)
- Mother Teresa (1910–1997)
- Bill Gates (1955–)
- Oprah Winfrey (1954–)
- Summary
- Application
- 2.1 Case Study
- 2.2 Leadership Traits Questionnaire
- 2.3 Observational Exercise
- 2.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 3. Engaging Strengths
- Introduction
- Strengths-Based Leadership Explained
- Historical Background
- Identifying and Measuring Strengths
- Strengths-Based Leadership in Practice
- Discovering Your Strengths
- Developing Your Strengths
- Addressing Your Weaknesses
- Leadership Snapshot: Steve Jobs
- Recognizing and Engaging the Strengths of Others
- Fostering a Positive Strengths-Based Environment
- Summary
- Application
- 3.1 Case Study
- 3.2 Leadership Strengths Questionnaire
- 3.3 Observational Exercise
- 3.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 4. Understanding Philosophy and Styles
- Introduction
- Leadership Philosophy Explained
- Theory X
- Theory Y
- Leadership Styles Explained
- Authoritarian Leadership Style
- Democratic Leadership Style
- Laissez-Faire Leadership Style
- Leadership Snapshot: Victoria Ransom
- Leadership Styles in Practice
- Summary
- Application
- 4.1 Case Study
- 4.2 Leadership Styles Questionnaire
- 4.3 Observational Exercise
- 4.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 5. Attending to Tasks and Relationships
- Introduction
- Task and Relationship Styles Explained
- Task Style
- Relationship Style
- Leadership Snapshot: Mick Wilz
- Task and Relationship Styles in Practice
- Task Leadership
- Relationship Leadership
- Summary
- Application
- 5.1 Case Study
- 5.2 Task and Relationship Questionnaire
- 5.3 Observational Exercise
- 5.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 6. Developing Leadership Skills
- Introduction
- Administrative Skills Explained
- Administrative Skills in Practice
- Interpersonal Skills Explained
- Interpersonal Skills in Practice
- Leadership Snapshot: Coquese Washington
- Conceptual Skills Explained
- Conceptual Skills in Practice
- Summary
- Application
- 6.1 Case Study
- 6.2 Leadership Skills Questionnaire
- 6.3 Observational Exercise
- 6.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 7. Creating a Vision
- Introduction
- Vision Explained
- A Picture
- A Change
- Values
- Leadership Snapshot: Rosalie Giffoniello
- A Map
- A Challenge
- Vision in Practice
- Articulating a Vision
- Implementing a Vision
- Summary
- Application
- 7.1 Case Study
- 7.2 Leadership Vision Questionnaire
- 7.3 Observational Exercise
- 7.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 8. Establishing a Constructive Climate
- Introduction
- Constructive Climate Explained
- Climate in Practice
- Providing Structure
- Clarifying Norms
- Building Cohesiveness
- Promoting Standards of Excellence
- Leadership Snapshot: Meg Whitman
- Summary
- Application
- 8.1 Case Study
- 8.2 Organizational Climate Questionnaire
- 8.3 Observational Exercise
- 8.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 9. Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
- Introduction
- Diversity and Inclusion Explained
- Definitions
- Brief Historical Perspective
- Inclusion Framework
- Leadership Snapshot: Ursula Burns
- Diversity and Inclusion in Practice
- Model of Inclusive Practices
- Leader Practices That Advance Diversity and Inclusion
- Barriers to Embracing Diversity and Inclusion
- Summary
- Application
- 9.1 Case Study
- 9.2 Cultural Diversity Awareness Questionnaire
- 9.3 Observational Exercise
- 9.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 10. Listening to Out-Group Members
- Introduction
- Out-Group Members Explained
- How Out-Groups Form
- The Impact of Out-Group Members
- Out-Group Members in Practice
- Strategy 1: Listen to Out-Group Members
- Strategy 2: Show Empathy to Out-Group Members
- Strategy 3: Recognize the Unique Contributions of Out-Group Members
- Strategy 4: Help Out-Group Members Feel Included
- Strategy 5: Create a Special Relationship With Out-Group Members
- Strategy 6: Give Out-Group Members a Voice and Empower Them to Act
- Leadership Snapshot: Abraham Lincoln
- Summary
- Application
- 10.1 Case Study
- 10.2 Building Community Questionnaire
- 10.3 Observational Exercise
- 10.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 11. Managing Conflict
- Introduction
- Conflict Explained
- Communication and Conflict
- Conflict on the Content Level
- Leadership Snapshot: Humaira Bachal
- Conflict on the Relational Level
- Managing Conflict in Practice
- Fisher and Ury Approach to Conflict
- Communication Strategies for Conflict Resolution
- Kilmann and Thomas Styles of Approaching Conflict
- Summary
- Application
- 11.1 Case Study
- 11.2 Conflict Style Questionnaire
- 11.3 Observational Exercise
- 11.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 12. Addressing Ethics in Leadership
- Introduction
- Leadership Ethics Explained
- Leadership Ethics in Practice
- 1. The Character of the Leader
- 2. The Actions of the Leader
- Leadership Snapshot: Warren Buffett and Bill and Melinda Gates
- 3. The Goals of the Leader
- 4. The Honesty of the Leader
- 5. The Power of the Leader
- 6. The Values of the Leader
- Culture and Leadership Ethics
- Summary
- Application
- 12.1 Case Study
- 12.2 Sample Items From the Ethical Leadership Style Questionnaire
- 12.3 Observational Exercise
- 12.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- 13. Overcoming Obstacles
- Introduction
- Obstacles Explained
- Overcoming Obstacles in Practice
- Obstacle 1: Unclear Goals
- Obstacle 2: Unclear Directions
- Obstacle 3: Low Motivation
- Leadership Snapshot: Bill Courtney
- Obstacle 4: Complex Tasks
- Obstacle 5: Simple Tasks
- Obstacle 6: Low Involvement
- Obstacle 7: Lack of a Challenge
- Summary
- Application
- 13.1 Case Study
- 13.2 Path–Goal Styles Questionnaire
- 13.3 Observational Exercise
- 13.4 Reflection and Action Worksheet
- References
- Glossary
- Index
